(send_process): Use encode_coding_object instead of
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / calc.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
3 @c smallbook
4 @setfilename ../../info/calc
5 @c [title]
6 @settitle GNU Emacs Calc Manual
7 @setchapternewpage odd
8 @comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
9
10 @c The following macros are used for conditional output for single lines.
11 @c @texline foo
12 @c `foo' will appear only in TeX output
13 @c @infoline foo
14 @c `foo' will appear only in non-TeX output
15
16 @c @expr{expr} will typeset an expression;
17 @c $x$ in TeX, @samp{x} otherwise.
18
19 @iftex
20 @macro texline
21 @end macro
22 @alias infoline=comment
23 @alias expr=math
24 @alias tfn=code
25 @alias mathit=expr
26 @alias summarykey=key
27 @macro cpi{}
28 @math{@pi{}}
29 @end macro
30 @macro cpiover{den}
31 @math{@pi/\den\}
32 @end macro
33 @end iftex
34
35 @ifnottex
36 @alias texline=comment
37 @macro infoline{stuff}
38 \stuff\
39 @end macro
40 @alias expr=samp
41 @alias tfn=t
42 @alias mathit=i
43 @macro summarykey{ky}
44 \ky\
45 @end macro
46 @macro cpi{}
47 @expr{pi}
48 @end macro
49 @macro cpiover{den}
50 @expr{pi/\den\}
51 @end macro
52 @end ifnottex
53
54
55 @tex
56 % Suggested by Karl Berry <karl@@freefriends.org>
57 \gdef\!{\mskip-\thinmuskip}
58 @end tex
59
60 @c Fix some other things specifically for this manual.
61 @iftex
62 @finalout
63 @mathcode`@:=`@: @c Make Calc fractions come out right in math mode
64 @tex
65 \gdef\coloneq{\mathrel{\mathord:\mathord=}}
66
67 \gdef\beforedisplay{\vskip-10pt}
68 \gdef\afterdisplay{\vskip-5pt}
69 \gdef\beforedisplayh{\vskip-25pt}
70 \gdef\afterdisplayh{\vskip-10pt}
71 @end tex
72 @newdimen@kyvpos @kyvpos=0pt
73 @newdimen@kyhpos @kyhpos=0pt
74 @newcount@calcclubpenalty @calcclubpenalty=1000
75 @ignore
76 @newcount@calcpageno
77 @newtoks@calcoldeverypar @calcoldeverypar=@everypar
78 @everypar={@calceverypar@the@calcoldeverypar}
79 @ifx@turnoffactive@undefinedzzz@def@turnoffactive{}@fi
80 @ifx@ninett@undefinedzzz@font@ninett=cmtt9@fi
81 @catcode`@\=0 \catcode`\@=11
82 \r@ggedbottomtrue
83 \catcode`\@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
84 @end ignore
85 @end iftex
86
87 @copying
88 @ifinfo
89 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator.
90 @end ifinfo
91 @ifnotinfo
92 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator, included with GNU Emacs 23.1.
93 @end ifnotinfo
94
95 Copyright @copyright{} 1990, 1991, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004,
96 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
97
98 @quotation
99 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
101 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
102 Invariant Sections being just ``GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE'', with the
103 Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and with the Back-Cover
104 Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is included in the section
105 entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
106
107 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
108 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
109 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
110 @end quotation
111 @end copying
112
113 @dircategory Emacs
114 @direntry
115 * Calc: (calc). Advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool.
116 @end direntry
117
118 @titlepage
119 @sp 6
120 @center @titlefont{Calc Manual}
121 @sp 4
122 @center GNU Emacs Calc
123 @c [volume]
124 @sp 5
125 @center Dave Gillespie
126 @center daveg@@synaptics.com
127 @page
128
129 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
130 @insertcopying
131 @end titlepage
132
133
134 @summarycontents
135
136 @c [end]
137
138 @contents
139
140 @c [begin]
141 @ifnottex
142 @node Top, Getting Started, (dir), (dir)
143 @chapter The GNU Emacs Calculator
144
145 @noindent
146 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool
147 written by Dave Gillespie that runs as part of the GNU Emacs environment.
148
149 This manual, also written (mostly) by Dave Gillespie, is divided into
150 three major parts: ``Getting Started,'' the ``Calc Tutorial,'' and the
151 ``Calc Reference.'' The Tutorial introduces all the major aspects of
152 Calculator use in an easy, hands-on way. The remainder of the manual is
153 a complete reference to the features of the Calculator.
154 @end ifnottex
155
156 @ifinfo
157 For help in the Emacs Info system (which you are using to read this
158 file), type @kbd{?}. (You can also type @kbd{h} to run through a
159 longer Info tutorial.)
160 @end ifinfo
161
162 @insertcopying
163
164 @menu
165 * Getting Started:: General description and overview.
166 @ifinfo
167 * Interactive Tutorial::
168 @end ifinfo
169 * Tutorial:: A step-by-step introduction for beginners.
170
171 * Introduction:: Introduction to the Calc reference manual.
172 * Data Types:: Types of objects manipulated by Calc.
173 * Stack and Trail:: Manipulating the stack and trail buffers.
174 * Mode Settings:: Adjusting display format and other modes.
175 * Arithmetic:: Basic arithmetic functions.
176 * Scientific Functions:: Transcendentals and other scientific functions.
177 * Matrix Functions:: Operations on vectors and matrices.
178 * Algebra:: Manipulating expressions algebraically.
179 * Units:: Operations on numbers with units.
180 * Store and Recall:: Storing and recalling variables.
181 * Graphics:: Commands for making graphs of data.
182 * Kill and Yank:: Moving data into and out of Calc.
183 * Keypad Mode:: Operating Calc from a keypad.
184 * Embedded Mode:: Working with formulas embedded in a file.
185 * Programming:: Calc as a programmable calculator.
186
187 * Copying:: How you can copy and share Calc.
188 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
189 * Customizing Calc:: Customizing Calc.
190 * Reporting Bugs:: How to report bugs and make suggestions.
191
192 * Summary:: Summary of Calc commands and functions.
193
194 * Key Index:: The standard Calc key sequences.
195 * Command Index:: The interactive Calc commands.
196 * Function Index:: Functions (in algebraic formulas).
197 * Concept Index:: General concepts.
198 * Variable Index:: Variables used by Calc (both user and internal).
199 * Lisp Function Index:: Internal Lisp math functions.
200 @end menu
201
202 @ifinfo
203 @node Getting Started, Interactive Tutorial, Top, Top
204 @end ifinfo
205 @ifnotinfo
206 @node Getting Started, Tutorial, Top, Top
207 @end ifnotinfo
208 @chapter Getting Started
209 @noindent
210 This chapter provides a general overview of Calc, the GNU Emacs
211 Calculator: What it is, how to start it and how to exit from it,
212 and what are the various ways that it can be used.
213
214 @menu
215 * What is Calc::
216 * About This Manual::
217 * Notations Used in This Manual::
218 * Demonstration of Calc::
219 * Using Calc::
220 * History and Acknowledgements::
221 @end menu
222
223 @node What is Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started, Getting Started
224 @section What is Calc?
225
226 @noindent
227 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced calculator and mathematical tool that runs as
228 part of the GNU Emacs environment. Very roughly based on the HP-28/48
229 series of calculators, its many features include:
230
231 @itemize @bullet
232 @item
233 Choice of algebraic or RPN (stack-based) entry of calculations.
234
235 @item
236 Arbitrary precision integers and floating-point numbers.
237
238 @item
239 Arithmetic on rational numbers, complex numbers (rectangular and polar),
240 error forms with standard deviations, open and closed intervals, vectors
241 and matrices, dates and times, infinities, sets, quantities with units,
242 and algebraic formulas.
243
244 @item
245 Mathematical operations such as logarithms and trigonometric functions.
246
247 @item
248 Programmer's features (bitwise operations, non-decimal numbers).
249
250 @item
251 Financial functions such as future value and internal rate of return.
252
253 @item
254 Number theoretical features such as prime factorization and arithmetic
255 modulo @var{m} for any @var{m}.
256
257 @item
258 Algebraic manipulation features, including symbolic calculus.
259
260 @item
261 Moving data to and from regular editing buffers.
262
263 @item
264 Embedded mode for manipulating Calc formulas and data directly
265 inside any editing buffer.
266
267 @item
268 Graphics using GNUPLOT, a versatile (and free) plotting program.
269
270 @item
271 Easy programming using keyboard macros, algebraic formulas,
272 algebraic rewrite rules, or extended Emacs Lisp.
273 @end itemize
274
275 Calc tries to include a little something for everyone; as a result it is
276 large and might be intimidating to the first-time user. If you plan to
277 use Calc only as a traditional desk calculator, all you really need to
278 read is the ``Getting Started'' chapter of this manual and possibly the
279 first few sections of the tutorial. As you become more comfortable with
280 the program you can learn its additional features. Calc does not
281 have the scope and depth of a fully-functional symbolic math package,
282 but Calc has the advantages of convenience, portability, and freedom.
283
284 @node About This Manual, Notations Used in This Manual, What is Calc, Getting Started
285 @section About This Manual
286
287 @noindent
288 This document serves as a complete description of the GNU Emacs
289 Calculator. It works both as an introduction for novices and as
290 a reference for experienced users. While it helps to have some
291 experience with GNU Emacs in order to get the most out of Calc,
292 this manual ought to be readable even if you don't know or use Emacs
293 regularly.
294
295 This manual is divided into three major parts:@: the ``Getting
296 Started'' chapter you are reading now, the Calc tutorial, and the Calc
297 reference manual.
298 @c [when-split]
299 @c This manual has been printed in two volumes, the @dfn{Tutorial} and the
300 @c @dfn{Reference}. Both volumes include a copy of the ``Getting Started''
301 @c chapter.
302
303 If you are in a hurry to use Calc, there is a brief ``demonstration''
304 below which illustrates the major features of Calc in just a couple of
305 pages. If you don't have time to go through the full tutorial, this
306 will show you everything you need to know to begin.
307 @xref{Demonstration of Calc}.
308
309 The tutorial chapter walks you through the various parts of Calc
310 with lots of hands-on examples and explanations. If you are new
311 to Calc and you have some time, try going through at least the
312 beginning of the tutorial. The tutorial includes about 70 exercises
313 with answers. These exercises give you some guided practice with
314 Calc, as well as pointing out some interesting and unusual ways
315 to use its features.
316
317 The reference section discusses Calc in complete depth. You can read
318 the reference from start to finish if you want to learn every aspect
319 of Calc. Or, you can look in the table of contents or the Concept
320 Index to find the parts of the manual that discuss the things you
321 need to know.
322
323 @c @cindex Marginal notes
324 Every Calc keyboard command is listed in the Calc Summary, and also
325 in the Key Index. Algebraic functions, @kbd{M-x} commands, and
326 variables also have their own indices.
327 @c @texline Each
328 @c @infoline In the printed manual, each
329 @c paragraph that is referenced in the Key or Function Index is marked
330 @c in the margin with its index entry.
331
332 @c [fix-ref Help Commands]
333 You can access this manual on-line at any time within Calc by pressing
334 the @kbd{h i} key sequence. Outside of the Calc window, you can press
335 @kbd{C-x * i} to read the manual on-line. From within Calc the command
336 @kbd{h t} will jump directly to the Tutorial; from outside of Calc the
337 command @kbd{C-x * t} will jump to the Tutorial and start Calc if
338 necessary. Pressing @kbd{h s} or @kbd{C-x * s} will take you directly
339 to the Calc Summary. Within Calc, you can also go to the part of the
340 manual describing any Calc key, function, or variable using
341 @w{@kbd{h k}}, @kbd{h f}, or @kbd{h v}, respectively. @xref{Help Commands}.
342
343 @ifnottex
344 The Calc manual can be printed, but because the manual is so large, you
345 should only make a printed copy if you really need it. To print the
346 manual, you will need the @TeX{} typesetting program (this is a free
347 program by Donald Knuth at Stanford University) as well as the
348 @file{texindex} program and @file{texinfo.tex} file, both of which can
349 be obtained from the FSF as part of the @code{texinfo} package.
350 To print the Calc manual in one huge tome, you will need the
351 source code to this manual, @file{calc.texi}, available as part of the
352 Emacs source. Once you have this file, type @kbd{texi2dvi calc.texi}.
353 Alternatively, change to the @file{man} subdirectory of the Emacs
354 source distribution, and type @kbd{make calc.dvi}. (Don't worry if you
355 get some ``overfull box'' warnings while @TeX{} runs.)
356 The result will be a device-independent output file called
357 @file{calc.dvi}, which you must print in whatever way is right
358 for your system. On many systems, the command is
359
360 @example
361 lpr -d calc.dvi
362 @end example
363
364 @noindent
365 or
366
367 @example
368 dvips calc.dvi
369 @end example
370 @end ifnottex
371 @c Printed copies of this manual are also available from the Free Software
372 @c Foundation.
373
374 @node Notations Used in This Manual, Demonstration of Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started
375 @section Notations Used in This Manual
376
377 @noindent
378 This section describes the various notations that are used
379 throughout the Calc manual.
380
381 In keystroke sequences, uppercase letters mean you must hold down
382 the shift key while typing the letter. Keys pressed with Control
383 held down are shown as @kbd{C-x}. Keys pressed with Meta held down
384 are shown as @kbd{M-x}. Other notations are @key{RET} for the
385 Return key, @key{SPC} for the space bar, @key{TAB} for the Tab key,
386 @key{DEL} for the Delete key, and @key{LFD} for the Line-Feed key.
387 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards, it is
388 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
389 regularly using Emacs.
390
391 (If you don't have the @key{LFD} or @key{TAB} keys on your keyboard,
392 the @kbd{C-j} and @kbd{C-i} keys are equivalent to them, respectively.
393 If you don't have a Meta key, look for Alt or Extend Char. You can
394 also press @key{ESC} or @kbd{C-[} first to get the same effect, so
395 that @kbd{M-x}, @kbd{@key{ESC} x}, and @kbd{C-[ x} are all equivalent.)
396
397 Sometimes the @key{RET} key is not shown when it is ``obvious''
398 that you must press @key{RET} to proceed. For example, the @key{RET}
399 is usually omitted in key sequences like @kbd{M-x calc-keypad @key{RET}}.
400
401 Commands are generally shown like this: @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision})
402 or @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}). This means that the command is
403 normally used by pressing the @kbd{p} key or @kbd{C-x * k} key sequence,
404 but it also has the full-name equivalent shown, e.g., @kbd{M-x calc-precision}.
405
406 Commands that correspond to functions in algebraic notation
407 are written: @kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}]. This means
408 the @kbd{C} key is equivalent to @kbd{M-x calc-cos}, and that
409 the corresponding function in an algebraic-style formula would
410 be @samp{cos(@var{x})}.
411
412 A few commands don't have key equivalents: @code{calc-sincos}
413 [@code{sincos}].
414
415 @node Demonstration of Calc, Using Calc, Notations Used in This Manual, Getting Started
416 @section A Demonstration of Calc
417
418 @noindent
419 @cindex Demonstration of Calc
420 This section will show some typical small problems being solved with
421 Calc. The focus is more on demonstration than explanation, but
422 everything you see here will be covered more thoroughly in the
423 Tutorial.
424
425 To begin, start Emacs if necessary (usually the command @code{emacs}
426 does this), and type @kbd{C-x * c} to start the
427 Calculator. (You can also use @kbd{M-x calc} if this doesn't work.
428 @xref{Starting Calc}, for various ways of starting the Calculator.)
429
430 Be sure to type all the sample input exactly, especially noting the
431 difference between lower-case and upper-case letters. Remember,
432 @key{RET}, @key{TAB}, @key{DEL}, and @key{SPC} are the Return, Tab,
433 Delete, and Space keys.
434
435 @strong{RPN calculation.} In RPN, you type the input number(s) first,
436 then the command to operate on the numbers.
437
438 @noindent
439 Type @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + Q} to compute
440 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3} = 2.2360679775}.
441 @infoline the square root of 2+3, which is 2.2360679775.
442
443 @noindent
444 Type @kbd{P 2 ^} to compute
445 @texline @math{\pi^2 = 9.86960440109}.
446 @infoline the value of `pi' squared, 9.86960440109.
447
448 @noindent
449 Type @key{TAB} to exchange the order of these two results.
450
451 @noindent
452 Type @kbd{- I H S} to subtract these results and compute the Inverse
453 Hyperbolic sine of the difference, 2.72996136574.
454
455 @noindent
456 Type @key{DEL} to erase this result.
457
458 @strong{Algebraic calculation.} You can also enter calculations using
459 conventional ``algebraic'' notation. To enter an algebraic formula,
460 use the apostrophe key.
461
462 @noindent
463 Type @kbd{' sqrt(2+3) @key{RET}} to compute
464 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3}}.
465 @infoline the square root of 2+3.
466
467 @noindent
468 Type @kbd{' pi^2 @key{RET}} to enter
469 @texline @math{\pi^2}.
470 @infoline `pi' squared.
471 To evaluate this symbolic formula as a number, type @kbd{=}.
472
473 @noindent
474 Type @kbd{' arcsinh($ - $$) @key{RET}} to subtract the second-most-recent
475 result from the most-recent and compute the Inverse Hyperbolic sine.
476
477 @strong{Keypad mode.} If you are using the X window system, press
478 @w{@kbd{C-x * k}} to get Keypad mode. (If you don't use X, skip to
479 the next section.)
480
481 @noindent
482 Click on the @key{2}, @key{ENTER}, @key{3}, @key{+}, and @key{SQRT}
483 ``buttons'' using your left mouse button.
484
485 @noindent
486 Click on @key{PI}, @key{2}, and @tfn{y^x}.
487
488 @noindent
489 Click on @key{INV}, then @key{ENTER} to swap the two results.
490
491 @noindent
492 Click on @key{-}, @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, and @key{SIN}.
493
494 @noindent
495 Click on @key{<-} to erase the result, then click @key{OFF} to turn
496 the Keypad Calculator off.
497
498 @strong{Grabbing data.} Type @kbd{C-x * x} if necessary to exit Calc.
499 Now select the following numbers as an Emacs region: ``Mark'' the
500 front of the list by typing @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or @kbd{C-@@} there,
501 then move to the other end of the list. (Either get this list from
502 the on-line copy of this manual, accessed by @w{@kbd{C-x * i}}, or just
503 type these numbers into a scratch file.) Now type @kbd{C-x * g} to
504 ``grab'' these numbers into Calc.
505
506 @example
507 @group
508 1.23 1.97
509 1.6 2
510 1.19 1.08
511 @end group
512 @end example
513
514 @noindent
515 The result @samp{[1.23, 1.97, 1.6, 2, 1.19, 1.08]} is a Calc ``vector.''
516 Type @w{@kbd{V R +}} to compute the sum of these numbers.
517
518 @noindent
519 Type @kbd{U} to Undo this command, then type @kbd{V R *} to compute
520 the product of the numbers.
521
522 @noindent
523 You can also grab data as a rectangular matrix. Place the cursor on
524 the upper-leftmost @samp{1} and set the mark, then move to just after
525 the lower-right @samp{8} and press @kbd{C-x * r}.
526
527 @noindent
528 Type @kbd{v t} to transpose this
529 @texline @math{3\times2}
530 @infoline 3x2
531 matrix into a
532 @texline @math{2\times3}
533 @infoline 2x3
534 matrix. Type @w{@kbd{v u}} to unpack the rows into two separate
535 vectors. Now type @w{@kbd{V R + @key{TAB} V R +}} to compute the sums
536 of the two original columns. (There is also a special
537 grab-and-sum-columns command, @kbd{C-x * :}.)
538
539 @strong{Units conversion.} Units are entered algebraically.
540 Type @w{@kbd{' 43 mi/hr @key{RET}}} to enter the quantity 43 miles-per-hour.
541 Type @w{@kbd{u c km/hr @key{RET}}}. Type @w{@kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}}}.
542
543 @strong{Date arithmetic.} Type @kbd{t N} to get the current date and
544 time. Type @kbd{90 +} to find the date 90 days from now. Type
545 @kbd{' <25 dec 87> @key{RET}} to enter a date, then @kbd{- 7 /} to see how
546 many weeks have passed since then.
547
548 @strong{Algebra.} Algebraic entries can also include formulas
549 or equations involving variables. Type @kbd{@w{' [x + y} = a, x y = 1] @key{RET}}
550 to enter a pair of equations involving three variables.
551 (Note the leading apostrophe in this example; also, note that the space
552 in @samp{x y} is required.) Type @w{@kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}}} to solve
553 these equations for the variables @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
554
555 @noindent
556 Type @kbd{d B} to view the solutions in more readable notation.
557 Type @w{@kbd{d C}} to view them in C language notation, @kbd{d T}
558 to view them in the notation for the @TeX{} typesetting system,
559 and @kbd{d L} to view them in the notation for the La@TeX{} typesetting
560 system. Type @kbd{d N} to return to normal notation.
561
562 @noindent
563 Type @kbd{7.5}, then @kbd{s l a @key{RET}} to let @expr{a = 7.5} in these formulas.
564 (That's the letter @kbd{l}, not the numeral @kbd{1}.)
565
566 @ifnotinfo
567 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
568 manual. Type @kbd{C-x * c} to return to Calc after each of these
569 commands: @kbd{h k t N} to read about the @kbd{t N} command,
570 @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the @code{sqrt} function, and
571 @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
572 @end ifnotinfo
573 @ifinfo
574 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
575 manual. Remember to type the letter @kbd{l}, then @kbd{C-x * c}, to
576 return here after each of these commands: @w{@kbd{h k t N}} to read
577 about the @w{@kbd{t N}} command, @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the
578 @code{sqrt} function, and @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
579 @end ifinfo
580
581 Press @key{DEL} repeatedly to remove any leftover results from the stack.
582 To exit from Calc, press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again.
583
584 @node Using Calc, History and Acknowledgements, Demonstration of Calc, Getting Started
585 @section Using Calc
586
587 @noindent
588 Calc has several user interfaces that are specialized for
589 different kinds of tasks. As well as Calc's standard interface,
590 there are Quick mode, Keypad mode, and Embedded mode.
591
592 @menu
593 * Starting Calc::
594 * The Standard Interface::
595 * Quick Mode Overview::
596 * Keypad Mode Overview::
597 * Standalone Operation::
598 * Embedded Mode Overview::
599 * Other C-x * Commands::
600 @end menu
601
602 @node Starting Calc, The Standard Interface, Using Calc, Using Calc
603 @subsection Starting Calc
604
605 @noindent
606 On most systems, you can type @kbd{C-x *} to start the Calculator.
607 The key sequence @kbd{C-x *} is bound to the command @code{calc-dispatch},
608 which can be rebound if convenient (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
609
610 When you press @kbd{C-x *}, Emacs waits for you to press a second key to
611 complete the command. In this case, you will follow @kbd{C-x *} with a
612 letter (upper- or lower-case, it doesn't matter for @kbd{C-x *}) that says
613 which Calc interface you want to use.
614
615 To get Calc's standard interface, type @kbd{C-x * c}. To get
616 Keypad mode, type @kbd{C-x * k}. Type @kbd{C-x * ?} to get a brief
617 list of the available options, and type a second @kbd{?} to get
618 a complete list.
619
620 To ease typing, @kbd{C-x * *} also works to start Calc. It starts the
621 same interface (either @kbd{C-x * c} or @w{@kbd{C-x * k}}) that you last
622 used, selecting the @kbd{C-x * c} interface by default.
623
624 If @kbd{C-x *} doesn't work for you, you can always type explicit
625 commands like @kbd{M-x calc} (for the standard user interface) or
626 @w{@kbd{M-x calc-keypad}} (for Keypad mode). First type @kbd{M-x}
627 (that's Meta with the letter @kbd{x}), then, at the prompt,
628 type the full command (like @kbd{calc-keypad}) and press Return.
629
630 The same commands (like @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}) that start
631 the Calculator also turn it off if it is already on.
632
633 @node The Standard Interface, Quick Mode Overview, Starting Calc, Using Calc
634 @subsection The Standard Calc Interface
635
636 @noindent
637 @cindex Standard user interface
638 Calc's standard interface acts like a traditional RPN calculator,
639 operated by the normal Emacs keyboard. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}
640 to start the Calculator, the Emacs screen splits into two windows
641 with the file you were editing on top and Calc on the bottom.
642
643 @smallexample
644 @group
645
646 ...
647 --**-Emacs: myfile (Fundamental)----All----------------------
648 --- Emacs Calculator Mode --- |Emacs Calculator Trail
649 2: 17.3 | 17.3
650 1: -5 | 3
651 . | 2
652 | 4
653 | * 8
654 | ->-5
655 |
656 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All----- --%*- *Calc Trail*
657 @end group
658 @end smallexample
659
660 In this figure, the mode-line for @file{myfile} has moved up and the
661 ``Calculator'' window has appeared below it. As you can see, Calc
662 actually makes two windows side-by-side. The lefthand one is
663 called the @dfn{stack window} and the righthand one is called the
664 @dfn{trail window.} The stack holds the numbers involved in the
665 calculation you are currently performing. The trail holds a complete
666 record of all calculations you have done. In a desk calculator with
667 a printer, the trail corresponds to the paper tape that records what
668 you do.
669
670 In this case, the trail shows that four numbers (17.3, 3, 2, and 4)
671 were first entered into the Calculator, then the 2 and 4 were
672 multiplied to get 8, then the 3 and 8 were subtracted to get @mathit{-5}.
673 (The @samp{>} symbol shows that this was the most recent calculation.)
674 The net result is the two numbers 17.3 and @mathit{-5} sitting on the stack.
675
676 Most Calculator commands deal explicitly with the stack only, but
677 there is a set of commands that allow you to search back through
678 the trail and retrieve any previous result.
679
680 Calc commands use the digits, letters, and punctuation keys.
681 Shifted (i.e., upper-case) letters are different from lowercase
682 letters. Some letters are @dfn{prefix} keys that begin two-letter
683 commands. For example, @kbd{e} means ``enter exponent'' and shifted
684 @kbd{E} means @expr{e^x}. With the @kbd{d} (``display modes'') prefix
685 the letter ``e'' takes on very different meanings: @kbd{d e} means
686 ``engineering notation'' and @kbd{d E} means ``@dfn{eqn} language mode.''
687
688 There is nothing stopping you from switching out of the Calc
689 window and back into your editing window, say by using the Emacs
690 @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window}) command. When the cursor is
691 inside a regular window, Emacs acts just like normal. When the
692 cursor is in the Calc stack or trail windows, keys are interpreted
693 as Calc commands.
694
695 When you quit by pressing @kbd{C-x * c} a second time, the Calculator
696 windows go away but the actual Stack and Trail are not gone, just
697 hidden. When you press @kbd{C-x * c} once again you will get the
698 same stack and trail contents you had when you last used the
699 Calculator.
700
701 The Calculator does not remember its state between Emacs sessions.
702 Thus if you quit Emacs and start it again, @kbd{C-x * c} will give you
703 a fresh stack and trail. There is a command (@kbd{m m}) that lets
704 you save your favorite mode settings between sessions, though.
705 One of the things it saves is which user interface (standard or
706 Keypad) you last used; otherwise, a freshly started Emacs will
707 always treat @kbd{C-x * *} the same as @kbd{C-x * c}.
708
709 The @kbd{q} key is another equivalent way to turn the Calculator off.
710
711 If you type @kbd{C-x * b} first and then @kbd{C-x * c}, you get a
712 full-screen version of Calc (@code{full-calc}) in which the stack and
713 trail windows are still side-by-side but are now as tall as the whole
714 Emacs screen. When you press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again to quit,
715 the file you were editing before reappears. The @kbd{C-x * b} key
716 switches back and forth between ``big'' full-screen mode and the
717 normal partial-screen mode.
718
719 Finally, @kbd{C-x * o} (@code{calc-other-window}) is like @kbd{C-x * c}
720 except that the Calc window is not selected. The buffer you were
721 editing before remains selected instead. If you are in a Calc window,
722 then @kbd{C-x * o} will switch you out of it, being careful not to
723 switch you to the Calc Trail window. So @kbd{C-x * o} is a handy
724 way to switch out of Calc momentarily to edit your file; you can then
725 type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch back into Calc when you are done.
726
727 @node Quick Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, The Standard Interface, Using Calc
728 @subsection Quick Mode (Overview)
729
730 @noindent
731 @dfn{Quick mode} is a quick way to use Calc when you don't need the
732 full complexity of the stack and trail. To use it, type @kbd{C-x * q}
733 (@code{quick-calc}) in any regular editing buffer.
734
735 Quick mode is very simple: It prompts you to type any formula in
736 standard algebraic notation (like @samp{4 - 2/3}) and then displays
737 the result at the bottom of the Emacs screen (@mathit{3.33333333333}
738 in this case). You are then back in the same editing buffer you
739 were in before, ready to continue editing or to type @kbd{C-x * q}
740 again to do another quick calculation. The result of the calculation
741 will also be in the Emacs ``kill ring'' so that a @kbd{C-y} command
742 at this point will yank the result into your editing buffer.
743
744 Calc mode settings affect Quick mode, too, though you will have to
745 go into regular Calc (with @kbd{C-x * c}) to change the mode settings.
746
747 @c [fix-ref Quick Calculator mode]
748 @xref{Quick Calculator}, for further information.
749
750 @node Keypad Mode Overview, Standalone Operation, Quick Mode Overview, Using Calc
751 @subsection Keypad Mode (Overview)
752
753 @noindent
754 @dfn{Keypad mode} is a mouse-based interface to the Calculator.
755 It is designed for use with terminals that support a mouse. If you
756 don't have a mouse, you will have to operate Keypad mode with your
757 arrow keys (which is probably more trouble than it's worth).
758
759 Type @kbd{C-x * k} to turn Keypad mode on or off. Once again you
760 get two new windows, this time on the righthand side of the screen
761 instead of at the bottom. The upper window is the familiar Calc
762 Stack; the lower window is a picture of a typical calculator keypad.
763
764 @tex
765 \dimen0=\pagetotal%
766 \advance \dimen0 by 24\baselineskip%
767 \ifdim \dimen0>\pagegoal \vfill\eject \fi%
768 \medskip
769 @end tex
770 @smallexample
771 @group
772 |--- Emacs Calculator Mode ---
773 |2: 17.3
774 |1: -5
775 | .
776 |--%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calcul
777 |----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
778 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
779 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
780 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
781 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
782 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
783 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
784 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
785 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
786 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
787 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
788 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
789 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
790 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
791 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
792 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
793 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
794 @end group
795 @end smallexample
796
797 Keypad mode is much easier for beginners to learn, because there
798 is no need to memorize lots of obscure key sequences. But not all
799 commands in regular Calc are available on the Keypad. You can
800 always switch the cursor into the Calc stack window to use
801 standard Calc commands if you need. Serious Calc users, though,
802 often find they prefer the standard interface over Keypad mode.
803
804 To operate the Calculator, just click on the ``buttons'' of the
805 keypad using your left mouse button. To enter the two numbers
806 shown here you would click @w{@kbd{1 7 .@: 3 ENTER 5 +/- ENTER}}; to
807 add them together you would then click @kbd{+} (to get 12.3 on
808 the stack).
809
810 If you click the right mouse button, the top three rows of the
811 keypad change to show other sets of commands, such as advanced
812 math functions, vector operations, and operations on binary
813 numbers.
814
815 Because Keypad mode doesn't use the regular keyboard, Calc leaves
816 the cursor in your original editing buffer. You can type in
817 this buffer in the usual way while also clicking on the Calculator
818 keypad. One advantage of Keypad mode is that you don't need an
819 explicit command to switch between editing and calculating.
820
821 If you press @kbd{C-x * b} first, you get a full-screen Keypad mode
822 (@code{full-calc-keypad}) with three windows: The keypad in the lower
823 left, the stack in the lower right, and the trail on top.
824
825 @c [fix-ref Keypad Mode]
826 @xref{Keypad Mode}, for further information.
827
828 @node Standalone Operation, Embedded Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, Using Calc
829 @subsection Standalone Operation
830
831 @noindent
832 @cindex Standalone Operation
833 If you are not in Emacs at the moment but you wish to use Calc,
834 you must start Emacs first. If all you want is to run Calc, you
835 can give the commands:
836
837 @example
838 emacs -f full-calc
839 @end example
840
841 @noindent
842 or
843
844 @example
845 emacs -f full-calc-keypad
846 @end example
847
848 @noindent
849 which run a full-screen Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * c}) or
850 a full-screen X-based Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * k}).
851 In standalone operation, quitting the Calculator (by pressing
852 @kbd{q} or clicking on the keypad @key{EXIT} button) quits Emacs
853 itself.
854
855 @node Embedded Mode Overview, Other C-x * Commands, Standalone Operation, Using Calc
856 @subsection Embedded Mode (Overview)
857
858 @noindent
859 @dfn{Embedded mode} is a way to use Calc directly from inside an
860 editing buffer. Suppose you have a formula written as part of a
861 document like this:
862
863 @smallexample
864 @group
865 The derivative of
866
867 ln(ln(x))
868
869 is
870 @end group
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 and you wish to have Calc compute and format the derivative for
875 you and store this derivative in the buffer automatically. To
876 do this with Embedded mode, first copy the formula down to where
877 you want the result to be, leaving a blank line before and after the
878 formula:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @group
882 The derivative of
883
884 ln(ln(x))
885
886 is
887
888 ln(ln(x))
889 @end group
890 @end smallexample
891
892 Now, move the cursor onto this new formula and press @kbd{C-x * e}.
893 Calc will read the formula (using the surrounding blank lines to tell
894 how much text to read), then push this formula (invisibly) onto the Calc
895 stack. The cursor will stay on the formula in the editing buffer, but
896 the line with the formula will now appear as it would on the Calc stack
897 (in this case, it will be left-aligned) and the buffer's mode line will
898 change to look like the Calc mode line (with mode indicators like
899 @samp{12 Deg} and so on). Even though you are still in your editing
900 buffer, the keyboard now acts like the Calc keyboard, and any new result
901 you get is copied from the stack back into the buffer. To take the
902 derivative, you would type @kbd{a d x @key{RET}}.
903
904 @smallexample
905 @group
906 The derivative of
907
908 ln(ln(x))
909
910 is
911
912 1 / ln(x) x
913 @end group
914 @end smallexample
915
916 (Note that by default, Calc gives division lower precedence than multiplication,
917 so that @samp{1 / ln(x) x} is equivalent to @samp{1 / (ln(x) x)}.)
918
919 To make this look nicer, you might want to press @kbd{d =} to center
920 the formula, and even @kbd{d B} to use Big display mode.
921
922 @smallexample
923 @group
924 The derivative of
925
926 ln(ln(x))
927
928 is
929 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
930 % [calc-mode: language: big]
931
932 1
933 -------
934 ln(x) x
935 @end group
936 @end smallexample
937
938 Calc has added annotations to the file to help it remember the modes
939 that were used for this formula. They are formatted like comments
940 in the @TeX{} typesetting language, just in case you are using @TeX{} or
941 La@TeX{}. (In this example @TeX{} is not being used, so you might want
942 to move these comments up to the top of the file or otherwise put them
943 out of the way.)
944
945 As an extra flourish, we can add an equation number using a
946 righthand label: Type @kbd{d @} (1) @key{RET}}.
947
948 @smallexample
949 @group
950 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
951 % [calc-mode: language: big]
952 % [calc-mode: right-label: " (1)"]
953
954 1
955 ------- (1)
956 ln(x) x
957 @end group
958 @end smallexample
959
960 To leave Embedded mode, type @kbd{C-x * e} again. The mode line
961 and keyboard will revert to the way they were before.
962
963 The related command @kbd{C-x * w} operates on a single word, which
964 generally means a single number, inside text. It searches for an
965 expression which ``looks'' like a number containing the point.
966 Here's an example of its use:
967
968 @smallexample
969 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 1 degrees.
970 @end smallexample
971
972 Place the cursor on the @samp{1}, then type @kbd{C-x * w} to enable
973 Embedded mode on that number. Now type @kbd{3 /} (to get one-third),
974 and @kbd{I T} (the Inverse Tangent converts a slope into an angle),
975 then @w{@kbd{C-x * w}} again to exit Embedded mode.
976
977 @smallexample
978 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 18.4349488229 degrees.
979 @end smallexample
980
981 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
982 @xref{Embedded Mode}, for full details.
983
984 @node Other C-x * Commands, , Embedded Mode Overview, Using Calc
985 @subsection Other @kbd{C-x *} Commands
986
987 @noindent
988 Two more Calc-related commands are @kbd{C-x * g} and @kbd{C-x * r},
989 which ``grab'' data from a selected region of a buffer into the
990 Calculator. The region is defined in the usual Emacs way, by
991 a ``mark'' placed at one end of the region, and the Emacs
992 cursor or ``point'' placed at the other.
993
994 The @kbd{C-x * g} command reads the region in the usual left-to-right,
995 top-to-bottom order. The result is packaged into a Calc vector
996 of numbers and placed on the stack. Calc (in its standard
997 user interface) is then started. Type @kbd{v u} if you want
998 to unpack this vector into separate numbers on the stack. Also,
999 @kbd{C-u C-x * g} interprets the region as a single number or
1000 formula.
1001
1002 The @kbd{C-x * r} command reads a rectangle, with the point and
1003 mark defining opposite corners of the rectangle. The result
1004 is a matrix of numbers on the Calculator stack.
1005
1006 Complementary to these is @kbd{C-x * y}, which ``yanks'' the
1007 value at the top of the Calc stack back into an editing buffer.
1008 If you type @w{@kbd{C-x * y}} while in such a buffer, the value is
1009 yanked at the current position. If you type @kbd{C-x * y} while
1010 in the Calc buffer, Calc makes an educated guess as to which
1011 editing buffer you want to use. The Calc window does not have
1012 to be visible in order to use this command, as long as there
1013 is something on the Calc stack.
1014
1015 Here, for reference, is the complete list of @kbd{C-x *} commands.
1016 The shift, control, and meta keys are ignored for the keystroke
1017 following @kbd{C-x *}.
1018
1019 @noindent
1020 Commands for turning Calc on and off:
1021
1022 @table @kbd
1023 @item *
1024 Turn Calc on or off, employing the same user interface as last time.
1025
1026 @item =, +, -, /, \, &, #
1027 Alternatives for @kbd{*}.
1028
1029 @item C
1030 Turn Calc on or off using its standard bottom-of-the-screen
1031 interface. If Calc is already turned on but the cursor is not
1032 in the Calc window, move the cursor into the window.
1033
1034 @item O
1035 Same as @kbd{C}, but don't select the new Calc window. If
1036 Calc is already turned on and the cursor is in the Calc window,
1037 move it out of that window.
1038
1039 @item B
1040 Control whether @kbd{C-x * c} and @kbd{C-x * k} use the full screen.
1041
1042 @item Q
1043 Use Quick mode for a single short calculation.
1044
1045 @item K
1046 Turn Calc Keypad mode on or off.
1047
1048 @item E
1049 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current formula.
1050
1051 @item J
1052 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off, select the interesting part.
1053
1054 @item W
1055 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current word (number).
1056
1057 @item Z
1058 Turn Calc on in a user-defined way, as defined by a @kbd{Z I} command.
1059
1060 @item X
1061 Quit Calc; turn off standard, Keypad, or Embedded mode if on.
1062 (This is like @kbd{q} or @key{OFF} inside of Calc.)
1063 @end table
1064 @iftex
1065 @sp 2
1066 @end iftex
1067
1068 @noindent
1069 Commands for moving data into and out of the Calculator:
1070
1071 @table @kbd
1072 @item G
1073 Grab the region into the Calculator as a vector.
1074
1075 @item R
1076 Grab the rectangular region into the Calculator as a matrix.
1077
1078 @item :
1079 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its columns.
1080
1081 @item _
1082 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its rows.
1083
1084 @item Y
1085 Yank a value from the Calculator into the current editing buffer.
1086 @end table
1087 @iftex
1088 @sp 2
1089 @end iftex
1090
1091 @noindent
1092 Commands for use with Embedded mode:
1093
1094 @table @kbd
1095 @item A
1096 ``Activate'' the current buffer. Locate all formulas that
1097 contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols and record their locations
1098 so that they can be updated automatically as variables are changed.
1099
1100 @item D
1101 Duplicate the current formula immediately below and select
1102 the duplicate.
1103
1104 @item F
1105 Insert a new formula at the current point.
1106
1107 @item N
1108 Move the cursor to the next active formula in the buffer.
1109
1110 @item P
1111 Move the cursor to the previous active formula in the buffer.
1112
1113 @item U
1114 Update (i.e., as if by the @kbd{=} key) the formula at the current point.
1115
1116 @item `
1117 Edit (as if by @code{calc-edit}) the formula at the current point.
1118 @end table
1119 @iftex
1120 @sp 2
1121 @end iftex
1122
1123 @noindent
1124 Miscellaneous commands:
1125
1126 @table @kbd
1127 @item I
1128 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc manual.
1129 (This is the same as @kbd{h i} inside of Calc.)
1130
1131 @item T
1132 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Tutorial.
1133
1134 @item S
1135 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Summary.
1136
1137 @item L
1138 Load Calc entirely into memory. (Normally the various parts
1139 are loaded only as they are needed.)
1140
1141 @item M
1142 Read a region of written keystroke names (like @kbd{C-n a b c @key{RET}})
1143 and record them as the current keyboard macro.
1144
1145 @item 0
1146 (This is the ``zero'' digit key.) Reset the Calculator to
1147 its initial state: Empty stack, and initial mode settings.
1148 @end table
1149
1150 @node History and Acknowledgements, , Using Calc, Getting Started
1151 @section History and Acknowledgements
1152
1153 @noindent
1154 Calc was originally started as a two-week project to occupy a lull
1155 in the author's schedule. Basically, a friend asked if I remembered
1156 the value of
1157 @texline @math{2^{32}}.
1158 @infoline @expr{2^32}.
1159 I didn't offhand, but I said, ``that's easy, just call up an
1160 @code{xcalc}.'' @code{Xcalc} duly reported that the answer to our
1161 question was @samp{4.294967e+09}---with no way to see the full ten
1162 digits even though we knew they were there in the program's memory! I
1163 was so annoyed, I vowed to write a calculator of my own, once and for
1164 all.
1165
1166 I chose Emacs Lisp, a) because I had always been curious about it
1167 and b) because, being only a text editor extension language after
1168 all, Emacs Lisp would surely reach its limits long before the project
1169 got too far out of hand.
1170
1171 To make a long story short, Emacs Lisp turned out to be a distressingly
1172 solid implementation of Lisp, and the humble task of calculating
1173 turned out to be more open-ended than one might have expected.
1174
1175 Emacs Lisp didn't have built-in floating point math (now it does), so
1176 this had to be simulated in software. In fact, Emacs integers would
1177 only comfortably fit six decimal digits or so---not enough for a decent
1178 calculator. So I had to write my own high-precision integer code as
1179 well, and once I had this I figured that arbitrary-size integers were
1180 just as easy as large integers. Arbitrary floating-point precision was
1181 the logical next step. Also, since the large integer arithmetic was
1182 there anyway it seemed only fair to give the user direct access to it,
1183 which in turn made it practical to support fractions as well as floats.
1184 All these features inspired me to look around for other data types that
1185 might be worth having.
1186
1187 Around this time, my friend Rick Koshi showed me his nifty new HP-28
1188 calculator. It allowed the user to manipulate formulas as well as
1189 numerical quantities, and it could also operate on matrices. I
1190 decided that these would be good for Calc to have, too. And once
1191 things had gone this far, I figured I might as well take a look at
1192 serious algebra systems for further ideas. Since these systems did
1193 far more than I could ever hope to implement, I decided to focus on
1194 rewrite rules and other programming features so that users could
1195 implement what they needed for themselves.
1196
1197 Rick complained that matrices were hard to read, so I put in code to
1198 format them in a 2D style. Once these routines were in place, Big mode
1199 was obligatory. Gee, what other language modes would be useful?
1200
1201 Scott Hemphill and Allen Knutson, two friends with a strong mathematical
1202 bent, contributed ideas and algorithms for a number of Calc features
1203 including modulo forms, primality testing, and float-to-fraction conversion.
1204
1205 Units were added at the eager insistence of Mass Sivilotti. Later,
1206 Ulrich Mueller at CERN and Przemek Klosowski at NIST provided invaluable
1207 expert assistance with the units table. As far as I can remember, the
1208 idea of using algebraic formulas and variables to represent units dates
1209 back to an ancient article in Byte magazine about muMath, an early
1210 algebra system for microcomputers.
1211
1212 Many people have contributed to Calc by reporting bugs and suggesting
1213 features, large and small. A few deserve special mention: Tim Peters,
1214 who helped develop the ideas that led to the selection commands, rewrite
1215 rules, and many other algebra features;
1216 @texline Fran\c{c}ois
1217 @infoline Francois
1218 Pinard, who contributed an early prototype of the Calc Summary appendix
1219 as well as providing valuable suggestions in many other areas of Calc;
1220 Carl Witty, whose eagle eyes discovered many typographical and factual
1221 errors in the Calc manual; Tim Kay, who drove the development of
1222 Embedded mode; Ove Ewerlid, who made many suggestions relating to the
1223 algebra commands and contributed some code for polynomial operations;
1224 Randal Schwartz, who suggested the @code{calc-eval} function; Juha
1225 Sarlin, who first worked out how to split Calc into quickly-loading
1226 parts; Bob Weiner, who helped immensely with the Lucid Emacs port; and
1227 Robert J. Chassell, who suggested the Calc Tutorial and exercises as
1228 well as many other things.
1229
1230 @cindex Bibliography
1231 @cindex Knuth, Art of Computer Programming
1232 @cindex Numerical Recipes
1233 @c Should these be expanded into more complete references?
1234 Among the books used in the development of Calc were Knuth's @emph{Art
1235 of Computer Programming} (especially volume II, @emph{Seminumerical
1236 Algorithms}); @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky,
1237 and Vetterling; Bevington's @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis
1238 for the Physical Sciences}; @emph{Concrete Mathematics} by Graham,
1239 Knuth, and Patashnik; Steele's @emph{Common Lisp, the Language}; the
1240 @emph{CRC Standard Math Tables} (William H. Beyer, ed.); and
1241 Abramowitz and Stegun's venerable @emph{Handbook of Mathematical
1242 Functions}. Also, of course, Calc could not have been written without
1243 the excellent @emph{GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, by Bil Lewis and
1244 Dan LaLiberte.
1245
1246 Final thanks go to Richard Stallman, without whose fine implementations
1247 of the Emacs editor, language, and environment, Calc would have been
1248 finished in two weeks.
1249
1250 @c [tutorial]
1251
1252 @ifinfo
1253 @c This node is accessed by the `C-x * t' command.
1254 @node Interactive Tutorial, Tutorial, Getting Started, Top
1255 @chapter Tutorial
1256
1257 @noindent
1258 Some brief instructions on using the Emacs Info system for this tutorial:
1259
1260 Press the space bar and Delete keys to go forward and backward in a
1261 section by screenfuls (or use the regular Emacs scrolling commands
1262 for this).
1263
1264 Press @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to go to the Next or Previous section.
1265 If the section has a @dfn{menu}, press a digit key like @kbd{1}
1266 or @kbd{2} to go to a sub-section from the menu. Press @kbd{u} to
1267 go back up from a sub-section to the menu it is part of.
1268
1269 Exercises in the tutorial all have cross-references to the
1270 appropriate page of the ``answers'' section. Press @kbd{f}, then
1271 the exercise number, to see the answer to an exercise. After
1272 you have followed a cross-reference, you can press the letter
1273 @kbd{l} to return to where you were before.
1274
1275 You can press @kbd{?} at any time for a brief summary of Info commands.
1276
1277 Press the number @kbd{1} now to enter the first section of the Tutorial.
1278
1279 @menu
1280 * Tutorial::
1281 @end menu
1282
1283 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Interactive Tutorial, Top
1284 @end ifinfo
1285 @ifnotinfo
1286 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Getting Started, Top
1287 @end ifnotinfo
1288 @chapter Tutorial
1289
1290 @noindent
1291 This chapter explains how to use Calc and its many features, in
1292 a step-by-step, tutorial way. You are encouraged to run Calc and
1293 work along with the examples as you read (@pxref{Starting Calc}).
1294 If you are already familiar with advanced calculators, you may wish
1295 @c [not-split]
1296 to skip on to the rest of this manual.
1297 @c [when-split]
1298 @c to skip on to volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}.
1299
1300 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
1301 This tutorial describes the standard user interface of Calc only.
1302 The Quick mode and Keypad mode interfaces are fairly
1303 self-explanatory. @xref{Embedded Mode}, for a description of
1304 the Embedded mode interface.
1305
1306 The easiest way to read this tutorial on-line is to have two windows on
1307 your Emacs screen, one with Calc and one with the Info system. Press
1308 @kbd{C-x * t} to set this up; the on-line tutorial will be opened in the
1309 current window and Calc will be started in another window. From the
1310 Info window, the command @kbd{C-x * c} can be used to switch to the Calc
1311 window and @kbd{C-x * o} can be used to switch back to the Info window.
1312 (If you have a printed copy of the manual you can use that instead; in
1313 that case you only need to press @kbd{C-x * c} to start Calc.)
1314
1315 This tutorial is designed to be done in sequence. But the rest of this
1316 manual does not assume you have gone through the tutorial. The tutorial
1317 does not cover everything in the Calculator, but it touches on most
1318 general areas.
1319
1320 @ifnottex
1321 You may wish to print out a copy of the Calc Summary and keep notes on
1322 it as you learn Calc. @xref{About This Manual}, to see how to make a
1323 printed summary. @xref{Summary}.
1324 @end ifnottex
1325 @iftex
1326 The Calc Summary at the end of the reference manual includes some blank
1327 space for your own use. You may wish to keep notes there as you learn
1328 Calc.
1329 @end iftex
1330
1331 @menu
1332 * Basic Tutorial::
1333 * Arithmetic Tutorial::
1334 * Vector/Matrix Tutorial::
1335 * Types Tutorial::
1336 * Algebra Tutorial::
1337 * Programming Tutorial::
1338
1339 * Answers to Exercises::
1340 @end menu
1341
1342 @node Basic Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial, Tutorial
1343 @section Basic Tutorial
1344
1345 @noindent
1346 In this section, we learn how RPN and algebraic-style calculations
1347 work, how to undo and redo an operation done by mistake, and how
1348 to control various modes of the Calculator.
1349
1350 @menu
1351 * RPN Tutorial:: Basic operations with the stack.
1352 * Algebraic Tutorial:: Algebraic entry; variables.
1353 * Undo Tutorial:: If you make a mistake: Undo and the trail.
1354 * Modes Tutorial:: Common mode-setting commands.
1355 @end menu
1356
1357 @node RPN Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1358 @subsection RPN Calculations and the Stack
1359
1360 @cindex RPN notation
1361 @ifnottex
1362 @noindent
1363 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1364 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1365 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1366 Jan Lukasiewicz.)
1367 @end ifnottex
1368 @tex
1369 \noindent
1370 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1371 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1372 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1373 Jan \L ukasiewicz.)
1374 @end tex
1375
1376 The central component of an RPN calculator is the @dfn{stack}. A
1377 calculator stack is like a stack of dishes. New dishes (numbers) are
1378 added at the top of the stack, and numbers are normally only removed
1379 from the top of the stack.
1380
1381 @cindex Operators
1382 @cindex Operands
1383 In an operation like @expr{2+3}, the 2 and 3 are called the @dfn{operands}
1384 and the @expr{+} is the @dfn{operator}. In an RPN calculator you always
1385 enter the operands first, then the operator. Each time you type a
1386 number, Calc adds or @dfn{pushes} it onto the top of the Stack.
1387 When you press an operator key like @kbd{+}, Calc @dfn{pops} the appropriate
1388 number of operands from the stack and pushes back the result.
1389
1390 Thus we could add the numbers 2 and 3 in an RPN calculator by typing:
1391 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} +}. (The @key{RET} key, Return, corresponds to
1392 the @key{ENTER} key on traditional RPN calculators.) Try this now if
1393 you wish; type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch into the Calc window (you can type
1394 @kbd{C-x * c} again or @kbd{C-x * o} to switch back to the Tutorial window).
1395 The first four keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 2 and 3 onto the stack.
1396 The @kbd{+} key ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
1397 and pushes the result (5) back onto the stack. Here's how the stack
1398 will look at various points throughout the calculation:
1399
1400 @smallexample
1401 @group
1402 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1403 . 1: 3 .
1404 .
1405
1406 C-x * c 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} + @key{DEL}
1407 @end group
1408 @end smallexample
1409
1410 The @samp{.} symbol is a marker that represents the top of the stack.
1411 Note that the ``top'' of the stack is really shown at the bottom of
1412 the Stack window. This may seem backwards, but it turns out to be
1413 less distracting in regular use.
1414
1415 @cindex Stack levels
1416 @cindex Levels of stack
1417 The numbers @samp{1:} and @samp{2:} on the left are @dfn{stack level
1418 numbers}. Old RPN calculators always had four stack levels called
1419 @expr{x}, @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and @expr{t}. Calc's stack can grow
1420 as large as you like, so it uses numbers instead of letters. Some
1421 stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric argument that says
1422 which stack level to work on. Normal commands like @kbd{+} always
1423 work on the top few levels of the stack.
1424
1425 @c [fix-ref Truncating the Stack]
1426 The Stack buffer is just an Emacs buffer, and you can move around in
1427 it using the regular Emacs motion commands. But no matter where the
1428 cursor is, even if you have scrolled the @samp{.} marker out of
1429 view, most Calc commands always move the cursor back down to level 1
1430 before doing anything. It is possible to move the @samp{.} marker
1431 upwards through the stack, temporarily ``hiding'' some numbers from
1432 commands like @kbd{+}. This is called @dfn{stack truncation} and
1433 we will not cover it in this tutorial; @pxref{Truncating the Stack},
1434 if you are interested.
1435
1436 You don't really need the second @key{RET} in @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3
1437 @key{RET} +}. That's because if you type any operator name or
1438 other non-numeric key when you are entering a number, the Calculator
1439 automatically enters that number and then does the requested command.
1440 Thus @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +} will work just as well.
1441
1442 Examples in this tutorial will often omit @key{RET} even when the
1443 stack displays shown would only happen if you did press @key{RET}:
1444
1445 @smallexample
1446 @group
1447 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5
1448 . 1: 3 .
1449 .
1450
1451 2 @key{RET} 3 +
1452 @end group
1453 @end smallexample
1454
1455 @noindent
1456 Here, after pressing @kbd{3} the stack would really show @samp{1: 2}
1457 with @samp{Calc:@: 3} in the minibuffer. In these situations, you can
1458 press the optional @key{RET} to see the stack as the figure shows.
1459
1460 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} (This tutorial will include exercises
1461 at various points. Try them if you wish. Answers to all the exercises
1462 are located at the end of the Tutorial chapter. Each exercise will
1463 include a cross-reference to its particular answer. If you are
1464 reading with the Emacs Info system, press @kbd{f} and the
1465 exercise number to go to the answer, then the letter @kbd{l} to
1466 return to where you were.)
1467
1468 @noindent
1469 Here's the first exercise: What will the keystrokes @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2
1470 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -} compute? (@samp{*} is the symbol for
1471 multiplication.) Figure it out by hand, then try it with Calc to see
1472 if you're right. @xref{RPN Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1473
1474 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Compute
1475 @texline @math{(2\times4) + (7\times9.4) + {5\over4}}
1476 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4}
1477 using the stack. @xref{RPN Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
1478
1479 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards. It is
1480 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
1481 regularly using Emacs. The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the
1482 top value on the stack. (You can still get that value back from
1483 the Trail if you should need it later on.) There are many places
1484 in this tutorial where we assume you have used @key{DEL} to erase the
1485 results of the previous example at the beginning of a new example.
1486 In the few places where it is really important to use @key{DEL} to
1487 clear away old results, the text will remind you to do so.
1488
1489 (It won't hurt to let things accumulate on the stack, except that
1490 whenever you give a display-mode-changing command Calc will have to
1491 spend a long time reformatting such a large stack.)
1492
1493 Since the @kbd{-} key is also an operator (it subtracts the top two
1494 stack elements), how does one enter a negative number? Calc uses
1495 the @kbd{_} (underscore) key to act like the minus sign in a number.
1496 So, typing @kbd{-5 @key{RET}} won't work because the @kbd{-} key
1497 will try to do a subtraction, but @kbd{_5 @key{RET}} works just fine.
1498
1499 You can also press @kbd{n}, which means ``change sign.'' It changes
1500 the number at the top of the stack (or the number being entered)
1501 from positive to negative or vice-versa: @kbd{5 n @key{RET}}.
1502
1503 @cindex Duplicating a stack entry
1504 If you press @key{RET} when you're not entering a number, the effect
1505 is to duplicate the top number on the stack. Consider this calculation:
1506
1507 @smallexample
1508 @group
1509 1: 3 2: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 81
1510 . 1: 3 . 1: 9 .
1511 . .
1512
1513 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * @key{RET} *
1514 @end group
1515 @end smallexample
1516
1517 @noindent
1518 (Of course, an easier way to do this would be @kbd{3 @key{RET} 4 ^},
1519 to raise 3 to the fourth power.)
1520
1521 The space-bar key (denoted @key{SPC} here) performs the same function
1522 as @key{RET}; you could replace all three occurrences of @key{RET} in
1523 the above example with @key{SPC} and the effect would be the same.
1524
1525 @cindex Exchanging stack entries
1526 Another stack manipulation key is @key{TAB}. This exchanges the top
1527 two stack entries. Suppose you have computed @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +}
1528 to get 5, and then you realize what you really wanted to compute
1529 was @expr{20 / (2+3)}.
1530
1531 @smallexample
1532 @group
1533 1: 5 2: 5 2: 20 1: 4
1534 . 1: 20 1: 5 .
1535 . .
1536
1537 2 @key{RET} 3 + 20 @key{TAB} /
1538 @end group
1539 @end smallexample
1540
1541 @noindent
1542 Planning ahead, the calculation would have gone like this:
1543
1544 @smallexample
1545 @group
1546 1: 20 2: 20 3: 20 2: 20 1: 4
1547 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1548 . 1: 3 .
1549 .
1550
1551 20 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 + /
1552 @end group
1553 @end smallexample
1554
1555 A related stack command is @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (hold @key{META} and type
1556 @key{TAB}). It rotates the top three elements of the stack upward,
1557 bringing the object in level 3 to the top.
1558
1559 @smallexample
1560 @group
1561 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 20 3: 30
1562 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 30 2: 10
1563 . 1: 30 1: 10 1: 20
1564 . . .
1565
1566 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
1567 @end group
1568 @end smallexample
1569
1570 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Suppose the numbers 10, 20, and 30 are
1571 on the stack. Figure out how to add one to the number in level 2
1572 without affecting the rest of the stack. Also figure out how to add
1573 one to the number in level 3. @xref{RPN Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
1574
1575 Operations like @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/}, and @kbd{^} pop two
1576 arguments from the stack and push a result. Operations like @kbd{n} and
1577 @kbd{Q} (square root) pop a single number and push the result. You can
1578 think of them as simply operating on the top element of the stack.
1579
1580 @smallexample
1581 @group
1582 1: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 25 1: 5
1583 . . 1: 16 . .
1584 .
1585
1586 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} @key{RET} * + Q
1587 @end group
1588 @end smallexample
1589
1590 @noindent
1591 (Note that capital @kbd{Q} means to hold down the Shift key while
1592 typing @kbd{q}. Remember, plain unshifted @kbd{q} is the Quit command.)
1593
1594 @cindex Pythagorean Theorem
1595 Here we've used the Pythagorean Theorem to determine the hypotenuse of a
1596 right triangle. Calc actually has a built-in command for that called
1597 @kbd{f h}, but let's suppose we can't remember the necessary keystrokes.
1598 We can still enter it by its full name using @kbd{M-x} notation:
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 @group
1602 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1603 . 1: 4 .
1604 .
1605
1606 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} M-x calc-hypot
1607 @end group
1608 @end smallexample
1609
1610 All Calculator commands begin with the word @samp{calc-}. Since it
1611 gets tiring to type this, Calc provides an @kbd{x} key which is just
1612 like the regular Emacs @kbd{M-x} key except that it types the @samp{calc-}
1613 prefix for you:
1614
1615 @smallexample
1616 @group
1617 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1618 . 1: 4 .
1619 .
1620
1621 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} x hypot
1622 @end group
1623 @end smallexample
1624
1625 What happens if you take the square root of a negative number?
1626
1627 @smallexample
1628 @group
1629 1: 4 1: -4 1: (0, 2)
1630 . . .
1631
1632 4 @key{RET} n Q
1633 @end group
1634 @end smallexample
1635
1636 @noindent
1637 The notation @expr{(a, b)} represents a complex number.
1638 Complex numbers are more traditionally written @expr{a + b i};
1639 Calc can display in this format, too, but for now we'll stick to the
1640 @expr{(a, b)} notation.
1641
1642 If you don't know how complex numbers work, you can safely ignore this
1643 feature. Complex numbers only arise from operations that would be
1644 errors in a calculator that didn't have complex numbers. (For example,
1645 taking the square root or logarithm of a negative number produces a
1646 complex result.)
1647
1648 Complex numbers are entered in the notation shown. The @kbd{(} and
1649 @kbd{,} and @kbd{)} keys manipulate ``incomplete complex numbers.''
1650
1651 @smallexample
1652 @group
1653 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
1654 . 1: 2 . 3 .
1655 . .
1656
1657 ( 2 , 3 )
1658 @end group
1659 @end smallexample
1660
1661 You can perform calculations while entering parts of incomplete objects.
1662 However, an incomplete object cannot actually participate in a calculation:
1663
1664 @smallexample
1665 @group
1666 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 3: ( ... 1: ( ... 1: ( ...
1667 . 1: 2 2: 2 5 5
1668 . 1: 3 . .
1669 .
1670 (error)
1671 ( 2 @key{RET} 3 + +
1672 @end group
1673 @end smallexample
1674
1675 @noindent
1676 Adding 5 to an incomplete object makes no sense, so the last command
1677 produces an error message and leaves the stack the same.
1678
1679 Incomplete objects can't participate in arithmetic, but they can be
1680 moved around by the regular stack commands.
1681
1682 @smallexample
1683 @group
1684 2: 2 3: 2 3: 3 1: ( ... 1: (2, 3)
1685 1: 3 2: 3 2: ( ... 2 .
1686 . 1: ( ... 1: 2 3
1687 . . .
1688
1689 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} ( M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} )
1690 @end group
1691 @end smallexample
1692
1693 @noindent
1694 Note that the @kbd{,} (comma) key did not have to be used here.
1695 When you press @kbd{)} all the stack entries between the incomplete
1696 entry and the top are collected, so there's never really a reason
1697 to use the comma. It's up to you.
1698
1699 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} To enter the complex number @expr{(2, 3)},
1700 your friend Joe typed @kbd{( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )}. What happened?
1701 (Joe thought of a clever way to correct his mistake in only two
1702 keystrokes, but it didn't quite work. Try it to find out why.)
1703 @xref{RPN Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
1704
1705 Vectors are entered the same way as complex numbers, but with square
1706 brackets in place of parentheses. We'll meet vectors again later in
1707 the tutorial.
1708
1709 Any Emacs command can be given a @dfn{numeric prefix argument} by
1710 typing a series of @key{META}-digits beforehand. If @key{META} is
1711 awkward for you, you can instead type @kbd{C-u} followed by the
1712 necessary digits. Numeric prefix arguments can be negative, as in
1713 @kbd{M-- M-3 M-5} or @w{@kbd{C-u - 3 5}}. Calc commands use numeric
1714 prefix arguments in a variety of ways. For example, a numeric prefix
1715 on the @kbd{+} operator adds any number of stack entries at once:
1716
1717 @smallexample
1718 @group
1719 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 1: 60
1720 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 .
1721 . 1: 30 1: 30
1722 . .
1723
1724 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u 3 +
1725 @end group
1726 @end smallexample
1727
1728 For stack manipulation commands like @key{RET}, a positive numeric
1729 prefix argument operates on the top @var{n} stack entries at once. A
1730 negative argument operates on the entry in level @var{n} only. An
1731 argument of zero operates on the entire stack. In this example, we copy
1732 the second-to-top element of the stack:
1733
1734 @smallexample
1735 @group
1736 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10
1737 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 3: 20
1738 . 1: 30 1: 30 2: 30
1739 . . 1: 20
1740 .
1741
1742 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u -2 @key{RET}
1743 @end group
1744 @end smallexample
1745
1746 @cindex Clearing the stack
1747 @cindex Emptying the stack
1748 Another common idiom is @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}, which clears the stack.
1749 (The @kbd{M-0} numeric prefix tells @key{DEL} to operate on the
1750 entire stack.)
1751
1752 @node Algebraic Tutorial, Undo Tutorial, RPN Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1753 @subsection Algebraic-Style Calculations
1754
1755 @noindent
1756 If you are not used to RPN notation, you may prefer to operate the
1757 Calculator in Algebraic mode, which is closer to the way
1758 non-RPN calculators work. In Algebraic mode, you enter formulas
1759 in traditional @expr{2+3} notation.
1760
1761 @strong{Notice:} Calc gives @samp{/} lower precedence than @samp{*}, so
1762 that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}; this is not
1763 standard across all computer languages. See below for details.
1764
1765 You don't really need any special ``mode'' to enter algebraic formulas.
1766 You can enter a formula at any time by pressing the apostrophe (@kbd{'})
1767 key. Answer the prompt with the desired formula, then press @key{RET}.
1768 The formula is evaluated and the result is pushed onto the RPN stack.
1769 If you don't want to think in RPN at all, you can enter your whole
1770 computation as a formula, read the result from the stack, then press
1771 @key{DEL} to delete it from the stack.
1772
1773 Try pressing the apostrophe key, then @kbd{2+3+4}, then @key{RET}.
1774 The result should be the number 9.
1775
1776 Algebraic formulas use the operators @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*},
1777 @samp{/}, and @samp{^}. You can use parentheses to make the order
1778 of evaluation clear. In the absence of parentheses, @samp{^} is
1779 evaluated first, then @samp{*}, then @samp{/}, then finally
1780 @samp{+} and @samp{-}. For example, the expression
1781
1782 @example
1783 2 + 3*4*5 / 6*7^8 - 9
1784 @end example
1785
1786 @noindent
1787 is equivalent to
1788
1789 @example
1790 2 + ((3*4*5) / (6*(7^8)) - 9
1791 @end example
1792
1793 @noindent
1794 or, in large mathematical notation,
1795
1796 @ifnottex
1797 @example
1798 @group
1799 3 * 4 * 5
1800 2 + --------- - 9
1801 8
1802 6 * 7
1803 @end group
1804 @end example
1805 @end ifnottex
1806 @tex
1807 \turnoffactive
1808 \beforedisplay
1809 $$ 2 + { 3 \times 4 \times 5 \over 6 \times 7^8 } - 9 $$
1810 \afterdisplay
1811 @end tex
1812
1813 @noindent
1814 The result of this expression will be the number @mathit{-6.99999826533}.
1815
1816 Calc's order of evaluation is the same as for most computer languages,
1817 except that @samp{*} binds more strongly than @samp{/}, as the above
1818 example shows. As in normal mathematical notation, the @samp{*} symbol
1819 can often be omitted: @samp{2 a} is the same as @samp{2*a}.
1820
1821 Operators at the same level are evaluated from left to right, except
1822 that @samp{^} is evaluated from right to left. Thus, @samp{2-3-4} is
1823 equivalent to @samp{(2-3)-4} or @mathit{-5}, whereas @samp{2^3^4} is equivalent
1824 to @samp{2^(3^4)} (a very large integer; try it!).
1825
1826 If you tire of typing the apostrophe all the time, there is
1827 Algebraic mode, where Calc automatically senses
1828 when you are about to type an algebraic expression. To enter this
1829 mode, press the two letters @w{@kbd{m a}}. (An @samp{Alg} indicator
1830 should appear in the Calc window's mode line.)
1831
1832 Press @kbd{m a}, then @kbd{2+3+4} with no apostrophe, then @key{RET}.
1833
1834 In Algebraic mode, when you press any key that would normally begin
1835 entering a number (such as a digit, a decimal point, or the @kbd{_}
1836 key), or if you press @kbd{(} or @kbd{[}, Calc automatically begins
1837 an algebraic entry.
1838
1839 Functions which do not have operator symbols like @samp{+} and @samp{*}
1840 must be entered in formulas using function-call notation. For example,
1841 the function name corresponding to the square-root key @kbd{Q} is
1842 @code{sqrt}. To compute a square root in a formula, you would use
1843 the notation @samp{sqrt(@var{x})}.
1844
1845 Press the apostrophe, then type @kbd{sqrt(5*2) - 3}. The result should
1846 be @expr{0.16227766017}.
1847
1848 Note that if the formula begins with a function name, you need to use
1849 the apostrophe even if you are in Algebraic mode. If you type @kbd{arcsin}
1850 out of the blue, the @kbd{a r} will be taken as an Algebraic Rewrite
1851 command, and the @kbd{csin} will be taken as the name of the rewrite
1852 rule to use!
1853
1854 Some people prefer to enter complex numbers and vectors in algebraic
1855 form because they find RPN entry with incomplete objects to be too
1856 distracting, even though they otherwise use Calc as an RPN calculator.
1857
1858 Still in Algebraic mode, type:
1859
1860 @smallexample
1861 @group
1862 1: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (8, -1) 2: (8, -1) 1: (9, -1)
1863 . 1: (1, -2) . 1: 1 .
1864 . .
1865
1866 (2,3) @key{RET} (1,-2) @key{RET} * 1 @key{RET} +
1867 @end group
1868 @end smallexample
1869
1870 Algebraic mode allows us to enter complex numbers without pressing
1871 an apostrophe first, but it also means we need to press @key{RET}
1872 after every entry, even for a simple number like @expr{1}.
1873
1874 (You can type @kbd{C-u m a} to enable a special Incomplete Algebraic
1875 mode in which the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys use algebraic entry even
1876 though regular numeric keys still use RPN numeric entry. There is also
1877 Total Algebraic mode, started by typing @kbd{m t}, in which all
1878 normal keys begin algebraic entry. You must then use the @key{META} key
1879 to type Calc commands: @kbd{M-m t} to get back out of Total Algebraic
1880 mode, @kbd{M-q} to quit, etc.)
1881
1882 If you're still in Algebraic mode, press @kbd{m a} again to turn it off.
1883
1884 Actual non-RPN calculators use a mixture of algebraic and RPN styles.
1885 In general, operators of two numbers (like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*})
1886 use algebraic form, but operators of one number (like @kbd{n} and @kbd{Q})
1887 use RPN form. Also, a non-RPN calculator allows you to see the
1888 intermediate results of a calculation as you go along. You can
1889 accomplish this in Calc by performing your calculation as a series
1890 of algebraic entries, using the @kbd{$} sign to tie them together.
1891 In an algebraic formula, @kbd{$} represents the number on the top
1892 of the stack. Here, we perform the calculation
1893 @texline @math{\sqrt{2\times4+1}},
1894 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2*4+1)},
1895 which on a traditional calculator would be done by pressing
1896 @kbd{2 * 4 + 1 =} and then the square-root key.
1897
1898 @smallexample
1899 @group
1900 1: 8 1: 9 1: 3
1901 . . .
1902
1903 ' 2*4 @key{RET} $+1 @key{RET} Q
1904 @end group
1905 @end smallexample
1906
1907 @noindent
1908 Notice that we didn't need to press an apostrophe for the @kbd{$+1},
1909 because the dollar sign always begins an algebraic entry.
1910
1911 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} How could you get the same effect as
1912 pressing @kbd{Q} but using an algebraic entry instead? How about
1913 if the @kbd{Q} key on your keyboard were broken?
1914 @xref{Algebraic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1915
1916 The notations @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on stand for higher stack
1917 entries. For example, @kbd{' $$+$ @key{RET}} is just like typing @kbd{+}.
1918
1919 Algebraic formulas can include @dfn{variables}. To store in a
1920 variable, press @kbd{s s}, then type the variable name, then press
1921 @key{RET}. (There are actually two flavors of store command:
1922 @kbd{s s} stores a number in a variable but also leaves the number
1923 on the stack, while @w{@kbd{s t}} removes a number from the stack and
1924 stores it in the variable.) A variable name should consist of one
1925 or more letters or digits, beginning with a letter.
1926
1927 @smallexample
1928 @group
1929 1: 17 . 1: a + a^2 1: 306
1930 . . .
1931
1932 17 s t a @key{RET} ' a+a^2 @key{RET} =
1933 @end group
1934 @end smallexample
1935
1936 @noindent
1937 The @kbd{=} key @dfn{evaluates} a formula by replacing all its
1938 variables by the values that were stored in them.
1939
1940 For RPN calculations, you can recall a variable's value on the
1941 stack either by entering its name as a formula and pressing @kbd{=},
1942 or by using the @kbd{s r} command.
1943
1944 @smallexample
1945 @group
1946 1: 17 2: 17 3: 17 2: 17 1: 306
1947 . 1: 17 2: 17 1: 289 .
1948 . 1: 2 .
1949 .
1950
1951 s r a @key{RET} ' a @key{RET} = 2 ^ +
1952 @end group
1953 @end smallexample
1954
1955 If you press a single digit for a variable name (as in @kbd{s t 3}, you
1956 get one of ten @dfn{quick variables} @code{q0} through @code{q9}.
1957 They are ``quick'' simply because you don't have to type the letter
1958 @code{q} or the @key{RET} after their names. In fact, you can type
1959 simply @kbd{s 3} as a shorthand for @kbd{s s 3}, and likewise for
1960 @kbd{t 3} and @w{@kbd{r 3}}.
1961
1962 Any variables in an algebraic formula for which you have not stored
1963 values are left alone, even when you evaluate the formula.
1964
1965 @smallexample
1966 @group
1967 1: 2 a + 2 b 1: 34 + 2 b
1968 . .
1969
1970 ' 2a+2b @key{RET} =
1971 @end group
1972 @end smallexample
1973
1974 Calls to function names which are undefined in Calc are also left
1975 alone, as are calls for which the value is undefined.
1976
1977 @smallexample
1978 @group
1979 1: 2 + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5, 6) + foo(3)
1980 .
1981
1982 ' log10(100) + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5,6) + foo(3) @key{RET}
1983 @end group
1984 @end smallexample
1985
1986 @noindent
1987 In this example, the first call to @code{log10} works, but the other
1988 calls are not evaluated. In the second call, the logarithm is
1989 undefined for that value of the argument; in the third, the argument
1990 is symbolic, and in the fourth, there are too many arguments. In the
1991 fifth case, there is no function called @code{foo}. You will see a
1992 ``Wrong number of arguments'' message referring to @samp{log10(5,6)}.
1993 Press the @kbd{w} (``why'') key to see any other messages that may
1994 have arisen from the last calculation. In this case you will get
1995 ``logarithm of zero,'' then ``number expected: @code{x}''. Calc
1996 automatically displays the first message only if the message is
1997 sufficiently important; for example, Calc considers ``wrong number
1998 of arguments'' and ``logarithm of zero'' to be important enough to
1999 report automatically, while a message like ``number expected: @code{x}''
2000 will only show up if you explicitly press the @kbd{w} key.
2001
2002 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Joe entered the formula @samp{2 x y},
2003 stored 5 in @code{x}, pressed @kbd{=}, and got the expected result,
2004 @samp{10 y}. He then tried the same for the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)},
2005 expecting @samp{10 (1+y)}, but it didn't work. Why not?
2006 @xref{Algebraic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2007
2008 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} What result would you expect
2009 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} to give? What if you then type @kbd{0 *}?
2010 @xref{Algebraic Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2011
2012 One interesting way to work with variables is to use the
2013 @dfn{evaluates-to} (@samp{=>}) operator. It works like this:
2014 Enter a formula algebraically in the usual way, but follow
2015 the formula with an @samp{=>} symbol. (There is also an @kbd{s =}
2016 command which builds an @samp{=>} formula using the stack.) On
2017 the stack, you will see two copies of the formula with an @samp{=>}
2018 between them. The lefthand formula is exactly like you typed it;
2019 the righthand formula has been evaluated as if by typing @kbd{=}.
2020
2021 @smallexample
2022 @group
2023 2: 2 + 3 => 5 2: 2 + 3 => 5
2024 1: 2 a + 2 b => 34 + 2 b 1: 2 a + 2 b => 20 + 2 b
2025 . .
2026
2027 ' 2+3 => @key{RET} ' 2a+2b @key{RET} s = 10 s t a @key{RET}
2028 @end group
2029 @end smallexample
2030
2031 @noindent
2032 Notice that the instant we stored a new value in @code{a}, all
2033 @samp{=>} operators already on the stack that referred to @expr{a}
2034 were updated to use the new value. With @samp{=>}, you can push a
2035 set of formulas on the stack, then change the variables experimentally
2036 to see the effects on the formulas' values.
2037
2038 You can also ``unstore'' a variable when you are through with it:
2039
2040 @smallexample
2041 @group
2042 2: 2 + 5 => 5
2043 1: 2 a + 2 b => 2 a + 2 b
2044 .
2045
2046 s u a @key{RET}
2047 @end group
2048 @end smallexample
2049
2050 We will encounter formulas involving variables and functions again
2051 when we discuss the algebra and calculus features of the Calculator.
2052
2053 @node Undo Tutorial, Modes Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2054 @subsection Undo and Redo
2055
2056 @noindent
2057 If you make a mistake, you can usually correct it by pressing shift-@kbd{U},
2058 the ``undo'' command. First, clear the stack (@kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}) and exit
2059 and restart Calc (@kbd{C-x * * C-x * *}) to make sure things start off
2060 with a clean slate. Now:
2061
2062 @smallexample
2063 @group
2064 1: 2 2: 2 1: 8 2: 2 1: 6
2065 . 1: 3 . 1: 3 .
2066 . .
2067
2068 2 @key{RET} 3 ^ U *
2069 @end group
2070 @end smallexample
2071
2072 You can undo any number of times. Calc keeps a complete record of
2073 all you have done since you last opened the Calc window. After the
2074 above example, you could type:
2075
2076 @smallexample
2077 @group
2078 1: 6 2: 2 1: 2 . .
2079 . 1: 3 .
2080 .
2081 (error)
2082 U U U U
2083 @end group
2084 @end smallexample
2085
2086 You can also type @kbd{D} to ``redo'' a command that you have undone
2087 mistakenly.
2088
2089 @smallexample
2090 @group
2091 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 6 1: 6
2092 . 1: 3 . .
2093 .
2094 (error)
2095 D D D D
2096 @end group
2097 @end smallexample
2098
2099 @noindent
2100 It was not possible to redo past the @expr{6}, since that was placed there
2101 by something other than an undo command.
2102
2103 @cindex Time travel
2104 You can think of undo and redo as a sort of ``time machine.'' Press
2105 @kbd{U} to go backward in time, @kbd{D} to go forward. If you go
2106 backward and do something (like @kbd{*}) then, as any science fiction
2107 reader knows, you have changed your future and you cannot go forward
2108 again. Thus, the inability to redo past the @expr{6} even though there
2109 was an earlier undo command.
2110
2111 You can always recall an earlier result using the Trail. We've ignored
2112 the trail so far, but it has been faithfully recording everything we
2113 did since we loaded the Calculator. If the Trail is not displayed,
2114 press @kbd{t d} now to turn it on.
2115
2116 Let's try grabbing an earlier result. The @expr{8} we computed was
2117 undone by a @kbd{U} command, and was lost even to Redo when we pressed
2118 @kbd{*}, but it's still there in the trail. There should be a little
2119 @samp{>} arrow (the @dfn{trail pointer}) resting on the last trail
2120 entry. If there isn't, press @kbd{t ]} to reset the trail pointer.
2121 Now, press @w{@kbd{t p}} to move the arrow onto the line containing
2122 @expr{8}, and press @w{@kbd{t y}} to ``yank'' that number back onto the
2123 stack.
2124
2125 If you press @kbd{t ]} again, you will see that even our Yank command
2126 went into the trail.
2127
2128 Let's go further back in time. Earlier in the tutorial we computed
2129 a huge integer using the formula @samp{2^3^4}. We don't remember
2130 what it was, but the first digits were ``241''. Press @kbd{t r}
2131 (which stands for trail-search-reverse), then type @kbd{241}.
2132 The trail cursor will jump back to the next previous occurrence of
2133 the string ``241'' in the trail. This is just a regular Emacs
2134 incremental search; you can now press @kbd{C-s} or @kbd{C-r} to
2135 continue the search forwards or backwards as you like.
2136
2137 To finish the search, press @key{RET}. This halts the incremental
2138 search and leaves the trail pointer at the thing we found. Now we
2139 can type @kbd{t y} to yank that number onto the stack. If we hadn't
2140 remembered the ``241'', we could simply have searched for @kbd{2^3^4},
2141 then pressed @kbd{@key{RET} t n} to halt and then move to the next item.
2142
2143 You may have noticed that all the trail-related commands begin with
2144 the letter @kbd{t}. (The store-and-recall commands, on the other hand,
2145 all began with @kbd{s}.) Calc has so many commands that there aren't
2146 enough keys for all of them, so various commands are grouped into
2147 two-letter sequences where the first letter is called the @dfn{prefix}
2148 key. If you type a prefix key by accident, you can press @kbd{C-g}
2149 to cancel it. (In fact, you can press @kbd{C-g} to cancel almost
2150 anything in Emacs.) To get help on a prefix key, press that key
2151 followed by @kbd{?}. Some prefixes have several lines of help,
2152 so you need to press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see them all.
2153 You can also type @kbd{h h} to see all the help at once.
2154
2155 Try pressing @kbd{t ?} now. You will see a line of the form,
2156
2157 @smallexample
2158 trail/time: Display; Fwd, Back; Next, Prev, Here, [, ]; Yank: [MORE] t-
2159 @end smallexample
2160
2161 @noindent
2162 The word ``trail'' indicates that the @kbd{t} prefix key contains
2163 trail-related commands. Each entry on the line shows one command,
2164 with a single capital letter showing which letter you press to get
2165 that command. We have used @kbd{t n}, @kbd{t p}, @kbd{t ]}, and
2166 @kbd{t y} so far. The @samp{[MORE]} means you can press @kbd{?}
2167 again to see more @kbd{t}-prefix commands. Notice that the commands
2168 are roughly divided (by semicolons) into related groups.
2169
2170 When you are in the help display for a prefix key, the prefix is
2171 still active. If you press another key, like @kbd{y} for example,
2172 it will be interpreted as a @kbd{t y} command. If all you wanted
2173 was to look at the help messages, press @kbd{C-g} afterwards to cancel
2174 the prefix.
2175
2176 One more way to correct an error is by editing the stack entries.
2177 The actual Stack buffer is marked read-only and must not be edited
2178 directly, but you can press @kbd{`} (the backquote or accent grave)
2179 to edit a stack entry.
2180
2181 Try entering @samp{3.141439} now. If this is supposed to represent
2182 @cpi{}, it's got several errors. Press @kbd{`} to edit this number.
2183 Now use the normal Emacs cursor motion and editing keys to change
2184 the second 4 to a 5, and to transpose the 3 and the 9. When you
2185 press @key{RET}, the number on the stack will be replaced by your
2186 new number. This works for formulas, vectors, and all other types
2187 of values you can put on the stack. The @kbd{`} key also works
2188 during entry of a number or algebraic formula.
2189
2190 @node Modes Tutorial, , Undo Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2191 @subsection Mode-Setting Commands
2192
2193 @noindent
2194 Calc has many types of @dfn{modes} that affect the way it interprets
2195 your commands or the way it displays data. We have already seen one
2196 mode, namely Algebraic mode. There are many others, too; we'll
2197 try some of the most common ones here.
2198
2199 Perhaps the most fundamental mode in Calc is the current @dfn{precision}.
2200 Notice the @samp{12} on the Calc window's mode line:
2201
2202 @smallexample
2203 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All------
2204 @end smallexample
2205
2206 @noindent
2207 Most of the symbols there are Emacs things you don't need to worry
2208 about, but the @samp{12} and the @samp{Deg} are mode indicators.
2209 The @samp{12} means that calculations should always be carried to
2210 12 significant figures. That is why, when we type @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /},
2211 we get @expr{0.142857142857} with exactly 12 digits, not counting
2212 leading and trailing zeros.
2213
2214 You can set the precision to anything you like by pressing @kbd{p},
2215 then entering a suitable number. Try pressing @kbd{p 30 @key{RET}},
2216 then doing @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /} again:
2217
2218 @smallexample
2219 @group
2220 1: 0.142857142857
2221 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2222 .
2223 @end group
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 Although the precision can be set arbitrarily high, Calc always
2227 has to have @emph{some} value for the current precision. After
2228 all, the true value @expr{1/7} is an infinitely repeating decimal;
2229 Calc has to stop somewhere.
2230
2231 Of course, calculations are slower the more digits you request.
2232 Press @w{@kbd{p 12}} now to set the precision back down to the default.
2233
2234 Calculations always use the current precision. For example, even
2235 though we have a 30-digit value for @expr{1/7} on the stack, if
2236 we use it in a calculation in 12-digit mode it will be rounded
2237 down to 12 digits before it is used. Try it; press @key{RET} to
2238 duplicate the number, then @w{@kbd{1 +}}. Notice that the @key{RET}
2239 key didn't round the number, because it doesn't do any calculation.
2240 But the instant we pressed @kbd{+}, the number was rounded down.
2241
2242 @smallexample
2243 @group
2244 1: 0.142857142857
2245 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2246 3: 1.14285714286
2247 .
2248 @end group
2249 @end smallexample
2250
2251 @noindent
2252 In fact, since we added a digit on the left, we had to lose one
2253 digit on the right from even the 12-digit value of @expr{1/7}.
2254
2255 How did we get more than 12 digits when we computed @samp{2^3^4}? The
2256 answer is that Calc makes a distinction between @dfn{integers} and
2257 @dfn{floating-point} numbers, or @dfn{floats}. An integer is a number
2258 that does not contain a decimal point. There is no such thing as an
2259 ``infinitely repeating fraction integer,'' so Calc doesn't have to limit
2260 itself. If you asked for @samp{2^10000} (don't try this!), you would
2261 have to wait a long time but you would eventually get an exact answer.
2262 If you ask for @samp{2.^10000}, you will quickly get an answer which is
2263 correct only to 12 places. The decimal point tells Calc that it should
2264 use floating-point arithmetic to get the answer, not exact integer
2265 arithmetic.
2266
2267 You can use the @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) command to convert a
2268 floating-point value to an integer, and @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float})
2269 to convert an integer to floating-point form.
2270
2271 Let's try entering that last calculation:
2272
2273 @smallexample
2274 @group
2275 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311689e3010
2276 . 1: 10000 .
2277 .
2278
2279 2.0 @key{RET} 10000 @key{RET} ^
2280 @end group
2281 @end smallexample
2282
2283 @noindent
2284 @cindex Scientific notation, entry of
2285 Notice the letter @samp{e} in there. It represents ``times ten to the
2286 power of,'' and is used by Calc automatically whenever writing the
2287 number out fully would introduce more extra zeros than you probably
2288 want to see. You can enter numbers in this notation, too.
2289
2290 @smallexample
2291 @group
2292 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311678e3010
2293 . 1: 10000. .
2294 .
2295
2296 2.0 @key{RET} 1e4 @key{RET} ^
2297 @end group
2298 @end smallexample
2299
2300 @cindex Round-off errors
2301 @noindent
2302 Hey, the answer is different! Look closely at the middle columns
2303 of the two examples. In the first, the stack contained the
2304 exact integer @expr{10000}, but in the second it contained
2305 a floating-point value with a decimal point. When you raise a
2306 number to an integer power, Calc uses repeated squaring and
2307 multiplication to get the answer. When you use a floating-point
2308 power, Calc uses logarithms and exponentials. As you can see,
2309 a slight error crept in during one of these methods. Which
2310 one should we trust? Let's raise the precision a bit and find
2311 out:
2312
2313 @smallexample
2314 @group
2315 . 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.995063116880828e3010
2316 . 1: 10000. .
2317 .
2318
2319 p 16 @key{RET} 2. @key{RET} 1e4 ^ p 12 @key{RET}
2320 @end group
2321 @end smallexample
2322
2323 @noindent
2324 @cindex Guard digits
2325 Presumably, it doesn't matter whether we do this higher-precision
2326 calculation using an integer or floating-point power, since we
2327 have added enough ``guard digits'' to trust the first 12 digits
2328 no matter what. And the verdict is@dots{} Integer powers were more
2329 accurate; in fact, the result was only off by one unit in the
2330 last place.
2331
2332 @cindex Guard digits
2333 Calc does many of its internal calculations to a slightly higher
2334 precision, but it doesn't always bump the precision up enough.
2335 In each case, Calc added about two digits of precision during
2336 its calculation and then rounded back down to 12 digits
2337 afterward. In one case, it was enough; in the other, it
2338 wasn't. If you really need @var{x} digits of precision, it
2339 never hurts to do the calculation with a few extra guard digits.
2340
2341 What if we want guard digits but don't want to look at them?
2342 We can set the @dfn{float format}. Calc supports four major
2343 formats for floating-point numbers, called @dfn{normal},
2344 @dfn{fixed-point}, @dfn{scientific notation}, and @dfn{engineering
2345 notation}. You get them by pressing @w{@kbd{d n}}, @kbd{d f},
2346 @kbd{d s}, and @kbd{d e}, respectively. In each case, you can
2347 supply a numeric prefix argument which says how many digits
2348 should be displayed. As an example, let's put a few numbers
2349 onto the stack and try some different display modes. First,
2350 use @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}} to clear the stack, then enter the four
2351 numbers shown here:
2352
2353 @smallexample
2354 @group
2355 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2356 3: 12345. 3: 12300. 3: 1.2345e4 3: 1.23e4 3: 12345.000
2357 2: 123.45 2: 123. 2: 1.2345e2 2: 1.23e2 2: 123.450
2358 1: 12.345 1: 12.3 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.23e1 1: 12.345
2359 . . . . .
2360
2361 d n M-3 d n d s M-3 d s M-3 d f
2362 @end group
2363 @end smallexample
2364
2365 @noindent
2366 Notice that when we typed @kbd{M-3 d n}, the numbers were rounded down
2367 to three significant digits, but then when we typed @kbd{d s} all
2368 five significant figures reappeared. The float format does not
2369 affect how numbers are stored, it only affects how they are
2370 displayed. Only the current precision governs the actual rounding
2371 of numbers in the Calculator's memory.
2372
2373 Engineering notation, not shown here, is like scientific notation
2374 except the exponent (the power-of-ten part) is always adjusted to be
2375 a multiple of three (as in ``kilo,'' ``micro,'' etc.). As a result
2376 there will be one, two, or three digits before the decimal point.
2377
2378 Whenever you change a display-related mode, Calc redraws everything
2379 in the stack. This may be slow if there are many things on the stack,
2380 so Calc allows you to type shift-@kbd{H} before any mode command to
2381 prevent it from updating the stack. Anything Calc displays after the
2382 mode-changing command will appear in the new format.
2383
2384 @smallexample
2385 @group
2386 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2387 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 1.2345e4 3: 12345.
2388 2: 123.450 2: 123.450 2: 1.2345e1 2: 1.2345e1 2: 123.45
2389 1: 12.345 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.2345e2 1: 1.2345e2 1: 12.345
2390 . . . . .
2391
2392 H d s @key{DEL} U @key{TAB} d @key{SPC} d n
2393 @end group
2394 @end smallexample
2395
2396 @noindent
2397 Here the @kbd{H d s} command changes to scientific notation but without
2398 updating the screen. Deleting the top stack entry and undoing it back
2399 causes it to show up in the new format; swapping the top two stack
2400 entries reformats both entries. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command refreshes the
2401 whole stack. The @kbd{d n} command changes back to the normal float
2402 format; since it doesn't have an @kbd{H} prefix, it also updates all
2403 the stack entries to be in @kbd{d n} format.
2404
2405 Notice that the integer @expr{12345} was not affected by any
2406 of the float formats. Integers are integers, and are always
2407 displayed exactly.
2408
2409 @cindex Large numbers, readability
2410 Large integers have their own problems. Let's look back at
2411 the result of @kbd{2^3^4}.
2412
2413 @example
2414 2417851639229258349412352
2415 @end example
2416
2417 @noindent
2418 Quick---how many digits does this have? Try typing @kbd{d g}:
2419
2420 @example
2421 2,417,851,639,229,258,349,412,352
2422 @end example
2423
2424 @noindent
2425 Now how many digits does this have? It's much easier to tell!
2426 We can actually group digits into clumps of any size. Some
2427 people prefer @kbd{M-5 d g}:
2428
2429 @example
2430 24178,51639,22925,83494,12352
2431 @end example
2432
2433 Let's see what happens to floating-point numbers when they are grouped.
2434 First, type @kbd{p 25 @key{RET}} to make sure we have enough precision
2435 to get ourselves into trouble. Now, type @kbd{1e13 /}:
2436
2437 @example
2438 24,17851,63922.9258349412352
2439 @end example
2440
2441 @noindent
2442 The integer part is grouped but the fractional part isn't. Now try
2443 @kbd{M-- M-5 d g} (that's meta-minus-sign, meta-five):
2444
2445 @example
2446 24,17851,63922.92583,49412,352
2447 @end example
2448
2449 If you find it hard to tell the decimal point from the commas, try
2450 changing the grouping character to a space with @kbd{d , @key{SPC}}:
2451
2452 @example
2453 24 17851 63922.92583 49412 352
2454 @end example
2455
2456 Type @kbd{d , ,} to restore the normal grouping character, then
2457 @kbd{d g} again to turn grouping off. Also, press @kbd{p 12} to
2458 restore the default precision.
2459
2460 Press @kbd{U} enough times to get the original big integer back.
2461 (Notice that @kbd{U} does not undo each mode-setting command; if
2462 you want to undo a mode-setting command, you have to do it yourself.)
2463 Now, type @kbd{d r 16 @key{RET}}:
2464
2465 @example
2466 16#200000000000000000000
2467 @end example
2468
2469 @noindent
2470 The number is now displayed in @dfn{hexadecimal}, or ``base-16'' form.
2471 Suddenly it looks pretty simple; this should be no surprise, since we
2472 got this number by computing a power of two, and 16 is a power of 2.
2473 In fact, we can use @w{@kbd{d r 2 @key{RET}}} to see it in actual binary
2474 form:
2475
2476 @example
2477 2#1000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 @dots{}
2478 @end example
2479
2480 @noindent
2481 We don't have enough space here to show all the zeros! They won't
2482 fit on a typical screen, either, so you will have to use horizontal
2483 scrolling to see them all. Press @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} to scroll the
2484 stack window left and right by half its width. Another way to view
2485 something large is to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the top of
2486 stack in a separate window. (Press @kbd{C-c C-c} when you are done.)
2487
2488 You can enter non-decimal numbers using the @kbd{#} symbol, too.
2489 Let's see what the hexadecimal number @samp{5FE} looks like in
2490 binary. Type @kbd{16#5FE} (the letters can be typed in upper or
2491 lower case; they will always appear in upper case). It will also
2492 help to turn grouping on with @kbd{d g}:
2493
2494 @example
2495 2#101,1111,1110
2496 @end example
2497
2498 Notice that @kbd{d g} groups by fours by default if the display radix
2499 is binary or hexadecimal, but by threes if it is decimal, octal, or any
2500 other radix.
2501
2502 Now let's see that number in decimal; type @kbd{d r 10}:
2503
2504 @example
2505 1,534
2506 @end example
2507
2508 Numbers are not @emph{stored} with any particular radix attached. They're
2509 just numbers; they can be entered in any radix, and are always displayed
2510 in whatever radix you've chosen with @kbd{d r}. The current radix applies
2511 to integers, fractions, and floats.
2512
2513 @cindex Roundoff errors, in non-decimal numbers
2514 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Your friend Joe tried to enter one-third
2515 as @samp{3#0.1} in @kbd{d r 3} mode with a precision of 12. He got
2516 @samp{3#0.0222222...} (with 25 2's) in the display. When he multiplied
2517 that by three, he got @samp{3#0.222222...} instead of the expected
2518 @samp{3#1}. Next, Joe entered @samp{3#0.2} and, to his great relief,
2519 saw @samp{3#0.2} on the screen. But when he typed @kbd{2 /}, he got
2520 @samp{3#0.10000001} (some zeros omitted). What's going on here?
2521 @xref{Modes Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2522
2523 @cindex Scientific notation, in non-decimal numbers
2524 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Scientific notation works in non-decimal
2525 modes in the natural way (the exponent is a power of the radix instead of
2526 a power of ten, although the exponent itself is always written in decimal).
2527 Thus @samp{8#1.23e3 = 8#1230.0}. Suppose we have the hexadecimal number
2528 @samp{f.e8f} times 16 to the 15th power: We write @samp{16#f.e8fe15}.
2529 What is wrong with this picture? What could we write instead that would
2530 work better? @xref{Modes Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2531
2532 The @kbd{m} prefix key has another set of modes, relating to the way
2533 Calc interprets your inputs and does computations. Whereas @kbd{d}-prefix
2534 modes generally affect the way things look, @kbd{m}-prefix modes affect
2535 the way they are actually computed.
2536
2537 The most popular @kbd{m}-prefix mode is the @dfn{angular mode}. Notice
2538 the @samp{Deg} indicator in the mode line. This means that if you use
2539 a command that interprets a number as an angle, it will assume the
2540 angle is measured in degrees. For example,
2541
2542 @smallexample
2543 @group
2544 1: 45 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001 1: 0.5
2545 . . . .
2546
2547 45 S 2 ^ c 1
2548 @end group
2549 @end smallexample
2550
2551 @noindent
2552 The shift-@kbd{S} command computes the sine of an angle. The sine
2553 of 45 degrees is
2554 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2};
2555 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2};
2556 squaring this yields @expr{2/4 = 0.5}. However, there has been a slight
2557 roundoff error because the representation of
2558 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2}
2559 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2}
2560 wasn't exact. The @kbd{c 1} command is a handy way to clean up numbers
2561 in this case; it temporarily reduces the precision by one digit while it
2562 re-rounds the number on the top of the stack.
2563
2564 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2565 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe computed the sine
2566 of 45 degrees as shown above, then, hoping to avoid an inexact
2567 result, he increased the precision to 16 digits before squaring.
2568 What happened? @xref{Modes Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2569
2570 To do this calculation in radians, we would type @kbd{m r} first.
2571 (The indicator changes to @samp{Rad}.) 45 degrees corresponds to
2572 @cpiover{4} radians. To get @cpi{}, press the @kbd{P} key. (Once
2573 again, this is a shifted capital @kbd{P}. Remember, unshifted
2574 @kbd{p} sets the precision.)
2575
2576 @smallexample
2577 @group
2578 1: 3.14159265359 1: 0.785398163398 1: 0.707106781187
2579 . . .
2580
2581 P 4 / m r S
2582 @end group
2583 @end smallexample
2584
2585 Likewise, inverse trigonometric functions generate results in
2586 either radians or degrees, depending on the current angular mode.
2587
2588 @smallexample
2589 @group
2590 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.785398163398 1: 45.
2591 . . .
2592
2593 .5 Q m r I S m d U I S
2594 @end group
2595 @end smallexample
2596
2597 @noindent
2598 Here we compute the Inverse Sine of
2599 @texline @math{\sqrt{0.5}},
2600 @infoline @expr{sqrt(0.5)},
2601 first in radians, then in degrees.
2602
2603 Use @kbd{c d} and @kbd{c r} to convert a number from radians to degrees
2604 and vice-versa.
2605
2606 @smallexample
2607 @group
2608 1: 45 1: 0.785398163397 1: 45.
2609 . . .
2610
2611 45 c r c d
2612 @end group
2613 @end smallexample
2614
2615 Another interesting mode is @dfn{Fraction mode}. Normally,
2616 dividing two integers produces a floating-point result if the
2617 quotient can't be expressed as an exact integer. Fraction mode
2618 causes integer division to produce a fraction, i.e., a rational
2619 number, instead.
2620
2621 @smallexample
2622 @group
2623 2: 12 1: 1.33333333333 1: 4:3
2624 1: 9 . .
2625 .
2626
2627 12 @key{RET} 9 / m f U / m f
2628 @end group
2629 @end smallexample
2630
2631 @noindent
2632 In the first case, we get an approximate floating-point result.
2633 In the second case, we get an exact fractional result (four-thirds).
2634
2635 You can enter a fraction at any time using @kbd{:} notation.
2636 (Calc uses @kbd{:} instead of @kbd{/} as the fraction separator
2637 because @kbd{/} is already used to divide the top two stack
2638 elements.) Calculations involving fractions will always
2639 produce exact fractional results; Fraction mode only says
2640 what to do when dividing two integers.
2641
2642 @cindex Fractions vs. floats
2643 @cindex Floats vs. fractions
2644 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} If fractional arithmetic is exact,
2645 why would you ever use floating-point numbers instead?
2646 @xref{Modes Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
2647
2648 Typing @kbd{m f} doesn't change any existing values in the stack.
2649 In the above example, we had to Undo the division and do it over
2650 again when we changed to Fraction mode. But if you use the
2651 evaluates-to operator you can get commands like @kbd{m f} to
2652 recompute for you.
2653
2654 @smallexample
2655 @group
2656 1: 12 / 9 => 1.33333333333 1: 12 / 9 => 1.333 1: 12 / 9 => 4:3
2657 . . .
2658
2659 ' 12/9 => @key{RET} p 4 @key{RET} m f
2660 @end group
2661 @end smallexample
2662
2663 @noindent
2664 In this example, the righthand side of the @samp{=>} operator
2665 on the stack is recomputed when we change the precision, then
2666 again when we change to Fraction mode. All @samp{=>} expressions
2667 on the stack are recomputed every time you change any mode that
2668 might affect their values.
2669
2670 @node Arithmetic Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Tutorial
2671 @section Arithmetic Tutorial
2672
2673 @noindent
2674 In this section, we explore the arithmetic and scientific functions
2675 available in the Calculator.
2676
2677 The standard arithmetic commands are @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/},
2678 and @kbd{^}. Each normally takes two numbers from the top of the stack
2679 and pushes back a result. The @kbd{n} and @kbd{&} keys perform
2680 change-sign and reciprocal operations, respectively.
2681
2682 @smallexample
2683 @group
2684 1: 5 1: 0.2 1: 5. 1: -5. 1: 5.
2685 . . . . .
2686
2687 5 & & n n
2688 @end group
2689 @end smallexample
2690
2691 @cindex Binary operators
2692 You can apply a ``binary operator'' like @kbd{+} across any number of
2693 stack entries by giving it a numeric prefix. You can also apply it
2694 pairwise to several stack elements along with the top one if you use
2695 a negative prefix.
2696
2697 @smallexample
2698 @group
2699 3: 2 1: 9 3: 2 4: 2 3: 12
2700 2: 3 . 2: 3 3: 3 2: 13
2701 1: 4 1: 4 2: 4 1: 14
2702 . . 1: 10 .
2703 .
2704
2705 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 + U 10 M-- M-3 +
2706 @end group
2707 @end smallexample
2708
2709 @cindex Unary operators
2710 You can apply a ``unary operator'' like @kbd{&} to the top @var{n}
2711 stack entries with a numeric prefix, too.
2712
2713 @smallexample
2714 @group
2715 3: 2 3: 0.5 3: 0.5
2716 2: 3 2: 0.333333333333 2: 3.
2717 1: 4 1: 0.25 1: 4.
2718 . . .
2719
2720 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 & M-2 &
2721 @end group
2722 @end smallexample
2723
2724 Notice that the results here are left in floating-point form.
2725 We can convert them back to integers by pressing @kbd{F}, the
2726 ``floor'' function. This function rounds down to the next lower
2727 integer. There is also @kbd{R}, which rounds to the nearest
2728 integer.
2729
2730 @smallexample
2731 @group
2732 7: 2. 7: 2 7: 2
2733 6: 2.4 6: 2 6: 2
2734 5: 2.5 5: 2 5: 3
2735 4: 2.6 4: 2 4: 3
2736 3: -2. 3: -2 3: -2
2737 2: -2.4 2: -3 2: -2
2738 1: -2.6 1: -3 1: -3
2739 . . .
2740
2741 M-7 F U M-7 R
2742 @end group
2743 @end smallexample
2744
2745 Since dividing-and-flooring (i.e., ``integer quotient'') is such a
2746 common operation, Calc provides a special command for that purpose, the
2747 backslash @kbd{\}. Another common arithmetic operator is @kbd{%}, which
2748 computes the remainder that would arise from a @kbd{\} operation, i.e.,
2749 the ``modulo'' of two numbers. For example,
2750
2751 @smallexample
2752 @group
2753 2: 1234 1: 12 2: 1234 1: 34
2754 1: 100 . 1: 100 .
2755 . .
2756
2757 1234 @key{RET} 100 \ U %
2758 @end group
2759 @end smallexample
2760
2761 These commands actually work for any real numbers, not just integers.
2762
2763 @smallexample
2764 @group
2765 2: 3.1415 1: 3 2: 3.1415 1: 0.1415
2766 1: 1 . 1: 1 .
2767 . .
2768
2769 3.1415 @key{RET} 1 \ U %
2770 @end group
2771 @end smallexample
2772
2773 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The @kbd{\} command would appear to be a
2774 frill, since you could always do the same thing with @kbd{/ F}. Think
2775 of a situation where this is not true---@kbd{/ F} would be inadequate.
2776 Now think of a way you could get around the problem if Calc didn't
2777 provide a @kbd{\} command. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2778
2779 We've already seen the @kbd{Q} (square root) and @kbd{S} (sine)
2780 commands. Other commands along those lines are @kbd{C} (cosine),
2781 @kbd{T} (tangent), @kbd{E} (@expr{e^x}) and @kbd{L} (natural
2782 logarithm). These can be modified by the @kbd{I} (inverse) and
2783 @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix keys.
2784
2785 Let's compute the sine and cosine of an angle, and verify the
2786 identity
2787 @texline @math{\sin^2x + \cos^2x = 1}.
2788 @infoline @expr{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}.
2789 We'll arbitrarily pick @mathit{-64} degrees as a good value for @expr{x}.
2790 With the angular mode set to degrees (type @w{@kbd{m d}}), do:
2791
2792 @smallexample
2793 @group
2794 2: -64 2: -64 2: -0.89879 2: -0.89879 1: 1.
2795 1: -64 1: -0.89879 1: -64 1: 0.43837 .
2796 . . . .
2797
2798 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} S @key{TAB} C f h
2799 @end group
2800 @end smallexample
2801
2802 @noindent
2803 (For brevity, we're showing only five digits of the results here.
2804 You can of course do these calculations to any precision you like.)
2805
2806 Remember, @kbd{f h} is the @code{calc-hypot}, or square-root of sum
2807 of squares, command.
2808
2809 Another identity is
2810 @texline @math{\displaystyle\tan x = {\sin x \over \cos x}}.
2811 @infoline @expr{tan(x) = sin(x) / cos(x)}.
2812 @smallexample
2813 @group
2814
2815 2: -0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2816 1: 0.43837 . .
2817 .
2818
2819 U / I T
2820 @end group
2821 @end smallexample
2822
2823 A physical interpretation of this calculation is that if you move
2824 @expr{0.89879} units downward and @expr{0.43837} units to the right,
2825 your direction of motion is @mathit{-64} degrees from horizontal. Suppose
2826 we move in the opposite direction, up and to the left:
2827
2828 @smallexample
2829 @group
2830 2: -0.89879 2: 0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2831 1: 0.43837 1: -0.43837 . .
2832 . .
2833
2834 U U M-2 n / I T
2835 @end group
2836 @end smallexample
2837
2838 @noindent
2839 How can the angle be the same? The answer is that the @kbd{/} operation
2840 loses information about the signs of its inputs. Because the quotient
2841 is negative, we know exactly one of the inputs was negative, but we
2842 can't tell which one. There is an @kbd{f T} [@code{arctan2}] function which
2843 computes the inverse tangent of the quotient of a pair of numbers.
2844 Since you feed it the two original numbers, it has enough information
2845 to give you a full 360-degree answer.
2846
2847 @smallexample
2848 @group
2849 2: 0.89879 1: 116. 3: 116. 2: 116. 1: 180.
2850 1: -0.43837 . 2: -0.89879 1: -64. .
2851 . 1: 0.43837 .
2852 .
2853
2854 U U f T M-@key{RET} M-2 n f T -
2855 @end group
2856 @end smallexample
2857
2858 @noindent
2859 The resulting angles differ by 180 degrees; in other words, they
2860 point in opposite directions, just as we would expect.
2861
2862 The @key{META}-@key{RET} we used in the third step is the
2863 ``last-arguments'' command. It is sort of like Undo, except that it
2864 restores the arguments of the last command to the stack without removing
2865 the command's result. It is useful in situations like this one,
2866 where we need to do several operations on the same inputs. We could
2867 have accomplished the same thing by using @kbd{M-2 @key{RET}} to duplicate
2868 the top two stack elements right after the @kbd{U U}, then a pair of
2869 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} commands to cycle the 116 up around the duplicates.
2870
2871 A similar identity is supposed to hold for hyperbolic sines and cosines,
2872 except that it is the @emph{difference}
2873 @texline @math{\cosh^2x - \sinh^2x}
2874 @infoline @expr{cosh(x)^2 - sinh(x)^2}
2875 that always equals one. Let's try to verify this identity.
2876
2877 @smallexample
2878 @group
2879 2: -64 2: -64 2: -64 2: 9.7192e54 2: 9.7192e54
2880 1: -64 1: -3.1175e27 1: 9.7192e54 1: -64 1: 9.7192e54
2881 . . . . .
2882
2883 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} H C 2 ^ @key{TAB} H S 2 ^
2884 @end group
2885 @end smallexample
2886
2887 @noindent
2888 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2889 Something's obviously wrong, because when we subtract these numbers
2890 the answer will clearly be zero! But if you think about it, if these
2891 numbers @emph{did} differ by one, it would be in the 55th decimal
2892 place. The difference we seek has been lost entirely to roundoff
2893 error.
2894
2895 We could verify this hypothesis by doing the actual calculation with,
2896 say, 60 decimal places of precision. This will be slow, but not
2897 enormously so. Try it if you wish; sure enough, the answer is
2898 0.99999, reasonably close to 1.
2899
2900 Of course, a more reasonable way to verify the identity is to use
2901 a more reasonable value for @expr{x}!
2902
2903 @cindex Common logarithm
2904 Some Calculator commands use the Hyperbolic prefix for other purposes.
2905 The logarithm and exponential functions, for example, work to the base
2906 @expr{e} normally but use base-10 instead if you use the Hyperbolic
2907 prefix.
2908
2909 @smallexample
2910 @group
2911 1: 1000 1: 6.9077 1: 1000 1: 3
2912 . . . .
2913
2914 1000 L U H L
2915 @end group
2916 @end smallexample
2917
2918 @noindent
2919 First, we mistakenly compute a natural logarithm. Then we undo
2920 and compute a common logarithm instead.
2921
2922 The @kbd{B} key computes a general base-@var{b} logarithm for any
2923 value of @var{b}.
2924
2925 @smallexample
2926 @group
2927 2: 1000 1: 3 1: 1000. 2: 1000. 1: 6.9077
2928 1: 10 . . 1: 2.71828 .
2929 . .
2930
2931 1000 @key{RET} 10 B H E H P B
2932 @end group
2933 @end smallexample
2934
2935 @noindent
2936 Here we first use @kbd{B} to compute the base-10 logarithm, then use
2937 the ``hyperbolic'' exponential as a cheap hack to recover the number
2938 1000, then use @kbd{B} again to compute the natural logarithm. Note
2939 that @kbd{P} with the hyperbolic prefix pushes the constant @expr{e}
2940 onto the stack.
2941
2942 You may have noticed that both times we took the base-10 logarithm
2943 of 1000, we got an exact integer result. Calc always tries to give
2944 an exact rational result for calculations involving rational numbers
2945 where possible. But when we used @kbd{H E}, the result was a
2946 floating-point number for no apparent reason. In fact, if we had
2947 computed @kbd{10 @key{RET} 3 ^} we @emph{would} have gotten an
2948 exact integer 1000. But the @kbd{H E} command is rigged to generate
2949 a floating-point result all of the time so that @kbd{1000 H E} will
2950 not waste time computing a thousand-digit integer when all you
2951 probably wanted was @samp{1e1000}.
2952
2953 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Find a pair of integer inputs to
2954 the @kbd{B} command for which Calc could find an exact rational
2955 result but doesn't. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2956
2957 The Calculator also has a set of functions relating to combinatorics
2958 and statistics. You may be familiar with the @dfn{factorial} function,
2959 which computes the product of all the integers up to a given number.
2960
2961 @smallexample
2962 @group
2963 1: 100 1: 93326215443... 1: 100. 1: 9.3326e157
2964 . . . .
2965
2966 100 ! U c f !
2967 @end group
2968 @end smallexample
2969
2970 @noindent
2971 Recall, the @kbd{c f} command converts the integer or fraction at the
2972 top of the stack to floating-point format. If you take the factorial
2973 of a floating-point number, you get a floating-point result
2974 accurate to the current precision. But if you give @kbd{!} an
2975 exact integer, you get an exact integer result (158 digits long
2976 in this case).
2977
2978 If you take the factorial of a non-integer, Calc uses a generalized
2979 factorial function defined in terms of Euler's Gamma function
2980 @texline @math{\Gamma(n)}
2981 @infoline @expr{gamma(n)}
2982 (which is itself available as the @kbd{f g} command).
2983
2984 @smallexample
2985 @group
2986 3: 4. 3: 24. 1: 5.5 1: 52.342777847
2987 2: 4.5 2: 52.3427777847 . .
2988 1: 5. 1: 120.
2989 . .
2990
2991 M-3 ! M-0 @key{DEL} 5.5 f g
2992 @end group
2993 @end smallexample
2994
2995 @noindent
2996 Here we verify the identity
2997 @texline @math{n! = \Gamma(n+1)}.
2998 @infoline @expr{@var{n}!@: = gamma(@var{n}+1)}.
2999
3000 The binomial coefficient @var{n}-choose-@var{m}
3001 @texline or @math{\displaystyle {n \choose m}}
3002 is defined by
3003 @texline @math{\displaystyle {n! \over m! \, (n-m)!}}
3004 @infoline @expr{n!@: / m!@: (n-m)!}
3005 for all reals @expr{n} and @expr{m}. The intermediate results in this
3006 formula can become quite large even if the final result is small; the
3007 @kbd{k c} command computes a binomial coefficient in a way that avoids
3008 large intermediate values.
3009
3010 The @kbd{k} prefix key defines several common functions out of
3011 combinatorics and number theory. Here we compute the binomial
3012 coefficient 30-choose-20, then determine its prime factorization.
3013
3014 @smallexample
3015 @group
3016 2: 30 1: 30045015 1: [3, 3, 5, 7, 11, 13, 23, 29]
3017 1: 20 . .
3018 .
3019
3020 30 @key{RET} 20 k c k f
3021 @end group
3022 @end smallexample
3023
3024 @noindent
3025 You can verify these prime factors by using @kbd{V R *} to multiply
3026 together the elements of this vector. The result is the original
3027 number, 30045015.
3028
3029 @cindex Hash tables
3030 Suppose a program you are writing needs a hash table with at least
3031 10000 entries. It's best to use a prime number as the actual size
3032 of a hash table. Calc can compute the next prime number after 10000:
3033
3034 @smallexample
3035 @group
3036 1: 10000 1: 10007 1: 9973
3037 . . .
3038
3039 10000 k n I k n
3040 @end group
3041 @end smallexample
3042
3043 @noindent
3044 Just for kicks we've also computed the next prime @emph{less} than
3045 10000.
3046
3047 @c [fix-ref Financial Functions]
3048 @xref{Financial Functions}, for a description of the Calculator
3049 commands that deal with business and financial calculations (functions
3050 like @code{pv}, @code{rate}, and @code{sln}).
3051
3052 @c [fix-ref Binary Number Functions]
3053 @xref{Binary Functions}, to read about the commands for operating
3054 on binary numbers (like @code{and}, @code{xor}, and @code{lsh}).
3055
3056 @node Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial
3057 @section Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3058
3059 @noindent
3060 A @dfn{vector} is a list of numbers or other Calc data objects.
3061 Calc provides a large set of commands that operate on vectors. Some
3062 are familiar operations from vector analysis. Others simply treat
3063 a vector as a list of objects.
3064
3065 @menu
3066 * Vector Analysis Tutorial::
3067 * Matrix Tutorial::
3068 * List Tutorial::
3069 @end menu
3070
3071 @node Vector Analysis Tutorial, Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3072 @subsection Vector Analysis
3073
3074 @noindent
3075 If you add two vectors, the result is a vector of the sums of the
3076 elements, taken pairwise.
3077
3078 @smallexample
3079 @group
3080 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [8, 8, 3]
3081 . 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3082 .
3083
3084 [1,2,3] s 1 [7 6 0] s 2 +
3085 @end group
3086 @end smallexample
3087
3088 @noindent
3089 Note that we can separate the vector elements with either commas or
3090 spaces. This is true whether we are using incomplete vectors or
3091 algebraic entry. The @kbd{s 1} and @kbd{s 2} commands save these
3092 vectors so we can easily reuse them later.
3093
3094 If you multiply two vectors, the result is the sum of the products
3095 of the elements taken pairwise. This is called the @dfn{dot product}
3096 of the vectors.
3097
3098 @smallexample
3099 @group
3100 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 19
3101 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3102 .
3103
3104 r 1 r 2 *
3105 @end group
3106 @end smallexample
3107
3108 @cindex Dot product
3109 The dot product of two vectors is equal to the product of their
3110 lengths times the cosine of the angle between them. (Here the vector
3111 is interpreted as a line from the origin @expr{(0,0,0)} to the
3112 specified point in three-dimensional space.) The @kbd{A}
3113 (absolute value) command can be used to compute the length of a
3114 vector.
3115
3116 @smallexample
3117 @group
3118 3: 19 3: 19 1: 0.550782 1: 56.579
3119 2: [1, 2, 3] 2: 3.741657 . .
3120 1: [7, 6, 0] 1: 9.219544
3121 . .
3122
3123 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / I C
3124 @end group
3125 @end smallexample
3126
3127 @noindent
3128 First we recall the arguments to the dot product command, then
3129 we compute the absolute values of the top two stack entries to
3130 obtain the lengths of the vectors, then we divide the dot product
3131 by the product of the lengths to get the cosine of the angle.
3132 The inverse cosine finds that the angle between the vectors
3133 is about 56 degrees.
3134
3135 @cindex Cross product
3136 @cindex Perpendicular vectors
3137 The @dfn{cross product} of two vectors is a vector whose length
3138 is the product of the lengths of the inputs times the sine of the
3139 angle between them, and whose direction is perpendicular to both
3140 input vectors. Unlike the dot product, the cross product is
3141 defined only for three-dimensional vectors. Let's double-check
3142 our computation of the angle using the cross product.
3143
3144 @smallexample
3145 @group
3146 2: [1, 2, 3] 3: [-18, 21, -8] 1: [-0.52, 0.61, -0.23] 1: 56.579
3147 1: [7, 6, 0] 2: [1, 2, 3] . .
3148 . 1: [7, 6, 0]
3149 .
3150
3151 r 1 r 2 V C s 3 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / A I S
3152 @end group
3153 @end smallexample
3154
3155 @noindent
3156 First we recall the original vectors and compute their cross product,
3157 which we also store for later reference. Now we divide the vector
3158 by the product of the lengths of the original vectors. The length of
3159 this vector should be the sine of the angle; sure enough, it is!
3160
3161 @c [fix-ref General Mode Commands]
3162 Vector-related commands generally begin with the @kbd{v} prefix key.
3163 Some are uppercase letters and some are lowercase. To make it easier
3164 to type these commands, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix key acts the same as
3165 the @kbd{v} key. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to make all
3166 prefix keys have this property.)
3167
3168 If we take the dot product of two perpendicular vectors we expect
3169 to get zero, since the cosine of 90 degrees is zero. Let's check
3170 that the cross product is indeed perpendicular to both inputs:
3171
3172 @smallexample
3173 @group
3174 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 0 2: [7, 6, 0] 1: 0
3175 1: [-18, 21, -8] . 1: [-18, 21, -8] .
3176 . .
3177
3178 r 1 r 3 * @key{DEL} r 2 r 3 *
3179 @end group
3180 @end smallexample
3181
3182 @cindex Normalizing a vector
3183 @cindex Unit vectors
3184 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Given a vector on the top of the
3185 stack, what keystrokes would you use to @dfn{normalize} the
3186 vector, i.e., to reduce its length to one without changing its
3187 direction? @xref{Vector Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3188
3189 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Suppose a certain particle can be
3190 at any of several positions along a ruler. You have a list of
3191 those positions in the form of a vector, and another list of the
3192 probabilities for the particle to be at the corresponding positions.
3193 Find the average position of the particle.
3194 @xref{Vector Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3195
3196 @node Matrix Tutorial, List Tutorial, Vector Analysis Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3197 @subsection Matrices
3198
3199 @noindent
3200 A @dfn{matrix} is just a vector of vectors, all the same length.
3201 This means you can enter a matrix using nested brackets. You can
3202 also use the semicolon character to enter a matrix. We'll show
3203 both methods here:
3204
3205 @smallexample
3206 @group
3207 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3208 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3209 . .
3210
3211 [[1 2 3] [4 5 6]] ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6] @key{RET}
3212 @end group
3213 @end smallexample
3214
3215 @noindent
3216 We'll be using this matrix again, so type @kbd{s 4} to save it now.
3217
3218 Note that semicolons work with incomplete vectors, but they work
3219 better in algebraic entry. That's why we use the apostrophe in
3220 the second example.
3221
3222 When two matrices are multiplied, the lefthand matrix must have
3223 the same number of columns as the righthand matrix has rows.
3224 Row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of the result is effectively the
3225 dot product of row @expr{i} of the left matrix by column @expr{j}
3226 of the right matrix.
3227
3228 If we try to duplicate this matrix and multiply it by itself,
3229 the dimensions are wrong and the multiplication cannot take place:
3230
3231 @smallexample
3232 @group
3233 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] * [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3234 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3235 .
3236
3237 @key{RET} *
3238 @end group
3239 @end smallexample
3240
3241 @noindent
3242 Though rather hard to read, this is a formula which shows the product
3243 of two matrices. The @samp{*} function, having invalid arguments, has
3244 been left in symbolic form.
3245
3246 We can multiply the matrices if we @dfn{transpose} one of them first.
3247
3248 @smallexample
3249 @group
3250 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 14, 32 ] 1: [ [ 17, 22, 27 ]
3251 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 32, 77 ] ] [ 22, 29, 36 ]
3252 1: [ [ 1, 4 ] . [ 27, 36, 45 ] ]
3253 [ 2, 5 ] .
3254 [ 3, 6 ] ]
3255 .
3256
3257 U v t * U @key{TAB} *
3258 @end group
3259 @end smallexample
3260
3261 Matrix multiplication is not commutative; indeed, switching the
3262 order of the operands can even change the dimensions of the result
3263 matrix, as happened here!
3264
3265 If you multiply a plain vector by a matrix, it is treated as a
3266 single row or column depending on which side of the matrix it is
3267 on. The result is a plain vector which should also be interpreted
3268 as a row or column as appropriate.
3269
3270 @smallexample
3271 @group
3272 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [14, 32]
3273 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] .
3274 1: [1, 2, 3]
3275 .
3276
3277 r 4 r 1 *
3278 @end group
3279 @end smallexample
3280
3281 Multiplying in the other order wouldn't work because the number of
3282 rows in the matrix is different from the number of elements in the
3283 vector.
3284
3285 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Use @samp{*} to sum along the rows
3286 of the above
3287 @texline @math{2\times3}
3288 @infoline 2x3
3289 matrix to get @expr{[6, 15]}. Now use @samp{*} to sum along the columns
3290 to get @expr{[5, 7, 9]}.
3291 @xref{Matrix Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3292
3293 @cindex Identity matrix
3294 An @dfn{identity matrix} is a square matrix with ones along the
3295 diagonal and zeros elsewhere. It has the property that multiplication
3296 by an identity matrix, on the left or on the right, always produces
3297 the original matrix.
3298
3299 @smallexample
3300 @group
3301 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3302 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3303 . 1: [ [ 1, 0, 0 ] .
3304 [ 0, 1, 0 ]
3305 [ 0, 0, 1 ] ]
3306 .
3307
3308 r 4 v i 3 @key{RET} *
3309 @end group
3310 @end smallexample
3311
3312 If a matrix is square, it is often possible to find its @dfn{inverse},
3313 that is, a matrix which, when multiplied by the original matrix, yields
3314 an identity matrix. The @kbd{&} (reciprocal) key also computes the
3315 inverse of a matrix.
3316
3317 @smallexample
3318 @group
3319 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ -2.4, 1.2, -0.2 ]
3320 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2.8, -1.4, 0.4 ]
3321 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ -0.73333, 0.53333, -0.2 ] ]
3322 . .
3323
3324 r 4 r 2 | s 5 &
3325 @end group
3326 @end smallexample
3327
3328 @noindent
3329 The vertical bar @kbd{|} @dfn{concatenates} numbers, vectors, and
3330 matrices together. Here we have used it to add a new row onto
3331 our matrix to make it square.
3332
3333 We can multiply these two matrices in either order to get an identity.
3334
3335 @smallexample
3336 @group
3337 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ] 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ]
3338 [ 0., 1., 0. ] [ 0., 1., 0. ]
3339 [ 0., 0., 1. ] ] [ 0., 0., 1. ] ]
3340 . .
3341
3342 M-@key{RET} * U @key{TAB} *
3343 @end group
3344 @end smallexample
3345
3346 @cindex Systems of linear equations
3347 @cindex Linear equations, systems of
3348 Matrix inverses are related to systems of linear equations in algebra.
3349 Suppose we had the following set of equations:
3350
3351 @ifnottex
3352 @group
3353 @example
3354 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3355 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3356 7a + 6b = 3
3357 @end example
3358 @end group
3359 @end ifnottex
3360 @tex
3361 \turnoffactive
3362 \beforedisplayh
3363 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3364 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3365 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3366 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3367 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3368 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3369 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3370 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr}
3371 $$
3372 \afterdisplayh
3373 @end tex
3374
3375 @noindent
3376 This can be cast into the matrix equation,
3377
3378 @ifnottex
3379 @group
3380 @example
3381 [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] [ [ a ] [ [ 6 ]
3382 [ 4, 5, 6 ] * [ b ] = [ 2 ]
3383 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ c ] ] [ 3 ] ]
3384 @end example
3385 @end group
3386 @end ifnottex
3387 @tex
3388 \turnoffactive
3389 \beforedisplay
3390 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 \cr 4 & 5 & 6 \cr 7 & 6 & 0 }
3391 \times
3392 \pmatrix{ a \cr b \cr c } = \pmatrix{ 6 \cr 2 \cr 3 }
3393 $$
3394 \afterdisplay
3395 @end tex
3396
3397 We can solve this system of equations by multiplying both sides by the
3398 inverse of the matrix. Calc can do this all in one step:
3399
3400 @smallexample
3401 @group
3402 2: [6, 2, 3] 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3403 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
3404 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
3405 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3406 .
3407
3408 [6,2,3] r 5 /
3409 @end group
3410 @end smallexample
3411
3412 @noindent
3413 The result is the @expr{[a, b, c]} vector that solves the equations.
3414 (Dividing by a square matrix is equivalent to multiplying by its
3415 inverse.)
3416
3417 Let's verify this solution:
3418
3419 @smallexample
3420 @group
3421 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [6., 2., 3.]
3422 [ 4, 5, 6 ] .
3423 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3424 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3425 .
3426
3427 r 5 @key{TAB} *
3428 @end group
3429 @end smallexample
3430
3431 @noindent
3432 Note that we had to be careful about the order in which we multiplied
3433 the matrix and vector. If we multiplied in the other order, Calc would
3434 assume the vector was a row vector in order to make the dimensions
3435 come out right, and the answer would be incorrect. If you
3436 don't feel safe letting Calc take either interpretation of your
3437 vectors, use explicit
3438 @texline @math{N\times1}
3439 @infoline Nx1
3440 or
3441 @texline @math{1\times N}
3442 @infoline 1xN
3443 matrices instead. In this case, you would enter the original column
3444 vector as @samp{[[6], [2], [3]]} or @samp{[6; 2; 3]}.
3445
3446 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Algebraic entry allows you to make
3447 vectors and matrices that include variables. Solve the following
3448 system of equations to get expressions for @expr{x} and @expr{y}
3449 in terms of @expr{a} and @expr{b}.
3450
3451 @ifnottex
3452 @group
3453 @example
3454 x + a y = 6
3455 x + b y = 10
3456 @end example
3457 @end group
3458 @end ifnottex
3459 @tex
3460 \turnoffactive
3461 \beforedisplay
3462 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
3463 x &+ b y = 10}
3464 $$
3465 \afterdisplay
3466 @end tex
3467
3468 @noindent
3469 @xref{Matrix Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3470
3471 @cindex Least-squares for over-determined systems
3472 @cindex Over-determined systems of equations
3473 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} A system of equations is ``over-determined''
3474 if it has more equations than variables. It is often the case that
3475 there are no values for the variables that will satisfy all the
3476 equations at once, but it is still useful to find a set of values
3477 which ``nearly'' satisfy all the equations. In terms of matrix equations,
3478 you can't solve @expr{A X = B} directly because the matrix @expr{A}
3479 is not square for an over-determined system. Matrix inversion works
3480 only for square matrices. One common trick is to multiply both sides
3481 on the left by the transpose of @expr{A}:
3482 @ifnottex
3483 @samp{trn(A)*A*X = trn(A)*B}.
3484 @end ifnottex
3485 @tex
3486 \turnoffactive
3487 $A^T A \, X = A^T B$, where $A^T$ is the transpose \samp{trn(A)}.
3488 @end tex
3489 Now
3490 @texline @math{A^T A}
3491 @infoline @expr{trn(A)*A}
3492 is a square matrix so a solution is possible. It turns out that the
3493 @expr{X} vector you compute in this way will be a ``least-squares''
3494 solution, which can be regarded as the ``closest'' solution to the set
3495 of equations. Use Calc to solve the following over-determined
3496 system:
3497
3498 @ifnottex
3499 @group
3500 @example
3501 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3502 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3503 7a + 6b = 3
3504 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
3505 @end example
3506 @end group
3507 @end ifnottex
3508 @tex
3509 \turnoffactive
3510 \beforedisplayh
3511 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3512 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3513 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3514 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3515 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3516 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3517 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3518 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
3519 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
3520 $$
3521 \afterdisplayh
3522 @end tex
3523
3524 @noindent
3525 @xref{Matrix Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
3526
3527 @node List Tutorial, , Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3528 @subsection Vectors as Lists
3529
3530 @noindent
3531 @cindex Lists
3532 Although Calc has a number of features for manipulating vectors and
3533 matrices as mathematical objects, you can also treat vectors as
3534 simple lists of values. For example, we saw that the @kbd{k f}
3535 command returns a vector which is a list of the prime factors of a
3536 number.
3537
3538 You can pack and unpack stack entries into vectors:
3539
3540 @smallexample
3541 @group
3542 3: 10 1: [10, 20, 30] 3: 10
3543 2: 20 . 2: 20
3544 1: 30 1: 30
3545 . .
3546
3547 M-3 v p v u
3548 @end group
3549 @end smallexample
3550
3551 You can also build vectors out of consecutive integers, or out
3552 of many copies of a given value:
3553
3554 @smallexample
3555 @group
3556 1: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4]
3557 . 1: 17 1: [17, 17, 17, 17]
3558 . .
3559
3560 v x 4 @key{RET} 17 v b 4 @key{RET}
3561 @end group
3562 @end smallexample
3563
3564 You can apply an operator to every element of a vector using the
3565 @dfn{map} command.
3566
3567 @smallexample
3568 @group
3569 1: [17, 34, 51, 68] 1: [289, 1156, 2601, 4624] 1: [17, 34, 51, 68]
3570 . . .
3571
3572 V M * 2 V M ^ V M Q
3573 @end group
3574 @end smallexample
3575
3576 @noindent
3577 In the first step, we multiply the vector of integers by the vector
3578 of 17's elementwise. In the second step, we raise each element to
3579 the power two. (The general rule is that both operands must be
3580 vectors of the same length, or else one must be a vector and the
3581 other a plain number.) In the final step, we take the square root
3582 of each element.
3583
3584 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Compute a vector of powers of two
3585 from
3586 @texline @math{2^{-4}}
3587 @infoline @expr{2^-4}
3588 to @expr{2^4}. @xref{List Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3589
3590 You can also @dfn{reduce} a binary operator across a vector.
3591 For example, reducing @samp{*} computes the product of all the
3592 elements in the vector:
3593
3594 @smallexample
3595 @group
3596 1: 123123 1: [3, 7, 11, 13, 41] 1: 123123
3597 . . .
3598
3599 123123 k f V R *
3600 @end group
3601 @end smallexample
3602
3603 @noindent
3604 In this example, we decompose 123123 into its prime factors, then
3605 multiply those factors together again to yield the original number.
3606
3607 We could compute a dot product ``by hand'' using mapping and
3608 reduction:
3609
3610 @smallexample
3611 @group
3612 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [7, 12, 0] 1: 19
3613 1: [7, 6, 0] . .
3614 .
3615
3616 r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
3617 @end group
3618 @end smallexample
3619
3620 @noindent
3621 Recalling two vectors from the previous section, we compute the
3622 sum of pairwise products of the elements to get the same answer
3623 for the dot product as before.
3624
3625 A slight variant of vector reduction is the @dfn{accumulate} operation,
3626 @kbd{V U}. This produces a vector of the intermediate results from
3627 a corresponding reduction. Here we compute a table of factorials:
3628
3629 @smallexample
3630 @group
3631 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] 1: [1, 2, 6, 24, 120, 720]
3632 . .
3633
3634 v x 6 @key{RET} V U *
3635 @end group
3636 @end smallexample
3637
3638 Calc allows vectors to grow as large as you like, although it gets
3639 rather slow if vectors have more than about a hundred elements.
3640 Actually, most of the time is spent formatting these large vectors
3641 for display, not calculating on them. Try the following experiment
3642 (if your computer is very fast you may need to substitute a larger
3643 vector size).
3644
3645 @smallexample
3646 @group
3647 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ... 1: [2, 3, 4, 5, ...
3648 . .
3649
3650 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3651 @end group
3652 @end smallexample
3653
3654 Now press @kbd{v .} (the letter @kbd{v}, then a period) and try the
3655 experiment again. In @kbd{v .} mode, long vectors are displayed
3656 ``abbreviated'' like this:
3657
3658 @smallexample
3659 @group
3660 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 500] 1: [2, 3, 4, ..., 501]
3661 . .
3662
3663 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3664 @end group
3665 @end smallexample
3666
3667 @noindent
3668 (where now the @samp{...} is actually part of the Calc display).
3669 You will find both operations are now much faster. But notice that
3670 even in @w{@kbd{v .}} mode, the full vectors are still shown in the Trail.
3671 Type @w{@kbd{t .}} to cause the trail to abbreviate as well, and try the
3672 experiment one more time. Operations on long vectors are now quite
3673 fast! (But of course if you use @kbd{t .} you will lose the ability
3674 to get old vectors back using the @kbd{t y} command.)
3675
3676 An easy way to view a full vector when @kbd{v .} mode is active is
3677 to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the vector; editing always works
3678 with the full, unabbreviated value.
3679
3680 @cindex Least-squares for fitting a straight line
3681 @cindex Fitting data to a line
3682 @cindex Line, fitting data to
3683 @cindex Data, extracting from buffers
3684 @cindex Columns of data, extracting
3685 As a larger example, let's try to fit a straight line to some data,
3686 using the method of least squares. (Calc has a built-in command for
3687 least-squares curve fitting, but we'll do it by hand here just to
3688 practice working with vectors.) Suppose we have the following list
3689 of values in a file we have loaded into Emacs:
3690
3691 @smallexample
3692 x y
3693 --- ---
3694 1.34 0.234
3695 1.41 0.298
3696 1.49 0.402
3697 1.56 0.412
3698 1.64 0.466
3699 1.73 0.473
3700 1.82 0.601
3701 1.91 0.519
3702 2.01 0.603
3703 2.11 0.637
3704 2.22 0.645
3705 2.33 0.705
3706 2.45 0.917
3707 2.58 1.009
3708 2.71 0.971
3709 2.85 1.062
3710 3.00 1.148
3711 3.15 1.157
3712 3.32 1.354
3713 @end smallexample
3714
3715 @noindent
3716 If you are reading this tutorial in printed form, you will find it
3717 easiest to press @kbd{C-x * i} to enter the on-line Info version of
3718 the manual and find this table there. (Press @kbd{g}, then type
3719 @kbd{List Tutorial}, to jump straight to this section.)
3720
3721 Position the cursor at the upper-left corner of this table, just
3722 to the left of the @expr{1.34}. Press @kbd{C-@@} to set the mark.
3723 (On your system this may be @kbd{C-2}, @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}, or @kbd{NUL}.)
3724 Now position the cursor to the lower-right, just after the @expr{1.354}.
3725 You have now defined this region as an Emacs ``rectangle.'' Still
3726 in the Info buffer, type @kbd{C-x * r}. This command
3727 (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) will pop you back into the Calculator, with
3728 the contents of the rectangle you specified in the form of a matrix.
3729
3730 @smallexample
3731 @group
3732 1: [ [ 1.34, 0.234 ]
3733 [ 1.41, 0.298 ]
3734 @dots{}
3735 @end group
3736 @end smallexample
3737
3738 @noindent
3739 (You may wish to use @kbd{v .} mode to abbreviate the display of this
3740 large matrix.)
3741
3742 We want to treat this as a pair of lists. The first step is to
3743 transpose this matrix into a pair of rows. Remember, a matrix is
3744 just a vector of vectors. So we can unpack the matrix into a pair
3745 of row vectors on the stack.
3746
3747 @smallexample
3748 @group
3749 1: [ [ 1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3750 [ 0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ] ] 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3751 . .
3752
3753 v t v u
3754 @end group
3755 @end smallexample
3756
3757 @noindent
3758 Let's store these in quick variables 1 and 2, respectively.
3759
3760 @smallexample
3761 @group
3762 1: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] .
3763 .
3764
3765 t 2 t 1
3766 @end group
3767 @end smallexample
3768
3769 @noindent
3770 (Recall that @kbd{t 2} is a variant of @kbd{s 2} that removes the
3771 stored value from the stack.)
3772
3773 In a least squares fit, the slope @expr{m} is given by the formula
3774
3775 @ifnottex
3776 @example
3777 m = (N sum(x y) - sum(x) sum(y)) / (N sum(x^2) - sum(x)^2)
3778 @end example
3779 @end ifnottex
3780 @tex
3781 \turnoffactive
3782 \beforedisplay
3783 $$ m = {N \sum x y - \sum x \sum y \over
3784 N \sum x^2 - \left( \sum x \right)^2} $$
3785 \afterdisplay
3786 @end tex
3787
3788 @noindent
3789 where
3790 @texline @math{\sum x}
3791 @infoline @expr{sum(x)}
3792 represents the sum of all the values of @expr{x}. While there is an
3793 actual @code{sum} function in Calc, it's easier to sum a vector using a
3794 simple reduction. First, let's compute the four different sums that
3795 this formula uses.
3796
3797 @smallexample
3798 @group
3799 1: 41.63 1: 98.0003
3800 . .
3801
3802 r 1 V R + t 3 r 1 2 V M ^ V R + t 4
3803
3804 @end group
3805 @end smallexample
3806 @noindent
3807 @smallexample
3808 @group
3809 1: 13.613 1: 33.36554
3810 . .
3811
3812 r 2 V R + t 5 r 1 r 2 V M * V R + t 6
3813 @end group
3814 @end smallexample
3815
3816 @ifnottex
3817 @noindent
3818 These are @samp{sum(x)}, @samp{sum(x^2)}, @samp{sum(y)}, and @samp{sum(x y)},
3819 respectively. (We could have used @kbd{*} to compute @samp{sum(x^2)} and
3820 @samp{sum(x y)}.)
3821 @end ifnottex
3822 @tex
3823 \turnoffactive
3824 These are $\sum x$, $\sum x^2$, $\sum y$, and $\sum x y$,
3825 respectively. (We could have used \kbd{*} to compute $\sum x^2$ and
3826 $\sum x y$.)
3827 @end tex
3828
3829 Finally, we also need @expr{N}, the number of data points. This is just
3830 the length of either of our lists.
3831
3832 @smallexample
3833 @group
3834 1: 19
3835 .
3836
3837 r 1 v l t 7
3838 @end group
3839 @end smallexample
3840
3841 @noindent
3842 (That's @kbd{v} followed by a lower-case @kbd{l}.)
3843
3844 Now we grind through the formula:
3845
3846 @smallexample
3847 @group
3848 1: 633.94526 2: 633.94526 1: 67.23607
3849 . 1: 566.70919 .
3850 .
3851
3852 r 7 r 6 * r 3 r 5 * -
3853
3854 @end group
3855 @end smallexample
3856 @noindent
3857 @smallexample
3858 @group
3859 2: 67.23607 3: 67.23607 2: 67.23607 1: 0.52141679
3860 1: 1862.0057 2: 1862.0057 1: 128.9488 .
3861 . 1: 1733.0569 .
3862 .
3863
3864 r 7 r 4 * r 3 2 ^ - / t 8
3865 @end group
3866 @end smallexample
3867
3868 That gives us the slope @expr{m}. The y-intercept @expr{b} can now
3869 be found with the simple formula,
3870
3871 @ifnottex
3872 @example
3873 b = (sum(y) - m sum(x)) / N
3874 @end example
3875 @end ifnottex
3876 @tex
3877 \turnoffactive
3878 \beforedisplay
3879 $$ b = {\sum y - m \sum x \over N} $$
3880 \afterdisplay
3881 \vskip10pt
3882 @end tex
3883
3884 @smallexample
3885 @group
3886 1: 13.613 2: 13.613 1: -8.09358 1: -0.425978
3887 . 1: 21.70658 . .
3888 .
3889
3890 r 5 r 8 r 3 * - r 7 / t 9
3891 @end group
3892 @end smallexample
3893
3894 Let's ``plot'' this straight line approximation,
3895 @texline @math{y \approx m x + b},
3896 @infoline @expr{m x + b},
3897 and compare it with the original data.
3898
3899 @smallexample
3900 @group
3901 1: [0.699, 0.735, ... ] 1: [0.273, 0.309, ... ]
3902 . .
3903
3904 r 1 r 8 * r 9 + s 0
3905 @end group
3906 @end smallexample
3907
3908 @noindent
3909 Notice that multiplying a vector by a constant, and adding a constant
3910 to a vector, can be done without mapping commands since these are
3911 common operations from vector algebra. As far as Calc is concerned,
3912 we've just been doing geometry in 19-dimensional space!
3913
3914 We can subtract this vector from our original @expr{y} vector to get
3915 a feel for the error of our fit. Let's find the maximum error:
3916
3917 @smallexample
3918 @group
3919 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: 0.0897
3920 . . .
3921
3922 r 2 - V M A V R X
3923 @end group
3924 @end smallexample
3925
3926 @noindent
3927 First we compute a vector of differences, then we take the absolute
3928 values of these differences, then we reduce the @code{max} function
3929 across the vector. (The @code{max} function is on the two-key sequence
3930 @kbd{f x}; because it is so common to use @code{max} in a vector
3931 operation, the letters @kbd{X} and @kbd{N} are also accepted for
3932 @code{max} and @code{min} in this context. In general, you answer
3933 the @kbd{V M} or @kbd{V R} prompt with the actual key sequence that
3934 invokes the function you want. You could have typed @kbd{V R f x} or
3935 even @kbd{V R x max @key{RET}} if you had preferred.)
3936
3937 If your system has the GNUPLOT program, you can see graphs of your
3938 data and your straight line to see how well they match. (If you have
3939 GNUPLOT 3.0 or higher, the following instructions will work regardless
3940 of the kind of display you have. Some GNUPLOT 2.0, non-X-windows systems
3941 may require additional steps to view the graphs.)
3942
3943 Let's start by plotting the original data. Recall the ``@var{x}'' and ``@var{y}''
3944 vectors onto the stack and press @kbd{g f}. This ``fast'' graphing
3945 command does everything you need to do for simple, straightforward
3946 plotting of data.
3947
3948 @smallexample
3949 @group
3950 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3951 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3952 .
3953
3954 r 1 r 2 g f
3955 @end group
3956 @end smallexample
3957
3958 If all goes well, you will shortly get a new window containing a graph
3959 of the data. (If not, contact your GNUPLOT or Calc installer to find
3960 out what went wrong.) In the X window system, this will be a separate
3961 graphics window. For other kinds of displays, the default is to
3962 display the graph in Emacs itself using rough character graphics.
3963 Press @kbd{q} when you are done viewing the character graphics.
3964
3965 Next, let's add the line we got from our least-squares fit.
3966 @ifinfo
3967 (If you are reading this tutorial on-line while running Calc, typing
3968 @kbd{g a} may cause the tutorial to disappear from its window and be
3969 replaced by a buffer named @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}. The tutorial
3970 will reappear when you terminate GNUPLOT by typing @kbd{g q}.)
3971 @end ifinfo
3972
3973 @smallexample
3974 @group
3975 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3976 1: [0.273, 0.309, 0.351, ... ]
3977 .
3978
3979 @key{DEL} r 0 g a g p
3980 @end group
3981 @end smallexample
3982
3983 It's not very useful to get symbols to mark the data points on this
3984 second curve; you can type @kbd{g S g p} to remove them. Type @kbd{g q}
3985 when you are done to remove the X graphics window and terminate GNUPLOT.
3986
3987 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} An earlier exercise showed how to do
3988 least squares fitting to a general system of equations. Our 19 data
3989 points are really 19 equations of the form @expr{y_i = m x_i + b} for
3990 different pairs of @expr{(x_i,y_i)}. Use the matrix-transpose method
3991 to solve for @expr{m} and @expr{b}, duplicating the above result.
3992 @xref{List Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3993
3994 @cindex Geometric mean
3995 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} If the input data do not form a
3996 rectangle, you can use @w{@kbd{C-x * g}} (@code{calc-grab-region})
3997 to grab the data the way Emacs normally works with regions---it reads
3998 left-to-right, top-to-bottom, treating line breaks the same as spaces.
3999 Use this command to find the geometric mean of the following numbers.
4000 (The geometric mean is the @var{n}th root of the product of @var{n} numbers.)
4001
4002 @example
4003 2.3 6 22 15.1 7
4004 15 14 7.5
4005 2.5
4006 @end example
4007
4008 @noindent
4009 The @kbd{C-x * g} command accepts numbers separated by spaces or commas,
4010 with or without surrounding vector brackets.
4011 @xref{List Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4012
4013 @ifnottex
4014 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4015 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4016 @var{n}-choose-0 minus @var{n}-choose-1 plus @var{n}-choose-2, and so
4017 on up to @var{n}-choose-@var{n},
4018 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4019 for @expr{n=6}.
4020 @end ifnottex
4021 @tex
4022 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4023 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4024 ${n \choose 0} - {n \choose 1} + {n \choose 2} - \cdots \pm {n \choose n}$
4025 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4026 for \cite{n=6}.
4027 @end tex
4028
4029 @smallexample
4030 @group
4031 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7] 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
4032 . .
4033
4034 v x 7 @key{RET} 1 -
4035
4036 @end group
4037 @end smallexample
4038 @noindent
4039 @smallexample
4040 @group
4041 1: [1, -6, 15, -20, 15, -6, 1] 1: 0
4042 . .
4043
4044 V M ' (-1)^$ choose(6,$) @key{RET} V R +
4045 @end group
4046 @end smallexample
4047
4048 The @kbd{V M '} command prompts you to enter any algebraic expression
4049 to define the function to map over the vector. The symbol @samp{$}
4050 inside this expression represents the argument to the function.
4051 The Calculator applies this formula to each element of the vector,
4052 substituting each element's value for the @samp{$} sign(s) in turn.
4053
4054 To define a two-argument function, use @samp{$$} for the first
4055 argument and @samp{$} for the second: @kbd{V M ' $$-$ @key{RET}} is
4056 equivalent to @kbd{V M -}. This is analogous to regular algebraic
4057 entry, where @samp{$$} would refer to the next-to-top stack entry
4058 and @samp{$} would refer to the top stack entry, and @kbd{' $$-$ @key{RET}}
4059 would act exactly like @kbd{-}.
4060
4061 Notice that the @kbd{V M '} command has recorded two things in the
4062 trail: The result, as usual, and also a funny-looking thing marked
4063 @samp{oper} that represents the operator function you typed in.
4064 The function is enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets, and the argument is
4065 denoted by a @samp{#} sign. If there were several arguments, they
4066 would be shown as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on. (For example,
4067 @kbd{V M ' $$-$} will put the function @samp{<#1 - #2>} on the
4068 trail.) This object is a ``nameless function''; you can use nameless
4069 @w{@samp{< >}} notation to answer the @kbd{V M '} prompt if you like.
4070 Nameless function notation has the interesting, occasionally useful
4071 property that a nameless function is not actually evaluated until
4072 it is used. For example, @kbd{V M ' $+random(2.0)} evaluates
4073 @samp{random(2.0)} once and adds that random number to all elements
4074 of the vector, but @kbd{V M ' <#+random(2.0)>} evaluates the
4075 @samp{random(2.0)} separately for each vector element.
4076
4077 Another group of operators that are often useful with @kbd{V M} are
4078 the relational operators: @kbd{a =}, for example, compares two numbers
4079 and gives the result 1 if they are equal, or 0 if not. Similarly,
4080 @w{@kbd{a <}} checks for one number being less than another.
4081
4082 Other useful vector operations include @kbd{v v}, to reverse a
4083 vector end-for-end; @kbd{V S}, to sort the elements of a vector
4084 into increasing order; and @kbd{v r} and @w{@kbd{v c}}, to extract
4085 one row or column of a matrix, or (in both cases) to extract one
4086 element of a plain vector. With a negative argument, @kbd{v r}
4087 and @kbd{v c} instead delete one row, column, or vector element.
4088
4089 @cindex Divisor functions
4090 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The @expr{k}th @dfn{divisor function}
4091 @tex
4092 $\sigma_k(n)$
4093 @end tex
4094 is the sum of the @expr{k}th powers of all the divisors of an
4095 integer @expr{n}. Figure out a method for computing the divisor
4096 function for reasonably small values of @expr{n}. As a test,
4097 the 0th and 1st divisor functions of 30 are 8 and 72, respectively.
4098 @xref{List Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4099
4100 @cindex Square-free numbers
4101 @cindex Duplicate values in a list
4102 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @kbd{k f} command produces a
4103 list of prime factors for a number. Sometimes it is important to
4104 know that a number is @dfn{square-free}, i.e., that no prime occurs
4105 more than once in its list of prime factors. Find a sequence of
4106 keystrokes to tell if a number is square-free; your method should
4107 leave 1 on the stack if it is, or 0 if it isn't.
4108 @xref{List Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4109
4110 @cindex Triangular lists
4111 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Build a list of lists that looks
4112 like the following diagram. (You may wish to use the @kbd{v /}
4113 command to enable multi-line display of vectors.)
4114
4115 @smallexample
4116 @group
4117 1: [ [1],
4118 [1, 2],
4119 [1, 2, 3],
4120 [1, 2, 3, 4],
4121 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5],
4122 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] ]
4123 @end group
4124 @end smallexample
4125
4126 @noindent
4127 @xref{List Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4128
4129 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Build the following list of lists.
4130
4131 @smallexample
4132 @group
4133 1: [ [0],
4134 [1, 2],
4135 [3, 4, 5],
4136 [6, 7, 8, 9],
4137 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
4138 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
4139 @end group
4140 @end smallexample
4141
4142 @noindent
4143 @xref{List Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4144
4145 @cindex Maximizing a function over a list of values
4146 @c [fix-ref Numerical Solutions]
4147 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} Compute a list of values of Bessel's
4148 @texline @math{J_1(x)}
4149 @infoline @expr{J1}
4150 function @samp{besJ(1,x)} for @expr{x} from 0 to 5 in steps of 0.25.
4151 Find the value of @expr{x} (from among the above set of values) for
4152 which @samp{besJ(1,x)} is a maximum. Use an ``automatic'' method,
4153 i.e., just reading along the list by hand to find the largest value
4154 is not allowed! (There is an @kbd{a X} command which does this kind
4155 of thing automatically; @pxref{Numerical Solutions}.)
4156 @xref{List Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4157
4158 @cindex Digits, vectors of
4159 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} You are given an integer in the range
4160 @texline @math{0 \le N < 10^m}
4161 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < 10^m}
4162 for @expr{m=12} (i.e., an integer of less than
4163 twelve digits). Convert this integer into a vector of @expr{m}
4164 digits, each in the range from 0 to 9. In vector-of-digits notation,
4165 add one to this integer to produce a vector of @expr{m+1} digits
4166 (since there could be a carry out of the most significant digit).
4167 Convert this vector back into a regular integer. A good integer
4168 to try is 25129925999. @xref{List Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4169
4170 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Your friend Joe tried to use
4171 @kbd{V R a =} to test if all numbers in a list were equal. What
4172 happened? How would you do this test? @xref{List Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4173
4174 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The area of a circle of radius one
4175 is @cpi{}. The area of the
4176 @texline @math{2\times2}
4177 @infoline 2x2
4178 square that encloses that circle is 4. So if we throw @var{n} darts at
4179 random points in the square, about @cpiover{4} of them will land inside
4180 the circle. This gives us an entertaining way to estimate the value of
4181 @cpi{}. The @w{@kbd{k r}}
4182 command picks a random number between zero and the value on the stack.
4183 We could get a random floating-point number between @mathit{-1} and 1 by typing
4184 @w{@kbd{2.0 k r 1 -}}. Build a vector of 100 random @expr{(x,y)} points in
4185 this square, then use vector mapping and reduction to count how many
4186 points lie inside the unit circle. Hint: Use the @kbd{v b} command.
4187 @xref{List Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4188
4189 @cindex Matchstick problem
4190 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} The @dfn{matchstick problem} provides
4191 another way to calculate @cpi{}. Say you have an infinite field
4192 of vertical lines with a spacing of one inch. Toss a one-inch matchstick
4193 onto the field. The probability that the matchstick will land crossing
4194 a line turns out to be
4195 @texline @math{2/\pi}.
4196 @infoline @expr{2/pi}.
4197 Toss 100 matchsticks to estimate @cpi{}. (If you want still more fun,
4198 the probability that the GCD (@w{@kbd{k g}}) of two large integers is
4199 one turns out to be
4200 @texline @math{6/\pi^2}.
4201 @infoline @expr{6/pi^2}.
4202 That provides yet another way to estimate @cpi{}.)
4203 @xref{List Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4204
4205 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} An algebraic entry of a string in
4206 double-quote marks, @samp{"hello"}, creates a vector of the numerical
4207 (ASCII) codes of the characters (here, @expr{[104, 101, 108, 108, 111]}).
4208 Sometimes it is convenient to compute a @dfn{hash code} of a string,
4209 which is just an integer that represents the value of that string.
4210 Two equal strings have the same hash code; two different strings
4211 @dfn{probably} have different hash codes. (For example, Calc has
4212 over 400 function names, but Emacs can quickly find the definition for
4213 any given name because it has sorted the functions into ``buckets'' by
4214 their hash codes. Sometimes a few names will hash into the same bucket,
4215 but it is easier to search among a few names than among all the names.)
4216 One popular hash function is computed as follows: First set @expr{h = 0}.
4217 Then, for each character from the string in turn, set @expr{h = 3h + c_i}
4218 where @expr{c_i} is the character's ASCII code. If we have 511 buckets,
4219 we then take the hash code modulo 511 to get the bucket number. Develop a
4220 simple command or commands for converting string vectors into hash codes.
4221 The hash code for @samp{"Testing, 1, 2, 3"} is 1960915098, which modulo
4222 511 is 121. @xref{List Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4223
4224 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} The @kbd{H V R} and @kbd{H V U}
4225 commands do nested function evaluations. @kbd{H V U} takes a starting
4226 value and a number of steps @var{n} from the stack; it then applies the
4227 function you give to the starting value 0, 1, 2, up to @var{n} times
4228 and returns a vector of the results. Use this command to create a
4229 ``random walk'' of 50 steps. Start with the two-dimensional point
4230 @expr{(0,0)}; then take one step a random distance between @mathit{-1} and 1
4231 in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}; then take another step, and so on. Use the
4232 @kbd{g f} command to display this random walk. Now modify your random
4233 walk to walk a unit distance, but in a random direction, at each step.
4234 (Hint: The @code{sincos} function returns a vector of the cosine and
4235 sine of an angle.) @xref{List Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4236
4237 @node Types Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Tutorial
4238 @section Types Tutorial
4239
4240 @noindent
4241 Calc understands a variety of data types as well as simple numbers.
4242 In this section, we'll experiment with each of these types in turn.
4243
4244 The numbers we've been using so far have mainly been either @dfn{integers}
4245 or @dfn{floats}. We saw that floats are usually a good approximation to
4246 the mathematical concept of real numbers, but they are only approximations
4247 and are susceptible to roundoff error. Calc also supports @dfn{fractions},
4248 which can exactly represent any rational number.
4249
4250 @smallexample
4251 @group
4252 1: 3628800 2: 3628800 1: 518400:7 1: 518414:7 1: 7:518414
4253 . 1: 49 . . .
4254 .
4255
4256 10 ! 49 @key{RET} : 2 + &
4257 @end group
4258 @end smallexample
4259
4260 @noindent
4261 The @kbd{:} command divides two integers to get a fraction; @kbd{/}
4262 would normally divide integers to get a floating-point result.
4263 Notice we had to type @key{RET} between the @kbd{49} and the @kbd{:}
4264 since the @kbd{:} would otherwise be interpreted as part of a
4265 fraction beginning with 49.
4266
4267 You can convert between floating-point and fractional format using
4268 @kbd{c f} and @kbd{c F}:
4269
4270 @smallexample
4271 @group
4272 1: 1.35027217629e-5 1: 7:518414
4273 . .
4274
4275 c f c F
4276 @end group
4277 @end smallexample
4278
4279 The @kbd{c F} command replaces a floating-point number with the
4280 ``simplest'' fraction whose floating-point representation is the
4281 same, to within the current precision.
4282
4283 @smallexample
4284 @group
4285 1: 3.14159265359 1: 1146408:364913 1: 3.1416 1: 355:113
4286 . . . .
4287
4288 P c F @key{DEL} p 5 @key{RET} P c F
4289 @end group
4290 @end smallexample
4291
4292 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} A calculation has produced the
4293 result 1.26508260337. You suspect it is the square root of the
4294 product of @cpi{} and some rational number. Is it? (Be sure
4295 to allow for roundoff error!) @xref{Types Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4296
4297 @dfn{Complex numbers} can be stored in both rectangular and polar form.
4298
4299 @smallexample
4300 @group
4301 1: -9 1: (0, 3) 1: (3; 90.) 1: (6; 90.) 1: (2.4495; 45.)
4302 . . . . .
4303
4304 9 n Q c p 2 * Q
4305 @end group
4306 @end smallexample
4307
4308 @noindent
4309 The square root of @mathit{-9} is by default rendered in rectangular form
4310 (@w{@expr{0 + 3i}}), but we can convert it to polar form (3 with a
4311 phase angle of 90 degrees). All the usual arithmetic and scientific
4312 operations are defined on both types of complex numbers.
4313
4314 Another generalized kind of number is @dfn{infinity}. Infinity
4315 isn't really a number, but it can sometimes be treated like one.
4316 Calc uses the symbol @code{inf} to represent positive infinity,
4317 i.e., a value greater than any real number. Naturally, you can
4318 also write @samp{-inf} for minus infinity, a value less than any
4319 real number. The word @code{inf} can only be input using
4320 algebraic entry.
4321
4322 @smallexample
4323 @group
4324 2: inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 1: nan
4325 1: -17 1: -inf 1: -inf 1: inf .
4326 . . . .
4327
4328 ' inf @key{RET} 17 n * @key{RET} 72 + A +
4329 @end group
4330 @end smallexample
4331
4332 @noindent
4333 Since infinity is infinitely large, multiplying it by any finite
4334 number (like @mathit{-17}) has no effect, except that since @mathit{-17}
4335 is negative, it changes a plus infinity to a minus infinity.
4336 (``A huge positive number, multiplied by @mathit{-17}, yields a huge
4337 negative number.'') Adding any finite number to infinity also
4338 leaves it unchanged. Taking an absolute value gives us plus
4339 infinity again. Finally, we add this plus infinity to the minus
4340 infinity we had earlier. If you work it out, you might expect
4341 the answer to be @mathit{-72} for this. But the 72 has been completely
4342 lost next to the infinities; by the time we compute @w{@samp{inf - inf}}
4343 the finite difference between them, if any, is undetectable.
4344 So we say the result is @dfn{indeterminate}, which Calc writes
4345 with the symbol @code{nan} (for Not A Number).
4346
4347 Dividing by zero is normally treated as an error, but you can get
4348 Calc to write an answer in terms of infinity by pressing @kbd{m i}
4349 to turn on Infinite mode.
4350
4351 @smallexample
4352 @group
4353 3: nan 2: nan 2: nan 2: nan 1: nan
4354 2: 1 1: 1 / 0 1: uinf 1: uinf .
4355 1: 0 . . .
4356 .
4357
4358 1 @key{RET} 0 / m i U / 17 n * +
4359 @end group
4360 @end smallexample
4361
4362 @noindent
4363 Dividing by zero normally is left unevaluated, but after @kbd{m i}
4364 it instead gives an infinite result. The answer is actually
4365 @code{uinf}, ``undirected infinity.'' If you look at a graph of
4366 @expr{1 / x} around @w{@expr{x = 0}}, you'll see that it goes toward
4367 plus infinity as you approach zero from above, but toward minus
4368 infinity as you approach from below. Since we said only @expr{1 / 0},
4369 Calc knows that the answer is infinite but not in which direction.
4370 That's what @code{uinf} means. Notice that multiplying @code{uinf}
4371 by a negative number still leaves plain @code{uinf}; there's no
4372 point in saying @samp{-uinf} because the sign of @code{uinf} is
4373 unknown anyway. Finally, we add @code{uinf} to our @code{nan},
4374 yielding @code{nan} again. It's easy to see that, because
4375 @code{nan} means ``totally unknown'' while @code{uinf} means
4376 ``unknown sign but known to be infinite,'' the more mysterious
4377 @code{nan} wins out when it is combined with @code{uinf}, or, for
4378 that matter, with anything else.
4379
4380 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Predict what Calc will answer
4381 for each of these formulas: @samp{inf / inf}, @samp{exp(inf)},
4382 @samp{exp(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(uinf)},
4383 @samp{abs(uinf)}, @samp{ln(0)}.
4384 @xref{Types Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4385
4386 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} We saw that @samp{inf - inf = nan},
4387 which stands for an unknown value. Can @code{nan} stand for
4388 a complex number? Can it stand for infinity?
4389 @xref{Types Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4390
4391 @dfn{HMS forms} represent a value in terms of hours, minutes, and
4392 seconds.
4393
4394 @smallexample
4395 @group
4396 1: 2@@ 30' 0" 1: 3@@ 30' 0" 2: 3@@ 30' 0" 1: 2.
4397 . . 1: 1@@ 45' 0." .
4398 .
4399
4400 2@@ 30' @key{RET} 1 + @key{RET} 2 / /
4401 @end group
4402 @end smallexample
4403
4404 HMS forms can also be used to hold angles in degrees, minutes, and
4405 seconds.
4406
4407 @smallexample
4408 @group
4409 1: 0.5 1: 26.56505 1: 26@@ 33' 54.18" 1: 0.44721
4410 . . . .
4411
4412 0.5 I T c h S
4413 @end group
4414 @end smallexample
4415
4416 @noindent
4417 First we convert the inverse tangent of 0.5 to degrees-minutes-seconds
4418 form, then we take the sine of that angle. Note that the trigonometric
4419 functions will accept HMS forms directly as input.
4420
4421 @cindex Beatles
4422 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The Beatles' @emph{Abbey Road} is
4423 47 minutes and 26 seconds long, and contains 17 songs. What is the
4424 average length of a song on @emph{Abbey Road}? If the Extended Disco
4425 Version of @emph{Abbey Road} added 20 seconds to the length of each
4426 song, how long would the album be? @xref{Types Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4427
4428 A @dfn{date form} represents a date, or a date and time. Dates must
4429 be entered using algebraic entry. Date forms are surrounded by
4430 @samp{< >} symbols; most standard formats for dates are recognized.
4431
4432 @smallexample
4433 @group
4434 2: <Sun Jan 13, 1991> 1: 2.25
4435 1: <6:00pm Thu Jan 10, 1991> .
4436 .
4437
4438 ' <13 Jan 1991>, <1/10/91, 6pm> @key{RET} -
4439 @end group
4440 @end smallexample
4441
4442 @noindent
4443 In this example, we enter two dates, then subtract to find the
4444 number of days between them. It is also possible to add an
4445 HMS form or a number (of days) to a date form to get another
4446 date form.
4447
4448 @smallexample
4449 @group
4450 1: <4:45:59pm Mon Jan 14, 1991> 1: <2:50:59am Thu Jan 17, 1991>
4451 . .
4452
4453 t N 2 + 10@@ 5' +
4454 @end group
4455 @end smallexample
4456
4457 @c [fix-ref Date Arithmetic]
4458 @noindent
4459 The @kbd{t N} (``now'') command pushes the current date and time on the
4460 stack; then we add two days, ten hours and five minutes to the date and
4461 time. Other date-and-time related commands include @kbd{t J}, which
4462 does Julian day conversions, @kbd{t W}, which finds the beginning of
4463 the week in which a date form lies, and @kbd{t I}, which increments a
4464 date by one or several months. @xref{Date Arithmetic}, for more.
4465
4466 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} How many days until the next
4467 Friday the 13th? @xref{Types Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4468
4469 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} How many leap years will there be
4470 between now and the year 10001 A.D.? @xref{Types Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4471
4472 @cindex Slope and angle of a line
4473 @cindex Angle and slope of a line
4474 An @dfn{error form} represents a mean value with an attached standard
4475 deviation, or error estimate. Suppose our measurements indicate that
4476 a certain telephone pole is about 30 meters away, with an estimated
4477 error of 1 meter, and 8 meters tall, with an estimated error of 0.2
4478 meters. What is the slope of a line from here to the top of the
4479 pole, and what is the equivalent angle in degrees?
4480
4481 @smallexample
4482 @group
4483 1: 8 +/- 0.2 2: 8 +/- 0.2 1: 0.266 +/- 0.011 1: 14.93 +/- 0.594
4484 . 1: 30 +/- 1 . .
4485 .
4486
4487 8 p .2 @key{RET} 30 p 1 / I T
4488 @end group
4489 @end smallexample
4490
4491 @noindent
4492 This means that the angle is about 15 degrees, and, assuming our
4493 original error estimates were valid standard deviations, there is about
4494 a 60% chance that the result is correct within 0.59 degrees.
4495
4496 @cindex Torus, volume of
4497 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} The volume of a torus (a donut shape) is
4498 @texline @math{2 \pi^2 R r^2}
4499 @infoline @w{@expr{2 pi^2 R r^2}}
4500 where @expr{R} is the radius of the circle that
4501 defines the center of the tube and @expr{r} is the radius of the tube
4502 itself. Suppose @expr{R} is 20 cm and @expr{r} is 4 cm, each known to
4503 within 5 percent. What is the volume and the relative uncertainty of
4504 the volume? @xref{Types Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4505
4506 An @dfn{interval form} represents a range of values. While an
4507 error form is best for making statistical estimates, intervals give
4508 you exact bounds on an answer. Suppose we additionally know that
4509 our telephone pole is definitely between 28 and 31 meters away,
4510 and that it is between 7.7 and 8.1 meters tall.
4511
4512 @smallexample
4513 @group
4514 1: [7.7 .. 8.1] 2: [7.7 .. 8.1] 1: [0.24 .. 0.28] 1: [13.9 .. 16.1]
4515 . 1: [28 .. 31] . .
4516 .
4517
4518 [ 7.7 .. 8.1 ] [ 28 .. 31 ] / I T
4519 @end group
4520 @end smallexample
4521
4522 @noindent
4523 If our bounds were correct, then the angle to the top of the pole
4524 is sure to lie in the range shown.
4525
4526 The square brackets around these intervals indicate that the endpoints
4527 themselves are allowable values. In other words, the distance to the
4528 telephone pole is between 28 and 31, @emph{inclusive}. You can also
4529 make an interval that is exclusive of its endpoints by writing
4530 parentheses instead of square brackets. You can even make an interval
4531 which is inclusive (``closed'') on one end and exclusive (``open'') on
4532 the other.
4533
4534 @smallexample
4535 @group
4536 1: [1 .. 10) 1: (0.1 .. 1] 2: (0.1 .. 1] 1: (0.2 .. 3)
4537 . . 1: [2 .. 3) .
4538 .
4539
4540 [ 1 .. 10 ) & [ 2 .. 3 ) *
4541 @end group
4542 @end smallexample
4543
4544 @noindent
4545 The Calculator automatically keeps track of which end values should
4546 be open and which should be closed. You can also make infinite or
4547 semi-infinite intervals by using @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} for one
4548 or both endpoints.
4549
4550 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} What answer would you expect from
4551 @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(0 .. 10)}}? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 0)}}? What
4552 about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{[0 .. 10]}} (where the interval actually includes
4553 zero)? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 10)}}?
4554 @xref{Types Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4555
4556 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} Two easy ways of squaring a number
4557 are @kbd{@key{RET} *} and @w{@kbd{2 ^}}. Normally these produce the same
4558 answer. Would you expect this still to hold true for interval forms?
4559 If not, which of these will result in a larger interval?
4560 @xref{Types Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4561
4562 A @dfn{modulo form} is used for performing arithmetic modulo @var{m}.
4563 For example, arithmetic involving time is generally done modulo 12
4564 or 24 hours.
4565
4566 @smallexample
4567 @group
4568 1: 17 mod 24 1: 3 mod 24 1: 21 mod 24 1: 9 mod 24
4569 . . . .
4570
4571 17 M 24 @key{RET} 10 + n 5 /
4572 @end group
4573 @end smallexample
4574
4575 @noindent
4576 In this last step, Calc has divided by 5 modulo 24; i.e., it has found a
4577 new number which, when multiplied by 5 modulo 24, produces the original
4578 number, 21. If @var{m} is prime and the divisor is not a multiple of
4579 @var{m}, it is always possible to find such a number. For non-prime
4580 @var{m} like 24, it is only sometimes possible.
4581
4582 @smallexample
4583 @group
4584 1: 10 mod 24 1: 16 mod 24 1: 1000000... 1: 16
4585 . . . .
4586
4587 10 M 24 @key{RET} 100 ^ 10 @key{RET} 100 ^ 24 %
4588 @end group
4589 @end smallexample
4590
4591 @noindent
4592 These two calculations get the same answer, but the first one is
4593 much more efficient because it avoids the huge intermediate value
4594 that arises in the second one.
4595
4596 @cindex Fermat, primality test of
4597 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} A theorem of Pierre de Fermat
4598 says that
4599 @texline @w{@math{x^{n-1} \bmod n = 1}}
4600 @infoline @expr{x^(n-1) mod n = 1}
4601 if @expr{n} is a prime number and @expr{x} is an integer less than
4602 @expr{n}. If @expr{n} is @emph{not} a prime number, this will
4603 @emph{not} be true for most values of @expr{x}. Thus we can test
4604 informally if a number is prime by trying this formula for several
4605 values of @expr{x}. Use this test to tell whether the following numbers
4606 are prime: 811749613, 15485863. @xref{Types Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4607
4608 It is possible to use HMS forms as parts of error forms, intervals,
4609 modulo forms, or as the phase part of a polar complex number.
4610 For example, the @code{calc-time} command pushes the current time
4611 of day on the stack as an HMS/modulo form.
4612
4613 @smallexample
4614 @group
4615 1: 17@@ 34' 45" mod 24@@ 0' 0" 1: 6@@ 22' 15" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
4616 . .
4617
4618 x time @key{RET} n
4619 @end group
4620 @end smallexample
4621
4622 @noindent
4623 This calculation tells me it is six hours and 22 minutes until midnight.
4624
4625 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} A rule of thumb is that one year
4626 is about
4627 @texline @math{\pi \times 10^7}
4628 @infoline @w{@expr{pi * 10^7}}
4629 seconds. What time will it be that many seconds from right now?
4630 @xref{Types Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4631
4632 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} You are preparing to order packaging
4633 for the CD release of the Extended Disco Version of @emph{Abbey Road}.
4634 You are told that the songs will actually be anywhere from 20 to 60
4635 seconds longer than the originals. One CD can hold about 75 minutes
4636 of music. Should you order single or double packages?
4637 @xref{Types Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4638
4639 Another kind of data the Calculator can manipulate is numbers with
4640 @dfn{units}. This isn't strictly a new data type; it's simply an
4641 application of algebraic expressions, where we use variables with
4642 suggestive names like @samp{cm} and @samp{in} to represent units
4643 like centimeters and inches.
4644
4645 @smallexample
4646 @group
4647 1: 2 in 1: 5.08 cm 1: 0.027778 fath 1: 0.0508 m
4648 . . . .
4649
4650 ' 2in @key{RET} u c cm @key{RET} u c fath @key{RET} u b
4651 @end group
4652 @end smallexample
4653
4654 @noindent
4655 We enter the quantity ``2 inches'' (actually an algebraic expression
4656 which means two times the variable @samp{in}), then we convert it
4657 first to centimeters, then to fathoms, then finally to ``base'' units,
4658 which in this case means meters.
4659
4660 @smallexample
4661 @group
4662 1: 9 acre 1: 3 sqrt(acre) 1: 190.84 m 1: 190.84 m + 30 cm
4663 . . . .
4664
4665 ' 9 acre @key{RET} Q u s ' $+30 cm @key{RET}
4666
4667 @end group
4668 @end smallexample
4669 @noindent
4670 @smallexample
4671 @group
4672 1: 191.14 m 1: 36536.3046 m^2 1: 365363046 cm^2
4673 . . .
4674
4675 u s 2 ^ u c cgs
4676 @end group
4677 @end smallexample
4678
4679 @noindent
4680 Since units expressions are really just formulas, taking the square
4681 root of @samp{acre} is undefined. After all, @code{acre} might be an
4682 algebraic variable that you will someday assign a value. We use the
4683 ``units-simplify'' command to simplify the expression with variables
4684 being interpreted as unit names.
4685
4686 In the final step, we have converted not to a particular unit, but to a
4687 units system. The ``cgs'' system uses centimeters instead of meters
4688 as its standard unit of length.
4689
4690 There is a wide variety of units defined in the Calculator.
4691
4692 @smallexample
4693 @group
4694 1: 55 mph 1: 88.5139 kph 1: 88.5139 km / hr 1: 8.201407e-8 c
4695 . . . .
4696
4697 ' 55 mph @key{RET} u c kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} u c c @key{RET}
4698 @end group
4699 @end smallexample
4700
4701 @noindent
4702 We express a speed first in miles per hour, then in kilometers per
4703 hour, then again using a slightly more explicit notation, then
4704 finally in terms of fractions of the speed of light.
4705
4706 Temperature conversions are a bit more tricky. There are two ways to
4707 interpret ``20 degrees Fahrenheit''---it could mean an actual
4708 temperature, or it could mean a change in temperature. For normal
4709 units there is no difference, but temperature units have an offset
4710 as well as a scale factor and so there must be two explicit commands
4711 for them.
4712
4713 @smallexample
4714 @group
4715 1: 20 degF 1: 11.1111 degC 1: -20:3 degC 1: -6.666 degC
4716 . . . .
4717
4718 ' 20 degF @key{RET} u c degC @key{RET} U u t degC @key{RET} c f
4719 @end group
4720 @end smallexample
4721
4722 @noindent
4723 First we convert a change of 20 degrees Fahrenheit into an equivalent
4724 change in degrees Celsius (or Centigrade). Then, we convert the
4725 absolute temperature 20 degrees Fahrenheit into Celsius. Since
4726 this comes out as an exact fraction, we then convert to floating-point
4727 for easier comparison with the other result.
4728
4729 For simple unit conversions, you can put a plain number on the stack.
4730 Then @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u t} will prompt for both old and new units.
4731 When you use this method, you're responsible for remembering which
4732 numbers are in which units:
4733
4734 @smallexample
4735 @group
4736 1: 55 1: 88.5139 1: 8.201407e-8
4737 . . .
4738
4739 55 u c mph @key{RET} kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} c @key{RET}
4740 @end group
4741 @end smallexample
4742
4743 To see a complete list of built-in units, type @kbd{u v}. Press
4744 @w{@kbd{C-x * c}} again to re-enter the Calculator when you're done looking
4745 at the units table.
4746
4747 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} How many seconds are there really
4748 in a year? @xref{Types Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4749
4750 @cindex Speed of light
4751 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} Supercomputer designs are limited by
4752 the speed of light (and of electricity, which is nearly as fast).
4753 Suppose a computer has a 4.1 ns (nanosecond) clock cycle, and its
4754 cabinet is one meter across. Is speed of light going to be a
4755 significant factor in its design? @xref{Types Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4756
4757 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 15.} Sam the Slug normally travels about
4758 five yards in an hour. He has obtained a supply of Power Pills; each
4759 Power Pill he eats doubles his speed. How many Power Pills can he
4760 swallow and still travel legally on most US highways?
4761 @xref{Types Answer 15, 15}. (@bullet{})
4762
4763 @node Algebra Tutorial, Programming Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Tutorial
4764 @section Algebra and Calculus Tutorial
4765
4766 @noindent
4767 This section shows how to use Calc's algebra facilities to solve
4768 equations, do simple calculus problems, and manipulate algebraic
4769 formulas.
4770
4771 @menu
4772 * Basic Algebra Tutorial::
4773 * Rewrites Tutorial::
4774 @end menu
4775
4776 @node Basic Algebra Tutorial, Rewrites Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
4777 @subsection Basic Algebra
4778
4779 @noindent
4780 If you enter a formula in Algebraic mode that refers to variables,
4781 the formula itself is pushed onto the stack. You can manipulate
4782 formulas as regular data objects.
4783
4784 @smallexample
4785 @group
4786 1: 2 x^2 - 6 1: 6 - 2 x^2 1: (6 - 2 x^2) (3 x^2 + y)
4787 . . .
4788
4789 ' 2x^2-6 @key{RET} n ' 3x^2+y @key{RET} *
4790 @end group
4791 @end smallexample
4792
4793 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Do @kbd{' x @key{RET} Q 2 ^} and
4794 @kbd{' x @key{RET} 2 ^ Q} both wind up with the same result (@samp{x})?
4795 Why or why not? @xref{Algebra Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4796
4797 There are also commands for doing common algebraic operations on
4798 formulas. Continuing with the formula from the last example,
4799
4800 @smallexample
4801 @group
4802 1: 18 x^2 + 6 y - 6 x^4 - 2 x^2 y 1: (18 - 2 y) x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y
4803 . .
4804
4805 a x a c x @key{RET}
4806 @end group
4807 @end smallexample
4808
4809 @noindent
4810 First we ``expand'' using the distributive law, then we ``collect''
4811 terms involving like powers of @expr{x}.
4812
4813 Let's find the value of this expression when @expr{x} is 2 and @expr{y}
4814 is one-half.
4815
4816 @smallexample
4817 @group
4818 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: -25
4819 . .
4820
4821 1:2 s l y @key{RET} 2 s l x @key{RET}
4822 @end group
4823 @end smallexample
4824
4825 @noindent
4826 The @kbd{s l} command means ``let''; it takes a number from the top of
4827 the stack and temporarily assigns it as the value of the variable
4828 you specify. It then evaluates (as if by the @kbd{=} key) the
4829 next expression on the stack. After this command, the variable goes
4830 back to its original value, if any.
4831
4832 (An earlier exercise in this tutorial involved storing a value in the
4833 variable @code{x}; if this value is still there, you will have to
4834 unstore it with @kbd{s u x @key{RET}} before the above example will work
4835 properly.)
4836
4837 @cindex Maximum of a function using Calculus
4838 Let's find the maximum value of our original expression when @expr{y}
4839 is one-half and @expr{x} ranges over all possible values. We can
4840 do this by taking the derivative with respect to @expr{x} and examining
4841 values of @expr{x} for which the derivative is zero. If the second
4842 derivative of the function at that value of @expr{x} is negative,
4843 the function has a local maximum there.
4844
4845 @smallexample
4846 @group
4847 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
4848 . .
4849
4850 U @key{DEL} s 1 a d x @key{RET} s 2
4851 @end group
4852 @end smallexample
4853
4854 @noindent
4855 Well, the derivative is clearly zero when @expr{x} is zero. To find
4856 the other root(s), let's divide through by @expr{x} and then solve:
4857
4858 @smallexample
4859 @group
4860 1: (34 x - 24 x^3) / x 1: 34 x / x - 24 x^3 / x 1: 34 - 24 x^2
4861 . . .
4862
4863 ' x @key{RET} / a x a s
4864
4865 @end group
4866 @end smallexample
4867 @noindent
4868 @smallexample
4869 @group
4870 1: 34 - 24 x^2 = 0 1: x = 1.19023
4871 . .
4872
4873 0 a = s 3 a S x @key{RET}
4874 @end group
4875 @end smallexample
4876
4877 @noindent
4878 Notice the use of @kbd{a s} to ``simplify'' the formula. When the
4879 default algebraic simplifications don't do enough, you can use
4880 @kbd{a s} to tell Calc to spend more time on the job.
4881
4882 Now we compute the second derivative and plug in our values of @expr{x}:
4883
4884 @smallexample
4885 @group
4886 1: 1.19023 2: 1.19023 2: 1.19023
4887 . 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: 34 - 72 x^2
4888 . .
4889
4890 a . r 2 a d x @key{RET} s 4
4891 @end group
4892 @end smallexample
4893
4894 @noindent
4895 (The @kbd{a .} command extracts just the righthand side of an equation.
4896 Another method would have been to use @kbd{v u} to unpack the equation
4897 @w{@samp{x = 1.19}} to @samp{x} and @samp{1.19}, then use @kbd{M-- M-2 @key{DEL}}
4898 to delete the @samp{x}.)
4899
4900 @smallexample
4901 @group
4902 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: -68. 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: 34
4903 1: 1.19023 . 1: 0 .
4904 . .
4905
4906 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET} U @key{DEL} 0 s l x @key{RET}
4907 @end group
4908 @end smallexample
4909
4910 @noindent
4911 The first of these second derivatives is negative, so we know the function
4912 has a maximum value at @expr{x = 1.19023}. (The function also has a
4913 local @emph{minimum} at @expr{x = 0}.)
4914
4915 When we solved for @expr{x}, we got only one value even though
4916 @expr{34 - 24 x^2 = 0} is a quadratic equation that ought to have
4917 two solutions. The reason is that @w{@kbd{a S}} normally returns a
4918 single ``principal'' solution. If it needs to come up with an
4919 arbitrary sign (as occurs in the quadratic formula) it picks @expr{+}.
4920 If it needs an arbitrary integer, it picks zero. We can get a full
4921 solution by pressing @kbd{H} (the Hyperbolic flag) before @kbd{a S}.
4922
4923 @smallexample
4924 @group
4925 1: 34 - 24 x^2 = 0 1: x = 1.19023 s1 1: x = -1.19023
4926 . . .
4927
4928 r 3 H a S x @key{RET} s 5 1 n s l s1 @key{RET}
4929 @end group
4930 @end smallexample
4931
4932 @noindent
4933 Calc has invented the variable @samp{s1} to represent an unknown sign;
4934 it is supposed to be either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}. Here we have used
4935 the ``let'' command to evaluate the expression when the sign is negative.
4936 If we plugged this into our second derivative we would get the same,
4937 negative, answer, so @expr{x = -1.19023} is also a maximum.
4938
4939 To find the actual maximum value, we must plug our two values of @expr{x}
4940 into the original formula.
4941
4942 @smallexample
4943 @group
4944 2: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 24.08333 s1^2 - 12.04166 s1^4 + 3
4945 1: x = 1.19023 s1 .
4946 .
4947
4948 r 1 r 5 s l @key{RET}
4949 @end group
4950 @end smallexample
4951
4952 @noindent
4953 (Here we see another way to use @kbd{s l}; if its input is an equation
4954 with a variable on the lefthand side, then @kbd{s l} treats the equation
4955 like an assignment to that variable if you don't give a variable name.)
4956
4957 It's clear that this will have the same value for either sign of
4958 @code{s1}, but let's work it out anyway, just for the exercise:
4959
4960 @smallexample
4961 @group
4962 2: [-1, 1] 1: [15.04166, 15.04166]
4963 1: 24.08333 s1^2 ... .
4964 .
4965
4966 [ 1 n , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
4967 @end group
4968 @end smallexample
4969
4970 @noindent
4971 Here we have used a vector mapping operation to evaluate the function
4972 at several values of @samp{s1} at once. @kbd{V M $} is like @kbd{V M '}
4973 except that it takes the formula from the top of the stack. The
4974 formula is interpreted as a function to apply across the vector at the
4975 next-to-top stack level. Since a formula on the stack can't contain
4976 @samp{$} signs, Calc assumes the variables in the formula stand for
4977 different arguments. It prompts you for an @dfn{argument list}, giving
4978 the list of all variables in the formula in alphabetical order as the
4979 default list. In this case the default is @samp{(s1)}, which is just
4980 what we want so we simply press @key{RET} at the prompt.
4981
4982 If there had been several different values, we could have used
4983 @w{@kbd{V R X}} to find the global maximum.
4984
4985 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a P} command that solves an equation using
4986 @w{@kbd{H a S}} and returns a vector of all the solutions. It simply
4987 automates the job we just did by hand. Applied to our original
4988 cubic polynomial, it would produce the vector of solutions
4989 @expr{[1.19023, -1.19023, 0]}. (There is also an @kbd{a X} command
4990 which finds a local maximum of a function. It uses a numerical search
4991 method rather than examining the derivatives, and thus requires you
4992 to provide some kind of initial guess to show it where to look.)
4993
4994 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Given a vector of the roots of a
4995 polynomial (such as the output of an @kbd{a P} command), what
4996 sequence of commands would you use to reconstruct the original
4997 polynomial? (The answer will be unique to within a constant
4998 multiple; choose the solution where the leading coefficient is one.)
4999 @xref{Algebra Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5000
5001 The @kbd{m s} command enables Symbolic mode, in which formulas
5002 like @samp{sqrt(5)} that can't be evaluated exactly are left in
5003 symbolic form rather than giving a floating-point approximate answer.
5004 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}) is also useful when doing algebra.
5005
5006 @smallexample
5007 @group
5008 2: 34 x - 24 x^3 2: 34 x - 24 x^3
5009 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0]
5010 . .
5011
5012 r 2 @key{RET} m s m f a P x @key{RET}
5013 @end group
5014 @end smallexample
5015
5016 One more mode that makes reading formulas easier is Big mode.
5017
5018 @smallexample
5019 @group
5020 3
5021 2: 34 x - 24 x
5022
5023 ____ ____
5024 V 51 V 51
5025 1: [-----, -----, 0]
5026 6 -6
5027
5028 .
5029
5030 d B
5031 @end group
5032 @end smallexample
5033
5034 Here things like powers, square roots, and quotients and fractions
5035 are displayed in a two-dimensional pictorial form. Calc has other
5036 language modes as well, such as C mode, FORTRAN mode, @TeX{} mode
5037 and La@TeX{} mode.
5038
5039 @smallexample
5040 @group
5041 2: 34*x - 24*pow(x, 3) 2: 34*x - 24*x**3
5042 1: @{sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0@} 1: /sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0/
5043 . .
5044
5045 d C d F
5046
5047 @end group
5048 @end smallexample
5049 @noindent
5050 @smallexample
5051 @group
5052 3: 34 x - 24 x^3
5053 2: [@{\sqrt@{51@} \over 6@}, @{\sqrt@{51@} \over -6@}, 0]
5054 1: @{2 \over 3@} \sqrt@{5@}
5055 .
5056
5057 d T ' 2 \sqrt@{5@} \over 3 @key{RET}
5058 @end group
5059 @end smallexample
5060
5061 @noindent
5062 As you can see, language modes affect both entry and display of
5063 formulas. They affect such things as the names used for built-in
5064 functions, the set of arithmetic operators and their precedences,
5065 and notations for vectors and matrices.
5066
5067 Notice that @samp{sqrt(51)} may cause problems with older
5068 implementations of C and FORTRAN, which would require something more
5069 like @samp{sqrt(51.0)}. It is always wise to check over the formulas
5070 produced by the various language modes to make sure they are fully
5071 correct.
5072
5073 Type @kbd{m s}, @kbd{m f}, and @kbd{d N} to reset these modes. (You
5074 may prefer to remain in Big mode, but all the examples in the tutorial
5075 are shown in normal mode.)
5076
5077 @cindex Area under a curve
5078 What is the area under the portion of this curve from @expr{x = 1} to @expr{2}?
5079 This is simply the integral of the function:
5080
5081 @smallexample
5082 @group
5083 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 5.6666 x^3 - 1.2 x^5 + 3 x
5084 . .
5085
5086 r 1 a i x
5087 @end group
5088 @end smallexample
5089
5090 @noindent
5091 We want to evaluate this at our two values for @expr{x} and subtract.
5092 One way to do it is again with vector mapping and reduction:
5093
5094 @smallexample
5095 @group
5096 2: [2, 1] 1: [12.93333, 7.46666] 1: 5.46666
5097 1: 5.6666 x^3 ... . .
5098
5099 [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5100 @end group
5101 @end smallexample
5102
5103 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Find the integral from 1 to @expr{y}
5104 of
5105 @texline @math{x \sin \pi x}
5106 @infoline @w{@expr{x sin(pi x)}}
5107 (where the sine is calculated in radians). Find the values of the
5108 integral for integers @expr{y} from 1 to 5. @xref{Algebra Answer 3,
5109 3}. (@bullet{})
5110
5111 Calc's integrator can do many simple integrals symbolically, but many
5112 others are beyond its capabilities. Suppose we wish to find the area
5113 under the curve
5114 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5115 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5116 over the same range of @expr{x}. If you entered this formula and typed
5117 @kbd{a i x @key{RET}} (don't bother to try this), Calc would work for a
5118 long time but would be unable to find a solution. In fact, there is no
5119 closed-form solution to this integral. Now what do we do?
5120
5121 @cindex Integration, numerical
5122 @cindex Numerical integration
5123 One approach would be to do the integral numerically. It is not hard
5124 to do this by hand using vector mapping and reduction. It is rather
5125 slow, though, since the sine and logarithm functions take a long time.
5126 We can save some time by reducing the working precision.
5127
5128 @smallexample
5129 @group
5130 3: 10 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9]
5131 2: 1 .
5132 1: 0.1
5133 .
5134
5135 10 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
5136 @end group
5137 @end smallexample
5138
5139 @noindent
5140 (Note that we have used the extended version of @kbd{v x}; we could
5141 also have used plain @kbd{v x} as follows: @kbd{v x 10 @key{RET} 9 + .1 *}.)
5142
5143 @smallexample
5144 @group
5145 2: [1, 1.1, ... ] 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
5146 1: sin(x) ln(x) .
5147 .
5148
5149 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} s 1 m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
5150
5151 @end group
5152 @end smallexample
5153 @noindent
5154 @smallexample
5155 @group
5156 1: 3.4195 0.34195
5157 . .
5158
5159 V R + 0.1 *
5160 @end group
5161 @end smallexample
5162
5163 @noindent
5164 (If you got wildly different results, did you remember to switch
5165 to Radians mode?)
5166
5167 Here we have divided the curve into ten segments of equal width;
5168 approximating these segments as rectangular boxes (i.e., assuming
5169 the curve is nearly flat at that resolution), we compute the areas
5170 of the boxes (height times width), then sum the areas. (It is
5171 faster to sum first, then multiply by the width, since the width
5172 is the same for every box.)
5173
5174 The true value of this integral turns out to be about 0.374, so
5175 we're not doing too well. Let's try another approach.
5176
5177 @smallexample
5178 @group
5179 1: sin(x) ln(x) 1: 0.84147 x - 0.84147 + 0.11957 (x - 1)^2 - ...
5180 . .
5181
5182 r 1 a t x=1 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET}
5183 @end group
5184 @end smallexample
5185
5186 @noindent
5187 Here we have computed the Taylor series expansion of the function
5188 about the point @expr{x=1}. We can now integrate this polynomial
5189 approximation, since polynomials are easy to integrate.
5190
5191 @smallexample
5192 @group
5193 1: 0.42074 x^2 + ... 1: [-0.0446, -0.42073] 1: 0.3761
5194 . . .
5195
5196 a i x @key{RET} [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5197 @end group
5198 @end smallexample
5199
5200 @noindent
5201 Better! By increasing the precision and/or asking for more terms
5202 in the Taylor series, we can get a result as accurate as we like.
5203 (Taylor series converge better away from singularities in the
5204 function such as the one at @code{ln(0)}, so it would also help to
5205 expand the series about the points @expr{x=2} or @expr{x=1.5} instead
5206 of @expr{x=1}.)
5207
5208 @cindex Simpson's rule
5209 @cindex Integration by Simpson's rule
5210 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Our first method approximated the
5211 curve by stairsteps of width 0.1; the total area was then the sum
5212 of the areas of the rectangles under these stairsteps. Our second
5213 method approximated the function by a polynomial, which turned out
5214 to be a better approximation than stairsteps. A third method is
5215 @dfn{Simpson's rule}, which is like the stairstep method except
5216 that the steps are not required to be flat. Simpson's rule boils
5217 down to the formula,
5218
5219 @ifnottex
5220 @example
5221 (h/3) * (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + ...
5222 + 2 f(a+(n-2)*h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)*h) + f(a+n*h))
5223 @end example
5224 @end ifnottex
5225 @tex
5226 \turnoffactive
5227 \beforedisplay
5228 $$ \displaylines{
5229 \qquad {h \over 3} (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + \cdots
5230 \hfill \cr \hfill {} + 2 f(a+(n-2)h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)h) + f(a+n h)) \qquad
5231 } $$
5232 \afterdisplay
5233 @end tex
5234
5235 @noindent
5236 where @expr{n} (which must be even) is the number of slices and @expr{h}
5237 is the width of each slice. These are 10 and 0.1 in our example.
5238 For reference, here is the corresponding formula for the stairstep
5239 method:
5240
5241 @ifnottex
5242 @example
5243 h * (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + ...
5244 + f(a+(n-2)*h) + f(a+(n-1)*h))
5245 @end example
5246 @end ifnottex
5247 @tex
5248 \turnoffactive
5249 \beforedisplay
5250 $$ h (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + \cdots
5251 + f(a+(n-2)h) + f(a+(n-1)h)) $$
5252 \afterdisplay
5253 @end tex
5254
5255 Compute the integral from 1 to 2 of
5256 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5257 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5258 using Simpson's rule with 10 slices.
5259 @xref{Algebra Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5260
5261 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a I} command for doing numerical integration.
5262 It uses @dfn{Romberg's method}, which is a more sophisticated cousin
5263 of Simpson's rule. In particular, it knows how to keep refining the
5264 result until the current precision is satisfied.
5265
5266 @c [fix-ref Selecting Sub-Formulas]
5267 Aside from the commands we've seen so far, Calc also provides a
5268 large set of commands for operating on parts of formulas. You
5269 indicate the desired sub-formula by placing the cursor on any part
5270 of the formula before giving a @dfn{selection} command. Selections won't
5271 be covered in the tutorial; @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}, for
5272 details and examples.
5273
5274 @c hard exercise: simplify (2^(n r) - 2^(r*(n - 1))) / (2^r - 1) 2^(n - 1)
5275 @c to 2^((n-1)*(r-1)).
5276
5277 @node Rewrites Tutorial, , Basic Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
5278 @subsection Rewrite Rules
5279
5280 @noindent
5281 No matter how many built-in commands Calc provided for doing algebra,
5282 there would always be something you wanted to do that Calc didn't have
5283 in its repertoire. So Calc also provides a @dfn{rewrite rule} system
5284 that you can use to define your own algebraic manipulations.
5285
5286 Suppose we want to simplify this trigonometric formula:
5287
5288 @smallexample
5289 @group
5290 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x)
5291 .
5292
5293 ' 1/cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) @key{RET} s 1
5294 @end group
5295 @end smallexample
5296
5297 @noindent
5298 If we were simplifying this by hand, we'd probably replace the
5299 @samp{tan} with a @samp{sin/cos} first, then combine over a common
5300 denominator. There is no Calc command to do the former; the @kbd{a n}
5301 algebra command will do the latter but we'll do both with rewrite
5302 rules just for practice.
5303
5304 Rewrite rules are written with the @samp{:=} symbol.
5305
5306 @smallexample
5307 @group
5308 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x)^2 / cos(x)
5309 .
5310
5311 a r tan(a) := sin(a)/cos(a) @key{RET}
5312 @end group
5313 @end smallexample
5314
5315 @noindent
5316 (The ``assignment operator'' @samp{:=} has several uses in Calc. All
5317 by itself the formula @samp{tan(a) := sin(a)/cos(a)} doesn't do anything,
5318 but when it is given to the @kbd{a r} command, that command interprets
5319 it as a rewrite rule.)
5320
5321 The lefthand side, @samp{tan(a)}, is called the @dfn{pattern} of the
5322 rewrite rule. Calc searches the formula on the stack for parts that
5323 match the pattern. Variables in a rewrite pattern are called
5324 @dfn{meta-variables}, and when matching the pattern each meta-variable
5325 can match any sub-formula. Here, the meta-variable @samp{a} matched
5326 the actual variable @samp{x}.
5327
5328 When the pattern part of a rewrite rule matches a part of the formula,
5329 that part is replaced by the righthand side with all the meta-variables
5330 substituted with the things they matched. So the result is
5331 @samp{sin(x) / cos(x)}. Calc's normal algebraic simplifications then
5332 mix this in with the rest of the original formula.
5333
5334 To merge over a common denominator, we can use another simple rule:
5335
5336 @smallexample
5337 @group
5338 1: (1 - sin(x)^2) / cos(x)
5339 .
5340
5341 a r a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET}
5342 @end group
5343 @end smallexample
5344
5345 This rule points out several interesting features of rewrite patterns.
5346 First, if a meta-variable appears several times in a pattern, it must
5347 match the same thing everywhere. This rule detects common denominators
5348 because the same meta-variable @samp{x} is used in both of the
5349 denominators.
5350
5351 Second, meta-variable names are independent from variables in the
5352 target formula. Notice that the meta-variable @samp{x} here matches
5353 the subformula @samp{cos(x)}; Calc never confuses the two meanings of
5354 @samp{x}.
5355
5356 And third, rewrite patterns know a little bit about the algebraic
5357 properties of formulas. The pattern called for a sum of two quotients;
5358 Calc was able to match a difference of two quotients by matching
5359 @samp{a = 1}, @samp{b = -sin(x)^2}, and @samp{x = cos(x)}.
5360
5361 @c [fix-ref Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules]
5362 We could just as easily have written @samp{a/x - b/x := (a-b)/x} for
5363 the rule. It would have worked just the same in all cases. (If we
5364 really wanted the rule to apply only to @samp{+} or only to @samp{-},
5365 we could have used the @code{plain} symbol. @xref{Algebraic Properties
5366 of Rewrite Rules}, for some examples of this.)
5367
5368 One more rewrite will complete the job. We want to use the identity
5369 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}, but of course we must first rearrange
5370 the identity in a way that matches our formula. The obvious rule
5371 would be @samp{@w{1 - sin(x)^2} := cos(x)^2}, but a little thought shows
5372 that the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2} will also work. The
5373 latter rule has a more general pattern so it will work in many other
5374 situations, too.
5375
5376 @smallexample
5377 @group
5378 1: (1 + cos(x)^2 - 1) / cos(x) 1: cos(x)
5379 . .
5380
5381 a r sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2 @key{RET} a s
5382 @end group
5383 @end smallexample
5384
5385 You may ask, what's the point of using the most general rule if you
5386 have to type it in every time anyway? The answer is that Calc allows
5387 you to store a rewrite rule in a variable, then give the variable
5388 name in the @kbd{a r} command. In fact, this is the preferred way to
5389 use rewrites. For one, if you need a rule once you'll most likely
5390 need it again later. Also, if the rule doesn't work quite right you
5391 can simply Undo, edit the variable, and run the rule again without
5392 having to retype it.
5393
5394 @smallexample
5395 @group
5396 ' tan(x) := sin(x)/cos(x) @key{RET} s t tsc @key{RET}
5397 ' a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET} s t merge @key{RET}
5398 ' sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2 @key{RET} s t sinsqr @key{RET}
5399
5400 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) 1: cos(x)
5401 . .
5402
5403 r 1 a r tsc @key{RET} a r merge @key{RET} a r sinsqr @key{RET} a s
5404 @end group
5405 @end smallexample
5406
5407 To edit a variable, type @kbd{s e} and the variable name, use regular
5408 Emacs editing commands as necessary, then type @kbd{C-c C-c} to store
5409 the edited value back into the variable.
5410 You can also use @w{@kbd{s e}} to create a new variable if you wish.
5411
5412 Notice that the first time you use each rule, Calc puts up a ``compiling''
5413 message briefly. The pattern matcher converts rules into a special
5414 optimized pattern-matching language rather than using them directly.
5415 This allows @kbd{a r} to apply even rather complicated rules very
5416 efficiently. If the rule is stored in a variable, Calc compiles it
5417 only once and stores the compiled form along with the variable. That's
5418 another good reason to store your rules in variables rather than
5419 entering them on the fly.
5420
5421 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Type @kbd{m s} to get Symbolic
5422 mode, then enter the formula @samp{@w{(2 + sqrt(2))} / @w{(1 + sqrt(2))}}.
5423 Using a rewrite rule, simplify this formula by multiplying the top and
5424 bottom by the conjugate @w{@samp{1 - sqrt(2)}}. The result will have
5425 to be expanded by the distributive law; do this with another
5426 rewrite. @xref{Rewrites Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5427
5428 The @kbd{a r} command can also accept a vector of rewrite rules, or
5429 a variable containing a vector of rules.
5430
5431 @smallexample
5432 @group
5433 1: [tsc, merge, sinsqr] 1: [tan(x) := sin(x) / cos(x), ... ]
5434 . .
5435
5436 ' [tsc,merge,sinsqr] @key{RET} =
5437
5438 @end group
5439 @end smallexample
5440 @noindent
5441 @smallexample
5442 @group
5443 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) 1: cos(x)
5444 . .
5445
5446 s t trig @key{RET} r 1 a r trig @key{RET} a s
5447 @end group
5448 @end smallexample
5449
5450 @c [fix-ref Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules]
5451 Calc tries all the rules you give against all parts of the formula,
5452 repeating until no further change is possible. (The exact order in
5453 which things are tried is rather complex, but for simple rules like
5454 the ones we've used here the order doesn't really matter.
5455 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.)
5456
5457 Calc actually repeats only up to 100 times, just in case your rule set
5458 has gotten into an infinite loop. You can give a numeric prefix argument
5459 to @kbd{a r} to specify any limit. In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} does
5460 only one rewrite at a time.
5461
5462 @smallexample
5463 @group
5464 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x)^2 / cos(x) 1: (1 - sin(x)^2) / cos(x)
5465 . .
5466
5467 r 1 M-1 a r trig @key{RET} M-1 a r trig @key{RET}
5468 @end group
5469 @end smallexample
5470
5471 You can type @kbd{M-0 a r} if you want no limit at all on the number
5472 of rewrites that occur.
5473
5474 Rewrite rules can also be @dfn{conditional}. Simply follow the rule
5475 with a @samp{::} symbol and the desired condition. For example,
5476
5477 @smallexample
5478 @group
5479 1: exp(2 pi i) + exp(3 pi i) + exp(4 pi i)
5480 .
5481
5482 ' exp(2 pi i) + exp(3 pi i) + exp(4 pi i) @key{RET}
5483
5484 @end group
5485 @end smallexample
5486 @noindent
5487 @smallexample
5488 @group
5489 1: 1 + exp(3 pi i) + 1
5490 .
5491
5492 a r exp(k pi i) := 1 :: k % 2 = 0 @key{RET}
5493 @end group
5494 @end smallexample
5495
5496 @noindent
5497 (Recall, @samp{k % 2} is the remainder from dividing @samp{k} by 2,
5498 which will be zero only when @samp{k} is an even integer.)
5499
5500 An interesting point is that the variables @samp{pi} and @samp{i}
5501 were matched literally rather than acting as meta-variables.
5502 This is because they are special-constant variables. The special
5503 constants @samp{e}, @samp{phi}, and so on also match literally.
5504 A common error with rewrite
5505 rules is to write, say, @samp{f(a,b,c,d,e) := g(a+b+c+d+e)}, expecting
5506 to match any @samp{f} with five arguments but in fact matching
5507 only when the fifth argument is literally @samp{e}!
5508
5509 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5510 @ignore
5511 @starindex
5512 @end ignore
5513 @tindex fib
5514 Rewrite rules provide an interesting way to define your own functions.
5515 Suppose we want to define @samp{fib(n)} to produce the @var{n}th
5516 Fibonacci number. The first two Fibonacci numbers are each 1;
5517 later numbers are formed by summing the two preceding numbers in
5518 the sequence. This is easy to express in a set of three rules:
5519
5520 @smallexample
5521 @group
5522 ' [fib(1) := 1, fib(2) := 1, fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2)] @key{RET} s t fib
5523
5524 1: fib(7) 1: 13
5525 . .
5526
5527 ' fib(7) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5528 @end group
5529 @end smallexample
5530
5531 One thing that is guaranteed about the order that rewrites are tried
5532 is that, for any given subformula, earlier rules in the rule set will
5533 be tried for that subformula before later ones. So even though the
5534 first and third rules both match @samp{fib(1)}, we know the first will
5535 be used preferentially.
5536
5537 This rule set has one dangerous bug: Suppose we apply it to the
5538 formula @samp{fib(x)}? (Don't actually try this.) The third rule
5539 will match @samp{fib(x)} and replace it with @w{@samp{fib(x-1) + fib(x-2)}}.
5540 Each of these will then be replaced to get @samp{fib(x-2) + 2 fib(x-3) +
5541 fib(x-4)}, and so on, expanding forever. What we really want is to apply
5542 the third rule only when @samp{n} is an integer greater than two. Type
5543 @w{@kbd{s e fib @key{RET}}}, then edit the third rule to:
5544
5545 @smallexample
5546 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2
5547 @end smallexample
5548
5549 @noindent
5550 Now:
5551
5552 @smallexample
5553 @group
5554 1: fib(6) + fib(x) + fib(0) 1: 8 + fib(x) + fib(0)
5555 . .
5556
5557 ' fib(6)+fib(x)+fib(0) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5558 @end group
5559 @end smallexample
5560
5561 @noindent
5562 We've created a new function, @code{fib}, and a new command,
5563 @w{@kbd{a r fib @key{RET}}}, which means ``evaluate all @code{fib} calls in
5564 this formula.'' To make things easier still, we can tell Calc to
5565 apply these rules automatically by storing them in the special
5566 variable @code{EvalRules}.
5567
5568 @smallexample
5569 @group
5570 1: [fib(1) := ...] . 1: [8, 13]
5571 . .
5572
5573 s r fib @key{RET} s t EvalRules @key{RET} ' [fib(6), fib(7)] @key{RET}
5574 @end group
5575 @end smallexample
5576
5577 It turns out that this rule set has the problem that it does far
5578 more work than it needs to when @samp{n} is large. Consider the
5579 first few steps of the computation of @samp{fib(6)}:
5580
5581 @smallexample
5582 @group
5583 fib(6) =
5584 fib(5) + fib(4) =
5585 fib(4) + fib(3) + fib(3) + fib(2) =
5586 fib(3) + fib(2) + fib(2) + fib(1) + fib(2) + fib(1) + 1 = ...
5587 @end group
5588 @end smallexample
5589
5590 @noindent
5591 Note that @samp{fib(3)} appears three times here. Unless Calc's
5592 algebraic simplifier notices the multiple @samp{fib(3)}s and combines
5593 them (and, as it happens, it doesn't), this rule set does lots of
5594 needless recomputation. To cure the problem, type @code{s e EvalRules}
5595 to edit the rules (or just @kbd{s E}, a shorthand command for editing
5596 @code{EvalRules}) and add another condition:
5597
5598 @smallexample
5599 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2 :: remember
5600 @end smallexample
5601
5602 @noindent
5603 If a @samp{:: remember} condition appears anywhere in a rule, then if
5604 that rule succeeds Calc will add another rule that describes that match
5605 to the front of the rule set. (Remembering works in any rule set, but
5606 for technical reasons it is most effective in @code{EvalRules}.) For
5607 example, if the rule rewrites @samp{fib(7)} to something that evaluates
5608 to 13, then the rule @samp{fib(7) := 13} will be added to the rule set.
5609
5610 Type @kbd{' fib(8) @key{RET}} to compute the eighth Fibonacci number, then
5611 type @kbd{s E} again to see what has happened to the rule set.
5612
5613 With the @code{remember} feature, our rule set can now compute
5614 @samp{fib(@var{n})} in just @var{n} steps. In the process it builds
5615 up a table of all Fibonacci numbers up to @var{n}. After we have
5616 computed the result for a particular @var{n}, we can get it back
5617 (and the results for all smaller @var{n}) later in just one step.
5618
5619 All Calc operations will run somewhat slower whenever @code{EvalRules}
5620 contains any rules. You should type @kbd{s u EvalRules @key{RET}} now to
5621 un-store the variable.
5622
5623 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Sometimes it is possible to reformulate
5624 a problem to reduce the amount of recursion necessary to solve it.
5625 Create a rule that, in about @var{n} simple steps and without recourse
5626 to the @code{remember} option, replaces @samp{fib(@var{n}, 1, 1)} with
5627 @samp{fib(1, @var{x}, @var{y})} where @var{x} and @var{y} are the
5628 @var{n}th and @var{n+1}st Fibonacci numbers, respectively. This rule is
5629 rather clunky to use, so add a couple more rules to make the ``user
5630 interface'' the same as for our first version: enter @samp{fib(@var{n})},
5631 get back a plain number. @xref{Rewrites Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5632
5633 There are many more things that rewrites can do. For example, there
5634 are @samp{&&&} and @samp{|||} pattern operators that create ``and''
5635 and ``or'' combinations of rules. As one really simple example, we
5636 could combine our first two Fibonacci rules thusly:
5637
5638 @example
5639 [fib(1 ||| 2) := 1, fib(n) := ... ]
5640 @end example
5641
5642 @noindent
5643 That means ``@code{fib} of something matching either 1 or 2 rewrites
5644 to 1.''
5645
5646 You can also make meta-variables optional by enclosing them in @code{opt}.
5647 For example, the pattern @samp{a + b x} matches @samp{2 + 3 x} but not
5648 @samp{2 + x} or @samp{3 x} or @samp{x}. The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x}
5649 matches all of these forms, filling in a default of zero for @samp{a}
5650 and one for @samp{b}.
5651
5652 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe had @samp{2 + 3 x}
5653 on the stack and tried to use the rule
5654 @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x := f(a, b, x)}. What happened?
5655 @xref{Rewrites Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5656
5657 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Starting with a positive integer @expr{a},
5658 divide @expr{a} by two if it is even, otherwise compute @expr{3 a + 1}.
5659 Now repeat this step over and over. A famous unproved conjecture
5660 is that for any starting @expr{a}, the sequence always eventually
5661 reaches 1. Given the formula @samp{seq(@var{a}, 0)}, write a set of
5662 rules that convert this into @samp{seq(1, @var{n})} where @var{n}
5663 is the number of steps it took the sequence to reach the value 1.
5664 Now enhance the rules to accept @samp{seq(@var{a})} as a starting
5665 configuration, and to stop with just the number @var{n} by itself.
5666 Now make the result be a vector of values in the sequence, from @var{a}
5667 to 1. (The formula @samp{@var{x}|@var{y}} appends the vectors @var{x}
5668 and @var{y}.) For example, rewriting @samp{seq(6)} should yield the
5669 vector @expr{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
5670 @xref{Rewrites Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5671
5672 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} Define, using rewrite rules, a function
5673 @samp{nterms(@var{x})} that returns the number of terms in the sum
5674 @var{x}, or 1 if @var{x} is not a sum. (A @dfn{sum} for our purposes
5675 is one or more non-sum terms separated by @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
5676 so that @expr{2 - 3 (x + y) + x y} is a sum of three terms.)
5677 @xref{Rewrites Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5678
5679 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} A Taylor series for a function is an
5680 infinite series that exactly equals the value of that function at
5681 values of @expr{x} near zero.
5682
5683 @ifnottex
5684 @example
5685 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + x^4 / 4! - x^6 / 6! + ...
5686 @end example
5687 @end ifnottex
5688 @tex
5689 \turnoffactive
5690 \beforedisplay
5691 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + {x^4 \over 4!} - {x^6 \over 6!} + \cdots $$
5692 \afterdisplay
5693 @end tex
5694
5695 The @kbd{a t} command produces a @dfn{truncated Taylor series} which
5696 is obtained by dropping all the terms higher than, say, @expr{x^2}.
5697 Calc represents the truncated Taylor series as a polynomial in @expr{x}.
5698 Mathematicians often write a truncated series using a ``big-O'' notation
5699 that records what was the lowest term that was truncated.
5700
5701 @ifnottex
5702 @example
5703 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + O(x^3)
5704 @end example
5705 @end ifnottex
5706 @tex
5707 \turnoffactive
5708 \beforedisplay
5709 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + O(x^3) $$
5710 \afterdisplay
5711 @end tex
5712
5713 @noindent
5714 The meaning of @expr{O(x^3)} is ``a quantity which is negligibly small
5715 if @expr{x^3} is considered negligibly small as @expr{x} goes to zero.''
5716
5717 The exercise is to create rewrite rules that simplify sums and products of
5718 power series represented as @samp{@var{polynomial} + O(@var{var}^@var{n})}.
5719 For example, given @samp{1 - x^2 / 2 + O(x^3)} and @samp{x - x^3 / 6 + O(x^4)}
5720 on the stack, we want to be able to type @kbd{*} and get the result
5721 @samp{x - 2:3 x^3 + O(x^4)}. Don't worry if the terms of the sum are
5722 rearranged or if @kbd{a s} needs to be typed after rewriting. (This one
5723 is rather tricky; the solution at the end of this chapter uses 6 rewrite
5724 rules. Hint: The @samp{constant(x)} condition tests whether @samp{x} is
5725 a number.) @xref{Rewrites Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5726
5727 Just for kicks, try adding the rule @code{2+3 := 6} to @code{EvalRules}.
5728 What happens? (Be sure to remove this rule afterward, or you might get
5729 a nasty surprise when you use Calc to balance your checkbook!)
5730
5731 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for the whole story on rewrite rules.
5732
5733 @node Programming Tutorial, Answers to Exercises, Algebra Tutorial, Tutorial
5734 @section Programming Tutorial
5735
5736 @noindent
5737 The Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, a highly extensible
5738 language. If you know Lisp, you can program the Calculator to do
5739 anything you like. Rewrite rules also work as a powerful programming
5740 system. But Lisp and rewrite rules take a while to master, and often
5741 all you want to do is define a new function or repeat a command a few
5742 times. Calc has features that allow you to do these things easily.
5743
5744 One very limited form of programming is defining your own functions.
5745 Calc's @kbd{Z F} command allows you to define a function name and
5746 key sequence to correspond to any formula. Programming commands use
5747 the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix; the user commands they create use the lower
5748 case @kbd{z} prefix.
5749
5750 @smallexample
5751 @group
5752 1: 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 1: 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6
5753 . .
5754
5755 ' 1 + x + x^2/2! + x^3/3! @key{RET} Z F e myexp @key{RET} @key{RET} @key{RET} y
5756 @end group
5757 @end smallexample
5758
5759 This polynomial is a Taylor series approximation to @samp{exp(x)}.
5760 The @kbd{Z F} command asks a number of questions. The above answers
5761 say that the key sequence for our function should be @kbd{z e}; the
5762 @kbd{M-x} equivalent should be @code{calc-myexp}; the name of the
5763 function in algebraic formulas should also be @code{myexp}; the
5764 default argument list @samp{(x)} is acceptable; and finally @kbd{y}
5765 answers the question ``leave it in symbolic form for non-constant
5766 arguments?''
5767
5768 @smallexample
5769 @group
5770 1: 1.3495 2: 1.3495 3: 1.3495
5771 . 1: 1.34986 2: 1.34986
5772 . 1: myexp(a + 1)
5773 .
5774
5775 .3 z e .3 E ' a+1 @key{RET} z e
5776 @end group
5777 @end smallexample
5778
5779 @noindent
5780 First we call our new @code{exp} approximation with 0.3 as an
5781 argument, and compare it with the true @code{exp} function. Then
5782 we note that, as requested, if we try to give @kbd{z e} an
5783 argument that isn't a plain number, it leaves the @code{myexp}
5784 function call in symbolic form. If we had answered @kbd{n} to the
5785 final question, @samp{myexp(a + 1)} would have evaluated by plugging
5786 in @samp{a + 1} for @samp{x} in the defining formula.
5787
5788 @cindex Sine integral Si(x)
5789 @ignore
5790 @starindex
5791 @end ignore
5792 @tindex Si
5793 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The ``sine integral'' function
5794 @texline @math{{\rm Si}(x)}
5795 @infoline @expr{Si(x)}
5796 is defined as the integral of @samp{sin(t)/t} for
5797 @expr{t = 0} to @expr{x} in radians. (It was invented because this
5798 integral has no solution in terms of basic functions; if you give it
5799 to Calc's @kbd{a i} command, it will ponder it for a long time and then
5800 give up.) We can use the numerical integration command, however,
5801 which in algebraic notation is written like @samp{ninteg(f(t), t, 0, x)}
5802 with any integrand @samp{f(t)}. Define a @kbd{z s} command and
5803 @code{Si} function that implement this. You will need to edit the
5804 default argument list a bit. As a test, @samp{Si(1)} should return
5805 0.946083. (If you don't get this answer, you might want to check that
5806 Calc is in Radians mode. Also, @code{ninteg} will run a lot faster if
5807 you reduce the precision to, say, six digits beforehand.)
5808 @xref{Programming Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5809
5810 The simplest way to do real ``programming'' of Emacs is to define a
5811 @dfn{keyboard macro}. A keyboard macro is simply a sequence of
5812 keystrokes which Emacs has stored away and can play back on demand.
5813 For example, if you find yourself typing @kbd{H a S x @key{RET}} often,
5814 you may wish to program a keyboard macro to type this for you.
5815
5816 @smallexample
5817 @group
5818 1: y = sqrt(x) 1: x = y^2
5819 . .
5820
5821 ' y=sqrt(x) @key{RET} C-x ( H a S x @key{RET} C-x )
5822
5823 1: y = cos(x) 1: x = s1 arccos(y) + 2 pi n1
5824 . .
5825
5826 ' y=cos(x) @key{RET} X
5827 @end group
5828 @end smallexample
5829
5830 @noindent
5831 When you type @kbd{C-x (}, Emacs begins recording. But it is also
5832 still ready to execute your keystrokes, so you're really ``training''
5833 Emacs by walking it through the procedure once. When you type
5834 @w{@kbd{C-x )}}, the macro is recorded. You can now type @kbd{X} to
5835 re-execute the same keystrokes.
5836
5837 You can give a name to your macro by typing @kbd{Z K}.
5838
5839 @smallexample
5840 @group
5841 1: . 1: y = x^4 1: x = s2 sqrt(s1 sqrt(y))
5842 . .
5843
5844 Z K x @key{RET} ' y=x^4 @key{RET} z x
5845 @end group
5846 @end smallexample
5847
5848 @noindent
5849 Notice that we use shift-@kbd{Z} to define the command, and lower-case
5850 @kbd{z} to call it up.
5851
5852 Keyboard macros can call other macros.
5853
5854 @smallexample
5855 @group
5856 1: abs(x) 1: x = s1 y 1: 2 / x 1: x = 2 / y
5857 . . . .
5858
5859 ' abs(x) @key{RET} C-x ( ' y @key{RET} a = z x C-x ) ' 2/x @key{RET} X
5860 @end group
5861 @end smallexample
5862
5863 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Define a keyboard macro to negate
5864 the item in level 3 of the stack, without disturbing the rest of
5865 the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5866
5867 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Define keyboard macros to compute
5868 the following functions:
5869
5870 @enumerate
5871 @item
5872 Compute
5873 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}},
5874 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x},
5875 where @expr{x} is the number on the top of the stack.
5876
5877 @item
5878 Compute the base-@expr{b} logarithm, just like the @kbd{B} key except
5879 the arguments are taken in the opposite order.
5880
5881 @item
5882 Produce a vector of integers from 1 to the integer on the top of
5883 the stack.
5884 @end enumerate
5885 @noindent
5886 @xref{Programming Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5887
5888 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Define a keyboard macro to compute
5889 the average (mean) value of a list of numbers.
5890 @xref{Programming Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5891
5892 In many programs, some of the steps must execute several times.
5893 Calc has @dfn{looping} commands that allow this. Loops are useful
5894 inside keyboard macros, but actually work at any time.
5895
5896 @smallexample
5897 @group
5898 1: x^6 2: x^6 1: 360 x^2
5899 . 1: 4 .
5900 .
5901
5902 ' x^6 @key{RET} 4 Z < a d x @key{RET} Z >
5903 @end group
5904 @end smallexample
5905
5906 @noindent
5907 Here we have computed the fourth derivative of @expr{x^6} by
5908 enclosing a derivative command in a ``repeat loop'' structure.
5909 This structure pops a repeat count from the stack, then
5910 executes the body of the loop that many times.
5911
5912 If you make a mistake while entering the body of the loop,
5913 type @w{@kbd{Z C-g}} to cancel the loop command.
5914
5915 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5916 Here's another example:
5917
5918 @smallexample
5919 @group
5920 3: 1 2: 10946
5921 2: 1 1: 17711
5922 1: 20 .
5923 .
5924
5925 1 @key{RET} @key{RET} 20 Z < @key{TAB} C-j + Z >
5926 @end group
5927 @end smallexample
5928
5929 @noindent
5930 The numbers in levels 2 and 1 should be the 21st and 22nd Fibonacci
5931 numbers, respectively. (To see what's going on, try a few repetitions
5932 of the loop body by hand; @kbd{C-j}, also on the Line-Feed or @key{LFD}
5933 key if you have one, makes a copy of the number in level 2.)
5934
5935 @cindex Golden ratio
5936 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
5937 A fascinating property of the Fibonacci numbers is that the @expr{n}th
5938 Fibonacci number can be found directly by computing
5939 @texline @math{\phi^n / \sqrt{5}}
5940 @infoline @expr{phi^n / sqrt(5)}
5941 and then rounding to the nearest integer, where
5942 @texline @math{\phi} (``phi''),
5943 @infoline @expr{phi},
5944 the ``golden ratio,'' is
5945 @texline @math{(1 + \sqrt{5}) / 2}.
5946 @infoline @expr{(1 + sqrt(5)) / 2}.
5947 (For convenience, this constant is available from the @code{phi}
5948 variable, or the @kbd{I H P} command.)
5949
5950 @smallexample
5951 @group
5952 1: 1.61803 1: 24476.0000409 1: 10945.9999817 1: 10946
5953 . . . .
5954
5955 I H P 21 ^ 5 Q / R
5956 @end group
5957 @end smallexample
5958
5959 @cindex Continued fractions
5960 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @dfn{continued fraction}
5961 representation of
5962 @texline @math{\phi}
5963 @infoline @expr{phi}
5964 is
5965 @texline @math{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( \ldots )))}.
5966 @infoline @expr{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( ...@: )))}.
5967 We can compute an approximate value by carrying this however far
5968 and then replacing the innermost
5969 @texline @math{1/( \ldots )}
5970 @infoline @expr{1/( ...@: )}
5971 by 1. Approximate
5972 @texline @math{\phi}
5973 @infoline @expr{phi}
5974 using a twenty-term continued fraction.
5975 @xref{Programming Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5976
5977 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Linear recurrences like the one for
5978 Fibonacci numbers can be expressed in terms of matrices. Given a
5979 vector @w{@expr{[a, b]}} determine a matrix which, when multiplied by this
5980 vector, produces the vector @expr{[b, c]}, where @expr{a}, @expr{b} and
5981 @expr{c} are three successive Fibonacci numbers. Now write a program
5982 that, given an integer @expr{n}, computes the @expr{n}th Fibonacci number
5983 using matrix arithmetic. @xref{Programming Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5984
5985 @cindex Harmonic numbers
5986 A more sophisticated kind of loop is the @dfn{for} loop. Suppose
5987 we wish to compute the 20th ``harmonic'' number, which is equal to
5988 the sum of the reciprocals of the integers from 1 to 20.
5989
5990 @smallexample
5991 @group
5992 3: 0 1: 3.597739
5993 2: 1 .
5994 1: 20
5995 .
5996
5997 0 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & + 1 Z )
5998 @end group
5999 @end smallexample
6000
6001 @noindent
6002 The ``for'' loop pops two numbers, the lower and upper limits, then
6003 repeats the body of the loop as an internal counter increases from
6004 the lower limit to the upper one. Just before executing the loop
6005 body, it pushes the current loop counter. When the loop body
6006 finishes, it pops the ``step,'' i.e., the amount by which to
6007 increment the loop counter. As you can see, our loop always
6008 uses a step of one.
6009
6010 This harmonic number function uses the stack to hold the running
6011 total as well as for the various loop housekeeping functions. If
6012 you find this disorienting, you can sum in a variable instead:
6013
6014 @smallexample
6015 @group
6016 1: 0 2: 1 . 1: 3.597739
6017 . 1: 20 .
6018 .
6019
6020 0 t 7 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & s + 7 1 Z ) r 7
6021 @end group
6022 @end smallexample
6023
6024 @noindent
6025 The @kbd{s +} command adds the top-of-stack into the value in a
6026 variable (and removes that value from the stack).
6027
6028 It's worth noting that many jobs that call for a ``for'' loop can
6029 also be done more easily by Calc's high-level operations. Two
6030 other ways to compute harmonic numbers are to use vector mapping
6031 and reduction (@kbd{v x 20}, then @w{@kbd{V M &}}, then @kbd{V R +}),
6032 or to use the summation command @kbd{a +}. Both of these are
6033 probably easier than using loops. However, there are some
6034 situations where loops really are the way to go:
6035
6036 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Use a ``for'' loop to find the first
6037 harmonic number which is greater than 4.0.
6038 @xref{Programming Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
6039
6040 Of course, if we're going to be using variables in our programs,
6041 we have to worry about the programs clobbering values that the
6042 caller was keeping in those same variables. This is easy to
6043 fix, though:
6044
6045 @smallexample
6046 @group
6047 . 1: 0.6667 1: 0.6667 3: 0.6667
6048 . . 2: 3.597739
6049 1: 0.6667
6050 .
6051
6052 Z ` p 4 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 / s 7 s s a @key{RET} Z ' r 7 s r a @key{RET}
6053 @end group
6054 @end smallexample
6055
6056 @noindent
6057 When we type @kbd{Z `} (that's a back-quote character), Calc saves
6058 its mode settings and the contents of the ten ``quick variables''
6059 for later reference. When we type @kbd{Z '} (that's an apostrophe
6060 now), Calc restores those saved values. Thus the @kbd{p 4} and
6061 @kbd{s 7} commands have no effect outside this sequence. Wrapping
6062 this around the body of a keyboard macro ensures that it doesn't
6063 interfere with what the user of the macro was doing. Notice that
6064 the contents of the stack, and the values of named variables,
6065 survive past the @kbd{Z '} command.
6066
6067 @cindex Bernoulli numbers, approximate
6068 The @dfn{Bernoulli numbers} are a sequence with the interesting
6069 property that all of the odd Bernoulli numbers are zero, and the
6070 even ones, while difficult to compute, can be roughly approximated
6071 by the formula
6072 @texline @math{\displaystyle{2 n! \over (2 \pi)^n}}.
6073 @infoline @expr{2 n!@: / (2 pi)^n}.
6074 Let's write a keyboard macro to compute (approximate) Bernoulli numbers.
6075 (Calc has a command, @kbd{k b}, to compute exact Bernoulli numbers, but
6076 this command is very slow for large @expr{n} since the higher Bernoulli
6077 numbers are very large fractions.)
6078
6079 @smallexample
6080 @group
6081 1: 10 1: 0.0756823
6082 . .
6083
6084 10 C-x ( @key{RET} 2 % Z [ @key{DEL} 0 Z : ' 2 $! / (2 pi)^$ @key{RET} = Z ] C-x )
6085 @end group
6086 @end smallexample
6087
6088 @noindent
6089 You can read @kbd{Z [} as ``then,'' @kbd{Z :} as ``else,'' and
6090 @kbd{Z ]} as ``end-if.'' There is no need for an explicit ``if''
6091 command. For the purposes of @w{@kbd{Z [}}, the condition is ``true''
6092 if the value it pops from the stack is a nonzero number, or ``false''
6093 if it pops zero or something that is not a number (like a formula).
6094 Here we take our integer argument modulo 2; this will be nonzero
6095 if we're asking for an odd Bernoulli number.
6096
6097 The actual tenth Bernoulli number is @expr{5/66}.
6098
6099 @smallexample
6100 @group
6101 3: 0.0756823 1: 0 1: 0.25305 1: 0 1: 1.16659
6102 2: 5:66 . . . .
6103 1: 0.0757575
6104 .
6105
6106 10 k b @key{RET} c f M-0 @key{DEL} 11 X @key{DEL} 12 X @key{DEL} 13 X @key{DEL} 14 X
6107 @end group
6108 @end smallexample
6109
6110 Just to exercise loops a bit more, let's compute a table of even
6111 Bernoulli numbers.
6112
6113 @smallexample
6114 @group
6115 3: [] 1: [0.10132, 0.03079, 0.02340, 0.033197, ...]
6116 2: 2 .
6117 1: 30
6118 .
6119
6120 [ ] 2 @key{RET} 30 Z ( X | 2 Z )
6121 @end group
6122 @end smallexample
6123
6124 @noindent
6125 The vertical-bar @kbd{|} is the vector-concatenation command. When
6126 we execute it, the list we are building will be in stack level 2
6127 (initially this is an empty list), and the next Bernoulli number
6128 will be in level 1. The effect is to append the Bernoulli number
6129 onto the end of the list. (To create a table of exact fractional
6130 Bernoulli numbers, just replace @kbd{X} with @kbd{k b} in the above
6131 sequence of keystrokes.)
6132
6133 With loops and conditionals, you can program essentially anything
6134 in Calc. One other command that makes looping easier is @kbd{Z /},
6135 which takes a condition from the stack and breaks out of the enclosing
6136 loop if the condition is true (non-zero). You can use this to make
6137 ``while'' and ``until'' style loops.
6138
6139 If you make a mistake when entering a keyboard macro, you can edit
6140 it using @kbd{Z E}. First, you must attach it to a key with @kbd{Z K}.
6141 One technique is to enter a throwaway dummy definition for the macro,
6142 then enter the real one in the edit command.
6143
6144 @smallexample
6145 @group
6146 1: 3 1: 3 Calc Macro Edit Mode.
6147 . . Original keys: 1 <return> 2 +
6148
6149 1 ;; calc digits
6150 RET ;; calc-enter
6151 2 ;; calc digits
6152 + ;; calc-plus
6153
6154 C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 2 + C-x ) Z K h @key{RET} Z E h
6155 @end group
6156 @end smallexample
6157
6158 @noindent
6159 A keyboard macro is stored as a pure keystroke sequence. The
6160 @file{edmacro} package (invoked by @kbd{Z E}) scans along the
6161 macro and tries to decode it back into human-readable steps.
6162 Descriptions of the keystrokes are given as comments, which begin with
6163 @samp{;;}, and which are ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6164 Spaces and line breaks are also ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6165 To enter a space into the macro, type @code{SPC}. All the special
6166 characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC}, @code{DEL},
6167 and @code{NUL} must be written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes
6168 @code{C-} and @code{M-}.
6169
6170 Let's edit in a new definition, for computing harmonic numbers.
6171 First, erase the four lines of the old definition. Then, type
6172 in the new definition (or use Emacs @kbd{M-w} and @kbd{C-y} commands
6173 to copy it from this page of the Info file; you can of course skip
6174 typing the comments, which begin with @samp{;;}).
6175
6176 @smallexample
6177 Z` ;; calc-kbd-push (Save local values)
6178 0 ;; calc digits (Push a zero onto the stack)
6179 st ;; calc-store-into (Store it in the following variable)
6180 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6181 1 ;; calc digits (Initial value for the loop)
6182 TAB ;; calc-roll-down (Swap initial and final)
6183 Z( ;; calc-kbd-for (Begin the "for" loop)
6184 & ;; calc-inv (Take the reciprocal)
6185 s+ ;; calc-store-plus (Add to the following variable)
6186 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6187 1 ;; calc digits (The loop step is 1)
6188 Z) ;; calc-kbd-end-for (End the "for" loop)
6189 sr ;; calc-recall (Recall the final accumulated value)
6190 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6191 Z' ;; calc-kbd-pop (Restore values)
6192 @end smallexample
6193
6194 @noindent
6195 Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and return to the Calculator.
6196
6197 @smallexample
6198 @group
6199 1: 20 1: 3.597739
6200 . .
6201
6202 20 z h
6203 @end group
6204 @end smallexample
6205
6206 The @file{edmacro} package defines a handy @code{read-kbd-macro} command
6207 which reads the current region of the current buffer as a sequence of
6208 keystroke names, and defines that sequence on the @kbd{X}
6209 (and @kbd{C-x e}) key. Because this is so useful, Calc puts this
6210 command on the @kbd{C-x * m} key. Try reading in this macro in the
6211 following form: Press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}) at
6212 one end of the text below, then type @kbd{C-x * m} at the other.
6213
6214 @example
6215 @group
6216 Z ` 0 t 1
6217 1 TAB
6218 Z ( & s + 1 1 Z )
6219 r 1
6220 Z '
6221 @end group
6222 @end example
6223
6224 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} A general algorithm for solving
6225 equations numerically is @dfn{Newton's Method}. Given the equation
6226 @expr{f(x) = 0} for any function @expr{f}, and an initial guess
6227 @expr{x_0} which is reasonably close to the desired solution, apply
6228 this formula over and over:
6229
6230 @ifnottex
6231 @example
6232 new_x = x - f(x)/f'(x)
6233 @end example
6234 @end ifnottex
6235 @tex
6236 \beforedisplay
6237 $$ x_{\rm new} = x - {f(x) \over f'(x)} $$
6238 \afterdisplay
6239 @end tex
6240
6241 @noindent
6242 where @expr{f'(x)} is the derivative of @expr{f}. The @expr{x}
6243 values will quickly converge to a solution, i.e., eventually
6244 @texline @math{x_{\rm new}}
6245 @infoline @expr{new_x}
6246 and @expr{x} will be equal to within the limits
6247 of the current precision. Write a program which takes a formula
6248 involving the variable @expr{x}, and an initial guess @expr{x_0},
6249 on the stack, and produces a value of @expr{x} for which the formula
6250 is zero. Use it to find a solution of
6251 @texline @math{\sin(\cos x) = 0.5}
6252 @infoline @expr{sin(cos(x)) = 0.5}
6253 near @expr{x = 4.5}. (Use angles measured in radians.) Note that
6254 the built-in @w{@kbd{a R}} (@code{calc-find-root}) command uses Newton's
6255 method when it is able. @xref{Programming Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
6256
6257 @cindex Digamma function
6258 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
6259 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
6260 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} The @dfn{digamma} function
6261 @texline @math{\psi(z) (``psi'')}
6262 @infoline @expr{psi(z)}
6263 is defined as the derivative of
6264 @texline @math{\ln \Gamma(z)}.
6265 @infoline @expr{ln(gamma(z))}.
6266 For large values of @expr{z}, it can be approximated by the infinite sum
6267
6268 @ifnottex
6269 @example
6270 psi(z) ~= ln(z) - 1/2z - sum(bern(2 n) / 2 n z^(2 n), n, 1, inf)
6271 @end example
6272 @end ifnottex
6273 @tex
6274 \beforedisplay
6275 $$ \psi(z) \approx \ln z - {1\over2z} -
6276 \sum_{n=1}^\infty {\code{bern}(2 n) \over 2 n z^{2n}}
6277 $$
6278 \afterdisplay
6279 @end tex
6280
6281 @noindent
6282 where
6283 @texline @math{\sum}
6284 @infoline @expr{sum}
6285 represents the sum over @expr{n} from 1 to infinity
6286 (or to some limit high enough to give the desired accuracy), and
6287 the @code{bern} function produces (exact) Bernoulli numbers.
6288 While this sum is not guaranteed to converge, in practice it is safe.
6289 An interesting mathematical constant is Euler's gamma, which is equal
6290 to about 0.5772. One way to compute it is by the formula,
6291 @texline @math{\gamma = -\psi(1)}.
6292 @infoline @expr{gamma = -psi(1)}.
6293 Unfortunately, 1 isn't a large enough argument
6294 for the above formula to work (5 is a much safer value for @expr{z}).
6295 Fortunately, we can compute
6296 @texline @math{\psi(1)}
6297 @infoline @expr{psi(1)}
6298 from
6299 @texline @math{\psi(5)}
6300 @infoline @expr{psi(5)}
6301 using the recurrence
6302 @texline @math{\psi(z+1) = \psi(z) + {1 \over z}}.
6303 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1) = psi(z) + 1/z}.
6304 Your task: Develop a program to compute
6305 @texline @math{\psi(z)};
6306 @infoline @expr{psi(z)};
6307 it should ``pump up'' @expr{z}
6308 if necessary to be greater than 5, then use the above summation
6309 formula. Use looping commands to compute the sum. Use your function
6310 to compute
6311 @texline @math{\gamma}
6312 @infoline @expr{gamma}
6313 to twelve decimal places. (Calc has a built-in command
6314 for Euler's constant, @kbd{I P}, which you can use to check your answer.)
6315 @xref{Programming Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
6316
6317 @cindex Polynomial, list of coefficients
6318 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Given a polynomial in @expr{x} and
6319 a number @expr{m} on the stack, where the polynomial is of degree
6320 @expr{m} or less (i.e., does not have any terms higher than @expr{x^m}),
6321 write a program to convert the polynomial into a list-of-coefficients
6322 notation. For example, @expr{5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2} with @expr{m = 6}
6323 should produce the list @expr{[1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]}. Also develop
6324 a way to convert from this form back to the standard algebraic form.
6325 @xref{Programming Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
6326
6327 @cindex Recursion
6328 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The @dfn{Stirling numbers of the
6329 first kind} are defined by the recurrences,
6330
6331 @ifnottex
6332 @example
6333 s(n,n) = 1 for n >= 0,
6334 s(n,0) = 0 for n > 0,
6335 s(n+1,m) = s(n,m-1) - n s(n,m) for n >= m >= 1.
6336 @end example
6337 @end ifnottex
6338 @tex
6339 \turnoffactive
6340 \beforedisplay
6341 $$ \eqalign{ s(n,n) &= 1 \qquad \hbox{for } n \ge 0, \cr
6342 s(n,0) &= 0 \qquad \hbox{for } n > 0, \cr
6343 s(n+1,m) &= s(n,m-1) - n \, s(n,m) \qquad
6344 \hbox{for } n \ge m \ge 1.}
6345 $$
6346 \afterdisplay
6347 \vskip5pt
6348 (These numbers are also sometimes written $\displaystyle{n \brack m}$.)
6349 @end tex
6350
6351 This can be implemented using a @dfn{recursive} program in Calc; the
6352 program must invoke itself in order to calculate the two righthand
6353 terms in the general formula. Since it always invokes itself with
6354 ``simpler'' arguments, it's easy to see that it must eventually finish
6355 the computation. Recursion is a little difficult with Emacs keyboard
6356 macros since the macro is executed before its definition is complete.
6357 So here's the recommended strategy: Create a ``dummy macro'' and assign
6358 it to a key with, e.g., @kbd{Z K s}. Now enter the true definition,
6359 using the @kbd{z s} command to call itself recursively, then assign it
6360 to the same key with @kbd{Z K s}. Now the @kbd{z s} command will run
6361 the complete recursive program. (Another way is to use @w{@kbd{Z E}}
6362 or @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the whole macro at once,
6363 thus avoiding the ``training'' phase.) The task: Write a program
6364 that computes Stirling numbers of the first kind, given @expr{n} and
6365 @expr{m} on the stack. Test it with @emph{small} inputs like
6366 @expr{s(4,2)}. (There is a built-in command for Stirling numbers,
6367 @kbd{k s}, which you can use to check your answers.)
6368 @xref{Programming Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
6369
6370 The programming commands we've seen in this part of the tutorial
6371 are low-level, general-purpose operations. Often you will find
6372 that a higher-level function, such as vector mapping or rewrite
6373 rules, will do the job much more easily than a detailed, step-by-step
6374 program can:
6375
6376 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} Write another program for
6377 computing Stirling numbers of the first kind, this time using
6378 rewrite rules. Once again, @expr{n} and @expr{m} should be taken
6379 from the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
6380
6381 @example
6382
6383 @end example
6384 This ends the tutorial section of the Calc manual. Now you know enough
6385 about Calc to use it effectively for many kinds of calculations. But
6386 Calc has many features that were not even touched upon in this tutorial.
6387 @c [not-split]
6388 The rest of this manual tells the whole story.
6389 @c [when-split]
6390 @c Volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}, tells the whole story.
6391
6392 @page
6393 @node Answers to Exercises, , Programming Tutorial, Tutorial
6394 @section Answers to Exercises
6395
6396 @noindent
6397 This section includes answers to all the exercises in the Calc tutorial.
6398
6399 @menu
6400 * RPN Answer 1:: 1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -
6401 * RPN Answer 2:: 2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4
6402 * RPN Answer 3:: Operating on levels 2 and 3
6403 * RPN Answer 4:: Joe's complex problems
6404 * Algebraic Answer 1:: Simulating Q command
6405 * Algebraic Answer 2:: Joe's algebraic woes
6406 * Algebraic Answer 3:: 1 / 0
6407 * Modes Answer 1:: 3#0.1 = 3#0.0222222?
6408 * Modes Answer 2:: 16#f.e8fe15
6409 * Modes Answer 3:: Joe's rounding bug
6410 * Modes Answer 4:: Why floating point?
6411 * Arithmetic Answer 1:: Why the \ command?
6412 * Arithmetic Answer 2:: Tripping up the B command
6413 * Vector Answer 1:: Normalizing a vector
6414 * Vector Answer 2:: Average position
6415 * Matrix Answer 1:: Row and column sums
6416 * Matrix Answer 2:: Symbolic system of equations
6417 * Matrix Answer 3:: Over-determined system
6418 * List Answer 1:: Powers of two
6419 * List Answer 2:: Least-squares fit with matrices
6420 * List Answer 3:: Geometric mean
6421 * List Answer 4:: Divisor function
6422 * List Answer 5:: Duplicate factors
6423 * List Answer 6:: Triangular list
6424 * List Answer 7:: Another triangular list
6425 * List Answer 8:: Maximum of Bessel function
6426 * List Answer 9:: Integers the hard way
6427 * List Answer 10:: All elements equal
6428 * List Answer 11:: Estimating pi with darts
6429 * List Answer 12:: Estimating pi with matchsticks
6430 * List Answer 13:: Hash codes
6431 * List Answer 14:: Random walk
6432 * Types Answer 1:: Square root of pi times rational
6433 * Types Answer 2:: Infinities
6434 * Types Answer 3:: What can "nan" be?
6435 * Types Answer 4:: Abbey Road
6436 * Types Answer 5:: Friday the 13th
6437 * Types Answer 6:: Leap years
6438 * Types Answer 7:: Erroneous donut
6439 * Types Answer 8:: Dividing intervals
6440 * Types Answer 9:: Squaring intervals
6441 * Types Answer 10:: Fermat's primality test
6442 * Types Answer 11:: pi * 10^7 seconds
6443 * Types Answer 12:: Abbey Road on CD
6444 * Types Answer 13:: Not quite pi * 10^7 seconds
6445 * Types Answer 14:: Supercomputers and c
6446 * Types Answer 15:: Sam the Slug
6447 * Algebra Answer 1:: Squares and square roots
6448 * Algebra Answer 2:: Building polynomial from roots
6449 * Algebra Answer 3:: Integral of x sin(pi x)
6450 * Algebra Answer 4:: Simpson's rule
6451 * Rewrites Answer 1:: Multiplying by conjugate
6452 * Rewrites Answer 2:: Alternative fib rule
6453 * Rewrites Answer 3:: Rewriting opt(a) + opt(b) x
6454 * Rewrites Answer 4:: Sequence of integers
6455 * Rewrites Answer 5:: Number of terms in sum
6456 * Rewrites Answer 6:: Truncated Taylor series
6457 * Programming Answer 1:: Fresnel's C(x)
6458 * Programming Answer 2:: Negate third stack element
6459 * Programming Answer 3:: Compute sin(x) / x, etc.
6460 * Programming Answer 4:: Average value of a list
6461 * Programming Answer 5:: Continued fraction phi
6462 * Programming Answer 6:: Matrix Fibonacci numbers
6463 * Programming Answer 7:: Harmonic number greater than 4
6464 * Programming Answer 8:: Newton's method
6465 * Programming Answer 9:: Digamma function
6466 * Programming Answer 10:: Unpacking a polynomial
6467 * Programming Answer 11:: Recursive Stirling numbers
6468 * Programming Answer 12:: Stirling numbers with rewrites
6469 @end menu
6470
6471 @c The following kludgery prevents the individual answers from
6472 @c being entered on the table of contents.
6473 @tex
6474 \global\let\oldwrite=\write
6475 \gdef\skipwrite#1#2{\let\write=\oldwrite}
6476 \global\let\oldchapternofonts=\chapternofonts
6477 \gdef\chapternofonts{\let\write=\skipwrite\oldchapternofonts}
6478 @end tex
6479
6480 @node RPN Answer 1, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises, Answers to Exercises
6481 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 1
6482
6483 @noindent
6484 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -}
6485
6486 The result is
6487 @texline @math{1 - (2 \times (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6488 @infoline @expr{1 - (2 * (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6489
6490 @node RPN Answer 2, RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6491 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 2
6492
6493 @noindent
6494 @texline @math{2\times4 + 7\times9.5 + {5\over4} = 75.75}
6495 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4 = 75.75}
6496
6497 After computing the intermediate term
6498 @texline @math{2\times4 = 8},
6499 @infoline @expr{2*4 = 8},
6500 you can leave that result on the stack while you compute the second
6501 term. With both of these results waiting on the stack you can then
6502 compute the final term, then press @kbd{+ +} to add everything up.
6503
6504 @smallexample
6505 @group
6506 2: 2 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8
6507 1: 4 . 2: 7 1: 66.5
6508 . 1: 9.5 .
6509 .
6510
6511 2 @key{RET} 4 * 7 @key{RET} 9.5 *
6512
6513 @end group
6514 @end smallexample
6515 @noindent
6516 @smallexample
6517 @group
6518 4: 8 3: 8 2: 8 1: 75.75
6519 3: 66.5 2: 66.5 1: 67.75 .
6520 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6521 1: 4 .
6522 .
6523
6524 5 @key{RET} 4 / + +
6525 @end group
6526 @end smallexample
6527
6528 Alternatively, you could add the first two terms before going on
6529 with the third term.
6530
6531 @smallexample
6532 @group
6533 2: 8 1: 74.5 3: 74.5 2: 74.5 1: 75.75
6534 1: 66.5 . 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6535 . 1: 4 .
6536 .
6537
6538 ... + 5 @key{RET} 4 / +
6539 @end group
6540 @end smallexample
6541
6542 On an old-style RPN calculator this second method would have the
6543 advantage of using only three stack levels. But since Calc's stack
6544 can grow arbitrarily large this isn't really an issue. Which method
6545 you choose is purely a matter of taste.
6546
6547 @node RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 4, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6548 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 3
6549
6550 @noindent
6551 The @key{TAB} key provides a way to operate on the number in level 2.
6552
6553 @smallexample
6554 @group
6555 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10 3: 10 3: 10
6556 2: 20 2: 30 3: 30 2: 30 2: 21
6557 1: 30 1: 20 2: 20 1: 21 1: 30
6558 . . 1: 1 . .
6559 .
6560
6561 @key{TAB} 1 + @key{TAB}
6562 @end group
6563 @end smallexample
6564
6565 Similarly, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} gives you access to the number in level 3.
6566
6567 @smallexample
6568 @group
6569 3: 10 3: 21 3: 21 3: 30 3: 11
6570 2: 21 2: 30 2: 30 2: 11 2: 21
6571 1: 30 1: 10 1: 11 1: 21 1: 30
6572 . . . . .
6573
6574 M-@key{TAB} 1 + M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
6575 @end group
6576 @end smallexample
6577
6578 @node RPN Answer 4, Algebraic Answer 1, RPN Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6579 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 4
6580
6581 @noindent
6582 Either @kbd{( 2 , 3 )} or @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )} would have worked,
6583 but using both the comma and the space at once yields:
6584
6585 @smallexample
6586 @group
6587 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 2: (2, ... 2: (2, ...
6588 . 1: 2 . 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
6589 . . .
6590
6591 ( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )
6592 @end group
6593 @end smallexample
6594
6595 Joe probably tried to type @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}} to swap the
6596 extra incomplete object to the top of the stack and delete it.
6597 But a feature of Calc is that @key{DEL} on an incomplete object
6598 deletes just one component out of that object, so he had to press
6599 @key{DEL} twice to finish the job.
6600
6601 @smallexample
6602 @group
6603 2: (2, ... 2: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (2, 3)
6604 1: (2, 3) 1: (2, ... 1: ( ... .
6605 . . .
6606
6607 @key{TAB} @key{DEL} @key{DEL}
6608 @end group
6609 @end smallexample
6610
6611 (As it turns out, deleting the second-to-top stack entry happens often
6612 enough that Calc provides a special key, @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, to do just that.
6613 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} is just like @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}}, except that it doesn't exhibit
6614 the ``feature'' that tripped poor Joe.)
6615
6616 @node Algebraic Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, RPN Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6617 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 1
6618
6619 @noindent
6620 Type @kbd{' sqrt($) @key{RET}}.
6621
6622 If the @kbd{Q} key is broken, you could use @kbd{' $^0.5 @key{RET}}.
6623 Or, RPN style, @kbd{0.5 ^}.
6624
6625 (Actually, @samp{$^1:2}, using the fraction one-half as the power, is
6626 a closer equivalent, since @samp{9^0.5} yields @expr{3.0} whereas
6627 @samp{sqrt(9)} and @samp{9^1:2} yield the exact integer @expr{3}.)
6628
6629 @node Algebraic Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Algebraic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6630 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 2
6631
6632 @noindent
6633 In the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)}, @samp{x} was interpreted as a function
6634 name with @samp{1+y} as its argument. Assigning a value to a variable
6635 has no relation to a function by the same name. Joe needed to use an
6636 explicit @samp{*} symbol here: @samp{2 x*(1+y)}.
6637
6638 @node Algebraic Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6639 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 3
6640
6641 @noindent
6642 The result from @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} will be the formula @expr{1 / 0}.
6643 The ``function'' @samp{/} cannot be evaluated when its second argument
6644 is zero, so it is left in symbolic form. When you now type @kbd{0 *},
6645 the result will be zero because Calc uses the general rule that ``zero
6646 times anything is zero.''
6647
6648 @c [fix-ref Infinities]
6649 The @kbd{m i} command enables an @dfn{Infinite mode} in which @expr{1 / 0}
6650 results in a special symbol that represents ``infinity.'' If you
6651 multiply infinity by zero, Calc uses another special new symbol to
6652 show that the answer is ``indeterminate.'' @xref{Infinities}, for
6653 further discussion of infinite and indeterminate values.
6654
6655 @node Modes Answer 1, Modes Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6656 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 1
6657
6658 @noindent
6659 Calc always stores its numbers in decimal, so even though one-third has
6660 an exact base-3 representation (@samp{3#0.1}), it is still stored as
6661 0.3333333 (chopped off after 12 or however many decimal digits) inside
6662 the calculator's memory. When this inexact number is converted back
6663 to base 3 for display, it may still be slightly inexact. When we
6664 multiply this number by 3, we get 0.999999, also an inexact value.
6665
6666 When Calc displays a number in base 3, it has to decide how many digits
6667 to show. If the current precision is 12 (decimal) digits, that corresponds
6668 to @samp{12 / log10(3) = 25.15} base-3 digits. Because 25.15 is not an
6669 exact integer, Calc shows only 25 digits, with the result that stored
6670 numbers carry a little bit of extra information that may not show up on
6671 the screen. When Joe entered @samp{3#0.2}, the stored number 0.666666
6672 happened to round to a pleasing value when it lost that last 0.15 of a
6673 digit, but it was still inexact in Calc's memory. When he divided by 2,
6674 he still got the dreaded inexact value 0.333333. (Actually, he divided
6675 0.666667 by 2 to get 0.333334, which is why he got something a little
6676 higher than @code{3#0.1} instead of a little lower.)
6677
6678 If Joe didn't want to be bothered with all this, he could have typed
6679 @kbd{M-24 d n} to display with one less digit than the default. (If
6680 you give @kbd{d n} a negative argument, it uses default-minus-that,
6681 so @kbd{M-- d n} would be an easier way to get the same effect.) Those
6682 inexact results would still be lurking there, but they would now be
6683 rounded to nice, natural-looking values for display purposes. (Remember,
6684 @samp{0.022222} in base 3 is like @samp{0.099999} in base 10; rounding
6685 off one digit will round the number up to @samp{0.1}.) Depending on the
6686 nature of your work, this hiding of the inexactness may be a benefit or
6687 a danger. With the @kbd{d n} command, Calc gives you the choice.
6688
6689 Incidentally, another consequence of all this is that if you type
6690 @kbd{M-30 d n} to display more digits than are ``really there,''
6691 you'll see garbage digits at the end of the number. (In decimal
6692 display mode, with decimally-stored numbers, these garbage digits are
6693 always zero so they vanish and you don't notice them.) Because Calc
6694 rounds off that 0.15 digit, there is the danger that two numbers could
6695 be slightly different internally but still look the same. If you feel
6696 uneasy about this, set the @kbd{d n} precision to be a little higher
6697 than normal; you'll get ugly garbage digits, but you'll always be able
6698 to tell two distinct numbers apart.
6699
6700 An interesting side note is that most computers store their
6701 floating-point numbers in binary, and convert to decimal for display.
6702 Thus everyday programs have the same problem: Decimal 0.1 cannot be
6703 represented exactly in binary (try it: @kbd{0.1 d 2}), so @samp{0.1 * 10}
6704 comes out as an inexact approximation to 1 on some machines (though
6705 they generally arrange to hide it from you by rounding off one digit as
6706 we did above). Because Calc works in decimal instead of binary, you can
6707 be sure that numbers that look exact @emph{are} exact as long as you stay
6708 in decimal display mode.
6709
6710 It's not hard to show that any number that can be represented exactly
6711 in binary, octal, or hexadecimal is also exact in decimal, so the kinds
6712 of problems we saw in this exercise are likely to be severe only when
6713 you use a relatively unusual radix like 3.
6714
6715 @node Modes Answer 2, Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6716 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 2
6717
6718 If the radix is 15 or higher, we can't use the letter @samp{e} to mark
6719 the exponent because @samp{e} is interpreted as a digit. When Calc
6720 needs to display scientific notation in a high radix, it writes
6721 @samp{16#F.E8F*16.^15}. You can enter a number like this as an
6722 algebraic entry. Also, pressing @kbd{e} without any digits before it
6723 normally types @kbd{1e}, but in a high radix it types @kbd{16.^} and
6724 puts you in algebraic entry: @kbd{16#f.e8f @key{RET} e 15 @key{RET} *} is another
6725 way to enter this number.
6726
6727 The reason Calc puts a decimal point in the @samp{16.^} is to prevent
6728 huge integers from being generated if the exponent is large (consider
6729 @samp{16#1.23*16^1000}, where we compute @samp{16^1000} as a giant
6730 exact integer and then throw away most of the digits when we multiply
6731 it by the floating-point @samp{16#1.23}). While this wouldn't normally
6732 matter for display purposes, it could give you a nasty surprise if you
6733 copied that number into a file and later moved it back into Calc.
6734
6735 @node Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 4, Modes Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6736 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 3
6737
6738 @noindent
6739 The answer he got was @expr{0.5000000000006399}.
6740
6741 The problem is not that the square operation is inexact, but that the
6742 sine of 45 that was already on the stack was accurate to only 12 places.
6743 Arbitrary-precision calculations still only give answers as good as
6744 their inputs.
6745
6746 The real problem is that there is no 12-digit number which, when
6747 squared, comes out to 0.5 exactly. The @kbd{f [} and @kbd{f ]}
6748 commands decrease or increase a number by one unit in the last
6749 place (according to the current precision). They are useful for
6750 determining facts like this.
6751
6752 @smallexample
6753 @group
6754 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001
6755 . .
6756
6757 45 S 2 ^
6758
6759 @end group
6760 @end smallexample
6761 @noindent
6762 @smallexample
6763 @group
6764 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.707106781186 1: 0.499999999999
6765 . . .
6766
6767 U @key{DEL} f [ 2 ^
6768 @end group
6769 @end smallexample
6770
6771 A high-precision calculation must be carried out in high precision
6772 all the way. The only number in the original problem which was known
6773 exactly was the quantity 45 degrees, so the precision must be raised
6774 before anything is done after the number 45 has been entered in order
6775 for the higher precision to be meaningful.
6776
6777 @node Modes Answer 4, Arithmetic Answer 1, Modes Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6778 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 4
6779
6780 @noindent
6781 Many calculations involve real-world quantities, like the width and
6782 height of a piece of wood or the volume of a jar. Such quantities
6783 can't be measured exactly anyway, and if the data that is input to
6784 a calculation is inexact, doing exact arithmetic on it is a waste
6785 of time.
6786
6787 Fractions become unwieldy after too many calculations have been
6788 done with them. For example, the sum of the reciprocals of the
6789 integers from 1 to 10 is 7381:2520. The sum from 1 to 30 is
6790 9304682830147:2329089562800. After a point it will take a long
6791 time to add even one more term to this sum, but a floating-point
6792 calculation of the sum will not have this problem.
6793
6794 Also, rational numbers cannot express the results of all calculations.
6795 There is no fractional form for the square root of two, so if you type
6796 @w{@kbd{2 Q}}, Calc has no choice but to give you a floating-point answer.
6797
6798 @node Arithmetic Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 2, Modes Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6799 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 1
6800
6801 @noindent
6802 Dividing two integers that are larger than the current precision may
6803 give a floating-point result that is inaccurate even when rounded
6804 down to an integer. Consider @expr{123456789 / 2} when the current
6805 precision is 6 digits. The true answer is @expr{61728394.5}, but
6806 with a precision of 6 this will be rounded to
6807 @texline @math{12345700.0/2.0 = 61728500.0}.
6808 @infoline @expr{12345700.@: / 2.@: = 61728500.}.
6809 The result, when converted to an integer, will be off by 106.
6810
6811 Here are two solutions: Raise the precision enough that the
6812 floating-point round-off error is strictly to the right of the
6813 decimal point. Or, convert to Fraction mode so that @expr{123456789 / 2}
6814 produces the exact fraction @expr{123456789:2}, which can be rounded
6815 down by the @kbd{F} command without ever switching to floating-point
6816 format.
6817
6818 @node Arithmetic Answer 2, Vector Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6819 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 2
6820
6821 @noindent
6822 @kbd{27 @key{RET} 9 B} could give the exact result @expr{3:2}, but it
6823 does a floating-point calculation instead and produces @expr{1.5}.
6824
6825 Calc will find an exact result for a logarithm if the result is an integer
6826 or (when in Fraction mode) the reciprocal of an integer. But there is
6827 no efficient way to search the space of all possible rational numbers
6828 for an exact answer, so Calc doesn't try.
6829
6830 @node Vector Answer 1, Vector Answer 2, Arithmetic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6831 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 1
6832
6833 @noindent
6834 Duplicate the vector, compute its length, then divide the vector
6835 by its length: @kbd{@key{RET} A /}.
6836
6837 @smallexample
6838 @group
6839 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [0.27, 0.53, 0.80] 1: 1.
6840 . 1: 3.74165738677 . .
6841 .
6842
6843 r 1 @key{RET} A / A
6844 @end group
6845 @end smallexample
6846
6847 The final @kbd{A} command shows that the normalized vector does
6848 indeed have unit length.
6849
6850 @node Vector Answer 2, Matrix Answer 1, Vector Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6851 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 2
6852
6853 @noindent
6854 The average position is equal to the sum of the products of the
6855 positions times their corresponding probabilities. This is the
6856 definition of the dot product operation. So all you need to do
6857 is to put the two vectors on the stack and press @kbd{*}.
6858
6859 @node Matrix Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Vector Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6860 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 1
6861
6862 @noindent
6863 The trick is to multiply by a vector of ones. Use @kbd{r 4 [1 1 1] *} to
6864 get the row sum. Similarly, use @kbd{[1 1] r 4 *} to get the column sum.
6865
6866 @node Matrix Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Matrix Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6867 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 2
6868
6869 @ifnottex
6870 @example
6871 @group
6872 x + a y = 6
6873 x + b y = 10
6874 @end group
6875 @end example
6876 @end ifnottex
6877 @tex
6878 \turnoffactive
6879 \beforedisplay
6880 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
6881 x &+ b y = 10}
6882 $$
6883 \afterdisplay
6884 @end tex
6885
6886 Just enter the righthand side vector, then divide by the lefthand side
6887 matrix as usual.
6888
6889 @smallexample
6890 @group
6891 1: [6, 10] 2: [6, 10] 1: [6 - 4 a / (b - a), 4 / (b - a) ]
6892 . 1: [ [ 1, a ] .
6893 [ 1, b ] ]
6894 .
6895
6896 ' [6 10] @key{RET} ' [1 a; 1 b] @key{RET} /
6897 @end group
6898 @end smallexample
6899
6900 This can be made more readable using @kbd{d B} to enable Big display
6901 mode:
6902
6903 @smallexample
6904 @group
6905 4 a 4
6906 1: [6 - -----, -----]
6907 b - a b - a
6908 @end group
6909 @end smallexample
6910
6911 Type @kbd{d N} to return to Normal display mode afterwards.
6912
6913 @node Matrix Answer 3, List Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6914 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 3
6915
6916 @noindent
6917 To solve
6918 @texline @math{A^T A \, X = A^T B},
6919 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A * X = trn(A) * B},
6920 first we compute
6921 @texline @math{A' = A^T A}
6922 @infoline @expr{A2 = trn(A) * A}
6923 and
6924 @texline @math{B' = A^T B};
6925 @infoline @expr{B2 = trn(A) * B};
6926 now, we have a system
6927 @texline @math{A' X = B'}
6928 @infoline @expr{A2 * X = B2}
6929 which we can solve using Calc's @samp{/} command.
6930
6931 @ifnottex
6932 @example
6933 @group
6934 a + 2b + 3c = 6
6935 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
6936 7a + 6b = 3
6937 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
6938 @end group
6939 @end example
6940 @end ifnottex
6941 @tex
6942 \turnoffactive
6943 \beforedisplayh
6944 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
6945 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
6946 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6947 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6948 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
6949 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
6950 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
6951 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
6952 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
6953 $$
6954 \afterdisplayh
6955 @end tex
6956
6957 The first step is to enter the coefficient matrix. We'll store it in
6958 quick variable number 7 for later reference. Next, we compute the
6959 @texline @math{B'}
6960 @infoline @expr{B2}
6961 vector.
6962
6963 @smallexample
6964 @group
6965 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 4, 7, 2 ] 1: [57, 84, 96]
6966 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2, 5, 6, 4 ] .
6967 [ 7, 6, 0 ] [ 3, 6, 0, 6 ] ]
6968 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ] 1: [6, 2, 3, 11]
6969 . .
6970
6971 ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6; 7 6 0; 2 4 6] @key{RET} s 7 v t [6 2 3 11] *
6972 @end group
6973 @end smallexample
6974
6975 @noindent
6976 Now we compute the matrix
6977 @texline @math{A'}
6978 @infoline @expr{A2}
6979 and divide.
6980
6981 @smallexample
6982 @group
6983 2: [57, 84, 96] 1: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64]
6984 1: [ [ 70, 72, 39 ] .
6985 [ 72, 81, 60 ]
6986 [ 39, 60, 81 ] ]
6987 .
6988
6989 r 7 v t r 7 * /
6990 @end group
6991 @end smallexample
6992
6993 @noindent
6994 (The actual computed answer will be slightly inexact due to
6995 round-off error.)
6996
6997 Notice that the answers are similar to those for the
6998 @texline @math{3\times3}
6999 @infoline 3x3
7000 system solved in the text. That's because the fourth equation that was
7001 added to the system is almost identical to the first one multiplied
7002 by two. (If it were identical, we would have gotten the exact same
7003 answer since the
7004 @texline @math{4\times3}
7005 @infoline 4x3
7006 system would be equivalent to the original
7007 @texline @math{3\times3}
7008 @infoline 3x3
7009 system.)
7010
7011 Since the first and fourth equations aren't quite equivalent, they
7012 can't both be satisfied at once. Let's plug our answers back into
7013 the original system of equations to see how well they match.
7014
7015 @smallexample
7016 @group
7017 2: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64] 1: [5.6, 2., 3., 11.2]
7018 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
7019 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
7020 [ 7, 6, 0 ]
7021 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ]
7022 .
7023
7024 r 7 @key{TAB} *
7025 @end group
7026 @end smallexample
7027
7028 @noindent
7029 This is reasonably close to our original @expr{B} vector,
7030 @expr{[6, 2, 3, 11]}.
7031
7032 @node List Answer 1, List Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7033 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 1
7034
7035 @noindent
7036 We can use @kbd{v x} to build a vector of integers. This needs to be
7037 adjusted to get the range of integers we desire. Mapping @samp{-}
7038 across the vector will accomplish this, although it turns out the
7039 plain @samp{-} key will work just as well.
7040
7041 @smallexample
7042 @group
7043 2: 2 2: 2
7044 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9] 1: [-4, -3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4]
7045 . .
7046
7047 2 v x 9 @key{RET} 5 V M - or 5 -
7048 @end group
7049 @end smallexample
7050
7051 @noindent
7052 Now we use @kbd{V M ^} to map the exponentiation operator across the
7053 vector.
7054
7055 @smallexample
7056 @group
7057 1: [0.0625, 0.125, 0.25, 0.5, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16]
7058 .
7059
7060 V M ^
7061 @end group
7062 @end smallexample
7063
7064 @node List Answer 2, List Answer 3, List Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7065 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 2
7066
7067 @noindent
7068 Given @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors in quick variables 1 and 2 as before,
7069 the first job is to form the matrix that describes the problem.
7070
7071 @ifnottex
7072 @example
7073 m*x + b*1 = y
7074 @end example
7075 @end ifnottex
7076 @tex
7077 \turnoffactive
7078 \beforedisplay
7079 $$ m \times x + b \times 1 = y $$
7080 \afterdisplay
7081 @end tex
7082
7083 Thus we want a
7084 @texline @math{19\times2}
7085 @infoline 19x2
7086 matrix with our @expr{x} vector as one column and
7087 ones as the other column. So, first we build the column of ones, then
7088 we combine the two columns to form our @expr{A} matrix.
7089
7090 @smallexample
7091 @group
7092 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 1: [ [ 1.34, 1 ]
7093 1: [1, 1, 1, ...] [ 1.41, 1 ]
7094 . [ 1.49, 1 ]
7095 @dots{}
7096
7097 r 1 1 v b 19 @key{RET} M-2 v p v t s 3
7098 @end group
7099 @end smallexample
7100
7101 @noindent
7102 Now we compute
7103 @texline @math{A^T y}
7104 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * y}
7105 and
7106 @texline @math{A^T A}
7107 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A}
7108 and divide.
7109
7110 @smallexample
7111 @group
7112 1: [33.36554, 13.613] 2: [33.36554, 13.613]
7113 . 1: [ [ 98.0003, 41.63 ]
7114 [ 41.63, 19 ] ]
7115 .
7116
7117 v t r 2 * r 3 v t r 3 *
7118 @end group
7119 @end smallexample
7120
7121 @noindent
7122 (Hey, those numbers look familiar!)
7123
7124 @smallexample
7125 @group
7126 1: [0.52141679, -0.425978]
7127 .
7128
7129 /
7130 @end group
7131 @end smallexample
7132
7133 Since we were solving equations of the form
7134 @texline @math{m \times x + b \times 1 = y},
7135 @infoline @expr{m*x + b*1 = y},
7136 these numbers should be @expr{m} and @expr{b}, respectively. Sure
7137 enough, they agree exactly with the result computed using @kbd{V M} and
7138 @kbd{V R}!
7139
7140 The moral of this story: @kbd{V M} and @kbd{V R} will probably solve
7141 your problem, but there is often an easier way using the higher-level
7142 arithmetic functions!
7143
7144 @c [fix-ref Curve Fitting]
7145 In fact, there is a built-in @kbd{a F} command that does least-squares
7146 fits. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
7147
7148 @node List Answer 3, List Answer 4, List Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7149 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 3
7150
7151 @noindent
7152 Move to one end of the list and press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or
7153 whatever) to set the mark, then move to the other end of the list
7154 and type @w{@kbd{C-x * g}}.
7155
7156 @smallexample
7157 @group
7158 1: [2.3, 6, 22, 15.1, 7, 15, 14, 7.5, 2.5]
7159 .
7160 @end group
7161 @end smallexample
7162
7163 To make things interesting, let's assume we don't know at a glance
7164 how many numbers are in this list. Then we could type:
7165
7166 @smallexample
7167 @group
7168 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ]
7169 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 126356422.5
7170 . .
7171
7172 @key{RET} V R *
7173
7174 @end group
7175 @end smallexample
7176 @noindent
7177 @smallexample
7178 @group
7179 2: 126356422.5 2: 126356422.5 1: 7.94652913734
7180 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 9 .
7181 . .
7182
7183 @key{TAB} v l I ^
7184 @end group
7185 @end smallexample
7186
7187 @noindent
7188 (The @kbd{I ^} command computes the @var{n}th root of a number.
7189 You could also type @kbd{& ^} to take the reciprocal of 9 and
7190 then raise the number to that power.)
7191
7192 @node List Answer 4, List Answer 5, List Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7193 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 4
7194
7195 @noindent
7196 A number @expr{j} is a divisor of @expr{n} if
7197 @texline @math{n \mathbin{\hbox{\code{\%}}} j = 0}.
7198 @infoline @samp{n % j = 0}.
7199 The first step is to get a vector that identifies the divisors.
7200
7201 @smallexample
7202 @group
7203 2: 30 2: [0, 0, 0, 2, ...] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...]
7204 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: 0 .
7205 . .
7206
7207 30 @key{RET} v x 30 @key{RET} s 1 V M % 0 V M a = s 2
7208 @end group
7209 @end smallexample
7210
7211 @noindent
7212 This vector has 1's marking divisors of 30 and 0's marking non-divisors.
7213
7214 The zeroth divisor function is just the total number of divisors.
7215 The first divisor function is the sum of the divisors.
7216
7217 @smallexample
7218 @group
7219 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8 2: 8
7220 2: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: [1, 2, 3, 0, ...] 1: 72
7221 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...] . .
7222 .
7223
7224 V R + r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
7225 @end group
7226 @end smallexample
7227
7228 @noindent
7229 Once again, the last two steps just compute a dot product for which
7230 a simple @kbd{*} would have worked equally well.
7231
7232 @node List Answer 5, List Answer 6, List Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
7233 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 5
7234
7235 @noindent
7236 The obvious first step is to obtain the list of factors with @kbd{k f}.
7237 This list will always be in sorted order, so if there are duplicates
7238 they will be right next to each other. A suitable method is to compare
7239 the list with a copy of itself shifted over by one.
7240
7241 @smallexample
7242 @group
7243 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0]
7244 . 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0] 1: [0, 3, 7, 7, 7, 19]
7245 . .
7246
7247 19551 k f @key{RET} 0 | @key{TAB} 0 @key{TAB} |
7248
7249 @end group
7250 @end smallexample
7251 @noindent
7252 @smallexample
7253 @group
7254 1: [0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0] 1: 2 1: 0
7255 . . .
7256
7257 V M a = V R + 0 a =
7258 @end group
7259 @end smallexample
7260
7261 @noindent
7262 Note that we have to arrange for both vectors to have the same length
7263 so that the mapping operation works; no prime factor will ever be
7264 zero, so adding zeros on the left and right is safe. From then on
7265 the job is pretty straightforward.
7266
7267 Incidentally, Calc provides the
7268 @texline @dfn{M@"obius} @math{\mu}
7269 @infoline @dfn{Moebius mu}
7270 function which is zero if and only if its argument is square-free. It
7271 would be a much more convenient way to do the above test in practice.
7272
7273 @node List Answer 6, List Answer 7, List Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
7274 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 6
7275
7276 @noindent
7277 First use @kbd{v x 6 @key{RET}} to get a list of integers, then @kbd{V M v x}
7278 to get a list of lists of integers!
7279
7280 @node List Answer 7, List Answer 8, List Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
7281 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 7
7282
7283 @noindent
7284 Here's one solution. First, compute the triangular list from the previous
7285 exercise and type @kbd{1 -} to subtract one from all the elements.
7286
7287 @smallexample
7288 @group
7289 1: [ [0],
7290 [0, 1],
7291 [0, 1, 2],
7292 @dots{}
7293
7294 1 -
7295 @end group
7296 @end smallexample
7297
7298 The numbers down the lefthand edge of the list we desire are called
7299 the ``triangular numbers'' (now you know why!). The @expr{n}th
7300 triangular number is the sum of the integers from 1 to @expr{n}, and
7301 can be computed directly by the formula
7302 @texline @math{n (n+1) \over 2}.
7303 @infoline @expr{n * (n+1) / 2}.
7304
7305 @smallexample
7306 @group
7307 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7308 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7309 . .
7310
7311 v x 6 @key{RET} 1 - V M ' $ ($+1)/2 @key{RET}
7312 @end group
7313 @end smallexample
7314
7315 @noindent
7316 Adding this list to the above list of lists produces the desired
7317 result:
7318
7319 @smallexample
7320 @group
7321 1: [ [0],
7322 [1, 2],
7323 [3, 4, 5],
7324 [6, 7, 8, 9],
7325 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
7326 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
7327 .
7328
7329 V M +
7330 @end group
7331 @end smallexample
7332
7333 If we did not know the formula for triangular numbers, we could have
7334 computed them using a @kbd{V U +} command. We could also have
7335 gotten them the hard way by mapping a reduction across the original
7336 triangular list.
7337
7338 @smallexample
7339 @group
7340 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7341 1: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7342 . .
7343
7344 @key{RET} V M V R +
7345 @end group
7346 @end smallexample
7347
7348 @noindent
7349 (This means ``map a @kbd{V R +} command across the vector,'' and
7350 since each element of the main vector is itself a small vector,
7351 @kbd{V R +} computes the sum of its elements.)
7352
7353 @node List Answer 8, List Answer 9, List Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
7354 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 8
7355
7356 @noindent
7357 The first step is to build a list of values of @expr{x}.
7358
7359 @smallexample
7360 @group
7361 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 21] 1: [0, 1, 2, ..., 20] 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ..., 5]
7362 . . .
7363
7364 v x 21 @key{RET} 1 - 4 / s 1
7365 @end group
7366 @end smallexample
7367
7368 Next, we compute the Bessel function values.
7369
7370 @smallexample
7371 @group
7372 1: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ..., -0.328]
7373 .
7374
7375 V M ' besJ(1,$) @key{RET}
7376 @end group
7377 @end smallexample
7378
7379 @noindent
7380 (Another way to do this would be @kbd{1 @key{TAB} V M f j}.)
7381
7382 A way to isolate the maximum value is to compute the maximum using
7383 @kbd{V R X}, then compare all the Bessel values with that maximum.
7384
7385 @smallexample
7386 @group
7387 2: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ]
7388 1: 0.5801562 . 1: 1
7389 . .
7390
7391 @key{RET} V R X V M a = @key{RET} V R + @key{DEL}
7392 @end group
7393 @end smallexample
7394
7395 @noindent
7396 It's a good idea to verify, as in the last step above, that only
7397 one value is equal to the maximum. (After all, a plot of
7398 @texline @math{\sin x}
7399 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
7400 might have many points all equal to the maximum value, 1.)
7401
7402 The vector we have now has a single 1 in the position that indicates
7403 the maximum value of @expr{x}. Now it is a simple matter to convert
7404 this back into the corresponding value itself.
7405
7406 @smallexample
7407 @group
7408 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0., 0., ... ] 1: 1.75
7409 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ... ] . .
7410 .
7411
7412 r 1 V M * V R +
7413 @end group
7414 @end smallexample
7415
7416 If @kbd{a =} had produced more than one @expr{1} value, this method
7417 would have given the sum of all maximum @expr{x} values; not very
7418 useful! In this case we could have used @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector})
7419 instead. This command deletes all elements of a ``data'' vector that
7420 correspond to zeros in a ``mask'' vector, leaving us with, in this
7421 example, a vector of maximum @expr{x} values.
7422
7423 The built-in @kbd{a X} command maximizes a function using more
7424 efficient methods. Just for illustration, let's use @kbd{a X}
7425 to maximize @samp{besJ(1,x)} over this same interval.
7426
7427 @smallexample
7428 @group
7429 2: besJ(1, x) 1: [1.84115, 0.581865]
7430 1: [0 .. 5] .
7431 .
7432
7433 ' besJ(1,x), [0..5] @key{RET} a X x @key{RET}
7434 @end group
7435 @end smallexample
7436
7437 @noindent
7438 The output from @kbd{a X} is a vector containing the value of @expr{x}
7439 that maximizes the function, and the function's value at that maximum.
7440 As you can see, our simple search got quite close to the right answer.
7441
7442 @node List Answer 9, List Answer 10, List Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
7443 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 9
7444
7445 @noindent
7446 Step one is to convert our integer into vector notation.
7447
7448 @smallexample
7449 @group
7450 1: 25129925999 3: 25129925999
7451 . 2: 10
7452 1: [11, 10, 9, ..., 1, 0]
7453 .
7454
7455 25129925999 @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 12 @key{RET} v x 12 @key{RET} -
7456
7457 @end group
7458 @end smallexample
7459 @noindent
7460 @smallexample
7461 @group
7462 1: 25129925999 1: [0, 2, 25, 251, 2512, ... ]
7463 2: [100000000000, ... ] .
7464 .
7465
7466 V M ^ s 1 V M \
7467 @end group
7468 @end smallexample
7469
7470 @noindent
7471 (Recall, the @kbd{\} command computes an integer quotient.)
7472
7473 @smallexample
7474 @group
7475 1: [0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 5, 9, 9, 9]
7476 .
7477
7478 10 V M % s 2
7479 @end group
7480 @end smallexample
7481
7482 Next we must increment this number. This involves adding one to
7483 the last digit, plus handling carries. There is a carry to the
7484 left out of a digit if that digit is a nine and all the digits to
7485 the right of it are nines.
7486
7487 @smallexample
7488 @group
7489 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, ... ]
7490 . .
7491
7492 9 V M a = v v
7493
7494 @end group
7495 @end smallexample
7496 @noindent
7497 @smallexample
7498 @group
7499 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1]
7500 . .
7501
7502 V U * v v 1 |
7503 @end group
7504 @end smallexample
7505
7506 @noindent
7507 Accumulating @kbd{*} across a vector of ones and zeros will preserve
7508 only the initial run of ones. These are the carries into all digits
7509 except the rightmost digit. Concatenating a one on the right takes
7510 care of aligning the carries properly, and also adding one to the
7511 rightmost digit.
7512
7513 @smallexample
7514 @group
7515 2: [0, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 6, 0, 0, 0]
7516 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] .
7517 .
7518
7519 0 r 2 | V M + 10 V M %
7520 @end group
7521 @end smallexample
7522
7523 @noindent
7524 Here we have concatenated 0 to the @emph{left} of the original number;
7525 this takes care of shifting the carries by one with respect to the
7526 digits that generated them.
7527
7528 Finally, we must convert this list back into an integer.
7529
7530 @smallexample
7531 @group
7532 3: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ]
7533 2: 1000000000000 1: [1000000000000, 100000000000, ... ]
7534 1: [100000000000, ... ] .
7535 .
7536
7537 10 @key{RET} 12 ^ r 1 |
7538
7539 @end group
7540 @end smallexample
7541 @noindent
7542 @smallexample
7543 @group
7544 1: [0, 0, 20000000000, 5000000000, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7545 . .
7546
7547 V M * V R +
7548 @end group
7549 @end smallexample
7550
7551 @noindent
7552 Another way to do this final step would be to reduce the formula
7553 @w{@samp{10 $$ + $}} across the vector of digits.
7554
7555 @smallexample
7556 @group
7557 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7558 . .
7559
7560 V R ' 10 $$ + $ @key{RET}
7561 @end group
7562 @end smallexample
7563
7564 @node List Answer 10, List Answer 11, List Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
7565 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 10
7566
7567 @noindent
7568 For the list @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, the result is @expr{((a = b) = c) = d},
7569 which will compare @expr{a} and @expr{b} to produce a 1 or 0, which is
7570 then compared with @expr{c} to produce another 1 or 0, which is then
7571 compared with @expr{d}. This is not at all what Joe wanted.
7572
7573 Here's a more correct method:
7574
7575 @smallexample
7576 @group
7577 1: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7] 2: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7]
7578 . 1: 7
7579 .
7580
7581 ' [7,7,7,8,7] @key{RET} @key{RET} v r 1 @key{RET}
7582
7583 @end group
7584 @end smallexample
7585 @noindent
7586 @smallexample
7587 @group
7588 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 1] 1: 0
7589 . .
7590
7591 V M a = V R *
7592 @end group
7593 @end smallexample
7594
7595 @node List Answer 11, List Answer 12, List Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
7596 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 11
7597
7598 @noindent
7599 The circle of unit radius consists of those points @expr{(x,y)} for which
7600 @expr{x^2 + y^2 < 1}. We start by generating a vector of @expr{x^2}
7601 and a vector of @expr{y^2}.
7602
7603 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7604 commands.
7605
7606 @smallexample
7607 @group
7608 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.]
7609 1: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [1.16, 1.98, ..., 0.81]
7610 . .
7611
7612 v . t . 2. v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r
7613
7614 @end group
7615 @end smallexample
7616 @noindent
7617 @smallexample
7618 @group
7619 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036]
7620 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036] 2: [0.53, 0.81, ..., 0.094]
7621 . .
7622
7623 1 - 2 V M ^ @key{TAB} V M k r 1 - 2 V M ^
7624 @end group
7625 @end smallexample
7626
7627 Now we sum the @expr{x^2} and @expr{y^2} values, compare with 1 to
7628 get a vector of 1/0 truth values, then sum the truth values.
7629
7630 @smallexample
7631 @group
7632 1: [0.56, 1.78, ..., 0.13] 1: [1, 0, ..., 1] 1: 84
7633 . . .
7634
7635 + 1 V M a < V R +
7636 @end group
7637 @end smallexample
7638
7639 @noindent
7640 The ratio @expr{84/100} should approximate the ratio @cpiover{4}.
7641
7642 @smallexample
7643 @group
7644 1: 0.84 1: 3.36 2: 3.36 1: 1.0695
7645 . . 1: 3.14159 .
7646
7647 100 / 4 * P /
7648 @end group
7649 @end smallexample
7650
7651 @noindent
7652 Our estimate, 3.36, is off by about 7%. We could get a better estimate
7653 by taking more points (say, 1000), but it's clear that this method is
7654 not very efficient!
7655
7656 (Naturally, since this example uses random numbers your own answer
7657 will be slightly different from the one shown here!)
7658
7659 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7660 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7661
7662 @node List Answer 12, List Answer 13, List Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
7663 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 12
7664
7665 @noindent
7666 This problem can be made a lot easier by taking advantage of some
7667 symmetries. First of all, after some thought it's clear that the
7668 @expr{y} axis can be ignored altogether. Just pick a random @expr{x}
7669 component for one end of the match, pick a random direction
7670 @texline @math{\theta},
7671 @infoline @expr{theta},
7672 and see if @expr{x} and
7673 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta}
7674 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)}
7675 (which is the @expr{x} coordinate of the other endpoint) cross a line.
7676 The lines are at integer coordinates, so this happens when the two
7677 numbers surround an integer.
7678
7679 Since the two endpoints are equivalent, we may as well choose the leftmost
7680 of the two endpoints as @expr{x}. Then @expr{theta} is an angle pointing
7681 to the right, in the range -90 to 90 degrees. (We could use radians, but
7682 it would feel like cheating to refer to @cpiover{2} radians while trying
7683 to estimate @cpi{}!)
7684
7685 In fact, since the field of lines is infinite we can choose the
7686 coordinates 0 and 1 for the lines on either side of the leftmost
7687 endpoint. The rightmost endpoint will be between 0 and 1 if the
7688 match does not cross a line, or between 1 and 2 if it does. So:
7689 Pick random @expr{x} and
7690 @texline @math{\theta},
7691 @infoline @expr{theta},
7692 compute
7693 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta},
7694 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)},
7695 and count how many of the results are greater than one. Simple!
7696
7697 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7698 commands.
7699
7700 @smallexample
7701 @group
7702 1: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72]
7703 . 1: [78.4, 64.5, ..., -42.9]
7704 .
7705
7706 v . t . 1. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 180. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 90 -
7707 @end group
7708 @end smallexample
7709
7710 @noindent
7711 (The next step may be slow, depending on the speed of your computer.)
7712
7713 @smallexample
7714 @group
7715 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 1: [0.72, 1.14, ..., 1.45]
7716 1: [0.20, 0.43, ..., 0.73] .
7717 .
7718
7719 m d V M C +
7720
7721 @end group
7722 @end smallexample
7723 @noindent
7724 @smallexample
7725 @group
7726 1: [0, 1, ..., 1] 1: 0.64 1: 3.125
7727 . . .
7728
7729 1 V M a > V R + 100 / 2 @key{TAB} /
7730 @end group
7731 @end smallexample
7732
7733 Let's try the third method, too. We'll use random integers up to
7734 one million. The @kbd{k r} command with an integer argument picks
7735 a random integer.
7736
7737 @smallexample
7738 @group
7739 2: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 2: [78489, 527587, ..., 814975]
7740 1: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 1: [324014, 358783, ..., 955450]
7741 . .
7742
7743 1000000 v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r @key{TAB} V M k r
7744
7745 @end group
7746 @end smallexample
7747 @noindent
7748 @smallexample
7749 @group
7750 1: [1, 1, ..., 25] 1: [1, 1, ..., 0] 1: 0.56
7751 . . .
7752
7753 V M k g 1 V M a = V R + 100 /
7754
7755 @end group
7756 @end smallexample
7757 @noindent
7758 @smallexample
7759 @group
7760 1: 10.714 1: 3.273
7761 . .
7762
7763 6 @key{TAB} / Q
7764 @end group
7765 @end smallexample
7766
7767 For a proof of this property of the GCD function, see section 4.5.2,
7768 exercise 10, of Knuth's @emph{Art of Computer Programming}, volume II.
7769
7770 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7771 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7772
7773 @node List Answer 13, List Answer 14, List Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
7774 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 13
7775
7776 @noindent
7777 First, we put the string on the stack as a vector of ASCII codes.
7778
7779 @smallexample
7780 @group
7781 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7782 .
7783
7784 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET}
7785 @end group
7786 @end smallexample
7787
7788 @noindent
7789 Note that the @kbd{"} key, like @kbd{$}, initiates algebraic entry so
7790 there was no need to type an apostrophe. Also, Calc didn't mind that
7791 we omitted the closing @kbd{"}. (The same goes for all closing delimiters
7792 like @kbd{)} and @kbd{]} at the end of a formula.
7793
7794 We'll show two different approaches here. In the first, we note that
7795 if the input vector is @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, then the hash code is
7796 @expr{3 (3 (3a + b) + c) + d = 27a + 9b + 3c + d}. In other words,
7797 it's a sum of descending powers of three times the ASCII codes.
7798
7799 @smallexample
7800 @group
7801 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7802 1: 16 1: [15, 14, 13, ..., 0]
7803 . .
7804
7805 @key{RET} v l v x 16 @key{RET} -
7806
7807 @end group
7808 @end smallexample
7809 @noindent
7810 @smallexample
7811 @group
7812 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098 1: 121
7813 1: [14348907, ..., 1] . .
7814 .
7815
7816 3 @key{TAB} V M ^ * 511 %
7817 @end group
7818 @end smallexample
7819
7820 @noindent
7821 Once again, @kbd{*} elegantly summarizes most of the computation.
7822 But there's an even more elegant approach: Reduce the formula
7823 @kbd{3 $$ + $} across the vector. Recall that this represents a
7824 function of two arguments that computes its first argument times three
7825 plus its second argument.
7826
7827 @smallexample
7828 @group
7829 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098
7830 . .
7831
7832 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' 3$$+$ @key{RET}
7833 @end group
7834 @end smallexample
7835
7836 @noindent
7837 If you did the decimal arithmetic exercise, this will be familiar.
7838 Basically, we're turning a base-3 vector of digits into an integer,
7839 except that our ``digits'' are much larger than real digits.
7840
7841 Instead of typing @kbd{511 %} again to reduce the result, we can be
7842 cleverer still and notice that rather than computing a huge integer
7843 and taking the modulo at the end, we can take the modulo at each step
7844 without affecting the result. While this means there are more
7845 arithmetic operations, the numbers we operate on remain small so
7846 the operations are faster.
7847
7848 @smallexample
7849 @group
7850 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 121
7851 . .
7852
7853 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' (3$$+$)%511 @key{RET}
7854 @end group
7855 @end smallexample
7856
7857 Why does this work? Think about a two-step computation:
7858 @w{@expr{3 (3a + b) + c}}. Taking a result modulo 511 basically means
7859 subtracting off enough 511's to put the result in the desired range.
7860 So the result when we take the modulo after every step is,
7861
7862 @ifnottex
7863 @example
7864 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n
7865 @end example
7866 @end ifnottex
7867 @tex
7868 \turnoffactive
7869 \beforedisplay
7870 $$ 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n $$
7871 \afterdisplay
7872 @end tex
7873
7874 @noindent
7875 for some suitable integers @expr{m} and @expr{n}. Expanding out by
7876 the distributive law yields
7877
7878 @ifnottex
7879 @example
7880 9 a + 3 b + c - 511*3 m - 511 n
7881 @end example
7882 @end ifnottex
7883 @tex
7884 \turnoffactive
7885 \beforedisplay
7886 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511\times3 m - 511 n $$
7887 \afterdisplay
7888 @end tex
7889
7890 @noindent
7891 The @expr{m} term in the latter formula is redundant because any
7892 contribution it makes could just as easily be made by the @expr{n}
7893 term. So we can take it out to get an equivalent formula with
7894 @expr{n' = 3m + n},
7895
7896 @ifnottex
7897 @example
7898 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n'
7899 @end example
7900 @end ifnottex
7901 @tex
7902 \turnoffactive
7903 \beforedisplay
7904 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n' $$
7905 \afterdisplay
7906 @end tex
7907
7908 @noindent
7909 which is just the formula for taking the modulo only at the end of
7910 the calculation. Therefore the two methods are essentially the same.
7911
7912 Later in the tutorial we will encounter @dfn{modulo forms}, which
7913 basically automate the idea of reducing every intermediate result
7914 modulo some value @var{m}.
7915
7916 @node List Answer 14, Types Answer 1, List Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
7917 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 14
7918
7919 We want to use @kbd{H V U} to nest a function which adds a random
7920 step to an @expr{(x,y)} coordinate. The function is a bit long, but
7921 otherwise the problem is quite straightforward.
7922
7923 @smallexample
7924 @group
7925 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7926 1: 50 [ 0.4288, -0.1695 ]
7927 . [ -0.4787, -0.9027 ]
7928 ...
7929
7930 [0,0] 50 H V U ' <# + [random(2.0)-1, random(2.0)-1]> @key{RET}
7931 @end group
7932 @end smallexample
7933
7934 Just as the text recommended, we used @samp{< >} nameless function
7935 notation to keep the two @code{random} calls from being evaluated
7936 before nesting even begins.
7937
7938 We now have a vector of @expr{[x, y]} sub-vectors, which by Calc's
7939 rules acts like a matrix. We can transpose this matrix and unpack
7940 to get a pair of vectors, @expr{x} and @expr{y}, suitable for graphing.
7941
7942 @smallexample
7943 @group
7944 2: [ 0, 0.4288, -0.4787, ... ]
7945 1: [ 0, -0.1696, -0.9027, ... ]
7946 .
7947
7948 v t v u g f
7949 @end group
7950 @end smallexample
7951
7952 Incidentally, because the @expr{x} and @expr{y} are completely
7953 independent in this case, we could have done two separate commands
7954 to create our @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers directly.
7955
7956 To make a random walk of unit steps, we note that @code{sincos} of
7957 a random direction exactly gives us an @expr{[x, y]} step of unit
7958 length; in fact, the new nesting function is even briefer, though
7959 we might want to lower the precision a bit for it.
7960
7961 @smallexample
7962 @group
7963 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7964 1: 50 [ 0.1318, 0.9912 ]
7965 . [ -0.5965, 0.3061 ]
7966 ...
7967
7968 [0,0] 50 m d p 6 @key{RET} H V U ' <# + sincos(random(360.0))> @key{RET}
7969 @end group
7970 @end smallexample
7971
7972 Another @kbd{v t v u g f} sequence will graph this new random walk.
7973
7974 An interesting twist on these random walk functions would be to use
7975 complex numbers instead of 2-vectors to represent points on the plane.
7976 In the first example, we'd use something like @samp{random + random*(0,1)},
7977 and in the second we could use polar complex numbers with random phase
7978 angles. (This exercise was first suggested in this form by Randal
7979 Schwartz.)
7980
7981 @node Types Answer 1, Types Answer 2, List Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
7982 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 1
7983
7984 @noindent
7985 If the number is the square root of @cpi{} times a rational number,
7986 then its square, divided by @cpi{}, should be a rational number.
7987
7988 @smallexample
7989 @group
7990 1: 1.26508260337 1: 0.509433962268 1: 2486645810:4881193627
7991 . . .
7992
7993 2 ^ P / c F
7994 @end group
7995 @end smallexample
7996
7997 @noindent
7998 Technically speaking this is a rational number, but not one that is
7999 likely to have arisen in the original problem. More likely, it just
8000 happens to be the fraction which most closely represents some
8001 irrational number to within 12 digits.
8002
8003 But perhaps our result was not quite exact. Let's reduce the
8004 precision slightly and try again:
8005
8006 @smallexample
8007 @group
8008 1: 0.509433962268 1: 27:53
8009 . .
8010
8011 U p 10 @key{RET} c F
8012 @end group
8013 @end smallexample
8014
8015 @noindent
8016 Aha! It's unlikely that an irrational number would equal a fraction
8017 this simple to within ten digits, so our original number was probably
8018 @texline @math{\sqrt{27 \pi / 53}}.
8019 @infoline @expr{sqrt(27 pi / 53)}.
8020
8021 Notice that we didn't need to re-round the number when we reduced the
8022 precision. Remember, arithmetic operations always round their inputs
8023 to the current precision before they begin.
8024
8025 @node Types Answer 2, Types Answer 3, Types Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8026 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 2
8027
8028 @noindent
8029 @samp{inf / inf = nan}. Perhaps @samp{1} is the ``obvious'' answer.
8030 But if @w{@samp{17 inf = inf}}, then @samp{17 inf / inf = inf / inf = 17}, too.
8031
8032 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}. It's tempting to say that the exponential
8033 of infinity must be ``bigger'' than ``regular'' infinity, but as
8034 far as Calc is concerned all infinities are the same size.
8035 In other words, as @expr{x} goes to infinity, @expr{e^x} also goes
8036 to infinity, but the fact the @expr{e^x} grows much faster than
8037 @expr{x} is not relevant here.
8038
8039 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. Here we have a finite answer even though
8040 the input is infinite.
8041
8042 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = (0, 1) inf}. Remember that @expr{(0, 1)}
8043 represents the imaginary number @expr{i}. Here's a derivation:
8044 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = @w{sqrt((-1) * inf)} = sqrt(-1) * sqrt(inf)}.
8045 The first part is, by definition, @expr{i}; the second is @code{inf}
8046 because, once again, all infinities are the same size.
8047
8048 @samp{sqrt(uinf) = uinf}. In fact, we do know something about the
8049 direction because @code{sqrt} is defined to return a value in the
8050 right half of the complex plane. But Calc has no notation for this,
8051 so it settles for the conservative answer @code{uinf}.
8052
8053 @samp{abs(uinf) = inf}. No matter which direction @expr{x} points,
8054 @samp{abs(x)} always points along the positive real axis.
8055
8056 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}. Here we have an infinite answer to a finite
8057 input. As in the @expr{1 / 0} case, Calc will only use infinities
8058 here if you have turned on Infinite mode. Otherwise, it will
8059 treat @samp{ln(0)} as an error.
8060
8061 @node Types Answer 3, Types Answer 4, Types Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8062 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 3
8063
8064 @noindent
8065 We can make @samp{inf - inf} be any real number we like, say,
8066 @expr{a}, just by claiming that we added @expr{a} to the first
8067 infinity but not to the second. This is just as true for complex
8068 values of @expr{a}, so @code{nan} can stand for a complex number.
8069 (And, similarly, @code{uinf} can stand for an infinity that points
8070 in any direction in the complex plane, such as @samp{(0, 1) inf}).
8071
8072 In fact, we can multiply the first @code{inf} by two. Surely
8073 @w{@samp{2 inf - inf = inf}}, but also @samp{2 inf - inf = inf - inf = nan}.
8074 So @code{nan} can even stand for infinity. Obviously it's just
8075 as easy to make it stand for minus infinity as for plus infinity.
8076
8077 The moral of this story is that ``infinity'' is a slippery fish
8078 indeed, and Calc tries to handle it by having a very simple model
8079 for infinities (only the direction counts, not the ``size''); but
8080 Calc is careful to write @code{nan} any time this simple model is
8081 unable to tell what the true answer is.
8082
8083 @node Types Answer 4, Types Answer 5, Types Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8084 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 4
8085
8086 @smallexample
8087 @group
8088 2: 0@@ 47' 26" 1: 0@@ 2' 47.411765"
8089 1: 17 .
8090 .
8091
8092 0@@ 47' 26" @key{RET} 17 /
8093 @end group
8094 @end smallexample
8095
8096 @noindent
8097 The average song length is two minutes and 47.4 seconds.
8098
8099 @smallexample
8100 @group
8101 2: 0@@ 2' 47.411765" 1: 0@@ 3' 7.411765" 1: 0@@ 53' 6.000005"
8102 1: 0@@ 0' 20" . .
8103 .
8104
8105 20" + 17 *
8106 @end group
8107 @end smallexample
8108
8109 @noindent
8110 The album would be 53 minutes and 6 seconds long.
8111
8112 @node Types Answer 5, Types Answer 6, Types Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8113 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 5
8114
8115 @noindent
8116 Let's suppose it's January 14, 1991. The easiest thing to do is
8117 to keep trying 13ths of months until Calc reports a Friday.
8118 We can do this by manually entering dates, or by using @kbd{t I}:
8119
8120 @smallexample
8121 @group
8122 1: <Wed Feb 13, 1991> 1: <Wed Mar 13, 1991> 1: <Sat Apr 13, 1991>
8123 . . .
8124
8125 ' <2/13> @key{RET} @key{DEL} ' <3/13> @key{RET} t I
8126 @end group
8127 @end smallexample
8128
8129 @noindent
8130 (Calc assumes the current year if you don't say otherwise.)
8131
8132 This is getting tedious---we can keep advancing the date by typing
8133 @kbd{t I} over and over again, but let's automate the job by using
8134 vector mapping. The @kbd{t I} command actually takes a second
8135 ``how-many-months'' argument, which defaults to one. This
8136 argument is exactly what we want to map over:
8137
8138 @smallexample
8139 @group
8140 2: <Sat Apr 13, 1991> 1: [<Mon May 13, 1991>, <Thu Jun 13, 1991>,
8141 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] <Sat Jul 13, 1991>, <Tue Aug 13, 1991>,
8142 . <Fri Sep 13, 1991>, <Sun Oct 13, 1991>]
8143 .
8144
8145 v x 6 @key{RET} V M t I
8146 @end group
8147 @end smallexample
8148
8149 @noindent
8150 Et voil@`a, September 13, 1991 is a Friday.
8151
8152 @smallexample
8153 @group
8154 1: 242
8155 .
8156
8157 ' <sep 13> - <jan 14> @key{RET}
8158 @end group
8159 @end smallexample
8160
8161 @noindent
8162 And the answer to our original question: 242 days to go.
8163
8164 @node Types Answer 6, Types Answer 7, Types Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8165 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 6
8166
8167 @noindent
8168 The full rule for leap years is that they occur in every year divisible
8169 by four, except that they don't occur in years divisible by 100, except
8170 that they @emph{do} in years divisible by 400. We could work out the
8171 answer by carefully counting the years divisible by four and the
8172 exceptions, but there is a much simpler way that works even if we
8173 don't know the leap year rule.
8174
8175 Let's assume the present year is 1991. Years have 365 days, except
8176 that leap years (whenever they occur) have 366 days. So let's count
8177 the number of days between now and then, and compare that to the
8178 number of years times 365. The number of extra days we find must be
8179 equal to the number of leap years there were.
8180
8181 @smallexample
8182 @group
8183 1: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 2: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 1: 2925593
8184 . 1: <Tue Jan 1, 1991> .
8185 .
8186
8187 ' <jan 1 10001> @key{RET} ' <jan 1 1991> @key{RET} -
8188
8189 @end group
8190 @end smallexample
8191 @noindent
8192 @smallexample
8193 @group
8194 3: 2925593 2: 2925593 2: 2925593 1: 1943
8195 2: 10001 1: 8010 1: 2923650 .
8196 1: 1991 . .
8197 .
8198
8199 10001 @key{RET} 1991 - 365 * -
8200 @end group
8201 @end smallexample
8202
8203 @c [fix-ref Date Forms]
8204 @noindent
8205 There will be 1943 leap years before the year 10001. (Assuming,
8206 of course, that the algorithm for computing leap years remains
8207 unchanged for that long. @xref{Date Forms}, for some interesting
8208 background information in that regard.)
8209
8210 @node Types Answer 7, Types Answer 8, Types Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8211 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 7
8212
8213 @noindent
8214 The relative errors must be converted to absolute errors so that
8215 @samp{+/-} notation may be used.
8216
8217 @smallexample
8218 @group
8219 1: 1. 2: 1.
8220 . 1: 0.2
8221 .
8222
8223 20 @key{RET} .05 * 4 @key{RET} .05 *
8224 @end group
8225 @end smallexample
8226
8227 Now we simply chug through the formula.
8228
8229 @smallexample
8230 @group
8231 1: 19.7392088022 1: 394.78 +/- 19.739 1: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8232 . . .
8233
8234 2 P 2 ^ * 20 p 1 * 4 p .2 @key{RET} 2 ^ *
8235 @end group
8236 @end smallexample
8237
8238 It turns out the @kbd{v u} command will unpack an error form as
8239 well as a vector. This saves us some retyping of numbers.
8240
8241 @smallexample
8242 @group
8243 3: 6316.5 +/- 706.21 2: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8244 2: 6316.5 1: 0.1118
8245 1: 706.21 .
8246 .
8247
8248 @key{RET} v u @key{TAB} /
8249 @end group
8250 @end smallexample
8251
8252 @noindent
8253 Thus the volume is 6316 cubic centimeters, within about 11 percent.
8254
8255 @node Types Answer 8, Types Answer 9, Types Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
8256 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 8
8257
8258 @noindent
8259 The first answer is pretty simple: @samp{1 / (0 .. 10) = (0.1 .. inf)}.
8260 Since a number in the interval @samp{(0 .. 10)} can get arbitrarily
8261 close to zero, its reciprocal can get arbitrarily large, so the answer
8262 is an interval that effectively means, ``any number greater than 0.1''
8263 but with no upper bound.
8264
8265 The second answer, similarly, is @samp{1 / (-10 .. 0) = (-inf .. -0.1)}.
8266
8267 Calc normally treats division by zero as an error, so that the formula
8268 @w{@samp{1 / 0}} is left unsimplified. Our third problem,
8269 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 10]}}, also (potentially) divides by zero because zero
8270 is now a member of the interval. So Calc leaves this one unevaluated, too.
8271
8272 If you turn on Infinite mode by pressing @kbd{m i}, you will
8273 instead get the answer @samp{[0.1 .. inf]}, which includes infinity
8274 as a possible value.
8275
8276 The fourth calculation, @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}, has the same problem.
8277 Zero is buried inside the interval, but it's still a possible value.
8278 It's not hard to see that the actual result of @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}
8279 will be either greater than @mathit{0.1}, or less than @mathit{-0.1}. Thus
8280 the interval goes from minus infinity to plus infinity, with a ``hole''
8281 in it from @mathit{-0.1} to @mathit{0.1}. Calc doesn't have any way to
8282 represent this, so it just reports @samp{[-inf .. inf]} as the answer.
8283 It may be disappointing to hear ``the answer lies somewhere between
8284 minus infinity and plus infinity, inclusive,'' but that's the best
8285 that interval arithmetic can do in this case.
8286
8287 @node Types Answer 9, Types Answer 10, Types Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
8288 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 9
8289
8290 @smallexample
8291 @group
8292 1: [-3 .. 3] 2: [-3 .. 3] 2: [0 .. 9]
8293 . 1: [0 .. 9] 1: [-9 .. 9]
8294 . .
8295
8296 [ 3 n .. 3 ] @key{RET} 2 ^ @key{TAB} @key{RET} *
8297 @end group
8298 @end smallexample
8299
8300 @noindent
8301 In the first case the result says, ``if a number is between @mathit{-3} and
8302 3, its square is between 0 and 9.'' The second case says, ``the product
8303 of two numbers each between @mathit{-3} and 3 is between @mathit{-9} and 9.''
8304
8305 An interval form is not a number; it is a symbol that can stand for
8306 many different numbers. Two identical-looking interval forms can stand
8307 for different numbers.
8308
8309 The same issue arises when you try to square an error form.
8310
8311 @node Types Answer 10, Types Answer 11, Types Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
8312 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 10
8313
8314 @noindent
8315 Testing the first number, we might arbitrarily choose 17 for @expr{x}.
8316
8317 @smallexample
8318 @group
8319 1: 17 mod 811749613 2: 17 mod 811749613 1: 533694123 mod 811749613
8320 . 811749612 .
8321 .
8322
8323 17 M 811749613 @key{RET} 811749612 ^
8324 @end group
8325 @end smallexample
8326
8327 @noindent
8328 Since 533694123 is (considerably) different from 1, the number 811749613
8329 must not be prime.
8330
8331 It's awkward to type the number in twice as we did above. There are
8332 various ways to avoid this, and algebraic entry is one. In fact, using
8333 a vector mapping operation we can perform several tests at once. Let's
8334 use this method to test the second number.
8335
8336 @smallexample
8337 @group
8338 2: [17, 42, 100000] 1: [1 mod 15485863, 1 mod ... ]
8339 1: 15485863 .
8340 .
8341
8342 [17 42 100000] 15485863 @key{RET} V M ' ($$ mod $)^($-1) @key{RET}
8343 @end group
8344 @end smallexample
8345
8346 @noindent
8347 The result is three ones (modulo @expr{n}), so it's very probable that
8348 15485863 is prime. (In fact, this number is the millionth prime.)
8349
8350 Note that the functions @samp{($$^($-1)) mod $} or @samp{$$^($-1) % $}
8351 would have been hopelessly inefficient, since they would have calculated
8352 the power using full integer arithmetic.
8353
8354 Calc has a @kbd{k p} command that does primality testing. For small
8355 numbers it does an exact test; for large numbers it uses a variant
8356 of the Fermat test we used here. You can use @kbd{k p} repeatedly
8357 to prove that a large integer is prime with any desired probability.
8358
8359 @node Types Answer 11, Types Answer 12, Types Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
8360 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 11
8361
8362 @noindent
8363 There are several ways to insert a calculated number into an HMS form.
8364 One way to convert a number of seconds to an HMS form is simply to
8365 multiply the number by an HMS form representing one second:
8366
8367 @smallexample
8368 @group
8369 1: 31415926.5359 2: 31415926.5359 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8370 . 1: 0@@ 0' 1" .
8371 .
8372
8373 P 1e7 * 0@@ 0' 1" *
8374
8375 @end group
8376 @end smallexample
8377 @noindent
8378 @smallexample
8379 @group
8380 2: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359" 1: 6@@ 6' 2.5359" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
8381 1: 15@@ 27' 16" mod 24@@ 0' 0" .
8382 .
8383
8384 x time @key{RET} +
8385 @end group
8386 @end smallexample
8387
8388 @noindent
8389 It will be just after six in the morning.
8390
8391 The algebraic @code{hms} function can also be used to build an
8392 HMS form:
8393
8394 @smallexample
8395 @group
8396 1: hms(0, 0, 10000000. pi) 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8397 . .
8398
8399 ' hms(0, 0, 1e7 pi) @key{RET} =
8400 @end group
8401 @end smallexample
8402
8403 @noindent
8404 The @kbd{=} key is necessary to evaluate the symbol @samp{pi} to
8405 the actual number 3.14159...
8406
8407 @node Types Answer 12, Types Answer 13, Types Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
8408 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 12
8409
8410 @noindent
8411 As we recall, there are 17 songs of about 2 minutes and 47 seconds
8412 each.
8413
8414 @smallexample
8415 @group
8416 2: 0@@ 2' 47" 1: [0@@ 3' 7" .. 0@@ 3' 47"]
8417 1: [0@@ 0' 20" .. 0@@ 1' 0"] .
8418 .
8419
8420 [ 0@@ 20" .. 0@@ 1' ] +
8421
8422 @end group
8423 @end smallexample
8424 @noindent
8425 @smallexample
8426 @group
8427 1: [0@@ 52' 59." .. 1@@ 4' 19."]
8428 .
8429
8430 17 *
8431 @end group
8432 @end smallexample
8433
8434 @noindent
8435 No matter how long it is, the album will fit nicely on one CD.
8436
8437 @node Types Answer 13, Types Answer 14, Types Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
8438 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 13
8439
8440 @noindent
8441 Type @kbd{' 1 yr @key{RET} u c s @key{RET}}. The answer is 31557600 seconds.
8442
8443 @node Types Answer 14, Types Answer 15, Types Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
8444 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 14
8445
8446 @noindent
8447 How long will it take for a signal to get from one end of the computer
8448 to the other?
8449
8450 @smallexample
8451 @group
8452 1: m / c 1: 3.3356 ns
8453 . .
8454
8455 ' 1 m / c @key{RET} u c ns @key{RET}
8456 @end group
8457 @end smallexample
8458
8459 @noindent
8460 (Recall, @samp{c} is a ``unit'' corresponding to the speed of light.)
8461
8462 @smallexample
8463 @group
8464 1: 3.3356 ns 1: 0.81356 ns / ns 1: 0.81356
8465 2: 4.1 ns . .
8466 .
8467
8468 ' 4.1 ns @key{RET} / u s
8469 @end group
8470 @end smallexample
8471
8472 @noindent
8473 Thus a signal could take up to 81 percent of a clock cycle just to
8474 go from one place to another inside the computer, assuming the signal
8475 could actually attain the full speed of light. Pretty tight!
8476
8477 @node Types Answer 15, Algebra Answer 1, Types Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
8478 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 15
8479
8480 @noindent
8481 The speed limit is 55 miles per hour on most highways. We want to
8482 find the ratio of Sam's speed to the US speed limit.
8483
8484 @smallexample
8485 @group
8486 1: 55 mph 2: 55 mph 3: 11 hr mph / yd
8487 . 1: 5 yd / hr .
8488 .
8489
8490 ' 55 mph @key{RET} ' 5 yd/hr @key{RET} /
8491 @end group
8492 @end smallexample
8493
8494 The @kbd{u s} command cancels out these units to get a plain
8495 number. Now we take the logarithm base two to find the final
8496 answer, assuming that each successive pill doubles his speed.
8497
8498 @smallexample
8499 @group
8500 1: 19360. 2: 19360. 1: 14.24
8501 . 1: 2 .
8502 .
8503
8504 u s 2 B
8505 @end group
8506 @end smallexample
8507
8508 @noindent
8509 Thus Sam can take up to 14 pills without a worry.
8510
8511 @node Algebra Answer 1, Algebra Answer 2, Types Answer 15, Answers to Exercises
8512 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 1
8513
8514 @noindent
8515 @c [fix-ref Declarations]
8516 The result @samp{sqrt(x)^2} is simplified back to @expr{x} by the
8517 Calculator, but @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is not. (Consider what happens
8518 if @w{@expr{x = -4}}.) If @expr{x} is real, this formula could be
8519 simplified to @samp{abs(x)}, but for general complex arguments even
8520 that is not safe. (@xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell Calc
8521 that @expr{x} is known to be real.)
8522
8523 @node Algebra Answer 2, Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8524 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 2
8525
8526 @noindent
8527 Suppose our roots are @expr{[a, b, c]}. We want a polynomial which
8528 is zero when @expr{x} is any of these values. The trivial polynomial
8529 @expr{x-a} is zero when @expr{x=a}, so the product @expr{(x-a)(x-b)(x-c)}
8530 will do the job. We can use @kbd{a c x} to write this in a more
8531 familiar form.
8532
8533 @smallexample
8534 @group
8535 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [1.19023, -1.19023, 0]
8536 . .
8537
8538 r 2 a P x @key{RET}
8539
8540 @end group
8541 @end smallexample
8542 @noindent
8543 @smallexample
8544 @group
8545 1: [x - 1.19023, x + 1.19023, x] 1: (x - 1.19023) (x + 1.19023) x
8546 . .
8547
8548 V M ' x-$ @key{RET} V R *
8549
8550 @end group
8551 @end smallexample
8552 @noindent
8553 @smallexample
8554 @group
8555 1: x^3 - 1.41666 x 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
8556 . .
8557
8558 a c x @key{RET} 24 n * a x
8559 @end group
8560 @end smallexample
8561
8562 @noindent
8563 Sure enough, our answer (multiplied by a suitable constant) is the
8564 same as the original polynomial.
8565
8566 @node Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 4, Algebra Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8567 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 3
8568
8569 @smallexample
8570 @group
8571 1: x sin(pi x) 1: (sin(pi x) - pi x cos(pi x)) / pi^2
8572 . .
8573
8574 ' x sin(pi x) @key{RET} m r a i x @key{RET}
8575
8576 @end group
8577 @end smallexample
8578 @noindent
8579 @smallexample
8580 @group
8581 1: [y, 1]
8582 2: (sin(pi x) - pi x cos(pi x)) / pi^2
8583 .
8584
8585 ' [y,1] @key{RET} @key{TAB}
8586
8587 @end group
8588 @end smallexample
8589 @noindent
8590 @smallexample
8591 @group
8592 1: [(sin(pi y) - pi y cos(pi y)) / pi^2, (sin(pi) - pi cos(pi)) / pi^2]
8593 .
8594
8595 V M $ @key{RET}
8596
8597 @end group
8598 @end smallexample
8599 @noindent
8600 @smallexample
8601 @group
8602 1: (sin(pi y) - pi y cos(pi y)) / pi^2 + (pi cos(pi) - sin(pi)) / pi^2
8603 .
8604
8605 V R -
8606
8607 @end group
8608 @end smallexample
8609 @noindent
8610 @smallexample
8611 @group
8612 1: (sin(3.14159 y) - 3.14159 y cos(3.14159 y)) / 9.8696 - 0.3183
8613 .
8614
8615 =
8616
8617 @end group
8618 @end smallexample
8619 @noindent
8620 @smallexample
8621 @group
8622 1: [0., -0.95493, 0.63662, -1.5915, 1.2732]
8623 .
8624
8625 v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
8626 @end group
8627 @end smallexample
8628
8629 @node Algebra Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 1, Algebra Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8630 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 4
8631
8632 @noindent
8633 The hard part is that @kbd{V R +} is no longer sufficient to add up all
8634 the contributions from the slices, since the slices have varying
8635 coefficients. So first we must come up with a vector of these
8636 coefficients. Here's one way:
8637
8638 @smallexample
8639 @group
8640 2: -1 2: 3 1: [4, 2, ..., 4]
8641 1: [1, 2, ..., 9] 1: [-1, 1, ..., -1] .
8642 . .
8643
8644 1 n v x 9 @key{RET} V M ^ 3 @key{TAB} -
8645
8646 @end group
8647 @end smallexample
8648 @noindent
8649 @smallexample
8650 @group
8651 1: [4, 2, ..., 4, 1] 1: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8652 . .
8653
8654 1 | 1 @key{TAB} |
8655 @end group
8656 @end smallexample
8657
8658 @noindent
8659 Now we compute the function values. Note that for this method we need
8660 eleven values, including both endpoints of the desired interval.
8661
8662 @smallexample
8663 @group
8664 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8665 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9, 2.]
8666 .
8667
8668 11 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
8669
8670 @end group
8671 @end smallexample
8672 @noindent
8673 @smallexample
8674 @group
8675 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8676 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
8677 .
8678
8679 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
8680 @end group
8681 @end smallexample
8682
8683 @noindent
8684 Once again this calls for @kbd{V M * V R +}; a simple @kbd{*} does the
8685 same thing.
8686
8687 @smallexample
8688 @group
8689 1: 11.22 1: 1.122 1: 0.374
8690 . . .
8691
8692 * .1 * 3 /
8693 @end group
8694 @end smallexample
8695
8696 @noindent
8697 Wow! That's even better than the result from the Taylor series method.
8698
8699 @node Rewrites Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 2, Algebra Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8700 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 1
8701
8702 @noindent
8703 We'll use Big mode to make the formulas more readable.
8704
8705 @smallexample
8706 @group
8707 ___
8708 2 + V 2
8709 1: (2 + sqrt(2)) / (1 + sqrt(2)) 1: --------
8710 . ___
8711 1 + V 2
8712
8713 .
8714
8715 ' (2+sqrt(2)) / (1+sqrt(2)) @key{RET} d B
8716 @end group
8717 @end smallexample
8718
8719 @noindent
8720 Multiplying by the conjugate helps because @expr{(a+b) (a-b) = a^2 - b^2}.
8721
8722 @smallexample
8723 @group
8724 ___ ___
8725 1: (2 + V 2 ) (V 2 - 1)
8726 .
8727
8728 a r a/(b+c) := a*(b-c) / (b^2-c^2) @key{RET}
8729
8730 @end group
8731 @end smallexample
8732 @noindent
8733 @smallexample
8734 @group
8735 ___ ___
8736 1: 2 + V 2 - 2 1: V 2
8737 . .
8738
8739 a r a*(b+c) := a*b + a*c a s
8740 @end group
8741 @end smallexample
8742
8743 @noindent
8744 (We could have used @kbd{a x} instead of a rewrite rule for the
8745 second step.)
8746
8747 The multiply-by-conjugate rule turns out to be useful in many
8748 different circumstances, such as when the denominator involves
8749 sines and cosines or the imaginary constant @code{i}.
8750
8751 @node Rewrites Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8752 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 2
8753
8754 @noindent
8755 Here is the rule set:
8756
8757 @smallexample
8758 @group
8759 [ fib(n) := fib(n, 1, 1) :: integer(n) :: n >= 1,
8760 fib(1, x, y) := x,
8761 fib(n, x, y) := fib(n-1, y, x+y) ]
8762 @end group
8763 @end smallexample
8764
8765 @noindent
8766 The first rule turns a one-argument @code{fib} that people like to write
8767 into a three-argument @code{fib} that makes computation easier. The
8768 second rule converts back from three-argument form once the computation
8769 is done. The third rule does the computation itself. It basically
8770 says that if @expr{x} and @expr{y} are two consecutive Fibonacci numbers,
8771 then @expr{y} and @expr{x+y} are the next (overlapping) pair of Fibonacci
8772 numbers.
8773
8774 Notice that because the number @expr{n} was ``validated'' by the
8775 conditions on the first rule, there is no need to put conditions on
8776 the other rules because the rule set would never get that far unless
8777 the input were valid. That further speeds computation, since no
8778 extra conditions need to be checked at every step.
8779
8780 Actually, a user with a nasty sense of humor could enter a bad
8781 three-argument @code{fib} call directly, say, @samp{fib(0, 1, 1)},
8782 which would get the rules into an infinite loop. One thing that would
8783 help keep this from happening by accident would be to use something like
8784 @samp{ZzFib} instead of @code{fib} as the name of the three-argument
8785 function.
8786
8787 @node Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8788 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 3
8789
8790 @noindent
8791 He got an infinite loop. First, Calc did as expected and rewrote
8792 @w{@samp{2 + 3 x}} to @samp{f(2, 3, x)}. Then it looked for ways to
8793 apply the rule again, and found that @samp{f(2, 3, x)} looks like
8794 @samp{a + b x} with @w{@samp{a = 0}} and @samp{b = 1}, so it rewrote to
8795 @samp{f(0, 1, f(2, 3, x))}. It then wrapped another @samp{f(0, 1, ...)}
8796 around that, and so on, ad infinitum. Joe should have used @kbd{M-1 a r}
8797 to make sure the rule applied only once.
8798
8799 (Actually, even the first step didn't work as he expected. What Calc
8800 really gives for @kbd{M-1 a r} in this situation is @samp{f(3 x, 1, 2)},
8801 treating 2 as the ``variable,'' and @samp{3 x} as a constant being added
8802 to it. While this may seem odd, it's just as valid a solution as the
8803 ``obvious'' one. One way to fix this would be to add the condition
8804 @samp{:: variable(x)} to the rule, to make sure the thing that matches
8805 @samp{x} is indeed a variable, or to change @samp{x} to @samp{quote(x)}
8806 on the lefthand side, so that the rule matches the actual variable
8807 @samp{x} rather than letting @samp{x} stand for something else.)
8808
8809 @node Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8810 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 4
8811
8812 @noindent
8813 @ignore
8814 @starindex
8815 @end ignore
8816 @tindex seq
8817 Here is a suitable set of rules to solve the first part of the problem:
8818
8819 @smallexample
8820 @group
8821 [ seq(n, c) := seq(n/2, c+1) :: n%2 = 0,
8822 seq(n, c) := seq(3n+1, c+1) :: n%2 = 1 :: n > 1 ]
8823 @end group
8824 @end smallexample
8825
8826 Given the initial formula @samp{seq(6, 0)}, application of these
8827 rules produces the following sequence of formulas:
8828
8829 @example
8830 seq( 3, 1)
8831 seq(10, 2)
8832 seq( 5, 3)
8833 seq(16, 4)
8834 seq( 8, 5)
8835 seq( 4, 6)
8836 seq( 2, 7)
8837 seq( 1, 8)
8838 @end example
8839
8840 @noindent
8841 whereupon neither of the rules match, and rewriting stops.
8842
8843 We can pretty this up a bit with a couple more rules:
8844
8845 @smallexample
8846 @group
8847 [ seq(n) := seq(n, 0),
8848 seq(1, c) := c,
8849 ... ]
8850 @end group
8851 @end smallexample
8852
8853 @noindent
8854 Now, given @samp{seq(6)} as the starting configuration, we get 8
8855 as the result.
8856
8857 The change to return a vector is quite simple:
8858
8859 @smallexample
8860 @group
8861 [ seq(n) := seq(n, []) :: integer(n) :: n > 0,
8862 seq(1, v) := v | 1,
8863 seq(n, v) := seq(n/2, v | n) :: n%2 = 0,
8864 seq(n, v) := seq(3n+1, v | n) :: n%2 = 1 ]
8865 @end group
8866 @end smallexample
8867
8868 @noindent
8869 Given @samp{seq(6)}, the result is @samp{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
8870
8871 Notice that the @expr{n > 1} guard is no longer necessary on the last
8872 rule since the @expr{n = 1} case is now detected by another rule.
8873 But a guard has been added to the initial rule to make sure the
8874 initial value is suitable before the computation begins.
8875
8876 While still a good idea, this guard is not as vitally important as it
8877 was for the @code{fib} function, since calling, say, @samp{seq(x, [])}
8878 will not get into an infinite loop. Calc will not be able to prove
8879 the symbol @samp{x} is either even or odd, so none of the rules will
8880 apply and the rewrites will stop right away.
8881
8882 @node Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 6, Rewrites Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8883 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 5
8884
8885 @noindent
8886 @ignore
8887 @starindex
8888 @end ignore
8889 @tindex nterms
8890 If @expr{x} is the sum @expr{a + b}, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' must
8891 be `@tfn{nterms(}@var{a}@tfn{)}' plus `@tfn{nterms(}@var{b}@tfn{)}'. If @expr{x}
8892 is not a sum, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' = 1.
8893
8894 @smallexample
8895 @group
8896 [ nterms(a + b) := nterms(a) + nterms(b),
8897 nterms(x) := 1 ]
8898 @end group
8899 @end smallexample
8900
8901 @noindent
8902 Here we have taken advantage of the fact that earlier rules always
8903 match before later rules; @samp{nterms(x)} will only be tried if we
8904 already know that @samp{x} is not a sum.
8905
8906 @node Rewrites Answer 6, Programming Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8907 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 6
8908
8909 @noindent
8910 Here is a rule set that will do the job:
8911
8912 @smallexample
8913 @group
8914 [ a*(b + c) := a*b + a*c,
8915 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) O(x^m) := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8916 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8917 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) x^m := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8918 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8919 a O(x^n) := O(x^n) :: constant(a),
8920 x^opt(m) O(x^n) := O(x^(n+m)),
8921 O(x^n) O(x^m) := O(x^(n+m)) ]
8922 @end group
8923 @end smallexample
8924
8925 If we really want the @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} keys to operate naturally
8926 on power series, we should put these rules in @code{EvalRules}. For
8927 testing purposes, it is better to put them in a different variable,
8928 say, @code{O}, first.
8929
8930 The first rule just expands products of sums so that the rest of the
8931 rules can assume they have an expanded-out polynomial to work with.
8932 Note that this rule does not mention @samp{O} at all, so it will
8933 apply to any product-of-sum it encounters---this rule may surprise
8934 you if you put it into @code{EvalRules}!
8935
8936 In the second rule, the sum of two O's is changed to the smaller O.
8937 The optional constant coefficients are there mostly so that
8938 @samp{O(x^2) - O(x^3)} and @samp{O(x^3) - O(x^2)} are handled
8939 as well as @samp{O(x^2) + O(x^3)}.
8940
8941 The third rule absorbs higher powers of @samp{x} into O's.
8942
8943 The fourth rule says that a constant times a negligible quantity
8944 is still negligible. (This rule will also match @samp{O(x^3) / 4},
8945 with @samp{a = 1/4}.)
8946
8947 The fifth rule rewrites, for example, @samp{x^2 O(x^3)} to @samp{O(x^5)}.
8948 (It is easy to see that if one of these forms is negligible, the other
8949 is, too.) Notice the @samp{x^opt(m)} to pick up terms like
8950 @w{@samp{x O(x^3)}}. Optional powers will match @samp{x} as @samp{x^1}
8951 but not 1 as @samp{x^0}. This turns out to be exactly what we want here.
8952
8953 The sixth rule is the corresponding rule for products of two O's.
8954
8955 Another way to solve this problem would be to create a new ``data type''
8956 that represents truncated power series. We might represent these as
8957 function calls @samp{series(@var{coefs}, @var{x})} where @var{coefs} is
8958 a vector of coefficients for @expr{x^0}, @expr{x^1}, @expr{x^2}, and so
8959 on. Rules would exist for sums and products of such @code{series}
8960 objects, and as an optional convenience could also know how to combine a
8961 @code{series} object with a normal polynomial. (With this, and with a
8962 rule that rewrites @samp{O(x^n)} to the equivalent @code{series} form,
8963 you could still enter power series in exactly the same notation as
8964 before.) Operations on such objects would probably be more efficient,
8965 although the objects would be a bit harder to read.
8966
8967 @c [fix-ref Compositions]
8968 Some other symbolic math programs provide a power series data type
8969 similar to this. Mathematica, for example, has an object that looks
8970 like @samp{PowerSeries[@var{x}, @var{x0}, @var{coefs}, @var{nmin},
8971 @var{nmax}, @var{den}]}, where @var{x0} is the point about which the
8972 power series is taken (we've been assuming this was always zero),
8973 and @var{nmin}, @var{nmax}, and @var{den} allow pseudo-power-series
8974 with fractional or negative powers. Also, the @code{PowerSeries}
8975 objects have a special display format that makes them look like
8976 @samp{2 x^2 + O(x^4)} when they are printed out. (@xref{Compositions},
8977 for a way to do this in Calc, although for something as involved as
8978 this it would probably be better to write the formatting routine
8979 in Lisp.)
8980
8981 @node Programming Answer 1, Programming Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8982 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 1
8983
8984 @noindent
8985 Just enter the formula @samp{ninteg(sin(t)/t, t, 0, x)}, type
8986 @kbd{Z F}, and answer the questions. Since this formula contains two
8987 variables, the default argument list will be @samp{(t x)}. We want to
8988 change this to @samp{(x)} since @expr{t} is really a dummy variable
8989 to be used within @code{ninteg}.
8990
8991 The exact keystrokes are @kbd{Z F s Si @key{RET} @key{RET} C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL} @key{RET} y}.
8992 (The @kbd{C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL}} are what fix the argument list.)
8993
8994 @node Programming Answer 2, Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8995 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 2
8996
8997 @noindent
8998 One way is to move the number to the top of the stack, operate on
8999 it, then move it back: @kbd{C-x ( M-@key{TAB} n M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} C-x )}.
9000
9001 Another way is to negate the top three stack entries, then negate
9002 again the top two stack entries: @kbd{C-x ( M-3 n M-2 n C-x )}.
9003
9004 Finally, it turns out that a negative prefix argument causes a
9005 command like @kbd{n} to operate on the specified stack entry only,
9006 which is just what we want: @kbd{C-x ( M-- 3 n C-x )}.
9007
9008 Just for kicks, let's also do it algebraically:
9009 @w{@kbd{C-x ( ' -$$$, $$, $ @key{RET} C-x )}}.
9010
9011 @node Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
9012 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 3
9013
9014 @noindent
9015 Each of these functions can be computed using the stack, or using
9016 algebraic entry, whichever way you prefer:
9017
9018 @noindent
9019 Computing
9020 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}}:
9021 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x}:
9022
9023 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} S @key{TAB} / C-x )}.
9024
9025 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' sin($)/$ @key{RET} C-x )}.
9026
9027 @noindent
9028 Computing the logarithm:
9029
9030 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{TAB} B C-x )}
9031
9032 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' log($,$$) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9033
9034 @noindent
9035 Computing the vector of integers:
9036
9037 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x C-x )}. (Recall that
9038 @kbd{C-u v x} takes the vector size, starting value, and increment
9039 from the stack.)
9040
9041 Alternatively: @kbd{C-x ( ~ v x C-x )}. (The @kbd{~} key pops a
9042 number from the stack and uses it as the prefix argument for the
9043 next command.)
9044
9045 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' index($) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9046
9047 @node Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
9048 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 4
9049
9050 @noindent
9051 Here's one way: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} V R + @key{TAB} v l / C-x )}.
9052
9053 @node Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
9054 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 5
9055
9056 @smallexample
9057 @group
9058 2: 1 1: 1.61803398502 2: 1.61803398502
9059 1: 20 . 1: 1.61803398875
9060 . .
9061
9062 1 @key{RET} 20 Z < & 1 + Z > I H P
9063 @end group
9064 @end smallexample
9065
9066 @noindent
9067 This answer is quite accurate.
9068
9069 @node Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
9070 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 6
9071
9072 @noindent
9073 Here is the matrix:
9074
9075 @example
9076 [ [ 0, 1 ] * [a, b] = [b, a + b]
9077 [ 1, 1 ] ]
9078 @end example
9079
9080 @noindent
9081 Thus @samp{[0, 1; 1, 1]^n * [1, 1]} computes Fibonacci numbers @expr{n+1}
9082 and @expr{n+2}. Here's one program that does the job:
9083
9084 @example
9085 C-x ( ' [0, 1; 1, 1] ^ ($-1) * [1, 1] @key{RET} v u @key{DEL} C-x )
9086 @end example
9087
9088 @noindent
9089 This program is quite efficient because Calc knows how to raise a
9090 matrix (or other value) to the power @expr{n} in only
9091 @texline @math{\log_2 n}
9092 @infoline @expr{log(n,2)}
9093 steps. For example, this program can compute the 1000th Fibonacci
9094 number (a 209-digit integer!) in about 10 steps; even though the
9095 @kbd{Z < ... Z >} solution had much simpler steps, it would have
9096 required so many steps that it would not have been practical.
9097
9098 @node Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
9099 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 7
9100
9101 @noindent
9102 The trick here is to compute the harmonic numbers differently, so that
9103 the loop counter itself accumulates the sum of reciprocals. We use
9104 a separate variable to hold the integer counter.
9105
9106 @smallexample
9107 @group
9108 1: 1 2: 1 1: .
9109 . 1: 4
9110 .
9111
9112 1 t 1 1 @key{RET} 4 Z ( t 2 r 1 1 + s 1 & Z )
9113 @end group
9114 @end smallexample
9115
9116 @noindent
9117 The body of the loop goes as follows: First save the harmonic sum
9118 so far in variable 2. Then delete it from the stack; the for loop
9119 itself will take care of remembering it for us. Next, recall the
9120 count from variable 1, add one to it, and feed its reciprocal to
9121 the for loop to use as the step value. The for loop will increase
9122 the ``loop counter'' by that amount and keep going until the
9123 loop counter exceeds 4.
9124
9125 @smallexample
9126 @group
9127 2: 31 3: 31
9128 1: 3.99498713092 2: 3.99498713092
9129 . 1: 4.02724519544
9130 .
9131
9132 r 1 r 2 @key{RET} 31 & +
9133 @end group
9134 @end smallexample
9135
9136 Thus we find that the 30th harmonic number is 3.99, and the 31st
9137 harmonic number is 4.02.
9138
9139 @node Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
9140 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 8
9141
9142 @noindent
9143 The first step is to compute the derivative @expr{f'(x)} and thus
9144 the formula
9145 @texline @math{\displaystyle{x - {f(x) \over f'(x)}}}.
9146 @infoline @expr{x - f(x)/f'(x)}.
9147
9148 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9149 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9150 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9151 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9152 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9153 just for purposes of illustration.)
9154
9155 @smallexample
9156 @group
9157 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5 3: 4.5
9158 1: 4.5 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5
9159 . 1: -(sin(x) cos(cos(x)))
9160 .
9161
9162 ' sin(cos(x))-0.5 @key{RET} 4.5 m r C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET}
9163
9164 @end group
9165 @end smallexample
9166 @noindent
9167 @smallexample
9168 @group
9169 2: 4.5
9170 1: x + (sin(cos(x)) - 0.5) / sin(x) cos(cos(x))
9171 .
9172
9173 / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9174 @end group
9175 @end smallexample
9176
9177 Now, we enter the loop. We'll use a repeat loop with a 20-repetition
9178 limit just in case the method fails to converge for some reason.
9179 (Normally, the @w{@kbd{Z /}} command will stop the loop before all 20
9180 repetitions are done.)
9181
9182 @smallexample
9183 @group
9184 1: 4.5 3: 4.5 2: 4.5
9185 . 2: x + (sin(cos(x)) ... 1: 5.24196456928
9186 1: 4.5 .
9187 .
9188
9189 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9190 @end group
9191 @end smallexample
9192
9193 This is the new guess for @expr{x}. Now we compare it with the
9194 old one to see if we've converged.
9195
9196 @smallexample
9197 @group
9198 3: 5.24196 2: 5.24196 1: 5.24196 1: 5.26345856348
9199 2: 5.24196 1: 0 . .
9200 1: 4.5 .
9201 .
9202
9203 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / Z > Z ' C-x )
9204 @end group
9205 @end smallexample
9206
9207 The loop converges in just a few steps to this value. To check
9208 the result, we can simply substitute it back into the equation.
9209
9210 @smallexample
9211 @group
9212 2: 5.26345856348
9213 1: 0.499999999997
9214 .
9215
9216 @key{RET} ' sin(cos($)) @key{RET}
9217 @end group
9218 @end smallexample
9219
9220 Let's test the new definition again:
9221
9222 @smallexample
9223 @group
9224 2: x^2 - 9 1: 3.
9225 1: 1 .
9226 .
9227
9228 ' x^2-9 @key{RET} 1 X
9229 @end group
9230 @end smallexample
9231
9232 Once again, here's the full Newton's Method definition:
9233
9234 @example
9235 @group
9236 C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET} / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9237 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9238 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9239 Z >
9240 Z '
9241 C-x )
9242 @end group
9243 @end example
9244
9245 @c [fix-ref Nesting and Fixed Points]
9246 It turns out that Calc has a built-in command for applying a formula
9247 repeatedly until it converges to a number. @xref{Nesting and Fixed Points},
9248 to see how to use it.
9249
9250 @c [fix-ref Root Finding]
9251 Also, of course, @kbd{a R} is a built-in command that uses Newton's
9252 method (among others) to look for numerical solutions to any equation.
9253 @xref{Root Finding}.
9254
9255 @node Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
9256 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 9
9257
9258 @noindent
9259 The first step is to adjust @expr{z} to be greater than 5. A simple
9260 ``for'' loop will do the job here. If @expr{z} is less than 5, we
9261 reduce the problem using
9262 @texline @math{\psi(z) = \psi(z+1) - 1/z}.
9263 @infoline @expr{psi(z) = psi(z+1) - 1/z}. We go
9264 on to compute
9265 @texline @math{\psi(z+1)},
9266 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1)},
9267 and remember to add back a factor of @expr{-1/z} when we're done. This
9268 step is repeated until @expr{z > 5}.
9269
9270 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9271 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9272 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9273 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9274 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9275 just for purposes of illustration.)
9276
9277 @smallexample
9278 @group
9279 1: 1. 1: 1.
9280 . .
9281
9282 1.0 @key{RET} C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9283 @end group
9284 @end smallexample
9285
9286 Here, variable 1 holds @expr{z} and variable 2 holds the adjustment
9287 factor. If @expr{z < 5}, we use a loop to increase it.
9288
9289 (By the way, we started with @samp{1.0} instead of the integer 1 because
9290 otherwise the calculation below will try to do exact fractional arithmetic,
9291 and will never converge because fractions compare equal only if they
9292 are exactly equal, not just equal to within the current precision.)
9293
9294 @smallexample
9295 @group
9296 3: 1. 2: 1. 1: 6.
9297 2: 1. 1: 1 .
9298 1: 5 .
9299 .
9300
9301 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9302 @end group
9303 @end smallexample
9304
9305 Now we compute the initial part of the sum:
9306 @texline @math{\ln z - {1 \over 2z}}
9307 @infoline @expr{ln(z) - 1/2z}
9308 minus the adjustment factor.
9309
9310 @smallexample
9311 @group
9312 2: 1.79175946923 2: 1.7084261359 1: -0.57490719743
9313 1: 0.0833333333333 1: 2.28333333333 .
9314 . .
9315
9316 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9317 @end group
9318 @end smallexample
9319
9320 Now we evaluate the series. We'll use another ``for'' loop counting
9321 up the value of @expr{2 n}. (Calc does have a summation command,
9322 @kbd{a +}, but we'll use loops just to get more practice with them.)
9323
9324 @smallexample
9325 @group
9326 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5749 4: -0.5749 2: -0.5749
9327 2: 2 2: 1:6 3: 1:6 1: 2.3148e-3
9328 1: 40 1: 2 2: 2 .
9329 . . 1: 36.
9330 .
9331
9332 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9333
9334 @end group
9335 @end smallexample
9336 @noindent
9337 @smallexample
9338 @group
9339 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5772 2: -0.5772 1: -0.577215664892
9340 2: -0.5749 2: -0.5772 1: 0 .
9341 1: 2.3148e-3 1: -0.5749 .
9342 . .
9343
9344 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / 2 Z ) Z ' C-x )
9345 @end group
9346 @end smallexample
9347
9348 This is the value of
9349 @texline @math{-\gamma},
9350 @infoline @expr{- gamma},
9351 with a slight bit of roundoff error. To get a full 12 digits, let's use
9352 a higher precision:
9353
9354 @smallexample
9355 @group
9356 2: -0.577215664892 2: -0.577215664892
9357 1: 1. 1: -0.577215664901532
9358
9359 1. @key{RET} p 16 @key{RET} X
9360 @end group
9361 @end smallexample
9362
9363 Here's the complete sequence of keystrokes:
9364
9365 @example
9366 @group
9367 C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9368 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9369 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9370 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9371 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9372 2 Z )
9373 Z '
9374 C-x )
9375 @end group
9376 @end example
9377
9378 @node Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
9379 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 10
9380
9381 @noindent
9382 Taking the derivative of a term of the form @expr{x^n} will produce
9383 a term like
9384 @texline @math{n x^{n-1}}.
9385 @infoline @expr{n x^(n-1)}.
9386 Taking the derivative of a constant
9387 produces zero. From this it is easy to see that the @expr{n}th
9388 derivative of a polynomial, evaluated at @expr{x = 0}, will equal the
9389 coefficient on the @expr{x^n} term times @expr{n!}.
9390
9391 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9392 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9393 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9394 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9395 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9396 just for purposes of illustration.)
9397
9398 @smallexample
9399 @group
9400 2: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2 3: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2
9401 1: 6 2: 0
9402 . 1: 6
9403 .
9404
9405 ' 5 x^4 + (x+1)^2 @key{RET} 6 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9406 @end group
9407 @end smallexample
9408
9409 @noindent
9410 Variable 1 will accumulate the vector of coefficients.
9411
9412 @smallexample
9413 @group
9414 2: 0 3: 0 2: 5 x^4 + ...
9415 1: 5 x^4 + ... 2: 5 x^4 + ... 1: 1
9416 . 1: 1 .
9417 .
9418
9419 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9420 @end group
9421 @end smallexample
9422
9423 @noindent
9424 Note that @kbd{s | 1} appends the top-of-stack value to the vector
9425 in a variable; it is completely analogous to @kbd{s + 1}. We could
9426 have written instead, @kbd{r 1 @key{TAB} | t 1}.
9427
9428 @smallexample
9429 @group
9430 1: 20 x^3 + 2 x + 2 1: 0 1: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9431 . . .
9432
9433 a d x @key{RET} 1 Z ) @key{DEL} r 1 Z ' C-x )
9434 @end group
9435 @end smallexample
9436
9437 To convert back, a simple method is just to map the coefficients
9438 against a table of powers of @expr{x}.
9439
9440 @smallexample
9441 @group
9442 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9443 1: 6 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
9444 . .
9445
9446 6 @key{RET} 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x
9447
9448 @end group
9449 @end smallexample
9450 @noindent
9451 @smallexample
9452 @group
9453 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: 1 + 2 x + x^2 + 5 x^4
9454 1: [1, x, x^2, x^3, ... ] .
9455 .
9456
9457 ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ *
9458 @end group
9459 @end smallexample
9460
9461 Once again, here are the whole polynomial to/from vector programs:
9462
9463 @example
9464 @group
9465 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9466 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9467 a d x @key{RET}
9468 1 Z ) r 1
9469 Z '
9470 C-x )
9471
9472 C-x ( 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ * C-x )
9473 @end group
9474 @end example
9475
9476 @node Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 12, Programming Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
9477 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 11
9478
9479 @noindent
9480 First we define a dummy program to go on the @kbd{z s} key. The true
9481 @w{@kbd{z s}} key is supposed to take two numbers from the stack and
9482 return one number, so @key{DEL} as a dummy definition will make
9483 sure the stack comes out right.
9484
9485 @smallexample
9486 @group
9487 2: 4 1: 4 2: 4
9488 1: 2 . 1: 2
9489 . .
9490
9491 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( @key{DEL} C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} 2
9492 @end group
9493 @end smallexample
9494
9495 The last step replaces the 2 that was eaten during the creation
9496 of the dummy @kbd{z s} command. Now we move on to the real
9497 definition. The recurrence needs to be rewritten slightly,
9498 to the form @expr{s(n,m) = s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m)}.
9499
9500 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9501 below. You can use @kbd{C-x * m} to load it from there.)
9502
9503 @smallexample
9504 @group
9505 2: 4 4: 4 3: 4 2: 4
9506 1: 2 3: 2 2: 2 1: 2
9507 . 2: 4 1: 0 .
9508 1: 2 .
9509 .
9510
9511 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1 Z :
9512
9513 @end group
9514 @end smallexample
9515 @noindent
9516 @smallexample
9517 @group
9518 4: 4 2: 4 2: 3 4: 3 4: 3 3: 3
9519 3: 2 1: 2 1: 2 3: 2 3: 2 2: 2
9520 2: 2 . . 2: 3 2: 3 1: 3
9521 1: 0 1: 2 1: 1 .
9522 . . .
9523
9524 @key{RET} 0 a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9525 @end group
9526 @end smallexample
9527
9528 @noindent
9529 (Note that the value 3 that our dummy @kbd{z s} produces is not correct;
9530 it is merely a placeholder that will do just as well for now.)
9531
9532 @smallexample
9533 @group
9534 3: 3 4: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: -6
9535 2: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: 9 .
9536 1: 2 2: 3 1: 3 .
9537 . 1: 2 .
9538 .
9539
9540 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9541
9542 @end group
9543 @end smallexample
9544 @noindent
9545 @smallexample
9546 @group
9547 1: -6 2: 4 1: 11 2: 11
9548 . 1: 2 . 1: 11
9549 . .
9550
9551 Z ] Z ] C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} @key{DEL} 4 @key{RET} 2 z s M-@key{RET} k s
9552 @end group
9553 @end smallexample
9554
9555 Even though the result that we got during the definition was highly
9556 bogus, once the definition is complete the @kbd{z s} command gets
9557 the right answers.
9558
9559 Here's the full program once again:
9560
9561 @example
9562 @group
9563 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a =
9564 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1
9565 Z : @key{RET} 0 a =
9566 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0
9567 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9568 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9569 Z ]
9570 Z ]
9571 C-x )
9572 @end group
9573 @end example
9574
9575 You can read this definition using @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro})
9576 followed by @kbd{Z K s}, without having to make a dummy definition
9577 first, because @code{read-kbd-macro} doesn't need to execute the
9578 definition as it reads it in. For this reason, @code{C-x * m} is often
9579 the easiest way to create recursive programs in Calc.
9580
9581 @node Programming Answer 12, , Programming Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
9582 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 12
9583
9584 @noindent
9585 This turns out to be a much easier way to solve the problem. Let's
9586 denote Stirling numbers as calls of the function @samp{s}.
9587
9588 First, we store the rewrite rules corresponding to the definition of
9589 Stirling numbers in a convenient variable:
9590
9591 @smallexample
9592 s e StirlingRules @key{RET}
9593 [ s(n,n) := 1 :: n >= 0,
9594 s(n,0) := 0 :: n > 0,
9595 s(n,m) := s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m) :: n >= m :: m >= 1 ]
9596 C-c C-c
9597 @end smallexample
9598
9599 Now, it's just a matter of applying the rules:
9600
9601 @smallexample
9602 @group
9603 2: 4 1: s(4, 2) 1: 11
9604 1: 2 . .
9605 .
9606
9607 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( ' s($$,$) @key{RET} a r StirlingRules @key{RET} C-x )
9608 @end group
9609 @end smallexample
9610
9611 As in the case of the @code{fib} rules, it would be useful to put these
9612 rules in @code{EvalRules} and to add a @samp{:: remember} condition to
9613 the last rule.
9614
9615 @c This ends the table-of-contents kludge from above:
9616 @tex
9617 \global\let\chapternofonts=\oldchapternofonts
9618 @end tex
9619
9620 @c [reference]
9621
9622 @node Introduction, Data Types, Tutorial, Top
9623 @chapter Introduction
9624
9625 @noindent
9626 This chapter is the beginning of the Calc reference manual.
9627 It covers basic concepts such as the stack, algebraic and
9628 numeric entry, undo, numeric prefix arguments, etc.
9629
9630 @c [when-split]
9631 @c (Chapter 2, the Tutorial, has been printed in a separate volume.)
9632
9633 @menu
9634 * Basic Commands::
9635 * Help Commands::
9636 * Stack Basics::
9637 * Numeric Entry::
9638 * Algebraic Entry::
9639 * Quick Calculator::
9640 * Prefix Arguments::
9641 * Undo::
9642 * Error Messages::
9643 * Multiple Calculators::
9644 * Troubleshooting Commands::
9645 @end menu
9646
9647 @node Basic Commands, Help Commands, Introduction, Introduction
9648 @section Basic Commands
9649
9650 @noindent
9651 @pindex calc
9652 @pindex calc-mode
9653 @cindex Starting the Calculator
9654 @cindex Running the Calculator
9655 To start the Calculator in its standard interface, type @kbd{M-x calc}.
9656 By default this creates a pair of small windows, @samp{*Calculator*}
9657 and @samp{*Calc Trail*}. The former displays the contents of the
9658 Calculator stack and is manipulated exclusively through Calc commands.
9659 It is possible (though not usually necessary) to create several Calc
9660 mode buffers each of which has an independent stack, undo list, and
9661 mode settings. There is exactly one Calc Trail buffer; it records a
9662 list of the results of all calculations that have been done. The
9663 Calc Trail buffer uses a variant of Calc mode, so Calculator commands
9664 still work when the trail buffer's window is selected. It is possible
9665 to turn the trail window off, but the @samp{*Calc Trail*} buffer itself
9666 still exists and is updated silently. @xref{Trail Commands}.
9667
9668 @kindex C-x * c
9669 @kindex C-x * *
9670 @ignore
9671 @mindex @null
9672 @end ignore
9673 In most installations, the @kbd{C-x * c} key sequence is a more
9674 convenient way to start the Calculator. Also, @kbd{C-x * *}
9675 is a synonym for @kbd{C-x * c} unless you last used Calc
9676 in its Keypad mode.
9677
9678 @kindex x
9679 @kindex M-x
9680 @pindex calc-execute-extended-command
9681 Most Calc commands use one or two keystrokes. Lower- and upper-case
9682 letters are distinct. Commands may also be entered in full @kbd{M-x} form;
9683 for some commands this is the only form. As a convenience, the @kbd{x}
9684 key (@code{calc-execute-extended-command})
9685 is like @kbd{M-x} except that it enters the initial string @samp{calc-}
9686 for you. For example, the following key sequences are equivalent:
9687 @kbd{S}, @kbd{M-x calc-sin @key{RET}}, @kbd{x sin @key{RET}}.
9688
9689 Although Calc is designed to be used from the keyboard, some of
9690 Calc's more common commands are available from a menu. In the menu, the
9691 arguments to the functions are given by referring to their stack level
9692 numbers.
9693
9694 @cindex Extensions module
9695 @cindex @file{calc-ext} module
9696 The Calculator exists in many parts. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}, the
9697 Emacs ``auto-load'' mechanism will bring in only the first part, which
9698 contains the basic arithmetic functions. The other parts will be
9699 auto-loaded the first time you use the more advanced commands like trig
9700 functions or matrix operations. This is done to improve the response time
9701 of the Calculator in the common case when all you need to do is a
9702 little arithmetic. If for some reason the Calculator fails to load an
9703 extension module automatically, you can force it to load all the
9704 extensions by using the @kbd{C-x * L} (@code{calc-load-everything})
9705 command. @xref{Mode Settings}.
9706
9707 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} or @kbd{C-x * c} with any numeric prefix argument,
9708 the Calculator is loaded if necessary, but it is not actually started.
9709 If the argument is positive, the @file{calc-ext} extensions are also
9710 loaded if necessary. User-written Lisp code that wishes to make use
9711 of Calc's arithmetic routines can use @samp{(calc 0)} or @samp{(calc 1)}
9712 to auto-load the Calculator.
9713
9714 @kindex C-x * b
9715 @pindex full-calc
9716 If you type @kbd{C-x * b}, then next time you use @kbd{C-x * c} you
9717 will get a Calculator that uses the full height of the Emacs screen.
9718 When full-screen mode is on, @kbd{C-x * c} runs the @code{full-calc}
9719 command instead of @code{calc}. From the Unix shell you can type
9720 @samp{emacs -f full-calc} to start a new Emacs specifically for use
9721 as a calculator. When Calc is started from the Emacs command line
9722 like this, Calc's normal ``quit'' commands actually quit Emacs itself.
9723
9724 @kindex C-x * o
9725 @pindex calc-other-window
9726 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is like @kbd{C-x * c} except that the Calc
9727 window is not actually selected. If you are already in the Calc
9728 window, @kbd{C-x * o} switches you out of it. (The regular Emacs
9729 @kbd{C-x o} command would also work for this, but it has a
9730 tendency to drop you into the Calc Trail window instead, which
9731 @kbd{C-x * o} takes care not to do.)
9732
9733 @ignore
9734 @mindex C-x * q
9735 @end ignore
9736 For one quick calculation, you can type @kbd{C-x * q} (@code{quick-calc})
9737 which prompts you for a formula (like @samp{2+3/4}). The result is
9738 displayed at the bottom of the Emacs screen without ever creating
9739 any special Calculator windows. @xref{Quick Calculator}.
9740
9741 @ignore
9742 @mindex C-x * k
9743 @end ignore
9744 Finally, if you are using the X window system you may want to try
9745 @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) which runs Calc with a
9746 ``calculator keypad'' picture as well as a stack display. Click on
9747 the keys with the mouse to operate the calculator. @xref{Keypad Mode}.
9748
9749 @kindex q
9750 @pindex calc-quit
9751 @cindex Quitting the Calculator
9752 @cindex Exiting the Calculator
9753 The @kbd{q} key (@code{calc-quit}) exits Calc mode and closes the
9754 Calculator's window(s). It does not delete the Calculator buffers.
9755 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} again, the Calculator will reappear with the
9756 contents of the stack intact. Typing @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}
9757 again from inside the Calculator buffer is equivalent to executing
9758 @code{calc-quit}; you can think of @kbd{C-x * *} as toggling the
9759 Calculator on and off.
9760
9761 @kindex C-x * x
9762 The @kbd{C-x * x} command also turns the Calculator off, no matter which
9763 user interface (standard, Keypad, or Embedded) is currently active.
9764 It also cancels @code{calc-edit} mode if used from there.
9765
9766 @kindex d @key{SPC}
9767 @pindex calc-refresh
9768 @cindex Refreshing a garbled display
9769 @cindex Garbled displays, refreshing
9770 The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} key sequence (@code{calc-refresh}) redraws the contents
9771 of the Calculator buffer from memory. Use this if the contents of the
9772 buffer have been damaged somehow.
9773
9774 @ignore
9775 @mindex o
9776 @end ignore
9777 The @kbd{o} key (@code{calc-realign}) moves the cursor back to its
9778 ``home'' position at the bottom of the Calculator buffer.
9779
9780 @kindex <
9781 @kindex >
9782 @pindex calc-scroll-left
9783 @pindex calc-scroll-right
9784 @cindex Horizontal scrolling
9785 @cindex Scrolling
9786 @cindex Wide text, scrolling
9787 The @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-left} and
9788 @code{calc-scroll-right}. These are just like the normal horizontal
9789 scrolling commands except that they scroll one half-screen at a time by
9790 default. (Calc formats its output to fit within the bounds of the
9791 window whenever it can.)
9792
9793 @kindex @{
9794 @kindex @}
9795 @pindex calc-scroll-down
9796 @pindex calc-scroll-up
9797 @cindex Vertical scrolling
9798 The @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-down}
9799 and @code{calc-scroll-up}. They scroll up or down by one-half the
9800 height of the Calc window.
9801
9802 @kindex C-x * 0
9803 @pindex calc-reset
9804 The @kbd{C-x * 0} command (@code{calc-reset}; that's @kbd{C-x *} followed
9805 by a zero) resets the Calculator to its initial state. This clears
9806 the stack, resets all the modes to their initial values (the values
9807 that were saved with @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})), clears the
9808 caches (@pxref{Caches}), and so on. (It does @emph{not} erase the
9809 values of any variables.) With an argument of 0, Calc will be reset to
9810 its default state; namely, the modes will be given their default values.
9811 With a positive prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of
9812 the stack but resets everything else to its initial state; with a
9813 negative prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of the
9814 stack but resets everything else to its default state.
9815
9816 @node Help Commands, Stack Basics, Basic Commands, Introduction
9817 @section Help Commands
9818
9819 @noindent
9820 @cindex Help commands
9821 @kindex ?
9822 @kindex a ?
9823 @kindex b ?
9824 @kindex c ?
9825 @kindex d ?
9826 @kindex f ?
9827 @kindex g ?
9828 @kindex j ?
9829 @kindex k ?
9830 @kindex m ?
9831 @kindex r ?
9832 @kindex s ?
9833 @kindex t ?
9834 @kindex u ?
9835 @kindex v ?
9836 @kindex V ?
9837 @kindex z ?
9838 @kindex Z ?
9839 @pindex calc-help
9840 The @kbd{?} key (@code{calc-help}) displays a series of brief help messages.
9841 Some keys (such as @kbd{b} and @kbd{d}) are prefix keys, like Emacs'
9842 @key{ESC} and @kbd{C-x} prefixes. You can type
9843 @kbd{?} after a prefix to see a list of commands beginning with that
9844 prefix. (If the message includes @samp{[MORE]}, press @kbd{?} again
9845 to see additional commands for that prefix.)
9846
9847 @kindex h h
9848 @pindex calc-full-help
9849 The @kbd{h h} (@code{calc-full-help}) command displays all the @kbd{?}
9850 responses at once. When printed, this makes a nice, compact (three pages)
9851 summary of Calc keystrokes.
9852
9853 In general, the @kbd{h} key prefix introduces various commands that
9854 provide help within Calc. Many of the @kbd{h} key functions are
9855 Calc-specific analogues to the @kbd{C-h} functions for Emacs help.
9856
9857 @kindex h i
9858 @kindex C-x * i
9859 @kindex i
9860 @pindex calc-info
9861 The @kbd{h i} (@code{calc-info}) command runs the Emacs Info system
9862 to read this manual on-line. This is basically the same as typing
9863 @kbd{C-h i} (the regular way to run the Info system), then, if Info
9864 is not already in the Calc manual, selecting the beginning of the
9865 manual. The @kbd{C-x * i} command is another way to read the Calc
9866 manual; it is different from @kbd{h i} in that it works any time,
9867 not just inside Calc. The plain @kbd{i} key is also equivalent to
9868 @kbd{h i}, though this key is obsolete and may be replaced with a
9869 different command in a future version of Calc.
9870
9871 @kindex h t
9872 @kindex C-x * t
9873 @pindex calc-tutorial
9874 The @kbd{h t} (@code{calc-tutorial}) command runs the Info system on
9875 the Tutorial section of the Calc manual. It is like @kbd{h i},
9876 except that it selects the starting node of the tutorial rather
9877 than the beginning of the whole manual. (It actually selects the
9878 node ``Interactive Tutorial'' which tells a few things about
9879 using the Info system before going on to the actual tutorial.)
9880 The @kbd{C-x * t} key is equivalent to @kbd{h t} (but it works at
9881 all times).
9882
9883 @kindex h s
9884 @kindex C-x * s
9885 @pindex calc-info-summary
9886 The @kbd{h s} (@code{calc-info-summary}) command runs the Info system
9887 on the Summary node of the Calc manual. @xref{Summary}. The @kbd{C-x * s}
9888 key is equivalent to @kbd{h s}.
9889
9890 @kindex h k
9891 @pindex calc-describe-key
9892 The @kbd{h k} (@code{calc-describe-key}) command looks up a key
9893 sequence in the Calc manual. For example, @kbd{h k H a S} looks
9894 up the documentation on the @kbd{H a S} (@code{calc-solve-for})
9895 command. This works by looking up the textual description of
9896 the key(s) in the Key Index of the manual, then jumping to the
9897 node indicated by the index.
9898
9899 Most Calc commands do not have traditional Emacs documentation
9900 strings, since the @kbd{h k} command is both more convenient and
9901 more instructive. This means the regular Emacs @kbd{C-h k}
9902 (@code{describe-key}) command will not be useful for Calc keystrokes.
9903
9904 @kindex h c
9905 @pindex calc-describe-key-briefly
9906 The @kbd{h c} (@code{calc-describe-key-briefly}) command reads a
9907 key sequence and displays a brief one-line description of it at
9908 the bottom of the screen. It looks for the key sequence in the
9909 Summary node of the Calc manual; if it doesn't find the sequence
9910 there, it acts just like its regular Emacs counterpart @kbd{C-h c}
9911 (@code{describe-key-briefly}). For example, @kbd{h c H a S}
9912 gives the description:
9913
9914 @smallexample
9915 H a S runs calc-solve-for: a `H a S' v => fsolve(a,v) (?=notes)
9916 @end smallexample
9917
9918 @noindent
9919 which means the command @kbd{H a S} or @kbd{H M-x calc-solve-for}
9920 takes a value @expr{a} from the stack, prompts for a value @expr{v},
9921 then applies the algebraic function @code{fsolve} to these values.
9922 The @samp{?=notes} message means you can now type @kbd{?} to see
9923 additional notes from the summary that apply to this command.
9924
9925 @kindex h f
9926 @pindex calc-describe-function
9927 The @kbd{h f} (@code{calc-describe-function}) command looks up an
9928 algebraic function or a command name in the Calc manual. Enter an
9929 algebraic function name to look up that function in the Function
9930 Index or enter a command name beginning with @samp{calc-} to look it
9931 up in the Command Index. This command will also look up operator
9932 symbols that can appear in algebraic formulas, like @samp{%} and
9933 @samp{=>}.
9934
9935 @kindex h v
9936 @pindex calc-describe-variable
9937 The @kbd{h v} (@code{calc-describe-variable}) command looks up a
9938 variable in the Calc manual. Enter a variable name like @code{pi} or
9939 @code{PlotRejects}.
9940
9941 @kindex h b
9942 @pindex describe-bindings
9943 The @kbd{h b} (@code{calc-describe-bindings}) command is just like
9944 @kbd{C-h b}, except that only local (Calc-related) key bindings are
9945 listed.
9946
9947 @kindex h n
9948 The @kbd{h n} or @kbd{h C-n} (@code{calc-view-news}) command displays
9949 the ``news'' or change history of Calc. This is kept in the file
9950 @file{README}, which Calc looks for in the same directory as the Calc
9951 source files.
9952
9953 @kindex h C-c
9954 @kindex h C-d
9955 @kindex h C-w
9956 The @kbd{h C-c}, @kbd{h C-d}, and @kbd{h C-w} keys display copying,
9957 distribution, and warranty information about Calc. These work by
9958 pulling up the appropriate parts of the ``Copying'' or ``Reporting
9959 Bugs'' sections of the manual.
9960
9961 @node Stack Basics, Numeric Entry, Help Commands, Introduction
9962 @section Stack Basics
9963
9964 @noindent
9965 @cindex Stack basics
9966 @c [fix-tut RPN Calculations and the Stack]
9967 Calc uses RPN notation. If you are not familiar with RPN, @pxref{RPN
9968 Tutorial}.
9969
9970 To add the numbers 1 and 2 in Calc you would type the keys:
9971 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 +}.
9972 (@key{RET} corresponds to the @key{ENTER} key on most calculators.)
9973 The first three keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 1 and 2 onto the stack. The
9974 @kbd{+} key always ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
9975 and pushes the result (3) back onto the stack. This number is ready for
9976 further calculations: @kbd{5 -} pushes 5 onto the stack, then pops the
9977 3 and 5, subtracts them, and pushes the result (@mathit{-2}).
9978
9979 Note that the ``top'' of the stack actually appears at the @emph{bottom}
9980 of the buffer. A line containing a single @samp{.} character signifies
9981 the end of the buffer; Calculator commands operate on the number(s)
9982 directly above this line. The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack})
9983 command allows you to move the @samp{.} marker up and down in the stack;
9984 @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
9985
9986 @kindex d l
9987 @pindex calc-line-numbering
9988 Stack elements are numbered consecutively, with number 1 being the top of
9989 the stack. These line numbers are ordinarily displayed on the lefthand side
9990 of the window. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) command controls
9991 whether these numbers appear. (Line numbers may be turned off since they
9992 slow the Calculator down a bit and also clutter the display.)
9993
9994 @kindex o
9995 @pindex calc-realign
9996 The unshifted letter @kbd{o} (@code{calc-realign}) command repositions
9997 the cursor to its top-of-stack ``home'' position. It also undoes any
9998 horizontal scrolling in the window. If you give it a numeric prefix
9999 argument, it instead moves the cursor to the specified stack element.
10000
10001 The @key{RET} (or equivalent @key{SPC}) key is only required to separate
10002 two consecutive numbers.
10003 (After all, if you typed @kbd{1 2} by themselves the Calculator
10004 would enter the number 12.) If you press @key{RET} or @key{SPC} @emph{not}
10005 right after typing a number, the key duplicates the number on the top of
10006 the stack. @kbd{@key{RET} *} is thus a handy way to square a number.
10007
10008 The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the top number on the stack.
10009 The @key{TAB} key swaps the top two objects on the stack.
10010 @xref{Stack and Trail}, for descriptions of these and other stack-related
10011 commands.
10012
10013 @node Numeric Entry, Algebraic Entry, Stack Basics, Introduction
10014 @section Numeric Entry
10015
10016 @noindent
10017 @kindex 0-9
10018 @kindex .
10019 @kindex e
10020 @cindex Numeric entry
10021 @cindex Entering numbers
10022 Pressing a digit or other numeric key begins numeric entry using the
10023 minibuffer. The number is pushed on the stack when you press the @key{RET}
10024 or @key{SPC} keys. If you press any other non-numeric key, the number is
10025 pushed onto the stack and the appropriate operation is performed. If
10026 you press a numeric key which is not valid, the key is ignored.
10027
10028 @cindex Minus signs
10029 @cindex Negative numbers, entering
10030 @kindex _
10031 There are three different concepts corresponding to the word ``minus,''
10032 typified by @expr{a-b} (subtraction), @expr{-x}
10033 (change-sign), and @expr{-5} (negative number). Calc uses three
10034 different keys for these operations, respectively:
10035 @kbd{-}, @kbd{n}, and @kbd{_} (the underscore). The @kbd{-} key subtracts
10036 the two numbers on the top of the stack. The @kbd{n} key changes the sign
10037 of the number on the top of the stack or the number currently being entered.
10038 The @kbd{_} key begins entry of a negative number or changes the sign of
10039 the number currently being entered. The following sequences all enter the
10040 number @mathit{-5} onto the stack: @kbd{0 @key{RET} 5 -}, @kbd{5 n @key{RET}},
10041 @kbd{5 @key{RET} n}, @kbd{_ 5 @key{RET}}, @kbd{5 _ @key{RET}}.
10042
10043 Some other keys are active during numeric entry, such as @kbd{#} for
10044 non-decimal numbers, @kbd{:} for fractions, and @kbd{@@} for HMS forms.
10045 These notations are described later in this manual with the corresponding
10046 data types. @xref{Data Types}.
10047
10048 During numeric entry, the only editing key available is @key{DEL}.
10049
10050 @node Algebraic Entry, Quick Calculator, Numeric Entry, Introduction
10051 @section Algebraic Entry
10052
10053 @noindent
10054 @kindex '
10055 @pindex calc-algebraic-entry
10056 @cindex Algebraic notation
10057 @cindex Formulas, entering
10058 The @kbd{'} (@code{calc-algebraic-entry}) command can be used to enter
10059 calculations in algebraic form. This is accomplished by typing the
10060 apostrophe key, ', followed by the expression in standard format:
10061
10062 @example
10063 ' 2+3*4 @key{RET}.
10064 @end example
10065
10066 @noindent
10067 This will compute
10068 @texline @math{2+(3\times4) = 14}
10069 @infoline @expr{2+(3*4) = 14}
10070 and push it on the stack. If you wish you can
10071 ignore the RPN aspect of Calc altogether and simply enter algebraic
10072 expressions in this way. You may want to use @key{DEL} every so often to
10073 clear previous results off the stack.
10074
10075 You can press the apostrophe key during normal numeric entry to switch
10076 the half-entered number into Algebraic entry mode. One reason to do
10077 this would be to fix a typo, as the full Emacs cursor motion and editing
10078 keys are available during algebraic entry but not during numeric entry.
10079
10080 In the same vein, during either numeric or algebraic entry you can
10081 press @kbd{`} (backquote) to switch to @code{calc-edit} mode, where
10082 you complete your half-finished entry in a separate buffer.
10083 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}.
10084
10085 @kindex m a
10086 @pindex calc-algebraic-mode
10087 @cindex Algebraic Mode
10088 If you prefer algebraic entry, you can use the command @kbd{m a}
10089 (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) to set Algebraic mode. In this mode,
10090 digits and other keys that would normally start numeric entry instead
10091 start full algebraic entry; as long as your formula begins with a digit
10092 you can omit the apostrophe. Open parentheses and square brackets also
10093 begin algebraic entry. You can still do RPN calculations in this mode,
10094 but you will have to press @key{RET} to terminate every number:
10095 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} +} would accomplish the same
10096 thing as @kbd{2*3+4 @key{RET}}.
10097
10098 @cindex Incomplete Algebraic Mode
10099 If you give a numeric prefix argument like @kbd{C-u} to the @kbd{m a}
10100 command, it enables Incomplete Algebraic mode; this is like regular
10101 Algebraic mode except that it applies to the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys
10102 only. Numeric keys still begin a numeric entry in this mode.
10103
10104 @kindex m t
10105 @pindex calc-total-algebraic-mode
10106 @cindex Total Algebraic Mode
10107 The @kbd{m t} (@code{calc-total-algebraic-mode}) gives you an even
10108 stronger algebraic-entry mode, in which @emph{all} regular letter and
10109 punctuation keys begin algebraic entry. Use this if you prefer typing
10110 @w{@kbd{sqrt( )}} instead of @kbd{Q}, @w{@kbd{factor( )}} instead of
10111 @kbd{a f}, and so on. To type regular Calc commands when you are in
10112 Total Algebraic mode, hold down the @key{META} key. Thus @kbd{M-q}
10113 is the command to quit Calc, @kbd{M-p} sets the precision, and
10114 @kbd{M-m t} (or @kbd{M-m M-t}, if you prefer) turns Total Algebraic
10115 mode back off again. Meta keys also terminate algebraic entry, so
10116 that @kbd{2+3 M-S} is equivalent to @kbd{2+3 @key{RET} M-S}. The symbol
10117 @samp{Alg*} will appear in the mode line whenever you are in this mode.
10118
10119 Pressing @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) a second time re-enters the previous
10120 algebraic formula. You can then use the normal Emacs editing keys to
10121 modify this formula to your liking before pressing @key{RET}.
10122
10123 @kindex $
10124 @cindex Formulas, referring to stack
10125 Within a formula entered from the keyboard, the symbol @kbd{$}
10126 represents the number on the top of the stack. If an entered formula
10127 contains any @kbd{$} characters, the Calculator replaces the top of
10128 stack with that formula rather than simply pushing the formula onto the
10129 stack. Thus, @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3 on the stack, and @kbd{$*2
10130 @key{RET}} replaces it with 6. Note that the @kbd{$} key always
10131 initiates algebraic entry; the @kbd{'} is unnecessary if @kbd{$} is the
10132 first character in the new formula.
10133
10134 Higher stack elements can be accessed from an entered formula with the
10135 symbols @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on. The number of stack elements
10136 removed (to be replaced by the entered values) equals the number of dollar
10137 signs in the longest such symbol in the formula. For example, @samp{$$+$$$}
10138 adds the second and third stack elements, replacing the top three elements
10139 with the answer. (All information about the top stack element is thus lost
10140 since no single @samp{$} appears in this formula.)
10141
10142 A slightly different way to refer to stack elements is with a dollar
10143 sign followed by a number: @samp{$1}, @samp{$2}, and so on are much
10144 like @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, etc., except that stack entries referred
10145 to numerically are not replaced by the algebraic entry. That is, while
10146 @samp{$+1} replaces 5 on the stack with 6, @samp{$1+1} leaves the 5
10147 on the stack and pushes an additional 6.
10148
10149 If a sequence of formulas are entered separated by commas, each formula
10150 is pushed onto the stack in turn. For example, @samp{1,2,3} pushes
10151 those three numbers onto the stack (leaving the 3 at the top), and
10152 @samp{$+1,$-1} replaces a 5 on the stack with 4 followed by 6. Also,
10153 @samp{$,$$} exchanges the top two elements of the stack, just like the
10154 @key{TAB} key.
10155
10156 You can finish an algebraic entry with @kbd{M-=} or @kbd{M-@key{RET}} instead
10157 of @key{RET}. This uses @kbd{=} to evaluate the variables in each
10158 formula that goes onto the stack. (Thus @kbd{' pi @key{RET}} pushes
10159 the variable @samp{pi}, but @kbd{' pi M-@key{RET}} pushes 3.1415.)
10160
10161 If you finish your algebraic entry by pressing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j})
10162 instead of @key{RET}, Calc disables the default simplifications
10163 (as if by @kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}) while the entry
10164 is being pushed on the stack. Thus @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3
10165 on the stack, but @kbd{' 1+2 @key{LFD}} pushes the formula @expr{1+2};
10166 you might then press @kbd{=} when it is time to evaluate this formula.
10167
10168 @node Quick Calculator, Prefix Arguments, Algebraic Entry, Introduction
10169 @section ``Quick Calculator'' Mode
10170
10171 @noindent
10172 @kindex C-x * q
10173 @pindex quick-calc
10174 @cindex Quick Calculator
10175 There is another way to invoke the Calculator if all you need to do
10176 is make one or two quick calculations. Type @kbd{C-x * q} (or
10177 @kbd{M-x quick-calc}), then type any formula as an algebraic entry.
10178 The Calculator will compute the result and display it in the echo
10179 area, without ever actually putting up a Calc window.
10180
10181 You can use the @kbd{$} character in a Quick Calculator formula to
10182 refer to the previous Quick Calculator result. Older results are
10183 not retained; the Quick Calculator has no effect on the full
10184 Calculator's stack or trail. If you compute a result and then
10185 forget what it was, just run @code{C-x * q} again and enter
10186 @samp{$} as the formula.
10187
10188 If this is the first time you have used the Calculator in this Emacs
10189 session, the @kbd{C-x * q} command will create the @code{*Calculator*}
10190 buffer and perform all the usual initializations; it simply will
10191 refrain from putting that buffer up in a new window. The Quick
10192 Calculator refers to the @code{*Calculator*} buffer for all mode
10193 settings. Thus, for example, to set the precision that the Quick
10194 Calculator uses, simply run the full Calculator momentarily and use
10195 the regular @kbd{p} command.
10196
10197 If you use @code{C-x * q} from inside the Calculator buffer, the
10198 effect is the same as pressing the apostrophe key (algebraic entry).
10199
10200 The result of a Quick calculation is placed in the Emacs ``kill ring''
10201 as well as being displayed. A subsequent @kbd{C-y} command will
10202 yank the result into the editing buffer. You can also use this
10203 to yank the result into the next @kbd{C-x * q} input line as a more
10204 explicit alternative to @kbd{$} notation, or to yank the result
10205 into the Calculator stack after typing @kbd{C-x * c}.
10206
10207 If you finish your formula by typing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j}) instead
10208 of @key{RET}, the result is inserted immediately into the current
10209 buffer rather than going into the kill ring.
10210
10211 Quick Calculator results are actually evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
10212 key (which replaces variable names by their stored values, if any).
10213 If the formula you enter is an assignment to a variable using the
10214 @samp{:=} operator, say, @samp{foo := 2 + 3} or @samp{foo := foo + 1},
10215 then the result of the evaluation is stored in that Calc variable.
10216 @xref{Store and Recall}.
10217
10218 If the result is an integer and the current display radix is decimal,
10219 the number will also be displayed in hex, octal and binary formats. If
10220 the integer is in the range from 1 to 126, it will also be displayed as
10221 an ASCII character.
10222
10223 For example, the quoted character @samp{"x"} produces the vector
10224 result @samp{[120]} (because 120 is the ASCII code of the lower-case
10225 `x'; @pxref{Strings}). Since this is a vector, not an integer, it
10226 is displayed only according to the current mode settings. But
10227 running Quick Calc again and entering @samp{120} will produce the
10228 result @samp{120 (16#78, 8#170, x)} which shows the number in its
10229 decimal, hexadecimal, octal, and ASCII forms.
10230
10231 Please note that the Quick Calculator is not any faster at loading
10232 or computing the answer than the full Calculator; the name ``quick''
10233 merely refers to the fact that it's much less hassle to use for
10234 small calculations.
10235
10236 @node Prefix Arguments, Undo, Quick Calculator, Introduction
10237 @section Numeric Prefix Arguments
10238
10239 @noindent
10240 Many Calculator commands use numeric prefix arguments. Some, such as
10241 @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}), set a parameter to the value of
10242 the prefix argument or use a default if you don't use a prefix.
10243 Others (like @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation})) require an argument
10244 and prompt for a number if you don't give one as a prefix.
10245
10246 As a rule, stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric prefix argument
10247 which is interpreted as an index into the stack. A positive argument
10248 operates on the top @var{n} stack entries; a negative argument operates
10249 on the @var{n}th stack entry in isolation; and a zero argument operates
10250 on the entire stack.
10251
10252 Most commands that perform computations (such as the arithmetic and
10253 scientific functions) accept a numeric prefix argument that allows the
10254 operation to be applied across many stack elements. For unary operations
10255 (that is, functions of one argument like absolute value or complex
10256 conjugate), a positive prefix argument applies that function to the top
10257 @var{n} stack entries simultaneously, and a negative argument applies it
10258 to the @var{n}th stack entry only. For binary operations (functions of
10259 two arguments like addition, GCD, and vector concatenation), a positive
10260 prefix argument ``reduces'' the function across the top @var{n}
10261 stack elements (for example, @kbd{C-u 5 +} sums the top 5 stack entries;
10262 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}), and a negative argument maps the next-to-top
10263 @var{n} stack elements with the top stack element as a second argument
10264 (for example, @kbd{7 c-u -5 +} adds 7 to the top 5 stack elements).
10265 This feature is not available for operations which use the numeric prefix
10266 argument for some other purpose.
10267
10268 Numeric prefixes are specified the same way as always in Emacs: Press
10269 a sequence of @key{META}-digits, or press @key{ESC} followed by digits,
10270 or press @kbd{C-u} followed by digits. Some commands treat plain
10271 @kbd{C-u} (without any actual digits) specially.
10272
10273 @kindex ~
10274 @pindex calc-num-prefix
10275 You can type @kbd{~} (@code{calc-num-prefix}) to pop an integer from the
10276 top of the stack and enter it as the numeric prefix for the next command.
10277 For example, @kbd{C-u 16 p} sets the precision to 16 digits; an alternate
10278 (silly) way to do this would be @kbd{2 @key{RET} 4 ^ ~ p}, i.e., compute 2
10279 to the fourth power and set the precision to that value.
10280
10281 Conversely, if you have typed a numeric prefix argument the @kbd{~} key
10282 pushes it onto the stack in the form of an integer.
10283
10284 @node Undo, Error Messages, Prefix Arguments, Introduction
10285 @section Undoing Mistakes
10286
10287 @noindent
10288 @kindex U
10289 @kindex C-_
10290 @pindex calc-undo
10291 @cindex Mistakes, undoing
10292 @cindex Undoing mistakes
10293 @cindex Errors, undoing
10294 The shift-@kbd{U} key (@code{calc-undo}) undoes the most recent operation.
10295 If that operation added or dropped objects from the stack, those objects
10296 are removed or restored. If it was a ``store'' operation, you are
10297 queried whether or not to restore the variable to its original value.
10298 The @kbd{U} key may be pressed any number of times to undo successively
10299 farther back in time; with a numeric prefix argument it undoes a
10300 specified number of operations. When the Calculator is quit, as with
10301 the @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command, the undo history will be
10302 truncated to the length of the customizable variable
10303 @code{calc-undo-length} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), which by default
10304 is @expr{100}. (Recall that @kbd{C-x * c} is synonymous with
10305 @code{calc-quit} while inside the Calculator; this also truncates the
10306 undo history.)
10307
10308 Currently the mode-setting commands (like @code{calc-precision}) are not
10309 undoable. You can undo past a point where you changed a mode, but you
10310 will need to reset the mode yourself.
10311
10312 @kindex D
10313 @pindex calc-redo
10314 @cindex Redoing after an Undo
10315 The shift-@kbd{D} key (@code{calc-redo}) redoes an operation that was
10316 mistakenly undone. Pressing @kbd{U} with a negative prefix argument is
10317 equivalent to executing @code{calc-redo}. You can redo any number of
10318 times, up to the number of recent consecutive undo commands. Redo
10319 information is cleared whenever you give any command that adds new undo
10320 information, i.e., if you undo, then enter a number on the stack or make
10321 any other change, then it will be too late to redo.
10322
10323 @kindex M-@key{RET}
10324 @pindex calc-last-args
10325 @cindex Last-arguments feature
10326 @cindex Arguments, restoring
10327 The @kbd{M-@key{RET}} key (@code{calc-last-args}) is like undo in that
10328 it restores the arguments of the most recent command onto the stack;
10329 however, it does not remove the result of that command. Given a numeric
10330 prefix argument, this command applies to the @expr{n}th most recent
10331 command which removed items from the stack; it pushes those items back
10332 onto the stack.
10333
10334 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command provides a related function
10335 to @kbd{M-@key{RET}}. @xref{Stack and Trail}.
10336
10337 It is also possible to recall previous results or inputs using the trail.
10338 @xref{Trail Commands}.
10339
10340 The standard Emacs @kbd{C-_} undo key is recognized as a synonym for @kbd{U}.
10341
10342 @node Error Messages, Multiple Calculators, Undo, Introduction
10343 @section Error Messages
10344
10345 @noindent
10346 @kindex w
10347 @pindex calc-why
10348 @cindex Errors, messages
10349 @cindex Why did an error occur?
10350 Many situations that would produce an error message in other calculators
10351 simply create unsimplified formulas in the Emacs Calculator. For example,
10352 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} pushes the formula @expr{1 / 0}; @w{@kbd{0 L}} pushes
10353 the formula @samp{ln(0)}. Floating-point overflow and underflow are also
10354 reasons for this to happen.
10355
10356 When a function call must be left in symbolic form, Calc usually
10357 produces a message explaining why. Messages that are probably
10358 surprising or indicative of user errors are displayed automatically.
10359 Other messages are simply kept in Calc's memory and are displayed only
10360 if you type @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why}). You can also press @kbd{w} if
10361 the same computation results in several messages. (The first message
10362 will end with @samp{[w=more]} in this case.)
10363
10364 @kindex d w
10365 @pindex calc-auto-why
10366 The @kbd{d w} (@code{calc-auto-why}) command controls when error messages
10367 are displayed automatically. (Calc effectively presses @kbd{w} for you
10368 after your computation finishes.) By default, this occurs only for
10369 ``important'' messages. The other possible modes are to report
10370 @emph{all} messages automatically, or to report none automatically (so
10371 that you must always press @kbd{w} yourself to see the messages).
10372
10373 @node Multiple Calculators, Troubleshooting Commands, Error Messages, Introduction
10374 @section Multiple Calculators
10375
10376 @noindent
10377 @pindex another-calc
10378 It is possible to have any number of Calc mode buffers at once.
10379 Usually this is done by executing @kbd{M-x another-calc}, which
10380 is similar to @kbd{C-x * c} except that if a @samp{*Calculator*}
10381 buffer already exists, a new, independent one with a name of the
10382 form @samp{*Calculator*<@var{n}>} is created. You can also use the
10383 command @code{calc-mode} to put any buffer into Calculator mode, but
10384 this would ordinarily never be done.
10385
10386 The @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command does not destroy a Calculator buffer;
10387 it only closes its window. Use @kbd{M-x kill-buffer} to destroy a
10388 Calculator buffer.
10389
10390 Each Calculator buffer keeps its own stack, undo list, and mode settings
10391 such as precision, angular mode, and display formats. In Emacs terms,
10392 variables such as @code{calc-stack} are buffer-local variables. The
10393 global default values of these variables are used only when a new
10394 Calculator buffer is created. The @code{calc-quit} command saves
10395 the stack and mode settings of the buffer being quit as the new defaults.
10396
10397 There is only one trail buffer, @samp{*Calc Trail*}, used by all
10398 Calculator buffers.
10399
10400 @node Troubleshooting Commands, , Multiple Calculators, Introduction
10401 @section Troubleshooting Commands
10402
10403 @noindent
10404 This section describes commands you can use in case a computation
10405 incorrectly fails or gives the wrong answer.
10406
10407 @xref{Reporting Bugs}, if you find a problem that appears to be due
10408 to a bug or deficiency in Calc.
10409
10410 @menu
10411 * Autoloading Problems::
10412 * Recursion Depth::
10413 * Caches::
10414 * Debugging Calc::
10415 @end menu
10416
10417 @node Autoloading Problems, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands, Troubleshooting Commands
10418 @subsection Autoloading Problems
10419
10420 @noindent
10421 The Calc program is split into many component files; components are
10422 loaded automatically as you use various commands that require them.
10423 Occasionally Calc may lose track of when a certain component is
10424 necessary; typically this means you will type a command and it won't
10425 work because some function you've never heard of was undefined.
10426
10427 @kindex C-x * L
10428 @pindex calc-load-everything
10429 If this happens, the easiest workaround is to type @kbd{C-x * L}
10430 (@code{calc-load-everything}) to force all the parts of Calc to be
10431 loaded right away. This will cause Emacs to take up a lot more
10432 memory than it would otherwise, but it's guaranteed to fix the problem.
10433
10434 @node Recursion Depth, Caches, Autoloading Problems, Troubleshooting Commands
10435 @subsection Recursion Depth
10436
10437 @noindent
10438 @kindex M
10439 @kindex I M
10440 @pindex calc-more-recursion-depth
10441 @pindex calc-less-recursion-depth
10442 @cindex Recursion depth
10443 @cindex ``Computation got stuck'' message
10444 @cindex @code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10445 @cindex @code{max-specpdl-size}
10446 Calc uses recursion in many of its calculations. Emacs Lisp keeps a
10447 variable @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} which limits the amount of recursion
10448 possible in an attempt to recover from program bugs. If a calculation
10449 ever halts incorrectly with the message ``Computation got stuck or
10450 ran too long,'' use the @kbd{M} command (@code{calc-more-recursion-depth})
10451 to increase this limit. (Of course, this will not help if the
10452 calculation really did get stuck due to some problem inside Calc.)
10453
10454 The limit is always increased (multiplied) by a factor of two. There
10455 is also an @kbd{I M} (@code{calc-less-recursion-depth}) command which
10456 decreases this limit by a factor of two, down to a minimum value of 200.
10457 The default value is 1000.
10458
10459 These commands also double or halve @code{max-specpdl-size}, another
10460 internal Lisp recursion limit. The minimum value for this limit is 600.
10461
10462 @node Caches, Debugging Calc, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands
10463 @subsection Caches
10464
10465 @noindent
10466 @cindex Caches
10467 @cindex Flushing caches
10468 Calc saves certain values after they have been computed once. For
10469 example, the @kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}) command initially ``knows'' the
10470 constant @cpi{} to about 20 decimal places; if the current precision
10471 is greater than this, it will recompute @cpi{} using a series
10472 approximation. This value will not need to be recomputed ever again
10473 unless you raise the precision still further. Many operations such as
10474 logarithms and sines make use of similarly cached values such as
10475 @cpiover{4} and
10476 @texline @math{\ln 2}.
10477 @infoline @expr{ln(2)}.
10478 The visible effect of caching is that
10479 high-precision computations may seem to do extra work the first time.
10480 Other things cached include powers of two (for the binary arithmetic
10481 functions), matrix inverses and determinants, symbolic integrals, and
10482 data points computed by the graphing commands.
10483
10484 @pindex calc-flush-caches
10485 If you suspect a Calculator cache has become corrupt, you can use the
10486 @code{calc-flush-caches} command to reset all caches to the empty state.
10487 (This should only be necessary in the event of bugs in the Calculator.)
10488 The @kbd{C-x * 0} (with the zero key) command also resets caches along
10489 with all other aspects of the Calculator's state.
10490
10491 @node Debugging Calc, , Caches, Troubleshooting Commands
10492 @subsection Debugging Calc
10493
10494 @noindent
10495 A few commands exist to help in the debugging of Calc commands.
10496 @xref{Programming}, to see the various ways that you can write
10497 your own Calc commands.
10498
10499 @kindex Z T
10500 @pindex calc-timing
10501 The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing}) command turns on and off a mode
10502 in which the timing of slow commands is reported in the Trail.
10503 Any Calc command that takes two seconds or longer writes a line
10504 to the Trail showing how many seconds it took. This value is
10505 accurate only to within one second.
10506
10507 All steps of executing a command are included; in particular, time
10508 taken to format the result for display in the stack and trail is
10509 counted. Some prompts also count time taken waiting for them to
10510 be answered, while others do not; this depends on the exact
10511 implementation of the command. For best results, if you are timing
10512 a sequence that includes prompts or multiple commands, define a
10513 keyboard macro to run the whole sequence at once. Calc's @kbd{X}
10514 command (@pxref{Keyboard Macros}) will then report the time taken
10515 to execute the whole macro.
10516
10517 Another advantage of the @kbd{X} command is that while it is
10518 executing, the stack and trail are not updated from step to step.
10519 So if you expect the output of your test sequence to leave a result
10520 that may take a long time to format and you don't wish to count
10521 this formatting time, end your sequence with a @key{DEL} keystroke
10522 to clear the result from the stack. When you run the sequence with
10523 @kbd{X}, Calc will never bother to format the large result.
10524
10525 Another thing @kbd{Z T} does is to increase the Emacs variable
10526 @code{gc-cons-threshold} to a much higher value (two million; the
10527 usual default in Calc is 250,000) for the duration of each command.
10528 This generally prevents garbage collection during the timing of
10529 the command, though it may cause your Emacs process to grow
10530 abnormally large. (Garbage collection time is a major unpredictable
10531 factor in the timing of Emacs operations.)
10532
10533 Another command that is useful when debugging your own Lisp
10534 extensions to Calc is @kbd{M-x calc-pass-errors}, which disables
10535 the error handler that changes the ``@code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10536 exceeded'' message to the much more friendly ``Computation got
10537 stuck or ran too long.'' This handler interferes with the Emacs
10538 Lisp debugger's @code{debug-on-error} mode. Errors are reported
10539 in the handler itself rather than at the true location of the
10540 error. After you have executed @code{calc-pass-errors}, Lisp
10541 errors will be reported correctly but the user-friendly message
10542 will be lost.
10543
10544 @node Data Types, Stack and Trail, Introduction, Top
10545 @chapter Data Types
10546
10547 @noindent
10548 This chapter discusses the various types of objects that can be placed
10549 on the Calculator stack, how they are displayed, and how they are
10550 entered. (@xref{Data Type Formats}, for information on how these data
10551 types are represented as underlying Lisp objects.)
10552
10553 Integers, fractions, and floats are various ways of describing real
10554 numbers. HMS forms also for many purposes act as real numbers. These
10555 types can be combined to form complex numbers, modulo forms, error forms,
10556 or interval forms. (But these last four types cannot be combined
10557 arbitrarily:@: error forms may not contain modulo forms, for example.)
10558 Finally, all these types of numbers may be combined into vectors,
10559 matrices, or algebraic formulas.
10560
10561 @menu
10562 * Integers:: The most basic data type.
10563 * Fractions:: This and above are called @dfn{rationals}.
10564 * Floats:: This and above are called @dfn{reals}.
10565 * Complex Numbers:: This and above are called @dfn{numbers}.
10566 * Infinities::
10567 * Vectors and Matrices::
10568 * Strings::
10569 * HMS Forms::
10570 * Date Forms::
10571 * Modulo Forms::
10572 * Error Forms::
10573 * Interval Forms::
10574 * Incomplete Objects::
10575 * Variables::
10576 * Formulas::
10577 @end menu
10578
10579 @node Integers, Fractions, Data Types, Data Types
10580 @section Integers
10581
10582 @noindent
10583 @cindex Integers
10584 The Calculator stores integers to arbitrary precision. Addition,
10585 subtraction, and multiplication of integers always yields an exact
10586 integer result. (If the result of a division or exponentiation of
10587 integers is not an integer, it is expressed in fractional or
10588 floating-point form according to the current Fraction mode.
10589 @xref{Fraction Mode}.)
10590
10591 A decimal integer is represented as an optional sign followed by a
10592 sequence of digits. Grouping (@pxref{Grouping Digits}) can be used to
10593 insert a comma at every third digit for display purposes, but you
10594 must not type commas during the entry of numbers.
10595
10596 @kindex #
10597 A non-decimal integer is represented as an optional sign, a radix
10598 between 2 and 36, a @samp{#} symbol, and one or more digits. For radix 11
10599 and above, the letters A through Z (upper- or lower-case) count as
10600 digits and do not terminate numeric entry mode. @xref{Radix Modes}, for how
10601 to set the default radix for display of integers. Numbers of any radix
10602 may be entered at any time. If you press @kbd{#} at the beginning of a
10603 number, the current display radix is used.
10604
10605 @node Fractions, Floats, Integers, Data Types
10606 @section Fractions
10607
10608 @noindent
10609 @cindex Fractions
10610 A @dfn{fraction} is a ratio of two integers. Fractions are traditionally
10611 written ``2/3'' but Calc uses the notation @samp{2:3}. (The @kbd{/} key
10612 performs RPN division; the following two sequences push the number
10613 @samp{2:3} on the stack: @kbd{2 :@: 3 @key{RET}}, or @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 /}
10614 assuming Fraction mode has been enabled.)
10615 When the Calculator produces a fractional result it always reduces it to
10616 simplest form, which may in fact be an integer.
10617
10618 Fractions may also be entered in a three-part form, where @samp{2:3:4}
10619 represents two-and-three-quarters. @xref{Fraction Formats}, for fraction
10620 display formats.
10621
10622 Non-decimal fractions are entered and displayed as
10623 @samp{@var{radix}#@var{num}:@var{denom}} (or in the analogous three-part
10624 form). The numerator and denominator always use the same radix.
10625
10626 @node Floats, Complex Numbers, Fractions, Data Types
10627 @section Floats
10628
10629 @noindent
10630 @cindex Floating-point numbers
10631 A floating-point number or @dfn{float} is a number stored in scientific
10632 notation. The number of significant digits in the fractional part is
10633 governed by the current floating precision (@pxref{Precision}). The
10634 range of acceptable values is from
10635 @texline @math{10^{-3999999}}
10636 @infoline @expr{10^-3999999}
10637 (inclusive) to
10638 @texline @math{10^{4000000}}
10639 @infoline @expr{10^4000000}
10640 (exclusive), plus the corresponding negative values and zero.
10641
10642 Calculations that would exceed the allowable range of values (such
10643 as @samp{exp(exp(20))}) are left in symbolic form by Calc. The
10644 messages ``floating-point overflow'' or ``floating-point underflow''
10645 indicate that during the calculation a number would have been produced
10646 that was too large or too close to zero, respectively, to be represented
10647 by Calc. This does not necessarily mean the final result would have
10648 overflowed, just that an overflow occurred while computing the result.
10649 (In fact, it could report an underflow even though the final result
10650 would have overflowed!)
10651
10652 If a rational number and a float are mixed in a calculation, the result
10653 will in general be expressed as a float. Commands that require an integer
10654 value (such as @kbd{k g} [@code{gcd}]) will also accept integer-valued
10655 floats, i.e., floating-point numbers with nothing after the decimal point.
10656
10657 Floats are identified by the presence of a decimal point and/or an
10658 exponent. In general a float consists of an optional sign, digits
10659 including an optional decimal point, and an optional exponent consisting
10660 of an @samp{e}, an optional sign, and up to seven exponent digits.
10661 For example, @samp{23.5e-2} is 23.5 times ten to the minus-second power,
10662 or 0.235.
10663
10664 Floating-point numbers are normally displayed in decimal notation with
10665 all significant figures shown. Exceedingly large or small numbers are
10666 displayed in scientific notation. Various other display options are
10667 available. @xref{Float Formats}.
10668
10669 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
10670 Floating-point numbers are stored in decimal, not binary. The result
10671 of each operation is rounded to the nearest value representable in the
10672 number of significant digits specified by the current precision,
10673 rounding away from zero in the case of a tie. Thus (in the default
10674 display mode) what you see is exactly what you get. Some operations such
10675 as square roots and transcendental functions are performed with several
10676 digits of extra precision and then rounded down, in an effort to make the
10677 final result accurate to the full requested precision. However,
10678 accuracy is not rigorously guaranteed. If you suspect the validity of a
10679 result, try doing the same calculation in a higher precision. The
10680 Calculator's arithmetic is not intended to be IEEE-conformant in any
10681 way.
10682
10683 While floats are always @emph{stored} in decimal, they can be entered
10684 and displayed in any radix just like integers and fractions. Since a
10685 float that is entered in a radix other that 10 will be converted to
10686 decimal, the number that Calc stores may not be exactly the number that
10687 was entered, it will be the closest decimal approximation given the
10688 current precison. The notation @samp{@var{radix}#@var{ddd}.@var{ddd}}
10689 is a floating-point number whose digits are in the specified radix.
10690 Note that the @samp{.} is more aptly referred to as a ``radix point''
10691 than as a decimal point in this case. The number @samp{8#123.4567} is
10692 defined as @samp{8#1234567 * 8^-4}. If the radix is 14 or less, you can
10693 use @samp{e} notation to write a non-decimal number in scientific
10694 notation. The exponent is written in decimal, and is considered to be a
10695 power of the radix: @samp{8#1234567e-4}. If the radix is 15 or above,
10696 the letter @samp{e} is a digit, so scientific notation must be written
10697 out, e.g., @samp{16#123.4567*16^2}. The first two exercises of the
10698 Modes Tutorial explore some of the properties of non-decimal floats.
10699
10700 @node Complex Numbers, Infinities, Floats, Data Types
10701 @section Complex Numbers
10702
10703 @noindent
10704 @cindex Complex numbers
10705 There are two supported formats for complex numbers: rectangular and
10706 polar. The default format is rectangular, displayed in the form
10707 @samp{(@var{real},@var{imag})} where @var{real} is the real part and
10708 @var{imag} is the imaginary part, each of which may be any real number.
10709 Rectangular complex numbers can also be displayed in @samp{@var{a}+@var{b}i}
10710 notation; @pxref{Complex Formats}.
10711
10712 Polar complex numbers are displayed in the form
10713 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'
10714 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'
10715 where @var{r} is the nonnegative magnitude and
10716 @texline @math{\theta}
10717 @infoline @var{theta}
10718 is the argument or phase angle. The range of
10719 @texline @math{\theta}
10720 @infoline @var{theta}
10721 depends on the current angular mode (@pxref{Angular Modes}); it is
10722 generally between @mathit{-180} and @mathit{+180} degrees or the equivalent range
10723 in radians.
10724
10725 Complex numbers are entered in stages using incomplete objects.
10726 @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10727
10728 Operations on rectangular complex numbers yield rectangular complex
10729 results, and similarly for polar complex numbers. Where the two types
10730 are mixed, or where new complex numbers arise (as for the square root of
10731 a negative real), the current @dfn{Polar mode} is used to determine the
10732 type. @xref{Polar Mode}.
10733
10734 A complex result in which the imaginary part is zero (or the phase angle
10735 is 0 or 180 degrees or @cpi{} radians) is automatically converted to a real
10736 number.
10737
10738 @node Infinities, Vectors and Matrices, Complex Numbers, Data Types
10739 @section Infinities
10740
10741 @noindent
10742 @cindex Infinity
10743 @cindex @code{inf} variable
10744 @cindex @code{uinf} variable
10745 @cindex @code{nan} variable
10746 @vindex inf
10747 @vindex uinf
10748 @vindex nan
10749 The word @code{inf} represents the mathematical concept of @dfn{infinity}.
10750 Calc actually has three slightly different infinity-like values:
10751 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan}. These are just regular
10752 variable names (@pxref{Variables}); you should avoid using these
10753 names for your own variables because Calc gives them special
10754 treatment. Infinities, like all variable names, are normally
10755 entered using algebraic entry.
10756
10757 Mathematically speaking, it is not rigorously correct to treat
10758 ``infinity'' as if it were a number, but mathematicians often do
10759 so informally. When they say that @samp{1 / inf = 0}, what they
10760 really mean is that @expr{1 / x}, as @expr{x} becomes larger and
10761 larger, becomes arbitrarily close to zero. So you can imagine
10762 that if @expr{x} got ``all the way to infinity,'' then @expr{1 / x}
10763 would go all the way to zero. Similarly, when they say that
10764 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}, they mean that
10765 @texline @math{e^x}
10766 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
10767 grows without bound as @expr{x} grows. The symbol @samp{-inf} likewise
10768 stands for an infinitely negative real value; for example, we say that
10769 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. You can have an infinity pointing in any
10770 direction on the complex plane: @samp{sqrt(-inf) = i inf}.
10771
10772 The same concept of limits can be used to define @expr{1 / 0}. We
10773 really want the value that @expr{1 / x} approaches as @expr{x}
10774 approaches zero. But if all we have is @expr{1 / 0}, we can't
10775 tell which direction @expr{x} was coming from. If @expr{x} was
10776 positive and decreasing toward zero, then we should say that
10777 @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. But if @expr{x} was negative and increasing
10778 toward zero, the answer is @samp{1 / 0 = -inf}. In fact, @expr{x}
10779 could be an imaginary number, giving the answer @samp{i inf} or
10780 @samp{-i inf}. Calc uses the special symbol @samp{uinf} to mean
10781 @dfn{undirected infinity}, i.e., a value which is infinitely
10782 large but with an unknown sign (or direction on the complex plane).
10783
10784 Calc actually has three modes that say how infinities are handled.
10785 Normally, infinities never arise from calculations that didn't
10786 already have them. Thus, @expr{1 / 0} is treated simply as an
10787 error and left unevaluated. The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode})
10788 command (@pxref{Infinite Mode}) enables a mode in which
10789 @expr{1 / 0} evaluates to @code{uinf} instead. There is also
10790 an alternative type of infinite mode which says to treat zeros
10791 as if they were positive, so that @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. While this
10792 is less mathematically correct, it may be the answer you want in
10793 some cases.
10794
10795 Since all infinities are ``as large'' as all others, Calc simplifies,
10796 e.g., @samp{5 inf} to @samp{inf}. Another example is
10797 @samp{5 - inf = -inf}, where the @samp{-inf} is so large that
10798 adding a finite number like five to it does not affect it.
10799 Note that @samp{a - inf} also results in @samp{-inf}; Calc assumes
10800 that variables like @code{a} always stand for finite quantities.
10801 Just to show that infinities really are all the same size,
10802 note that @samp{sqrt(inf) = inf^2 = exp(inf) = inf} in Calc's
10803 notation.
10804
10805 It's not so easy to define certain formulas like @samp{0 * inf} and
10806 @samp{inf / inf}. Depending on where these zeros and infinities
10807 came from, the answer could be literally anything. The latter
10808 formula could be the limit of @expr{x / x} (giving a result of one),
10809 or @expr{2 x / x} (giving two), or @expr{x^2 / x} (giving @code{inf}),
10810 or @expr{x / x^2} (giving zero). Calc uses the symbol @code{nan}
10811 to represent such an @dfn{indeterminate} value. (The name ``nan''
10812 comes from analogy with the ``NAN'' concept of IEEE standard
10813 arithmetic; it stands for ``Not A Number.'' This is somewhat of a
10814 misnomer, since @code{nan} @emph{does} stand for some number or
10815 infinity, it's just that @emph{which} number it stands for
10816 cannot be determined.) In Calc's notation, @samp{0 * inf = nan}
10817 and @samp{inf / inf = nan}. A few other common indeterminate
10818 expressions are @samp{inf - inf} and @samp{inf ^ 0}. Also,
10819 @samp{0 / 0 = nan} if you have turned on Infinite mode
10820 (as described above).
10821
10822 Infinities are especially useful as parts of @dfn{intervals}.
10823 @xref{Interval Forms}.
10824
10825 @node Vectors and Matrices, Strings, Infinities, Data Types
10826 @section Vectors and Matrices
10827
10828 @noindent
10829 @cindex Vectors
10830 @cindex Plain vectors
10831 @cindex Matrices
10832 The @dfn{vector} data type is flexible and general. A vector is simply a
10833 list of zero or more data objects. When these objects are numbers, the
10834 whole is a vector in the mathematical sense. When these objects are
10835 themselves vectors of equal (nonzero) length, the whole is a @dfn{matrix}.
10836 A vector which is not a matrix is referred to here as a @dfn{plain vector}.
10837
10838 A vector is displayed as a list of values separated by commas and enclosed
10839 in square brackets: @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Thus the following is a 2 row by
10840 3 column matrix: @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}. Vectors, like complex
10841 numbers, are entered as incomplete objects. @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10842 During algebraic entry, vectors are entered all at once in the usual
10843 brackets-and-commas form. Matrices may be entered algebraically as nested
10844 vectors, or using the shortcut notation @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3; 4, 5, 6]}},
10845 with rows separated by semicolons. The commas may usually be omitted
10846 when entering vectors: @samp{[1 2 3]}. Curly braces may be used in
10847 place of brackets: @samp{@{1, 2, 3@}}, but the commas are required in
10848 this case.
10849
10850 Traditional vector and matrix arithmetic is also supported;
10851 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic} and @pxref{Matrix Functions}.
10852 Many other operations are applied to vectors element-wise. For example,
10853 the complex conjugate of a vector is a vector of the complex conjugates
10854 of its elements.
10855
10856 @ignore
10857 @starindex
10858 @end ignore
10859 @tindex vec
10860 Algebraic functions for building vectors include @samp{vec(a, b, c)}
10861 to build @samp{[a, b, c]}, @samp{cvec(a, n, m)} to build an
10862 @texline @math{n\times m}
10863 @infoline @var{n}x@var{m}
10864 matrix of @samp{a}s, and @samp{index(n)} to build a vector of integers
10865 from 1 to @samp{n}.
10866
10867 @node Strings, HMS Forms, Vectors and Matrices, Data Types
10868 @section Strings
10869
10870 @noindent
10871 @kindex "
10872 @cindex Strings
10873 @cindex Character strings
10874 Character strings are not a special data type in the Calculator.
10875 Rather, a string is represented simply as a vector all of whose
10876 elements are integers in the range 0 to 255 (ASCII codes). You can
10877 enter a string at any time by pressing the @kbd{"} key. Quotation
10878 marks and backslashes are written @samp{\"} and @samp{\\}, respectively,
10879 inside strings. Other notations introduced by backslashes are:
10880
10881 @example
10882 @group
10883 \a 7 \^@@ 0
10884 \b 8 \^a-z 1-26
10885 \e 27 \^[ 27
10886 \f 12 \^\\ 28
10887 \n 10 \^] 29
10888 \r 13 \^^ 30
10889 \t 9 \^_ 31
10890 \^? 127
10891 @end group
10892 @end example
10893
10894 @noindent
10895 Finally, a backslash followed by three octal digits produces any
10896 character from its ASCII code.
10897
10898 @kindex d "
10899 @pindex calc-display-strings
10900 Strings are normally displayed in vector-of-integers form. The
10901 @w{@kbd{d "}} (@code{calc-display-strings}) command toggles a mode in
10902 which any vectors of small integers are displayed as quoted strings
10903 instead.
10904
10905 The backslash notations shown above are also used for displaying
10906 strings. Characters 128 and above are not translated by Calc; unless
10907 you have an Emacs modified for 8-bit fonts, these will show up in
10908 backslash-octal-digits notation. For characters below 32, and
10909 for character 127, Calc uses the backslash-letter combination if
10910 there is one, or otherwise uses a @samp{\^} sequence.
10911
10912 The only Calc feature that uses strings is @dfn{compositions};
10913 @pxref{Compositions}. Strings also provide a convenient
10914 way to do conversions between ASCII characters and integers.
10915
10916 @ignore
10917 @starindex
10918 @end ignore
10919 @tindex string
10920 There is a @code{string} function which provides a different display
10921 format for strings. Basically, @samp{string(@var{s})}, where @var{s}
10922 is a vector of integers in the proper range, is displayed as the
10923 corresponding string of characters with no surrounding quotation
10924 marks or other modifications. Thus @samp{string("ABC")} (or
10925 @samp{string([65 66 67])}) will look like @samp{ABC} on the stack.
10926 This happens regardless of whether @w{@kbd{d "}} has been used. The
10927 only way to turn it off is to use @kbd{d U} (unformatted language
10928 mode) which will display @samp{string("ABC")} instead.
10929
10930 Control characters are displayed somewhat differently by @code{string}.
10931 Characters below 32, and character 127, are shown using @samp{^} notation
10932 (same as shown above, but without the backslash). The quote and
10933 backslash characters are left alone, as are characters 128 and above.
10934
10935 @ignore
10936 @starindex
10937 @end ignore
10938 @tindex bstring
10939 The @code{bstring} function is just like @code{string} except that
10940 the resulting string is breakable across multiple lines if it doesn't
10941 fit all on one line. Potential break points occur at every space
10942 character in the string.
10943
10944 @node HMS Forms, Date Forms, Strings, Data Types
10945 @section HMS Forms
10946
10947 @noindent
10948 @cindex Hours-minutes-seconds forms
10949 @cindex Degrees-minutes-seconds forms
10950 @dfn{HMS} stands for Hours-Minutes-Seconds; when used as an angular
10951 argument, the interpretation is Degrees-Minutes-Seconds. All functions
10952 that operate on angles accept HMS forms. These are interpreted as
10953 degrees regardless of the current angular mode. It is also possible to
10954 use HMS as the angular mode so that calculated angles are expressed in
10955 degrees, minutes, and seconds.
10956
10957 @kindex @@
10958 @ignore
10959 @mindex @null
10960 @end ignore
10961 @kindex ' (HMS forms)
10962 @ignore
10963 @mindex @null
10964 @end ignore
10965 @kindex " (HMS forms)
10966 @ignore
10967 @mindex @null
10968 @end ignore
10969 @kindex h (HMS forms)
10970 @ignore
10971 @mindex @null
10972 @end ignore
10973 @kindex o (HMS forms)
10974 @ignore
10975 @mindex @null
10976 @end ignore
10977 @kindex m (HMS forms)
10978 @ignore
10979 @mindex @null
10980 @end ignore
10981 @kindex s (HMS forms)
10982 The default format for HMS values is
10983 @samp{@var{hours}@@ @var{mins}' @var{secs}"}. During entry, the letters
10984 @samp{h} (for ``hours'') or
10985 @samp{o} (approximating the ``degrees'' symbol) are accepted as well as
10986 @samp{@@}, @samp{m} is accepted in place of @samp{'}, and @samp{s} is
10987 accepted in place of @samp{"}.
10988 The @var{hours} value is an integer (or integer-valued float).
10989 The @var{mins} value is an integer or integer-valued float between 0 and 59.
10990 The @var{secs} value is a real number between 0 (inclusive) and 60
10991 (exclusive). A positive HMS form is interpreted as @var{hours} +
10992 @var{mins}/60 + @var{secs}/3600. A negative HMS form is interpreted
10993 as @mathit{- @var{hours}} @mathit{-} @var{mins}/60 @mathit{-} @var{secs}/3600.
10994 Display format for HMS forms is quite flexible. @xref{HMS Formats}.
10995
10996 HMS forms can be added and subtracted. When they are added to numbers,
10997 the numbers are interpreted according to the current angular mode. HMS
10998 forms can also be multiplied and divided by real numbers. Dividing
10999 two HMS forms produces a real-valued ratio of the two angles.
11000
11001 @pindex calc-time
11002 @cindex Time of day
11003 Just for kicks, @kbd{M-x calc-time} pushes the current time of day on
11004 the stack as an HMS form.
11005
11006 @node Date Forms, Modulo Forms, HMS Forms, Data Types
11007 @section Date Forms
11008
11009 @noindent
11010 @cindex Date forms
11011 A @dfn{date form} represents a date and possibly an associated time.
11012 Simple date arithmetic is supported: Adding a number to a date
11013 produces a new date shifted by that many days; adding an HMS form to
11014 a date shifts it by that many hours. Subtracting two date forms
11015 computes the number of days between them (represented as a simple
11016 number). Many other operations, such as multiplying two date forms,
11017 are nonsensical and are not allowed by Calc.
11018
11019 Date forms are entered and displayed enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets.
11020 The default format is, e.g., @samp{<Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates,
11021 or @samp{<3:32:20pm Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates with times.
11022 Input is flexible; date forms can be entered in any of the usual
11023 notations for dates and times. @xref{Date Formats}.
11024
11025 Date forms are stored internally as numbers, specifically the number
11026 of days since midnight on the morning of January 1 of the year 1 AD.
11027 If the internal number is an integer, the form represents a date only;
11028 if the internal number is a fraction or float, the form represents
11029 a date and time. For example, @samp{<6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991>}
11030 is represented by the number 726842.25. The standard precision of
11031 12 decimal digits is enough to ensure that a (reasonable) date and
11032 time can be stored without roundoff error.
11033
11034 If the current precision is greater than 12, date forms will keep
11035 additional digits in the seconds position. For example, if the
11036 precision is 15, the seconds will keep three digits after the
11037 decimal point. Decreasing the precision below 12 may cause the
11038 time part of a date form to become inaccurate. This can also happen
11039 if astronomically high years are used, though this will not be an
11040 issue in everyday (or even everymillennium) use. Note that date
11041 forms without times are stored as exact integers, so roundoff is
11042 never an issue for them.
11043
11044 You can use the @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) and @kbd{v u}
11045 (@code{calc-unpack}) commands to get at the numerical representation
11046 of a date form. @xref{Packing and Unpacking}.
11047
11048 Date forms can go arbitrarily far into the future or past. Negative
11049 year numbers represent years BC. Calc uses a combination of the
11050 Gregorian and Julian calendars, following the history of Great
11051 Britain and the British colonies. This is the same calendar that
11052 is used by the @code{cal} program in most Unix implementations.
11053
11054 @cindex Julian calendar
11055 @cindex Gregorian calendar
11056 Some historical background: The Julian calendar was created by
11057 Julius Caesar in the year 46 BC as an attempt to fix the gradual
11058 drift caused by the lack of leap years in the calendar used
11059 until that time. The Julian calendar introduced an extra day in
11060 all years divisible by four. After some initial confusion, the
11061 calendar was adopted around the year we call 8 AD. Some centuries
11062 later it became apparent that the Julian year of 365.25 days was
11063 itself not quite right. In 1582 Pope Gregory XIII introduced the
11064 Gregorian calendar, which added the new rule that years divisible
11065 by 100, but not by 400, were not to be considered leap years
11066 despite being divisible by four. Many countries delayed adoption
11067 of the Gregorian calendar because of religious differences;
11068 in Britain it was put off until the year 1752, by which time
11069 the Julian calendar had fallen eleven days behind the true
11070 seasons. So the switch to the Gregorian calendar in early
11071 September 1752 introduced a discontinuity: The day after
11072 Sep 2, 1752 is Sep 14, 1752. Calc follows this convention.
11073 To take another example, Russia waited until 1918 before
11074 adopting the new calendar, and thus needed to remove thirteen
11075 days (between Feb 1, 1918 and Feb 14, 1918). This means that
11076 Calc's reckoning will be inconsistent with Russian history between
11077 1752 and 1918, and similarly for various other countries.
11078
11079 Today's timekeepers introduce an occasional ``leap second'' as
11080 well, but Calc does not take these minor effects into account.
11081 (If it did, it would have to report a non-integer number of days
11082 between, say, @samp{<12:00am Mon Jan 1, 1900>} and
11083 @samp{<12:00am Sat Jan 1, 2000>}.)
11084
11085 Calc uses the Julian calendar for all dates before the year 1752,
11086 including dates BC when the Julian calendar technically had not
11087 yet been invented. Thus the claim that day number @mathit{-10000} is
11088 called ``August 16, 28 BC'' should be taken with a grain of salt.
11089
11090 Please note that there is no ``year 0''; the day before
11091 @samp{<Sat Jan 1, +1>} is @samp{<Fri Dec 31, -1>}. These are
11092 days 0 and @mathit{-1} respectively in Calc's internal numbering scheme.
11093
11094 @cindex Julian day counting
11095 Another day counting system in common use is, confusingly, also called
11096 ``Julian.'' The Julian day number is the numbers of days since
11097 12:00 noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC, which in Calc's scheme (in GMT)
11098 is @mathit{-1721423.5} (recall that Calc starts at midnight instead
11099 of noon). Thus to convert a Calc date code obtained by unpacking a
11100 date form into a Julian day number, simply add 1721423.5 after
11101 compensating for the time zone difference. The built-in @kbd{t J}
11102 command performs this conversion for you.
11103
11104 The Julian day number is based on the Julian cycle, which was invented
11105 in 1583 by Joseph Justus Scaliger. Scaliger named it the Julian cycle
11106 since it involves the Julian calendar, but some have suggested that
11107 Scaliger named it in honor of his father, Julius Caesar Scaliger. The
11108 Julian cycle is based on three other cycles: the indiction cycle, the
11109 Metonic cycle, and the solar cycle. The indiction cycle is a 15 year
11110 cycle originally used by the Romans for tax purposes but later used to
11111 date medieval documents. The Metonic cycle is a 19 year cycle; 19
11112 years is close to being a common multiple of a solar year and a lunar
11113 month, and so every 19 years the phases of the moon will occur on the
11114 same days of the year. The solar cycle is a 28 year cycle; the Julian
11115 calendar repeats itself every 28 years. The smallest time period
11116 which contains multiples of all three cycles is the least common
11117 multiple of 15 years, 19 years and 28 years, which (since they're
11118 pairwise relatively prime) is
11119 @texline @math{15\times 19\times 28 = 7980} years.
11120 @infoline 15*19*28 = 7980 years.
11121 This is the length of a Julian cycle. Working backwards, the previous
11122 year in which all three cycles began was 4713 BC, and so Scalinger
11123 chose that year as the beginning of a Julian cycle. Since at the time
11124 there were no historical records from before 4713 BC, using this year
11125 as a starting point had the advantage of avoiding negative year
11126 numbers. In 1849, the astronomer John Herschel (son of William
11127 Herschel) suggested using the number of days since the beginning of
11128 the Julian cycle as an astronomical dating system; this idea was taken
11129 up by other astronomers. (At the time, noon was the start of the
11130 astronomical day. Herschel originally suggested counting the days
11131 since Jan 1, 4713 BC at noon Alexandria time; this was later amended to
11132 noon GMT.) Julian day numbering is largely used in astronomy.
11133
11134 @cindex Unix time format
11135 The Unix operating system measures time as an integer number of
11136 seconds since midnight, Jan 1, 1970. To convert a Calc date
11137 value into a Unix time stamp, first subtract 719164 (the code
11138 for @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}), then multiply by 86400 (the number of
11139 seconds in a day) and press @kbd{R} to round to the nearest
11140 integer. If you have a date form, you can simply subtract the
11141 day @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>} instead of unpacking and subtracting
11142 719164. Likewise, divide by 86400 and add @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}
11143 to convert from Unix time to a Calc date form. (Note that
11144 Unix normally maintains the time in the GMT time zone; you may
11145 need to subtract five hours to get New York time, or eight hours
11146 for California time. The same is usually true of Julian day
11147 counts.) The built-in @kbd{t U} command performs these
11148 conversions.
11149
11150 @node Modulo Forms, Error Forms, Date Forms, Data Types
11151 @section Modulo Forms
11152
11153 @noindent
11154 @cindex Modulo forms
11155 A @dfn{modulo form} is a real number which is taken modulo (i.e., within
11156 an integer multiple of) some value @var{M}. Arithmetic modulo @var{M}
11157 often arises in number theory. Modulo forms are written
11158 `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}',
11159 where @var{a} and @var{M} are real numbers or HMS forms, and
11160 @texline @math{0 \le a < M}.
11161 @infoline @expr{0 <= a < @var{M}}.
11162 In many applications @expr{a} and @expr{M} will be
11163 integers but this is not required.
11164
11165 @ignore
11166 @mindex M
11167 @end ignore
11168 @kindex M (modulo forms)
11169 @ignore
11170 @mindex mod
11171 @end ignore
11172 @tindex mod (operator)
11173 To create a modulo form during numeric entry, press the shift-@kbd{M}
11174 key to enter the word @samp{mod}. As a special convenience, pressing
11175 shift-@kbd{M} a second time automatically enters the value of @expr{M}
11176 that was most recently used before. During algebraic entry, either
11177 type @samp{mod} by hand or press @kbd{M-m} (that's @kbd{@key{META}-m}).
11178 Once again, pressing this a second time enters the current modulo.
11179
11180 Modulo forms are not to be confused with the modulo operator @samp{%}.
11181 The expression @samp{27 % 10} means to compute 27 modulo 10 to produce
11182 the result 7. Further computations treat this 7 as just a regular integer.
11183 The expression @samp{27 mod 10} produces the result @samp{7 mod 10};
11184 further computations with this value are again reduced modulo 10 so that
11185 the result always lies in the desired range.
11186
11187 When two modulo forms with identical @expr{M}'s are added or multiplied,
11188 the Calculator simply adds or multiplies the values, then reduces modulo
11189 @expr{M}. If one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number,
11190 the plain number is treated like a compatible modulo form. It is also
11191 possible to raise modulo forms to powers; the result is the value raised
11192 to the power, then reduced modulo @expr{M}. (When all values involved
11193 are integers, this calculation is done much more efficiently than
11194 actually computing the power and then reducing.)
11195
11196 @cindex Modulo division
11197 Two modulo forms `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}' and `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'
11198 can be divided if @expr{a}, @expr{b}, and @expr{M} are all
11199 integers. The result is the modulo form which, when multiplied by
11200 `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}', produces `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'. If
11201 there is no solution to this equation (which can happen only when
11202 @expr{M} is non-prime), or if any of the arguments are non-integers, the
11203 division is left in symbolic form. Other operations, such as square
11204 roots, are not yet supported for modulo forms. (Note that, although
11205 @w{`@tfn{(}@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}@tfn{)^.5}'} will compute a ``modulo square root''
11206 in the sense of reducing
11207 @texline @math{\sqrt a}
11208 @infoline @expr{sqrt(a)}
11209 modulo @expr{M}, this is not a useful definition from the
11210 number-theoretical point of view.)
11211
11212 It is possible to mix HMS forms and modulo forms. For example, an
11213 HMS form modulo 24 could be used to manipulate clock times; an HMS
11214 form modulo 360 would be suitable for angles. Making the modulo @expr{M}
11215 also be an HMS form eliminates troubles that would arise if the angular
11216 mode were inadvertently set to Radians, in which case
11217 @w{@samp{2@@ 0' 0" mod 24}} would be interpreted as two degrees modulo
11218 24 radians!
11219
11220 Modulo forms cannot have variables or formulas for components. If you
11221 enter the formula @samp{(x + 2) mod 5}, Calc propagates the modulus
11222 to each of the coefficients: @samp{(1 mod 5) x + (2 mod 5)}.
11223
11224 You can use @kbd{v p} and @kbd{%} to modify modulo forms.
11225 @xref{Packing and Unpacking}. @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
11226
11227 @ignore
11228 @starindex
11229 @end ignore
11230 @tindex makemod
11231 The algebraic function @samp{makemod(a, m)} builds the modulo form
11232 @w{@samp{a mod m}}.
11233
11234 @node Error Forms, Interval Forms, Modulo Forms, Data Types
11235 @section Error Forms
11236
11237 @noindent
11238 @cindex Error forms
11239 @cindex Standard deviations
11240 An @dfn{error form} is a number with an associated standard
11241 deviation, as in @samp{2.3 +/- 0.12}. The notation
11242 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11243 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} sigma'
11244 stands for an uncertain value which follows
11245 a normal or Gaussian distribution of mean @expr{x} and standard
11246 deviation or ``error''
11247 @texline @math{\sigma}.
11248 @infoline @expr{sigma}.
11249 Both the mean and the error can be either numbers or
11250 formulas. Generally these are real numbers but the mean may also be
11251 complex. If the error is negative or complex, it is changed to its
11252 absolute value. An error form with zero error is converted to a
11253 regular number by the Calculator.
11254
11255 All arithmetic and transcendental functions accept error forms as input.
11256 Operations on the mean-value part work just like operations on regular
11257 numbers. The error part for any function @expr{f(x)} (such as
11258 @texline @math{\sin x}
11259 @infoline @expr{sin(x)})
11260 is defined by the error of @expr{x} times the derivative of @expr{f}
11261 evaluated at the mean value of @expr{x}. For a two-argument function
11262 @expr{f(x,y)} (such as addition) the error is the square root of the sum
11263 of the squares of the errors due to @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
11264 @tex
11265 $$ \eqalign{
11266 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma)
11267 &= f(x) \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma \left| {df(x) \over dx} \right| \cr
11268 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_x, y \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_y)
11269 &= f(x,y) \hbox{\code{ +/- }}
11270 \sqrt{\left(\sigma_x \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial x}
11271 \right| \right)^2
11272 +\left(\sigma_y \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial y}
11273 \right| \right)^2 } \cr
11274 } $$
11275 @end tex
11276 Note that this
11277 definition assumes the errors in @expr{x} and @expr{y} are uncorrelated.
11278 A side effect of this definition is that @samp{(2 +/- 1) * (2 +/- 1)}
11279 is not the same as @samp{(2 +/- 1)^2}; the former represents the product
11280 of two independent values which happen to have the same probability
11281 distributions, and the latter is the product of one random value with itself.
11282 The former will produce an answer with less error, since on the average
11283 the two independent errors can be expected to cancel out.
11284
11285 Consult a good text on error analysis for a discussion of the proper use
11286 of standard deviations. Actual errors often are neither Gaussian-distributed
11287 nor uncorrelated, and the above formulas are valid only when errors
11288 are small. As an example, the error arising from
11289 @texline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}@tfn{)}'
11290 @infoline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}@tfn{)}'
11291 is
11292 @texline `@math{\sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11293 @infoline `@var{sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11294 When @expr{x} is close to zero,
11295 @texline @math{\cos x}
11296 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11297 is close to one so the error in the sine is close to
11298 @texline @math{\sigma};
11299 @infoline @expr{sigma};
11300 this makes sense, since
11301 @texline @math{\sin x}
11302 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11303 is approximately @expr{x} near zero, so a given error in @expr{x} will
11304 produce about the same error in the sine. Likewise, near 90 degrees
11305 @texline @math{\cos x}
11306 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11307 is nearly zero and so the computed error is
11308 small: The sine curve is nearly flat in that region, so an error in @expr{x}
11309 has relatively little effect on the value of
11310 @texline @math{\sin x}.
11311 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}.
11312 However, consider @samp{sin(90 +/- 1000)}. The cosine of 90 is zero, so
11313 Calc will report zero error! We get an obviously wrong result because
11314 we have violated the small-error approximation underlying the error
11315 analysis. If the error in @expr{x} had been small, the error in
11316 @texline @math{\sin x}
11317 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11318 would indeed have been negligible.
11319
11320 @ignore
11321 @mindex p
11322 @end ignore
11323 @kindex p (error forms)
11324 @tindex +/-
11325 To enter an error form during regular numeric entry, use the @kbd{p}
11326 (``plus-or-minus'') key to type the @samp{+/-} symbol. (If you try actually
11327 typing @samp{+/-} the @kbd{+} key will be interpreted as the Calculator's
11328 @kbd{+} command!) Within an algebraic formula, you can press @kbd{M-+} to
11329 type the @samp{+/-} symbol, or type it out by hand.
11330
11331 Error forms and complex numbers can be mixed; the formulas shown above
11332 are used for complex numbers, too; note that if the error part evaluates
11333 to a complex number its absolute value (or the square root of the sum of
11334 the squares of the absolute values of the two error contributions) is
11335 used. Mathematically, this corresponds to a radially symmetric Gaussian
11336 distribution of numbers on the complex plane. However, note that Calc
11337 considers an error form with real components to represent a real number,
11338 not a complex distribution around a real mean.
11339
11340 Error forms may also be composed of HMS forms. For best results, both
11341 the mean and the error should be HMS forms if either one is.
11342
11343 @ignore
11344 @starindex
11345 @end ignore
11346 @tindex sdev
11347 The algebraic function @samp{sdev(a, b)} builds the error form @samp{a +/- b}.
11348
11349 @node Interval Forms, Incomplete Objects, Error Forms, Data Types
11350 @section Interval Forms
11351
11352 @noindent
11353 @cindex Interval forms
11354 An @dfn{interval} is a subset of consecutive real numbers. For example,
11355 the interval @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} represents all the numbers from 2 to 4,
11356 inclusive. If you multiply it by the interval @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]} you
11357 obtain @samp{[1 ..@: 8]}. This calculation represents the fact that if
11358 you multiply some number in the range @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} by some other
11359 number in the range @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]}, your result will lie in the range
11360 from 1 to 8. Interval arithmetic is used to get a worst-case estimate
11361 of the possible range of values a computation will produce, given the
11362 set of possible values of the input.
11363
11364 @ifnottex
11365 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including @dfn{closed}
11366 intervals of the type shown above, @dfn{open} intervals such as
11367 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11368 @emph{exclusive}, and @dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11369 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11370 terms,
11371 @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} means @expr{2 <= x <= 4}, whereas
11372 @samp{[2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 <= x < 4},
11373 @samp{(2 ..@: 4]} represents @expr{2 < x <= 4}, and
11374 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 < x < 4}.
11375 @end ifnottex
11376 @tex
11377 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including \dfn{closed}
11378 intervals of the type shown above, \dfn{open} intervals such as
11379 \samp{(2 ..\: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11380 \emph{exclusive}, and \dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11381 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11382 terms,
11383 $$ \eqalign{
11384 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x \le 4 \cr
11385 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x < 4 \cr
11386 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x \le 4 \cr
11387 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x < 4 \cr
11388 } $$
11389 @end tex
11390
11391 The lower and upper limits of an interval must be either real numbers
11392 (or HMS or date forms), or symbolic expressions which are assumed to be
11393 real-valued, or @samp{-inf} and @samp{inf}. In general the lower limit
11394 must be less than the upper limit. A closed interval containing only
11395 one value, @samp{[3 ..@: 3]}, is converted to a plain number (3)
11396 automatically. An interval containing no values at all (such as
11397 @samp{[3 ..@: 2]} or @samp{[2 ..@: 2)}) can be represented but is not
11398 guaranteed to behave well when used in arithmetic. Note that the
11399 interval @samp{[3 .. inf)} represents all real numbers greater than
11400 or equal to 3, and @samp{(-inf .. inf)} represents all real numbers.
11401 In fact, @samp{[-inf .. inf]} represents all real numbers including
11402 the real infinities.
11403
11404 Intervals are entered in the notation shown here, either as algebraic
11405 formulas, or using incomplete forms. (@xref{Incomplete Objects}.)
11406 In algebraic formulas, multiple periods in a row are collected from
11407 left to right, so that @samp{1...1e2} is interpreted as @samp{1.0 ..@: 1e2}
11408 rather than @samp{1 ..@: 0.1e2}. Add spaces or zeros if you want to
11409 get the other interpretation. If you omit the lower or upper limit,
11410 a default of @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} (respectively) is furnished.
11411
11412 Infinite mode also affects operations on intervals
11413 (@pxref{Infinities}). Calc will always introduce an open infinity,
11414 as in @samp{1 / (0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf)}. But closed infinities,
11415 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf]}}, arise only in Infinite mode;
11416 otherwise they are left unevaluated. Note that the ``direction'' of
11417 a zero is not an issue in this case since the zero is always assumed
11418 to be continuous with the rest of the interval. For intervals that
11419 contain zero inside them Calc is forced to give the result,
11420 @samp{1 / (-2 .. 2) = [-inf .. inf]}.
11421
11422 While it may seem that intervals and error forms are similar, they are
11423 based on entirely different concepts of inexact quantities. An error
11424 form
11425 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11426 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}'
11427 means a variable is random, and its value could
11428 be anything but is ``probably'' within one
11429 @texline @math{\sigma}
11430 @infoline @var{sigma}
11431 of the mean value @expr{x}. An interval
11432 `@tfn{[}@var{a} @tfn{..@:} @var{b}@tfn{]}' means a
11433 variable's value is unknown, but guaranteed to lie in the specified
11434 range. Error forms are statistical or ``average case'' approximations;
11435 interval arithmetic tends to produce ``worst case'' bounds on an
11436 answer.
11437
11438 Intervals may not contain complex numbers, but they may contain
11439 HMS forms or date forms.
11440
11441 @xref{Set Operations}, for commands that interpret interval forms
11442 as subsets of the set of real numbers.
11443
11444 @ignore
11445 @starindex
11446 @end ignore
11447 @tindex intv
11448 The algebraic function @samp{intv(n, a, b)} builds an interval form
11449 from @samp{a} to @samp{b}; @samp{n} is an integer code which must
11450 be 0 for @samp{(..)}, 1 for @samp{(..]}, 2 for @samp{[..)}, or
11451 3 for @samp{[..]}.
11452
11453 Please note that in fully rigorous interval arithmetic, care would be
11454 taken to make sure that the computation of the lower bound rounds toward
11455 minus infinity, while upper bound computations round toward plus
11456 infinity. Calc's arithmetic always uses a round-to-nearest mode,
11457 which means that roundoff errors could creep into an interval
11458 calculation to produce intervals slightly smaller than they ought to
11459 be. For example, entering @samp{[1..2]} and pressing @kbd{Q 2 ^}
11460 should yield the interval @samp{[1..2]} again, but in fact it yields the
11461 (slightly too small) interval @samp{[1..1.9999999]} due to roundoff
11462 error.
11463
11464 @node Incomplete Objects, Variables, Interval Forms, Data Types
11465 @section Incomplete Objects
11466
11467 @noindent
11468 @ignore
11469 @mindex [ ]
11470 @end ignore
11471 @kindex [
11472 @ignore
11473 @mindex ( )
11474 @end ignore
11475 @kindex (
11476 @kindex ,
11477 @ignore
11478 @mindex @null
11479 @end ignore
11480 @kindex ]
11481 @ignore
11482 @mindex @null
11483 @end ignore
11484 @kindex )
11485 @cindex Incomplete vectors
11486 @cindex Incomplete complex numbers
11487 @cindex Incomplete interval forms
11488 When @kbd{(} or @kbd{[} is typed to begin entering a complex number or
11489 vector, respectively, the effect is to push an @dfn{incomplete} complex
11490 number or vector onto the stack. The @kbd{,} key adds the value(s) at
11491 the top of the stack onto the current incomplete object. The @kbd{)}
11492 and @kbd{]} keys ``close'' the incomplete object after adding any values
11493 on the top of the stack in front of the incomplete object.
11494
11495 As a result, the sequence of keystrokes @kbd{[ 2 , 3 @key{RET} 2 * , 9 ]}
11496 pushes the vector @samp{[2, 6, 9]} onto the stack. Likewise, @kbd{( 1 , 2 Q )}
11497 pushes the complex number @samp{(1, 1.414)} (approximately).
11498
11499 If several values lie on the stack in front of the incomplete object,
11500 all are collected and appended to the object. Thus the @kbd{,} key
11501 is redundant: @kbd{[ 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 2 * 9 ]}. Some people
11502 prefer the equivalent @key{SPC} key to @key{RET}.
11503
11504 As a special case, typing @kbd{,} immediately after @kbd{(}, @kbd{[}, or
11505 @kbd{,} adds a zero or duplicates the preceding value in the list being
11506 formed. Typing @key{DEL} during incomplete entry removes the last item
11507 from the list.
11508
11509 @kindex ;
11510 The @kbd{;} key is used in the same way as @kbd{,} to create polar complex
11511 numbers: @kbd{( 1 ; 2 )}. When entering a vector, @kbd{;} is useful for
11512 creating a matrix. In particular, @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ; 3 , 4 ; 5 , 6 ] ]} is
11513 equivalent to @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ] , [ 3 , 4 ] , [ 5 , 6 ] ]}.
11514
11515 @kindex ..
11516 @pindex calc-dots
11517 Incomplete entry is also used to enter intervals. For example,
11518 @kbd{[ 2 ..@: 4 )} enters a semi-open interval. Note that when you type
11519 the first period, it will be interpreted as a decimal point, but when
11520 you type a second period immediately afterward, it is re-interpreted as
11521 part of the interval symbol. Typing @kbd{..} corresponds to executing
11522 the @code{calc-dots} command.
11523
11524 If you find incomplete entry distracting, you may wish to enter vectors
11525 and complex numbers as algebraic formulas by pressing the apostrophe key.
11526
11527 @node Variables, Formulas, Incomplete Objects, Data Types
11528 @section Variables
11529
11530 @noindent
11531 @cindex Variables, in formulas
11532 A @dfn{variable} is somewhere between a storage register on a conventional
11533 calculator, and a variable in a programming language. (In fact, a Calc
11534 variable is really just an Emacs Lisp variable that contains a Calc number
11535 or formula.) A variable's name is normally composed of letters and digits.
11536 Calc also allows apostrophes and @code{#} signs in variable names.
11537 (The Calc variable @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp variable
11538 @code{var-foo}, but unless you access the variable from within Emacs
11539 Lisp, you don't need to worry about it. Variable names in algebraic
11540 formulas implicitly have @samp{var-} prefixed to their names. The
11541 @samp{#} character in variable names used in algebraic formulas
11542 corresponds to a dash @samp{-} in the Lisp variable name. If the name
11543 contains any dashes, the prefix @samp{var-} is @emph{not} automatically
11544 added. Thus the two formulas @samp{foo + 1} and @samp{var#foo + 1} both
11545 refer to the same variable.)
11546
11547 In a command that takes a variable name, you can either type the full
11548 name of a variable, or type a single digit to use one of the special
11549 convenience variables @code{q0} through @code{q9}. For example,
11550 @kbd{3 s s 2} stores the number 3 in variable @code{q2}, and
11551 @w{@kbd{3 s s foo @key{RET}}} stores that number in variable
11552 @code{foo}.
11553
11554 To push a variable itself (as opposed to the variable's value) on the
11555 stack, enter its name as an algebraic expression using the apostrophe
11556 (@key{'}) key.
11557
11558 @kindex =
11559 @pindex calc-evaluate
11560 @cindex Evaluation of variables in a formula
11561 @cindex Variables, evaluation
11562 @cindex Formulas, evaluation
11563 The @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) key ``evaluates'' a formula by
11564 replacing all variables in the formula which have been given values by a
11565 @code{calc-store} or @code{calc-let} command by their stored values.
11566 Other variables are left alone. Thus a variable that has not been
11567 stored acts like an abstract variable in algebra; a variable that has
11568 been stored acts more like a register in a traditional calculator.
11569 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{=} evaluates the top
11570 @var{n} stack entries; with a negative argument, @kbd{=} evaluates
11571 the @var{n}th stack entry.
11572
11573 @cindex @code{e} variable
11574 @cindex @code{pi} variable
11575 @cindex @code{i} variable
11576 @cindex @code{phi} variable
11577 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
11578 @vindex e
11579 @vindex pi
11580 @vindex i
11581 @vindex phi
11582 @vindex gamma
11583 A few variables are called @dfn{special constants}. Their names are
11584 @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and @samp{gamma}.
11585 (@xref{Scientific Functions}.) When they are evaluated with @kbd{=},
11586 their values are calculated if necessary according to the current precision
11587 or complex polar mode. If you wish to use these symbols for other purposes,
11588 simply undefine or redefine them using @code{calc-store}.
11589
11590 The variables @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} stand for
11591 infinite or indeterminate values. It's best not to use them as
11592 regular variables, since Calc uses special algebraic rules when
11593 it manipulates them. Calc displays a warning message if you store
11594 a value into any of these special variables.
11595
11596 @xref{Store and Recall}, for a discussion of commands dealing with variables.
11597
11598 @node Formulas, , Variables, Data Types
11599 @section Formulas
11600
11601 @noindent
11602 @cindex Formulas
11603 @cindex Expressions
11604 @cindex Operators in formulas
11605 @cindex Precedence of operators
11606 When you press the apostrophe key you may enter any expression or formula
11607 in algebraic form. (Calc uses the terms ``expression'' and ``formula''
11608 interchangeably.) An expression is built up of numbers, variable names,
11609 and function calls, combined with various arithmetic operators.
11610 Parentheses may
11611 be used to indicate grouping. Spaces are ignored within formulas, except
11612 that spaces are not permitted within variable names or numbers.
11613 Arithmetic operators, in order from highest to lowest precedence, and
11614 with their equivalent function names, are:
11615
11616 @samp{_} [@code{subscr}] (subscripts);
11617
11618 postfix @samp{%} [@code{percent}] (as in @samp{25% = 0.25});
11619
11620 prefix @samp{!} [@code{lnot}] (logical ``not,'' as in @samp{!x});
11621
11622 @samp{+/-} [@code{sdev}] (the standard deviation symbol) and
11623 @samp{mod} [@code{makemod}] (the symbol for modulo forms);
11624
11625 postfix @samp{!} [@code{fact}] (factorial, as in @samp{n!})
11626 and postfix @samp{!!} [@code{dfact}] (double factorial);
11627
11628 @samp{^} [@code{pow}] (raised-to-the-power-of);
11629
11630 prefix @samp{+} and @samp{-} [@code{neg}] (as in @samp{-x});
11631
11632 @samp{*} [@code{mul}];
11633
11634 @samp{/} [@code{div}], @samp{%} [@code{mod}] (modulo), and
11635 @samp{\} [@code{idiv}] (integer division);
11636
11637 infix @samp{+} [@code{add}] and @samp{-} [@code{sub}] (as in @samp{x-y});
11638
11639 @samp{|} [@code{vconcat}] (vector concatenation);
11640
11641 relations @samp{=} [@code{eq}], @samp{!=} [@code{neq}], @samp{<} [@code{lt}],
11642 @samp{>} [@code{gt}], @samp{<=} [@code{leq}], and @samp{>=} [@code{geq}];
11643
11644 @samp{&&} [@code{land}] (logical ``and'');
11645
11646 @samp{||} [@code{lor}] (logical ``or'');
11647
11648 the C-style ``if'' operator @samp{a?b:c} [@code{if}];
11649
11650 @samp{!!!} [@code{pnot}] (rewrite pattern ``not'');
11651
11652 @samp{&&&} [@code{pand}] (rewrite pattern ``and'');
11653
11654 @samp{|||} [@code{por}] (rewrite pattern ``or'');
11655
11656 @samp{:=} [@code{assign}] (for assignments and rewrite rules);
11657
11658 @samp{::} [@code{condition}] (rewrite pattern condition);
11659
11660 @samp{=>} [@code{evalto}].
11661
11662 Note that, unlike in usual computer notation, multiplication binds more
11663 strongly than division: @samp{a*b/c*d} is equivalent to
11664 @texline @math{a b \over c d}.
11665 @infoline @expr{(a*b)/(c*d)}.
11666
11667 @cindex Multiplication, implicit
11668 @cindex Implicit multiplication
11669 The multiplication sign @samp{*} may be omitted in many cases. In particular,
11670 if the righthand side is a number, variable name, or parenthesized
11671 expression, the @samp{*} may be omitted. Implicit multiplication has the
11672 same precedence as the explicit @samp{*} operator. The one exception to
11673 the rule is that a variable name followed by a parenthesized expression,
11674 as in @samp{f(x)},
11675 is interpreted as a function call, not an implicit @samp{*}. In many
11676 cases you must use a space if you omit the @samp{*}: @samp{2a} is the
11677 same as @samp{2*a}, and @samp{a b} is the same as @samp{a*b}, but @samp{ab}
11678 is a variable called @code{ab}, @emph{not} the product of @samp{a} and
11679 @samp{b}! Also note that @samp{f (x)} is still a function call.
11680
11681 @cindex Implicit comma in vectors
11682 The rules are slightly different for vectors written with square brackets.
11683 In vectors, the space character is interpreted (like the comma) as a
11684 separator of elements of the vector. Thus @w{@samp{[ 2a b+c d ]}} is
11685 equivalent to @samp{[2*a, b+c, d]}, whereas @samp{2a b+c d} is equivalent
11686 to @samp{2*a*b + c*d}.
11687 Note that spaces around the brackets, and around explicit commas, are
11688 ignored. To force spaces to be interpreted as multiplication you can
11689 enclose a formula in parentheses as in @samp{[(a b) 2(c d)]}, which is
11690 interpreted as @samp{[a*b, 2*c*d]}. An implicit comma is also inserted
11691 between @samp{][}, as in the matrix @samp{[[1 2][3 4]]}.
11692
11693 Vectors that contain commas (not embedded within nested parentheses or
11694 brackets) do not treat spaces specially: @samp{[a b, 2 c d]} is a vector
11695 of two elements. Also, if it would be an error to treat spaces as
11696 separators, but not otherwise, then Calc will ignore spaces:
11697 @w{@samp{[a - b]}} is a vector of one element, but @w{@samp{[a -b]}} is
11698 a vector of two elements. Finally, vectors entered with curly braces
11699 instead of square brackets do not give spaces any special treatment.
11700 When Calc displays a vector that does not contain any commas, it will
11701 insert parentheses if necessary to make the meaning clear:
11702 @w{@samp{[(a b)]}}.
11703
11704 The expression @samp{5%-2} is ambiguous; is this five-percent minus two,
11705 or five modulo minus-two? Calc always interprets the leftmost symbol as
11706 an infix operator preferentially (modulo, in this case), so you would
11707 need to write @samp{(5%)-2} to get the former interpretation.
11708
11709 @cindex Function call notation
11710 A function call is, e.g., @samp{sin(1+x)}. (The Calc algebraic function
11711 @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp function @code{calcFunc-foo},
11712 but unless you access the function from within Emacs Lisp, you don't
11713 need to worry about it.) Most mathematical Calculator commands like
11714 @code{calc-sin} have function equivalents like @code{sin}.
11715 If no Lisp function is defined for a function called by a formula, the
11716 call is left as it is during algebraic manipulation: @samp{f(x+y)} is
11717 left alone. Beware that many innocent-looking short names like @code{in}
11718 and @code{re} have predefined meanings which could surprise you; however,
11719 single letters or single letters followed by digits are always safe to
11720 use for your own function names. @xref{Function Index}.
11721
11722 In the documentation for particular commands, the notation @kbd{H S}
11723 (@code{calc-sinh}) [@code{sinh}] means that the key sequence @kbd{H S}, the
11724 command @kbd{M-x calc-sinh}, and the algebraic function @code{sinh(x)} all
11725 represent the same operation.
11726
11727 Commands that interpret (``parse'') text as algebraic formulas include
11728 algebraic entry (@kbd{'}), editing commands like @kbd{`} which parse
11729 the contents of the editing buffer when you finish, the @kbd{C-x * g}
11730 and @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} commands, the @kbd{C-y} command, the X window system
11731 ``paste'' mouse operation, and Embedded mode. All of these operations
11732 use the same rules for parsing formulas; in particular, language modes
11733 (@pxref{Language Modes}) affect them all in the same way.
11734
11735 When you read a large amount of text into the Calculator (say a vector
11736 which represents a big set of rewrite rules; @pxref{Rewrite Rules}),
11737 you may wish to include comments in the text. Calc's formula parser
11738 ignores the symbol @samp{%%} and anything following it on a line:
11739
11740 @example
11741 [ a + b, %% the sum of "a" and "b"
11742 c + d,
11743 %% last line is coming up:
11744 e + f ]
11745 @end example
11746
11747 @noindent
11748 This is parsed exactly the same as @samp{[ a + b, c + d, e + f ]}.
11749
11750 @xref{Syntax Tables}, for a way to create your own operators and other
11751 input notations. @xref{Compositions}, for a way to create new display
11752 formats.
11753
11754 @xref{Algebra}, for commands for manipulating formulas symbolically.
11755
11756 @node Stack and Trail, Mode Settings, Data Types, Top
11757 @chapter Stack and Trail Commands
11758
11759 @noindent
11760 This chapter describes the Calc commands for manipulating objects on the
11761 stack and in the trail buffer. (These commands operate on objects of any
11762 type, such as numbers, vectors, formulas, and incomplete objects.)
11763
11764 @menu
11765 * Stack Manipulation::
11766 * Editing Stack Entries::
11767 * Trail Commands::
11768 * Keep Arguments::
11769 @end menu
11770
11771 @node Stack Manipulation, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail, Stack and Trail
11772 @section Stack Manipulation Commands
11773
11774 @noindent
11775 @kindex @key{RET}
11776 @kindex @key{SPC}
11777 @pindex calc-enter
11778 @cindex Duplicating stack entries
11779 To duplicate the top object on the stack, press @key{RET} or @key{SPC}
11780 (two equivalent keys for the @code{calc-enter} command).
11781 Given a positive numeric prefix argument, these commands duplicate
11782 several elements at the top of the stack.
11783 Given a negative argument,
11784 these commands duplicate the specified element of the stack.
11785 Given an argument of zero, they duplicate the entire stack.
11786 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11787 @key{RET} creates @samp{10 20 30 30},
11788 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20 30},
11789 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20}, and
11790 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 10 20 30}.
11791
11792 @kindex @key{LFD}
11793 @pindex calc-over
11794 The @key{LFD} (@code{calc-over}) command (on a key marked Line-Feed if you
11795 have it, else on @kbd{C-j}) is like @code{calc-enter}
11796 except that the sign of the numeric prefix argument is interpreted
11797 oppositely. Also, with no prefix argument the default argument is 2.
11798 Thus with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack, @key{LFD} and @kbd{C-u 2 @key{LFD}}
11799 are both equivalent to @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}}, producing
11800 @samp{10 20 30 20}.
11801
11802 @kindex @key{DEL}
11803 @kindex C-d
11804 @pindex calc-pop
11805 @cindex Removing stack entries
11806 @cindex Deleting stack entries
11807 To remove the top element from the stack, press @key{DEL} (@code{calc-pop}).
11808 The @kbd{C-d} key is a synonym for @key{DEL}.
11809 (If the top element is an incomplete object with at least one element, the
11810 last element is removed from it.) Given a positive numeric prefix argument,
11811 several elements are removed. Given a negative argument, the specified
11812 element of the stack is deleted. Given an argument of zero, the entire
11813 stack is emptied.
11814 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11815 @key{DEL} leaves @samp{10 20},
11816 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10},
11817 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10 30}, and
11818 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{DEL}} leaves an empty stack.
11819
11820 @kindex M-@key{DEL}
11821 @pindex calc-pop-above
11822 The @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} (@code{calc-pop-above}) command is to @key{DEL} what
11823 @key{LFD} is to @key{RET}: It interprets the sign of the numeric
11824 prefix argument in the opposite way, and the default argument is 2.
11825 Thus @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} by itself removes the second-from-top stack element,
11826 leaving the first, third, fourth, and so on; @kbd{M-3 M-@key{DEL}} deletes
11827 the third stack element.
11828
11829 @kindex @key{TAB}
11830 @pindex calc-roll-down
11831 To exchange the top two elements of the stack, press @key{TAB}
11832 (@code{calc-roll-down}). Given a positive numeric prefix argument, the
11833 specified number of elements at the top of the stack are rotated downward.
11834 Given a negative argument, the entire stack is rotated downward the specified
11835 number of times. Given an argument of zero, the entire stack is reversed
11836 top-for-bottom.
11837 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11838 @key{TAB} creates @samp{10 20 30 50 40},
11839 @kbd{C-u 3 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 50 30 40},
11840 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{40 50 10 20 30}, and
11841 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11842
11843 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
11844 @pindex calc-roll-up
11845 The command @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{calc-roll-up}) is analogous to @key{TAB}
11846 except that it rotates upward instead of downward. Also, the default
11847 with no prefix argument is to rotate the top 3 elements.
11848 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11849 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 40 50 30},
11850 @kbd{C-u 4 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 30 40 50 20},
11851 @kbd{C-u - 2 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{30 40 50 10 20}, and
11852 @kbd{C-u 0 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11853
11854 A good way to view the operation of @key{TAB} and @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} is in
11855 terms of moving a particular element to a new position in the stack.
11856 With a positive argument @var{n}, @key{TAB} moves the top stack
11857 element down to level @var{n}, making room for it by pulling all the
11858 intervening stack elements toward the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} moves the
11859 element at level @var{n} up to the top. (Compare with @key{LFD},
11860 which copies instead of moving the element in level @var{n}.)
11861
11862 With a negative argument @mathit{-@var{n}}, @key{TAB} rotates the stack
11863 to move the object in level @var{n} to the deepest place in the
11864 stack, and the object in level @mathit{@var{n}+1} to the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}
11865 rotates the deepest stack element to be in level @var{n}, also
11866 putting the top stack element in level @mathit{@var{n}+1}.
11867
11868 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for a way to apply these commands to
11869 any portion of a vector or formula on the stack.
11870
11871 @kindex C-xC-t
11872 @pindex calc-transpose-lines
11873 @cindex Moving stack entries
11874 The command @kbd{C-x C-t} (@code{calc-transpose-lines}) will transpose
11875 the stack object determined by the point with the stack object at the
11876 next higher level. For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the
11877 stack and the point on the line containing @samp{30}, @kbd{C-x C-t}
11878 creates @samp{10 20 40 30 50}. More generally, @kbd{C-x C-t} acts on
11879 the stack objects determined by the current point (and mark) similar
11880 to how the text-mode command @code{transpose-lines} acts on
11881 lines. With argument @var{n}, @kbd{C-x C-t} will move the stack object
11882 at the level above the current point and move it past N other objects;
11883 for example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack and the point on
11884 the line containing @samp{30}, @kbd{C-u 2 C-x C-t} creates
11885 @samp{10 40 20 30 50}. With an argument of 0, @kbd{C-x C-t} will switch
11886 the stack objects at the levels determined by the point and the mark.
11887
11888 @node Editing Stack Entries, Trail Commands, Stack Manipulation, Stack and Trail
11889 @section Editing Stack Entries
11890
11891 @noindent
11892 @kindex `
11893 @pindex calc-edit
11894 @pindex calc-edit-finish
11895 @cindex Editing the stack with Emacs
11896 The @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command creates a temporary buffer
11897 (@samp{*Calc Edit*}) for editing the top-of-stack value using regular
11898 Emacs commands. Note that @kbd{`} is a backquote, not a quote. With a
11899 numeric prefix argument, it edits the specified number of stack entries
11900 at once. (An argument of zero edits the entire stack; a negative
11901 argument edits one specific stack entry.)
11902
11903 When you are done editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish and return
11904 to Calc. The @key{RET} and @key{LFD} keys also work to finish most
11905 sorts of editing, though in some cases Calc leaves @key{RET} with its
11906 usual meaning (``insert a newline'') if it's a situation where you
11907 might want to insert new lines into the editing buffer.
11908
11909 When you finish editing, the Calculator parses the lines of text in
11910 the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer as numbers or formulas, replaces the
11911 original stack elements in the original buffer with these new values,
11912 then kills the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. The original Calculator buffer
11913 continues to exist during editing, but for best results you should be
11914 careful not to change it until you have finished the edit. You can
11915 also cancel the edit by killing the buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
11916
11917 The formula is normally reevaluated as it is put onto the stack.
11918 For example, editing @samp{a + 2} to @samp{3 + 2} and pressing
11919 @kbd{C-c C-c} will push 5 on the stack. If you use @key{LFD} to
11920 finish, Calc will put the result on the stack without evaluating it.
11921
11922 If you give a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c},
11923 Calc will not kill the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. You can switch
11924 back to that buffer and continue editing if you wish. However, you
11925 should understand that if you initiated the edit with @kbd{`}, the
11926 @kbd{C-c C-c} operation will be programmed to replace the top of the
11927 stack with the new edited value, and it will do this even if you have
11928 rearranged the stack in the meanwhile. This is not so much of a problem
11929 with other editing commands, though, such as @kbd{s e}
11930 (@code{calc-edit-variable}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}).
11931
11932 If the @code{calc-edit} command involves more than one stack entry,
11933 each line of the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer is interpreted as a
11934 separate formula. Otherwise, the entire buffer is interpreted as
11935 one formula, with line breaks ignored. (You can use @kbd{C-o} or
11936 @kbd{C-q C-j} to insert a newline in the buffer without pressing @key{RET}.)
11937
11938 The @kbd{`} key also works during numeric or algebraic entry. The
11939 text entered so far is moved to the @code{*Calc Edit*} buffer for
11940 more extensive editing than is convenient in the minibuffer.
11941
11942 @node Trail Commands, Keep Arguments, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail
11943 @section Trail Commands
11944
11945 @noindent
11946 @cindex Trail buffer
11947 The commands for manipulating the Calc Trail buffer are two-key sequences
11948 beginning with the @kbd{t} prefix.
11949
11950 @kindex t d
11951 @pindex calc-trail-display
11952 The @kbd{t d} (@code{calc-trail-display}) command turns display of the
11953 trail on and off. Normally the trail display is toggled on if it was off,
11954 off if it was on. With a numeric prefix of zero, this command always
11955 turns the trail off; with a prefix of one, it always turns the trail on.
11956 The other trail-manipulation commands described here automatically turn
11957 the trail on. Note that when the trail is off values are still recorded
11958 there; they are simply not displayed. To set Emacs to turn the trail
11959 off by default, type @kbd{t d} and then save the mode settings with
11960 @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}).
11961
11962 @kindex t i
11963 @pindex calc-trail-in
11964 @kindex t o
11965 @pindex calc-trail-out
11966 The @kbd{t i} (@code{calc-trail-in}) and @kbd{t o}
11967 (@code{calc-trail-out}) commands switch the cursor into and out of the
11968 Calc Trail window. In practice they are rarely used, since the commands
11969 shown below are a more convenient way to move around in the
11970 trail, and they work ``by remote control'' when the cursor is still
11971 in the Calculator window.
11972
11973 @cindex Trail pointer
11974 There is a @dfn{trail pointer} which selects some entry of the trail at
11975 any given time. The trail pointer looks like a @samp{>} symbol right
11976 before the selected number. The following commands operate on the
11977 trail pointer in various ways.
11978
11979 @kindex t y
11980 @pindex calc-trail-yank
11981 @cindex Retrieving previous results
11982 The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command reads the selected value in
11983 the trail and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. It allows you to
11984 re-use any previously computed value without retyping. With a numeric
11985 prefix argument @var{n}, it yanks the value @var{n} lines above the current
11986 trail pointer.
11987
11988 @kindex t <
11989 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-left
11990 @kindex t >
11991 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-right
11992 The @kbd{t <} (@code{calc-trail-scroll-left}) and @kbd{t >}
11993 (@code{calc-trail-scroll-right}) commands horizontally scroll the trail
11994 window left or right by one half of its width.
11995
11996 @kindex t n
11997 @pindex calc-trail-next
11998 @kindex t p
11999 @pindex calc-trail-previous
12000 @kindex t f
12001 @pindex calc-trail-forward
12002 @kindex t b
12003 @pindex calc-trail-backward
12004 The @kbd{t n} (@code{calc-trail-next}) and @kbd{t p}
12005 (@code{calc-trail-previous)} commands move the trail pointer down or up
12006 one line. The @kbd{t f} (@code{calc-trail-forward}) and @kbd{t b}
12007 (@code{calc-trail-backward}) commands move the trail pointer down or up
12008 one screenful at a time. All of these commands accept numeric prefix
12009 arguments to move several lines or screenfuls at a time.
12010
12011 @kindex t [
12012 @pindex calc-trail-first
12013 @kindex t ]
12014 @pindex calc-trail-last
12015 @kindex t h
12016 @pindex calc-trail-here
12017 The @kbd{t [} (@code{calc-trail-first}) and @kbd{t ]}
12018 (@code{calc-trail-last}) commands move the trail pointer to the first or
12019 last line of the trail. The @kbd{t h} (@code{calc-trail-here}) command
12020 moves the trail pointer to the cursor position; unlike the other trail
12021 commands, @kbd{t h} works only when Calc Trail is the selected window.
12022
12023 @kindex t s
12024 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-forward
12025 @kindex t r
12026 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-backward
12027 @ifnottex
12028 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12029 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) commands perform an incremental
12030 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12031 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12032 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12033 it was when the search began.
12034 @end ifnottex
12035 @tex
12036 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12037 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) com\-mands perform an incremental
12038 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12039 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12040 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12041 it was when the search began.
12042 @end tex
12043
12044 @kindex t m
12045 @pindex calc-trail-marker
12046 The @kbd{t m} (@code{calc-trail-marker}) command allows you to enter a
12047 line of text of your own choosing into the trail. The text is inserted
12048 after the line containing the trail pointer; this usually means it is
12049 added to the end of the trail. Trail markers are useful mainly as the
12050 targets for later incremental searches in the trail.
12051
12052 @kindex t k
12053 @pindex calc-trail-kill
12054 The @kbd{t k} (@code{calc-trail-kill}) command removes the selected line
12055 from the trail. The line is saved in the Emacs kill ring suitable for
12056 yanking into another buffer, but it is not easy to yank the text back
12057 into the trail buffer. With a numeric prefix argument, this command
12058 kills the @var{n} lines below or above the selected one.
12059
12060 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command is described
12061 elsewhere; @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
12062
12063 @node Keep Arguments, , Trail Commands, Stack and Trail
12064 @section Keep Arguments
12065
12066 @noindent
12067 @kindex K
12068 @pindex calc-keep-args
12069 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command acts like a prefix for
12070 the following command. It prevents that command from removing its
12071 arguments from the stack. For example, after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +},
12072 the stack contains the sole number 5, but after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K +},
12073 the stack contains the arguments and the result: @samp{2 3 5}.
12074
12075 With the exception of keyboard macros, this works for all commands that
12076 take arguments off the stack. (To avoid potentially unpleasant behavior,
12077 a @kbd{K} prefix before a keyboard macro will be ignored. A @kbd{K}
12078 prefix called @emph{within} the keyboard macro will still take effect.)
12079 As another example, @kbd{K a s} simplifies a formula, pushing the
12080 simplified version of the formula onto the stack after the original
12081 formula (rather than replacing the original formula). Note that you
12082 could get the same effect by typing @kbd{@key{RET} a s}, copying the
12083 formula and then simplifying the copy. One difference is that for a very
12084 large formula the time taken to format the intermediate copy in
12085 @kbd{@key{RET} a s} could be noticeable; @kbd{K a s} would avoid this
12086 extra work.
12087
12088 Even stack manipulation commands are affected. @key{TAB} works by
12089 popping two values and pushing them back in the opposite order,
12090 so @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K @key{TAB}} produces @samp{2 3 3 2}.
12091
12092 A few Calc commands provide other ways of doing the same thing.
12093 For example, @kbd{' sin($)} replaces the number on the stack with
12094 its sine using algebraic entry; to push the sine and keep the
12095 original argument you could use either @kbd{' sin($1)} or
12096 @kbd{K ' sin($)}. @xref{Algebraic Entry}. Also, the @kbd{s s}
12097 command is effectively the same as @kbd{K s t}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
12098
12099 If you execute a command and then decide you really wanted to keep
12100 the argument, you can press @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
12101 This command pushes the last arguments that were popped by any command
12102 onto the stack. Note that the order of things on the stack will be
12103 different than with @kbd{K}: @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + M-@key{RET}} leaves
12104 @samp{5 2 3} on the stack instead of @samp{2 3 5}. @xref{Undo}.
12105
12106 @node Mode Settings, Arithmetic, Stack and Trail, Top
12107 @chapter Mode Settings
12108
12109 @noindent
12110 This chapter describes commands that set modes in the Calculator.
12111 They do not affect the contents of the stack, although they may change
12112 the @emph{appearance} or @emph{interpretation} of the stack's contents.
12113
12114 @menu
12115 * General Mode Commands::
12116 * Precision::
12117 * Inverse and Hyperbolic::
12118 * Calculation Modes::
12119 * Simplification Modes::
12120 * Declarations::
12121 * Display Modes::
12122 * Language Modes::
12123 * Modes Variable::
12124 * Calc Mode Line::
12125 @end menu
12126
12127 @node General Mode Commands, Precision, Mode Settings, Mode Settings
12128 @section General Mode Commands
12129
12130 @noindent
12131 @kindex m m
12132 @pindex calc-save-modes
12133 @cindex Continuous memory
12134 @cindex Saving mode settings
12135 @cindex Permanent mode settings
12136 @cindex Calc init file, mode settings
12137 You can save all of the current mode settings in your Calc init file
12138 (the file given by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
12139 @file{~/.calc.el}) with the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command.
12140 This will cause Emacs to reestablish these modes each time it starts up.
12141 The modes saved in the file include everything controlled by the @kbd{m}
12142 and @kbd{d} prefix keys, the current precision and binary word size,
12143 whether or not the trail is displayed, the current height of the Calc
12144 window, and more. The current interface (used when you type @kbd{C-x * *})
12145 is also saved. If there were already saved mode settings in the
12146 file, they are replaced. Otherwise, the new mode information is
12147 appended to the end of the file.
12148
12149 @kindex m R
12150 @pindex calc-mode-record-mode
12151 The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command tells Calc to
12152 record all the mode settings (as if by pressing @kbd{m m}) every
12153 time a mode setting changes. If the modes are saved this way, then this
12154 ``automatic mode recording'' mode is also saved.
12155 Type @kbd{m R} again to disable this method of recording the mode
12156 settings. To turn it off permanently, the @kbd{m m} command will also be
12157 necessary. (If Embedded mode is enabled, other options for recording
12158 the modes are available; @pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
12159
12160 @kindex m F
12161 @pindex calc-settings-file-name
12162 The @kbd{m F} (@code{calc-settings-file-name}) command allows you to
12163 choose a different file than the current value of @code{calc-settings-file}
12164 for @kbd{m m}, @kbd{Z P}, and similar commands to save permanent information.
12165 You are prompted for a file name. All Calc modes are then reset to
12166 their default values, then settings from the file you named are loaded
12167 if this file exists, and this file becomes the one that Calc will
12168 use in the future for commands like @kbd{m m}. The default settings
12169 file name is @file{~/.calc.el}. You can see the current file name by
12170 giving a blank response to the @kbd{m F} prompt. See also the
12171 discussion of the @code{calc-settings-file} variable; @pxref{Customizing Calc}.
12172
12173 If the file name you give is your user init file (typically
12174 @file{~/.emacs}), @kbd{m F} will not automatically load the new file. This
12175 is because your user init file may contain other things you don't want
12176 to reread. You can give
12177 a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{m F} to force it to read the
12178 file no matter what. Conversely, an argument of @mathit{-1} tells
12179 @kbd{m F} @emph{not} to read the new file. An argument of 2 or @mathit{-2}
12180 tells @kbd{m F} not to reset the modes to their defaults beforehand,
12181 which is useful if you intend your new file to have a variant of the
12182 modes present in the file you were using before.
12183
12184 @kindex m x
12185 @pindex calc-always-load-extensions
12186 The @kbd{m x} (@code{calc-always-load-extensions}) command enables a mode
12187 in which the first use of Calc loads the entire program, including all
12188 extensions modules. Otherwise, the extensions modules will not be loaded
12189 until the various advanced Calc features are used. Since this mode only
12190 has effect when Calc is first loaded, @kbd{m x} is usually followed by
12191 @kbd{m m} to make the mode-setting permanent. To load all of Calc just
12192 once, rather than always in the future, you can press @kbd{C-x * L}.
12193
12194 @kindex m S
12195 @pindex calc-shift-prefix
12196 The @kbd{m S} (@code{calc-shift-prefix}) command enables a mode in which
12197 all of Calc's letter prefix keys may be typed shifted as well as unshifted.
12198 If you are typing, say, @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) quite often
12199 you might find it easier to turn this mode on so that you can type
12200 @kbd{A S} instead. When this mode is enabled, the commands that used to
12201 be on those single shifted letters (e.g., @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs})) can
12202 now be invoked by pressing the shifted letter twice: @kbd{A A}. Note
12203 that the @kbd{v} prefix key always works both shifted and unshifted, and
12204 the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z} prefix keys are always distinct. Also, the @kbd{h}
12205 prefix is not affected by this mode. Press @kbd{m S} again to disable
12206 shifted-prefix mode.
12207
12208 @node Precision, Inverse and Hyperbolic, General Mode Commands, Mode Settings
12209 @section Precision
12210
12211 @noindent
12212 @kindex p
12213 @pindex calc-precision
12214 @cindex Precision of calculations
12215 The @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision}) command controls the precision to
12216 which floating-point calculations are carried. The precision must be
12217 at least 3 digits and may be arbitrarily high, within the limits of
12218 memory and time. This affects only floats: Integer and rational
12219 calculations are always carried out with as many digits as necessary.
12220
12221 The @kbd{p} key prompts for the current precision. If you wish you
12222 can instead give the precision as a numeric prefix argument.
12223
12224 Many internal calculations are carried to one or two digits higher
12225 precision than normal. Results are rounded down afterward to the
12226 current precision. Unless a special display mode has been selected,
12227 floats are always displayed with their full stored precision, i.e.,
12228 what you see is what you get. Reducing the current precision does not
12229 round values already on the stack, but those values will be rounded
12230 down before being used in any calculation. The @kbd{c 0} through
12231 @kbd{c 9} commands (@pxref{Conversions}) can be used to round an
12232 existing value to a new precision.
12233
12234 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
12235 It is important to distinguish the concepts of @dfn{precision} and
12236 @dfn{accuracy}. In the normal usage of these words, the number
12237 123.4567 has a precision of 7 digits but an accuracy of 4 digits.
12238 The precision is the total number of digits not counting leading
12239 or trailing zeros (regardless of the position of the decimal point).
12240 The accuracy is simply the number of digits after the decimal point
12241 (again not counting trailing zeros). In Calc you control the precision,
12242 not the accuracy of computations. If you were to set the accuracy
12243 instead, then calculations like @samp{exp(100)} would generate many
12244 more digits than you would typically need, while @samp{exp(-100)} would
12245 probably round to zero! In Calc, both these computations give you
12246 exactly 12 (or the requested number of) significant digits.
12247
12248 The only Calc features that deal with accuracy instead of precision
12249 are fixed-point display mode for floats (@kbd{d f}; @pxref{Float Formats}),
12250 and the rounding functions like @code{floor} and @code{round}
12251 (@pxref{Integer Truncation}). Also, @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}
12252 deal with both precision and accuracy depending on the magnitudes
12253 of the numbers involved.
12254
12255 If you need to work with a particular fixed accuracy (say, dollars and
12256 cents with two digits after the decimal point), one solution is to work
12257 with integers and an ``implied'' decimal point. For example, $8.99
12258 divided by 6 would be entered @kbd{899 @key{RET} 6 /}, yielding 149.833
12259 (actually $1.49833 with our implied decimal point); pressing @kbd{R}
12260 would round this to 150 cents, i.e., $1.50.
12261
12262 @xref{Floats}, for still more on floating-point precision and related
12263 issues.
12264
12265 @node Inverse and Hyperbolic, Calculation Modes, Precision, Mode Settings
12266 @section Inverse and Hyperbolic Flags
12267
12268 @noindent
12269 @kindex I
12270 @pindex calc-inverse
12271 There is no single-key equivalent to the @code{calc-arcsin} function.
12272 Instead, you must first press @kbd{I} (@code{calc-inverse}) to set
12273 the @dfn{Inverse Flag}, then press @kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}).
12274 The @kbd{I} key actually toggles the Inverse Flag. When this flag
12275 is set, the word @samp{Inv} appears in the mode line.
12276
12277 @kindex H
12278 @pindex calc-hyperbolic
12279 Likewise, the @kbd{H} key (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) sets or clears the
12280 Hyperbolic Flag, which transforms @code{calc-sin} into @code{calc-sinh}.
12281 If both of these flags are set at once, the effect will be
12282 @code{calc-arcsinh}. (The Hyperbolic flag is also used by some
12283 non-trigonometric commands; for example @kbd{H L} computes a base-10,
12284 instead of base-@mathit{e}, logarithm.)
12285
12286 Command names like @code{calc-arcsin} are provided for completeness, and
12287 may be executed with @kbd{x} or @kbd{M-x}. Their effect is simply to
12288 toggle the Inverse and/or Hyperbolic flags and then execute the
12289 corresponding base command (@code{calc-sin} in this case).
12290
12291 The Inverse and Hyperbolic flags apply only to the next Calculator
12292 command, after which they are automatically cleared. (They are also
12293 cleared if the next keystroke is not a Calc command.) Digits you
12294 type after @kbd{I} or @kbd{H} (or @kbd{K}) are treated as prefix
12295 arguments for the next command, not as numeric entries. The same
12296 is true of @kbd{C-u}, but not of the minus sign (@kbd{K -} means to
12297 subtract and keep arguments).
12298
12299 The third Calc prefix flag, @kbd{K} (keep-arguments), is discussed
12300 elsewhere. @xref{Keep Arguments}.
12301
12302 @node Calculation Modes, Simplification Modes, Inverse and Hyperbolic, Mode Settings
12303 @section Calculation Modes
12304
12305 @noindent
12306 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with
12307 the @kbd{m} prefix. (That's the letter @kbd{m}, not the @key{META} key.)
12308 The @samp{m a} (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) command is described elsewhere
12309 (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
12310
12311 @menu
12312 * Angular Modes::
12313 * Polar Mode::
12314 * Fraction Mode::
12315 * Infinite Mode::
12316 * Symbolic Mode::
12317 * Matrix Mode::
12318 * Automatic Recomputation::
12319 * Working Message::
12320 @end menu
12321
12322 @node Angular Modes, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes, Calculation Modes
12323 @subsection Angular Modes
12324
12325 @noindent
12326 @cindex Angular mode
12327 The Calculator supports three notations for angles: radians, degrees,
12328 and degrees-minutes-seconds. When a number is presented to a function
12329 like @code{sin} that requires an angle, the current angular mode is
12330 used to interpret the number as either radians or degrees. If an HMS
12331 form is presented to @code{sin}, it is always interpreted as
12332 degrees-minutes-seconds.
12333
12334 Functions that compute angles produce a number in radians, a number in
12335 degrees, or an HMS form depending on the current angular mode. If the
12336 result is a complex number and the current mode is HMS, the number is
12337 instead expressed in degrees. (Complex-number calculations would
12338 normally be done in Radians mode, though. Complex numbers are converted
12339 to degrees by calculating the complex result in radians and then
12340 multiplying by 180 over @cpi{}.)
12341
12342 @kindex m r
12343 @pindex calc-radians-mode
12344 @kindex m d
12345 @pindex calc-degrees-mode
12346 @kindex m h
12347 @pindex calc-hms-mode
12348 The @kbd{m r} (@code{calc-radians-mode}), @kbd{m d} (@code{calc-degrees-mode}),
12349 and @kbd{m h} (@code{calc-hms-mode}) commands control the angular mode.
12350 The current angular mode is displayed on the Emacs mode line.
12351 The default angular mode is Degrees.
12352
12353 @node Polar Mode, Fraction Mode, Angular Modes, Calculation Modes
12354 @subsection Polar Mode
12355
12356 @noindent
12357 @cindex Polar mode
12358 The Calculator normally ``prefers'' rectangular complex numbers in the
12359 sense that rectangular form is used when the proper form can not be
12360 decided from the input. This might happen by multiplying a rectangular
12361 number by a polar one, by taking the square root of a negative real
12362 number, or by entering @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )}.
12363
12364 @kindex m p
12365 @pindex calc-polar-mode
12366 The @kbd{m p} (@code{calc-polar-mode}) command toggles complex-number
12367 preference between rectangular and polar forms. In Polar mode, all
12368 of the above example situations would produce polar complex numbers.
12369
12370 @node Fraction Mode, Infinite Mode, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes
12371 @subsection Fraction Mode
12372
12373 @noindent
12374 @cindex Fraction mode
12375 @cindex Division of integers
12376 Division of two integers normally yields a floating-point number if the
12377 result cannot be expressed as an integer. In some cases you would
12378 rather get an exact fractional answer. One way to accomplish this is
12379 to use the @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command, which
12380 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fraction:
12381 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 :} produces @expr{3:2} even though
12382 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 /} produces @expr{1.5}.
12383
12384 @kindex m f
12385 @pindex calc-frac-mode
12386 To set the Calculator to produce fractional results for normal integer
12387 divisions, use the @kbd{m f} (@code{calc-frac-mode}) command.
12388 For example, @expr{8/4} produces @expr{2} in either mode,
12389 but @expr{6/4} produces @expr{3:2} in Fraction mode, @expr{1.5} in
12390 Float mode.
12391
12392 At any time you can use @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) to convert a
12393 fraction to a float, or @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) to convert a
12394 float to a fraction. @xref{Conversions}.
12395
12396 @node Infinite Mode, Symbolic Mode, Fraction Mode, Calculation Modes
12397 @subsection Infinite Mode
12398
12399 @noindent
12400 @cindex Infinite mode
12401 The Calculator normally treats results like @expr{1 / 0} as errors;
12402 formulas like this are left in unsimplified form. But Calc can be
12403 put into a mode where such calculations instead produce ``infinite''
12404 results.
12405
12406 @kindex m i
12407 @pindex calc-infinite-mode
12408 The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode}) command turns this mode
12409 on and off. When the mode is off, infinities do not arise except
12410 in calculations that already had infinities as inputs. (One exception
12411 is that infinite open intervals like @samp{[0 .. inf)} can be
12412 generated; however, intervals closed at infinity (@samp{[0 .. inf]})
12413 will not be generated when Infinite mode is off.)
12414
12415 With Infinite mode turned on, @samp{1 / 0} will generate @code{uinf},
12416 an undirected infinity. @xref{Infinities}, for a discussion of the
12417 difference between @code{inf} and @code{uinf}. Also, @expr{0 / 0}
12418 evaluates to @code{nan}, the ``indeterminate'' symbol. Various other
12419 functions can also return infinities in this mode; for example,
12420 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}, and @samp{gamma(-7) = uinf}. Once again,
12421 note that @samp{exp(inf) = inf} regardless of Infinite mode because
12422 this calculation has infinity as an input.
12423
12424 @cindex Positive Infinite mode
12425 The @kbd{m i} command with a numeric prefix argument of zero,
12426 i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 m i}, turns on a Positive Infinite mode in
12427 which zero is treated as positive instead of being directionless.
12428 Thus, @samp{1 / 0 = inf} and @samp{-1 / 0 = -inf} in this mode.
12429 Note that zero never actually has a sign in Calc; there are no
12430 separate representations for @mathit{+0} and @mathit{-0}. Positive
12431 Infinite mode merely changes the interpretation given to the
12432 single symbol, @samp{0}. One consequence of this is that, while
12433 you might expect @samp{1 / -0 = -inf}, actually @samp{1 / -0}
12434 is equivalent to @samp{1 / 0}, which is equal to positive @code{inf}.
12435
12436 @node Symbolic Mode, Matrix Mode, Infinite Mode, Calculation Modes
12437 @subsection Symbolic Mode
12438
12439 @noindent
12440 @cindex Symbolic mode
12441 @cindex Inexact results
12442 Calculations are normally performed numerically wherever possible.
12443 For example, the @code{calc-sqrt} command, or @code{sqrt} function in an
12444 algebraic expression, produces a numeric answer if the argument is a
12445 number or a symbolic expression if the argument is an expression:
12446 @kbd{2 Q} pushes 1.4142 but @kbd{@key{'} x+1 @key{RET} Q} pushes @samp{sqrt(x+1)}.
12447
12448 @kindex m s
12449 @pindex calc-symbolic-mode
12450 In @dfn{Symbolic mode}, controlled by the @kbd{m s} (@code{calc-symbolic-mode})
12451 command, functions which would produce inexact, irrational results are
12452 left in symbolic form. Thus @kbd{16 Q} pushes 4, but @kbd{2 Q} pushes
12453 @samp{sqrt(2)}.
12454
12455 @kindex N
12456 @pindex calc-eval-num
12457 The shift-@kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) command evaluates numerically
12458 the expression at the top of the stack, by temporarily disabling
12459 @code{calc-symbolic-mode} and executing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
12460 Given a numeric prefix argument, it also
12461 sets the floating-point precision to the specified value for the duration
12462 of the command.
12463
12464 To evaluate a formula numerically without expanding the variables it
12465 contains, you can use the key sequence @kbd{m s a v m s} (this uses
12466 @code{calc-alg-evaluate}, which resimplifies but doesn't evaluate
12467 variables.)
12468
12469 @node Matrix Mode, Automatic Recomputation, Symbolic Mode, Calculation Modes
12470 @subsection Matrix and Scalar Modes
12471
12472 @noindent
12473 @cindex Matrix mode
12474 @cindex Scalar mode
12475 Calc sometimes makes assumptions during algebraic manipulation that
12476 are awkward or incorrect when vectors and matrices are involved.
12477 Calc has two modes, @dfn{Matrix mode} and @dfn{Scalar mode}, which
12478 modify its behavior around vectors in useful ways.
12479
12480 @kindex m v
12481 @pindex calc-matrix-mode
12482 Press @kbd{m v} (@code{calc-matrix-mode}) once to enter Matrix mode.
12483 In this mode, all objects are assumed to be matrices unless provably
12484 otherwise. One major effect is that Calc will no longer consider
12485 multiplication to be commutative. (Recall that in matrix arithmetic,
12486 @samp{A*B} is not the same as @samp{B*A}.) This assumption affects
12487 rewrite rules and algebraic simplification. Another effect of this
12488 mode is that calculations that would normally produce constants like
12489 0 and 1 (e.g., @expr{a - a} and @expr{a / a}, respectively) will now
12490 produce function calls that represent ``generic'' zero or identity
12491 matrices: @samp{idn(0)}, @samp{idn(1)}. The @code{idn} function
12492 @samp{idn(@var{a},@var{n})} returns @var{a} times an @var{n}x@var{n}
12493 identity matrix; if @var{n} is omitted, it doesn't know what
12494 dimension to use and so the @code{idn} call remains in symbolic
12495 form. However, if this generic identity matrix is later combined
12496 with a matrix whose size is known, it will be converted into
12497 a true identity matrix of the appropriate size. On the other hand,
12498 if it is combined with a scalar (as in @samp{idn(1) + 2}), Calc
12499 will assume it really was a scalar after all and produce, e.g., 3.
12500
12501 Press @kbd{m v} a second time to get Scalar mode. Here, objects are
12502 assumed @emph{not} to be vectors or matrices unless provably so.
12503 For example, normally adding a variable to a vector, as in
12504 @samp{[x, y, z] + a}, will leave the sum in symbolic form because
12505 as far as Calc knows, @samp{a} could represent either a number or
12506 another 3-vector. In Scalar mode, @samp{a} is assumed to be a
12507 non-vector, and the addition is evaluated to @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]}.
12508
12509 Press @kbd{m v} a third time to return to the normal mode of operation.
12510
12511 If you press @kbd{m v} with a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, you
12512 get a special ``dimensioned'' Matrix mode in which matrices of
12513 unknown size are assumed to be @var{n}x@var{n} square matrices.
12514 Then, the function call @samp{idn(1)} will expand into an actual
12515 matrix rather than representing a ``generic'' matrix. Simply typing
12516 @kbd{C-u m v} will get you a square Matrix mode, in which matrices of
12517 unknown size are assumed to be square matrices of unspecified size.
12518
12519 @cindex Declaring scalar variables
12520 Of course these modes are approximations to the true state of
12521 affairs, which is probably that some quantities will be matrices
12522 and others will be scalars. One solution is to ``declare''
12523 certain variables or functions to be scalar-valued.
12524 @xref{Declarations}, to see how to make declarations in Calc.
12525
12526 There is nothing stopping you from declaring a variable to be
12527 scalar and then storing a matrix in it; however, if you do, the
12528 results you get from Calc may not be valid. Suppose you let Calc
12529 get the result @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]} shown above, and then stored
12530 @samp{[1, 2, 3]} in @samp{a}. The result would not be the same as
12531 for @samp{[x, y, z] + [1, 2, 3]}, but that's because you have broken
12532 your earlier promise to Calc that @samp{a} would be scalar.
12533
12534 Another way to mix scalars and matrices is to use selections
12535 (@pxref{Selecting Subformulas}). Use Matrix mode when operating on
12536 your formula normally; then, to apply Scalar mode to a certain part
12537 of the formula without affecting the rest just select that part,
12538 change into Scalar mode and press @kbd{=} to resimplify the part
12539 under this mode, then change back to Matrix mode before deselecting.
12540
12541 @node Automatic Recomputation, Working Message, Matrix Mode, Calculation Modes
12542 @subsection Automatic Recomputation
12543
12544 @noindent
12545 The @dfn{evaluates-to} operator, @samp{=>}, has the special
12546 property that any @samp{=>} formulas on the stack are recomputed
12547 whenever variable values or mode settings that might affect them
12548 are changed. @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}.
12549
12550 @kindex m C
12551 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
12552 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns this
12553 automatic recomputation on and off. If you turn it off, Calc will
12554 not update @samp{=>} operators on the stack (nor those in the
12555 attached Embedded mode buffer, if there is one). They will not
12556 be updated unless you explicitly do so by pressing @kbd{=} or until
12557 you press @kbd{m C} to turn recomputation back on. (While automatic
12558 recomputation is off, you can think of @kbd{m C m C} as a command
12559 to update all @samp{=>} operators while leaving recomputation off.)
12560
12561 To update @samp{=>} operators in an Embedded buffer while
12562 automatic recomputation is off, use @w{@kbd{C-x * u}}.
12563 @xref{Embedded Mode}.
12564
12565 @node Working Message, , Automatic Recomputation, Calculation Modes
12566 @subsection Working Messages
12567
12568 @noindent
12569 @cindex Performance
12570 @cindex Working messages
12571 Since the Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, which is not
12572 designed for heavy numerical work, many operations are quite slow.
12573 The Calculator normally displays the message @samp{Working...} in the
12574 echo area during any command that may be slow. In addition, iterative
12575 operations such as square roots and trigonometric functions display the
12576 intermediate result at each step. Both of these types of messages can
12577 be disabled if you find them distracting.
12578
12579 @kindex m w
12580 @pindex calc-working
12581 Type @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) with a numeric prefix of 0 to
12582 disable all ``working'' messages. Use a numeric prefix of 1 to enable
12583 only the plain @samp{Working...} message. Use a numeric prefix of 2 to
12584 see intermediate results as well. With no numeric prefix this displays
12585 the current mode.
12586
12587 While it may seem that the ``working'' messages will slow Calc down
12588 considerably, experiments have shown that their impact is actually
12589 quite small. But if your terminal is slow you may find that it helps
12590 to turn the messages off.
12591
12592 @node Simplification Modes, Declarations, Calculation Modes, Mode Settings
12593 @section Simplification Modes
12594
12595 @noindent
12596 The current @dfn{simplification mode} controls how numbers and formulas
12597 are ``normalized'' when being taken from or pushed onto the stack.
12598 Some normalizations are unavoidable, such as rounding floating-point
12599 results to the current precision, and reducing fractions to simplest
12600 form. Others, such as simplifying a formula like @expr{a+a} (or @expr{2+3}),
12601 are done by default but can be turned off when necessary.
12602
12603 When you press a key like @kbd{+} when @expr{2} and @expr{3} are on the
12604 stack, Calc pops these numbers, normalizes them, creates the formula
12605 @expr{2+3}, normalizes it, and pushes the result. Of course the standard
12606 rules for normalizing @expr{2+3} will produce the result @expr{5}.
12607
12608 Simplification mode commands consist of the lower-case @kbd{m} prefix key
12609 followed by a shifted letter.
12610
12611 @kindex m O
12612 @pindex calc-no-simplify-mode
12613 The @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) command turns off all optional
12614 simplifications. These would leave a formula like @expr{2+3} alone. In
12615 fact, nothing except simple numbers are ever affected by normalization
12616 in this mode.
12617
12618 @kindex m N
12619 @pindex calc-num-simplify-mode
12620 The @kbd{m N} (@code{calc-num-simplify-mode}) command turns off simplification
12621 of any formulas except those for which all arguments are constants. For
12622 example, @expr{1+2} is simplified to @expr{3}, and @expr{a+(2-2)} is
12623 simplified to @expr{a+0} but no further, since one argument of the sum
12624 is not a constant. Unfortunately, @expr{(a+2)-2} is @emph{not} simplified
12625 because the top-level @samp{-} operator's arguments are not both
12626 constant numbers (one of them is the formula @expr{a+2}).
12627 A constant is a number or other numeric object (such as a constant
12628 error form or modulo form), or a vector all of whose
12629 elements are constant.
12630
12631 @kindex m D
12632 @pindex calc-default-simplify-mode
12633 The @kbd{m D} (@code{calc-default-simplify-mode}) command restores the
12634 default simplifications for all formulas. This includes many easy and
12635 fast algebraic simplifications such as @expr{a+0} to @expr{a}, and
12636 @expr{a + 2 a} to @expr{3 a}, as well as evaluating functions like
12637 @expr{@tfn{deriv}(x^2, x)} to @expr{2 x}.
12638
12639 @kindex m B
12640 @pindex calc-bin-simplify-mode
12641 The @kbd{m B} (@code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}) mode applies the default
12642 simplifications to a result and then, if the result is an integer,
12643 uses the @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip}) command to clip the integer according
12644 to the current binary word size. @xref{Binary Functions}. Real numbers
12645 are rounded to the nearest integer and then clipped; other kinds of
12646 results (after the default simplifications) are left alone.
12647
12648 @kindex m A
12649 @pindex calc-alg-simplify-mode
12650 The @kbd{m A} (@code{calc-alg-simplify-mode}) mode does algebraic
12651 simplification; it applies all the default simplifications, and also
12652 the more powerful (and slower) simplifications made by @kbd{a s}
12653 (@code{calc-simplify}). @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
12654
12655 @kindex m E
12656 @pindex calc-ext-simplify-mode
12657 The @kbd{m E} (@code{calc-ext-simplify-mode}) mode does ``extended''
12658 algebraic simplification, as by the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended})
12659 command. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
12660
12661 @kindex m U
12662 @pindex calc-units-simplify-mode
12663 The @kbd{m U} (@code{calc-units-simplify-mode}) mode does units
12664 simplification; it applies the command @kbd{u s}
12665 (@code{calc-simplify-units}), which in turn
12666 is a superset of @kbd{a s}. In this mode, variable names which
12667 are identifiable as unit names (like @samp{mm} for ``millimeters'')
12668 are simplified with their unit definitions in mind.
12669
12670 A common technique is to set the simplification mode down to the lowest
12671 amount of simplification you will allow to be applied automatically, then
12672 use manual commands like @kbd{a s} and @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) to
12673 perform higher types of simplifications on demand. @xref{Algebraic
12674 Definitions}, for another sample use of No-Simplification mode.
12675
12676 @node Declarations, Display Modes, Simplification Modes, Mode Settings
12677 @section Declarations
12678
12679 @noindent
12680 A @dfn{declaration} is a statement you make that promises you will
12681 use a certain variable or function in a restricted way. This may
12682 give Calc the freedom to do things that it couldn't do if it had to
12683 take the fully general situation into account.
12684
12685 @menu
12686 * Declaration Basics::
12687 * Kinds of Declarations::
12688 * Functions for Declarations::
12689 @end menu
12690
12691 @node Declaration Basics, Kinds of Declarations, Declarations, Declarations
12692 @subsection Declaration Basics
12693
12694 @noindent
12695 @kindex s d
12696 @pindex calc-declare-variable
12697 The @kbd{s d} (@code{calc-declare-variable}) command is the easiest
12698 way to make a declaration for a variable. This command prompts for
12699 the variable name, then prompts for the declaration. The default
12700 at the declaration prompt is the previous declaration, if any.
12701 You can edit this declaration, or press @kbd{C-k} to erase it and
12702 type a new declaration. (Or, erase it and press @key{RET} to clear
12703 the declaration, effectively ``undeclaring'' the variable.)
12704
12705 A declaration is in general a vector of @dfn{type symbols} and
12706 @dfn{range} values. If there is only one type symbol or range value,
12707 you can write it directly rather than enclosing it in a vector.
12708 For example, @kbd{s d foo @key{RET} real @key{RET}} declares @code{foo} to
12709 be a real number, and @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} [int, const, [1..6]] @key{RET}}
12710 declares @code{bar} to be a constant integer between 1 and 6.
12711 (Actually, you can omit the outermost brackets and Calc will
12712 provide them for you: @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} int, const, [1..6] @key{RET}}.)
12713
12714 @cindex @code{Decls} variable
12715 @vindex Decls
12716 Declarations in Calc are kept in a special variable called @code{Decls}.
12717 This variable encodes the set of all outstanding declarations in
12718 the form of a matrix. Each row has two elements: A variable or
12719 vector of variables declared by that row, and the declaration
12720 specifier as described above. You can use the @kbd{s D} command to
12721 edit this variable if you wish to see all the declarations at once.
12722 @xref{Operations on Variables}, for a description of this command
12723 and the @kbd{s p} command that allows you to save your declarations
12724 permanently if you wish.
12725
12726 Items being declared can also be function calls. The arguments in
12727 the call are ignored; the effect is to say that this function returns
12728 values of the declared type for any valid arguments. The @kbd{s d}
12729 command declares only variables, so if you wish to make a function
12730 declaration you will have to edit the @code{Decls} matrix yourself.
12731
12732 For example, the declaration matrix
12733
12734 @smallexample
12735 @group
12736 [ [ foo, real ]
12737 [ [j, k, n], int ]
12738 [ f(1,2,3), [0 .. inf) ] ]
12739 @end group
12740 @end smallexample
12741
12742 @noindent
12743 declares that @code{foo} represents a real number, @code{j}, @code{k}
12744 and @code{n} represent integers, and the function @code{f} always
12745 returns a real number in the interval shown.
12746
12747 @vindex All
12748 If there is a declaration for the variable @code{All}, then that
12749 declaration applies to all variables that are not otherwise declared.
12750 It does not apply to function names. For example, using the row
12751 @samp{[All, real]} says that all your variables are real unless they
12752 are explicitly declared without @code{real} in some other row.
12753 The @kbd{s d} command declares @code{All} if you give a blank
12754 response to the variable-name prompt.
12755
12756 @node Kinds of Declarations, Functions for Declarations, Declaration Basics, Declarations
12757 @subsection Kinds of Declarations
12758
12759 @noindent
12760 The type-specifier part of a declaration (that is, the second prompt
12761 in the @kbd{s d} command) can be a type symbol, an interval, or a
12762 vector consisting of zero or more type symbols followed by zero or
12763 more intervals or numbers that represent the set of possible values
12764 for the variable.
12765
12766 @smallexample
12767 @group
12768 [ [ a, [1, 2, 3, 4, 5] ]
12769 [ b, [1 .. 5] ]
12770 [ c, [int, 1 .. 5] ] ]
12771 @end group
12772 @end smallexample
12773
12774 Here @code{a} is declared to contain one of the five integers shown;
12775 @code{b} is any number in the interval from 1 to 5 (any real number
12776 since we haven't specified), and @code{c} is any integer in that
12777 interval. Thus the declarations for @code{a} and @code{c} are
12778 nearly equivalent (see below).
12779
12780 The type-specifier can be the empty vector @samp{[]} to say that
12781 nothing is known about a given variable's value. This is the same
12782 as not declaring the variable at all except that it overrides any
12783 @code{All} declaration which would otherwise apply.
12784
12785 The initial value of @code{Decls} is the empty vector @samp{[]}.
12786 If @code{Decls} has no stored value or if the value stored in it
12787 is not valid, it is ignored and there are no declarations as far
12788 as Calc is concerned. (The @kbd{s d} command will replace such a
12789 malformed value with a fresh empty matrix, @samp{[]}, before recording
12790 the new declaration.) Unrecognized type symbols are ignored.
12791
12792 The following type symbols describe what sorts of numbers will be
12793 stored in a variable:
12794
12795 @table @code
12796 @item int
12797 Integers.
12798 @item numint
12799 Numerical integers. (Integers or integer-valued floats.)
12800 @item frac
12801 Fractions. (Rational numbers which are not integers.)
12802 @item rat
12803 Rational numbers. (Either integers or fractions.)
12804 @item float
12805 Floating-point numbers.
12806 @item real
12807 Real numbers. (Integers, fractions, or floats. Actually,
12808 intervals and error forms with real components also count as
12809 reals here.)
12810 @item pos
12811 Positive real numbers. (Strictly greater than zero.)
12812 @item nonneg
12813 Nonnegative real numbers. (Greater than or equal to zero.)
12814 @item number
12815 Numbers. (Real or complex.)
12816 @end table
12817
12818 Calc uses this information to determine when certain simplifications
12819 of formulas are safe. For example, @samp{(x^y)^z} cannot be
12820 simplified to @samp{x^(y z)} in general; for example,
12821 @samp{((-3)^2)^1:2} is 3, but @samp{(-3)^(2*1:2) = (-3)^1} is @mathit{-3}.
12822 However, this simplification @emph{is} safe if @code{z} is known
12823 to be an integer, or if @code{x} is known to be a nonnegative
12824 real number. If you have given declarations that allow Calc to
12825 deduce either of these facts, Calc will perform this simplification
12826 of the formula.
12827
12828 Calc can apply a certain amount of logic when using declarations.
12829 For example, @samp{(x^y)^(2n+1)} will be simplified if @code{n}
12830 has been declared @code{int}; Calc knows that an integer times an
12831 integer, plus an integer, must always be an integer. (In fact,
12832 Calc would simplify @samp{(-x)^(2n+1)} to @samp{-(x^(2n+1))} since
12833 it is able to determine that @samp{2n+1} must be an odd integer.)
12834
12835 Similarly, @samp{(abs(x)^y)^z} will be simplified to @samp{abs(x)^(y z)}
12836 because Calc knows that the @code{abs} function always returns a
12837 nonnegative real. If you had a @code{myabs} function that also had
12838 this property, you could get Calc to recognize it by adding the row
12839 @samp{[myabs(), nonneg]} to the @code{Decls} matrix.
12840
12841 One instance of this simplification is @samp{sqrt(x^2)} (since the
12842 @code{sqrt} function is effectively a one-half power). Normally
12843 Calc leaves this formula alone. After the command
12844 @kbd{s d x @key{RET} real @key{RET}}, however, it can simplify the formula to
12845 @samp{abs(x)}. And after @kbd{s d x @key{RET} nonneg @key{RET}}, Calc can
12846 simplify this formula all the way to @samp{x}.
12847
12848 If there are any intervals or real numbers in the type specifier,
12849 they comprise the set of possible values that the variable or
12850 function being declared can have. In particular, the type symbol
12851 @code{real} is effectively the same as the range @samp{[-inf .. inf]}
12852 (note that infinity is included in the range of possible values);
12853 @code{pos} is the same as @samp{(0 .. inf]}, and @code{nonneg} is
12854 the same as @samp{[0 .. inf]}. Saying @samp{[real, [-5 .. 5]]} is
12855 redundant because the fact that the variable is real can be
12856 deduced just from the interval, but @samp{[int, [-5 .. 5]]} and
12857 @samp{[rat, [-5 .. 5]]} are useful combinations.
12858
12859 Note that the vector of intervals or numbers is in the same format
12860 used by Calc's set-manipulation commands. @xref{Set Operations}.
12861
12862 The type specifier @samp{[1, 2, 3]} is equivalent to
12863 @samp{[numint, 1, 2, 3]}, @emph{not} to @samp{[int, 1, 2, 3]}.
12864 In other words, the range of possible values means only that
12865 the variable's value must be numerically equal to a number in
12866 that range, but not that it must be equal in type as well.
12867 Calc's set operations act the same way; @samp{in(2, [1., 2., 3.])}
12868 and @samp{in(1.5, [1:2, 3:2, 5:2])} both report ``true.''
12869
12870 If you use a conflicting combination of type specifiers, the
12871 results are unpredictable. An example is @samp{[pos, [0 .. 5]]},
12872 where the interval does not lie in the range described by the
12873 type symbol.
12874
12875 ``Real'' declarations mostly affect simplifications involving powers
12876 like the one described above. Another case where they are used
12877 is in the @kbd{a P} command which returns a list of all roots of a
12878 polynomial; if the variable has been declared real, only the real
12879 roots (if any) will be included in the list.
12880
12881 ``Integer'' declarations are used for simplifications which are valid
12882 only when certain values are integers (such as @samp{(x^y)^z}
12883 shown above).
12884
12885 Another command that makes use of declarations is @kbd{a s}, when
12886 simplifying equations and inequalities. It will cancel @code{x}
12887 from both sides of @samp{a x = b x} only if it is sure @code{x}
12888 is non-zero, say, because it has a @code{pos} declaration.
12889 To declare specifically that @code{x} is real and non-zero,
12890 use @samp{[[-inf .. 0), (0 .. inf]]}. (There is no way in the
12891 current notation to say that @code{x} is nonzero but not necessarily
12892 real.) The @kbd{a e} command does ``unsafe'' simplifications,
12893 including cancelling @samp{x} from the equation when @samp{x} is
12894 not known to be nonzero.
12895
12896 Another set of type symbols distinguish between scalars and vectors.
12897
12898 @table @code
12899 @item scalar
12900 The value is not a vector.
12901 @item vector
12902 The value is a vector.
12903 @item matrix
12904 The value is a matrix (a rectangular vector of vectors).
12905 @item sqmatrix
12906 The value is a square matrix.
12907 @end table
12908
12909 These type symbols can be combined with the other type symbols
12910 described above; @samp{[int, matrix]} describes an object which
12911 is a matrix of integers.
12912
12913 Scalar/vector declarations are used to determine whether certain
12914 algebraic operations are safe. For example, @samp{[a, b, c] + x}
12915 is normally not simplified to @samp{[a + x, b + x, c + x]}, but
12916 it will be if @code{x} has been declared @code{scalar}. On the
12917 other hand, multiplication is usually assumed to be commutative,
12918 but the terms in @samp{x y} will never be exchanged if both @code{x}
12919 and @code{y} are known to be vectors or matrices. (Calc currently
12920 never distinguishes between @code{vector} and @code{matrix}
12921 declarations.)
12922
12923 @xref{Matrix Mode}, for a discussion of Matrix mode and
12924 Scalar mode, which are similar to declaring @samp{[All, matrix]}
12925 or @samp{[All, scalar]} but much more convenient.
12926
12927 One more type symbol that is recognized is used with the @kbd{H a d}
12928 command for taking total derivatives of a formula. @xref{Calculus}.
12929
12930 @table @code
12931 @item const
12932 The value is a constant with respect to other variables.
12933 @end table
12934
12935 Calc does not check the declarations for a variable when you store
12936 a value in it. However, storing @mathit{-3.5} in a variable that has
12937 been declared @code{pos}, @code{int}, or @code{matrix} may have
12938 unexpected effects; Calc may evaluate @samp{sqrt(x^2)} to @expr{3.5}
12939 if it substitutes the value first, or to @expr{-3.5} if @code{x}
12940 was declared @code{pos} and the formula @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is
12941 simplified to @samp{x} before the value is substituted. Before
12942 using a variable for a new purpose, it is best to use @kbd{s d}
12943 or @kbd{s D} to check to make sure you don't still have an old
12944 declaration for the variable that will conflict with its new meaning.
12945
12946 @node Functions for Declarations, , Kinds of Declarations, Declarations
12947 @subsection Functions for Declarations
12948
12949 @noindent
12950 Calc has a set of functions for accessing the current declarations
12951 in a convenient manner. These functions return 1 if the argument
12952 can be shown to have the specified property, or 0 if the argument
12953 can be shown @emph{not} to have that property; otherwise they are
12954 left unevaluated. These functions are suitable for use with rewrite
12955 rules (@pxref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}) or programming constructs
12956 (@pxref{Conditionals in Macros}). They can be entered only using
12957 algebraic notation. @xref{Logical Operations}, for functions
12958 that perform other tests not related to declarations.
12959
12960 For example, @samp{dint(17)} returns 1 because 17 is an integer, as
12961 do @samp{dint(n)} and @samp{dint(2 n - 3)} if @code{n} has been declared
12962 @code{int}, but @samp{dint(2.5)} and @samp{dint(n + 0.5)} return 0.
12963 Calc consults knowledge of its own built-in functions as well as your
12964 own declarations: @samp{dint(floor(x))} returns 1.
12965
12966 @ignore
12967 @starindex
12968 @end ignore
12969 @tindex dint
12970 @ignore
12971 @starindex
12972 @end ignore
12973 @tindex dnumint
12974 @ignore
12975 @starindex
12976 @end ignore
12977 @tindex dnatnum
12978 The @code{dint} function checks if its argument is an integer.
12979 The @code{dnatnum} function checks if its argument is a natural
12980 number, i.e., a nonnegative integer. The @code{dnumint} function
12981 checks if its argument is numerically an integer, i.e., either an
12982 integer or an integer-valued float. Note that these and the other
12983 data type functions also accept vectors or matrices composed of
12984 suitable elements, and that real infinities @samp{inf} and @samp{-inf}
12985 are considered to be integers for the purposes of these functions.
12986
12987 @ignore
12988 @starindex
12989 @end ignore
12990 @tindex drat
12991 The @code{drat} function checks if its argument is rational, i.e.,
12992 an integer or fraction. Infinities count as rational, but intervals
12993 and error forms do not.
12994
12995 @ignore
12996 @starindex
12997 @end ignore
12998 @tindex dreal
12999 The @code{dreal} function checks if its argument is real. This
13000 includes integers, fractions, floats, real error forms, and intervals.
13001
13002 @ignore
13003 @starindex
13004 @end ignore
13005 @tindex dimag
13006 The @code{dimag} function checks if its argument is imaginary,
13007 i.e., is mathematically equal to a real number times @expr{i}.
13008
13009 @ignore
13010 @starindex
13011 @end ignore
13012 @tindex dpos
13013 @ignore
13014 @starindex
13015 @end ignore
13016 @tindex dneg
13017 @ignore
13018 @starindex
13019 @end ignore
13020 @tindex dnonneg
13021 The @code{dpos} function checks for positive (but nonzero) reals.
13022 The @code{dneg} function checks for negative reals. The @code{dnonneg}
13023 function checks for nonnegative reals, i.e., reals greater than or
13024 equal to zero. Note that the @kbd{a s} command can simplify an
13025 expression like @expr{x > 0} to 1 or 0 using @code{dpos}, and that
13026 @kbd{a s} is effectively applied to all conditions in rewrite rules,
13027 so the actual functions @code{dpos}, @code{dneg}, and @code{dnonneg}
13028 are rarely necessary.
13029
13030 @ignore
13031 @starindex
13032 @end ignore
13033 @tindex dnonzero
13034 The @code{dnonzero} function checks that its argument is nonzero.
13035 This includes all nonzero real or complex numbers, all intervals that
13036 do not include zero, all nonzero modulo forms, vectors all of whose
13037 elements are nonzero, and variables or formulas whose values can be
13038 deduced to be nonzero. It does not include error forms, since they
13039 represent values which could be anything including zero. (This is
13040 also the set of objects considered ``true'' in conditional contexts.)
13041
13042 @ignore
13043 @starindex
13044 @end ignore
13045 @tindex deven
13046 @ignore
13047 @starindex
13048 @end ignore
13049 @tindex dodd
13050 The @code{deven} function returns 1 if its argument is known to be
13051 an even integer (or integer-valued float); it returns 0 if its argument
13052 is known not to be even (because it is known to be odd or a non-integer).
13053 The @kbd{a s} command uses this to simplify a test of the form
13054 @samp{x % 2 = 0}. There is also an analogous @code{dodd} function.
13055
13056 @ignore
13057 @starindex
13058 @end ignore
13059 @tindex drange
13060 The @code{drange} function returns a set (an interval or a vector
13061 of intervals and/or numbers; @pxref{Set Operations}) that describes
13062 the set of possible values of its argument. If the argument is
13063 a variable or a function with a declaration, the range is copied
13064 from the declaration. Otherwise, the possible signs of the
13065 expression are determined using a method similar to @code{dpos},
13066 etc., and a suitable set like @samp{[0 .. inf]} is returned. If
13067 the expression is not provably real, the @code{drange} function
13068 remains unevaluated.
13069
13070 @ignore
13071 @starindex
13072 @end ignore
13073 @tindex dscalar
13074 The @code{dscalar} function returns 1 if its argument is provably
13075 scalar, or 0 if its argument is provably non-scalar. It is left
13076 unevaluated if this cannot be determined. (If Matrix mode or Scalar
13077 mode is in effect, this function returns 1 or 0, respectively,
13078 if it has no other information.) When Calc interprets a condition
13079 (say, in a rewrite rule) it considers an unevaluated formula to be
13080 ``false.'' Thus, @samp{dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a} is
13081 provably scalar, and @samp{!dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a}
13082 is provably non-scalar; both are ``false'' if there is insufficient
13083 information to tell.
13084
13085 @node Display Modes, Language Modes, Declarations, Mode Settings
13086 @section Display Modes
13087
13088 @noindent
13089 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with the
13090 @kbd{d} prefix. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) and @kbd{d b}
13091 (@code{calc-line-breaking}) commands are described elsewhere;
13092 @pxref{Stack Basics} and @pxref{Normal Language Modes}, respectively.
13093 Display formats for vectors and matrices are also covered elsewhere;
13094 @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
13095
13096 One thing all display modes have in common is their treatment of the
13097 @kbd{H} prefix. This prefix causes any mode command that would normally
13098 refresh the stack to leave the stack display alone. The word ``Dirty''
13099 will appear in the mode line when Calc thinks the stack display may not
13100 reflect the latest mode settings.
13101
13102 @kindex d @key{RET}
13103 @pindex calc-refresh-top
13104 The @kbd{d @key{RET}} (@code{calc-refresh-top}) command reformats the
13105 top stack entry according to all the current modes. Positive prefix
13106 arguments reformat the top @var{n} entries; negative prefix arguments
13107 reformat the specified entry, and a prefix of zero is equivalent to
13108 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}), which reformats the entire stack.
13109 For example, @kbd{H d s M-2 d @key{RET}} changes to scientific notation
13110 but reformats only the top two stack entries in the new mode.
13111
13112 The @kbd{I} prefix has another effect on the display modes. The mode
13113 is set only temporarily; the top stack entry is reformatted according
13114 to that mode, then the original mode setting is restored. In other
13115 words, @kbd{I d s} is equivalent to @kbd{H d s d @key{RET} H d (@var{old mode})}.
13116
13117 @menu
13118 * Radix Modes::
13119 * Grouping Digits::
13120 * Float Formats::
13121 * Complex Formats::
13122 * Fraction Formats::
13123 * HMS Formats::
13124 * Date Formats::
13125 * Truncating the Stack::
13126 * Justification::
13127 * Labels::
13128 @end menu
13129
13130 @node Radix Modes, Grouping Digits, Display Modes, Display Modes
13131 @subsection Radix Modes
13132
13133 @noindent
13134 @cindex Radix display
13135 @cindex Non-decimal numbers
13136 @cindex Decimal and non-decimal numbers
13137 Calc normally displays numbers in decimal (@dfn{base-10} or @dfn{radix-10})
13138 notation. Calc can actually display in any radix from two (binary) to 36.
13139 When the radix is above 10, the letters @code{A} to @code{Z} are used as
13140 digits. When entering such a number, letter keys are interpreted as
13141 potential digits rather than terminating numeric entry mode.
13142
13143 @kindex d 2
13144 @kindex d 8
13145 @kindex d 6
13146 @kindex d 0
13147 @cindex Hexadecimal integers
13148 @cindex Octal integers
13149 The key sequences @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, @kbd{d 6}, and @kbd{d 0} select
13150 binary, octal, hexadecimal, and decimal as the current display radix,
13151 respectively. Numbers can always be entered in any radix, though the
13152 current radix is used as a default if you press @kbd{#} without any initial
13153 digits. A number entered without a @kbd{#} is @emph{always} interpreted
13154 as decimal.
13155
13156 @kindex d r
13157 @pindex calc-radix
13158 To set the radix generally, use @kbd{d r} (@code{calc-radix}) and enter
13159 an integer from 2 to 36. You can specify the radix as a numeric prefix
13160 argument; otherwise you will be prompted for it.
13161
13162 @kindex d z
13163 @pindex calc-leading-zeros
13164 @cindex Leading zeros
13165 Integers normally are displayed with however many digits are necessary to
13166 represent the integer and no more. The @kbd{d z} (@code{calc-leading-zeros})
13167 command causes integers to be padded out with leading zeros according to the
13168 current binary word size. (@xref{Binary Functions}, for a discussion of
13169 word size.) If the absolute value of the word size is @expr{w}, all integers
13170 are displayed with at least enough digits to represent
13171 @texline @math{2^w-1}
13172 @infoline @expr{(2^w)-1}
13173 in the current radix. (Larger integers will still be displayed in their
13174 entirety.)
13175
13176 @node Grouping Digits, Float Formats, Radix Modes, Display Modes
13177 @subsection Grouping Digits
13178
13179 @noindent
13180 @kindex d g
13181 @pindex calc-group-digits
13182 @cindex Grouping digits
13183 @cindex Digit grouping
13184 Long numbers can be hard to read if they have too many digits. For
13185 example, the factorial of 30 is 33 digits long! Press @kbd{d g}
13186 (@code{calc-group-digits}) to enable @dfn{Grouping} mode, in which digits
13187 are displayed in clumps of 3 or 4 (depending on the current radix)
13188 separated by commas.
13189
13190 The @kbd{d g} command toggles grouping on and off.
13191 With a numeric prefix of 0, this command displays the current state of
13192 the grouping flag; with an argument of minus one it disables grouping;
13193 with a positive argument @expr{N} it enables grouping on every @expr{N}
13194 digits. For floating-point numbers, grouping normally occurs only
13195 before the decimal point. A negative prefix argument @expr{-N} enables
13196 grouping every @expr{N} digits both before and after the decimal point.
13197
13198 @kindex d ,
13199 @pindex calc-group-char
13200 The @kbd{d ,} (@code{calc-group-char}) command allows you to choose any
13201 character as the grouping separator. The default is the comma character.
13202 If you find it difficult to read vectors of large integers grouped with
13203 commas, you may wish to use spaces or some other character instead.
13204 This command takes the next character you type, whatever it is, and
13205 uses it as the digit separator. As a special case, @kbd{d , \} selects
13206 @samp{\,} (@TeX{}'s thin-space symbol) as the digit separator.
13207
13208 Please note that grouped numbers will not generally be parsed correctly
13209 if re-read in textual form, say by the use of @kbd{C-x * y} and @kbd{C-x * g}.
13210 (@xref{Kill and Yank}, for details on these commands.) One exception is
13211 the @samp{\,} separator, which doesn't interfere with parsing because it
13212 is ignored by @TeX{} language mode.
13213
13214 @node Float Formats, Complex Formats, Grouping Digits, Display Modes
13215 @subsection Float Formats
13216
13217 @noindent
13218 Floating-point quantities are normally displayed in standard decimal
13219 form, with scientific notation used if the exponent is especially high
13220 or low. All significant digits are normally displayed. The commands
13221 in this section allow you to choose among several alternative display
13222 formats for floats.
13223
13224 @kindex d n
13225 @pindex calc-normal-notation
13226 The @kbd{d n} (@code{calc-normal-notation}) command selects the normal
13227 display format. All significant figures in a number are displayed.
13228 With a positive numeric prefix, numbers are rounded if necessary to
13229 that number of significant digits. With a negative numerix prefix,
13230 the specified number of significant digits less than the current
13231 precision is used. (Thus @kbd{C-u -2 d n} displays 10 digits if the
13232 current precision is 12.)
13233
13234 @kindex d f
13235 @pindex calc-fix-notation
13236 The @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation}) command selects fixed-point
13237 notation. The numeric argument is the number of digits after the
13238 decimal point, zero or more. This format will relax into scientific
13239 notation if a nonzero number would otherwise have been rounded all the
13240 way to zero. Specifying a negative number of digits is the same as
13241 for a positive number, except that small nonzero numbers will be rounded
13242 to zero rather than switching to scientific notation.
13243
13244 @kindex d s
13245 @pindex calc-sci-notation
13246 @cindex Scientific notation, display of
13247 The @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}) command selects scientific
13248 notation. A positive argument sets the number of significant figures
13249 displayed, of which one will be before and the rest after the decimal
13250 point. A negative argument works the same as for @kbd{d n} format.
13251 The default is to display all significant digits.
13252
13253 @kindex d e
13254 @pindex calc-eng-notation
13255 @cindex Engineering notation, display of
13256 The @kbd{d e} (@code{calc-eng-notation}) command selects engineering
13257 notation. This is similar to scientific notation except that the
13258 exponent is rounded down to a multiple of three, with from one to three
13259 digits before the decimal point. An optional numeric prefix sets the
13260 number of significant digits to display, as for @kbd{d s}.
13261
13262 It is important to distinguish between the current @emph{precision} and
13263 the current @emph{display format}. After the commands @kbd{C-u 10 p}
13264 and @kbd{C-u 6 d n} the Calculator computes all results to ten
13265 significant figures but displays only six. (In fact, intermediate
13266 calculations are often carried to one or two more significant figures,
13267 but values placed on the stack will be rounded down to ten figures.)
13268 Numbers are never actually rounded to the display precision for storage,
13269 except by commands like @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-x * y} which operate on the
13270 actual displayed text in the Calculator buffer.
13271
13272 @kindex d .
13273 @pindex calc-point-char
13274 The @kbd{d .} (@code{calc-point-char}) command selects the character used
13275 as a decimal point. Normally this is a period; users in some countries
13276 may wish to change this to a comma. Note that this is only a display
13277 style; on entry, periods must always be used to denote floating-point
13278 numbers, and commas to separate elements in a list.
13279
13280 @node Complex Formats, Fraction Formats, Float Formats, Display Modes
13281 @subsection Complex Formats
13282
13283 @noindent
13284 @kindex d c
13285 @pindex calc-complex-notation
13286 There are three supported notations for complex numbers in rectangular
13287 form. The default is as a pair of real numbers enclosed in parentheses
13288 and separated by a comma: @samp{(a,b)}. The @kbd{d c}
13289 (@code{calc-complex-notation}) command selects this style.
13290
13291 @kindex d i
13292 @pindex calc-i-notation
13293 @kindex d j
13294 @pindex calc-j-notation
13295 The other notations are @kbd{d i} (@code{calc-i-notation}), in which
13296 numbers are displayed in @samp{a+bi} form, and @kbd{d j}
13297 (@code{calc-j-notation}) which displays the form @samp{a+bj} preferred
13298 in some disciplines.
13299
13300 @cindex @code{i} variable
13301 @vindex i
13302 Complex numbers are normally entered in @samp{(a,b)} format.
13303 If you enter @samp{2+3i} as an algebraic formula, it will be stored as
13304 the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i}. However, if you use @kbd{=} to evaluate
13305 this formula and you have not changed the variable @samp{i}, the @samp{i}
13306 will be interpreted as @samp{(0,1)} and the formula will be simplified
13307 to @samp{(2,3)}. Other commands (like @code{calc-sin}) will @emph{not}
13308 interpret the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i} as a complex number.
13309 @xref{Variables}, under ``special constants.''
13310
13311 @node Fraction Formats, HMS Formats, Complex Formats, Display Modes
13312 @subsection Fraction Formats
13313
13314 @noindent
13315 @kindex d o
13316 @pindex calc-over-notation
13317 Display of fractional numbers is controlled by the @kbd{d o}
13318 (@code{calc-over-notation}) command. By default, a number like
13319 eight thirds is displayed in the form @samp{8:3}. The @kbd{d o} command
13320 prompts for a one- or two-character format. If you give one character,
13321 that character is used as the fraction separator. Common separators are
13322 @samp{:} and @samp{/}. (During input of numbers, the @kbd{:} key must be
13323 used regardless of the display format; in particular, the @kbd{/} is used
13324 for RPN-style division, @emph{not} for entering fractions.)
13325
13326 If you give two characters, fractions use ``integer-plus-fractional-part''
13327 notation. For example, the format @samp{+/} would display eight thirds
13328 as @samp{2+2/3}. If two colons are present in a number being entered,
13329 the number is interpreted in this form (so that the entries @kbd{2:2:3}
13330 and @kbd{8:3} are equivalent).
13331
13332 It is also possible to follow the one- or two-character format with
13333 a number. For example: @samp{:10} or @samp{+/3}. In this case,
13334 Calc adjusts all fractions that are displayed to have the specified
13335 denominator, if possible. Otherwise it adjusts the denominator to
13336 be a multiple of the specified value. For example, in @samp{:6} mode
13337 the fraction @expr{1:6} will be unaffected, but @expr{2:3} will be
13338 displayed as @expr{4:6}, @expr{1:2} will be displayed as @expr{3:6},
13339 and @expr{1:8} will be displayed as @expr{3:24}. Integers are also
13340 affected by this mode: 3 is displayed as @expr{18:6}. Note that the
13341 format @samp{:1} writes fractions the same as @samp{:}, but it writes
13342 integers as @expr{n:1}.
13343
13344 The fraction format does not affect the way fractions or integers are
13345 stored, only the way they appear on the screen. The fraction format
13346 never affects floats.
13347
13348 @node HMS Formats, Date Formats, Fraction Formats, Display Modes
13349 @subsection HMS Formats
13350
13351 @noindent
13352 @kindex d h
13353 @pindex calc-hms-notation
13354 The @kbd{d h} (@code{calc-hms-notation}) command controls the display of
13355 HMS (hours-minutes-seconds) forms. It prompts for a string which
13356 consists basically of an ``hours'' marker, optional punctuation, a
13357 ``minutes'' marker, more optional punctuation, and a ``seconds'' marker.
13358 Punctuation is zero or more spaces, commas, or semicolons. The hours
13359 marker is one or more non-punctuation characters. The minutes and
13360 seconds markers must be single non-punctuation characters.
13361
13362 The default HMS format is @samp{@@ ' "}, producing HMS values of the form
13363 @samp{23@@ 30' 15.75"}. The format @samp{deg, ms} would display this same
13364 value as @samp{23deg, 30m15.75s}. During numeric entry, the @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}
13365 keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{@@} regardless of display format.
13366 The @kbd{m} and @kbd{s} keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{'} and
13367 @kbd{"}, respectively, but only if an @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}) has
13368 already been typed; otherwise, they have their usual meanings
13369 (@kbd{m-} prefix and @kbd{s-} prefix). Thus, @kbd{5 "}, @kbd{0 @@ 5 "}, and
13370 @kbd{0 h 5 s} are some of the ways to enter the quantity ``five seconds.''
13371 The @kbd{'} key is recognized as ``minutes'' only if @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or
13372 @kbd{o}) has already been pressed; otherwise it means to switch to algebraic
13373 entry.
13374
13375 @node Date Formats, Truncating the Stack, HMS Formats, Display Modes
13376 @subsection Date Formats
13377
13378 @noindent
13379 @kindex d d
13380 @pindex calc-date-notation
13381 The @kbd{d d} (@code{calc-date-notation}) command controls the display
13382 of date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). It prompts for a string which
13383 contains letters that represent the various parts of a date and time.
13384 To show which parts should be omitted when the form represents a pure
13385 date with no time, parts of the string can be enclosed in @samp{< >}
13386 marks. If you don't include @samp{< >} markers in the format, Calc
13387 guesses at which parts, if any, should be omitted when formatting
13388 pure dates.
13389
13390 The default format is: @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY}.
13391 An example string in this format is @samp{3:32pm Wed Jan 9, 1991}.
13392 If you enter a blank format string, this default format is
13393 reestablished.
13394
13395 Calc uses @samp{< >} notation for nameless functions as well as for
13396 dates. @xref{Specifying Operators}. To avoid confusion with nameless
13397 functions, your date formats should avoid using the @samp{#} character.
13398
13399 @menu
13400 * Date Formatting Codes::
13401 * Free-Form Dates::
13402 * Standard Date Formats::
13403 @end menu
13404
13405 @node Date Formatting Codes, Free-Form Dates, Date Formats, Date Formats
13406 @subsubsection Date Formatting Codes
13407
13408 @noindent
13409 When displaying a date, the current date format is used. All
13410 characters except for letters and @samp{<} and @samp{>} are
13411 copied literally when dates are formatted. The portion between
13412 @samp{< >} markers is omitted for pure dates, or included for
13413 date/time forms. Letters are interpreted according to the table
13414 below.
13415
13416 When dates are read in during algebraic entry, Calc first tries to
13417 match the input string to the current format either with or without
13418 the time part. The punctuation characters (including spaces) must
13419 match exactly; letter fields must correspond to suitable text in
13420 the input. If this doesn't work, Calc checks if the input is a
13421 simple number; if so, the number is interpreted as a number of days
13422 since Jan 1, 1 AD. Otherwise, Calc tries a much more relaxed and
13423 flexible algorithm which is described in the next section.
13424
13425 Weekday names are ignored during reading.
13426
13427 Two-digit year numbers are interpreted as lying in the range
13428 from 1941 to 2039. Years outside that range are always
13429 entered and displayed in full. Year numbers with a leading
13430 @samp{+} sign are always interpreted exactly, allowing the
13431 entry and display of the years 1 through 99 AD.
13432
13433 Here is a complete list of the formatting codes for dates:
13434
13435 @table @asis
13436 @item Y
13437 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13438 @item YY
13439 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``07'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13440 @item BY
13441 Year: ``91'' for 1991, `` 7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13442 @item YYY
13443 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``23'' for 23 AD.
13444 @item YYYY
13445 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13446 @item aa
13447 Year: ``ad'' or blank.
13448 @item AA
13449 Year: ``AD'' or blank.
13450 @item aaa
13451 Year: ``ad '' or blank. (Note trailing space.)
13452 @item AAA
13453 Year: ``AD '' or blank.
13454 @item aaaa
13455 Year: ``a.d.'' or blank.
13456 @item AAAA
13457 Year: ``A.D.'' or blank.
13458 @item bb
13459 Year: ``bc'' or blank.
13460 @item BB
13461 Year: ``BC'' or blank.
13462 @item bbb
13463 Year: `` bc'' or blank. (Note leading space.)
13464 @item BBB
13465 Year: `` BC'' or blank.
13466 @item bbbb
13467 Year: ``b.c.'' or blank.
13468 @item BBBB
13469 Year: ``B.C.'' or blank.
13470 @item M
13471 Month: ``8'' for August.
13472 @item MM
13473 Month: ``08'' for August.
13474 @item BM
13475 Month: `` 8'' for August.
13476 @item MMM
13477 Month: ``AUG'' for August.
13478 @item Mmm
13479 Month: ``Aug'' for August.
13480 @item mmm
13481 Month: ``aug'' for August.
13482 @item MMMM
13483 Month: ``AUGUST'' for August.
13484 @item Mmmm
13485 Month: ``August'' for August.
13486 @item D
13487 Day: ``7'' for 7th day of month.
13488 @item DD
13489 Day: ``07'' for 7th day of month.
13490 @item BD
13491 Day: `` 7'' for 7th day of month.
13492 @item W
13493 Weekday: ``0'' for Sunday, ``6'' for Saturday.
13494 @item WWW
13495 Weekday: ``SUN'' for Sunday.
13496 @item Www
13497 Weekday: ``Sun'' for Sunday.
13498 @item www
13499 Weekday: ``sun'' for Sunday.
13500 @item WWWW
13501 Weekday: ``SUNDAY'' for Sunday.
13502 @item Wwww
13503 Weekday: ``Sunday'' for Sunday.
13504 @item d
13505 Day of year: ``34'' for Feb. 3.
13506 @item ddd
13507 Day of year: ``034'' for Feb. 3.
13508 @item bdd
13509 Day of year: `` 34'' for Feb. 3.
13510 @item h
13511 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13512 @item hh
13513 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13514 @item bh
13515 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13516 @item H
13517 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13518 @item HH
13519 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13520 @item BH
13521 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13522 @item p
13523 AM/PM: ``a'' or ``p''.
13524 @item P
13525 AM/PM: ``A'' or ``P''.
13526 @item pp
13527 AM/PM: ``am'' or ``pm''.
13528 @item PP
13529 AM/PM: ``AM'' or ``PM''.
13530 @item pppp
13531 AM/PM: ``a.m.'' or ``p.m.''.
13532 @item PPPP
13533 AM/PM: ``A.M.'' or ``P.M.''.
13534 @item m
13535 Minutes: ``7'' for 7.
13536 @item mm
13537 Minutes: ``07'' for 7.
13538 @item bm
13539 Minutes: `` 7'' for 7.
13540 @item s
13541 Seconds: ``7'' for 7; ``7.23'' for 7.23.
13542 @item ss
13543 Seconds: ``07'' for 7; ``07.23'' for 7.23.
13544 @item bs
13545 Seconds: `` 7'' for 7; `` 7.23'' for 7.23.
13546 @item SS
13547 Optional seconds: ``07'' for 7; blank for 0.
13548 @item BS
13549 Optional seconds: `` 7'' for 7; blank for 0.
13550 @item N
13551 Numeric date/time: ``726842.25'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13552 @item n
13553 Numeric date: ``726842'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13554 @item J
13555 Julian date/time: ``2448265.75'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13556 @item j
13557 Julian date: ``2448266'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13558 @item U
13559 Unix time: ``663400800'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13560 @item X
13561 Brackets suppression. An ``X'' at the front of the format
13562 causes the surrounding @w{@samp{< >}} delimiters to be omitted
13563 when formatting dates. Note that the brackets are still
13564 required for algebraic entry.
13565 @end table
13566
13567 If ``SS'' or ``BS'' (optional seconds) is preceded by a colon, the
13568 colon is also omitted if the seconds part is zero.
13569
13570 If ``bb,'' ``bbb'' or ``bbbb'' or their upper-case equivalents
13571 appear in the format, then negative year numbers are displayed
13572 without a minus sign. Note that ``aa'' and ``bb'' are mutually
13573 exclusive. Some typical usages would be @samp{YYYY AABB};
13574 @samp{AAAYYYYBBB}; @samp{YYYYBBB}.
13575
13576 The formats ``YY,'' ``YYYY,'' ``MM,'' ``DD,'' ``ddd,'' ``hh,'' ``HH,''
13577 ``mm,'' ``ss,'' and ``SS'' actually match any number of digits during
13578 reading unless several of these codes are strung together with no
13579 punctuation in between, in which case the input must have exactly as
13580 many digits as there are letters in the format.
13581
13582 The ``j,'' ``J,'' and ``U'' formats do not make any time zone
13583 adjustment. They effectively use @samp{julian(x,0)} and
13584 @samp{unixtime(x,0)} to make the conversion; @pxref{Date Arithmetic}.
13585
13586 @node Free-Form Dates, Standard Date Formats, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats
13587 @subsubsection Free-Form Dates
13588
13589 @noindent
13590 When reading a date form during algebraic entry, Calc falls back
13591 on the algorithm described here if the input does not exactly
13592 match the current date format. This algorithm generally
13593 ``does the right thing'' and you don't have to worry about it,
13594 but it is described here in full detail for the curious.
13595
13596 Calc does not distinguish between upper- and lower-case letters
13597 while interpreting dates.
13598
13599 First, the time portion, if present, is located somewhere in the
13600 text and then removed. The remaining text is then interpreted as
13601 the date.
13602
13603 A time is of the form @samp{hh:mm:ss}, possibly with the seconds
13604 part omitted and possibly with an AM/PM indicator added to indicate
13605 12-hour time. If the AM/PM is present, the minutes may also be
13606 omitted. The AM/PM part may be any of the words @samp{am},
13607 @samp{pm}, @samp{noon}, or @samp{midnight}; each of these may be
13608 abbreviated to one letter, and the alternate forms @samp{a.m.},
13609 @samp{p.m.}, and @samp{mid} are also understood. Obviously
13610 @samp{noon} and @samp{midnight} are allowed only on 12:00:00.
13611 The words @samp{noon}, @samp{mid}, and @samp{midnight} are also
13612 recognized with no number attached.
13613
13614 If there is no AM/PM indicator, the time is interpreted in 24-hour
13615 format.
13616
13617 To read the date portion, all words and numbers are isolated
13618 from the string; other characters are ignored. All words must
13619 be either month names or day-of-week names (the latter of which
13620 are ignored). Names can be written in full or as three-letter
13621 abbreviations.
13622
13623 Large numbers, or numbers with @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
13624 are interpreted as years. If one of the other numbers is
13625 greater than 12, then that must be the day and the remaining
13626 number in the input is therefore the month. Otherwise, Calc
13627 assumes the month, day and year are in the same order that they
13628 appear in the current date format. If the year is omitted, the
13629 current year is taken from the system clock.
13630
13631 If there are too many or too few numbers, or any unrecognizable
13632 words, then the input is rejected.
13633
13634 If there are any large numbers (of five digits or more) other than
13635 the year, they are ignored on the assumption that they are something
13636 like Julian dates that were included along with the traditional
13637 date components when the date was formatted.
13638
13639 One of the words @samp{ad}, @samp{a.d.}, @samp{bc}, or @samp{b.c.}
13640 may optionally be used; the latter two are equivalent to a
13641 minus sign on the year value.
13642
13643 If you always enter a four-digit year, and use a name instead
13644 of a number for the month, there is no danger of ambiguity.
13645
13646 @node Standard Date Formats, , Free-Form Dates, Date Formats
13647 @subsubsection Standard Date Formats
13648
13649 @noindent
13650 There are actually ten standard date formats, numbered 0 through 9.
13651 Entering a blank line at the @kbd{d d} command's prompt gives
13652 you format number 1, Calc's usual format. You can enter any digit
13653 to select the other formats.
13654
13655 To create your own standard date formats, give a numeric prefix
13656 argument from 0 to 9 to the @w{@kbd{d d}} command. The format you
13657 enter will be recorded as the new standard format of that
13658 number, as well as becoming the new current date format.
13659 You can save your formats permanently with the @w{@kbd{m m}}
13660 command (@pxref{Mode Settings}).
13661
13662 @table @asis
13663 @item 0
13664 @samp{N} (Numerical format)
13665 @item 1
13666 @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY} (American format)
13667 @item 2
13668 @samp{D Mmm YYYY<, h:mm:SS>} (European format)
13669 @item 3
13670 @samp{Www Mmm BD< hh:mm:ss> YYYY} (Unix written date format)
13671 @item 4
13672 @samp{M/D/Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American slashed format)
13673 @item 5
13674 @samp{D.M.Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dotted format)
13675 @item 6
13676 @samp{M-D-Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American dashed format)
13677 @item 7
13678 @samp{D-M-Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dashed format)
13679 @item 8
13680 @samp{j<, h:mm:ss>} (Julian day plus time)
13681 @item 9
13682 @samp{YYddd< hh:mm:ss>} (Year-day format)
13683 @end table
13684
13685 @node Truncating the Stack, Justification, Date Formats, Display Modes
13686 @subsection Truncating the Stack
13687
13688 @noindent
13689 @kindex d t
13690 @pindex calc-truncate-stack
13691 @cindex Truncating the stack
13692 @cindex Narrowing the stack
13693 The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack}) command moves the @samp{.}@:
13694 line that marks the top-of-stack up or down in the Calculator buffer.
13695 The number right above that line is considered to the be at the top of
13696 the stack. Any numbers below that line are ``hidden'' from all stack
13697 operations (although still visible to the user). This is similar to the
13698 Emacs ``narrowing'' feature, except that the values below the @samp{.}
13699 are @emph{visible}, just temporarily frozen. This feature allows you to
13700 keep several independent calculations running at once in different parts
13701 of the stack, or to apply a certain command to an element buried deep in
13702 the stack.
13703
13704 Pressing @kbd{d t} by itself moves the @samp{.} to the line the cursor
13705 is on. Thus, this line and all those below it become hidden. To un-hide
13706 these lines, move down to the end of the buffer and press @w{@kbd{d t}}.
13707 With a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{n}, @kbd{d t} hides the
13708 bottom @expr{n} values in the buffer. With a negative argument, it hides
13709 all but the top @expr{n} values. With an argument of zero, it hides zero
13710 values, i.e., moves the @samp{.} all the way down to the bottom.
13711
13712 @kindex d [
13713 @pindex calc-truncate-up
13714 @kindex d ]
13715 @pindex calc-truncate-down
13716 The @kbd{d [} (@code{calc-truncate-up}) and @kbd{d ]}
13717 (@code{calc-truncate-down}) commands move the @samp{.} up or down one
13718 line at a time (or several lines with a prefix argument).
13719
13720 @node Justification, Labels, Truncating the Stack, Display Modes
13721 @subsection Justification
13722
13723 @noindent
13724 @kindex d <
13725 @pindex calc-left-justify
13726 @kindex d =
13727 @pindex calc-center-justify
13728 @kindex d >
13729 @pindex calc-right-justify
13730 Values on the stack are normally left-justified in the window. You can
13731 control this arrangement by typing @kbd{d <} (@code{calc-left-justify}),
13732 @kbd{d >} (@code{calc-right-justify}), or @kbd{d =}
13733 (@code{calc-center-justify}). For example, in Right-Justification mode,
13734 stack entries are displayed flush-right against the right edge of the
13735 window.
13736
13737 If you change the width of the Calculator window you may have to type
13738 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}) to re-align right-justified or centered
13739 text.
13740
13741 Right-justification is especially useful together with fixed-point
13742 notation (see @code{d f}; @code{calc-fix-notation}). With these modes
13743 together, the decimal points on numbers will always line up.
13744
13745 With a numeric prefix argument, the justification commands give you
13746 a little extra control over the display. The argument specifies the
13747 horizontal ``origin'' of a display line. It is also possible to
13748 specify a maximum line width using the @kbd{d b} command (@pxref{Normal
13749 Language Modes}). For reference, the precise rules for formatting and
13750 breaking lines are given below. Notice that the interaction between
13751 origin and line width is slightly different in each justification
13752 mode.
13753
13754 In Left-Justified mode, the line is indented by a number of spaces
13755 given by the origin (default zero). If the result is longer than the
13756 maximum line width, if given, or too wide to fit in the Calc window
13757 otherwise, then it is broken into lines which will fit; each broken
13758 line is indented to the origin.
13759
13760 In Right-Justified mode, lines are shifted right so that the rightmost
13761 character is just before the origin, or just before the current
13762 window width if no origin was specified. If the line is too long
13763 for this, then it is broken; the current line width is used, if
13764 specified, or else the origin is used as a width if that is
13765 specified, or else the line is broken to fit in the window.
13766
13767 In Centering mode, the origin is the column number of the center of
13768 each stack entry. If a line width is specified, lines will not be
13769 allowed to go past that width; Calc will either indent less or
13770 break the lines if necessary. If no origin is specified, half the
13771 line width or Calc window width is used.
13772
13773 Note that, in each case, if line numbering is enabled the display
13774 is indented an additional four spaces to make room for the line
13775 number. The width of the line number is taken into account when
13776 positioning according to the current Calc window width, but not
13777 when positioning by explicit origins and widths. In the latter
13778 case, the display is formatted as specified, and then uniformly
13779 shifted over four spaces to fit the line numbers.
13780
13781 @node Labels, , Justification, Display Modes
13782 @subsection Labels
13783
13784 @noindent
13785 @kindex d @{
13786 @pindex calc-left-label
13787 The @kbd{d @{} (@code{calc-left-label}) command prompts for a string,
13788 then displays that string to the left of every stack entry. If the
13789 entries are left-justified (@pxref{Justification}), then they will
13790 appear immediately after the label (unless you specified an origin
13791 greater than the length of the label). If the entries are centered
13792 or right-justified, the label appears on the far left and does not
13793 affect the horizontal position of the stack entry.
13794
13795 Give a blank string (with @kbd{d @{ @key{RET}}) to turn the label off.
13796
13797 @kindex d @}
13798 @pindex calc-right-label
13799 The @kbd{d @}} (@code{calc-right-label}) command similarly adds a
13800 label on the righthand side. It does not affect positioning of
13801 the stack entries unless they are right-justified. Also, if both
13802 a line width and an origin are given in Right-Justified mode, the
13803 stack entry is justified to the origin and the righthand label is
13804 justified to the line width.
13805
13806 One application of labels would be to add equation numbers to
13807 formulas you are manipulating in Calc and then copying into a
13808 document (possibly using Embedded mode). The equations would
13809 typically be centered, and the equation numbers would be on the
13810 left or right as you prefer.
13811
13812 @node Language Modes, Modes Variable, Display Modes, Mode Settings
13813 @section Language Modes
13814
13815 @noindent
13816 The commands in this section change Calc to use a different notation for
13817 entry and display of formulas, corresponding to the conventions of some
13818 other common language such as Pascal or La@TeX{}. Objects displayed on the
13819 stack or yanked from the Calculator to an editing buffer will be formatted
13820 in the current language; objects entered in algebraic entry or yanked from
13821 another buffer will be interpreted according to the current language.
13822
13823 The current language has no effect on things written to or read from the
13824 trail buffer, nor does it affect numeric entry. Only algebraic entry is
13825 affected. You can make even algebraic entry ignore the current language
13826 and use the standard notation by giving a numeric prefix, e.g., @kbd{C-u '}.
13827
13828 For example, suppose the formula @samp{2*a[1] + atan(a[2])} occurs in a C
13829 program; elsewhere in the program you need the derivatives of this formula
13830 with respect to @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}. First, type @kbd{d C}
13831 to switch to C notation. Now use @code{C-u C-x * g} to grab the formula
13832 into the Calculator, @kbd{a d a[1] @key{RET}} to differentiate with respect
13833 to the first variable, and @kbd{C-x * y} to yank the formula for the derivative
13834 back into your C program. Press @kbd{U} to undo the differentiation and
13835 repeat with @kbd{a d a[2] @key{RET}} for the other derivative.
13836
13837 Without being switched into C mode first, Calc would have misinterpreted
13838 the brackets in @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}, would not have known that
13839 @code{atan} was equivalent to Calc's built-in @code{arctan} function,
13840 and would have written the formula back with notations (like implicit
13841 multiplication) which would not have been valid for a C program.
13842
13843 As another example, suppose you are maintaining a C program and a La@TeX{}
13844 document, each of which needs a copy of the same formula. You can grab the
13845 formula from the program in C mode, switch to La@TeX{} mode, and yank the
13846 formula into the document in La@TeX{} math-mode format.
13847
13848 Language modes are selected by typing the letter @kbd{d} followed by a
13849 shifted letter key.
13850
13851 @menu
13852 * Normal Language Modes::
13853 * C FORTRAN Pascal::
13854 * TeX and LaTeX Language Modes::
13855 * Eqn Language Mode::
13856 * Yacas Language Mode::
13857 * Maxima Language Mode::
13858 * Giac Language Mode::
13859 * Mathematica Language Mode::
13860 * Maple Language Mode::
13861 * Compositions::
13862 * Syntax Tables::
13863 @end menu
13864
13865 @node Normal Language Modes, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes, Language Modes
13866 @subsection Normal Language Modes
13867
13868 @noindent
13869 @kindex d N
13870 @pindex calc-normal-language
13871 The @kbd{d N} (@code{calc-normal-language}) command selects the usual
13872 notation for Calc formulas, as described in the rest of this manual.
13873 Matrices are displayed in a multi-line tabular format, but all other
13874 objects are written in linear form, as they would be typed from the
13875 keyboard.
13876
13877 @kindex d O
13878 @pindex calc-flat-language
13879 @cindex Matrix display
13880 The @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) command selects a language
13881 identical with the normal one, except that matrices are written in
13882 one-line form along with everything else. In some applications this
13883 form may be more suitable for yanking data into other buffers.
13884
13885 @kindex d b
13886 @pindex calc-line-breaking
13887 @cindex Line breaking
13888 @cindex Breaking up long lines
13889 Even in one-line mode, long formulas or vectors will still be split
13890 across multiple lines if they exceed the width of the Calculator window.
13891 The @kbd{d b} (@code{calc-line-breaking}) command turns this line-breaking
13892 feature on and off. (It works independently of the current language.)
13893 If you give a numeric prefix argument of five or greater to the @kbd{d b}
13894 command, that argument will specify the line width used when breaking
13895 long lines.
13896
13897 @kindex d B
13898 @pindex calc-big-language
13899 The @kbd{d B} (@code{calc-big-language}) command selects a language
13900 which uses textual approximations to various mathematical notations,
13901 such as powers, quotients, and square roots:
13902
13903 @example
13904 ____________
13905 | a + 1 2
13906 | ----- + c
13907 \| b
13908 @end example
13909
13910 @noindent
13911 in place of @samp{sqrt((a+1)/b + c^2)}.
13912
13913 Subscripts like @samp{a_i} are displayed as actual subscripts in Big
13914 mode. Double subscripts, @samp{a_i_j} (@samp{subscr(subscr(a, i), j)})
13915 are displayed as @samp{a} with subscripts separated by commas:
13916 @samp{i, j}. They must still be entered in the usual underscore
13917 notation.
13918
13919 One slight ambiguity of Big notation is that
13920
13921 @example
13922 3
13923 - -
13924 4
13925 @end example
13926
13927 @noindent
13928 can represent either the negative rational number @expr{-3:4}, or the
13929 actual expression @samp{-(3/4)}; but the latter formula would normally
13930 never be displayed because it would immediately be evaluated to
13931 @expr{-3:4} or @expr{-0.75}, so this ambiguity is not a problem in
13932 typical use.
13933
13934 Non-decimal numbers are displayed with subscripts. Thus there is no
13935 way to tell the difference between @samp{16#C2} and @samp{C2_16},
13936 though generally you will know which interpretation is correct.
13937 Logarithms @samp{log(x,b)} and @samp{log10(x)} also use subscripts
13938 in Big mode.
13939
13940 In Big mode, stack entries often take up several lines. To aid
13941 readability, stack entries are separated by a blank line in this mode.
13942 You may find it useful to expand the Calc window's height using
13943 @kbd{C-x ^} (@code{enlarge-window}) or to make the Calc window the only
13944 one on the screen with @kbd{C-x 1} (@code{delete-other-windows}).
13945
13946 Long lines are currently not rearranged to fit the window width in
13947 Big mode, so you may need to use the @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys
13948 to scroll across a wide formula. For really big formulas, you may
13949 even need to use @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} to scroll up and down.
13950
13951 @kindex d U
13952 @pindex calc-unformatted-language
13953 The @kbd{d U} (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) command altogether disables
13954 the use of operator notation in formulas. In this mode, the formula
13955 shown above would be displayed:
13956
13957 @example
13958 sqrt(add(div(add(a, 1), b), pow(c, 2)))
13959 @end example
13960
13961 These four modes differ only in display format, not in the format
13962 expected for algebraic entry. The standard Calc operators work in
13963 all four modes, and unformatted notation works in any language mode
13964 (except that Mathematica mode expects square brackets instead of
13965 parentheses).
13966
13967 @node C FORTRAN Pascal, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Normal Language Modes, Language Modes
13968 @subsection C, FORTRAN, and Pascal Modes
13969
13970 @noindent
13971 @kindex d C
13972 @pindex calc-c-language
13973 @cindex C language
13974 The @kbd{d C} (@code{calc-c-language}) command selects the conventions
13975 of the C language for display and entry of formulas. This differs from
13976 the normal language mode in a variety of (mostly minor) ways. In
13977 particular, C language operators and operator precedences are used in
13978 place of Calc's usual ones. For example, @samp{a^b} means @samp{xor(a,b)}
13979 in C mode; a value raised to a power is written as a function call,
13980 @samp{pow(a,b)}.
13981
13982 In C mode, vectors and matrices use curly braces instead of brackets.
13983 Octal and hexadecimal values are written with leading @samp{0} or @samp{0x}
13984 rather than using the @samp{#} symbol. Array subscripting is
13985 translated into @code{subscr} calls, so that @samp{a[i]} in C
13986 mode is the same as @samp{a_i} in Normal mode. Assignments
13987 turn into the @code{assign} function, which Calc normally displays
13988 using the @samp{:=} symbol.
13989
13990 The variables @code{pi} and @code{e} would be displayed @samp{pi}
13991 and @samp{e} in Normal mode, but in C mode they are displayed as
13992 @samp{M_PI} and @samp{M_E}, corresponding to the names of constants
13993 typically provided in the @file{<math.h>} header. Functions whose
13994 names are different in C are translated automatically for entry and
13995 display purposes. For example, entering @samp{asin(x)} will push the
13996 formula @samp{arcsin(x)} onto the stack; this formula will be displayed
13997 as @samp{asin(x)} as long as C mode is in effect.
13998
13999 @kindex d P
14000 @pindex calc-pascal-language
14001 @cindex Pascal language
14002 The @kbd{d P} (@code{calc-pascal-language}) command selects Pascal
14003 conventions. Like C mode, Pascal mode interprets array brackets and uses
14004 a different table of operators. Hexadecimal numbers are entered and
14005 displayed with a preceding dollar sign. (Thus the regular meaning of
14006 @kbd{$2} during algebraic entry does not work in Pascal mode, though
14007 @kbd{$} (and @kbd{$$}, etc.) not followed by digits works the same as
14008 always.) No special provisions are made for other non-decimal numbers,
14009 vectors, and so on, since there is no universally accepted standard way
14010 of handling these in Pascal.
14011
14012 @kindex d F
14013 @pindex calc-fortran-language
14014 @cindex FORTRAN language
14015 The @kbd{d F} (@code{calc-fortran-language}) command selects FORTRAN
14016 conventions. Various function names are transformed into FORTRAN
14017 equivalents. Vectors are written as @samp{/1, 2, 3/}, and may be
14018 entered this way or using square brackets. Since FORTRAN uses round
14019 parentheses for both function calls and array subscripts, Calc displays
14020 both in the same way; @samp{a(i)} is interpreted as a function call
14021 upon reading, and subscripts must be entered as @samp{subscr(a, i)}.
14022 If the variable @code{a} has been declared to have type
14023 @code{vector} or @code{matrix}, however, then @samp{a(i)} will be
14024 parsed as a subscript. (@xref{Declarations}.) Usually it doesn't
14025 matter, though; if you enter the subscript expression @samp{a(i)} and
14026 Calc interprets it as a function call, you'll never know the difference
14027 unless you switch to another language mode or replace @code{a} with an
14028 actual vector (or unless @code{a} happens to be the name of a built-in
14029 function!).
14030
14031 Underscores are allowed in variable and function names in all of these
14032 language modes. The underscore here is equivalent to the @samp{#} in
14033 Normal mode, or to hyphens in the underlying Emacs Lisp variable names.
14034
14035 FORTRAN and Pascal modes normally do not adjust the case of letters in
14036 formulas. Most built-in Calc names use lower-case letters. If you use a
14037 positive numeric prefix argument with @kbd{d P} or @kbd{d F}, these
14038 modes will use upper-case letters exclusively for display, and will
14039 convert to lower-case on input. With a negative prefix, these modes
14040 convert to lower-case for display and input.
14041
14042 @node TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Eqn Language Mode, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes
14043 @subsection @TeX{} and La@TeX{} Language Modes
14044
14045 @noindent
14046 @kindex d T
14047 @pindex calc-tex-language
14048 @cindex TeX language
14049 @kindex d L
14050 @pindex calc-latex-language
14051 @cindex LaTeX language
14052 The @kbd{d T} (@code{calc-tex-language}) command selects the conventions
14053 of ``math mode'' in Donald Knuth's @TeX{} typesetting language,
14054 and the @kbd{d L} (@code{calc-latex-language}) command selects the
14055 conventions of ``math mode'' in La@TeX{}, a typesetting language that
14056 uses @TeX{} as its formatting engine. Calc's La@TeX{} language mode can
14057 read any formula that the @TeX{} language mode can, although La@TeX{}
14058 mode may display it differently.
14059
14060 Formulas are entered and displayed in the appropriate notation;
14061 @texline @math{\sin(a/b)}
14062 @infoline @expr{sin(a/b)}
14063 will appear as @samp{\sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)} in @TeX{} mode and
14064 @samp{\sin\left(\frac@{a@}@{b@}\right)} in La@TeX{} mode.
14065 Math formulas are often enclosed by @samp{$ $} signs in @TeX{} and
14066 La@TeX{}; these should be omitted when interfacing with Calc. To Calc,
14067 the @samp{$} sign has the same meaning it always does in algebraic
14068 formulas (a reference to an existing entry on the stack).
14069
14070 Complex numbers are displayed as in @samp{3 + 4i}. Fractions and
14071 quotients are written using @code{\over} in @TeX{} mode (as in
14072 @code{@{a \over b@}}) and @code{\frac} in La@TeX{} mode (as in
14073 @code{\frac@{a@}@{b@}}); binomial coefficients are written with
14074 @code{\choose} in @TeX{} mode (as in @code{@{a \choose b@}}) and
14075 @code{\binom} in La@TeX{} mode (as in @code{\binom@{a@}@{b@}}).
14076 Interval forms are written with @code{\ldots}, and error forms are
14077 written with @code{\pm}. Absolute values are written as in
14078 @samp{|x + 1|}, and the floor and ceiling functions are written with
14079 @code{\lfloor}, @code{\rfloor}, etc. The words @code{\left} and
14080 @code{\right} are ignored when reading formulas in @TeX{} and La@TeX{}
14081 modes. Both @code{inf} and @code{uinf} are written as @code{\infty};
14082 when read, @code{\infty} always translates to @code{inf}.
14083
14084 Function calls are written the usual way, with the function name followed
14085 by the arguments in parentheses. However, functions for which @TeX{}
14086 and La@TeX{} have special names (like @code{\sin}) will use curly braces
14087 instead of parentheses for very simple arguments. During input, curly
14088 braces and parentheses work equally well for grouping, but when the
14089 document is formatted the curly braces will be invisible. Thus the
14090 printed result is
14091 @texline @math{\sin{2 x}}
14092 @infoline @expr{sin 2x}
14093 but
14094 @texline @math{\sin(2 + x)}.
14095 @infoline @expr{sin(2 + x)}.
14096
14097 Function and variable names not treated specially by @TeX{} and La@TeX{}
14098 are simply written out as-is, which will cause them to come out in
14099 italic letters in the printed document. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or
14100 @kbd{d L} with a positive numeric prefix argument, names of more than
14101 one character will instead be enclosed in a protective commands that
14102 will prevent them from being typeset in the math italics; they will be
14103 written @samp{\hbox@{@var{name}@}} in @TeX{} mode and
14104 @samp{\text@{@var{name}@}} in La@TeX{} mode. The
14105 @samp{\hbox@{ @}} and @samp{\text@{ @}} notations are ignored during
14106 reading. If you use a negative prefix argument, such function names are
14107 written @samp{\@var{name}}, and function names that begin with @code{\} during
14108 reading have the @code{\} removed. (Note that in this mode, long
14109 variable names are still written with @code{\hbox} or @code{\text}.
14110 However, you can always make an actual variable name like @code{\bar} in
14111 any @TeX{} mode.)
14112
14113 During reading, text of the form @samp{\matrix@{ ...@: @}} is replaced
14114 by @samp{[ ...@: ]}. The same also applies to @code{\pmatrix} and
14115 @code{\bmatrix}. In La@TeX{} mode this also applies to
14116 @samp{\begin@{matrix@} ... \end@{matrix@}},
14117 @samp{\begin@{bmatrix@} ... \end@{bmatrix@}},
14118 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} ... \end@{pmatrix@}}, as well as
14119 @samp{\begin@{smallmatrix@} ... \end@{smallmatrix@}}.
14120 The symbol @samp{&} is interpreted as a comma,
14121 and the symbols @samp{\cr} and @samp{\\} are interpreted as semicolons.
14122 During output, matrices are displayed in @samp{\matrix@{ a & b \\ c & d@}}
14123 format in @TeX{} mode and in
14124 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} a & b \\ c & d \end@{pmatrix@}} format in
14125 La@TeX{} mode; you may need to edit this afterwards to change to your
14126 preferred matrix form. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or @kbd{d L} with an
14127 argument of 2 or -2, then matrices will be displayed in two-dimensional
14128 form, such as
14129
14130 @example
14131 \begin@{pmatrix@}
14132 a & b \\
14133 c & d
14134 \end@{pmatrix@}
14135 @end example
14136
14137 @noindent
14138 This may be convenient for isolated matrices, but could lead to
14139 expressions being displayed like
14140
14141 @example
14142 \begin@{pmatrix@} \times x
14143 a & b \\
14144 c & d
14145 \end@{pmatrix@}
14146 @end example
14147
14148 @noindent
14149 While this wouldn't bother Calc, it is incorrect La@TeX{}.
14150 (Similarly for @TeX{}.)
14151
14152 Accents like @code{\tilde} and @code{\bar} translate into function
14153 calls internally (@samp{tilde(x)}, @samp{bar(x)}). The @code{\underline}
14154 sequence is treated as an accent. The @code{\vec} accent corresponds
14155 to the function name @code{Vec}, because @code{vec} is the name of
14156 a built-in Calc function. The following table shows the accents
14157 in Calc, @TeX{}, La@TeX{} and @dfn{eqn} (described in the next section):
14158
14159 @ignore
14160 @iftex
14161 @begingroup
14162 @let@calcindexershow=@calcindexernoshow @c Suppress marginal notes
14163 @let@calcindexersh=@calcindexernoshow
14164 @end iftex
14165 @starindex
14166 @end ignore
14167 @tindex acute
14168 @ignore
14169 @starindex
14170 @end ignore
14171 @tindex Acute
14172 @ignore
14173 @starindex
14174 @end ignore
14175 @tindex bar
14176 @ignore
14177 @starindex
14178 @end ignore
14179 @tindex Bar
14180 @ignore
14181 @starindex
14182 @end ignore
14183 @tindex breve
14184 @ignore
14185 @starindex
14186 @end ignore
14187 @tindex Breve
14188 @ignore
14189 @starindex
14190 @end ignore
14191 @tindex check
14192 @ignore
14193 @starindex
14194 @end ignore
14195 @tindex Check
14196 @ignore
14197 @starindex
14198 @end ignore
14199 @tindex dddot
14200 @ignore
14201 @starindex
14202 @end ignore
14203 @tindex ddddot
14204 @ignore
14205 @starindex
14206 @end ignore
14207 @tindex dot
14208 @ignore
14209 @starindex
14210 @end ignore
14211 @tindex Dot
14212 @ignore
14213 @starindex
14214 @end ignore
14215 @tindex dotdot
14216 @ignore
14217 @starindex
14218 @end ignore
14219 @tindex DotDot
14220 @ignore
14221 @starindex
14222 @end ignore
14223 @tindex dyad
14224 @ignore
14225 @starindex
14226 @end ignore
14227 @tindex grave
14228 @ignore
14229 @starindex
14230 @end ignore
14231 @tindex Grave
14232 @ignore
14233 @starindex
14234 @end ignore
14235 @tindex hat
14236 @ignore
14237 @starindex
14238 @end ignore
14239 @tindex Hat
14240 @ignore
14241 @starindex
14242 @end ignore
14243 @tindex Prime
14244 @ignore
14245 @starindex
14246 @end ignore
14247 @tindex tilde
14248 @ignore
14249 @starindex
14250 @end ignore
14251 @tindex Tilde
14252 @ignore
14253 @starindex
14254 @end ignore
14255 @tindex under
14256 @ignore
14257 @starindex
14258 @end ignore
14259 @tindex Vec
14260 @ignore
14261 @starindex
14262 @end ignore
14263 @tindex VEC
14264 @ignore
14265 @iftex
14266 @endgroup
14267 @end iftex
14268 @end ignore
14269 @example
14270 Calc TeX LaTeX eqn
14271 ---- --- ----- ---
14272 acute \acute \acute
14273 Acute \Acute
14274 bar \bar \bar bar
14275 Bar \Bar
14276 breve \breve \breve
14277 Breve \Breve
14278 check \check \check
14279 Check \Check
14280 dddot \dddot
14281 ddddot \ddddot
14282 dot \dot \dot dot
14283 Dot \Dot
14284 dotdot \ddot \ddot dotdot
14285 DotDot \Ddot
14286 dyad dyad
14287 grave \grave \grave
14288 Grave \Grave
14289 hat \hat \hat hat
14290 Hat \Hat
14291 Prime prime
14292 tilde \tilde \tilde tilde
14293 Tilde \Tilde
14294 under \underline \underline under
14295 Vec \vec \vec vec
14296 VEC \Vec
14297 @end example
14298
14299 The @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operator appears as a @code{\to} symbol:
14300 @samp{@{@var{a} \to @var{b}@}}. @TeX{} defines @code{\to} as an
14301 alias for @code{\rightarrow}. However, if the @samp{=>} is the
14302 top-level expression being formatted, a slightly different notation
14303 is used: @samp{\evalto @var{a} \to @var{b}}. The @code{\evalto}
14304 word is ignored by Calc's input routines, and is undefined in @TeX{}.
14305 You will typically want to include one of the following definitions
14306 at the top of a @TeX{} file that uses @code{\evalto}:
14307
14308 @example
14309 \def\evalto@{@}
14310 \def\evalto#1\to@{@}
14311 @end example
14312
14313 The first definition formats evaluates-to operators in the usual
14314 way. The second causes only the @var{b} part to appear in the
14315 printed document; the @var{a} part and the arrow are hidden.
14316 Another definition you may wish to use is @samp{\let\to=\Rightarrow}
14317 which causes @code{\to} to appear more like Calc's @samp{=>} symbol.
14318 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a discussion of @code{evalto}.
14319
14320 The complete set of @TeX{} control sequences that are ignored during
14321 reading is:
14322
14323 @example
14324 \hbox \mbox \text \left \right
14325 \, \> \: \; \! \quad \qquad \hfil \hfill
14326 \displaystyle \textstyle \dsize \tsize
14327 \scriptstyle \scriptscriptstyle \ssize \ssize
14328 \rm \bf \it \sl \roman \bold \italic \slanted
14329 \cal \mit \Cal \Bbb \frak \goth
14330 \evalto
14331 @end example
14332
14333 Note that, because these symbols are ignored, reading a @TeX{} or
14334 La@TeX{} formula into Calc and writing it back out may lose spacing and
14335 font information.
14336
14337 Also, the ``discretionary multiplication sign'' @samp{\*} is read
14338 the same as @samp{*}.
14339
14340 @ifnottex
14341 The @TeX{} version of this manual includes some printed examples at the
14342 end of this section.
14343 @end ifnottex
14344 @iftex
14345 Here are some examples of how various Calc formulas are formatted in @TeX{}:
14346
14347 @example
14348 @group
14349 sin(a^2 / b_i)
14350 \sin\left( {a^2 \over b_i} \right)
14351 @end group
14352 @end example
14353 @tex
14354 $$ \sin\left( a^2 \over b_i \right) $$
14355 @end tex
14356 @sp 1
14357
14358 @example
14359 @group
14360 [(3, 4), 3:4, 3 +/- 4, [3 .. inf)]
14361 [3 + 4i, @{3 \over 4@}, 3 \pm 4, [3 \ldots \infty)]
14362 @end group
14363 @end example
14364 @tex
14365 \turnoffactive
14366 $$ [3 + 4i, {3 \over 4}, 3 \pm 4, [ 3 \ldots \infty)] $$
14367 @end tex
14368 @sp 1
14369
14370 @example
14371 @group
14372 [abs(a), abs(a / b), floor(a), ceil(a / b)]
14373 [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14374 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil]
14375 @end group
14376 @end example
14377 @tex
14378 $$ [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14379 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil] $$
14380 @end tex
14381 @sp 1
14382
14383 @example
14384 @group
14385 [sin(a), sin(2 a), sin(2 + a), sin(a / b)]
14386 [\sin@{a@}, \sin@{2 a@}, \sin(2 + a),
14387 \sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)]
14388 @end group
14389 @end example
14390 @tex
14391 \turnoffactive
14392 $$ [\sin{a}, \sin{2 a}, \sin(2 + a), \sin\left( {a \over b} \right)] $$
14393 @end tex
14394 @sp 2
14395
14396 First with plain @kbd{d T}, then with @kbd{C-u d T}, then finally with
14397 @kbd{C-u - d T} (using the example definition
14398 @samp{\def\foo#1@{\tilde F(#1)@}}:
14399
14400 @example
14401 @group
14402 [f(a), foo(bar), sin(pi)]
14403 [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}]
14404 [f(a), \hbox@{foo@}(\hbox@{bar@}), \sin@{\pi@}]
14405 [f(a), \foo@{\hbox@{bar@}@}, \sin@{\pi@}]
14406 @end group
14407 @end example
14408 @tex
14409 $$ [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}] $$
14410 $$ [f(a), \hbox{foo}(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14411 $$ [f(a), \tilde F(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14412 @end tex
14413 @sp 2
14414
14415 First with @samp{\def\evalto@{@}}, then with @samp{\def\evalto#1\to@{@}}:
14416
14417 @example
14418 @group
14419 2 + 3 => 5
14420 \evalto 2 + 3 \to 5
14421 @end group
14422 @end example
14423 @tex
14424 \turnoffactive
14425 $$ 2 + 3 \to 5 $$
14426 $$ 5 $$
14427 @end tex
14428 @sp 2
14429
14430 First with standard @code{\to}, then with @samp{\let\to\Rightarrow}:
14431
14432 @example
14433 @group
14434 [2 + 3 => 5, a / 2 => (b + c) / 2]
14435 [@{2 + 3 \to 5@}, @{@{a \over 2@} \to @{b + c \over 2@}@}]
14436 @end group
14437 @end example
14438 @tex
14439 \turnoffactive
14440 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$
14441 {\let\to\Rightarrow
14442 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$}
14443 @end tex
14444 @sp 2
14445
14446 Matrices normally, then changing @code{\matrix} to @code{\pmatrix}:
14447
14448 @example
14449 @group
14450 [ [ a / b, 0 ], [ 0, 2^(x + 1) ] ]
14451 \matrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14452 \pmatrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14453 @end group
14454 @end example
14455 @tex
14456 \turnoffactive
14457 $$ \matrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14458 $$ \pmatrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14459 @end tex
14460 @sp 2
14461 @end iftex
14462
14463 @node Eqn Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Language Modes
14464 @subsection Eqn Language Mode
14465
14466 @noindent
14467 @kindex d E
14468 @pindex calc-eqn-language
14469 @dfn{Eqn} is another popular formatter for math formulas. It is
14470 designed for use with the TROFF text formatter, and comes standard
14471 with many versions of Unix. The @kbd{d E} (@code{calc-eqn-language})
14472 command selects @dfn{eqn} notation.
14473
14474 The @dfn{eqn} language's main idiosyncrasy is that whitespace plays
14475 a significant part in the parsing of the language. For example,
14476 @samp{sqrt x+1 + y} treats @samp{x+1} as the argument of the
14477 @code{sqrt} operator. @dfn{Eqn} also understands more conventional
14478 grouping using curly braces: @samp{sqrt@{x+1@} + y}. Braces are
14479 required only when the argument contains spaces.
14480
14481 In Calc's @dfn{eqn} mode, however, curly braces are required to
14482 delimit arguments of operators like @code{sqrt}. The first of the
14483 above examples would treat only the @samp{x} as the argument of
14484 @code{sqrt}, and in fact @samp{sin x+1} would be interpreted as
14485 @samp{sin * x + 1}, because @code{sin} is not a special operator
14486 in the @dfn{eqn} language. If you always surround the argument
14487 with curly braces, Calc will never misunderstand.
14488
14489 Calc also understands parentheses as grouping characters. Another
14490 peculiarity of @dfn{eqn}'s syntax makes it advisable to separate
14491 words with spaces from any surrounding characters that aren't curly
14492 braces, so Calc writes @samp{sin ( x + y )} in @dfn{eqn} mode.
14493 (The spaces around @code{sin} are important to make @dfn{eqn}
14494 recognize that @code{sin} should be typeset in a roman font, and
14495 the spaces around @code{x} and @code{y} are a good idea just in
14496 case the @dfn{eqn} document has defined special meanings for these
14497 names, too.)
14498
14499 Powers and subscripts are written with the @code{sub} and @code{sup}
14500 operators, respectively. Note that the caret symbol @samp{^} is
14501 treated the same as a space in @dfn{eqn} mode, as is the @samp{~}
14502 symbol (these are used to introduce spaces of various widths into
14503 the typeset output of @dfn{eqn}).
14504
14505 As in La@TeX{} mode, Calc's formatter omits parentheses around the
14506 arguments of functions like @code{ln} and @code{sin} if they are
14507 ``simple-looking''; in this case Calc surrounds the argument with
14508 braces, separated by a @samp{~} from the function name: @samp{sin~@{x@}}.
14509
14510 Font change codes (like @samp{roman @var{x}}) and positioning codes
14511 (like @samp{~} and @samp{down @var{n} @var{x}}) are ignored by the
14512 @dfn{eqn} reader. Also ignored are the words @code{left}, @code{right},
14513 @code{mark}, and @code{lineup}. Quotation marks in @dfn{eqn} mode input
14514 are treated the same as curly braces: @samp{sqrt "1+x"} is equivalent to
14515 @samp{sqrt @{1+x@}}; this is only an approximation to the true meaning
14516 of quotes in @dfn{eqn}, but it is good enough for most uses.
14517
14518 Accent codes (@samp{@var{x} dot}) are handled by treating them as
14519 function calls (@samp{dot(@var{x})}) internally.
14520 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a table of these accent
14521 functions. The @code{prime} accent is treated specially if it occurs on
14522 a variable or function name: @samp{f prime prime @w{( x prime )}} is
14523 stored internally as @samp{f'@w{'}(x')}. For example, taking the
14524 derivative of @samp{f(2 x)} with @kbd{a d x} will produce @samp{2 f'(2
14525 x)}, which @dfn{eqn} mode will display as @samp{2 f prime ( 2 x )}.
14526
14527 Assignments are written with the @samp{<-} (left-arrow) symbol,
14528 and @code{evalto} operators are written with @samp{->} or
14529 @samp{evalto ... ->} (@pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a discussion
14530 of this). The regular Calc symbols @samp{:=} and @samp{=>} are also
14531 recognized for these operators during reading.
14532
14533 Vectors in @dfn{eqn} mode use regular Calc square brackets, but
14534 matrices are formatted as @samp{matrix @{ ccol @{ a above b @} ... @}}.
14535 The words @code{lcol} and @code{rcol} are recognized as synonyms
14536 for @code{ccol} during input, and are generated instead of @code{ccol}
14537 if the matrix justification mode so specifies.
14538
14539 @node Yacas Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Eqn Language Mode, Language Modes
14540 @subsection Yacas Language Mode
14541
14542 @noindent
14543 @kindex d Y
14544 @pindex calc-yacas-language
14545 @cindex Yacas language
14546 The @kbd{d Y} (@code{calc-yacas-language}) command selects the
14547 conventions of Yacas, a free computer algebra system. While the
14548 operators and functions in Yacas are similar to those of Calc, the names
14549 of built-in functions in Yacas are capitalized. The Calc formula
14550 @samp{sin(2 x)}, for example, is entered and displayed @samp{Sin(2 x)}
14551 in Yacas mode, and `@samp{arcsin(x^2)} is @samp{ArcSin(x^2)} in Yacas
14552 mode. Complex numbers are written are written @samp{3 + 4 I}.
14553 The standard special constants are written @code{Pi}, @code{E},
14554 @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio} and @code{Gamma}. @code{Infinity}
14555 represents both @code{inf} and @code{uinf}, and @code{Undefined}
14556 represents @code{nan}.
14557
14558 Certain operators on functions, such as @code{D} for differentiation
14559 and @code{Integrate} for integration, take a prefix form in Yacas. For
14560 example, the derivative of @w{@samp{e^x sin(x)}} can be computed with
14561 @w{@samp{D(x) Exp(x)*Sin(x)}}.
14562
14563 Other notable differences between Yacas and standard Calc expressions
14564 are that vectors and matrices use curly braces in Yacas, and subscripts
14565 use square brackets. If, for example, @samp{A} represents the list
14566 @samp{@{a,2,c,4@}}, then @samp{A[3]} would equal @samp{c}.
14567
14568
14569 @node Maxima Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, Language Modes
14570 @subsection Maxima Language Mode
14571
14572 @noindent
14573 @kindex d X
14574 @pindex calc-maxima-language
14575 @cindex Maxima language
14576 The @kbd{d X} (@code{calc-maxima-language}) command selects the
14577 conventions of Maxima, another free computer algebra system. The
14578 function names in Maxima are similar, but not always identical, to Calc.
14579 For example, instead of @samp{arcsin(x)}, Maxima will use
14580 @samp{asin(x)}. Complex numbers are written @samp{3 + 4 %i}. The
14581 standard special constants are written @code{%pi}, @code{%e},
14582 @code{%i}, @code{%phi} and @code{%gamma}. In Maxima, @code{inf} means
14583 the same as in Calc, but @code{infinity} represents Calc's @code{uinf}.
14584
14585 Underscores as well as percent signs are allowed in function and
14586 variable names in Maxima mode. The underscore again is equivalent to
14587 the @samp{#} in Normal mode, and the percent sign is equivalent to
14588 @samp{o'o}.
14589
14590 Maxima uses square brackets for lists and vectors, and matrices are
14591 written as calls to the function @code{matrix}, given the row vectors of
14592 the matrix as arguments. Square brackets are also used as subscripts.
14593
14594 @node Giac Language Mode, Mathematica Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Language Modes
14595 @subsection Giac Language Mode
14596
14597 @noindent
14598 @kindex d A
14599 @pindex calc-giac-language
14600 @cindex Giac language
14601 The @kbd{d A} (@code{calc-giac-language}) command selects the
14602 conventions of Giac, another free computer algebra system. The function
14603 names in Giac are similar to Maxima. Complex numbers are written
14604 @samp{3 + 4 i}. The standard special constants in Giac are the same as
14605 in Calc, except that @code{infinity} represents both Calc's @code{inf}
14606 and @code{uinf}.
14607
14608 Underscores are allowed in function and variable names in Giac mode.
14609 Brackets are used for subscripts. In Giac, indexing of lists begins at
14610 0, instead of 1 as in Calc. So if @samp{A} represents the list
14611 @samp{[a,2,c,4]}, then @samp{A[2]} would equal @samp{c}. In general,
14612 @samp{A[n]} in Giac mode corresponds to @samp{A_(n+1)} in Normal mode.
14613
14614 The Giac interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} has no surrounding brackets;
14615 Calc reads @samp{2 .. 3} as the closed interval @samp{[2 .. 3]} and
14616 writes any kind of interval as @samp{2 .. 3}. This means you cannot see
14617 the difference between an open and a closed interval while in Giac mode.
14618
14619 @node Mathematica Language Mode, Maple Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Language Modes
14620 @subsection Mathematica Language Mode
14621
14622 @noindent
14623 @kindex d M
14624 @pindex calc-mathematica-language
14625 @cindex Mathematica language
14626 The @kbd{d M} (@code{calc-mathematica-language}) command selects the
14627 conventions of Mathematica. Notable differences in Mathematica mode
14628 are that the names of built-in functions are capitalized, and function
14629 calls use square brackets instead of parentheses. Thus the Calc
14630 formula @samp{sin(2 x)} is entered and displayed @w{@samp{Sin[2 x]}} in
14631 Mathematica mode.
14632
14633 Vectors and matrices use curly braces in Mathematica. Complex numbers
14634 are written @samp{3 + 4 I}. The standard special constants in Calc are
14635 written @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio}, @code{EulerGamma},
14636 @code{Infinity}, @code{ComplexInfinity}, and @code{Indeterminate} in
14637 Mathematica mode.
14638 Non-decimal numbers are written, e.g., @samp{16^^7fff}. Floating-point
14639 numbers in scientific notation are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14640 Subscripts use double square brackets: @samp{a[[i]]}.
14641
14642 @node Maple Language Mode, Compositions, Mathematica Language Mode, Language Modes
14643 @subsection Maple Language Mode
14644
14645 @noindent
14646 @kindex d W
14647 @pindex calc-maple-language
14648 @cindex Maple language
14649 The @kbd{d W} (@code{calc-maple-language}) command selects the
14650 conventions of Maple.
14651
14652 Maple's language is much like C. Underscores are allowed in symbol
14653 names; square brackets are used for subscripts; explicit @samp{*}s for
14654 multiplications are required. Use either @samp{^} or @samp{**} to
14655 denote powers.
14656
14657 Maple uses square brackets for lists and curly braces for sets. Calc
14658 interprets both notations as vectors, and displays vectors with square
14659 brackets. This means Maple sets will be converted to lists when they
14660 pass through Calc. As a special case, matrices are written as calls
14661 to the function @code{matrix}, given a list of lists as the argument,
14662 and can be read in this form or with all-capitals @code{MATRIX}.
14663
14664 The Maple interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} is like Giac's interval
14665 notation, and is handled the same by Calc.
14666
14667 Maple writes complex numbers as @samp{3 + 4*I}. Its special constants
14668 are @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, and @code{infinity} (all three of
14669 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} display as @code{infinity}).
14670 Floating-point numbers are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14671
14672 Among things not currently handled by Calc's Maple mode are the
14673 various quote symbols, procedures and functional operators, and
14674 inert (@samp{&}) operators.
14675
14676 @node Compositions, Syntax Tables, Maple Language Mode, Language Modes
14677 @subsection Compositions
14678
14679 @noindent
14680 @cindex Compositions
14681 There are several @dfn{composition functions} which allow you to get
14682 displays in a variety of formats similar to those in Big language
14683 mode. Most of these functions do not evaluate to anything; they are
14684 placeholders which are left in symbolic form by Calc's evaluator but
14685 are recognized by Calc's display formatting routines.
14686
14687 Two of these, @code{string} and @code{bstring}, are described elsewhere.
14688 @xref{Strings}. For example, @samp{string("ABC")} is displayed as
14689 @samp{ABC}. When viewed on the stack it will be indistinguishable from
14690 the variable @code{ABC}, but internally it will be stored as
14691 @samp{string([65, 66, 67])} and can still be manipulated this way; for
14692 example, the selection and vector commands @kbd{j 1 v v j u} would
14693 select the vector portion of this object and reverse the elements, then
14694 deselect to reveal a string whose characters had been reversed.
14695
14696 The composition functions do the same thing in all language modes
14697 (although their components will of course be formatted in the current
14698 language mode). The one exception is Unformatted mode (@kbd{d U}),
14699 which does not give the composition functions any special treatment.
14700 The functions are discussed here because of their relationship to
14701 the language modes.
14702
14703 @menu
14704 * Composition Basics::
14705 * Horizontal Compositions::
14706 * Vertical Compositions::
14707 * Other Compositions::
14708 * Information about Compositions::
14709 * User-Defined Compositions::
14710 @end menu
14711
14712 @node Composition Basics, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions, Compositions
14713 @subsubsection Composition Basics
14714
14715 @noindent
14716 Compositions are generally formed by stacking formulas together
14717 horizontally or vertically in various ways. Those formulas are
14718 themselves compositions. @TeX{} users will find this analogous
14719 to @TeX{}'s ``boxes.'' Each multi-line composition has a
14720 @dfn{baseline}; horizontal compositions use the baselines to
14721 decide how formulas should be positioned relative to one another.
14722 For example, in the Big mode formula
14723
14724 @example
14725 @group
14726 2
14727 a + b
14728 17 + ------
14729 c
14730 @end group
14731 @end example
14732
14733 @noindent
14734 the second term of the sum is four lines tall and has line three as
14735 its baseline. Thus when the term is combined with 17, line three
14736 is placed on the same level as the baseline of 17.
14737
14738 @tex
14739 \bigskip
14740 @end tex
14741
14742 Another important composition concept is @dfn{precedence}. This is
14743 an integer that represents the binding strength of various operators.
14744 For example, @samp{*} has higher precedence (195) than @samp{+} (180),
14745 which means that @samp{(a * b) + c} will be formatted without the
14746 parentheses, but @samp{a * (b + c)} will keep the parentheses.
14747
14748 The operator table used by normal and Big language modes has the
14749 following precedences:
14750
14751 @example
14752 _ 1200 @r{(subscripts)}
14753 % 1100 @r{(as in n}%@r{)}
14754 ! 1000 @r{(as in }!@r{n)}
14755 mod 400
14756 +/- 300
14757 !! 210 @r{(as in n}!!@r{)}
14758 ! 210 @r{(as in n}!@r{)}
14759 ^ 200
14760 - 197 @r{(as in }-@r{n)}
14761 * 195 @r{(or implicit multiplication)}
14762 / % \ 190
14763 + - 180 @r{(as in a}+@r{b)}
14764 | 170
14765 < = 160 @r{(and other relations)}
14766 && 110
14767 || 100
14768 ? : 90
14769 !!! 85
14770 &&& 80
14771 ||| 75
14772 := 50
14773 :: 45
14774 => 40
14775 @end example
14776
14777 The general rule is that if an operator with precedence @expr{n}
14778 occurs as an argument to an operator with precedence @expr{m}, then
14779 the argument is enclosed in parentheses if @expr{n < m}. Top-level
14780 expressions and expressions which are function arguments, vector
14781 components, etc., are formatted with precedence zero (so that they
14782 normally never get additional parentheses).
14783
14784 For binary left-associative operators like @samp{+}, the righthand
14785 argument is actually formatted with one-higher precedence than shown
14786 in the table. This makes sure @samp{(a + b) + c} omits the parentheses,
14787 but the unnatural form @samp{a + (b + c)} keeps its parentheses.
14788 Right-associative operators like @samp{^} format the lefthand argument
14789 with one-higher precedence.
14790
14791 @ignore
14792 @starindex
14793 @end ignore
14794 @tindex cprec
14795 The @code{cprec} function formats an expression with an arbitrary
14796 precedence. For example, @samp{cprec(abc, 185)} will combine into
14797 sums and products as follows: @samp{7 + abc}, @samp{7 (abc)} (because
14798 this @code{cprec} form has higher precedence than addition, but lower
14799 precedence than multiplication).
14800
14801 @tex
14802 \bigskip
14803 @end tex
14804
14805 A final composition issue is @dfn{line breaking}. Calc uses two
14806 different strategies for ``flat'' and ``non-flat'' compositions.
14807 A non-flat composition is anything that appears on multiple lines
14808 (not counting line breaking). Examples would be matrices and Big
14809 mode powers and quotients. Non-flat compositions are displayed
14810 exactly as specified. If they come out wider than the current
14811 window, you must use horizontal scrolling (@kbd{<} and @kbd{>}) to
14812 view them.
14813
14814 Flat compositions, on the other hand, will be broken across several
14815 lines if they are too wide to fit the window. Certain points in a
14816 composition are noted internally as @dfn{break points}. Calc's
14817 general strategy is to fill each line as much as possible, then to
14818 move down to the next line starting at the first break point that
14819 didn't fit. However, the line breaker understands the hierarchical
14820 structure of formulas. It will not break an ``inner'' formula if
14821 it can use an earlier break point from an ``outer'' formula instead.
14822 For example, a vector of sums might be formatted as:
14823
14824 @example
14825 @group
14826 [ a + b + c, d + e + f,
14827 g + h + i, j + k + l, m ]
14828 @end group
14829 @end example
14830
14831 @noindent
14832 If the @samp{m} can fit, then so, it seems, could the @samp{g}.
14833 But Calc prefers to break at the comma since the comma is part
14834 of a ``more outer'' formula. Calc would break at a plus sign
14835 only if it had to, say, if the very first sum in the vector had
14836 itself been too large to fit.
14837
14838 Of the composition functions described below, only @code{choriz}
14839 generates break points. The @code{bstring} function (@pxref{Strings})
14840 also generates breakable items: A break point is added after every
14841 space (or group of spaces) except for spaces at the very beginning or
14842 end of the string.
14843
14844 Composition functions themselves count as levels in the formula
14845 hierarchy, so a @code{choriz} that is a component of a larger
14846 @code{choriz} will be less likely to be broken. As a special case,
14847 if a @code{bstring} occurs as a component of a @code{choriz} or
14848 @code{choriz}-like object (such as a vector or a list of arguments
14849 in a function call), then the break points in that @code{bstring}
14850 will be on the same level as the break points of the surrounding
14851 object.
14852
14853 @node Horizontal Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Composition Basics, Compositions
14854 @subsubsection Horizontal Compositions
14855
14856 @noindent
14857 @ignore
14858 @starindex
14859 @end ignore
14860 @tindex choriz
14861 The @code{choriz} function takes a vector of objects and composes
14862 them horizontally. For example, @samp{choriz([17, a b/c, d])} formats
14863 as @w{@samp{17a b / cd}} in Normal language mode, or as
14864
14865 @example
14866 @group
14867 a b
14868 17---d
14869 c
14870 @end group
14871 @end example
14872
14873 @noindent
14874 in Big language mode. This is actually one case of the general
14875 function @samp{choriz(@var{vec}, @var{sep}, @var{prec})}, where
14876 either or both of @var{sep} and @var{prec} may be omitted.
14877 @var{Prec} gives the @dfn{precedence} to use when formatting
14878 each of the components of @var{vec}. The default precedence is
14879 the precedence from the surrounding environment.
14880
14881 @var{Sep} is a string (i.e., a vector of character codes as might
14882 be entered with @code{" "} notation) which should separate components
14883 of the composition. Also, if @var{sep} is given, the line breaker
14884 will allow lines to be broken after each occurrence of @var{sep}.
14885 If @var{sep} is omitted, the composition will not be breakable
14886 (unless any of its component compositions are breakable).
14887
14888 For example, @samp{2 choriz([a, b c, d = e], " + ", 180)} is
14889 formatted as @samp{2 a + b c + (d = e)}. To get the @code{choriz}
14890 to have precedence 180 ``outwards'' as well as ``inwards,''
14891 enclose it in a @code{cprec} form: @samp{2 cprec(choriz(...), 180)}
14892 formats as @samp{2 (a + b c + (d = e))}.
14893
14894 The baseline of a horizontal composition is the same as the
14895 baselines of the component compositions, which are all aligned.
14896
14897 @node Vertical Compositions, Other Compositions, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions
14898 @subsubsection Vertical Compositions
14899
14900 @noindent
14901 @ignore
14902 @starindex
14903 @end ignore
14904 @tindex cvert
14905 The @code{cvert} function makes a vertical composition. Each
14906 component of the vector is centered in a column. The baseline of
14907 the result is by default the top line of the resulting composition.
14908 For example, @samp{f(cvert([a, bb, ccc]), cvert([a^2 + 1, b^2]))}
14909 formats in Big mode as
14910
14911 @example
14912 @group
14913 f( a , 2 )
14914 bb a + 1
14915 ccc 2
14916 b
14917 @end group
14918 @end example
14919
14920 @ignore
14921 @starindex
14922 @end ignore
14923 @tindex cbase
14924 There are several special composition functions that work only as
14925 components of a vertical composition. The @code{cbase} function
14926 controls the baseline of the vertical composition; the baseline
14927 will be the same as the baseline of whatever component is enclosed
14928 in @code{cbase}. Thus @samp{f(cvert([a, cbase(bb), ccc]),
14929 cvert([a^2 + 1, cbase(b^2)]))} displays as
14930
14931 @example
14932 @group
14933 2
14934 a + 1
14935 a 2
14936 f(bb , b )
14937 ccc
14938 @end group
14939 @end example
14940
14941 @ignore
14942 @starindex
14943 @end ignore
14944 @tindex ctbase
14945 @ignore
14946 @starindex
14947 @end ignore
14948 @tindex cbbase
14949 There are also @code{ctbase} and @code{cbbase} functions which
14950 make the baseline of the vertical composition equal to the top
14951 or bottom line (rather than the baseline) of that component.
14952 Thus @samp{cvert([cbase(a / b)]) + cvert([ctbase(a / b)]) +
14953 cvert([cbbase(a / b)])} gives
14954
14955 @example
14956 @group
14957 a
14958 a -
14959 - + a + b
14960 b -
14961 b
14962 @end group
14963 @end example
14964
14965 There should be only one @code{cbase}, @code{ctbase}, or @code{cbbase}
14966 function in a given vertical composition. These functions can also
14967 be written with no arguments: @samp{ctbase()} is a zero-height object
14968 which means the baseline is the top line of the following item, and
14969 @samp{cbbase()} means the baseline is the bottom line of the preceding
14970 item.
14971
14972 @ignore
14973 @starindex
14974 @end ignore
14975 @tindex crule
14976 The @code{crule} function builds a ``rule,'' or horizontal line,
14977 across a vertical composition. By itself @samp{crule()} uses @samp{-}
14978 characters to build the rule. You can specify any other character,
14979 e.g., @samp{crule("=")}. The argument must be a character code or
14980 vector of exactly one character code. It is repeated to match the
14981 width of the widest item in the stack. For example, a quotient
14982 with a thick line is @samp{cvert([a + 1, cbase(crule("=")), b^2])}:
14983
14984 @example
14985 @group
14986 a + 1
14987 =====
14988 2
14989 b
14990 @end group
14991 @end example
14992
14993 @ignore
14994 @starindex
14995 @end ignore
14996 @tindex clvert
14997 @ignore
14998 @starindex
14999 @end ignore
15000 @tindex crvert
15001 Finally, the functions @code{clvert} and @code{crvert} act exactly
15002 like @code{cvert} except that the items are left- or right-justified
15003 in the stack. Thus @samp{clvert([a, bb, ccc]) + crvert([a, bb, ccc])}
15004 gives:
15005
15006 @example
15007 @group
15008 a + a
15009 bb bb
15010 ccc ccc
15011 @end group
15012 @end example
15013
15014 Like @code{choriz}, the vertical compositions accept a second argument
15015 which gives the precedence to use when formatting the components.
15016 Vertical compositions do not support separator strings.
15017
15018 @node Other Compositions, Information about Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Compositions
15019 @subsubsection Other Compositions
15020
15021 @noindent
15022 @ignore
15023 @starindex
15024 @end ignore
15025 @tindex csup
15026 The @code{csup} function builds a superscripted expression. For
15027 example, @samp{csup(a, b)} looks the same as @samp{a^b} does in Big
15028 language mode. This is essentially a horizontal composition of
15029 @samp{a} and @samp{b}, where @samp{b} is shifted up so that its
15030 bottom line is one above the baseline.
15031
15032 @ignore
15033 @starindex
15034 @end ignore
15035 @tindex csub
15036 Likewise, the @code{csub} function builds a subscripted expression.
15037 This shifts @samp{b} down so that its top line is one below the
15038 bottom line of @samp{a} (note that this is not quite analogous to
15039 @code{csup}). Other arrangements can be obtained by using
15040 @code{choriz} and @code{cvert} directly.
15041
15042 @ignore
15043 @starindex
15044 @end ignore
15045 @tindex cflat
15046 The @code{cflat} function formats its argument in ``flat'' mode,
15047 as obtained by @samp{d O}, if the current language mode is normal
15048 or Big. It has no effect in other language modes. For example,
15049 @samp{a^(b/c)} is formatted by Big mode like @samp{csup(a, cflat(b/c))}
15050 to improve its readability.
15051
15052 @ignore
15053 @starindex
15054 @end ignore
15055 @tindex cspace
15056 The @code{cspace} function creates horizontal space. For example,
15057 @samp{cspace(4)} is effectively the same as @samp{string(" ")}.
15058 A second string (i.e., vector of characters) argument is repeated
15059 instead of the space character. For example, @samp{cspace(4, "ab")}
15060 looks like @samp{abababab}. If the second argument is not a string,
15061 it is formatted in the normal way and then several copies of that
15062 are composed together: @samp{cspace(4, a^2)} yields
15063
15064 @example
15065 @group
15066 2 2 2 2
15067 a a a a
15068 @end group
15069 @end example
15070
15071 @noindent
15072 If the number argument is zero, this is a zero-width object.
15073
15074 @ignore
15075 @starindex
15076 @end ignore
15077 @tindex cvspace
15078 The @code{cvspace} function creates vertical space, or a vertical
15079 stack of copies of a certain string or formatted object. The
15080 baseline is the center line of the resulting stack. A numerical
15081 argument of zero will produce an object which contributes zero
15082 height if used in a vertical composition.
15083
15084 @ignore
15085 @starindex
15086 @end ignore
15087 @tindex ctspace
15088 @ignore
15089 @starindex
15090 @end ignore
15091 @tindex cbspace
15092 There are also @code{ctspace} and @code{cbspace} functions which
15093 create vertical space with the baseline the same as the baseline
15094 of the top or bottom copy, respectively, of the second argument.
15095 Thus @samp{cvspace(2, a/b) + ctspace(2, a/b) + cbspace(2, a/b)}
15096 displays as:
15097
15098 @example
15099 @group
15100 a
15101 -
15102 a b
15103 - a a
15104 b + - + -
15105 a b b
15106 - a
15107 b -
15108 b
15109 @end group
15110 @end example
15111
15112 @node Information about Compositions, User-Defined Compositions, Other Compositions, Compositions
15113 @subsubsection Information about Compositions
15114
15115 @noindent
15116 The functions in this section are actual functions; they compose their
15117 arguments according to the current language and other display modes,
15118 then return a certain measurement of the composition as an integer.
15119
15120 @ignore
15121 @starindex
15122 @end ignore
15123 @tindex cwidth
15124 The @code{cwidth} function measures the width, in characters, of a
15125 composition. For example, @samp{cwidth(a + b)} is 5, and
15126 @samp{cwidth(a / b)} is 5 in Normal mode, 1 in Big mode, and 11 in
15127 @TeX{} mode (for @samp{@{a \over b@}}). The argument may involve
15128 the composition functions described in this section.
15129
15130 @ignore
15131 @starindex
15132 @end ignore
15133 @tindex cheight
15134 The @code{cheight} function measures the height of a composition.
15135 This is the total number of lines in the argument's printed form.
15136
15137 @ignore
15138 @starindex
15139 @end ignore
15140 @tindex cascent
15141 @ignore
15142 @starindex
15143 @end ignore
15144 @tindex cdescent
15145 The functions @code{cascent} and @code{cdescent} measure the amount
15146 of the height that is above (and including) the baseline, or below
15147 the baseline, respectively. Thus @samp{cascent(@var{x}) + cdescent(@var{x})}
15148 always equals @samp{cheight(@var{x})}. For a one-line formula like
15149 @samp{a + b}, @code{cascent} returns 1 and @code{cdescent} returns 0.
15150 For @samp{a / b} in Big mode, @code{cascent} returns 2 and @code{cdescent}
15151 returns 1. The only formula for which @code{cascent} will return zero
15152 is @samp{cvspace(0)} or equivalents.
15153
15154 @node User-Defined Compositions, , Information about Compositions, Compositions
15155 @subsubsection User-Defined Compositions
15156
15157 @noindent
15158 @kindex Z C
15159 @pindex calc-user-define-composition
15160 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command lets you
15161 define the display format for any algebraic function. You provide a
15162 formula containing a certain number of argument variables on the stack.
15163 Any time Calc formats a call to the specified function in the current
15164 language mode and with that number of arguments, Calc effectively
15165 replaces the function call with that formula with the arguments
15166 replaced.
15167
15168 Calc builds the default argument list by sorting all the variable names
15169 that appear in the formula into alphabetical order. You can edit this
15170 argument list before pressing @key{RET} if you wish. Any variables in
15171 the formula that do not appear in the argument list will be displayed
15172 literally; any arguments that do not appear in the formula will not
15173 affect the display at all.
15174
15175 You can define formats for built-in functions, for functions you have
15176 defined with @kbd{Z F} (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}), or for functions
15177 which have no definitions but are being used as purely syntactic objects.
15178 You can define different formats for each language mode, and for each
15179 number of arguments, using a succession of @kbd{Z C} commands. When
15180 Calc formats a function call, it first searches for a format defined
15181 for the current language mode (and number of arguments); if there is
15182 none, it uses the format defined for the Normal language mode. If
15183 neither format exists, Calc uses its built-in standard format for that
15184 function (usually just @samp{@var{func}(@var{args})}).
15185
15186 If you execute @kbd{Z C} with the number 0 on the stack instead of a
15187 formula, any defined formats for the function in the current language
15188 mode will be removed. The function will revert to its standard format.
15189
15190 For example, the default format for the binomial coefficient function
15191 @samp{choose(n, m)} in the Big language mode is
15192
15193 @example
15194 @group
15195 n
15196 ( )
15197 m
15198 @end group
15199 @end example
15200
15201 @noindent
15202 You might prefer the notation,
15203
15204 @example
15205 @group
15206 C
15207 n m
15208 @end group
15209 @end example
15210
15211 @noindent
15212 To define this notation, first make sure you are in Big mode,
15213 then put the formula
15214
15215 @smallexample
15216 choriz([cvert([cvspace(1), n]), C, cvert([cvspace(1), m])])
15217 @end smallexample
15218
15219 @noindent
15220 on the stack and type @kbd{Z C}. Answer the first prompt with
15221 @code{choose}. The second prompt will be the default argument list
15222 of @samp{(C m n)}. Edit this list to be @samp{(n m)} and press
15223 @key{RET}. Now, try it out: For example, turn simplification
15224 off with @kbd{m O} and enter @samp{choose(a,b) + choose(7,3)}
15225 as an algebraic entry.
15226
15227 @example
15228 @group
15229 C + C
15230 a b 7 3
15231 @end group
15232 @end example
15233
15234 As another example, let's define the usual notation for Stirling
15235 numbers of the first kind, @samp{stir1(n, m)}. This is just like
15236 the regular format for binomial coefficients but with square brackets
15237 instead of parentheses.
15238
15239 @smallexample
15240 choriz([string("["), cvert([n, cbase(cvspace(1)), m]), string("]")])
15241 @end smallexample
15242
15243 Now type @kbd{Z C stir1 @key{RET}}, edit the argument list to
15244 @samp{(n m)}, and type @key{RET}.
15245
15246 The formula provided to @kbd{Z C} usually will involve composition
15247 functions, but it doesn't have to. Putting the formula @samp{a + b + c}
15248 onto the stack and typing @kbd{Z C foo @key{RET} @key{RET}} would define
15249 the function @samp{foo(x,y,z)} to display like @samp{x + y + z}.
15250 This ``sum'' will act exactly like a real sum for all formatting
15251 purposes (it will be parenthesized the same, and so on). However
15252 it will be computationally unrelated to a sum. For example, the
15253 formula @samp{2 * foo(1, 2, 3)} will display as @samp{2 (1 + 2 + 3)}.
15254 Operator precedences have caused the ``sum'' to be written in
15255 parentheses, but the arguments have not actually been summed.
15256 (Generally a display format like this would be undesirable, since
15257 it can easily be confused with a real sum.)
15258
15259 The special function @code{eval} can be used inside a @kbd{Z C}
15260 composition formula to cause all or part of the formula to be
15261 evaluated at display time. For example, if the formula is
15262 @samp{a + eval(b + c)}, then @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} will be displayed
15263 as @samp{1 + 5}. Evaluation will use the default simplifications,
15264 regardless of the current simplification mode. There are also
15265 @code{evalsimp} and @code{evalextsimp} which simplify as if by
15266 @kbd{a s} and @kbd{a e} (respectively). Note that these ``functions''
15267 operate only in the context of composition formulas (and also in
15268 rewrite rules, where they serve a similar purpose; @pxref{Rewrite
15269 Rules}). On the stack, a call to @code{eval} will be left in
15270 symbolic form.
15271
15272 It is not a good idea to use @code{eval} except as a last resort.
15273 It can cause the display of formulas to be extremely slow. For
15274 example, while @samp{eval(a + b)} might seem quite fast and simple,
15275 there are several situations where it could be slow. For example,
15276 @samp{a} and/or @samp{b} could be polar complex numbers, in which
15277 case doing the sum requires trigonometry. Or, @samp{a} could be
15278 the factorial @samp{fact(100)} which is unevaluated because you
15279 have typed @kbd{m O}; @code{eval} will evaluate it anyway to
15280 produce a large, unwieldy integer.
15281
15282 You can save your display formats permanently using the @kbd{Z P}
15283 command (@pxref{Creating User Keys}).
15284
15285 @node Syntax Tables, , Compositions, Language Modes
15286 @subsection Syntax Tables
15287
15288 @noindent
15289 @cindex Syntax tables
15290 @cindex Parsing formulas, customized
15291 Syntax tables do for input what compositions do for output: They
15292 allow you to teach custom notations to Calc's formula parser.
15293 Calc keeps a separate syntax table for each language mode.
15294
15295 (Note that the Calc ``syntax tables'' discussed here are completely
15296 unrelated to the syntax tables described in the Emacs manual.)
15297
15298 @kindex Z S
15299 @pindex calc-edit-user-syntax
15300 The @kbd{Z S} (@code{calc-edit-user-syntax}) command edits the
15301 syntax table for the current language mode. If you want your
15302 syntax to work in any language, define it in the Normal language
15303 mode. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing the syntax table, or
15304 @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @kbd{m m} command saves all
15305 the syntax tables along with the other mode settings;
15306 @pxref{General Mode Commands}.
15307
15308 @menu
15309 * Syntax Table Basics::
15310 * Precedence in Syntax Tables::
15311 * Advanced Syntax Patterns::
15312 * Conditional Syntax Rules::
15313 @end menu
15314
15315 @node Syntax Table Basics, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15316 @subsubsection Syntax Table Basics
15317
15318 @noindent
15319 @dfn{Parsing} is the process of converting a raw string of characters,
15320 such as you would type in during algebraic entry, into a Calc formula.
15321 Calc's parser works in two stages. First, the input is broken down
15322 into @dfn{tokens}, such as words, numbers, and punctuation symbols
15323 like @samp{+}, @samp{:=}, and @samp{+/-}. Space between tokens is
15324 ignored (except when it serves to separate adjacent words). Next,
15325 the parser matches this string of tokens against various built-in
15326 syntactic patterns, such as ``an expression followed by @samp{+}
15327 followed by another expression'' or ``a name followed by @samp{(},
15328 zero or more expressions separated by commas, and @samp{)}.''
15329
15330 A @dfn{syntax table} is a list of user-defined @dfn{syntax rules},
15331 which allow you to specify new patterns to define your own
15332 favorite input notations. Calc's parser always checks the syntax
15333 table for the current language mode, then the table for the Normal
15334 language mode, before it uses its built-in rules to parse an
15335 algebraic formula you have entered. Each syntax rule should go on
15336 its own line; it consists of a @dfn{pattern}, a @samp{:=} symbol,
15337 and a Calc formula with an optional @dfn{condition}. (Syntax rules
15338 resemble algebraic rewrite rules, but the notation for patterns is
15339 completely different.)
15340
15341 A syntax pattern is a list of tokens, separated by spaces.
15342 Except for a few special symbols, tokens in syntax patterns are
15343 matched literally, from left to right. For example, the rule,
15344
15345 @example
15346 foo ( ) := 2+3
15347 @end example
15348
15349 @noindent
15350 would cause Calc to parse the formula @samp{4+foo()*5} as if it
15351 were @samp{4+(2+3)*5}. Notice that the parentheses were written
15352 as two separate tokens in the rule. As a result, the rule works
15353 for both @samp{foo()} and @w{@samp{foo ( )}}. If we had written
15354 the rule as @samp{foo () := 2+3}, then Calc would treat @samp{()}
15355 as a single, indivisible token, so that @w{@samp{foo( )}} would
15356 not be recognized by the rule. (It would be parsed as a regular
15357 zero-argument function call instead.) In fact, this rule would
15358 also make trouble for the rest of Calc's parser: An unrelated
15359 formula like @samp{bar()} would now be tokenized into @samp{bar ()}
15360 instead of @samp{bar ( )}, so that the standard parser for function
15361 calls would no longer recognize it!
15362
15363 While it is possible to make a token with a mixture of letters
15364 and punctuation symbols, this is not recommended. It is better to
15365 break it into several tokens, as we did with @samp{foo()} above.
15366
15367 The symbol @samp{#} in a syntax pattern matches any Calc expression.
15368 On the righthand side, the things that matched the @samp{#}s can
15369 be referred to as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on (where @samp{#1}
15370 matches the leftmost @samp{#} in the pattern). For example, these
15371 rules match a user-defined function, prefix operator, infix operator,
15372 and postfix operator, respectively:
15373
15374 @example
15375 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15376 foo # := myprefix(#1)
15377 # foo # := myinfix(#1,#2)
15378 # foo := mypostfix(#1)
15379 @end example
15380
15381 Thus @samp{foo(3)} will parse as @samp{myfunc(3)}, and @samp{2+3 foo}
15382 will parse as @samp{mypostfix(2+3)}.
15383
15384 It is important to write the first two rules in the order shown,
15385 because Calc tries rules in order from first to last. If the
15386 pattern @samp{foo #} came first, it would match anything that could
15387 match the @samp{foo ( # )} rule, since an expression in parentheses
15388 is itself a valid expression. Thus the @w{@samp{foo ( # )}} rule would
15389 never get to match anything. Likewise, the last two rules must be
15390 written in the order shown or else @samp{3 foo 4} will be parsed as
15391 @samp{mypostfix(3) * 4}. (Of course, the best way to avoid these
15392 ambiguities is not to use the same symbol in more than one way at
15393 the same time! In case you're not convinced, try the following
15394 exercise: How will the above rules parse the input @samp{foo(3,4)},
15395 if at all? Work it out for yourself, then try it in Calc and see.)
15396
15397 Calc is quite flexible about what sorts of patterns are allowed.
15398 The only rule is that every pattern must begin with a literal
15399 token (like @samp{foo} in the first two patterns above), or with
15400 a @samp{#} followed by a literal token (as in the last two
15401 patterns). After that, any mixture is allowed, although putting
15402 two @samp{#}s in a row will not be very useful since two
15403 expressions with nothing between them will be parsed as one
15404 expression that uses implicit multiplication.
15405
15406 As a more practical example, Maple uses the notation
15407 @samp{sum(a(i), i=1..10)} for sums, which Calc's Maple mode doesn't
15408 recognize at present. To handle this syntax, we simply add the
15409 rule,
15410
15411 @example
15412 sum ( # , # = # .. # ) := sum(#1,#2,#3,#4)
15413 @end example
15414
15415 @noindent
15416 to the Maple mode syntax table. As another example, C mode can't
15417 read assignment operators like @samp{++} and @samp{*=}. We can
15418 define these operators quite easily:
15419
15420 @example
15421 # *= # := muleq(#1,#2)
15422 # ++ := postinc(#1)
15423 ++ # := preinc(#1)
15424 @end example
15425
15426 @noindent
15427 To complete the job, we would use corresponding composition functions
15428 and @kbd{Z C} to cause these functions to display in their respective
15429 Maple and C notations. (Note that the C example ignores issues of
15430 operator precedence, which are discussed in the next section.)
15431
15432 You can enclose any token in quotes to prevent its usual
15433 interpretation in syntax patterns:
15434
15435 @example
15436 # ":=" # := becomes(#1,#2)
15437 @end example
15438
15439 Quotes also allow you to include spaces in a token, although once
15440 again it is generally better to use two tokens than one token with
15441 an embedded space. To include an actual quotation mark in a quoted
15442 token, precede it with a backslash. (This also works to include
15443 backslashes in tokens.)
15444
15445 @example
15446 # "bad token" # "/\"\\" # := silly(#1,#2,#3)
15447 @end example
15448
15449 @noindent
15450 This will parse @samp{3 bad token 4 /"\ 5} to @samp{silly(3,4,5)}.
15451
15452 The token @kbd{#} has a predefined meaning in Calc's formula parser;
15453 it is not valid to use @samp{"#"} in a syntax rule. However, longer
15454 tokens that include the @samp{#} character are allowed. Also, while
15455 @samp{"$"} and @samp{"\""} are allowed as tokens, their presence in
15456 the syntax table will prevent those characters from working in their
15457 usual ways (referring to stack entries and quoting strings,
15458 respectively).
15459
15460 Finally, the notation @samp{%%} anywhere in a syntax table causes
15461 the rest of the line to be ignored as a comment.
15462
15463 @node Precedence in Syntax Tables, Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Table Basics, Syntax Tables
15464 @subsubsection Precedence
15465
15466 @noindent
15467 Different operators are generally assigned different @dfn{precedences}.
15468 By default, an operator defined by a rule like
15469
15470 @example
15471 # foo # := foo(#1,#2)
15472 @end example
15473
15474 @noindent
15475 will have an extremely low precedence, so that @samp{2*3+4 foo 5 == 6}
15476 will be parsed as @samp{(2*3+4) foo (5 == 6)}. To change the
15477 precedence of an operator, use the notation @samp{#/@var{p}} in
15478 place of @samp{#}, where @var{p} is an integer precedence level.
15479 For example, 185 lies between the precedences for @samp{+} and
15480 @samp{*}, so if we change this rule to
15481
15482 @example
15483 #/185 foo #/186 := foo(#1,#2)
15484 @end example
15485
15486 @noindent
15487 then @samp{2+3 foo 4*5} will be parsed as @samp{2+(3 foo (4*5))}.
15488 Also, because we've given the righthand expression slightly higher
15489 precedence, our new operator will be left-associative:
15490 @samp{1 foo 2 foo 3} will be parsed as @samp{(1 foo 2) foo 3}.
15491 By raising the precedence of the lefthand expression instead, we
15492 can create a right-associative operator.
15493
15494 @xref{Composition Basics}, for a table of precedences of the
15495 standard Calc operators. For the precedences of operators in other
15496 language modes, look in the Calc source file @file{calc-lang.el}.
15497
15498 @node Advanced Syntax Patterns, Conditional Syntax Rules, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15499 @subsubsection Advanced Syntax Patterns
15500
15501 @noindent
15502 To match a function with a variable number of arguments, you could
15503 write
15504
15505 @example
15506 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15507 foo ( # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2)
15508 foo ( # , # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2,#3)
15509 @end example
15510
15511 @noindent
15512 but this isn't very elegant. To match variable numbers of items,
15513 Calc uses some notations inspired regular expressions and the
15514 ``extended BNF'' style used by some language designers.
15515
15516 @example
15517 foo ( @{ # @}*, ) := apply(myfunc,#1)
15518 @end example
15519
15520 The token @samp{@{} introduces a repeated or optional portion.
15521 One of the three tokens @samp{@}*}, @samp{@}+}, or @samp{@}?}
15522 ends the portion. These will match zero or more, one or more,
15523 or zero or one copies of the enclosed pattern, respectively.
15524 In addition, @samp{@}*} and @samp{@}+} can be followed by a
15525 separator token (with no space in between, as shown above).
15526 Thus @samp{@{ # @}*,} matches nothing, or one expression, or
15527 several expressions separated by commas.
15528
15529 A complete @samp{@{ ... @}} item matches as a vector of the
15530 items that matched inside it. For example, the above rule will
15531 match @samp{foo(1,2,3)} to get @samp{apply(myfunc,[1,2,3])}.
15532 The Calc @code{apply} function takes a function name and a vector
15533 of arguments and builds a call to the function with those
15534 arguments, so the net result is the formula @samp{myfunc(1,2,3)}.
15535
15536 If the body of a @samp{@{ ... @}} contains several @samp{#}s
15537 (or nested @samp{@{ ... @}} constructs), then the items will be
15538 strung together into the resulting vector. If the body
15539 does not contain anything but literal tokens, the result will
15540 always be an empty vector.
15541
15542 @example
15543 foo ( @{ # , # @}+, ) := bar(#1)
15544 foo ( @{ @{ # @}*, @}*; ) := matrix(#1)
15545 @end example
15546
15547 @noindent
15548 will parse @samp{foo(1, 2, 3, 4)} as @samp{bar([1, 2, 3, 4])}, and
15549 @samp{foo(1, 2; 3, 4)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2], [3, 4]])}. Also, after
15550 some thought it's easy to see how this pair of rules will parse
15551 @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2, 3]])}, since the first
15552 rule will only match an even number of arguments. The rule
15553
15554 @example
15555 foo ( # @{ , # , # @}? ) := bar(#1,#2)
15556 @end example
15557
15558 @noindent
15559 will parse @samp{foo(2,3,4)} as @samp{bar(2,[3,4])}, and
15560 @samp{foo(2)} as @samp{bar(2,[])}.
15561
15562 The notation @samp{@{ ... @}?.} (note the trailing period) works
15563 just the same as regular @samp{@{ ... @}?}, except that it does not
15564 count as an argument; the following two rules are equivalent:
15565
15566 @example
15567 foo ( # , @{ also @}? # ) := bar(#1,#3)
15568 foo ( # , @{ also @}?. # ) := bar(#1,#2)
15569 @end example
15570
15571 @noindent
15572 Note that in the first case the optional text counts as @samp{#2},
15573 which will always be an empty vector, but in the second case no
15574 empty vector is produced.
15575
15576 Another variant is @samp{@{ ... @}?$}, which means the body is
15577 optional only at the end of the input formula. All built-in syntax
15578 rules in Calc use this for closing delimiters, so that during
15579 algebraic entry you can type @kbd{[sqrt(2), sqrt(3 @key{RET}}, omitting
15580 the closing parenthesis and bracket. Calc does this automatically
15581 for trailing @samp{)}, @samp{]}, and @samp{>} tokens in syntax
15582 rules, but you can use @samp{@{ ... @}?$} explicitly to get
15583 this effect with any token (such as @samp{"@}"} or @samp{end}).
15584 Like @samp{@{ ... @}?.}, this notation does not count as an
15585 argument. Conversely, you can use quotes, as in @samp{")"}, to
15586 prevent a closing-delimiter token from being automatically treated
15587 as optional.
15588
15589 Calc's parser does not have full backtracking, which means some
15590 patterns will not work as you might expect:
15591
15592 @example
15593 foo ( @{ # , @}? # , # ) := bar(#1,#2,#3)
15594 @end example
15595
15596 @noindent
15597 Here we are trying to make the first argument optional, so that
15598 @samp{foo(2,3)} parses as @samp{bar([],2,3)}. Unfortunately, Calc
15599 first tries to match @samp{2,} against the optional part of the
15600 pattern, finds a match, and so goes ahead to match the rest of the
15601 pattern. Later on it will fail to match the second comma, but it
15602 doesn't know how to go back and try the other alternative at that
15603 point. One way to get around this would be to use two rules:
15604
15605 @example
15606 foo ( # , # , # ) := bar([#1],#2,#3)
15607 foo ( # , # ) := bar([],#1,#2)
15608 @end example
15609
15610 More precisely, when Calc wants to match an optional or repeated
15611 part of a pattern, it scans forward attempting to match that part.
15612 If it reaches the end of the optional part without failing, it
15613 ``finalizes'' its choice and proceeds. If it fails, though, it
15614 backs up and tries the other alternative. Thus Calc has ``partial''
15615 backtracking. A fully backtracking parser would go on to make sure
15616 the rest of the pattern matched before finalizing the choice.
15617
15618 @node Conditional Syntax Rules, , Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Tables
15619 @subsubsection Conditional Syntax Rules
15620
15621 @noindent
15622 It is possible to attach a @dfn{condition} to a syntax rule. For
15623 example, the rules
15624
15625 @example
15626 foo ( # ) := ifoo(#1) :: integer(#1)
15627 foo ( # ) := gfoo(#1)
15628 @end example
15629
15630 @noindent
15631 will parse @samp{foo(3)} as @samp{ifoo(3)}, but will parse
15632 @samp{foo(3.5)} and @samp{foo(x)} as calls to @code{gfoo}. Any
15633 number of conditions may be attached; all must be true for the
15634 rule to succeed. A condition is ``true'' if it evaluates to a
15635 nonzero number. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a list of Calc
15636 functions like @code{integer} that perform logical tests.
15637
15638 The exact sequence of events is as follows: When Calc tries a
15639 rule, it first matches the pattern as usual. It then substitutes
15640 @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, etc., in the conditions, if any. Next, the
15641 conditions are simplified and evaluated in order from left to right,
15642 as if by the @w{@kbd{a s}} algebra command (@pxref{Simplifying Formulas}).
15643 Each result is true if it is a nonzero number, or an expression
15644 that can be proven to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}). If the
15645 results of all conditions are true, the expression (such as
15646 @samp{ifoo(#1)}) has its @samp{#}s substituted, and that is the
15647 result of the parse. If the result of any condition is false, Calc
15648 goes on to try the next rule in the syntax table.
15649
15650 Syntax rules also support @code{let} conditions, which operate in
15651 exactly the same way as they do in algebraic rewrite rules.
15652 @xref{Other Features of Rewrite Rules}, for details. A @code{let}
15653 condition is always true, but as a side effect it defines a
15654 variable which can be used in later conditions, and also in the
15655 expression after the @samp{:=} sign:
15656
15657 @example
15658 foo ( # ) := hifoo(x) :: let(x := #1 + 0.5) :: dnumint(x)
15659 @end example
15660
15661 @noindent
15662 The @code{dnumint} function tests if a value is numerically an
15663 integer, i.e., either a true integer or an integer-valued float.
15664 This rule will parse @code{foo} with a half-integer argument,
15665 like @samp{foo(3.5)}, to a call like @samp{hifoo(4.)}.
15666
15667 The lefthand side of a syntax rule @code{let} must be a simple
15668 variable, not the arbitrary pattern that is allowed in rewrite
15669 rules.
15670
15671 The @code{matches} function is also treated specially in syntax
15672 rule conditions (again, in the same way as in rewrite rules).
15673 @xref{Matching Commands}. If the matching pattern contains
15674 meta-variables, then those meta-variables may be used in later
15675 conditions and in the result expression. The arguments to
15676 @code{matches} are not evaluated in this situation.
15677
15678 @example
15679 sum ( # , # ) := sum(#1,a,b,c) :: matches(#2, a=[b..c])
15680 @end example
15681
15682 @noindent
15683 This is another way to implement the Maple mode @code{sum} notation.
15684 In this approach, we allow @samp{#2} to equal the whole expression
15685 @samp{i=1..10}. Then, we use @code{matches} to break it apart into
15686 its components. If the expression turns out not to match the pattern,
15687 the syntax rule will fail. Note that @kbd{Z S} always uses Calc's
15688 Normal language mode for editing expressions in syntax rules, so we
15689 must use regular Calc notation for the interval @samp{[b..c]} that
15690 will correspond to the Maple mode interval @samp{1..10}.
15691
15692 @node Modes Variable, Calc Mode Line, Language Modes, Mode Settings
15693 @section The @code{Modes} Variable
15694
15695 @noindent
15696 @kindex m g
15697 @pindex calc-get-modes
15698 The @kbd{m g} (@code{calc-get-modes}) command pushes onto the stack
15699 a vector of numbers that describes the various mode settings that
15700 are in effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it pushes only the
15701 @var{n}th mode, i.e., the @var{n}th element of this vector. Keyboard
15702 macros can use the @kbd{m g} command to modify their behavior based
15703 on the current mode settings.
15704
15705 @cindex @code{Modes} variable
15706 @vindex Modes
15707 The modes vector is also available in the special variable
15708 @code{Modes}. In other words, @kbd{m g} is like @kbd{s r Modes @key{RET}}.
15709 It will not work to store into this variable; in fact, if you do,
15710 @code{Modes} will cease to track the current modes. (The @kbd{m g}
15711 command will continue to work, however.)
15712
15713 In general, each number in this vector is suitable as a numeric
15714 prefix argument to the associated mode-setting command. (Recall
15715 that the @kbd{~} key takes a number from the stack and gives it as
15716 a numeric prefix to the next command.)
15717
15718 The elements of the modes vector are as follows:
15719
15720 @enumerate
15721 @item
15722 Current precision. Default is 12; associated command is @kbd{p}.
15723
15724 @item
15725 Binary word size. Default is 32; associated command is @kbd{b w}.
15726
15727 @item
15728 Stack size (not counting the value about to be pushed by @kbd{m g}).
15729 This is zero if @kbd{m g} is executed with an empty stack.
15730
15731 @item
15732 Number radix. Default is 10; command is @kbd{d r}.
15733
15734 @item
15735 Floating-point format. This is the number of digits, plus the
15736 constant 0 for normal notation, 10000 for scientific notation,
15737 20000 for engineering notation, or 30000 for fixed-point notation.
15738 These codes are acceptable as prefix arguments to the @kbd{d n}
15739 command, but note that this may lose information: For example,
15740 @kbd{d s} and @kbd{C-u 12 d s} have similar (but not quite
15741 identical) effects if the current precision is 12, but they both
15742 produce a code of 10012, which will be treated by @kbd{d n} as
15743 @kbd{C-u 12 d s}. If the precision then changes, the float format
15744 will still be frozen at 12 significant figures.
15745
15746 @item
15747 Angular mode. Default is 1 (degrees). Other values are 2 (radians)
15748 and 3 (HMS). The @kbd{m d} command accepts these prefixes.
15749
15750 @item
15751 Symbolic mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m s}.
15752
15753 @item
15754 Fraction mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m f}.
15755
15756 @item
15757 Polar mode. Value is 0 (rectangular) or 1 (polar); default is 0.
15758 Command is @kbd{m p}.
15759
15760 @item
15761 Matrix/Scalar mode. Default value is @mathit{-1}. Value is 0 for Scalar
15762 mode, @mathit{-2} for Matrix mode, @mathit{-3} for square Matrix mode,
15763 or @var{N} for
15764 @texline @math{N\times N}
15765 @infoline @var{N}x@var{N}
15766 Matrix mode. Command is @kbd{m v}.
15767
15768 @item
15769 Simplification mode. Default is 1. Value is @mathit{-1} for off (@kbd{m O}),
15770 0 for @kbd{m N}, 2 for @kbd{m B}, 3 for @kbd{m A}, 4 for @kbd{m E},
15771 or 5 for @w{@kbd{m U}}. The @kbd{m D} command accepts these prefixes.
15772
15773 @item
15774 Infinite mode. Default is @mathit{-1} (off). Value is 1 if the mode is on,
15775 or 0 if the mode is on with positive zeros. Command is @kbd{m i}.
15776 @end enumerate
15777
15778 For example, the sequence @kbd{M-1 m g @key{RET} 2 + ~ p} increases the
15779 precision by two, leaving a copy of the old precision on the stack.
15780 Later, @kbd{~ p} will restore the original precision using that
15781 stack value. (This sequence might be especially useful inside a
15782 keyboard macro.)
15783
15784 As another example, @kbd{M-3 m g 1 - ~ @key{DEL}} deletes all but the
15785 oldest (bottommost) stack entry.
15786
15787 Yet another example: The HP-48 ``round'' command rounds a number
15788 to the current displayed precision. You could roughly emulate this
15789 in Calc with the sequence @kbd{M-5 m g 10000 % ~ c c}. (This
15790 would not work for fixed-point mode, but it wouldn't be hard to
15791 do a full emulation with the help of the @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z ]}
15792 programming commands. @xref{Conditionals in Macros}.)
15793
15794 @node Calc Mode Line, , Modes Variable, Mode Settings
15795 @section The Calc Mode Line
15796
15797 @noindent
15798 @cindex Mode line indicators
15799 This section is a summary of all symbols that can appear on the
15800 Calc mode line, the highlighted bar that appears under the Calc
15801 stack window (or under an editing window in Embedded mode).
15802
15803 The basic mode line format is:
15804
15805 @example
15806 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg @var{other modes} (Calculator)
15807 @end example
15808
15809 The @samp{%*} indicates that the buffer is ``read-only''; it shows that
15810 regular Emacs commands are not allowed to edit the stack buffer
15811 as if it were text.
15812
15813 The word @samp{Calc:} changes to @samp{CalcEmbed:} if Embedded mode
15814 is enabled. The words after this describe the various Calc modes
15815 that are in effect.
15816
15817 The first mode is always the current precision, an integer.
15818 The second mode is always the angular mode, either @code{Deg},
15819 @code{Rad}, or @code{Hms}.
15820
15821 Here is a complete list of the remaining symbols that can appear
15822 on the mode line:
15823
15824 @table @code
15825 @item Alg
15826 Algebraic mode (@kbd{m a}; @pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
15827
15828 @item Alg[(
15829 Incomplete algebraic mode (@kbd{C-u m a}).
15830
15831 @item Alg*
15832 Total algebraic mode (@kbd{m t}).
15833
15834 @item Symb
15835 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}).
15836
15837 @item Matrix
15838 Matrix mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15839
15840 @item Matrix@var{n}
15841 Dimensioned Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u @var{n} m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15842
15843 @item SqMatrix
15844 Square Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15845
15846 @item Scalar
15847 Scalar mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15848
15849 @item Polar
15850 Polar complex mode (@kbd{m p}; @pxref{Polar Mode}).
15851
15852 @item Frac
15853 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}; @pxref{Fraction Mode}).
15854
15855 @item Inf
15856 Infinite mode (@kbd{m i}; @pxref{Infinite Mode}).
15857
15858 @item +Inf
15859 Positive Infinite mode (@kbd{C-u 0 m i}).
15860
15861 @item NoSimp
15862 Default simplifications off (@kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}).
15863
15864 @item NumSimp
15865 Default simplifications for numeric arguments only (@kbd{m N}).
15866
15867 @item BinSimp@var{w}
15868 Binary-integer simplification mode; word size @var{w} (@kbd{m B}, @kbd{b w}).
15869
15870 @item AlgSimp
15871 Algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m A}).
15872
15873 @item ExtSimp
15874 Extended algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m E}).
15875
15876 @item UnitSimp
15877 Units simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
15878
15879 @item Bin
15880 Current radix is 2 (@kbd{d 2}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15881
15882 @item Oct
15883 Current radix is 8 (@kbd{d 8}).
15884
15885 @item Hex
15886 Current radix is 16 (@kbd{d 6}).
15887
15888 @item Radix@var{n}
15889 Current radix is @var{n} (@kbd{d r}).
15890
15891 @item Zero
15892 Leading zeros (@kbd{d z}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15893
15894 @item Big
15895 Big language mode (@kbd{d B}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15896
15897 @item Flat
15898 One-line normal language mode (@kbd{d O}).
15899
15900 @item Unform
15901 Unformatted language mode (@kbd{d U}).
15902
15903 @item C
15904 C language mode (@kbd{d C}; @pxref{C FORTRAN Pascal}).
15905
15906 @item Pascal
15907 Pascal language mode (@kbd{d P}).
15908
15909 @item Fortran
15910 FORTRAN language mode (@kbd{d F}).
15911
15912 @item TeX
15913 @TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d T}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15914
15915 @item LaTeX
15916 La@TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d L}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15917
15918 @item Eqn
15919 @dfn{Eqn} language mode (@kbd{d E}; @pxref{Eqn Language Mode}).
15920
15921 @item Math
15922 Mathematica language mode (@kbd{d M}; @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}).
15923
15924 @item Maple
15925 Maple language mode (@kbd{d W}; @pxref{Maple Language Mode}).
15926
15927 @item Norm@var{n}
15928 Normal float mode with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d n}; @pxref{Float Formats}).
15929
15930 @item Fix@var{n}
15931 Fixed point mode with @var{n} digits after the point (@kbd{d f}).
15932
15933 @item Sci
15934 Scientific notation mode (@kbd{d s}).
15935
15936 @item Sci@var{n}
15937 Scientific notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d s}).
15938
15939 @item Eng
15940 Engineering notation mode (@kbd{d e}).
15941
15942 @item Eng@var{n}
15943 Engineering notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d e}).
15944
15945 @item Left@var{n}
15946 Left-justified display indented by @var{n} (@kbd{d <}; @pxref{Justification}).
15947
15948 @item Right
15949 Right-justified display (@kbd{d >}).
15950
15951 @item Right@var{n}
15952 Right-justified display with width @var{n} (@kbd{d >}).
15953
15954 @item Center
15955 Centered display (@kbd{d =}).
15956
15957 @item Center@var{n}
15958 Centered display with center column @var{n} (@kbd{d =}).
15959
15960 @item Wid@var{n}
15961 Line breaking with width @var{n} (@kbd{d b}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15962
15963 @item Wide
15964 No line breaking (@kbd{d b}).
15965
15966 @item Break
15967 Selections show deep structure (@kbd{j b}; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15968
15969 @item Save
15970 Record modes in @file{~/.calc.el} (@kbd{m R}; @pxref{General Mode Commands}).
15971
15972 @item Local
15973 Record modes in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15974
15975 @item LocEdit
15976 Record modes as editing-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15977
15978 @item LocPerm
15979 Record modes as permanent-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15980
15981 @item Global
15982 Record modes as global in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15983
15984 @item Manual
15985 Automatic recomputation turned off (@kbd{m C}; @pxref{Automatic
15986 Recomputation}).
15987
15988 @item Graph
15989 GNUPLOT process is alive in background (@pxref{Graphics}).
15990
15991 @item Sel
15992 Top-of-stack has a selection (Embedded only; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15993
15994 @item Dirty
15995 The stack display may not be up-to-date (@pxref{Display Modes}).
15996
15997 @item Inv
15998 ``Inverse'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{I}; @pxref{Inverse and Hyperbolic}).
15999
16000 @item Hyp
16001 ``Hyperbolic'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{H}).
16002
16003 @item Keep
16004 ``Keep-arguments'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{K}).
16005
16006 @item Narrow
16007 Stack is truncated (@kbd{d t}; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}).
16008 @end table
16009
16010 In addition, the symbols @code{Active} and @code{~Active} can appear
16011 as minor modes on an Embedded buffer's mode line. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
16012
16013 @node Arithmetic, Scientific Functions, Mode Settings, Top
16014 @chapter Arithmetic Functions
16015
16016 @noindent
16017 This chapter describes the Calc commands for doing simple calculations
16018 on numbers, such as addition, absolute value, and square roots. These
16019 commands work by removing the top one or two values from the stack,
16020 performing the desired operation, and pushing the result back onto the
16021 stack. If the operation cannot be performed, the result pushed is a
16022 formula instead of a number, such as @samp{2/0} (because division by zero
16023 is invalid) or @samp{sqrt(x)} (because the argument @samp{x} is a formula).
16024
16025 Most of the commands described here can be invoked by a single keystroke.
16026 Some of the more obscure ones are two-letter sequences beginning with
16027 the @kbd{f} (``functions'') prefix key.
16028
16029 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
16030 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
16031 interpret a prefix argument.
16032
16033 @menu
16034 * Basic Arithmetic::
16035 * Integer Truncation::
16036 * Complex Number Functions::
16037 * Conversions::
16038 * Date Arithmetic::
16039 * Financial Functions::
16040 * Binary Functions::
16041 @end menu
16042
16043 @node Basic Arithmetic, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16044 @section Basic Arithmetic
16045
16046 @noindent
16047 @kindex +
16048 @pindex calc-plus
16049 @ignore
16050 @mindex @null
16051 @end ignore
16052 @tindex +
16053 The @kbd{+} (@code{calc-plus}) command adds two numbers. The numbers may
16054 be any of the standard Calc data types. The resulting sum is pushed back
16055 onto the stack.
16056
16057 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are vectors or matrices (of matching dimensions),
16058 the result is a vector or matrix sum. If one argument is a vector and the
16059 other a scalar (i.e., a non-vector), the scalar is added to each of the
16060 elements of the vector to form a new vector. If the scalar is not a
16061 number, the operation is left in symbolic form: Suppose you added @samp{x}
16062 to the vector @samp{[1,2]}. You may want the result @samp{[1+x,2+x]}, or
16063 you may plan to substitute a 2-vector for @samp{x} in the future. Since
16064 the Calculator can't tell which interpretation you want, it makes the
16065 safest assumption. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, for a way to add @samp{x}
16066 to every element of a vector.
16067
16068 If either argument of @kbd{+} is a complex number, the result will in general
16069 be complex. If one argument is in rectangular form and the other polar,
16070 the current Polar mode determines the form of the result. If Symbolic
16071 mode is enabled, the sum may be left as a formula if the necessary
16072 conversions for polar addition are non-trivial.
16073
16074 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are HMS forms, the forms are added according to
16075 the usual conventions of hours-minutes-seconds notation. If one argument
16076 is an HMS form and the other is a number, that number is converted from
16077 degrees or radians (depending on the current Angular mode) to HMS format
16078 and then the two HMS forms are added.
16079
16080 If one argument of @kbd{+} is a date form, the other can be either a
16081 real number, which advances the date by a certain number of days, or
16082 an HMS form, which advances the date by a certain amount of time.
16083 Subtracting two date forms yields the number of days between them.
16084 Adding two date forms is meaningless, but Calc interprets it as the
16085 subtraction of one date form and the negative of the other. (The
16086 negative of a date form can be understood by remembering that dates
16087 are stored as the number of days before or after Jan 1, 1 AD.)
16088
16089 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are error forms, the result is an error form
16090 with an appropriately computed standard deviation. If one argument is an
16091 error form and the other is a number, the number is taken to have zero error.
16092 Error forms may have symbolic formulas as their mean and/or error parts;
16093 adding these will produce a symbolic error form result. However, adding an
16094 error form to a plain symbolic formula (as in @samp{(a +/- b) + c}) will not
16095 work, for the same reasons just mentioned for vectors. Instead you must
16096 write @samp{(a +/- b) + (c +/- 0)}.
16097
16098 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are modulo forms with equal values of @expr{M},
16099 or if one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number, the
16100 result is a modulo form which represents the sum, modulo @expr{M}, of
16101 the two values.
16102
16103 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are intervals, the result is an interval
16104 which describes all possible sums of the possible input values. If
16105 one argument is a plain number, it is treated as the interval
16106 @w{@samp{[x ..@: x]}}.
16107
16108 If one argument of @kbd{+} is an infinity and the other is not, the
16109 result is that same infinity. If both arguments are infinite and in
16110 the same direction, the result is the same infinity, but if they are
16111 infinite in different directions the result is @code{nan}.
16112
16113 @kindex -
16114 @pindex calc-minus
16115 @ignore
16116 @mindex @null
16117 @end ignore
16118 @tindex -
16119 The @kbd{-} (@code{calc-minus}) command subtracts two values. The top
16120 number on the stack is subtracted from the one behind it, so that the
16121 computation @kbd{5 @key{RET} 2 -} produces 3, not @mathit{-3}. All options
16122 available for @kbd{+} are available for @kbd{-} as well.
16123
16124 @kindex *
16125 @pindex calc-times
16126 @ignore
16127 @mindex @null
16128 @end ignore
16129 @tindex *
16130 The @kbd{*} (@code{calc-times}) command multiplies two numbers. If one
16131 argument is a vector and the other a scalar, the scalar is multiplied by
16132 the elements of the vector to produce a new vector. If both arguments
16133 are vectors, the interpretation depends on the dimensions of the
16134 vectors: If both arguments are matrices, a matrix multiplication is
16135 done. If one argument is a matrix and the other a plain vector, the
16136 vector is interpreted as a row vector or column vector, whichever is
16137 dimensionally correct. If both arguments are plain vectors, the result
16138 is a single scalar number which is the dot product of the two vectors.
16139
16140 If one argument of @kbd{*} is an HMS form and the other a number, the
16141 HMS form is multiplied by that amount. It is an error to multiply two
16142 HMS forms together, or to attempt any multiplication involving date
16143 forms. Error forms, modulo forms, and intervals can be multiplied;
16144 see the comments for addition of those forms. When two error forms
16145 or intervals are multiplied they are considered to be statistically
16146 independent; thus, @samp{[-2 ..@: 3] * [-2 ..@: 3]} is @samp{[-6 ..@: 9]},
16147 whereas @w{@samp{[-2 ..@: 3] ^ 2}} is @samp{[0 ..@: 9]}.
16148
16149 @kindex /
16150 @pindex calc-divide
16151 @ignore
16152 @mindex @null
16153 @end ignore
16154 @tindex /
16155 The @kbd{/} (@code{calc-divide}) command divides two numbers.
16156
16157 When combining multiplication and division in an algebraic formula, it
16158 is good style to use parentheses to distinguish between possible
16159 interpretations; the expression @samp{a/b*c} should be written
16160 @samp{(a/b)*c} or @samp{a/(b*c)}, as appropriate. Without the
16161 parentheses, Calc will interpret @samp{a/b*c} as @samp{a/(b*c)}, since
16162 in algebraic entry Calc gives division a lower precedence than
16163 multiplication. (This is not standard across all computer languages, and
16164 Calc may change the precedence depending on the language mode being used.
16165 @xref{Language Modes}.) This default ordering can be changed by setting
16166 the customizable variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} to
16167 @code{nil} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}); this will give multiplication and
16168 division equal precedences. Note that Calc's default choice of
16169 precedence allows @samp{a b / c d} to be used as a shortcut for
16170 @smallexample
16171 @group
16172 a b
16173 ---.
16174 c d
16175 @end group
16176 @end smallexample
16177
16178 When dividing a scalar @expr{B} by a square matrix @expr{A}, the
16179 computation performed is @expr{B} times the inverse of @expr{A}. This
16180 also occurs if @expr{B} is itself a vector or matrix, in which case the
16181 effect is to solve the set of linear equations represented by @expr{B}.
16182 If @expr{B} is a matrix with the same number of rows as @expr{A}, or a
16183 plain vector (which is interpreted here as a column vector), then the
16184 equation @expr{A X = B} is solved for the vector or matrix @expr{X}.
16185 Otherwise, if @expr{B} is a non-square matrix with the same number of
16186 @emph{columns} as @expr{A}, the equation @expr{X A = B} is solved. If
16187 you wish a vector @expr{B} to be interpreted as a row vector to be
16188 solved as @expr{X A = B}, make it into a one-row matrix with @kbd{C-u 1
16189 v p} first. To force a left-handed solution with a square matrix
16190 @expr{B}, transpose @expr{A} and @expr{B} before dividing, then
16191 transpose the result.
16192
16193 HMS forms can be divided by real numbers or by other HMS forms. Error
16194 forms can be divided in any combination of ways. Modulo forms where both
16195 values and the modulo are integers can be divided to get an integer modulo
16196 form result. Intervals can be divided; dividing by an interval that
16197 encompasses zero or has zero as a limit will result in an infinite
16198 interval.
16199
16200 @kindex ^
16201 @pindex calc-power
16202 @ignore
16203 @mindex @null
16204 @end ignore
16205 @tindex ^
16206 The @kbd{^} (@code{calc-power}) command raises a number to a power. If
16207 the power is an integer, an exact result is computed using repeated
16208 multiplications. For non-integer powers, Calc uses Newton's method or
16209 logarithms and exponentials. Square matrices can be raised to integer
16210 powers. If either argument is an error (or interval or modulo) form,
16211 the result is also an error (or interval or modulo) form.
16212
16213 @kindex I ^
16214 @tindex nroot
16215 If you press the @kbd{I} (inverse) key first, the @kbd{I ^} command
16216 computes an Nth root: @kbd{125 @key{RET} 3 I ^} computes the number 5.
16217 (This is entirely equivalent to @kbd{125 @key{RET} 1:3 ^}.)
16218
16219 @kindex \
16220 @pindex calc-idiv
16221 @tindex idiv
16222 @ignore
16223 @mindex @null
16224 @end ignore
16225 @tindex \
16226 The @kbd{\} (@code{calc-idiv}) command divides two numbers on the stack
16227 to produce an integer result. It is equivalent to dividing with
16228 @key{/}, then rounding down with @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}), only a bit
16229 more convenient and efficient. Also, since it is an all-integer
16230 operation when the arguments are integers, it avoids problems that
16231 @kbd{/ F} would have with floating-point roundoff.
16232
16233 @kindex %
16234 @pindex calc-mod
16235 @ignore
16236 @mindex @null
16237 @end ignore
16238 @tindex %
16239 The @kbd{%} (@code{calc-mod}) command performs a ``modulo'' (or ``remainder'')
16240 operation. Mathematically, @samp{a%b = a - (a\b)*b}, and is defined
16241 for all real numbers @expr{a} and @expr{b} (except @expr{b=0}). For
16242 positive @expr{b}, the result will always be between 0 (inclusive) and
16243 @expr{b} (exclusive). Modulo does not work for HMS forms and error forms.
16244 If @expr{a} is a modulo form, its modulo is changed to @expr{b}, which
16245 must be positive real number.
16246
16247 @kindex :
16248 @pindex calc-fdiv
16249 @tindex fdiv
16250 The @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command
16251 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fractional
16252 result. This is a convenient shorthand for enabling Fraction mode (with
16253 @kbd{m f}) temporarily and using @samp{/}. Note that during numeric entry
16254 the @kbd{:} key is interpreted as a fraction separator, so to divide 8 by 6
16255 you would have to type @kbd{8 @key{RET} 6 @key{RET} :}. (Of course, in
16256 this case, it would be much easier simply to enter the fraction directly
16257 as @kbd{8:6 @key{RET}}!)
16258
16259 @kindex n
16260 @pindex calc-change-sign
16261 The @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the number on the top
16262 of the stack. It works on numbers, vectors and matrices, HMS forms, date
16263 forms, error forms, intervals, and modulo forms.
16264
16265 @kindex A
16266 @pindex calc-abs
16267 @tindex abs
16268 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the absolute
16269 value of a number. The result of @code{abs} is always a nonnegative
16270 real number: With a complex argument, it computes the complex magnitude.
16271 With a vector or matrix argument, it computes the Frobenius norm, i.e.,
16272 the square root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
16273 elements. The absolute value of an error form is defined by replacing
16274 the mean part with its absolute value and leaving the error part the same.
16275 The absolute value of a modulo form is undefined. The absolute value of
16276 an interval is defined in the obvious way.
16277
16278 @kindex f A
16279 @pindex calc-abssqr
16280 @tindex abssqr
16281 The @kbd{f A} (@code{calc-abssqr}) [@code{abssqr}] command computes the
16282 absolute value squared of a number, vector or matrix, or error form.
16283
16284 @kindex f s
16285 @pindex calc-sign
16286 @tindex sign
16287 The @kbd{f s} (@code{calc-sign}) [@code{sign}] command returns 1 if its
16288 argument is positive, @mathit{-1} if its argument is negative, or 0 if its
16289 argument is zero. In algebraic form, you can also write @samp{sign(a,x)}
16290 which evaluates to @samp{x * sign(a)}, i.e., either @samp{x}, @samp{-x}, or
16291 zero depending on the sign of @samp{a}.
16292
16293 @kindex &
16294 @pindex calc-inv
16295 @tindex inv
16296 @cindex Reciprocal
16297 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
16298 reciprocal of a number, i.e., @expr{1 / x}. Operating on a square
16299 matrix, it computes the inverse of that matrix.
16300
16301 @kindex Q
16302 @pindex calc-sqrt
16303 @tindex sqrt
16304 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] command computes the square
16305 root of a number. For a negative real argument, the result will be a
16306 complex number whose form is determined by the current Polar mode.
16307
16308 @kindex f h
16309 @pindex calc-hypot
16310 @tindex hypot
16311 The @kbd{f h} (@code{calc-hypot}) [@code{hypot}] command computes the square
16312 root of the sum of the squares of two numbers. That is, @samp{hypot(a,b)}
16313 is the length of the hypotenuse of a right triangle with sides @expr{a}
16314 and @expr{b}. If the arguments are complex numbers, their squared
16315 magnitudes are used.
16316
16317 @kindex f Q
16318 @pindex calc-isqrt
16319 @tindex isqrt
16320 The @kbd{f Q} (@code{calc-isqrt}) [@code{isqrt}] command computes the
16321 integer square root of an integer. This is the true square root of the
16322 number, rounded down to an integer. For example, @samp{isqrt(10)}
16323 produces 3. Note that, like @kbd{\} [@code{idiv}], this uses exact
16324 integer arithmetic throughout to avoid roundoff problems. If the input
16325 is a floating-point number or other non-integer value, this is exactly
16326 the same as @samp{floor(sqrt(x))}.
16327
16328 @kindex f n
16329 @kindex f x
16330 @pindex calc-min
16331 @tindex min
16332 @pindex calc-max
16333 @tindex max
16334 The @kbd{f n} (@code{calc-min}) [@code{min}] and @kbd{f x} (@code{calc-max})
16335 [@code{max}] commands take the minimum or maximum of two real numbers,
16336 respectively. These commands also work on HMS forms, date forms,
16337 intervals, and infinities. (In algebraic expressions, these functions
16338 take any number of arguments and return the maximum or minimum among
16339 all the arguments.)
16340
16341 @kindex f M
16342 @kindex f X
16343 @pindex calc-mant-part
16344 @tindex mant
16345 @pindex calc-xpon-part
16346 @tindex xpon
16347 The @kbd{f M} (@code{calc-mant-part}) [@code{mant}] function extracts
16348 the ``mantissa'' part @expr{m} of its floating-point argument; @kbd{f X}
16349 (@code{calc-xpon-part}) [@code{xpon}] extracts the ``exponent'' part
16350 @expr{e}. The original number is equal to
16351 @texline @math{m \times 10^e},
16352 @infoline @expr{m * 10^e},
16353 where @expr{m} is in the interval @samp{[1.0 ..@: 10.0)} except that
16354 @expr{m=e=0} if the original number is zero. For integers
16355 and fractions, @code{mant} returns the number unchanged and @code{xpon}
16356 returns zero. The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command can also be
16357 used to ``unpack'' a floating-point number; this produces an integer
16358 mantissa and exponent, with the constraint that the mantissa is not
16359 a multiple of ten (again except for the @expr{m=e=0} case).
16360
16361 @kindex f S
16362 @pindex calc-scale-float
16363 @tindex scf
16364 The @kbd{f S} (@code{calc-scale-float}) [@code{scf}] function scales a number
16365 by a given power of ten. Thus, @samp{scf(mant(x), xpon(x)) = x} for any
16366 real @samp{x}. The second argument must be an integer, but the first
16367 may actually be any numeric value. For example, @samp{scf(5,-2) = 0.05}
16368 or @samp{1:20} depending on the current Fraction mode.
16369
16370 @kindex f [
16371 @kindex f ]
16372 @pindex calc-decrement
16373 @pindex calc-increment
16374 @tindex decr
16375 @tindex incr
16376 The @kbd{f [} (@code{calc-decrement}) [@code{decr}] and @kbd{f ]}
16377 (@code{calc-increment}) [@code{incr}] functions decrease or increase
16378 a number by one unit. For integers, the effect is obvious. For
16379 floating-point numbers, the change is by one unit in the last place.
16380 For example, incrementing @samp{12.3456} when the current precision
16381 is 6 digits yields @samp{12.3457}. If the current precision had been
16382 8 digits, the result would have been @samp{12.345601}. Incrementing
16383 @samp{0.0} produces
16384 @texline @math{10^{-p}},
16385 @infoline @expr{10^-p},
16386 where @expr{p} is the current
16387 precision. These operations are defined only on integers and floats.
16388 With numeric prefix arguments, they change the number by @expr{n} units.
16389
16390 Note that incrementing followed by decrementing, or vice-versa, will
16391 almost but not quite always cancel out. Suppose the precision is
16392 6 digits and the number @samp{9.99999} is on the stack. Incrementing
16393 will produce @samp{10.0000}; decrementing will produce @samp{9.9999}.
16394 One digit has been dropped. This is an unavoidable consequence of the
16395 way floating-point numbers work.
16396
16397 Incrementing a date/time form adjusts it by a certain number of seconds.
16398 Incrementing a pure date form adjusts it by a certain number of days.
16399
16400 @node Integer Truncation, Complex Number Functions, Basic Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16401 @section Integer Truncation
16402
16403 @noindent
16404 There are four commands for truncating a real number to an integer,
16405 differing mainly in their treatment of negative numbers. All of these
16406 commands have the property that if the argument is an integer, the result
16407 is the same integer. An integer-valued floating-point argument is converted
16408 to integer form.
16409
16410 If you press @kbd{H} (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) first, the result will be
16411 expressed as an integer-valued floating-point number.
16412
16413 @cindex Integer part of a number
16414 @kindex F
16415 @pindex calc-floor
16416 @tindex floor
16417 @tindex ffloor
16418 @ignore
16419 @mindex @null
16420 @end ignore
16421 @kindex H F
16422 The @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) [@code{floor} or @code{ffloor}] command
16423 truncates a real number to the next lower integer, i.e., toward minus
16424 infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 F} produces 3, but @kbd{_3.6 F} produces
16425 @mathit{-4}.
16426
16427 @kindex I F
16428 @pindex calc-ceiling
16429 @tindex ceil
16430 @tindex fceil
16431 @ignore
16432 @mindex @null
16433 @end ignore
16434 @kindex H I F
16435 The @kbd{I F} (@code{calc-ceiling}) [@code{ceil} or @code{fceil}]
16436 command truncates toward positive infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 I F} produces
16437 4, and @kbd{_3.6 I F} produces @mathit{-3}.
16438
16439 @kindex R
16440 @pindex calc-round
16441 @tindex round
16442 @tindex fround
16443 @ignore
16444 @mindex @null
16445 @end ignore
16446 @kindex H R
16447 The @kbd{R} (@code{calc-round}) [@code{round} or @code{fround}] command
16448 rounds to the nearest integer. When the fractional part is .5 exactly,
16449 this command rounds away from zero. (All other rounding in the
16450 Calculator uses this convention as well.) Thus @kbd{3.5 R} produces 4
16451 but @kbd{3.4 R} produces 3; @kbd{_3.5 R} produces @mathit{-4}.
16452
16453 @kindex I R
16454 @pindex calc-trunc
16455 @tindex trunc
16456 @tindex ftrunc
16457 @ignore
16458 @mindex @null
16459 @end ignore
16460 @kindex H I R
16461 The @kbd{I R} (@code{calc-trunc}) [@code{trunc} or @code{ftrunc}]
16462 command truncates toward zero. In other words, it ``chops off''
16463 everything after the decimal point. Thus @kbd{3.6 I R} produces 3 and
16464 @kbd{_3.6 I R} produces @mathit{-3}.
16465
16466 These functions may not be applied meaningfully to error forms, but they
16467 do work for intervals. As a convenience, applying @code{floor} to a
16468 modulo form floors the value part of the form. Applied to a vector,
16469 these functions operate on all elements of the vector one by one.
16470 Applied to a date form, they operate on the internal numerical
16471 representation of dates, converting a date/time form into a pure date.
16472
16473 @ignore
16474 @starindex
16475 @end ignore
16476 @tindex rounde
16477 @ignore
16478 @starindex
16479 @end ignore
16480 @tindex roundu
16481 @ignore
16482 @starindex
16483 @end ignore
16484 @tindex frounde
16485 @ignore
16486 @starindex
16487 @end ignore
16488 @tindex froundu
16489 There are two more rounding functions which can only be entered in
16490 algebraic notation. The @code{roundu} function is like @code{round}
16491 except that it rounds up, toward plus infinity, when the fractional
16492 part is .5. This distinction matters only for negative arguments.
16493 Also, @code{rounde} rounds to an even number in the case of a tie,
16494 rounding up or down as necessary. For example, @samp{rounde(3.5)} and
16495 @samp{rounde(4.5)} both return 4, but @samp{rounde(5.5)} returns 6.
16496 The advantage of round-to-even is that the net error due to rounding
16497 after a long calculation tends to cancel out to zero. An important
16498 subtle point here is that the number being fed to @code{rounde} will
16499 already have been rounded to the current precision before @code{rounde}
16500 begins. For example, @samp{rounde(2.500001)} with a current precision
16501 of 6 will incorrectly, or at least surprisingly, yield 2 because the
16502 argument will first have been rounded down to @expr{2.5} (which
16503 @code{rounde} sees as an exact tie between 2 and 3).
16504
16505 Each of these functions, when written in algebraic formulas, allows
16506 a second argument which specifies the number of digits after the
16507 decimal point to keep. For example, @samp{round(123.4567, 2)} will
16508 produce the answer 123.46, and @samp{round(123.4567, -1)} will
16509 produce 120 (i.e., the cutoff is one digit to the @emph{left} of
16510 the decimal point). A second argument of zero is equivalent to
16511 no second argument at all.
16512
16513 @cindex Fractional part of a number
16514 To compute the fractional part of a number (i.e., the amount which, when
16515 added to `@tfn{floor(}@var{n}@tfn{)}', will produce @var{n}) just take @var{n}
16516 modulo 1 using the @code{%} command.
16517
16518 Note also the @kbd{\} (integer quotient), @kbd{f I} (integer logarithm),
16519 and @kbd{f Q} (integer square root) commands, which are analogous to
16520 @kbd{/}, @kbd{B}, and @kbd{Q}, respectively, except that they take integer
16521 arguments and return the result rounded down to an integer.
16522
16523 @node Complex Number Functions, Conversions, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic
16524 @section Complex Number Functions
16525
16526 @noindent
16527 @kindex J
16528 @pindex calc-conj
16529 @tindex conj
16530 The @kbd{J} (@code{calc-conj}) [@code{conj}] command computes the
16531 complex conjugate of a number. For complex number @expr{a+bi}, the
16532 complex conjugate is @expr{a-bi}. If the argument is a real number,
16533 this command leaves it the same. If the argument is a vector or matrix,
16534 this command replaces each element by its complex conjugate.
16535
16536 @kindex G
16537 @pindex calc-argument
16538 @tindex arg
16539 The @kbd{G} (@code{calc-argument}) [@code{arg}] command computes the
16540 ``argument'' or polar angle of a complex number. For a number in polar
16541 notation, this is simply the second component of the pair
16542 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'.
16543 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'.
16544 The result is expressed according to the current angular mode and will
16545 be in the range @mathit{-180} degrees (exclusive) to @mathit{+180} degrees
16546 (inclusive), or the equivalent range in radians.
16547
16548 @pindex calc-imaginary
16549 The @code{calc-imaginary} command multiplies the number on the
16550 top of the stack by the imaginary number @expr{i = (0,1)}. This
16551 command is not normally bound to a key in Calc, but it is available
16552 on the @key{IMAG} button in Keypad mode.
16553
16554 @kindex f r
16555 @pindex calc-re
16556 @tindex re
16557 The @kbd{f r} (@code{calc-re}) [@code{re}] command replaces a complex number
16558 by its real part. This command has no effect on real numbers. (As an
16559 added convenience, @code{re} applied to a modulo form extracts
16560 the value part.)
16561
16562 @kindex f i
16563 @pindex calc-im
16564 @tindex im
16565 The @kbd{f i} (@code{calc-im}) [@code{im}] command replaces a complex number
16566 by its imaginary part; real numbers are converted to zero. With a vector
16567 or matrix argument, these functions operate element-wise.
16568
16569 @ignore
16570 @mindex v p
16571 @end ignore
16572 @kindex v p (complex)
16573 @kindex V p (complex)
16574 @pindex calc-pack
16575 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) command can pack the top two numbers on
16576 the stack into a composite object such as a complex number. With
16577 a prefix argument of @mathit{-1}, it produces a rectangular complex number;
16578 with an argument of @mathit{-2}, it produces a polar complex number.
16579 (Also, @pxref{Building Vectors}.)
16580
16581 @ignore
16582 @mindex v u
16583 @end ignore
16584 @kindex v u (complex)
16585 @kindex V u (complex)
16586 @pindex calc-unpack
16587 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the complex number
16588 (or other composite object) on the top of the stack and unpacks it
16589 into its separate components.
16590
16591 @node Conversions, Date Arithmetic, Complex Number Functions, Arithmetic
16592 @section Conversions
16593
16594 @noindent
16595 The commands described in this section convert numbers from one form
16596 to another; they are two-key sequences beginning with the letter @kbd{c}.
16597
16598 @kindex c f
16599 @pindex calc-float
16600 @tindex pfloat
16601 The @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) [@code{pfloat}] command converts the
16602 number on the top of the stack to floating-point form. For example,
16603 @expr{23} is converted to @expr{23.0}, @expr{3:2} is converted to
16604 @expr{1.5}, and @expr{2.3} is left the same. If the value is a composite
16605 object such as a complex number or vector, each of the components is
16606 converted to floating-point. If the value is a formula, all numbers
16607 in the formula are converted to floating-point. Note that depending
16608 on the current floating-point precision, conversion to floating-point
16609 format may lose information.
16610
16611 As a special exception, integers which appear as powers or subscripts
16612 are not floated by @kbd{c f}. If you really want to float a power,
16613 you can use a @kbd{j s} command to select the power followed by @kbd{c f}.
16614 Because @kbd{c f} cannot examine the formula outside of the selection,
16615 it does not notice that the thing being floated is a power.
16616 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}.
16617
16618 The normal @kbd{c f} command is ``pervasive'' in the sense that it
16619 applies to all numbers throughout the formula. The @code{pfloat}
16620 algebraic function never stays around in a formula; @samp{pfloat(a + 1)}
16621 changes to @samp{a + 1.0} as soon as it is evaluated.
16622
16623 @kindex H c f
16624 @tindex float
16625 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c f} [@code{float}] operates
16626 only on the number or vector of numbers at the top level of its
16627 argument. Thus, @samp{float(1)} is 1.0, but @samp{float(a + 1)}
16628 is left unevaluated because its argument is not a number.
16629
16630 You should use @kbd{H c f} if you wish to guarantee that the final
16631 value, once all the variables have been assigned, is a float; you
16632 would use @kbd{c f} if you wish to do the conversion on the numbers
16633 that appear right now.
16634
16635 @kindex c F
16636 @pindex calc-fraction
16637 @tindex pfrac
16638 The @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) [@code{pfrac}] command converts a
16639 floating-point number into a fractional approximation. By default, it
16640 produces a fraction whose decimal representation is the same as the
16641 input number, to within the current precision. You can also give a
16642 numeric prefix argument to specify a tolerance, either directly, or,
16643 if the prefix argument is zero, by using the number on top of the stack
16644 as the tolerance. If the tolerance is a positive integer, the fraction
16645 is correct to within that many significant figures. If the tolerance is
16646 a non-positive integer, it specifies how many digits fewer than the current
16647 precision to use. If the tolerance is a floating-point number, the
16648 fraction is correct to within that absolute amount.
16649
16650 @kindex H c F
16651 @tindex frac
16652 The @code{pfrac} function is pervasive, like @code{pfloat}.
16653 There is also a non-pervasive version, @kbd{H c F} [@code{frac}],
16654 which is analogous to @kbd{H c f} discussed above.
16655
16656 @kindex c d
16657 @pindex calc-to-degrees
16658 @tindex deg
16659 The @kbd{c d} (@code{calc-to-degrees}) [@code{deg}] command converts a
16660 number into degrees form. The value on the top of the stack may be an
16661 HMS form (interpreted as degrees-minutes-seconds), or a real number which
16662 will be interpreted in radians regardless of the current angular mode.
16663
16664 @kindex c r
16665 @pindex calc-to-radians
16666 @tindex rad
16667 The @kbd{c r} (@code{calc-to-radians}) [@code{rad}] command converts an
16668 HMS form or angle in degrees into an angle in radians.
16669
16670 @kindex c h
16671 @pindex calc-to-hms
16672 @tindex hms
16673 The @kbd{c h} (@code{calc-to-hms}) [@code{hms}] command converts a real
16674 number, interpreted according to the current angular mode, to an HMS
16675 form describing the same angle. In algebraic notation, the @code{hms}
16676 function also accepts three arguments: @samp{hms(@var{h}, @var{m}, @var{s})}.
16677 (The three-argument version is independent of the current angular mode.)
16678
16679 @pindex calc-from-hms
16680 The @code{calc-from-hms} command converts the HMS form on the top of the
16681 stack into a real number according to the current angular mode.
16682
16683 @kindex c p
16684 @kindex I c p
16685 @pindex calc-polar
16686 @tindex polar
16687 @tindex rect
16688 The @kbd{c p} (@code{calc-polar}) command converts the complex number on
16689 the top of the stack from polar to rectangular form, or from rectangular
16690 to polar form, whichever is appropriate. Real numbers are left the same.
16691 This command is equivalent to the @code{rect} or @code{polar}
16692 functions in algebraic formulas, depending on the direction of
16693 conversion. (It uses @code{polar}, except that if the argument is
16694 already a polar complex number, it uses @code{rect} instead. The
16695 @kbd{I c p} command always uses @code{rect}.)
16696
16697 @kindex c c
16698 @pindex calc-clean
16699 @tindex pclean
16700 The @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) [@code{pclean}] command ``cleans'' the
16701 number on the top of the stack. Floating point numbers are re-rounded
16702 according to the current precision. Polar numbers whose angular
16703 components have strayed from the @mathit{-180} to @mathit{+180} degree range
16704 are normalized. (Note that results will be undesirable if the current
16705 angular mode is different from the one under which the number was
16706 produced!) Integers and fractions are generally unaffected by this
16707 operation. Vectors and formulas are cleaned by cleaning each component
16708 number (i.e., pervasively).
16709
16710 If the simplification mode is set below the default level, it is raised
16711 to the default level for the purposes of this command. Thus, @kbd{c c}
16712 applies the default simplifications even if their automatic application
16713 is disabled. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
16714
16715 @cindex Roundoff errors, correcting
16716 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{c c} sets the floating-point precision
16717 to that value for the duration of the command. A positive prefix (of at
16718 least 3) sets the precision to the specified value; a negative or zero
16719 prefix decreases the precision by the specified amount.
16720
16721 @kindex c 0-9
16722 @pindex calc-clean-num
16723 The keystroke sequences @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} are equivalent
16724 to @kbd{c c} with the corresponding negative prefix argument. If roundoff
16725 errors have changed 2.0 into 1.999999, typing @kbd{c 1} to clip off one
16726 decimal place often conveniently does the trick.
16727
16728 The @kbd{c c} command with a numeric prefix argument, and the @kbd{c 0}
16729 through @kbd{c 9} commands, also ``clip'' very small floating-point
16730 numbers to zero. If the exponent is less than or equal to the negative
16731 of the specified precision, the number is changed to 0.0. For example,
16732 if the current precision is 12, then @kbd{c 2} changes the vector
16733 @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 1e-10, 1e-11]} to @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 0, 0]}.
16734 Numbers this small generally arise from roundoff noise.
16735
16736 If the numbers you are using really are legitimately this small,
16737 you should avoid using the @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} commands.
16738 (The plain @kbd{c c} command rounds to the current precision but
16739 does not clip small numbers.)
16740
16741 One more property of @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}, and of @kbd{c c} with
16742 a prefix argument, is that integer-valued floats are converted to
16743 plain integers, so that @kbd{c 1} on @samp{[1., 1.5, 2., 2.5, 3.]}
16744 produces @samp{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3]}. This is not done for huge
16745 numbers (@samp{1e100} is technically an integer-valued float, but
16746 you wouldn't want it automatically converted to a 100-digit integer).
16747
16748 @kindex H c 0-9
16749 @kindex H c c
16750 @tindex clean
16751 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c c} and @kbd{H c 0} through @kbd{H c 9}
16752 operate non-pervasively [@code{clean}].
16753
16754 @node Date Arithmetic, Financial Functions, Conversions, Arithmetic
16755 @section Date Arithmetic
16756
16757 @noindent
16758 @cindex Date arithmetic, additional functions
16759 The commands described in this section perform various conversions
16760 and calculations involving date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). They
16761 use the @kbd{t} (for time/date) prefix key followed by shifted
16762 letters.
16763
16764 The simplest date arithmetic is done using the regular @kbd{+} and @kbd{-}
16765 commands. In particular, adding a number to a date form advances the
16766 date form by a certain number of days; adding an HMS form to a date
16767 form advances the date by a certain amount of time; and subtracting two
16768 date forms produces a difference measured in days. The commands
16769 described here provide additional, more specialized operations on dates.
16770
16771 Many of these commands accept a numeric prefix argument; if you give
16772 plain @kbd{C-u} as the prefix, these commands will instead take the
16773 additional argument from the top of the stack.
16774
16775 @menu
16776 * Date Conversions::
16777 * Date Functions::
16778 * Time Zones::
16779 * Business Days::
16780 @end menu
16781
16782 @node Date Conversions, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic, Date Arithmetic
16783 @subsection Date Conversions
16784
16785 @noindent
16786 @kindex t D
16787 @pindex calc-date
16788 @tindex date
16789 The @kbd{t D} (@code{calc-date}) [@code{date}] command converts a
16790 date form into a number, measured in days since Jan 1, 1 AD. The
16791 result will be an integer if @var{date} is a pure date form, or a
16792 fraction or float if @var{date} is a date/time form. Or, if its
16793 argument is a number, it converts this number into a date form.
16794
16795 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{t D} takes that many objects
16796 (up to six) from the top of the stack and interprets them in one
16797 of the following ways:
16798
16799 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day})} function
16800 builds a pure date form out of the specified year, month, and
16801 day, which must all be integers. @var{Year} is a year number,
16802 such as 1991 (@emph{not} the same as 91!). @var{Month} must be
16803 an integer in the range 1 to 12; @var{day} must be in the range
16804 1 to 31. If the specified month has fewer than 31 days and
16805 @var{day} is too large, the equivalent day in the following
16806 month will be used.
16807
16808 The @samp{date(@var{month}, @var{day})} function builds a
16809 pure date form using the current year, as determined by the
16810 real-time clock.
16811
16812 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hms})}
16813 function builds a date/time form using an @var{hms} form.
16814
16815 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hour},
16816 @var{minute}, @var{second})} function builds a date/time form.
16817 @var{hour} should be an integer in the range 0 to 23;
16818 @var{minute} should be an integer in the range 0 to 59;
16819 @var{second} should be any real number in the range @samp{[0 .. 60)}.
16820 The last two arguments default to zero if omitted.
16821
16822 @kindex t J
16823 @pindex calc-julian
16824 @tindex julian
16825 @cindex Julian day counts, conversions
16826 The @kbd{t J} (@code{calc-julian}) [@code{julian}] command converts
16827 a date form into a Julian day count, which is the number of days
16828 since noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC. A pure date is converted to an
16829 integer Julian count representing noon of that day. A date/time form
16830 is converted to an exact floating-point Julian count, adjusted to
16831 interpret the date form in the current time zone but the Julian
16832 day count in Greenwich Mean Time. A numeric prefix argument allows
16833 you to specify the time zone; @pxref{Time Zones}. Use a prefix of
16834 zero to suppress the time zone adjustment. Note that pure date forms
16835 are never time-zone adjusted.
16836
16837 This command can also do the opposite conversion, from a Julian day
16838 count (either an integer day, or a floating-point day and time in
16839 the GMT zone), into a pure date form or a date/time form in the
16840 current or specified time zone.
16841
16842 @kindex t U
16843 @pindex calc-unix-time
16844 @tindex unixtime
16845 @cindex Unix time format, conversions
16846 The @kbd{t U} (@code{calc-unix-time}) [@code{unixtime}] command
16847 converts a date form into a Unix time value, which is the number of
16848 seconds since midnight on Jan 1, 1970, or vice-versa. The numeric result
16849 will be an integer if the current precision is 12 or less; for higher
16850 precisions, the result may be a float with (@var{precision}@minus{}12)
16851 digits after the decimal. Just as for @kbd{t J}, the numeric time
16852 is interpreted in the GMT time zone and the date form is interpreted
16853 in the current or specified zone. Some systems use Unix-like
16854 numbering but with the local time zone; give a prefix of zero to
16855 suppress the adjustment if so.
16856
16857 @kindex t C
16858 @pindex calc-convert-time-zones
16859 @tindex tzconv
16860 @cindex Time Zones, converting between
16861 The @kbd{t C} (@code{calc-convert-time-zones}) [@code{tzconv}]
16862 command converts a date form from one time zone to another. You
16863 are prompted for each time zone name in turn; you can answer with
16864 any suitable Calc time zone expression (@pxref{Time Zones}).
16865 If you answer either prompt with a blank line, the local time
16866 zone is used for that prompt. You can also answer the first
16867 prompt with @kbd{$} to take the two time zone names from the
16868 stack (and the date to be converted from the third stack level).
16869
16870 @node Date Functions, Business Days, Date Conversions, Date Arithmetic
16871 @subsection Date Functions
16872
16873 @noindent
16874 @kindex t N
16875 @pindex calc-now
16876 @tindex now
16877 The @kbd{t N} (@code{calc-now}) [@code{now}] command pushes the
16878 current date and time on the stack as a date form. The time is
16879 reported in terms of the specified time zone; with no numeric prefix
16880 argument, @kbd{t N} reports for the current time zone.
16881
16882 @kindex t P
16883 @pindex calc-date-part
16884 The @kbd{t P} (@code{calc-date-part}) command extracts one part
16885 of a date form. The prefix argument specifies the part; with no
16886 argument, this command prompts for a part code from 1 to 9.
16887 The various part codes are described in the following paragraphs.
16888
16889 @tindex year
16890 The @kbd{M-1 t P} [@code{year}] function extracts the year number
16891 from a date form as an integer, e.g., 1991. This and the
16892 following functions will also accept a real number for an
16893 argument, which is interpreted as a standard Calc day number.
16894 Note that this function will never return zero, since the year
16895 1 BC immediately precedes the year 1 AD.
16896
16897 @tindex month
16898 The @kbd{M-2 t P} [@code{month}] function extracts the month number
16899 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 12.
16900
16901 @tindex day
16902 The @kbd{M-3 t P} [@code{day}] function extracts the day number
16903 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 31.
16904
16905 @tindex hour
16906 The @kbd{M-4 t P} [@code{hour}] function extracts the hour from
16907 a date form as an integer in the range 0 (midnight) to 23. Note
16908 that 24-hour time is always used. This returns zero for a pure
16909 date form. This function (and the following two) also accept
16910 HMS forms as input.
16911
16912 @tindex minute
16913 The @kbd{M-5 t P} [@code{minute}] function extracts the minute
16914 from a date form as an integer in the range 0 to 59.
16915
16916 @tindex second
16917 The @kbd{M-6 t P} [@code{second}] function extracts the second
16918 from a date form. If the current precision is 12 or less,
16919 the result is an integer in the range 0 to 59. For higher
16920 precisions, the result may instead be a floating-point number.
16921
16922 @tindex weekday
16923 The @kbd{M-7 t P} [@code{weekday}] function extracts the weekday
16924 number from a date form as an integer in the range 0 (Sunday)
16925 to 6 (Saturday).
16926
16927 @tindex yearday
16928 The @kbd{M-8 t P} [@code{yearday}] function extracts the day-of-year
16929 number from a date form as an integer in the range 1 (January 1)
16930 to 366 (December 31 of a leap year).
16931
16932 @tindex time
16933 The @kbd{M-9 t P} [@code{time}] function extracts the time portion
16934 of a date form as an HMS form. This returns @samp{0@@ 0' 0"}
16935 for a pure date form.
16936
16937 @kindex t M
16938 @pindex calc-new-month
16939 @tindex newmonth
16940 The @kbd{t M} (@code{calc-new-month}) [@code{newmonth}] command
16941 computes a new date form that represents the first day of the month
16942 specified by the input date. The result is always a pure date
16943 form; only the year and month numbers of the input are retained.
16944 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n} in the range from 1 to 31,
16945 @kbd{t M} computes the @var{n}th day of the month. (If @var{n}
16946 is greater than the actual number of days in the month, or if
16947 @var{n} is zero, the last day of the month is used.)
16948
16949 @kindex t Y
16950 @pindex calc-new-year
16951 @tindex newyear
16952 The @kbd{t Y} (@code{calc-new-year}) [@code{newyear}] command
16953 computes a new pure date form that represents the first day of
16954 the year specified by the input. The month, day, and time
16955 of the input date form are lost. With a numeric prefix argument
16956 @var{n} in the range from 1 to 366, @kbd{t Y} computes the
16957 @var{n}th day of the year (366 is treated as 365 in non-leap
16958 years). A prefix argument of 0 computes the last day of the
16959 year (December 31). A negative prefix argument from @mathit{-1} to
16960 @mathit{-12} computes the first day of the @var{n}th month of the year.
16961
16962 @kindex t W
16963 @pindex calc-new-week
16964 @tindex newweek
16965 The @kbd{t W} (@code{calc-new-week}) [@code{newweek}] command
16966 computes a new pure date form that represents the Sunday on or before
16967 the input date. With a numeric prefix argument, it can be made to
16968 use any day of the week as the starting day; the argument must be in
16969 the range from 0 (Sunday) to 6 (Saturday). This function always
16970 subtracts between 0 and 6 days from the input date.
16971
16972 Here's an example use of @code{newweek}: Find the date of the next
16973 Wednesday after a given date. Using @kbd{M-3 t W} or @samp{newweek(d, 3)}
16974 will give you the @emph{preceding} Wednesday, so @samp{newweek(d+7, 3)}
16975 will give you the following Wednesday. A further look at the definition
16976 of @code{newweek} shows that if the input date is itself a Wednesday,
16977 this formula will return the Wednesday one week in the future. An
16978 exercise for the reader is to modify this formula to yield the same day
16979 if the input is already a Wednesday. Another interesting exercise is
16980 to preserve the time-of-day portion of the input (@code{newweek} resets
16981 the time to midnight; hint:@: how can @code{newweek} be defined in terms
16982 of the @code{weekday} function?).
16983
16984 @ignore
16985 @starindex
16986 @end ignore
16987 @tindex pwday
16988 The @samp{pwday(@var{date})} function (not on any key) computes the
16989 day-of-month number of the Sunday on or before @var{date}. With
16990 two arguments, @samp{pwday(@var{date}, @var{day})} computes the day
16991 number of the Sunday on or before day number @var{day} of the month
16992 specified by @var{date}. The @var{day} must be in the range from
16993 7 to 31; if the day number is greater than the actual number of days
16994 in the month, the true number of days is used instead. Thus
16995 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 7)} finds the first Sunday of the month, and
16996 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 31)} finds the last Sunday of the month.
16997 With a third @var{weekday} argument, @code{pwday} can be made to look
16998 for any day of the week instead of Sunday.
16999
17000 @kindex t I
17001 @pindex calc-inc-month
17002 @tindex incmonth
17003 The @kbd{t I} (@code{calc-inc-month}) [@code{incmonth}] command
17004 increases a date form by one month, or by an arbitrary number of
17005 months specified by a numeric prefix argument. The time portion,
17006 if any, of the date form stays the same. The day also stays the
17007 same, except that if the new month has fewer days the day
17008 number may be reduced to lie in the valid range. For example,
17009 @samp{incmonth(<Jan 31, 1991>)} produces @samp{<Feb 28, 1991>}.
17010 Because of this, @kbd{t I t I} and @kbd{M-2 t I} do not always give
17011 the same results (@samp{<Mar 28, 1991>} versus @samp{<Mar 31, 1991>}
17012 in this case).
17013
17014 @ignore
17015 @starindex
17016 @end ignore
17017 @tindex incyear
17018 The @samp{incyear(@var{date}, @var{step})} function increases
17019 a date form by the specified number of years, which may be
17020 any positive or negative integer. Note that @samp{incyear(d, n)}
17021 is equivalent to @w{@samp{incmonth(d, 12*n)}}, but these do not have
17022 simple equivalents in terms of day arithmetic because
17023 months and years have varying lengths. If the @var{step}
17024 argument is omitted, 1 year is assumed. There is no keyboard
17025 command for this function; use @kbd{C-u 12 t I} instead.
17026
17027 There is no @code{newday} function at all because @kbd{F} [@code{floor}]
17028 serves this purpose. Similarly, instead of @code{incday} and
17029 @code{incweek} simply use @expr{d + n} or @expr{d + 7 n}.
17030
17031 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}, for the @kbd{f ]} [@code{incr}] command
17032 which can adjust a date/time form by a certain number of seconds.
17033
17034 @node Business Days, Time Zones, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic
17035 @subsection Business Days
17036
17037 @noindent
17038 Often time is measured in ``business days'' or ``working days,''
17039 where weekends and holidays are skipped. Calc's normal date
17040 arithmetic functions use calendar days, so that subtracting two
17041 consecutive Mondays will yield a difference of 7 days. By contrast,
17042 subtracting two consecutive Mondays would yield 5 business days
17043 (assuming two-day weekends and the absence of holidays).
17044
17045 @kindex t +
17046 @kindex t -
17047 @tindex badd
17048 @tindex bsub
17049 @pindex calc-business-days-plus
17050 @pindex calc-business-days-minus
17051 The @kbd{t +} (@code{calc-business-days-plus}) [@code{badd}]
17052 and @kbd{t -} (@code{calc-business-days-minus}) [@code{bsub}]
17053 commands perform arithmetic using business days. For @kbd{t +},
17054 one argument must be a date form and the other must be a real
17055 number (positive or negative). If the number is not an integer,
17056 then a certain amount of time is added as well as a number of
17057 days; for example, adding 0.5 business days to a time in Friday
17058 evening will produce a time in Monday morning. It is also
17059 possible to add an HMS form; adding @samp{12@@ 0' 0"} also adds
17060 half a business day. For @kbd{t -}, the arguments are either a
17061 date form and a number or HMS form, or two date forms, in which
17062 case the result is the number of business days between the two
17063 dates.
17064
17065 @cindex @code{Holidays} variable
17066 @vindex Holidays
17067 By default, Calc considers any day that is not a Saturday or
17068 Sunday to be a business day. You can define any number of
17069 additional holidays by editing the variable @code{Holidays}.
17070 (There is an @w{@kbd{s H}} convenience command for editing this
17071 variable.) Initially, @code{Holidays} contains the vector
17072 @samp{[sat, sun]}. Entries in the @code{Holidays} vector may
17073 be any of the following kinds of objects:
17074
17075 @itemize @bullet
17076 @item
17077 Date forms (pure dates, not date/time forms). These specify
17078 particular days which are to be treated as holidays.
17079
17080 @item
17081 Intervals of date forms. These specify a range of days, all of
17082 which are holidays (e.g., Christmas week). @xref{Interval Forms}.
17083
17084 @item
17085 Nested vectors of date forms. Each date form in the vector is
17086 considered to be a holiday.
17087
17088 @item
17089 Any Calc formula which evaluates to one of the above three things.
17090 If the formula involves the variable @expr{y}, it stands for a
17091 yearly repeating holiday; @expr{y} will take on various year
17092 numbers like 1992. For example, @samp{date(y, 12, 25)} specifies
17093 Christmas day, and @samp{newweek(date(y, 11, 7), 4) + 21} specifies
17094 Thanksgiving (which is held on the fourth Thursday of November).
17095 If the formula involves the variable @expr{m}, that variable
17096 takes on month numbers from 1 to 12: @samp{date(y, m, 15)} is
17097 a holiday that takes place on the 15th of every month.
17098
17099 @item
17100 A weekday name, such as @code{sat} or @code{sun}. This is really
17101 a variable whose name is a three-letter, lower-case day name.
17102
17103 @item
17104 An interval of year numbers (integers). This specifies the span of
17105 years over which this holiday list is to be considered valid. Any
17106 business-day arithmetic that goes outside this range will result
17107 in an error message. Use this if you are including an explicit
17108 list of holidays, rather than a formula to generate them, and you
17109 want to make sure you don't accidentally go beyond the last point
17110 where the holidays you entered are complete. If there is no
17111 limiting interval in the @code{Holidays} vector, the default
17112 @samp{[1 .. 2737]} is used. (This is the absolute range of years
17113 for which Calc's business-day algorithms will operate.)
17114
17115 @item
17116 An interval of HMS forms. This specifies the span of hours that
17117 are to be considered one business day. For example, if this
17118 range is @samp{[9@@ 0' 0" .. 17@@ 0' 0"]} (i.e., 9am to 5pm), then
17119 the business day is only eight hours long, so that @kbd{1.5 t +}
17120 on @samp{<4:00pm Fri Dec 13, 1991>} will add one business day and
17121 four business hours to produce @samp{<12:00pm Tue Dec 17, 1991>}.
17122 Likewise, @kbd{t -} will now express differences in time as
17123 fractions of an eight-hour day. Times before 9am will be treated
17124 as 9am by business date arithmetic, and times at or after 5pm will
17125 be treated as 4:59:59pm. If there is no HMS interval in @code{Holidays},
17126 the full 24-hour day @samp{[0@ 0' 0" .. 24@ 0' 0"]} is assumed.
17127 (Regardless of the type of bounds you specify, the interval is
17128 treated as inclusive on the low end and exclusive on the high end,
17129 so that the work day goes from 9am up to, but not including, 5pm.)
17130 @end itemize
17131
17132 If the @code{Holidays} vector is empty, then @kbd{t +} and
17133 @kbd{t -} will act just like @kbd{+} and @kbd{-} because there will
17134 then be no difference between business days and calendar days.
17135
17136 Calc expands the intervals and formulas you give into a complete
17137 list of holidays for internal use. This is done mainly to make
17138 sure it can detect multiple holidays. (For example,
17139 @samp{<Jan 1, 1989>} is both New Year's Day and a Sunday, but
17140 Calc's algorithms take care to count it only once when figuring
17141 the number of holidays between two dates.)
17142
17143 Since the complete list of holidays for all the years from 1 to
17144 2737 would be huge, Calc actually computes only the part of the
17145 list between the smallest and largest years that have been involved
17146 in business-day calculations so far. Normally, you won't have to
17147 worry about this. Keep in mind, however, that if you do one
17148 calculation for 1992, and another for 1792, even if both involve
17149 only a small range of years, Calc will still work out all the
17150 holidays that fall in that 200-year span.
17151
17152 If you add a (positive) number of days to a date form that falls on a
17153 weekend or holiday, the date form is treated as if it were the most
17154 recent business day. (Thus adding one business day to a Friday,
17155 Saturday, or Sunday will all yield the following Monday.) If you
17156 subtract a number of days from a weekend or holiday, the date is
17157 effectively on the following business day. (So subtracting one business
17158 day from Saturday, Sunday, or Monday yields the preceding Friday.) The
17159 difference between two dates one or both of which fall on holidays
17160 equals the number of actual business days between them. These
17161 conventions are consistent in the sense that, if you add @var{n}
17162 business days to any date, the difference between the result and the
17163 original date will come out to @var{n} business days. (It can't be
17164 completely consistent though; a subtraction followed by an addition
17165 might come out a bit differently, since @kbd{t +} is incapable of
17166 producing a date that falls on a weekend or holiday.)
17167
17168 @ignore
17169 @starindex
17170 @end ignore
17171 @tindex holiday
17172 There is a @code{holiday} function, not on any keys, that takes
17173 any date form and returns 1 if that date falls on a weekend or
17174 holiday, as defined in @code{Holidays}, or 0 if the date is a
17175 business day.
17176
17177 @node Time Zones, , Business Days, Date Arithmetic
17178 @subsection Time Zones
17179
17180 @noindent
17181 @cindex Time zones
17182 @cindex Daylight saving time
17183 Time zones and daylight saving time are a complicated business.
17184 The conversions to and from Julian and Unix-style dates automatically
17185 compute the correct time zone and daylight saving adjustment to use,
17186 provided they can figure out this information. This section describes
17187 Calc's time zone adjustment algorithm in detail, in case you want to
17188 do conversions in different time zones or in case Calc's algorithms
17189 can't determine the right correction to use.
17190
17191 Adjustments for time zones and daylight saving time are done by
17192 @kbd{t U}, @kbd{t J}, @kbd{t N}, and @kbd{t C}, but not by any other
17193 commands. In particular, @samp{<may 1 1991> - <apr 1 1991>} evaluates
17194 to exactly 30 days even though there is a daylight-saving
17195 transition in between. This is also true for Julian pure dates:
17196 @samp{julian(<may 1 1991>) - julian(<apr 1 1991>)}. But Julian
17197 and Unix date/times will adjust for daylight saving time: using Calc's
17198 default daylight saving time rule (see the explanation below),
17199 @samp{julian(<12am may 1 1991>) - julian(<12am apr 1 1991>)}
17200 evaluates to @samp{29.95833} (that's 29 days and 23 hours)
17201 because one hour was lost when daylight saving commenced on
17202 April 7, 1991.
17203
17204 In brief, the idiom @samp{julian(@var{date1}) - julian(@var{date2})}
17205 computes the actual number of 24-hour periods between two dates, whereas
17206 @samp{@var{date1} - @var{date2}} computes the number of calendar
17207 days between two dates without taking daylight saving into account.
17208
17209 @pindex calc-time-zone
17210 @ignore
17211 @starindex
17212 @end ignore
17213 @tindex tzone
17214 The @code{calc-time-zone} [@code{tzone}] command converts the time
17215 zone specified by its numeric prefix argument into a number of
17216 seconds difference from Greenwich mean time (GMT). If the argument
17217 is a number, the result is simply that value multiplied by 3600.
17218 Typical arguments for North America are 5 (Eastern) or 8 (Pacific). If
17219 Daylight Saving time is in effect, one hour should be subtracted from
17220 the normal difference.
17221
17222 If you give a prefix of plain @kbd{C-u}, @code{calc-time-zone} (like other
17223 date arithmetic commands that include a time zone argument) takes the
17224 zone argument from the top of the stack. (In the case of @kbd{t J}
17225 and @kbd{t U}, the normal argument is then taken from the second-to-top
17226 stack position.) This allows you to give a non-integer time zone
17227 adjustment. The time-zone argument can also be an HMS form, or
17228 it can be a variable which is a time zone name in upper- or lower-case.
17229 For example @samp{tzone(PST) = tzone(8)} and @samp{tzone(pdt) = tzone(7)}
17230 (for Pacific standard and daylight saving times, respectively).
17231
17232 North American and European time zone names are defined as follows;
17233 note that for each time zone there is one name for standard time,
17234 another for daylight saving time, and a third for ``generalized'' time
17235 in which the daylight saving adjustment is computed from context.
17236
17237 @smallexample
17238 @group
17239 YST PST MST CST EST AST NST GMT WET MET MEZ
17240 9 8 7 6 5 4 3.5 0 -1 -2 -2
17241
17242 YDT PDT MDT CDT EDT ADT NDT BST WETDST METDST MESZ
17243 8 7 6 5 4 3 2.5 -1 -2 -3 -3
17244
17245 YGT PGT MGT CGT EGT AGT NGT BGT WEGT MEGT MEGZ
17246 9/8 8/7 7/6 6/5 5/4 4/3 3.5/2.5 0/-1 -1/-2 -2/-3 -2/-3
17247 @end group
17248 @end smallexample
17249
17250 @vindex math-tzone-names
17251 To define time zone names that do not appear in the above table,
17252 you must modify the Lisp variable @code{math-tzone-names}. This
17253 is a list of lists describing the different time zone names; its
17254 structure is best explained by an example. The three entries for
17255 Pacific Time look like this:
17256
17257 @smallexample
17258 @group
17259 ( ( "PST" 8 0 ) ; Name as an upper-case string, then standard
17260 ( "PDT" 8 -1 ) ; adjustment, then daylight saving adjustment.
17261 ( "PGT" 8 "PST" "PDT" ) ) ; Generalized time zone.
17262 @end group
17263 @end smallexample
17264
17265 @cindex @code{TimeZone} variable
17266 @vindex TimeZone
17267 With no arguments, @code{calc-time-zone} or @samp{tzone()} will by
17268 default get the time zone and daylight saving information from the
17269 calendar (@pxref{Daylight Saving,Calendar/Diary,The Calendar and the Diary,
17270 emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}). To use a different time zone, or if the
17271 calendar does not give the desired result, you can set the Calc variable
17272 @code{TimeZone} (which is by default @code{nil}) to an appropriate
17273 time zone name. (The easiest way to do this is to edit the
17274 @code{TimeZone} variable using Calc's @kbd{s T} command, then use the
17275 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save the value of
17276 @code{TimeZone} permanently.)
17277 If the time zone given by @code{TimeZone} is a generalized time zone,
17278 e.g., @code{EGT}, Calc examines the date being converted to tell whether
17279 to use standard or daylight saving time. But if the current time zone
17280 is explicit, e.g., @code{EST} or @code{EDT}, then that adjustment is
17281 used exactly and Calc's daylight saving algorithm is not consulted.
17282 The special time zone name @code{local}
17283 is equivalent to no argument; i.e., it uses the information obtained
17284 from the calendar.
17285
17286 The @kbd{t J} and @code{t U} commands with no numeric prefix
17287 arguments do the same thing as @samp{tzone()}; namely, use the
17288 information from the calendar if @code{TimeZone} is @code{nil},
17289 otherwise use the time zone given by @code{TimeZone}.
17290
17291 @vindex math-daylight-savings-hook
17292 @findex math-std-daylight-savings
17293 When Calc computes the daylight saving information itself (i.e., when
17294 the @code{TimeZone} variable is set), it will by default consider
17295 daylight saving time to begin at 2 a.m.@: on the second Sunday of March
17296 (for years from 2007 on) or on the last Sunday in April (for years
17297 before 2007), and to end at 2 a.m.@: on the first Sunday of
17298 November. (for years from 2007 on) or the last Sunday in October (for
17299 years before 2007). These are the rules that have been in effect in
17300 much of North America since 1966 and take into account the rule change
17301 that began in 2007. If you are in a country that uses different rules
17302 for computing daylight saving time, you have two choices: Write your own
17303 daylight saving hook, or control time zones explicitly by setting the
17304 @code{TimeZone} variable and/or always giving a time-zone argument for
17305 the conversion functions.
17306
17307 The Lisp variable @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} holds the
17308 name of a function that is used to compute the daylight saving
17309 adjustment for a given date. The default is
17310 @code{math-std-daylight-savings}, which computes an adjustment
17311 (either 0 or @mathit{-1}) using the North American rules given above.
17312
17313 The daylight saving hook function is called with four arguments:
17314 The date, as a floating-point number in standard Calc format;
17315 a six-element list of the date decomposed into year, month, day,
17316 hour, minute, and second, respectively; a string which contains
17317 the generalized time zone name in upper-case, e.g., @code{"WEGT"};
17318 and a special adjustment to be applied to the hour value when
17319 converting into a generalized time zone (see below).
17320
17321 @findex math-prev-weekday-in-month
17322 The Lisp function @code{math-prev-weekday-in-month} is useful for
17323 daylight saving computations. This is an internal version of
17324 the user-level @code{pwday} function described in the previous
17325 section. It takes four arguments: The floating-point date value,
17326 the corresponding six-element date list, the day-of-month number,
17327 and the weekday number (0-6).
17328
17329 The default daylight saving hook ignores the time zone name, but a
17330 more sophisticated hook could use different algorithms for different
17331 time zones. It would also be possible to use different algorithms
17332 depending on the year number, but the default hook always uses the
17333 algorithm for 1987 and later. Here is a listing of the default
17334 daylight saving hook:
17335
17336 @smallexample
17337 (defun math-std-daylight-savings (date dt zone bump)
17338 (cond ((< (nth 1 dt) 4) 0)
17339 ((= (nth 1 dt) 4)
17340 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 7 0)))
17341 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) 0)
17342 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17343 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 3 bump)) -1 0))
17344 (t -1))))
17345 ((< (nth 1 dt) 10) -1)
17346 ((= (nth 1 dt) 10)
17347 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 31 0)))
17348 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) -1)
17349 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17350 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 2 bump)) 0 -1))
17351 (t 0))))
17352 (t 0))
17353 )
17354 @end smallexample
17355
17356 @noindent
17357 The @code{bump} parameter is equal to zero when Calc is converting
17358 from a date form in a generalized time zone into a GMT date value.
17359 It is @mathit{-1} when Calc is converting in the other direction. The
17360 adjustments shown above ensure that the conversion behaves correctly
17361 and reasonably around the 2 a.m.@: transition in each direction.
17362
17363 There is a ``missing'' hour between 2 a.m.@: and 3 a.m.@: at the
17364 beginning of daylight saving time; converting a date/time form that
17365 falls in this hour results in a time value for the following hour,
17366 from 3 a.m.@: to 4 a.m. At the end of daylight saving time, the
17367 hour from 1 a.m.@: to 2 a.m.@: repeats itself; converting a date/time
17368 form that falls in this hour results in a time value for the first
17369 manifestation of that time (@emph{not} the one that occurs one hour
17370 later).
17371
17372 If @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} is @code{nil}, then the
17373 daylight saving adjustment is always taken to be zero.
17374
17375 In algebraic formulas, @samp{tzone(@var{zone}, @var{date})}
17376 computes the time zone adjustment for a given zone name at a
17377 given date. The @var{date} is ignored unless @var{zone} is a
17378 generalized time zone. If @var{date} is a date form, the
17379 daylight saving computation is applied to it as it appears.
17380 If @var{date} is a numeric date value, it is adjusted for the
17381 daylight-saving version of @var{zone} before being given to
17382 the daylight saving hook. This odd-sounding rule ensures
17383 that the daylight-saving computation is always done in
17384 local time, not in the GMT time that a numeric @var{date}
17385 is typically represented in.
17386
17387 @ignore
17388 @starindex
17389 @end ignore
17390 @tindex dsadj
17391 The @samp{dsadj(@var{date}, @var{zone})} function computes the
17392 daylight saving adjustment that is appropriate for @var{date} in
17393 time zone @var{zone}. If @var{zone} is explicitly in or not in
17394 daylight saving time (e.g., @code{PDT} or @code{PST}) the
17395 @var{date} is ignored. If @var{zone} is a generalized time zone,
17396 the algorithms described above are used. If @var{zone} is omitted,
17397 the computation is done for the current time zone.
17398
17399 @node Financial Functions, Binary Functions, Date Arithmetic, Arithmetic
17400 @section Financial Functions
17401
17402 @noindent
17403 Calc's financial or business functions use the @kbd{b} prefix
17404 key followed by a shifted letter. (The @kbd{b} prefix followed by
17405 a lower-case letter is used for operations on binary numbers.)
17406
17407 Note that the rate and the number of intervals given to these
17408 functions must be on the same time scale, e.g., both months or
17409 both years. Mixing an annual interest rate with a time expressed
17410 in months will give you very wrong answers!
17411
17412 It is wise to compute these functions to a higher precision than
17413 you really need, just to make sure your answer is correct to the
17414 last penny; also, you may wish to check the definitions at the end
17415 of this section to make sure the functions have the meaning you expect.
17416
17417 @menu
17418 * Percentages::
17419 * Future Value::
17420 * Present Value::
17421 * Related Financial Functions::
17422 * Depreciation Functions::
17423 * Definitions of Financial Functions::
17424 @end menu
17425
17426 @node Percentages, Future Value, Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17427 @subsection Percentages
17428
17429 @kindex M-%
17430 @pindex calc-percent
17431 @tindex %
17432 @tindex percent
17433 The @kbd{M-%} (@code{calc-percent}) command takes a percentage value,
17434 say 5.4, and converts it to an equivalent actual number. For example,
17435 @kbd{5.4 M-%} enters 0.054 on the stack. (That's the @key{META} or
17436 @key{ESC} key combined with @kbd{%}.)
17437
17438 Actually, @kbd{M-%} creates a formula of the form @samp{5.4%}.
17439 You can enter @samp{5.4%} yourself during algebraic entry. The
17440 @samp{%} operator simply means, ``the preceding value divided by
17441 100.'' The @samp{%} operator has very high precedence, so that
17442 @samp{1+8%} is interpreted as @samp{1+(8%)}, not as @samp{(1+8)%}.
17443 (The @samp{%} operator is just a postfix notation for the
17444 @code{percent} function, just like @samp{20!} is the notation for
17445 @samp{fact(20)}, or twenty-factorial.)
17446
17447 The formula @samp{5.4%} would normally evaluate immediately to
17448 0.054, but the @kbd{M-%} command suppresses evaluation as it puts
17449 the formula onto the stack. However, the next Calc command that
17450 uses the formula @samp{5.4%} will evaluate it as its first step.
17451 The net effect is that you get to look at @samp{5.4%} on the stack,
17452 but Calc commands see it as @samp{0.054}, which is what they expect.
17453
17454 In particular, @samp{5.4%} and @samp{0.054} are suitable values
17455 for the @var{rate} arguments of the various financial functions,
17456 but the number @samp{5.4} is probably @emph{not} suitable---it
17457 represents a rate of 540 percent!
17458
17459 The key sequence @kbd{M-% *} effectively means ``percent-of.''
17460 For example, @kbd{68 @key{RET} 25 M-% *} computes 17, which is 25% of
17461 68 (and also 68% of 25, which comes out to the same thing).
17462
17463 @kindex c %
17464 @pindex calc-convert-percent
17465 The @kbd{c %} (@code{calc-convert-percent}) command converts the
17466 value on the top of the stack from numeric to percentage form.
17467 For example, if 0.08 is on the stack, @kbd{c %} converts it to
17468 @samp{8%}. The quantity is the same, it's just represented
17469 differently. (Contrast this with @kbd{M-%}, which would convert
17470 this number to @samp{0.08%}.) The @kbd{=} key is a convenient way
17471 to convert a formula like @samp{8%} back to numeric form, 0.08.
17472
17473 To compute what percentage one quantity is of another quantity,
17474 use @kbd{/ c %}. For example, @w{@kbd{17 @key{RET} 68 / c %}} displays
17475 @samp{25%}.
17476
17477 @kindex b %
17478 @pindex calc-percent-change
17479 @tindex relch
17480 The @kbd{b %} (@code{calc-percent-change}) [@code{relch}] command
17481 calculates the percentage change from one number to another.
17482 For example, @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} produces the answer @samp{25%},
17483 since 50 is 25% larger than 40. A negative result represents a
17484 decrease: @kbd{50 @key{RET} 40 b %} produces @samp{-20%}, since 40 is
17485 20% smaller than 50. (The answers are different in magnitude
17486 because, in the first case, we're increasing by 25% of 40, but
17487 in the second case, we're decreasing by 20% of 50.) The effect
17488 of @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} is to compute @expr{(50-40)/40}, converting
17489 the answer to percentage form as if by @kbd{c %}.
17490
17491 @node Future Value, Present Value, Percentages, Financial Functions
17492 @subsection Future Value
17493
17494 @noindent
17495 @kindex b F
17496 @pindex calc-fin-fv
17497 @tindex fv
17498 The @kbd{b F} (@code{calc-fin-fv}) [@code{fv}] command computes
17499 the future value of an investment. It takes three arguments
17500 from the stack: @samp{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17501 If you give payments of @var{payment} every year for @var{n}
17502 years, and the money you have paid earns interest at @var{rate} per
17503 year, then this function tells you what your investment would be
17504 worth at the end of the period. (The actual interval doesn't
17505 have to be years, as long as @var{n} and @var{rate} are expressed
17506 in terms of the same intervals.) This function assumes payments
17507 occur at the @emph{end} of each interval.
17508
17509 @kindex I b F
17510 @tindex fvb
17511 The @kbd{I b F} [@code{fvb}] command does the same computation,
17512 but assuming your payments are at the beginning of each interval.
17513 Suppose you plan to deposit $1000 per year in a savings account
17514 earning 5.4% interest, starting right now. How much will be
17515 in the account after five years? @code{fvb(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5870.73}.
17516 Thus you will have earned $870 worth of interest over the years.
17517 Using the stack, this calculation would have been
17518 @kbd{5.4 M-% 5 @key{RET} 1000 I b F}. Note that the rate is expressed
17519 as a number between 0 and 1, @emph{not} as a percentage.
17520
17521 @kindex H b F
17522 @tindex fvl
17523 The @kbd{H b F} [@code{fvl}] command computes the future value
17524 of an initial lump sum investment. Suppose you could deposit
17525 those five thousand dollars in the bank right now; how much would
17526 they be worth in five years? @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 5000) = 6503.89}.
17527
17528 The algebraic functions @code{fv} and @code{fvb} accept an optional
17529 fourth argument, which is used as an initial lump sum in the sense
17530 of @code{fvl}. In other words, @code{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17531 @var{payment}, @var{initial}) = fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})
17532 + fvl(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{initial})}.
17533
17534 To illustrate the relationships between these functions, we could
17535 do the @code{fvb} calculation ``by hand'' using @code{fvl}. The
17536 final balance will be the sum of the contributions of our five
17537 deposits at various times. The first deposit earns interest for
17538 five years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 1300.78}. The second
17539 deposit only earns interest for four years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 4, 1000) =
17540 1234.13}. And so on down to the last deposit, which earns one
17541 year's interest: @code{fvl(5.4%, 1, 1000) = 1054.00}. The sum of
17542 these five values is, sure enough, $5870.73, just as was computed
17543 by @code{fvb} directly.
17544
17545 What does @code{fv(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5569.96} mean? The payments
17546 are now at the ends of the periods. The end of one year is the same
17547 as the beginning of the next, so what this really means is that we've
17548 lost the payment at year zero (which contributed $1300.78), but we're
17549 now counting the payment at year five (which, since it didn't have
17550 a chance to earn interest, counts as $1000). Indeed, @expr{5569.96 =
17551 5870.73 - 1300.78 + 1000} (give or take a bit of roundoff error).
17552
17553 @node Present Value, Related Financial Functions, Future Value, Financial Functions
17554 @subsection Present Value
17555
17556 @noindent
17557 @kindex b P
17558 @pindex calc-fin-pv
17559 @tindex pv
17560 The @kbd{b P} (@code{calc-fin-pv}) [@code{pv}] command computes
17561 the present value of an investment. Like @code{fv}, it takes
17562 three arguments: @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17563 It computes the present value of a series of regular payments.
17564 Suppose you have the chance to make an investment that will
17565 pay $2000 per year over the next four years; as you receive
17566 these payments you can put them in the bank at 9% interest.
17567 You want to know whether it is better to make the investment, or
17568 to keep the money in the bank where it earns 9% interest right
17569 from the start. The calculation @code{pv(9%, 4, 2000)} gives the
17570 result 6479.44. If your initial investment must be less than this,
17571 say, $6000, then the investment is worthwhile. But if you had to
17572 put up $7000, then it would be better just to leave it in the bank.
17573
17574 Here is the interpretation of the result of @code{pv}: You are
17575 trying to compare the return from the investment you are
17576 considering, which is @code{fv(9%, 4, 2000) = 9146.26}, with
17577 the return from leaving the money in the bank, which is
17578 @code{fvl(9%, 4, @var{x})} where @var{x} is the amount of money
17579 you would have to put up in advance. The @code{pv} function
17580 finds the break-even point, @expr{x = 6479.44}, at which
17581 @code{fvl(9%, 4, 6479.44)} is also equal to 9146.26. This is
17582 the largest amount you should be willing to invest.
17583
17584 @kindex I b P
17585 @tindex pvb
17586 The @kbd{I b P} [@code{pvb}] command solves the same problem,
17587 but with payments occurring at the beginning of each interval.
17588 It has the same relationship to @code{fvb} as @code{pv} has
17589 to @code{fv}. For example @code{pvb(9%, 4, 2000) = 7062.59},
17590 a larger number than @code{pv} produced because we get to start
17591 earning interest on the return from our investment sooner.
17592
17593 @kindex H b P
17594 @tindex pvl
17595 The @kbd{H b P} [@code{pvl}] command computes the present value of
17596 an investment that will pay off in one lump sum at the end of the
17597 period. For example, if we get our $8000 all at the end of the
17598 four years, @code{pvl(9%, 4, 8000) = 5667.40}. This is much
17599 less than @code{pv} reported, because we don't earn any interest
17600 on the return from this investment. Note that @code{pvl} and
17601 @code{fvl} are simple inverses: @code{fvl(9%, 4, 5667.40) = 8000}.
17602
17603 You can give an optional fourth lump-sum argument to @code{pv}
17604 and @code{pvb}; this is handled in exactly the same way as the
17605 fourth argument for @code{fv} and @code{fvb}.
17606
17607 @kindex b N
17608 @pindex calc-fin-npv
17609 @tindex npv
17610 The @kbd{b N} (@code{calc-fin-npv}) [@code{npv}] command computes
17611 the net present value of a series of irregular investments.
17612 The first argument is the interest rate. The second argument is
17613 a vector which represents the expected return from the investment
17614 at the end of each interval. For example, if the rate represents
17615 a yearly interest rate, then the vector elements are the return
17616 from the first year, second year, and so on.
17617
17618 Thus, @code{npv(9%, [2000,2000,2000,2000]) = pv(9%, 4, 2000) = 6479.44}.
17619 Obviously this function is more interesting when the payments are
17620 not all the same!
17621
17622 The @code{npv} function can actually have two or more arguments.
17623 Multiple arguments are interpreted in the same way as for the
17624 vector statistical functions like @code{vsum}.
17625 @xref{Single-Variable Statistics}. Basically, if there are several
17626 payment arguments, each either a vector or a plain number, all these
17627 values are collected left-to-right into the complete list of payments.
17628 A numeric prefix argument on the @kbd{b N} command says how many
17629 payment values or vectors to take from the stack.
17630
17631 @kindex I b N
17632 @tindex npvb
17633 The @kbd{I b N} [@code{npvb}] command computes the net present
17634 value where payments occur at the beginning of each interval
17635 rather than at the end.
17636
17637 @node Related Financial Functions, Depreciation Functions, Present Value, Financial Functions
17638 @subsection Related Financial Functions
17639
17640 @noindent
17641 The functions in this section are basically inverses of the
17642 present value functions with respect to the various arguments.
17643
17644 @kindex b M
17645 @pindex calc-fin-pmt
17646 @tindex pmt
17647 The @kbd{b M} (@code{calc-fin-pmt}) [@code{pmt}] command computes
17648 the amount of periodic payment necessary to amortize a loan.
17649 Thus @code{pmt(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{amount})} equals the
17650 value of @var{payment} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17651 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}.
17652
17653 @kindex I b M
17654 @tindex pmtb
17655 The @kbd{I b M} [@code{pmtb}] command does the same computation
17656 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. Like @code{pv} and
17657 @code{pvb}, these functions can also take a fourth argument which
17658 represents an initial lump-sum investment.
17659
17660 @kindex H b M
17661 The @kbd{H b M} key just invokes the @code{fvl} function, which is
17662 the inverse of @code{pvl}. There is no explicit @code{pmtl} function.
17663
17664 @kindex b #
17665 @pindex calc-fin-nper
17666 @tindex nper
17667 The @kbd{b #} (@code{calc-fin-nper}) [@code{nper}] command computes
17668 the number of regular payments necessary to amortize a loan.
17669 Thus @code{nper(@var{rate}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} equals
17670 the value of @var{n} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17671 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}. If @var{payment} is too small
17672 ever to amortize a loan for @var{amount} at interest rate @var{rate},
17673 the @code{nper} function is left in symbolic form.
17674
17675 @kindex I b #
17676 @tindex nperb
17677 The @kbd{I b #} [@code{nperb}] command does the same computation
17678 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. You can give a fourth
17679 lump-sum argument to these functions, but the computation will be
17680 rather slow in the four-argument case.
17681
17682 @kindex H b #
17683 @tindex nperl
17684 The @kbd{H b #} [@code{nperl}] command does the same computation
17685 using @code{pvl}. By exchanging @var{payment} and @var{amount} you
17686 can also get the solution for @code{fvl}. For example,
17687 @code{nperl(8%, 2000, 1000) = 9.006}, so if you place $1000 in a
17688 bank account earning 8%, it will take nine years to grow to $2000.
17689
17690 @kindex b T
17691 @pindex calc-fin-rate
17692 @tindex rate
17693 The @kbd{b T} (@code{calc-fin-rate}) [@code{rate}] command computes
17694 the rate of return on an investment. This is also an inverse of @code{pv}:
17695 @code{rate(@var{n}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} computes the value of
17696 @var{rate} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment}) =
17697 @var{amount}}. The result is expressed as a formula like @samp{6.3%}.
17698
17699 @kindex I b T
17700 @kindex H b T
17701 @tindex rateb
17702 @tindex ratel
17703 The @kbd{I b T} [@code{rateb}] and @kbd{H b T} [@code{ratel}]
17704 commands solve the analogous equations with @code{pvb} or @code{pvl}
17705 in place of @code{pv}. Also, @code{rate} and @code{rateb} can
17706 accept an optional fourth argument just like @code{pv} and @code{pvb}.
17707 To redo the above example from a different perspective,
17708 @code{ratel(9, 2000, 1000) = 8.00597%}, which says you will need an
17709 interest rate of 8% in order to double your account in nine years.
17710
17711 @kindex b I
17712 @pindex calc-fin-irr
17713 @tindex irr
17714 The @kbd{b I} (@code{calc-fin-irr}) [@code{irr}] command is the
17715 analogous function to @code{rate} but for net present value.
17716 Its argument is a vector of payments. Thus @code{irr(@var{payments})}
17717 computes the @var{rate} such that @code{npv(@var{rate}, @var{payments}) = 0};
17718 this rate is known as the @dfn{internal rate of return}.
17719
17720 @kindex I b I
17721 @tindex irrb
17722 The @kbd{I b I} [@code{irrb}] command computes the internal rate of
17723 return assuming payments occur at the beginning of each period.
17724
17725 @node Depreciation Functions, Definitions of Financial Functions, Related Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17726 @subsection Depreciation Functions
17727
17728 @noindent
17729 The functions in this section calculate @dfn{depreciation}, which is
17730 the amount of value that a possession loses over time. These functions
17731 are characterized by three parameters: @var{cost}, the original cost
17732 of the asset; @var{salvage}, the value the asset will have at the end
17733 of its expected ``useful life''; and @var{life}, the number of years
17734 (or other periods) of the expected useful life.
17735
17736 There are several methods for calculating depreciation that differ in
17737 the way they spread the depreciation over the lifetime of the asset.
17738
17739 @kindex b S
17740 @pindex calc-fin-sln
17741 @tindex sln
17742 The @kbd{b S} (@code{calc-fin-sln}) [@code{sln}] command computes the
17743 ``straight-line'' depreciation. In this method, the asset depreciates
17744 by the same amount every year (or period). For example,
17745 @samp{sln(12000, 2000, 5)} returns 2000. The asset costs $12000
17746 initially and will be worth $2000 after five years; it loses $2000
17747 per year.
17748
17749 @kindex b Y
17750 @pindex calc-fin-syd
17751 @tindex syd
17752 The @kbd{b Y} (@code{calc-fin-syd}) [@code{syd}] command computes the
17753 accelerated ``sum-of-years'-digits'' depreciation. Here the depreciation
17754 is higher during the early years of the asset's life. Since the
17755 depreciation is different each year, @kbd{b Y} takes a fourth @var{period}
17756 parameter which specifies which year is requested, from 1 to @var{life}.
17757 If @var{period} is outside this range, the @code{syd} function will
17758 return zero.
17759
17760 @kindex b D
17761 @pindex calc-fin-ddb
17762 @tindex ddb
17763 The @kbd{b D} (@code{calc-fin-ddb}) [@code{ddb}] command computes an
17764 accelerated depreciation using the double-declining balance method.
17765 It also takes a fourth @var{period} parameter.
17766
17767 For symmetry, the @code{sln} function will accept a @var{period}
17768 parameter as well, although it will ignore its value except that the
17769 return value will as usual be zero if @var{period} is out of range.
17770
17771 For example, pushing the vector @expr{[1,2,3,4,5]} (perhaps with @kbd{v x 5})
17772 and then mapping @kbd{V M ' [sln(12000,2000,5,$), syd(12000,2000,5,$),
17773 ddb(12000,2000,5,$)] @key{RET}} produces a matrix that allows us to compare
17774 the three depreciation methods:
17775
17776 @example
17777 @group
17778 [ [ 2000, 3333, 4800 ]
17779 [ 2000, 2667, 2880 ]
17780 [ 2000, 2000, 1728 ]
17781 [ 2000, 1333, 592 ]
17782 [ 2000, 667, 0 ] ]
17783 @end group
17784 @end example
17785
17786 @noindent
17787 (Values have been rounded to nearest integers in this figure.)
17788 We see that @code{sln} depreciates by the same amount each year,
17789 @kbd{syd} depreciates more at the beginning and less at the end,
17790 and @kbd{ddb} weights the depreciation even more toward the beginning.
17791
17792 Summing columns with @kbd{V R : +} yields @expr{[10000, 10000, 10000]};
17793 the total depreciation in any method is (by definition) the
17794 difference between the cost and the salvage value.
17795
17796 @node Definitions of Financial Functions, , Depreciation Functions, Financial Functions
17797 @subsection Definitions
17798
17799 @noindent
17800 For your reference, here are the actual formulas used to compute
17801 Calc's financial functions.
17802
17803 Calc will not evaluate a financial function unless the @var{rate} or
17804 @var{n} argument is known. However, @var{payment} or @var{amount} can
17805 be a variable. Calc expands these functions according to the
17806 formulas below for symbolic arguments only when you use the @kbd{a "}
17807 (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command, or when taking derivatives or
17808 integrals or solving equations involving the functions.
17809
17810 @ifnottex
17811 These formulas are shown using the conventions of Big display
17812 mode (@kbd{d B}); for example, the formula for @code{fv} written
17813 linearly is @samp{pmt * ((1 + rate)^n) - 1) / rate}.
17814
17815 @example
17816 n
17817 (1 + rate) - 1
17818 fv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ---------------
17819 rate
17820
17821 n
17822 ((1 + rate) - 1) (1 + rate)
17823 fvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------------------
17824 rate
17825
17826 n
17827 fvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17828
17829 -n
17830 1 - (1 + rate)
17831 pv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------
17832 rate
17833
17834 -n
17835 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17836 pvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * -----------------------------
17837 rate
17838
17839 -n
17840 pvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17841
17842 -1 -2 -3
17843 npv(rate, [a, b, c]) = a*(1 + rate) + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17844
17845 -1 -2
17846 npvb(rate, [a, b, c]) = a + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17847
17848 -n
17849 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17850 pmt(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17851 -n
17852 1 - (1 + rate)
17853
17854 -n
17855 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17856 pmtb(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17857 -n
17858 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17859
17860 amt * rate
17861 nper(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ------------, 1 + rate)
17862 pmt
17863
17864 amt * rate
17865 nperb(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ---------------, 1 + rate)
17866 pmt * (1 + rate)
17867
17868 amt
17869 nperl(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(---, 1 + rate)
17870 pmt
17871
17872 1/n
17873 pmt
17874 ratel(n, pmt, amt) = ------ - 1
17875 1/n
17876 amt
17877
17878 cost - salv
17879 sln(cost, salv, life) = -----------
17880 life
17881
17882 (cost - salv) * (life - per + 1)
17883 syd(cost, salv, life, per) = --------------------------------
17884 life * (life + 1) / 2
17885
17886 book * 2
17887 ddb(cost, salv, life, per) = --------, book = cost - depreciation so far
17888 life
17889 @end example
17890 @end ifnottex
17891 @tex
17892 \turnoffactive
17893 $$ \code{fv}(r, n, p) = p { (1 + r)^n - 1 \over r } $$
17894 $$ \code{fvb}(r, n, p) = p { ((1 + r)^n - 1) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17895 $$ \code{fvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^n $$
17896 $$ \code{pv}(r, n, p) = p { 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} \over r } $$
17897 $$ \code{pvb}(r, n, p) = p { (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17898 $$ \code{pvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^{-n} $$
17899 $$ \code{npv}(r, [a,b,c]) = a (1 + r)^{-1} + b (1 + r)^{-2} + c (1 + r)^{-3} $$
17900 $$ \code{npvb}(r, [a,b,c]) = a + b (1 + r)^{-1} + c (1 + r)^{-2} $$
17901 $$ \code{pmt}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} }$$
17902 $$ \code{pmtb}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over
17903 (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) } $$
17904 $$ \code{nper}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p }, 1 + r) $$
17905 $$ \code{nperb}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p (1 + r) }, 1 + r) $$
17906 $$ \code{nperl}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}({a \over p}, 1 + r) $$
17907 $$ \code{ratel}(n, p, a) = { p^{1/n} \over a^{1/n} } - 1 $$
17908 $$ \code{sln}(c, s, l) = { c - s \over l } $$
17909 $$ \code{syd}(c, s, l, p) = { (c - s) (l - p + 1) \over l (l+1) / 2 } $$
17910 $$ \code{ddb}(c, s, l, p) = { 2 (c - \hbox{depreciation so far}) \over l } $$
17911 @end tex
17912
17913 @noindent
17914 In @code{pmt} and @code{pmtb}, @expr{x=0} if omitted.
17915
17916 These functions accept any numeric objects, including error forms,
17917 intervals, and even (though not very usefully) complex numbers. The
17918 above formulas specify exactly the behavior of these functions with
17919 all sorts of inputs.
17920
17921 Note that if the first argument to the @code{log} in @code{nper} is
17922 negative, @code{nper} leaves itself in symbolic form rather than
17923 returning a (financially meaningless) complex number.
17924
17925 @samp{rate(num, pmt, amt)} solves the equation
17926 @samp{pv(rate, num, pmt) = amt} for @samp{rate} using @kbd{H a R}
17927 (@code{calc-find-root}), with the interval @samp{[.01% .. 100%]}
17928 for an initial guess. The @code{rateb} function is the same except
17929 that it uses @code{pvb}. Note that @code{ratel} can be solved
17930 directly; its formula is shown in the above list.
17931
17932 Similarly, @samp{irr(pmts)} solves the equation @samp{npv(rate, pmts) = 0}
17933 for @samp{rate}.
17934
17935 If you give a fourth argument to @code{nper} or @code{nperb}, Calc
17936 will also use @kbd{H a R} to solve the equation using an initial
17937 guess interval of @samp{[0 .. 100]}.
17938
17939 A fourth argument to @code{fv} simply sums the two components
17940 calculated from the above formulas for @code{fv} and @code{fvl}.
17941 The same is true of @code{fvb}, @code{pv}, and @code{pvb}.
17942
17943 The @kbd{ddb} function is computed iteratively; the ``book'' value
17944 starts out equal to @var{cost}, and decreases according to the above
17945 formula for the specified number of periods. If the book value
17946 would decrease below @var{salvage}, it only decreases to @var{salvage}
17947 and the depreciation is zero for all subsequent periods. The @code{ddb}
17948 function returns the amount the book value decreased in the specified
17949 period.
17950
17951 @node Binary Functions, , Financial Functions, Arithmetic
17952 @section Binary Number Functions
17953
17954 @noindent
17955 The commands in this chapter all use two-letter sequences beginning with
17956 the @kbd{b} prefix.
17957
17958 @cindex Binary numbers
17959 The ``binary'' operations actually work regardless of the currently
17960 displayed radix, although their results make the most sense in a radix
17961 like 2, 8, or 16 (as obtained by the @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, or @w{@kbd{d 6}}
17962 commands, respectively). You may also wish to enable display of leading
17963 zeros with @kbd{d z}. @xref{Radix Modes}.
17964
17965 @cindex Word size for binary operations
17966 The Calculator maintains a current @dfn{word size} @expr{w}, an
17967 arbitrary positive or negative integer. For a positive word size, all
17968 of the binary operations described here operate modulo @expr{2^w}. In
17969 particular, negative arguments are converted to positive integers modulo
17970 @expr{2^w} by all binary functions.
17971
17972 If the word size is negative, binary operations produce 2's complement
17973 integers from
17974 @texline @math{-2^{-w-1}}
17975 @infoline @expr{-(2^(-w-1))}
17976 to
17977 @texline @math{2^{-w-1}-1}
17978 @infoline @expr{2^(-w-1)-1}
17979 inclusive. Either mode accepts inputs in any range; the sign of
17980 @expr{w} affects only the results produced.
17981
17982 @kindex b c
17983 @pindex calc-clip
17984 @tindex clip
17985 The @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip})
17986 [@code{clip}] command can be used to clip a number by reducing it modulo
17987 @expr{2^w}. The commands described in this chapter automatically clip
17988 their results to the current word size. Note that other operations like
17989 addition do not use the current word size, since integer addition
17990 generally is not ``binary.'' (However, @pxref{Simplification Modes},
17991 @code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}.) For example, with a word size of 8
17992 bits @kbd{b c} converts a number to the range 0 to 255; with a word
17993 size of @mathit{-8} @kbd{b c} converts to the range @mathit{-128} to 127.
17994
17995 @kindex b w
17996 @pindex calc-word-size
17997 The default word size is 32 bits. All operations except the shifts and
17998 rotates allow you to specify a different word size for that one
17999 operation by giving a numeric prefix argument: @kbd{C-u 8 b c} clips the
18000 top of stack to the range 0 to 255 regardless of the current word size.
18001 To set the word size permanently, use @kbd{b w} (@code{calc-word-size}).
18002 This command displays a prompt with the current word size; press @key{RET}
18003 immediately to keep this word size, or type a new word size at the prompt.
18004
18005 When the binary operations are written in symbolic form, they take an
18006 optional second (or third) word-size parameter. When a formula like
18007 @samp{and(a,b)} is finally evaluated, the word size current at that time
18008 will be used, but when @samp{and(a,b,-8)} is evaluated, a word size of
18009 @mathit{-8} will always be used. A symbolic binary function will be left
18010 in symbolic form unless the all of its argument(s) are integers or
18011 integer-valued floats.
18012
18013 If either or both arguments are modulo forms for which @expr{M} is a
18014 power of two, that power of two is taken as the word size unless a
18015 numeric prefix argument overrides it. The current word size is never
18016 consulted when modulo-power-of-two forms are involved.
18017
18018 @kindex b a
18019 @pindex calc-and
18020 @tindex and
18021 The @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}) [@code{and}] command computes the bitwise
18022 AND of the two numbers on the top of the stack. In other words, for each
18023 of the @expr{w} binary digits of the two numbers (pairwise), the corresponding
18024 bit of the result is 1 if and only if both input bits are 1:
18025 @samp{and(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1000}.
18026
18027 @kindex b o
18028 @pindex calc-or
18029 @tindex or
18030 The @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}) [@code{or}] command computes the bitwise
18031 inclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if either of the input bits, or
18032 both, are 1: @samp{or(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1110}.
18033
18034 @kindex b x
18035 @pindex calc-xor
18036 @tindex xor
18037 The @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}) [@code{xor}] command computes the bitwise
18038 exclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if exactly one of the input bits
18039 is 1: @samp{xor(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0110}.
18040
18041 @kindex b d
18042 @pindex calc-diff
18043 @tindex diff
18044 The @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}) [@code{diff}] command computes the bitwise
18045 difference of two numbers; this is defined by @samp{diff(a,b) = and(a,not(b))},
18046 so that @samp{diff(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0100}.
18047
18048 @kindex b n
18049 @pindex calc-not
18050 @tindex not
18051 The @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}) [@code{not}] command computes the bitwise
18052 NOT of a number. A bit is 1 if the input bit is 0 and vice-versa.
18053
18054 @kindex b l
18055 @pindex calc-lshift-binary
18056 @tindex lsh
18057 The @kbd{b l} (@code{calc-lshift-binary}) [@code{lsh}] command shifts a
18058 number left by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18059 prefix argument. A negative prefix argument performs a logical right shift,
18060 in which zeros are shifted in on the left. In symbolic form, @samp{lsh(a)}
18061 is short for @samp{lsh(a,1)}, which in turn is short for @samp{lsh(a,n,w)}.
18062 Bits shifted ``off the end,'' according to the current word size, are lost.
18063
18064 @kindex H b l
18065 @kindex H b r
18066 @ignore
18067 @mindex @idots
18068 @end ignore
18069 @kindex H b L
18070 @ignore
18071 @mindex @null
18072 @end ignore
18073 @kindex H b R
18074 @ignore
18075 @mindex @null
18076 @end ignore
18077 @kindex H b t
18078 The @kbd{H b l} command also does a left shift, but it takes two arguments
18079 from the stack (the value to shift, and, at top-of-stack, the number of
18080 bits to shift). This version interprets the prefix argument just like
18081 the regular binary operations, i.e., as a word size. The Hyperbolic flag
18082 has a similar effect on the rest of the binary shift and rotate commands.
18083
18084 @kindex b r
18085 @pindex calc-rshift-binary
18086 @tindex rsh
18087 The @kbd{b r} (@code{calc-rshift-binary}) [@code{rsh}] command shifts a
18088 number right by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18089 prefix argument: @samp{rsh(a,n) = lsh(a,-n)}.
18090
18091 @kindex b L
18092 @pindex calc-lshift-arith
18093 @tindex ash
18094 The @kbd{b L} (@code{calc-lshift-arith}) [@code{ash}] command shifts a
18095 number left. It is analogous to @code{lsh}, except that if the shift
18096 is rightward (the prefix argument is negative), an arithmetic shift
18097 is performed as described below.
18098
18099 @kindex b R
18100 @pindex calc-rshift-arith
18101 @tindex rash
18102 The @kbd{b R} (@code{calc-rshift-arith}) [@code{rash}] command performs
18103 an ``arithmetic'' shift to the right, in which the leftmost bit (according
18104 to the current word size) is duplicated rather than shifting in zeros.
18105 This corresponds to dividing by a power of two where the input is interpreted
18106 as a signed, twos-complement number. (The distinction between the @samp{rsh}
18107 and @samp{rash} operations is totally independent from whether the word
18108 size is positive or negative.) With a negative prefix argument, this
18109 performs a standard left shift.
18110
18111 @kindex b t
18112 @pindex calc-rotate-binary
18113 @tindex rot
18114 The @kbd{b t} (@code{calc-rotate-binary}) [@code{rot}] command rotates a
18115 number one bit to the left. The leftmost bit (according to the current
18116 word size) is dropped off the left and shifted in on the right. With a
18117 numeric prefix argument, the number is rotated that many bits to the left
18118 or right.
18119
18120 @xref{Set Operations}, for the @kbd{b p} and @kbd{b u} commands that
18121 pack and unpack binary integers into sets. (For example, @kbd{b u}
18122 unpacks the number @samp{2#11001} to the set of bit-numbers
18123 @samp{[0, 3, 4]}.) Type @kbd{b u V #} to count the number of ``1''
18124 bits in a binary integer.
18125
18126 Another interesting use of the set representation of binary integers
18127 is to reverse the bits in, say, a 32-bit integer. Type @kbd{b u} to
18128 unpack; type @kbd{31 @key{TAB} -} to replace each bit-number in the set
18129 with 31 minus that bit-number; type @kbd{b p} to pack the set back
18130 into a binary integer.
18131
18132 @node Scientific Functions, Matrix Functions, Arithmetic, Top
18133 @chapter Scientific Functions
18134
18135 @noindent
18136 The functions described here perform trigonometric and other transcendental
18137 calculations. They generally produce floating-point answers correct to the
18138 full current precision. The @kbd{H} (Hyperbolic) and @kbd{I} (Inverse)
18139 flag keys must be used to get some of these functions from the keyboard.
18140
18141 @kindex P
18142 @pindex calc-pi
18143 @cindex @code{pi} variable
18144 @vindex pi
18145 @kindex H P
18146 @cindex @code{e} variable
18147 @vindex e
18148 @kindex I P
18149 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
18150 @vindex gamma
18151 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
18152 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
18153 @kindex H I P
18154 @cindex @code{phi} variable
18155 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
18156 @cindex Golden ratio
18157 One miscellaneous command is shift-@kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}), which pushes
18158 the value of @cpi{} (at the current precision) onto the stack. With the
18159 Hyperbolic flag, it pushes the value @expr{e}, the base of natural logarithms.
18160 With the Inverse flag, it pushes Euler's constant
18161 @texline @math{\gamma}
18162 @infoline @expr{gamma}
18163 (about 0.5772). With both Inverse and Hyperbolic, it
18164 pushes the ``golden ratio''
18165 @texline @math{\phi}
18166 @infoline @expr{phi}
18167 (about 1.618). (At present, Euler's constant is not available
18168 to unlimited precision; Calc knows only the first 100 digits.)
18169 In Symbolic mode, these commands push the
18170 actual variables @samp{pi}, @samp{e}, @samp{gamma}, and @samp{phi},
18171 respectively, instead of their values; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}.
18172
18173 @ignore
18174 @mindex Q
18175 @end ignore
18176 @ignore
18177 @mindex I Q
18178 @end ignore
18179 @kindex I Q
18180 @tindex sqr
18181 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] function is described elsewhere;
18182 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}. With the Inverse flag [@code{sqr}], this command
18183 computes the square of the argument.
18184
18185 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
18186 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
18187 interpret a prefix argument.
18188
18189 @menu
18190 * Logarithmic Functions::
18191 * Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions::
18192 * Advanced Math Functions::
18193 * Branch Cuts::
18194 * Random Numbers::
18195 * Combinatorial Functions::
18196 * Probability Distribution Functions::
18197 @end menu
18198
18199 @node Logarithmic Functions, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions, Scientific Functions
18200 @section Logarithmic Functions
18201
18202 @noindent
18203 @kindex L
18204 @pindex calc-ln
18205 @tindex ln
18206 @ignore
18207 @mindex @null
18208 @end ignore
18209 @kindex I E
18210 The shift-@kbd{L} (@code{calc-ln}) [@code{ln}] command computes the natural
18211 logarithm of the real or complex number on the top of the stack. With
18212 the Inverse flag it computes the exponential function instead, although
18213 this is redundant with the @kbd{E} command.
18214
18215 @kindex E
18216 @pindex calc-exp
18217 @tindex exp
18218 @ignore
18219 @mindex @null
18220 @end ignore
18221 @kindex I L
18222 The shift-@kbd{E} (@code{calc-exp}) [@code{exp}] command computes the
18223 exponential, i.e., @expr{e} raised to the power of the number on the stack.
18224 The meanings of the Inverse and Hyperbolic flags follow from those for
18225 the @code{calc-ln} command.
18226
18227 @kindex H L
18228 @kindex H E
18229 @pindex calc-log10
18230 @tindex log10
18231 @tindex exp10
18232 @ignore
18233 @mindex @null
18234 @end ignore
18235 @kindex H I L
18236 @ignore
18237 @mindex @null
18238 @end ignore
18239 @kindex H I E
18240 The @kbd{H L} (@code{calc-log10}) [@code{log10}] command computes the common
18241 (base-10) logarithm of a number. (With the Inverse flag [@code{exp10}],
18242 it raises ten to a given power.) Note that the common logarithm of a
18243 complex number is computed by taking the natural logarithm and dividing
18244 by
18245 @texline @math{\ln10}.
18246 @infoline @expr{ln(10)}.
18247
18248 @kindex B
18249 @kindex I B
18250 @pindex calc-log
18251 @tindex log
18252 @tindex alog
18253 The @kbd{B} (@code{calc-log}) [@code{log}] command computes a logarithm
18254 to any base. For example, @kbd{1024 @key{RET} 2 B} produces 10, since
18255 @texline @math{2^{10} = 1024}.
18256 @infoline @expr{2^10 = 1024}.
18257 In certain cases like @samp{log(3,9)}, the result
18258 will be either @expr{1:2} or @expr{0.5} depending on the current Fraction
18259 mode setting. With the Inverse flag [@code{alog}], this command is
18260 similar to @kbd{^} except that the order of the arguments is reversed.
18261
18262 @kindex f I
18263 @pindex calc-ilog
18264 @tindex ilog
18265 The @kbd{f I} (@code{calc-ilog}) [@code{ilog}] command computes the
18266 integer logarithm of a number to any base. The number and the base must
18267 themselves be positive integers. This is the true logarithm, rounded
18268 down to an integer. Thus @kbd{ilog(x,10)} is 3 for all @expr{x} in the
18269 range from 1000 to 9999. If both arguments are positive integers, exact
18270 integer arithmetic is used; otherwise, this is equivalent to
18271 @samp{floor(log(x,b))}.
18272
18273 @kindex f E
18274 @pindex calc-expm1
18275 @tindex expm1
18276 The @kbd{f E} (@code{calc-expm1}) [@code{expm1}] command computes
18277 @texline @math{e^x - 1},
18278 @infoline @expr{exp(x)-1},
18279 but using an algorithm that produces a more accurate
18280 answer when the result is close to zero, i.e., when
18281 @texline @math{e^x}
18282 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
18283 is close to one.
18284
18285 @kindex f L
18286 @pindex calc-lnp1
18287 @tindex lnp1
18288 The @kbd{f L} (@code{calc-lnp1}) [@code{lnp1}] command computes
18289 @texline @math{\ln(x+1)},
18290 @infoline @expr{ln(x+1)},
18291 producing a more accurate answer when @expr{x} is close to zero.
18292
18293 @node Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Advanced Math Functions, Logarithmic Functions, Scientific Functions
18294 @section Trigonometric/Hyperbolic Functions
18295
18296 @noindent
18297 @kindex S
18298 @pindex calc-sin
18299 @tindex sin
18300 The shift-@kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}) [@code{sin}] command computes the sine
18301 of an angle or complex number. If the input is an HMS form, it is interpreted
18302 as degrees-minutes-seconds; otherwise, the input is interpreted according
18303 to the current angular mode. It is best to use Radians mode when operating
18304 on complex numbers.
18305
18306 Calc's ``units'' mechanism includes angular units like @code{deg},
18307 @code{rad}, and @code{grad}. While @samp{sin(45 deg)} is not evaluated
18308 all the time, the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command will
18309 simplify @samp{sin(45 deg)} by taking the sine of 45 degrees, regardless
18310 of the current angular mode. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
18311
18312 Also, the symbolic variable @code{pi} is not ordinarily recognized in
18313 arguments to trigonometric functions, as in @samp{sin(3 pi / 4)}, but
18314 the @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) command recognizes many such
18315 formulas when the current angular mode is Radians @emph{and} Symbolic
18316 mode is enabled; this example would be replaced by @samp{sqrt(2) / 2}.
18317 @xref{Symbolic Mode}. Beware, this simplification occurs even if you
18318 have stored a different value in the variable @samp{pi}; this is one
18319 reason why changing built-in variables is a bad idea. Arguments of
18320 the form @expr{x} plus a multiple of @cpiover{2} are also simplified.
18321 Calc includes similar formulas for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
18322
18323 The @kbd{a s} command knows all angles which are integer multiples of
18324 @cpiover{12}, @cpiover{10}, or @cpiover{8} radians. In Degrees mode,
18325 analogous simplifications occur for integer multiples of 15 or 18
18326 degrees, and for arguments plus multiples of 90 degrees.
18327
18328 @kindex I S
18329 @pindex calc-arcsin
18330 @tindex arcsin
18331 With the Inverse flag, @code{calc-sin} computes an arcsine. This is also
18332 available as the @code{calc-arcsin} command or @code{arcsin} algebraic
18333 function. The returned argument is converted to degrees, radians, or HMS
18334 notation depending on the current angular mode.
18335
18336 @kindex H S
18337 @pindex calc-sinh
18338 @tindex sinh
18339 @kindex H I S
18340 @pindex calc-arcsinh
18341 @tindex arcsinh
18342 With the Hyperbolic flag, @code{calc-sin} computes the hyperbolic
18343 sine, also available as @code{calc-sinh} [@code{sinh}]. With the
18344 Hyperbolic and Inverse flags, it computes the hyperbolic arcsine
18345 (@code{calc-arcsinh}) [@code{arcsinh}].
18346
18347 @kindex C
18348 @pindex calc-cos
18349 @tindex cos
18350 @ignore
18351 @mindex @idots
18352 @end ignore
18353 @kindex I C
18354 @pindex calc-arccos
18355 @ignore
18356 @mindex @null
18357 @end ignore
18358 @tindex arccos
18359 @ignore
18360 @mindex @null
18361 @end ignore
18362 @kindex H C
18363 @pindex calc-cosh
18364 @ignore
18365 @mindex @null
18366 @end ignore
18367 @tindex cosh
18368 @ignore
18369 @mindex @null
18370 @end ignore
18371 @kindex H I C
18372 @pindex calc-arccosh
18373 @ignore
18374 @mindex @null
18375 @end ignore
18376 @tindex arccosh
18377 @ignore
18378 @mindex @null
18379 @end ignore
18380 @kindex T
18381 @pindex calc-tan
18382 @ignore
18383 @mindex @null
18384 @end ignore
18385 @tindex tan
18386 @ignore
18387 @mindex @null
18388 @end ignore
18389 @kindex I T
18390 @pindex calc-arctan
18391 @ignore
18392 @mindex @null
18393 @end ignore
18394 @tindex arctan
18395 @ignore
18396 @mindex @null
18397 @end ignore
18398 @kindex H T
18399 @pindex calc-tanh
18400 @ignore
18401 @mindex @null
18402 @end ignore
18403 @tindex tanh
18404 @ignore
18405 @mindex @null
18406 @end ignore
18407 @kindex H I T
18408 @pindex calc-arctanh
18409 @ignore
18410 @mindex @null
18411 @end ignore
18412 @tindex arctanh
18413 The shift-@kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}] command computes the cosine
18414 of an angle or complex number, and shift-@kbd{T} (@code{calc-tan}) [@code{tan}]
18415 computes the tangent, along with all the various inverse and hyperbolic
18416 variants of these functions.
18417
18418 @kindex f T
18419 @pindex calc-arctan2
18420 @tindex arctan2
18421 The @kbd{f T} (@code{calc-arctan2}) [@code{arctan2}] command takes two
18422 numbers from the stack and computes the arc tangent of their ratio. The
18423 result is in the full range from @mathit{-180} (exclusive) to @mathit{+180}
18424 (inclusive) degrees, or the analogous range in radians. A similar
18425 result would be obtained with @kbd{/} followed by @kbd{I T}, but the
18426 value would only be in the range from @mathit{-90} to @mathit{+90} degrees
18427 since the division loses information about the signs of the two
18428 components, and an error might result from an explicit division by zero
18429 which @code{arctan2} would avoid. By (arbitrary) definition,
18430 @samp{arctan2(0,0)=0}.
18431
18432 @pindex calc-sincos
18433 @ignore
18434 @starindex
18435 @end ignore
18436 @tindex sincos
18437 @ignore
18438 @starindex
18439 @end ignore
18440 @ignore
18441 @mindex arc@idots
18442 @end ignore
18443 @tindex arcsincos
18444 The @code{calc-sincos} [@code{sincos}] command computes the sine and
18445 cosine of a number, returning them as a vector of the form
18446 @samp{[@var{cos}, @var{sin}]}.
18447 With the Inverse flag [@code{arcsincos}], this command takes a two-element
18448 vector as an argument and computes @code{arctan2} of the elements.
18449 (This command does not accept the Hyperbolic flag.)
18450
18451 @pindex calc-sec
18452 @tindex sec
18453 @pindex calc-csc
18454 @tindex csc
18455 @pindex calc-cot
18456 @tindex cot
18457 @pindex calc-sech
18458 @tindex sech
18459 @pindex calc-csch
18460 @tindex csch
18461 @pindex calc-coth
18462 @tindex coth
18463 The remaining trigonometric functions, @code{calc-sec} [@code{sec}],
18464 @code{calc-csc} [@code{csc}] and @code{calc-cot} [@code{cot}], are also
18465 available. With the Hyperbolic flag, these compute their hyperbolic
18466 counterparts, which are also available separately as @code{calc-sech}
18467 [@code{sech}], @code{calc-csch} [@code{csch}] and @code{calc-coth}
18468 [@code{coth}]. (These commands do not accept the Inverse flag.)
18469
18470 @node Advanced Math Functions, Branch Cuts, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions
18471 @section Advanced Mathematical Functions
18472
18473 @noindent
18474 Calc can compute a variety of less common functions that arise in
18475 various branches of mathematics. All of the functions described in
18476 this section allow arbitrary complex arguments and, except as noted,
18477 will work to arbitrarily large precisions. They can not at present
18478 handle error forms or intervals as arguments.
18479
18480 NOTE: These functions are still experimental. In particular, their
18481 accuracy is not guaranteed in all domains. It is advisable to set the
18482 current precision comfortably higher than you actually need when
18483 using these functions. Also, these functions may be impractically
18484 slow for some values of the arguments.
18485
18486 @kindex f g
18487 @pindex calc-gamma
18488 @tindex gamma
18489 The @kbd{f g} (@code{calc-gamma}) [@code{gamma}] command computes the Euler
18490 gamma function. For positive integer arguments, this is related to the
18491 factorial function: @samp{gamma(n+1) = fact(n)}. For general complex
18492 arguments the gamma function can be defined by the following definite
18493 integral:
18494 @texline @math{\Gamma(a) = \int_0^\infty t^{a-1} e^t dt}.
18495 @infoline @expr{gamma(a) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, inf)}.
18496 (The actual implementation uses far more efficient computational methods.)
18497
18498 @kindex f G
18499 @tindex gammaP
18500 @ignore
18501 @mindex @idots
18502 @end ignore
18503 @kindex I f G
18504 @ignore
18505 @mindex @null
18506 @end ignore
18507 @kindex H f G
18508 @ignore
18509 @mindex @null
18510 @end ignore
18511 @kindex H I f G
18512 @pindex calc-inc-gamma
18513 @ignore
18514 @mindex @null
18515 @end ignore
18516 @tindex gammaQ
18517 @ignore
18518 @mindex @null
18519 @end ignore
18520 @tindex gammag
18521 @ignore
18522 @mindex @null
18523 @end ignore
18524 @tindex gammaG
18525 The @kbd{f G} (@code{calc-inc-gamma}) [@code{gammaP}] command computes
18526 the incomplete gamma function, denoted @samp{P(a,x)}. This is defined by
18527 the integral,
18528 @texline @math{P(a,x) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} e^t dt \right) / \Gamma(a)}.
18529 @infoline @expr{gammaP(a,x) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, x) / gamma(a)}.
18530 This implies that @samp{gammaP(a,inf) = 1} for any @expr{a} (see the
18531 definition of the normal gamma function).
18532
18533 Several other varieties of incomplete gamma function are defined.
18534 The complement of @expr{P(a,x)}, called @expr{Q(a,x) = 1-P(a,x)} by
18535 some authors, is computed by the @kbd{I f G} [@code{gammaQ}] command.
18536 You can think of this as taking the other half of the integral, from
18537 @expr{x} to infinity.
18538
18539 @ifnottex
18540 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define @expr{P(a,x)}
18541 and @expr{Q(a,x)} but without the normalizing @expr{1/gamma(a)}
18542 factor are called @expr{g(a,x)} and @expr{G(a,x)}, respectively
18543 (where @expr{g} and @expr{G} represent the lower- and upper-case Greek
18544 letter gamma). You can obtain these using the @kbd{H f G} [@code{gammag}]
18545 and @kbd{H I f G} [@code{gammaG}] commands.
18546 @end ifnottex
18547 @tex
18548 \turnoffactive
18549 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define $P(a,x)$
18550 and $Q(a,x)$ but without the normalizing $1/\Gamma(a)$
18551 factor are called $\gamma(a,x)$ and $\Gamma(a,x)$, respectively.
18552 You can obtain these using the \kbd{H f G} [\code{gammag}] and
18553 \kbd{I H f G} [\code{gammaG}] commands.
18554 @end tex
18555
18556 @kindex f b
18557 @pindex calc-beta
18558 @tindex beta
18559 The @kbd{f b} (@code{calc-beta}) [@code{beta}] command computes the
18560 Euler beta function, which is defined in terms of the gamma function as
18561 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \Gamma(a) \Gamma(b) / \Gamma(a+b)},
18562 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = gamma(a) gamma(b) / gamma(a+b)},
18563 or by
18564 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \int_0^1 t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt}.
18565 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, 1)}.
18566
18567 @kindex f B
18568 @kindex H f B
18569 @pindex calc-inc-beta
18570 @tindex betaI
18571 @tindex betaB
18572 The @kbd{f B} (@code{calc-inc-beta}) [@code{betaI}] command computes
18573 the incomplete beta function @expr{I(x,a,b)}. It is defined by
18574 @texline @math{I(x,a,b) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt \right) / B(a,b)}.
18575 @infoline @expr{betaI(x,a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, x) / beta(a,b)}.
18576 Once again, the @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix gives the corresponding
18577 un-normalized version [@code{betaB}].
18578
18579 @kindex f e
18580 @kindex I f e
18581 @pindex calc-erf
18582 @tindex erf
18583 @tindex erfc
18584 The @kbd{f e} (@code{calc-erf}) [@code{erf}] command computes the
18585 error function
18586 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) = {2 \over \sqrt{\pi}} \int_0^x e^{-t^2} dt}.
18587 @infoline @expr{erf(x) = 2 integ(exp(-(t^2)), t, 0, x) / sqrt(pi)}.
18588 The complementary error function @kbd{I f e} (@code{calc-erfc}) [@code{erfc}]
18589 is the corresponding integral from @samp{x} to infinity; the sum
18590 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) + \hbox{erfc}(x) = 1}.
18591 @infoline @expr{erf(x) + erfc(x) = 1}.
18592
18593 @kindex f j
18594 @kindex f y
18595 @pindex calc-bessel-J
18596 @pindex calc-bessel-Y
18597 @tindex besJ
18598 @tindex besY
18599 The @kbd{f j} (@code{calc-bessel-J}) [@code{besJ}] and @kbd{f y}
18600 (@code{calc-bessel-Y}) [@code{besY}] commands compute the Bessel
18601 functions of the first and second kinds, respectively.
18602 In @samp{besJ(n,x)} and @samp{besY(n,x)} the ``order'' parameter
18603 @expr{n} is often an integer, but is not required to be one.
18604 Calc's implementation of the Bessel functions currently limits the
18605 precision to 8 digits, and may not be exact even to that precision.
18606 Use with care!
18607
18608 @node Branch Cuts, Random Numbers, Advanced Math Functions, Scientific Functions
18609 @section Branch Cuts and Principal Values
18610
18611 @noindent
18612 @cindex Branch cuts
18613 @cindex Principal values
18614 All of the logarithmic, trigonometric, and other scientific functions are
18615 defined for complex numbers as well as for reals.
18616 This section describes the values
18617 returned in cases where the general result is a family of possible values.
18618 Calc follows section 12.5.3 of Steele's @dfn{Common Lisp, the Language},
18619 second edition, in these matters. This section will describe each
18620 function briefly; for a more detailed discussion (including some nifty
18621 diagrams), consult Steele's book.
18622
18623 Note that the branch cuts for @code{arctan} and @code{arctanh} were
18624 changed between the first and second editions of Steele. Recent
18625 versions of Calc follow the second edition.
18626
18627 The new branch cuts exactly match those of the HP-28/48 calculators.
18628 They also match those of Mathematica 1.2, except that Mathematica's
18629 @code{arctan} cut is always in the right half of the complex plane,
18630 and its @code{arctanh} cut is always in the top half of the plane.
18631 Calc's cuts are continuous with quadrants I and III for @code{arctan},
18632 or II and IV for @code{arctanh}.
18633
18634 Note: The current implementations of these functions with complex arguments
18635 are designed with proper behavior around the branch cuts in mind, @emph{not}
18636 efficiency or accuracy. You may need to increase the floating precision
18637 and wait a while to get suitable answers from them.
18638
18639 For @samp{sqrt(a+bi)}: When @expr{a<0} and @expr{b} is small but positive
18640 or zero, the result is close to the @expr{+i} axis. For @expr{b} small and
18641 negative, the result is close to the @expr{-i} axis. The result always lies
18642 in the right half of the complex plane.
18643
18644 For @samp{ln(a+bi)}: The real part is defined as @samp{ln(abs(a+bi))}.
18645 The imaginary part is defined as @samp{arg(a+bi) = arctan2(b,a)}.
18646 Thus the branch cuts for @code{sqrt} and @code{ln} both lie on the
18647 negative real axis.
18648
18649 The following table describes these branch cuts in another way.
18650 If the real and imaginary parts of @expr{z} are as shown, then
18651 the real and imaginary parts of @expr{f(z)} will be as shown.
18652 Here @code{eps} stands for a small positive value; each
18653 occurrence of @code{eps} may stand for a different small value.
18654
18655 @smallexample
18656 z sqrt(z) ln(z)
18657 ----------------------------------------
18658 +, 0 +, 0 any, 0
18659 -, 0 0, + any, pi
18660 -, +eps +eps, + +eps, +
18661 -, -eps +eps, - +eps, -
18662 @end smallexample
18663
18664 For @samp{z1^z2}: This is defined by @samp{exp(ln(z1)*z2)}.
18665 One interesting consequence of this is that @samp{(-8)^1:3} does
18666 not evaluate to @mathit{-2} as you might expect, but to the complex
18667 number @expr{(1., 1.732)}. Both of these are valid cube roots
18668 of @mathit{-8} (as is @expr{(1., -1.732)}); Calc chooses a perhaps
18669 less-obvious root for the sake of mathematical consistency.
18670
18671 For @samp{arcsin(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(i*z + sqrt(1-z^2))}.
18672 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18673
18674 For @samp{arccos(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(z + i*sqrt(1-z^2))},
18675 or equivalently by @samp{pi/2 - arcsin(z)}. The branch cuts are on
18676 the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18677
18678 For @samp{arctan(z)}: This is defined by
18679 @samp{(ln(1+i*z) - ln(1-i*z)) / (2*i)}. The branch cuts are on the
18680 imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and above @expr{i}.
18681
18682 For @samp{arcsinh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{ln(z + sqrt(1+z^2))}.
18683 The branch cuts are on the imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and
18684 above @expr{i}.
18685
18686 For @samp{arccosh(z)}: This is defined by
18687 @samp{ln(z + (z+1)*sqrt((z-1)/(z+1)))}. The branch cut is on the
18688 real axis less than 1.
18689
18690 For @samp{arctanh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{(ln(1+z) - ln(1-z)) / 2}.
18691 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18692
18693 The following tables for @code{arcsin}, @code{arccos}, and
18694 @code{arctan} assume the current angular mode is Radians. The
18695 hyperbolic functions operate independently of the angular mode.
18696
18697 @smallexample
18698 z arcsin(z) arccos(z)
18699 -------------------------------------------------------
18700 (-1..1), 0 (-pi/2..pi/2), 0 (0..pi), 0
18701 (-1..1), +eps (-pi/2..pi/2), +eps (0..pi), -eps
18702 (-1..1), -eps (-pi/2..pi/2), -eps (0..pi), +eps
18703 <-1, 0 -pi/2, + pi, -
18704 <-1, +eps -pi/2 + eps, + pi - eps, -
18705 <-1, -eps -pi/2 + eps, - pi - eps, +
18706 >1, 0 pi/2, - 0, +
18707 >1, +eps pi/2 - eps, + +eps, -
18708 >1, -eps pi/2 - eps, - +eps, +
18709 @end smallexample
18710
18711 @smallexample
18712 z arccosh(z) arctanh(z)
18713 -----------------------------------------------------
18714 (-1..1), 0 0, (0..pi) any, 0
18715 (-1..1), +eps +eps, (0..pi) any, +eps
18716 (-1..1), -eps +eps, (-pi..0) any, -eps
18717 <-1, 0 +, pi -, pi/2
18718 <-1, +eps +, pi - eps -, pi/2 - eps
18719 <-1, -eps +, -pi + eps -, -pi/2 + eps
18720 >1, 0 +, 0 +, -pi/2
18721 >1, +eps +, +eps +, pi/2 - eps
18722 >1, -eps +, -eps +, -pi/2 + eps
18723 @end smallexample
18724
18725 @smallexample
18726 z arcsinh(z) arctan(z)
18727 -----------------------------------------------------
18728 0, (-1..1) 0, (-pi/2..pi/2) 0, any
18729 0, <-1 -, -pi/2 -pi/2, -
18730 +eps, <-1 +, -pi/2 + eps pi/2 - eps, -
18731 -eps, <-1 -, -pi/2 + eps -pi/2 + eps, -
18732 0, >1 +, pi/2 pi/2, +
18733 +eps, >1 +, pi/2 - eps pi/2 - eps, +
18734 -eps, >1 -, pi/2 - eps -pi/2 + eps, +
18735 @end smallexample
18736
18737 Finally, the following identities help to illustrate the relationship
18738 between the complex trigonometric and hyperbolic functions. They
18739 are valid everywhere, including on the branch cuts.
18740
18741 @smallexample
18742 sin(i*z) = i*sinh(z) arcsin(i*z) = i*arcsinh(z)
18743 cos(i*z) = cosh(z) arcsinh(i*z) = i*arcsin(z)
18744 tan(i*z) = i*tanh(z) arctan(i*z) = i*arctanh(z)
18745 sinh(i*z) = i*sin(z) cosh(i*z) = cos(z)
18746 @end smallexample
18747
18748 The ``advanced math'' functions (gamma, Bessel, etc.@:) are also defined
18749 for general complex arguments, but their branch cuts and principal values
18750 are not rigorously specified at present.
18751
18752 @node Random Numbers, Combinatorial Functions, Branch Cuts, Scientific Functions
18753 @section Random Numbers
18754
18755 @noindent
18756 @kindex k r
18757 @pindex calc-random
18758 @tindex random
18759 The @kbd{k r} (@code{calc-random}) [@code{random}] command produces
18760 random numbers of various sorts.
18761
18762 Given a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{M}, it produces a random
18763 integer @expr{N} in the range
18764 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}.
18765 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}.
18766 Each possible value @expr{N} appears with equal probability.
18767
18768 With no numeric prefix argument, the @kbd{k r} command takes its argument
18769 from the stack instead. Once again, if this is a positive integer @expr{M}
18770 the result is a random integer less than @expr{M}. However, note that
18771 while numeric prefix arguments are limited to six digits or so, an @expr{M}
18772 taken from the stack can be arbitrarily large. If @expr{M} is negative,
18773 the result is a random integer in the range
18774 @texline @math{M < N \le 0}.
18775 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0}.
18776
18777 If the value on the stack is a floating-point number @expr{M}, the result
18778 is a random floating-point number @expr{N} in the range
18779 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}
18780 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}
18781 or
18782 @texline @math{M < N \le 0},
18783 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0},
18784 according to the sign of @expr{M}.
18785
18786 If @expr{M} is zero, the result is a Gaussian-distributed random real
18787 number; the distribution has a mean of zero and a standard deviation
18788 of one. The algorithm used generates random numbers in pairs; thus,
18789 every other call to this function will be especially fast.
18790
18791 If @expr{M} is an error form
18792 @texline @math{m} @code{+/-} @math{\sigma}
18793 @infoline @samp{m +/- s}
18794 where @var{m} and
18795 @texline @math{\sigma}
18796 @infoline @var{s}
18797 are both real numbers, the result uses a Gaussian distribution with mean
18798 @var{m} and standard deviation
18799 @texline @math{\sigma}.
18800 @infoline @var{s}.
18801
18802 If @expr{M} is an interval form, the lower and upper bounds specify the
18803 acceptable limits of the random numbers. If both bounds are integers,
18804 the result is a random integer in the specified range. If either bound
18805 is floating-point, the result is a random real number in the specified
18806 range. If the interval is open at either end, the result will be sure
18807 not to equal that end value. (This makes a big difference for integer
18808 intervals, but for floating-point intervals it's relatively minor:
18809 with a precision of 6, @samp{random([1.0..2.0))} will return any of one
18810 million numbers from 1.00000 to 1.99999; @samp{random([1.0..2.0])} may
18811 additionally return 2.00000, but the probability of this happening is
18812 extremely small.)
18813
18814 If @expr{M} is a vector, the result is one element taken at random from
18815 the vector. All elements of the vector are given equal probabilities.
18816
18817 @vindex RandSeed
18818 The sequence of numbers produced by @kbd{k r} is completely random by
18819 default, i.e., the sequence is seeded each time you start Calc using
18820 the current time and other information. You can get a reproducible
18821 sequence by storing a particular ``seed value'' in the Calc variable
18822 @code{RandSeed}. Any integer will do for a seed; integers of from 1
18823 to 12 digits are good. If you later store a different integer into
18824 @code{RandSeed}, Calc will switch to a different pseudo-random
18825 sequence. If you ``unstore'' @code{RandSeed}, Calc will re-seed itself
18826 from the current time. If you store the same integer that you used
18827 before back into @code{RandSeed}, you will get the exact same sequence
18828 of random numbers as before.
18829
18830 @pindex calc-rrandom
18831 The @code{calc-rrandom} command (not on any key) produces a random real
18832 number between zero and one. It is equivalent to @samp{random(1.0)}.
18833
18834 @kindex k a
18835 @pindex calc-random-again
18836 The @kbd{k a} (@code{calc-random-again}) command produces another random
18837 number, re-using the most recent value of @expr{M}. With a numeric
18838 prefix argument @var{n}, it produces @var{n} more random numbers using
18839 that value of @expr{M}.
18840
18841 @kindex k h
18842 @pindex calc-shuffle
18843 @tindex shuffle
18844 The @kbd{k h} (@code{calc-shuffle}) command produces a vector of several
18845 random values with no duplicates. The value on the top of the stack
18846 specifies the set from which the random values are drawn, and may be any
18847 of the @expr{M} formats described above. The numeric prefix argument
18848 gives the length of the desired list. (If you do not provide a numeric
18849 prefix argument, the length of the list is taken from the top of the
18850 stack, and @expr{M} from second-to-top.)
18851
18852 If @expr{M} is a floating-point number, zero, or an error form (so
18853 that the random values are being drawn from the set of real numbers)
18854 there is little practical difference between using @kbd{k h} and using
18855 @kbd{k r} several times. But if the set of possible values consists
18856 of just a few integers, or the elements of a vector, then there is
18857 a very real chance that multiple @kbd{k r}'s will produce the same
18858 number more than once. The @kbd{k h} command produces a vector whose
18859 elements are always distinct. (Actually, there is a slight exception:
18860 If @expr{M} is a vector, no given vector element will be drawn more
18861 than once, but if several elements of @expr{M} are equal, they may
18862 each make it into the result vector.)
18863
18864 One use of @kbd{k h} is to rearrange a list at random. This happens
18865 if the prefix argument is equal to the number of values in the list:
18866 @kbd{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3] 5 k h} might produce the permuted list
18867 @samp{[2.5, 1, 1.5, 3, 2]}. As a convenient feature, if the argument
18868 @var{n} is negative it is replaced by the size of the set represented
18869 by @expr{M}. Naturally, this is allowed only when @expr{M} specifies
18870 a small discrete set of possibilities.
18871
18872 To do the equivalent of @kbd{k h} but with duplications allowed,
18873 given @expr{M} on the stack and with @var{n} just entered as a numeric
18874 prefix, use @kbd{v b} to build a vector of copies of @expr{M}, then use
18875 @kbd{V M k r} to ``map'' the normal @kbd{k r} function over the
18876 elements of this vector. @xref{Matrix Functions}.
18877
18878 @menu
18879 * Random Number Generator:: (Complete description of Calc's algorithm)
18880 @end menu
18881
18882 @node Random Number Generator, , Random Numbers, Random Numbers
18883 @subsection Random Number Generator
18884
18885 Calc's random number generator uses several methods to ensure that
18886 the numbers it produces are highly random. Knuth's @emph{Art of
18887 Computer Programming}, Volume II, contains a thorough description
18888 of the theory of random number generators and their measurement and
18889 characterization.
18890
18891 If @code{RandSeed} has no stored value, Calc calls Emacs' built-in
18892 @code{random} function to get a stream of random numbers, which it
18893 then treats in various ways to avoid problems inherent in the simple
18894 random number generators that many systems use to implement @code{random}.
18895
18896 When Calc's random number generator is first invoked, it ``seeds''
18897 the low-level random sequence using the time of day, so that the
18898 random number sequence will be different every time you use Calc.
18899
18900 Since Emacs Lisp doesn't specify the range of values that will be
18901 returned by its @code{random} function, Calc exercises the function
18902 several times to estimate the range. When Calc subsequently uses
18903 the @code{random} function, it takes only 10 bits of the result
18904 near the most-significant end. (It avoids at least the bottom
18905 four bits, preferably more, and also tries to avoid the top two
18906 bits.) This strategy works well with the linear congruential
18907 generators that are typically used to implement @code{random}.
18908
18909 If @code{RandSeed} contains an integer, Calc uses this integer to
18910 seed an ``additive congruential'' method (Knuth's algorithm 3.2.2A,
18911 computing
18912 @texline @math{X_{n-55} - X_{n-24}}.
18913 @infoline @expr{X_n-55 - X_n-24}).
18914 This method expands the seed
18915 value into a large table which is maintained internally; the variable
18916 @code{RandSeed} is changed from, e.g., 42 to the vector @expr{[42]}
18917 to indicate that the seed has been absorbed into this table. When
18918 @code{RandSeed} contains a vector, @kbd{k r} and related commands
18919 continue to use the same internal table as last time. There is no
18920 way to extract the complete state of the random number generator
18921 so that you can restart it from any point; you can only restart it
18922 from the same initial seed value. A simple way to restart from the
18923 same seed is to type @kbd{s r RandSeed} to get the seed vector,
18924 @kbd{v u} to unpack it back into a number, then @kbd{s t RandSeed}
18925 to reseed the generator with that number.
18926
18927 Calc uses a ``shuffling'' method as described in algorithm 3.2.2B
18928 of Knuth. It fills a table with 13 random 10-bit numbers. Then,
18929 to generate a new random number, it uses the previous number to
18930 index into the table, picks the value it finds there as the new
18931 random number, then replaces that table entry with a new value
18932 obtained from a call to the base random number generator (either
18933 the additive congruential generator or the @code{random} function
18934 supplied by the system). If there are any flaws in the base
18935 generator, shuffling will tend to even them out. But if the system
18936 provides an excellent @code{random} function, shuffling will not
18937 damage its randomness.
18938
18939 To create a random integer of a certain number of digits, Calc
18940 builds the integer three decimal digits at a time. For each group
18941 of three digits, Calc calls its 10-bit shuffling random number generator
18942 (which returns a value from 0 to 1023); if the random value is 1000
18943 or more, Calc throws it out and tries again until it gets a suitable
18944 value.
18945
18946 To create a random floating-point number with precision @var{p}, Calc
18947 simply creates a random @var{p}-digit integer and multiplies by
18948 @texline @math{10^{-p}}.
18949 @infoline @expr{10^-p}.
18950 The resulting random numbers should be very clean, but note
18951 that relatively small numbers will have few significant random digits.
18952 In other words, with a precision of 12, you will occasionally get
18953 numbers on the order of
18954 @texline @math{10^{-9}}
18955 @infoline @expr{10^-9}
18956 or
18957 @texline @math{10^{-10}},
18958 @infoline @expr{10^-10},
18959 but those numbers will only have two or three random digits since they
18960 correspond to small integers times
18961 @texline @math{10^{-12}}.
18962 @infoline @expr{10^-12}.
18963
18964 To create a random integer in the interval @samp{[0 .. @var{m})}, Calc
18965 counts the digits in @var{m}, creates a random integer with three
18966 additional digits, then reduces modulo @var{m}. Unless @var{m} is a
18967 power of ten the resulting values will be very slightly biased toward
18968 the lower numbers, but this bias will be less than 0.1%. (For example,
18969 if @var{m} is 42, Calc will reduce a random integer less than 100000
18970 modulo 42 to get a result less than 42. It is easy to show that the
18971 numbers 40 and 41 will be only 2380/2381 as likely to result from this
18972 modulo operation as numbers 39 and below.) If @var{m} is a power of
18973 ten, however, the numbers should be completely unbiased.
18974
18975 The Gaussian random numbers generated by @samp{random(0.0)} use the
18976 ``polar'' method described in Knuth section 3.4.1C. This method
18977 generates a pair of Gaussian random numbers at a time, so only every
18978 other call to @samp{random(0.0)} will require significant calculations.
18979
18980 @node Combinatorial Functions, Probability Distribution Functions, Random Numbers, Scientific Functions
18981 @section Combinatorial Functions
18982
18983 @noindent
18984 Commands relating to combinatorics and number theory begin with the
18985 @kbd{k} key prefix.
18986
18987 @kindex k g
18988 @pindex calc-gcd
18989 @tindex gcd
18990 The @kbd{k g} (@code{calc-gcd}) [@code{gcd}] command computes the
18991 Greatest Common Divisor of two integers. It also accepts fractions;
18992 the GCD of two fractions is defined by taking the GCD of the
18993 numerators, and the LCM of the denominators. This definition is
18994 consistent with the idea that @samp{a / gcd(a,x)} should yield an
18995 integer for any @samp{a} and @samp{x}. For other types of arguments,
18996 the operation is left in symbolic form.
18997
18998 @kindex k l
18999 @pindex calc-lcm
19000 @tindex lcm
19001 The @kbd{k l} (@code{calc-lcm}) [@code{lcm}] command computes the
19002 Least Common Multiple of two integers or fractions. The product of
19003 the LCM and GCD of two numbers is equal to the product of the
19004 numbers.
19005
19006 @kindex k E
19007 @pindex calc-extended-gcd
19008 @tindex egcd
19009 The @kbd{k E} (@code{calc-extended-gcd}) [@code{egcd}] command computes
19010 the GCD of two integers @expr{x} and @expr{y} and returns a vector
19011 @expr{[g, a, b]} where
19012 @texline @math{g = \gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19013 @infoline @expr{g = gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19014
19015 @kindex !
19016 @pindex calc-factorial
19017 @tindex fact
19018 @ignore
19019 @mindex @null
19020 @end ignore
19021 @tindex !
19022 The @kbd{!} (@code{calc-factorial}) [@code{fact}] command computes the
19023 factorial of the number at the top of the stack. If the number is an
19024 integer, the result is an exact integer. If the number is an
19025 integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point approximation. If
19026 the number is a non-integral real number, the generalized factorial is used,
19027 as defined by the Euler Gamma function. Please note that computation of
19028 large factorials can be slow; using floating-point format will help
19029 since fewer digits must be maintained. The same is true of many of
19030 the commands in this section.
19031
19032 @kindex k d
19033 @pindex calc-double-factorial
19034 @tindex dfact
19035 @ignore
19036 @mindex @null
19037 @end ignore
19038 @tindex !!
19039 The @kbd{k d} (@code{calc-double-factorial}) [@code{dfact}] command
19040 computes the ``double factorial'' of an integer. For an even integer,
19041 this is the product of even integers from 2 to @expr{N}. For an odd
19042 integer, this is the product of odd integers from 3 to @expr{N}. If
19043 the argument is an integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point
19044 approximation. This function is undefined for negative even integers.
19045 The notation @expr{N!!} is also recognized for double factorials.
19046
19047 @kindex k c
19048 @pindex calc-choose
19049 @tindex choose
19050 The @kbd{k c} (@code{calc-choose}) [@code{choose}] command computes the
19051 binomial coefficient @expr{N}-choose-@expr{M}, where @expr{M} is the number
19052 on the top of the stack and @expr{N} is second-to-top. If both arguments
19053 are integers, the result is an exact integer. Otherwise, the result is a
19054 floating-point approximation. The binomial coefficient is defined for all
19055 real numbers by
19056 @texline @math{N! \over M! (N-M)!\,}.
19057 @infoline @expr{N! / M! (N-M)!}.
19058
19059 @kindex H k c
19060 @pindex calc-perm
19061 @tindex perm
19062 @ifnottex
19063 The @kbd{H k c} (@code{calc-perm}) [@code{perm}] command computes the
19064 number-of-permutations function @expr{N! / (N-M)!}.
19065 @end ifnottex
19066 @tex
19067 The \kbd{H k c} (\code{calc-perm}) [\code{perm}] command computes the
19068 number-of-perm\-utations function $N! \over (N-M)!\,$.
19069 @end tex
19070
19071 @kindex k b
19072 @kindex H k b
19073 @pindex calc-bernoulli-number
19074 @tindex bern
19075 The @kbd{k b} (@code{calc-bernoulli-number}) [@code{bern}] command
19076 computes a given Bernoulli number. The value at the top of the stack
19077 is a nonnegative integer @expr{n} that specifies which Bernoulli number
19078 is desired. The @kbd{H k b} command computes a Bernoulli polynomial,
19079 taking @expr{n} from the second-to-top position and @expr{x} from the
19080 top of the stack. If @expr{x} is a variable or formula the result is
19081 a polynomial in @expr{x}; if @expr{x} is a number the result is a number.
19082
19083 @kindex k e
19084 @kindex H k e
19085 @pindex calc-euler-number
19086 @tindex euler
19087 The @kbd{k e} (@code{calc-euler-number}) [@code{euler}] command similarly
19088 computes an Euler number, and @w{@kbd{H k e}} computes an Euler polynomial.
19089 Bernoulli and Euler numbers occur in the Taylor expansions of several
19090 functions.
19091
19092 @kindex k s
19093 @kindex H k s
19094 @pindex calc-stirling-number
19095 @tindex stir1
19096 @tindex stir2
19097 The @kbd{k s} (@code{calc-stirling-number}) [@code{stir1}] command
19098 computes a Stirling number of the first
19099 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brack m},
19100 @infoline kind,
19101 given two integers @expr{n} and @expr{m} on the stack. The @kbd{H k s}
19102 [@code{stir2}] command computes a Stirling number of the second
19103 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brace m}.
19104 @infoline kind.
19105 These are the number of @expr{m}-cycle permutations of @expr{n} objects,
19106 and the number of ways to partition @expr{n} objects into @expr{m}
19107 non-empty sets, respectively.
19108
19109 @kindex k p
19110 @pindex calc-prime-test
19111 @cindex Primes
19112 The @kbd{k p} (@code{calc-prime-test}) command checks if the integer on
19113 the top of the stack is prime. For integers less than eight million, the
19114 answer is always exact and reasonably fast. For larger integers, a
19115 probabilistic method is used (see Knuth vol. II, section 4.5.4, algorithm P).
19116 The number is first checked against small prime factors (up to 13). Then,
19117 any number of iterations of the algorithm are performed. Each step either
19118 discovers that the number is non-prime, or substantially increases the
19119 certainty that the number is prime. After a few steps, the chance that
19120 a number was mistakenly described as prime will be less than one percent.
19121 (Indeed, this is a worst-case estimate of the probability; in practice
19122 even a single iteration is quite reliable.) After the @kbd{k p} command,
19123 the number will be reported as definitely prime or non-prime if possible,
19124 or otherwise ``probably'' prime with a certain probability of error.
19125
19126 @ignore
19127 @starindex
19128 @end ignore
19129 @tindex prime
19130 The normal @kbd{k p} command performs one iteration of the primality
19131 test. Pressing @kbd{k p} repeatedly for the same integer will perform
19132 additional iterations. Also, @kbd{k p} with a numeric prefix performs
19133 the specified number of iterations. There is also an algebraic function
19134 @samp{prime(n)} or @samp{prime(n,iters)} which returns 1 if @expr{n}
19135 is (probably) prime and 0 if not.
19136
19137 @kindex k f
19138 @pindex calc-prime-factors
19139 @tindex prfac
19140 The @kbd{k f} (@code{calc-prime-factors}) [@code{prfac}] command
19141 attempts to decompose an integer into its prime factors. For numbers up
19142 to 25 million, the answer is exact although it may take some time. The
19143 result is a vector of the prime factors in increasing order. For larger
19144 inputs, prime factors above 5000 may not be found, in which case the
19145 last number in the vector will be an unfactored integer greater than 25
19146 million (with a warning message). For negative integers, the first
19147 element of the list will be @mathit{-1}. For inputs @mathit{-1}, @mathit{0}, and
19148 @mathit{1}, the result is a list of the same number.
19149
19150 @kindex k n
19151 @pindex calc-next-prime
19152 @ignore
19153 @mindex nextpr@idots
19154 @end ignore
19155 @tindex nextprime
19156 The @kbd{k n} (@code{calc-next-prime}) [@code{nextprime}] command finds
19157 the next prime above a given number. Essentially, it searches by calling
19158 @code{calc-prime-test} on successive integers until it finds one that
19159 passes the test. This is quite fast for integers less than eight million,
19160 but once the probabilistic test comes into play the search may be rather
19161 slow. Ordinarily this command stops for any prime that passes one iteration
19162 of the primality test. With a numeric prefix argument, a number must pass
19163 the specified number of iterations before the search stops. (This only
19164 matters when searching above eight million.) You can always use additional
19165 @kbd{k p} commands to increase your certainty that the number is indeed
19166 prime.
19167
19168 @kindex I k n
19169 @pindex calc-prev-prime
19170 @ignore
19171 @mindex prevpr@idots
19172 @end ignore
19173 @tindex prevprime
19174 The @kbd{I k n} (@code{calc-prev-prime}) [@code{prevprime}] command
19175 analogously finds the next prime less than a given number.
19176
19177 @kindex k t
19178 @pindex calc-totient
19179 @tindex totient
19180 The @kbd{k t} (@code{calc-totient}) [@code{totient}] command computes the
19181 Euler ``totient''
19182 @texline function@tie{}@math{\phi(n)},
19183 @infoline function,
19184 the number of integers less than @expr{n} which
19185 are relatively prime to @expr{n}.
19186
19187 @kindex k m
19188 @pindex calc-moebius
19189 @tindex moebius
19190 The @kbd{k m} (@code{calc-moebius}) [@code{moebius}] command computes the
19191 @texline M@"obius @math{\mu}
19192 @infoline Moebius ``mu''
19193 function. If the input number is a product of @expr{k}
19194 distinct factors, this is @expr{(-1)^k}. If the input number has any
19195 duplicate factors (i.e., can be divided by the same prime more than once),
19196 the result is zero.
19197
19198 @node Probability Distribution Functions, , Combinatorial Functions, Scientific Functions
19199 @section Probability Distribution Functions
19200
19201 @noindent
19202 The functions in this section compute various probability distributions.
19203 For continuous distributions, this is the integral of the probability
19204 density function from @expr{x} to infinity. (These are the ``upper
19205 tail'' distribution functions; there are also corresponding ``lower
19206 tail'' functions which integrate from minus infinity to @expr{x}.)
19207 For discrete distributions, the upper tail function gives the sum
19208 from @expr{x} to infinity; the lower tail function gives the sum
19209 from minus infinity up to, but not including,@w{ }@expr{x}.
19210
19211 To integrate from @expr{x} to @expr{y}, just use the distribution
19212 function twice and subtract. For example, the probability that a
19213 Gaussian random variable with mean 2 and standard deviation 1 will
19214 lie in the range from 2.5 to 2.8 is @samp{utpn(2.5,2,1) - utpn(2.8,2,1)}
19215 (``the probability that it is greater than 2.5, but not greater than 2.8''),
19216 or equivalently @samp{ltpn(2.8,2,1) - ltpn(2.5,2,1)}.
19217
19218 @kindex k B
19219 @kindex I k B
19220 @pindex calc-utpb
19221 @tindex utpb
19222 @tindex ltpb
19223 The @kbd{k B} (@code{calc-utpb}) [@code{utpb}] function uses the
19224 binomial distribution. Push the parameters @var{n}, @var{p}, and
19225 then @var{x} onto the stack; the result (@samp{utpb(x,n,p)}) is the
19226 probability that an event will occur @var{x} or more times out
19227 of @var{n} trials, if its probability of occurring in any given
19228 trial is @var{p}. The @kbd{I k B} [@code{ltpb}] function is
19229 the probability that the event will occur fewer than @var{x} times.
19230
19231 The other probability distribution functions similarly take the
19232 form @kbd{k @var{X}} (@code{calc-utp@var{x}}) [@code{utp@var{x}}]
19233 and @kbd{I k @var{X}} [@code{ltp@var{x}}], for various letters
19234 @var{x}. The arguments to the algebraic functions are the value of
19235 the random variable first, then whatever other parameters define the
19236 distribution. Note these are among the few Calc functions where the
19237 order of the arguments in algebraic form differs from the order of
19238 arguments as found on the stack. (The random variable comes last on
19239 the stack, so that you can type, e.g., @kbd{2 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 2.5
19240 k N M-@key{RET} @key{DEL} 2.8 k N -}, using @kbd{M-@key{RET} @key{DEL}} to
19241 recover the original arguments but substitute a new value for @expr{x}.)
19242
19243 @kindex k C
19244 @pindex calc-utpc
19245 @tindex utpc
19246 @ignore
19247 @mindex @idots
19248 @end ignore
19249 @kindex I k C
19250 @ignore
19251 @mindex @null
19252 @end ignore
19253 @tindex ltpc
19254 The @samp{utpc(x,v)} function uses the chi-square distribution with
19255 @texline @math{\nu}
19256 @infoline @expr{v}
19257 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a model is
19258 correct if its chi-square statistic is @expr{x}.
19259
19260 @kindex k F
19261 @pindex calc-utpf
19262 @tindex utpf
19263 @ignore
19264 @mindex @idots
19265 @end ignore
19266 @kindex I k F
19267 @ignore
19268 @mindex @null
19269 @end ignore
19270 @tindex ltpf
19271 The @samp{utpf(F,v1,v2)} function uses the F distribution, used in
19272 various statistical tests. The parameters
19273 @texline @math{\nu_1}
19274 @infoline @expr{v1}
19275 and
19276 @texline @math{\nu_2}
19277 @infoline @expr{v2}
19278 are the degrees of freedom in the numerator and denominator,
19279 respectively, used in computing the statistic @expr{F}.
19280
19281 @kindex k N
19282 @pindex calc-utpn
19283 @tindex utpn
19284 @ignore
19285 @mindex @idots
19286 @end ignore
19287 @kindex I k N
19288 @ignore
19289 @mindex @null
19290 @end ignore
19291 @tindex ltpn
19292 The @samp{utpn(x,m,s)} function uses a normal (Gaussian) distribution
19293 with mean @expr{m} and standard deviation
19294 @texline @math{\sigma}.
19295 @infoline @expr{s}.
19296 It is the probability that such a normal-distributed random variable
19297 would exceed @expr{x}.
19298
19299 @kindex k P
19300 @pindex calc-utpp
19301 @tindex utpp
19302 @ignore
19303 @mindex @idots
19304 @end ignore
19305 @kindex I k P
19306 @ignore
19307 @mindex @null
19308 @end ignore
19309 @tindex ltpp
19310 The @samp{utpp(n,x)} function uses a Poisson distribution with
19311 mean @expr{x}. It is the probability that @expr{n} or more such
19312 Poisson random events will occur.
19313
19314 @kindex k T
19315 @pindex calc-ltpt
19316 @tindex utpt
19317 @ignore
19318 @mindex @idots
19319 @end ignore
19320 @kindex I k T
19321 @ignore
19322 @mindex @null
19323 @end ignore
19324 @tindex ltpt
19325 The @samp{utpt(t,v)} function uses the Student's ``t'' distribution
19326 with
19327 @texline @math{\nu}
19328 @infoline @expr{v}
19329 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a
19330 t-distributed random variable will be greater than @expr{t}.
19331 (Note: This computes the distribution function
19332 @texline @math{A(t|\nu)}
19333 @infoline @expr{A(t|v)}
19334 where
19335 @texline @math{A(0|\nu) = 1}
19336 @infoline @expr{A(0|v) = 1}
19337 and
19338 @texline @math{A(\infty|\nu) \to 0}.
19339 @infoline @expr{A(inf|v) -> 0}.
19340 The @code{UTPT} operation on the HP-48 uses a different definition which
19341 returns half of Calc's value: @samp{UTPT(t,v) = .5*utpt(t,v)}.)
19342
19343 While Calc does not provide inverses of the probability distribution
19344 functions, the @kbd{a R} command can be used to solve for the inverse.
19345 Since the distribution functions are monotonic, @kbd{a R} is guaranteed
19346 to be able to find a solution given any initial guess.
19347 @xref{Numerical Solutions}.
19348
19349 @node Matrix Functions, Algebra, Scientific Functions, Top
19350 @chapter Vector/Matrix Functions
19351
19352 @noindent
19353 Many of the commands described here begin with the @kbd{v} prefix.
19354 (For convenience, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix is equivalent to @kbd{v}.)
19355 The commands usually apply to both plain vectors and matrices; some
19356 apply only to matrices or only to square matrices. If the argument
19357 has the wrong dimensions the operation is left in symbolic form.
19358
19359 Vectors are entered and displayed using @samp{[a,b,c]} notation.
19360 Matrices are vectors of which all elements are vectors of equal length.
19361 (Though none of the standard Calc commands use this concept, a
19362 three-dimensional matrix or rank-3 tensor could be defined as a
19363 vector of matrices, and so on.)
19364
19365 @menu
19366 * Packing and Unpacking::
19367 * Building Vectors::
19368 * Extracting Elements::
19369 * Manipulating Vectors::
19370 * Vector and Matrix Arithmetic::
19371 * Set Operations::
19372 * Statistical Operations::
19373 * Reducing and Mapping::
19374 * Vector and Matrix Formats::
19375 @end menu
19376
19377 @node Packing and Unpacking, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions, Matrix Functions
19378 @section Packing and Unpacking
19379
19380 @noindent
19381 Calc's ``pack'' and ``unpack'' commands collect stack entries to build
19382 composite objects such as vectors and complex numbers. They are
19383 described in this chapter because they are most often used to build
19384 vectors.
19385
19386 @kindex v p
19387 @kindex V p
19388 @pindex calc-pack
19389 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) [@code{pack}] command collects several
19390 elements from the stack into a matrix, complex number, HMS form, error
19391 form, etc. It uses a numeric prefix argument to specify the kind of
19392 object to be built; this argument is referred to as the ``packing mode.''
19393 If the packing mode is a nonnegative integer, a vector of that
19394 length is created. For example, @kbd{C-u 5 v p} will pop the top
19395 five stack elements and push back a single vector of those five
19396 elements. (@kbd{C-u 0 v p} simply creates an empty vector.)
19397
19398 The same effect can be had by pressing @kbd{[} to push an incomplete
19399 vector on the stack, using @key{TAB} (@code{calc-roll-down}) to sneak
19400 the incomplete object up past a certain number of elements, and
19401 then pressing @kbd{]} to complete the vector.
19402
19403 Negative packing modes create other kinds of composite objects:
19404
19405 @table @cite
19406 @item -1
19407 Two values are collected to build a complex number. For example,
19408 @kbd{5 @key{RET} 7 C-u -1 v p} creates the complex number
19409 @expr{(5, 7)}. The result is always a rectangular complex
19410 number. The two input values must both be real numbers,
19411 i.e., integers, fractions, or floats. If they are not, Calc
19412 will instead build a formula like @samp{a + (0, 1) b}. (The
19413 other packing modes also create a symbolic answer if the
19414 components are not suitable.)
19415
19416 @item -2
19417 Two values are collected to build a polar complex number.
19418 The first is the magnitude; the second is the phase expressed
19419 in either degrees or radians according to the current angular
19420 mode.
19421
19422 @item -3
19423 Three values are collected into an HMS form. The first
19424 two values (hours and minutes) must be integers or
19425 integer-valued floats. The third value may be any real
19426 number.
19427
19428 @item -4
19429 Two values are collected into an error form. The inputs
19430 may be real numbers or formulas.
19431
19432 @item -5
19433 Two values are collected into a modulo form. The inputs
19434 must be real numbers.
19435
19436 @item -6
19437 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b]}.
19438 The inputs may be real numbers, HMS or date forms, or formulas.
19439
19440 @item -7
19441 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b)}.
19442
19443 @item -8
19444 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b]}.
19445
19446 @item -9
19447 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b)}.
19448
19449 @item -10
19450 Two integer values are collected into a fraction.
19451
19452 @item -11
19453 Two values are collected into a floating-point number.
19454 The first is the mantissa; the second, which must be an
19455 integer, is the exponent. The result is the mantissa
19456 times ten to the power of the exponent.
19457
19458 @item -12
19459 This is treated the same as @mathit{-11} by the @kbd{v p} command.
19460 When unpacking, @mathit{-12} specifies that a floating-point mantissa
19461 is desired.
19462
19463 @item -13
19464 A real number is converted into a date form.
19465
19466 @item -14
19467 Three numbers (year, month, day) are packed into a pure date form.
19468
19469 @item -15
19470 Six numbers are packed into a date/time form.
19471 @end table
19472
19473 With any of the two-input negative packing modes, either or both
19474 of the inputs may be vectors. If both are vectors of the same
19475 length, the result is another vector made by packing corresponding
19476 elements of the input vectors. If one input is a vector and the
19477 other is a plain number, the number is packed along with each vector
19478 element to produce a new vector. For example, @kbd{C-u -4 v p}
19479 could be used to convert a vector of numbers and a vector of errors
19480 into a single vector of error forms; @kbd{C-u -5 v p} could convert
19481 a vector of numbers and a single number @var{M} into a vector of
19482 numbers modulo @var{M}.
19483
19484 If you don't give a prefix argument to @kbd{v p}, it takes
19485 the packing mode from the top of the stack. The elements to
19486 be packed then begin at stack level 2. Thus
19487 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 4 n v p} is another way to
19488 enter the error form @samp{1 +/- 2}.
19489
19490 If the packing mode taken from the stack is a vector, the result is a
19491 matrix with the dimensions specified by the elements of the vector,
19492 which must each be integers. For example, if the packing mode is
19493 @samp{[2, 3]}, then six numbers will be taken from the stack and
19494 returned in the form @samp{[@w{[a, b, c]}, [d, e, f]]}.
19495
19496 If any elements of the vector are negative, other kinds of
19497 packing are done at that level as described above. For
19498 example, @samp{[2, 3, -4]} takes 12 objects and creates a
19499 @texline @math{2\times3}
19500 @infoline 2x3
19501 matrix of error forms: @samp{[[a +/- b, c +/- d ... ]]}.
19502 Also, @samp{[-4, -10]} will convert four integers into an
19503 error form consisting of two fractions: @samp{a:b +/- c:d}.
19504
19505 @ignore
19506 @starindex
19507 @end ignore
19508 @tindex pack
19509 There is an equivalent algebraic function,
19510 @samp{pack(@var{mode}, @var{items})} where @var{mode} is a
19511 packing mode (an integer or a vector of integers) and @var{items}
19512 is a vector of objects to be packed (re-packed, really) according
19513 to that mode. For example, @samp{pack([3, -4], [a,b,c,d,e,f])}
19514 yields @samp{[a +/- b, @w{c +/- d}, e +/- f]}. The function is
19515 left in symbolic form if the packing mode is invalid, or if the
19516 number of data items does not match the number of items required
19517 by the mode.
19518
19519 @kindex v u
19520 @kindex V u
19521 @pindex calc-unpack
19522 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the vector, complex
19523 number, HMS form, or other composite object on the top of the stack and
19524 ``unpacks'' it, pushing each of its elements onto the stack as separate
19525 objects. Thus, it is the ``inverse'' of @kbd{v p}. If the value
19526 at the top of the stack is a formula, @kbd{v u} unpacks it by pushing
19527 each of the arguments of the top-level operator onto the stack.
19528
19529 You can optionally give a numeric prefix argument to @kbd{v u}
19530 to specify an explicit (un)packing mode. If the packing mode is
19531 negative and the input is actually a vector or matrix, the result
19532 will be two or more similar vectors or matrices of the elements.
19533 For example, given the vector @samp{[@w{a +/- b}, c^2, d +/- 7]},
19534 the result of @kbd{C-u -4 v u} will be the two vectors
19535 @samp{[a, c^2, d]} and @w{@samp{[b, 0, 7]}}.
19536
19537 Note that the prefix argument can have an effect even when the input is
19538 not a vector. For example, if the input is the number @mathit{-5}, then
19539 @kbd{c-u -1 v u} yields @mathit{-5} and 0 (the components of @mathit{-5}
19540 when viewed as a rectangular complex number); @kbd{C-u -2 v u} yields 5
19541 and 180 (assuming Degrees mode); and @kbd{C-u -10 v u} yields @mathit{-5}
19542 and 1 (the numerator and denominator of @mathit{-5}, viewed as a rational
19543 number). Plain @kbd{v u} with this input would complain that the input
19544 is not a composite object.
19545
19546 Unpacking mode @mathit{-11} converts a float into an integer mantissa and
19547 an integer exponent, where the mantissa is not divisible by 10
19548 (except that 0.0 is represented by a mantissa and exponent of 0).
19549 Unpacking mode @mathit{-12} converts a float into a floating-point mantissa
19550 and integer exponent, where the mantissa (for non-zero numbers)
19551 is guaranteed to lie in the range [1 .. 10). In both cases,
19552 the mantissa is shifted left or right (and the exponent adjusted
19553 to compensate) in order to satisfy these constraints.
19554
19555 Positive unpacking modes are treated differently than for @kbd{v p}.
19556 A mode of 1 is much like plain @kbd{v u} with no prefix argument,
19557 except that in addition to the components of the input object,
19558 a suitable packing mode to re-pack the object is also pushed.
19559 Thus, @kbd{C-u 1 v u} followed by @kbd{v p} will re-build the
19560 original object.
19561
19562 A mode of 2 unpacks two levels of the object; the resulting
19563 re-packing mode will be a vector of length 2. This might be used
19564 to unpack a matrix, say, or a vector of error forms. Higher
19565 unpacking modes unpack the input even more deeply.
19566
19567 @ignore
19568 @starindex
19569 @end ignore
19570 @tindex unpack
19571 There are two algebraic functions analogous to @kbd{v u}.
19572 The @samp{unpack(@var{mode}, @var{item})} function unpacks the
19573 @var{item} using the given @var{mode}, returning the result as
19574 a vector of components. Here the @var{mode} must be an
19575 integer, not a vector. For example, @samp{unpack(-4, a +/- b)}
19576 returns @samp{[a, b]}, as does @samp{unpack(1, a +/- b)}.
19577
19578 @ignore
19579 @starindex
19580 @end ignore
19581 @tindex unpackt
19582 The @code{unpackt} function is like @code{unpack} but instead
19583 of returning a simple vector of items, it returns a vector of
19584 two things: The mode, and the vector of items. For example,
19585 @samp{unpackt(1, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[-4, [2:3, 1:4]]},
19586 and @samp{unpackt(2, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[[-4, -10], [2, 3, 1, 4]]}.
19587 The identity for re-building the original object is
19588 @samp{apply(pack, unpackt(@var{n}, @var{x})) = @var{x}}. (The
19589 @code{apply} function builds a function call given the function
19590 name and a vector of arguments.)
19591
19592 @cindex Numerator of a fraction, extracting
19593 Subscript notation is a useful way to extract a particular part
19594 of an object. For example, to get the numerator of a rational
19595 number, you can use @samp{unpack(-10, @var{x})_1}.
19596
19597 @node Building Vectors, Extracting Elements, Packing and Unpacking, Matrix Functions
19598 @section Building Vectors
19599
19600 @noindent
19601 Vectors and matrices can be added,
19602 subtracted, multiplied, and divided; @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}.
19603
19604 @kindex |
19605 @pindex calc-concat
19606 @ignore
19607 @mindex @null
19608 @end ignore
19609 @tindex |
19610 The @kbd{|} (@code{calc-concat}) [@code{vconcat}] command ``concatenates'' two vectors
19611 into one. For example, after @kbd{@w{[ 1 , 2 ]} [ 3 , 4 ] |}, the stack
19612 will contain the single vector @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]}. If the arguments
19613 are matrices, the rows of the first matrix are concatenated with the
19614 rows of the second. (In other words, two matrices are just two vectors
19615 of row-vectors as far as @kbd{|} is concerned.)
19616
19617 If either argument to @kbd{|} is a scalar (a non-vector), it is treated
19618 like a one-element vector for purposes of concatenation: @kbd{1 [ 2 , 3 ] |}
19619 produces the vector @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Likewise, if one argument is a
19620 matrix and the other is a plain vector, the vector is treated as a
19621 one-row matrix.
19622
19623 @kindex H |
19624 @tindex append
19625 The @kbd{H |} (@code{calc-append}) [@code{append}] command concatenates
19626 two vectors without any special cases. Both inputs must be vectors.
19627 Whether or not they are matrices is not taken into account. If either
19628 argument is a scalar, the @code{append} function is left in symbolic form.
19629 See also @code{cons} and @code{rcons} below.
19630
19631 @kindex I |
19632 @kindex H I |
19633 The @kbd{I |} and @kbd{H I |} commands are similar, but they use their
19634 two stack arguments in the opposite order. Thus @kbd{I |} is equivalent
19635 to @kbd{@key{TAB} |}, but possibly more convenient and also a bit faster.
19636
19637 @kindex v d
19638 @kindex V d
19639 @pindex calc-diag
19640 @tindex diag
19641 The @kbd{v d} (@code{calc-diag}) [@code{diag}] function builds a diagonal
19642 square matrix. The optional numeric prefix gives the number of rows
19643 and columns in the matrix. If the value at the top of the stack is a
19644 vector, the elements of the vector are used as the diagonal elements; the
19645 prefix, if specified, must match the size of the vector. If the value on
19646 the stack is a scalar, it is used for each element on the diagonal, and
19647 the prefix argument is required.
19648
19649 To build a constant square matrix, e.g., a
19650 @texline @math{3\times3}
19651 @infoline 3x3
19652 matrix filled with ones, use @kbd{0 M-3 v d 1 +}, i.e., build a zero
19653 matrix first and then add a constant value to that matrix. (Another
19654 alternative would be to use @kbd{v b} and @kbd{v a}; see below.)
19655
19656 @kindex v i
19657 @kindex V i
19658 @pindex calc-ident
19659 @tindex idn
19660 The @kbd{v i} (@code{calc-ident}) [@code{idn}] function builds an identity
19661 matrix of the specified size. It is a convenient form of @kbd{v d}
19662 where the diagonal element is always one. If no prefix argument is given,
19663 this command prompts for one.
19664
19665 In algebraic notation, @samp{idn(a,n)} acts much like @samp{diag(a,n)},
19666 except that @expr{a} is required to be a scalar (non-vector) quantity.
19667 If @expr{n} is omitted, @samp{idn(a)} represents @expr{a} times an
19668 identity matrix of unknown size. Calc can operate algebraically on
19669 such generic identity matrices, and if one is combined with a matrix
19670 whose size is known, it is converted automatically to an identity
19671 matrix of a suitable matching size. The @kbd{v i} command with an
19672 argument of zero creates a generic identity matrix, @samp{idn(1)}.
19673 Note that in dimensioned Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), generic
19674 identity matrices are immediately expanded to the current default
19675 dimensions.
19676
19677 @kindex v x
19678 @kindex V x
19679 @pindex calc-index
19680 @tindex index
19681 The @kbd{v x} (@code{calc-index}) [@code{index}] function builds a vector
19682 of consecutive integers from 1 to @var{n}, where @var{n} is the numeric
19683 prefix argument. If you do not provide a prefix argument, you will be
19684 prompted to enter a suitable number. If @var{n} is negative, the result
19685 is a vector of negative integers from @var{n} to @mathit{-1}.
19686
19687 With a prefix argument of just @kbd{C-u}, the @kbd{v x} command takes
19688 three values from the stack: @var{n}, @var{start}, and @var{incr} (with
19689 @var{incr} at top-of-stack). Counting starts at @var{start} and increases
19690 by @var{incr} for successive vector elements. If @var{start} or @var{n}
19691 is in floating-point format, the resulting vector elements will also be
19692 floats. Note that @var{start} and @var{incr} may in fact be any kind
19693 of numbers or formulas.
19694
19695 When @var{start} and @var{incr} are specified, a negative @var{n} has a
19696 different interpretation: It causes a geometric instead of arithmetic
19697 sequence to be generated. For example, @samp{index(-3, a, b)} produces
19698 @samp{[a, a b, a b^2]}. If you omit @var{incr} in the algebraic form,
19699 @samp{index(@var{n}, @var{start})}, the default value for @var{incr}
19700 is one for positive @var{n} or two for negative @var{n}.
19701
19702 @kindex v b
19703 @kindex V b
19704 @pindex calc-build-vector
19705 @tindex cvec
19706 The @kbd{v b} (@code{calc-build-vector}) [@code{cvec}] function builds a
19707 vector of @var{n} copies of the value on the top of the stack, where @var{n}
19708 is the numeric prefix argument. In algebraic formulas, @samp{cvec(x,n,m)}
19709 can also be used to build an @var{n}-by-@var{m} matrix of copies of @var{x}.
19710 (Interactively, just use @kbd{v b} twice: once to build a row, then again
19711 to build a matrix of copies of that row.)
19712
19713 @kindex v h
19714 @kindex V h
19715 @kindex I v h
19716 @kindex I V h
19717 @pindex calc-head
19718 @pindex calc-tail
19719 @tindex head
19720 @tindex tail
19721 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) [@code{head}] function returns the first
19722 element of a vector. The @kbd{I v h} (@code{calc-tail}) [@code{tail}]
19723 function returns the vector with its first element removed. In both
19724 cases, the argument must be a non-empty vector.
19725
19726 @kindex v k
19727 @kindex V k
19728 @pindex calc-cons
19729 @tindex cons
19730 The @kbd{v k} (@code{calc-cons}) [@code{cons}] function takes a value @var{h}
19731 and a vector @var{t} from the stack, and produces the vector whose head is
19732 @var{h} and whose tail is @var{t}. This is similar to @kbd{|}, except
19733 if @var{h} is itself a vector, @kbd{|} will concatenate the two vectors
19734 whereas @code{cons} will insert @var{h} at the front of the vector @var{t}.
19735
19736 @kindex H v h
19737 @kindex H V h
19738 @tindex rhead
19739 @ignore
19740 @mindex @idots
19741 @end ignore
19742 @kindex H I v h
19743 @kindex H I V h
19744 @ignore
19745 @mindex @null
19746 @end ignore
19747 @kindex H v k
19748 @kindex H V k
19749 @ignore
19750 @mindex @null
19751 @end ignore
19752 @tindex rtail
19753 @ignore
19754 @mindex @null
19755 @end ignore
19756 @tindex rcons
19757 Each of these three functions also accepts the Hyperbolic flag [@code{rhead},
19758 @code{rtail}, @code{rcons}] in which case @var{t} instead represents
19759 the @emph{last} single element of the vector, with @var{h}
19760 representing the remainder of the vector. Thus the vector
19761 @samp{[a, b, c, d] = cons(a, [b, c, d]) = rcons([a, b, c], d)}.
19762 Also, @samp{head([a, b, c, d]) = a}, @samp{tail([a, b, c, d]) = [b, c, d]},
19763 @samp{rhead([a, b, c, d]) = [a, b, c]}, and @samp{rtail([a, b, c, d]) = d}.
19764
19765 @node Extracting Elements, Manipulating Vectors, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions
19766 @section Extracting Vector Elements
19767
19768 @noindent
19769 @kindex v r
19770 @kindex V r
19771 @pindex calc-mrow
19772 @tindex mrow
19773 The @kbd{v r} (@code{calc-mrow}) [@code{mrow}] command extracts one row of
19774 the matrix on the top of the stack, or one element of the plain vector on
19775 the top of the stack. The row or element is specified by the numeric
19776 prefix argument; the default is to prompt for the row or element number.
19777 The matrix or vector is replaced by the specified row or element in the
19778 form of a vector or scalar, respectively.
19779
19780 @cindex Permutations, applying
19781 With a prefix argument of @kbd{C-u} only, @kbd{v r} takes the index of
19782 the element or row from the top of the stack, and the vector or matrix
19783 from the second-to-top position. If the index is itself a vector of
19784 integers, the result is a vector of the corresponding elements of the
19785 input vector, or a matrix of the corresponding rows of the input matrix.
19786 This command can be used to obtain any permutation of a vector.
19787
19788 With @kbd{C-u}, if the index is an interval form with integer components,
19789 it is interpreted as a range of indices and the corresponding subvector or
19790 submatrix is returned.
19791
19792 @cindex Subscript notation
19793 @kindex a _
19794 @pindex calc-subscript
19795 @tindex subscr
19796 @tindex _
19797 Subscript notation in algebraic formulas (@samp{a_b}) stands for the
19798 Calc function @code{subscr}, which is synonymous with @code{mrow}.
19799 Thus, @samp{[x, y, z]_k} produces @expr{x}, @expr{y}, or @expr{z} if
19800 @expr{k} is one, two, or three, respectively. A double subscript
19801 (@samp{M_i_j}, equivalent to @samp{subscr(subscr(M, i), j)}) will
19802 access the element at row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of a matrix.
19803 The @kbd{a _} (@code{calc-subscript}) command creates a subscript
19804 formula @samp{a_b} out of two stack entries. (It is on the @kbd{a}
19805 ``algebra'' prefix because subscripted variables are often used
19806 purely as an algebraic notation.)
19807
19808 @tindex mrrow
19809 Given a negative prefix argument, @kbd{v r} instead deletes one row or
19810 element from the matrix or vector on the top of the stack. Thus
19811 @kbd{C-u 2 v r} replaces a matrix with its second row, but @kbd{C-u -2 v r}
19812 replaces the matrix with the same matrix with its second row removed.
19813 In algebraic form this function is called @code{mrrow}.
19814
19815 @tindex getdiag
19816 Given a prefix argument of zero, @kbd{v r} extracts the diagonal elements
19817 of a square matrix in the form of a vector. In algebraic form this
19818 function is called @code{getdiag}.
19819
19820 @kindex v c
19821 @kindex V c
19822 @pindex calc-mcol
19823 @tindex mcol
19824 @tindex mrcol
19825 The @kbd{v c} (@code{calc-mcol}) [@code{mcol} or @code{mrcol}] command is
19826 the analogous operation on columns of a matrix. Given a plain vector
19827 it extracts (or removes) one element, just like @kbd{v r}. If the
19828 index in @kbd{C-u v c} is an interval or vector and the argument is a
19829 matrix, the result is a submatrix with only the specified columns
19830 retained (and possibly permuted in the case of a vector index).
19831
19832 To extract a matrix element at a given row and column, use @kbd{v r} to
19833 extract the row as a vector, then @kbd{v c} to extract the column element
19834 from that vector. In algebraic formulas, it is often more convenient to
19835 use subscript notation: @samp{m_i_j} gives row @expr{i}, column @expr{j}
19836 of matrix @expr{m}.
19837
19838 @kindex v s
19839 @kindex V s
19840 @pindex calc-subvector
19841 @tindex subvec
19842 The @kbd{v s} (@code{calc-subvector}) [@code{subvec}] command extracts
19843 a subvector of a vector. The arguments are the vector, the starting
19844 index, and the ending index, with the ending index in the top-of-stack
19845 position. The starting index indicates the first element of the vector
19846 to take. The ending index indicates the first element @emph{past} the
19847 range to be taken. Thus, @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)} produces
19848 the subvector @samp{[b, c]}. You could get the same result using
19849 @samp{mrow([a, b, c, d, e], @w{[2 .. 4)})}.
19850
19851 If either the start or the end index is zero or negative, it is
19852 interpreted as relative to the end of the vector. Thus
19853 @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, -2)} also produces @samp{[b, c]}. In
19854 the algebraic form, the end index can be omitted in which case it
19855 is taken as zero, i.e., elements from the starting element to the
19856 end of the vector are used. The infinity symbol, @code{inf}, also
19857 has this effect when used as the ending index.
19858
19859 @kindex I v s
19860 @kindex I V s
19861 @tindex rsubvec
19862 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I v s} [@code{rsubvec}] removes a subvector
19863 from a vector. The arguments are interpreted the same as for the
19864 normal @kbd{v s} command. Thus, @samp{rsubvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)}
19865 produces @samp{[a, d, e]}. It is always true that @code{subvec} and
19866 @code{rsubvec} return complementary parts of the input vector.
19867
19868 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for an alternative way to operate on
19869 vectors one element at a time.
19870
19871 @node Manipulating Vectors, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Extracting Elements, Matrix Functions
19872 @section Manipulating Vectors
19873
19874 @noindent
19875 @kindex v l
19876 @kindex V l
19877 @pindex calc-vlength
19878 @tindex vlen
19879 The @kbd{v l} (@code{calc-vlength}) [@code{vlen}] command computes the
19880 length of a vector. The length of a non-vector is considered to be zero.
19881 Note that matrices are just vectors of vectors for the purposes of this
19882 command.
19883
19884 @kindex H v l
19885 @kindex H V l
19886 @tindex mdims
19887 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v l} [@code{mdims}] computes a vector
19888 of the dimensions of a vector, matrix, or higher-order object. For
19889 example, @samp{mdims([[a,b,c],[d,e,f]])} returns @samp{[2, 3]} since
19890 its argument is a
19891 @texline @math{2\times3}
19892 @infoline 2x3
19893 matrix.
19894
19895 @kindex v f
19896 @kindex V f
19897 @pindex calc-vector-find
19898 @tindex find
19899 The @kbd{v f} (@code{calc-vector-find}) [@code{find}] command searches
19900 along a vector for the first element equal to a given target. The target
19901 is on the top of the stack; the vector is in the second-to-top position.
19902 If a match is found, the result is the index of the matching element.
19903 Otherwise, the result is zero. The numeric prefix argument, if given,
19904 allows you to select any starting index for the search.
19905
19906 @kindex v a
19907 @kindex V a
19908 @pindex calc-arrange-vector
19909 @tindex arrange
19910 @cindex Arranging a matrix
19911 @cindex Reshaping a matrix
19912 @cindex Flattening a matrix
19913 The @kbd{v a} (@code{calc-arrange-vector}) [@code{arrange}] command
19914 rearranges a vector to have a certain number of columns and rows. The
19915 numeric prefix argument specifies the number of columns; if you do not
19916 provide an argument, you will be prompted for the number of columns.
19917 The vector or matrix on the top of the stack is @dfn{flattened} into a
19918 plain vector. If the number of columns is nonzero, this vector is
19919 then formed into a matrix by taking successive groups of @var{n} elements.
19920 If the number of columns does not evenly divide the number of elements
19921 in the vector, the last row will be short and the result will not be
19922 suitable for use as a matrix. For example, with the matrix
19923 @samp{[[1, 2], @w{[3, 4]}]} on the stack, @kbd{v a 4} produces
19924 @samp{[[1, 2, 3, 4]]} (a
19925 @texline @math{1\times4}
19926 @infoline 1x4
19927 matrix), @kbd{v a 1} produces @samp{[[1], [2], [3], [4]]} (a
19928 @texline @math{4\times1}
19929 @infoline 4x1
19930 matrix), @kbd{v a 2} produces @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4]]} (the original
19931 @texline @math{2\times2}
19932 @infoline 2x2
19933 matrix), @w{@kbd{v a 3}} produces @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4]]} (not a
19934 matrix), and @kbd{v a 0} produces the flattened list
19935 @samp{[1, 2, @w{3, 4}]}.
19936
19937 @cindex Sorting data
19938 @kindex v S
19939 @kindex V S
19940 @kindex I v S
19941 @kindex I V S
19942 @pindex calc-sort
19943 @tindex sort
19944 @tindex rsort
19945 The @kbd{V S} (@code{calc-sort}) [@code{sort}] command sorts the elements of
19946 a vector into increasing order. Real numbers, real infinities, and
19947 constant interval forms come first in this ordering; next come other
19948 kinds of numbers, then variables (in alphabetical order), then finally
19949 come formulas and other kinds of objects; these are sorted according
19950 to a kind of lexicographic ordering with the useful property that
19951 one vector is less or greater than another if the first corresponding
19952 unequal elements are less or greater, respectively. Since quoted strings
19953 are stored by Calc internally as vectors of ASCII character codes
19954 (@pxref{Strings}), this means vectors of strings are also sorted into
19955 alphabetical order by this command.
19956
19957 The @kbd{I V S} [@code{rsort}] command sorts a vector into decreasing order.
19958
19959 @cindex Permutation, inverse of
19960 @cindex Inverse of permutation
19961 @cindex Index tables
19962 @cindex Rank tables
19963 @kindex v G
19964 @kindex V G
19965 @kindex I v G
19966 @kindex I V G
19967 @pindex calc-grade
19968 @tindex grade
19969 @tindex rgrade
19970 The @kbd{V G} (@code{calc-grade}) [@code{grade}, @code{rgrade}] command
19971 produces an index table or permutation vector which, if applied to the
19972 input vector (as the index of @kbd{C-u v r}, say), would sort the vector.
19973 A permutation vector is just a vector of integers from 1 to @var{n}, where
19974 each integer occurs exactly once. One application of this is to sort a
19975 matrix of data rows using one column as the sort key; extract that column,
19976 grade it with @kbd{V G}, then use the result to reorder the original matrix
19977 with @kbd{C-u v r}. Another interesting property of the @code{V G} command
19978 is that, if the input is itself a permutation vector, the result will
19979 be the inverse of the permutation. The inverse of an index table is
19980 a rank table, whose @var{k}th element says where the @var{k}th original
19981 vector element will rest when the vector is sorted. To get a rank
19982 table, just use @kbd{V G V G}.
19983
19984 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I V G} produces an index table that would
19985 sort the input into decreasing order. Note that @kbd{V S} and @kbd{V G}
19986 use a ``stable'' sorting algorithm, i.e., any two elements which are equal
19987 will not be moved out of their original order. Generally there is no way
19988 to tell with @kbd{V S}, since two elements which are equal look the same,
19989 but with @kbd{V G} this can be an important issue. In the matrix-of-rows
19990 example, suppose you have names and telephone numbers as two columns and
19991 you wish to sort by phone number primarily, and by name when the numbers
19992 are equal. You can sort the data matrix by names first, and then again
19993 by phone numbers. Because the sort is stable, any two rows with equal
19994 phone numbers will remain sorted by name even after the second sort.
19995
19996 @cindex Histograms
19997 @kindex v H
19998 @kindex V H
19999 @pindex calc-histogram
20000 @ignore
20001 @mindex histo@idots
20002 @end ignore
20003 @tindex histogram
20004 The @kbd{V H} (@code{calc-histogram}) [@code{histogram}] command builds a
20005 histogram of a vector of numbers. Vector elements are assumed to be
20006 integers or real numbers in the range [0..@var{n}) for some ``number of
20007 bins'' @var{n}, which is the numeric prefix argument given to the
20008 command. The result is a vector of @var{n} counts of how many times
20009 each value appeared in the original vector. Non-integers in the input
20010 are rounded down to integers. Any vector elements outside the specified
20011 range are ignored. (You can tell if elements have been ignored by noting
20012 that the counts in the result vector don't add up to the length of the
20013 input vector.)
20014
20015 @kindex H v H
20016 @kindex H V H
20017 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H V H} pulls two vectors from the stack.
20018 The second-to-top vector is the list of numbers as before. The top
20019 vector is an equal-sized list of ``weights'' to attach to the elements
20020 of the data vector. For example, if the first data element is 4.2 and
20021 the first weight is 10, then 10 will be added to bin 4 of the result
20022 vector. Without the hyperbolic flag, every element has a weight of one.
20023
20024 @kindex v t
20025 @kindex V t
20026 @pindex calc-transpose
20027 @tindex trn
20028 The @kbd{v t} (@code{calc-transpose}) [@code{trn}] command computes
20029 the transpose of the matrix at the top of the stack. If the argument
20030 is a plain vector, it is treated as a row vector and transposed into
20031 a one-column matrix.
20032
20033 @kindex v v
20034 @kindex V v
20035 @pindex calc-reverse-vector
20036 @tindex rev
20037 The @kbd{v v} (@code{calc-reverse-vector}) [@code{rev}] command reverses
20038 a vector end-for-end. Given a matrix, it reverses the order of the rows.
20039 (To reverse the columns instead, just use @kbd{v t v v v t}. The same
20040 principle can be used to apply other vector commands to the columns of
20041 a matrix.)
20042
20043 @kindex v m
20044 @kindex V m
20045 @pindex calc-mask-vector
20046 @tindex vmask
20047 The @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector}) [@code{vmask}] command uses
20048 one vector as a mask to extract elements of another vector. The mask
20049 is in the second-to-top position; the target vector is on the top of
20050 the stack. These vectors must have the same length. The result is
20051 the same as the target vector, but with all elements which correspond
20052 to zeros in the mask vector deleted. Thus, for example,
20053 @samp{vmask([1, 0, 1, 0, 1], [a, b, c, d, e])} produces @samp{[a, c, e]}.
20054 @xref{Logical Operations}.
20055
20056 @kindex v e
20057 @kindex V e
20058 @pindex calc-expand-vector
20059 @tindex vexp
20060 The @kbd{v e} (@code{calc-expand-vector}) [@code{vexp}] command
20061 expands a vector according to another mask vector. The result is a
20062 vector the same length as the mask, but with nonzero elements replaced
20063 by successive elements from the target vector. The length of the target
20064 vector is normally the number of nonzero elements in the mask. If the
20065 target vector is longer, its last few elements are lost. If the target
20066 vector is shorter, the last few nonzero mask elements are left
20067 unreplaced in the result. Thus @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b])}
20068 produces @samp{[a, 0, b, 0, 7]}.
20069
20070 @kindex H v e
20071 @kindex H V e
20072 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v e} takes a filler value from the
20073 top of the stack; the mask and target vectors come from the third and
20074 second elements of the stack. This filler is used where the mask is
20075 zero: @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b], z)} produces
20076 @samp{[a, z, c, z, 7]}. If the filler value is itself a vector,
20077 then successive values are taken from it, so that the effect is to
20078 interleave two vectors according to the mask:
20079 @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 7, 0, 0], [a, b], [x, y])} produces
20080 @samp{[a, x, b, 7, y, 0]}.
20081
20082 Another variation on the masking idea is to combine @samp{[a, b, c, d, e]}
20083 with the mask @samp{[1, 0, 1, 0, 1]} to produce @samp{[a, 0, c, 0, e]}.
20084 You can accomplish this with @kbd{V M a &}, mapping the logical ``and''
20085 operation across the two vectors. @xref{Logical Operations}. Note that
20086 the @code{? :} operation also discussed there allows other types of
20087 masking using vectors.
20088
20089 @node Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Set Operations, Manipulating Vectors, Matrix Functions
20090 @section Vector and Matrix Arithmetic
20091
20092 @noindent
20093 Basic arithmetic operations like addition and multiplication are defined
20094 for vectors and matrices as well as for numbers. Division of matrices, in
20095 the sense of multiplying by the inverse, is supported. (Division by a
20096 matrix actually uses LU-decomposition for greater accuracy and speed.)
20097 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
20098
20099 The following functions are applied element-wise if their arguments are
20100 vectors or matrices: @code{change-sign}, @code{conj}, @code{arg},
20101 @code{re}, @code{im}, @code{polar}, @code{rect}, @code{clean},
20102 @code{float}, @code{frac}. @xref{Function Index}.
20103
20104 @kindex v J
20105 @kindex V J
20106 @pindex calc-conj-transpose
20107 @tindex ctrn
20108 The @kbd{V J} (@code{calc-conj-transpose}) [@code{ctrn}] command computes
20109 the conjugate transpose of its argument, i.e., @samp{conj(trn(x))}.
20110
20111 @ignore
20112 @mindex A
20113 @end ignore
20114 @kindex A (vectors)
20115 @pindex calc-abs (vectors)
20116 @ignore
20117 @mindex abs
20118 @end ignore
20119 @tindex abs (vectors)
20120 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the
20121 Frobenius norm of a vector or matrix argument. This is the square
20122 root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
20123 elements of the vector or matrix. If the vector is interpreted as
20124 a point in two- or three-dimensional space, this is the distance
20125 from that point to the origin.
20126
20127 @kindex v n
20128 @kindex V n
20129 @pindex calc-rnorm
20130 @tindex rnorm
20131 The @kbd{v n} (@code{calc-rnorm}) [@code{rnorm}] command computes the
20132 infinity-norm of a vector, or the row norm of a matrix. For a plain
20133 vector, this is the maximum of the absolute values of the elements. For
20134 a matrix, this is the maximum of the row-absolute-value-sums, i.e., of
20135 the sums of the absolute values of the elements along the various rows.
20136
20137 @kindex v N
20138 @kindex V N
20139 @pindex calc-cnorm
20140 @tindex cnorm
20141 The @kbd{V N} (@code{calc-cnorm}) [@code{cnorm}] command computes
20142 the one-norm of a vector, or column norm of a matrix. For a plain
20143 vector, this is the sum of the absolute values of the elements.
20144 For a matrix, this is the maximum of the column-absolute-value-sums.
20145 General @expr{k}-norms for @expr{k} other than one or infinity are
20146 not provided. However, the 2-norm (or Frobenius norm) is provided for
20147 vectors by the @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) command.
20148
20149 @kindex v C
20150 @kindex V C
20151 @pindex calc-cross
20152 @tindex cross
20153 The @kbd{V C} (@code{calc-cross}) [@code{cross}] command computes the
20154 right-handed cross product of two vectors, each of which must have
20155 exactly three elements.
20156
20157 @ignore
20158 @mindex &
20159 @end ignore
20160 @kindex & (matrices)
20161 @pindex calc-inv (matrices)
20162 @ignore
20163 @mindex inv
20164 @end ignore
20165 @tindex inv (matrices)
20166 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
20167 inverse of a square matrix. If the matrix is singular, the inverse
20168 operation is left in symbolic form. Matrix inverses are recorded so
20169 that once an inverse (or determinant) of a particular matrix has been
20170 computed, the inverse and determinant of the matrix can be recomputed
20171 quickly in the future.
20172
20173 If the argument to @kbd{&} is a plain number @expr{x}, this
20174 command simply computes @expr{1/x}. This is okay, because the
20175 @samp{/} operator also does a matrix inversion when dividing one
20176 by a matrix.
20177
20178 @kindex v D
20179 @kindex V D
20180 @pindex calc-mdet
20181 @tindex det
20182 The @kbd{V D} (@code{calc-mdet}) [@code{det}] command computes the
20183 determinant of a square matrix.
20184
20185 @kindex v L
20186 @kindex V L
20187 @pindex calc-mlud
20188 @tindex lud
20189 The @kbd{V L} (@code{calc-mlud}) [@code{lud}] command computes the
20190 LU decomposition of a matrix. The result is a list of three matrices
20191 which, when multiplied together left-to-right, form the original matrix.
20192 The first is a permutation matrix that arises from pivoting in the
20193 algorithm, the second is lower-triangular with ones on the diagonal,
20194 and the third is upper-triangular.
20195
20196 @kindex v T
20197 @kindex V T
20198 @pindex calc-mtrace
20199 @tindex tr
20200 The @kbd{V T} (@code{calc-mtrace}) [@code{tr}] command computes the
20201 trace of a square matrix. This is defined as the sum of the diagonal
20202 elements of the matrix.
20203
20204 @kindex v K
20205 @kindex V K
20206 @pindex calc-kron
20207 @tindex kron
20208 The @kbd{V K} (@code{calc-kron}) [@code{kron}] command computes
20209 the Kronecker product of two matrices.
20210
20211 @node Set Operations, Statistical Operations, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Matrix Functions
20212 @section Set Operations using Vectors
20213
20214 @noindent
20215 @cindex Sets, as vectors
20216 Calc includes several commands which interpret vectors as @dfn{sets} of
20217 objects. A set is a collection of objects; any given object can appear
20218 only once in the set. Calc stores sets as vectors of objects in
20219 sorted order. Objects in a Calc set can be any of the usual things,
20220 such as numbers, variables, or formulas. Two set elements are considered
20221 equal if they are identical, except that numerically equal numbers like
20222 the integer 4 and the float 4.0 are considered equal even though they
20223 are not ``identical.'' Variables are treated like plain symbols without
20224 attached values by the set operations; subtracting the set @samp{[b]}
20225 from @samp{[a, b]} always yields the set @samp{[a]} even though if
20226 the variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} both equaled 17, you might
20227 expect the answer @samp{[]}.
20228
20229 If a set contains interval forms, then it is assumed to be a set of
20230 real numbers. In this case, all set operations require the elements
20231 of the set to be only things that are allowed in intervals: Real
20232 numbers, plus and minus infinity, HMS forms, and date forms. If
20233 there are variables or other non-real objects present in a real set,
20234 all set operations on it will be left in unevaluated form.
20235
20236 If the input to a set operation is a plain number or interval form
20237 @var{a}, it is treated like the one-element vector @samp{[@var{a}]}.
20238 The result is always a vector, except that if the set consists of a
20239 single interval, the interval itself is returned instead.
20240
20241 @xref{Logical Operations}, for the @code{in} function which tests if
20242 a certain value is a member of a given set. To test if the set @expr{A}
20243 is a subset of the set @expr{B}, use @samp{vdiff(A, B) = []}.
20244
20245 @kindex v +
20246 @kindex V +
20247 @pindex calc-remove-duplicates
20248 @tindex rdup
20249 The @kbd{V +} (@code{calc-remove-duplicates}) [@code{rdup}] command
20250 converts an arbitrary vector into set notation. It works by sorting
20251 the vector as if by @kbd{V S}, then removing duplicates. (For example,
20252 @kbd{[a, 5, 4, a, 4.0]} is sorted to @samp{[4, 4.0, 5, a, a]} and then
20253 reduced to @samp{[4, 5, a]}). Overlapping intervals are merged as
20254 necessary. You rarely need to use @kbd{V +} explicitly, since all the
20255 other set-based commands apply @kbd{V +} to their inputs before using
20256 them.
20257
20258 @kindex v V
20259 @kindex V V
20260 @pindex calc-set-union
20261 @tindex vunion
20262 The @kbd{V V} (@code{calc-set-union}) [@code{vunion}] command computes
20263 the union of two sets. An object is in the union of two sets if and
20264 only if it is in either (or both) of the input sets. (You could
20265 accomplish the same thing by concatenating the sets with @kbd{|},
20266 then using @kbd{V +}.)
20267
20268 @kindex v ^
20269 @kindex V ^
20270 @pindex calc-set-intersect
20271 @tindex vint
20272 The @kbd{V ^} (@code{calc-set-intersect}) [@code{vint}] command computes
20273 the intersection of two sets. An object is in the intersection if
20274 and only if it is in both of the input sets. Thus if the input
20275 sets are disjoint, i.e., if they share no common elements, the result
20276 will be the empty vector @samp{[]}. Note that the characters @kbd{V}
20277 and @kbd{^} were chosen to be close to the conventional mathematical
20278 notation for set
20279 @texline union@tie{}(@math{A \cup B})
20280 @infoline union
20281 and
20282 @texline intersection@tie{}(@math{A \cap B}).
20283 @infoline intersection.
20284
20285 @kindex v -
20286 @kindex V -
20287 @pindex calc-set-difference
20288 @tindex vdiff
20289 The @kbd{V -} (@code{calc-set-difference}) [@code{vdiff}] command computes
20290 the difference between two sets. An object is in the difference
20291 @expr{A - B} if and only if it is in @expr{A} but not in @expr{B}.
20292 Thus subtracting @samp{[y,z]} from a set will remove the elements
20293 @samp{y} and @samp{z} if they are present. You can also think of this
20294 as a general @dfn{set complement} operator; if @expr{A} is the set of
20295 all possible values, then @expr{A - B} is the ``complement'' of @expr{B}.
20296 Obviously this is only practical if the set of all possible values in
20297 your problem is small enough to list in a Calc vector (or simple
20298 enough to express in a few intervals).
20299
20300 @kindex v X
20301 @kindex V X
20302 @pindex calc-set-xor
20303 @tindex vxor
20304 The @kbd{V X} (@code{calc-set-xor}) [@code{vxor}] command computes
20305 the ``exclusive-or,'' or ``symmetric difference'' of two sets.
20306 An object is in the symmetric difference of two sets if and only
20307 if it is in one, but @emph{not} both, of the sets. Objects that
20308 occur in both sets ``cancel out.''
20309
20310 @kindex v ~
20311 @kindex V ~
20312 @pindex calc-set-complement
20313 @tindex vcompl
20314 The @kbd{V ~} (@code{calc-set-complement}) [@code{vcompl}] command
20315 computes the complement of a set with respect to the real numbers.
20316 Thus @samp{vcompl(x)} is equivalent to @samp{vdiff([-inf .. inf], x)}.
20317 For example, @samp{vcompl([2, (3 .. 4]])} evaluates to
20318 @samp{[[-inf .. 2), (2 .. 3], (4 .. inf]]}.
20319
20320 @kindex v F
20321 @kindex V F
20322 @pindex calc-set-floor
20323 @tindex vfloor
20324 The @kbd{V F} (@code{calc-set-floor}) [@code{vfloor}] command
20325 reinterprets a set as a set of integers. Any non-integer values,
20326 and intervals that do not enclose any integers, are removed. Open
20327 intervals are converted to equivalent closed intervals. Successive
20328 integers are converted into intervals of integers. For example, the
20329 complement of the set @samp{[2, 6, 7, 8]} is messy, but if you wanted
20330 the complement with respect to the set of integers you could type
20331 @kbd{V ~ V F} to get @samp{[[-inf .. 1], [3 .. 5], [9 .. inf]]}.
20332
20333 @kindex v E
20334 @kindex V E
20335 @pindex calc-set-enumerate
20336 @tindex venum
20337 The @kbd{V E} (@code{calc-set-enumerate}) [@code{venum}] command
20338 converts a set of integers into an explicit vector. Intervals in
20339 the set are expanded out to lists of all integers encompassed by
20340 the intervals. This only works for finite sets (i.e., sets which
20341 do not involve @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf}).
20342
20343 @kindex v :
20344 @kindex V :
20345 @pindex calc-set-span
20346 @tindex vspan
20347 The @kbd{V :} (@code{calc-set-span}) [@code{vspan}] command converts any
20348 set of reals into an interval form that encompasses all its elements.
20349 The lower limit will be the smallest element in the set; the upper
20350 limit will be the largest element. For an empty set, @samp{vspan([])}
20351 returns the empty interval @w{@samp{[0 .. 0)}}.
20352
20353 @kindex v #
20354 @kindex V #
20355 @pindex calc-set-cardinality
20356 @tindex vcard
20357 The @kbd{V #} (@code{calc-set-cardinality}) [@code{vcard}] command counts
20358 the number of integers in a set. The result is the length of the vector
20359 that would be produced by @kbd{V E}, although the computation is much
20360 more efficient than actually producing that vector.
20361
20362 @cindex Sets, as binary numbers
20363 Another representation for sets that may be more appropriate in some
20364 cases is binary numbers. If you are dealing with sets of integers
20365 in the range 0 to 49, you can use a 50-bit binary number where a
20366 particular bit is 1 if the corresponding element is in the set.
20367 @xref{Binary Functions}, for a list of commands that operate on
20368 binary numbers. Note that many of the above set operations have
20369 direct equivalents in binary arithmetic: @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}),
20370 @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}), @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}),
20371 @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}), and @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}),
20372 respectively. You can use whatever representation for sets is most
20373 convenient to you.
20374
20375 @kindex b p
20376 @kindex b u
20377 @pindex calc-pack-bits
20378 @pindex calc-unpack-bits
20379 @tindex vpack
20380 @tindex vunpack
20381 The @kbd{b u} (@code{calc-unpack-bits}) [@code{vunpack}] command
20382 converts an integer that represents a set in binary into a set
20383 in vector/interval notation. For example, @samp{vunpack(67)}
20384 returns @samp{[[0 .. 1], 6]}. If the input is negative, the set
20385 it represents is semi-infinite: @samp{vunpack(-4) = [2 .. inf)}.
20386 Use @kbd{V E} afterwards to expand intervals to individual
20387 values if you wish. Note that this command uses the @kbd{b}
20388 (binary) prefix key.
20389
20390 The @kbd{b p} (@code{calc-pack-bits}) [@code{vpack}] command
20391 converts the other way, from a vector or interval representing
20392 a set of nonnegative integers into a binary integer describing
20393 the same set. The set may include positive infinity, but must
20394 not include any negative numbers. The input is interpreted as a
20395 set of integers in the sense of @kbd{V F} (@code{vfloor}). Beware
20396 that a simple input like @samp{[100]} can result in a huge integer
20397 representation
20398 @texline (@math{2^{100}}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20399 @infoline (@expr{2^100}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20400
20401 @node Statistical Operations, Reducing and Mapping, Set Operations, Matrix Functions
20402 @section Statistical Operations on Vectors
20403
20404 @noindent
20405 @cindex Statistical functions
20406 The commands in this section take vectors as arguments and compute
20407 various statistical measures on the data stored in the vectors. The
20408 references used in the definitions of these functions are Bevington's
20409 @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis for the Physical Sciences},
20410 and @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky and
20411 Vetterling.
20412
20413 The statistical commands use the @kbd{u} prefix key followed by
20414 a shifted letter or other character.
20415
20416 @xref{Manipulating Vectors}, for a description of @kbd{V H}
20417 (@code{calc-histogram}).
20418
20419 @xref{Curve Fitting}, for the @kbd{a F} command for doing
20420 least-squares fits to statistical data.
20421
20422 @xref{Probability Distribution Functions}, for several common
20423 probability distribution functions.
20424
20425 @menu
20426 * Single-Variable Statistics::
20427 * Paired-Sample Statistics::
20428 @end menu
20429
20430 @node Single-Variable Statistics, Paired-Sample Statistics, Statistical Operations, Statistical Operations
20431 @subsection Single-Variable Statistics
20432
20433 @noindent
20434 These functions do various statistical computations on single
20435 vectors. Given a numeric prefix argument, they actually pop
20436 @var{n} objects from the stack and combine them into a data
20437 vector. Each object may be either a number or a vector; if a
20438 vector, any sub-vectors inside it are ``flattened'' as if by
20439 @kbd{v a 0}; @pxref{Manipulating Vectors}. By default one object
20440 is popped, which (in order to be useful) is usually a vector.
20441
20442 If an argument is a variable name, and the value stored in that
20443 variable is a vector, then the stored vector is used. This method
20444 has the advantage that if your data vector is large, you can avoid
20445 the slow process of manipulating it directly on the stack.
20446
20447 These functions are left in symbolic form if any of their arguments
20448 are not numbers or vectors, e.g., if an argument is a formula, or
20449 a non-vector variable. However, formulas embedded within vector
20450 arguments are accepted; the result is a symbolic representation
20451 of the computation, based on the assumption that the formula does
20452 not itself represent a vector. All varieties of numbers such as
20453 error forms and interval forms are acceptable.
20454
20455 Some of the functions in this section also accept a single error form
20456 or interval as an argument. They then describe a property of the
20457 normal or uniform (respectively) statistical distribution described
20458 by the argument. The arguments are interpreted in the same way as
20459 the @var{M} argument of the random number function @kbd{k r}. In
20460 particular, an interval with integer limits is considered an integer
20461 distribution, so that @samp{[2 .. 6)} is the same as @samp{[2 .. 5]}.
20462 An interval with at least one floating-point limit is a continuous
20463 distribution: @samp{[2.0 .. 6.0)} is @emph{not} the same as
20464 @samp{[2.0 .. 5.0]}!
20465
20466 @kindex u #
20467 @pindex calc-vector-count
20468 @tindex vcount
20469 The @kbd{u #} (@code{calc-vector-count}) [@code{vcount}] command
20470 computes the number of data values represented by the inputs.
20471 For example, @samp{vcount(1, [2, 3], [[4, 5], [], x, y])} returns 7.
20472 If the argument is a single vector with no sub-vectors, this
20473 simply computes the length of the vector.
20474
20475 @kindex u +
20476 @kindex u *
20477 @pindex calc-vector-sum
20478 @pindex calc-vector-prod
20479 @tindex vsum
20480 @tindex vprod
20481 @cindex Summations (statistical)
20482 The @kbd{u +} (@code{calc-vector-sum}) [@code{vsum}] command
20483 computes the sum of the data values. The @kbd{u *}
20484 (@code{calc-vector-prod}) [@code{vprod}] command computes the
20485 product of the data values. If the input is a single flat vector,
20486 these are the same as @kbd{V R +} and @kbd{V R *}
20487 (@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}).
20488
20489 @kindex u X
20490 @kindex u N
20491 @pindex calc-vector-max
20492 @pindex calc-vector-min
20493 @tindex vmax
20494 @tindex vmin
20495 The @kbd{u X} (@code{calc-vector-max}) [@code{vmax}] command
20496 computes the maximum of the data values, and the @kbd{u N}
20497 (@code{calc-vector-min}) [@code{vmin}] command computes the minimum.
20498 If the argument is an interval, this finds the minimum or maximum
20499 value in the interval. (Note that @samp{vmax([2..6)) = 5} as
20500 described above.) If the argument is an error form, this returns
20501 plus or minus infinity.
20502
20503 @kindex u M
20504 @pindex calc-vector-mean
20505 @tindex vmean
20506 @cindex Mean of data values
20507 The @kbd{u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean}) [@code{vmean}] command
20508 computes the average (arithmetic mean) of the data values.
20509 If the inputs are error forms
20510 @texline @math{x \pm \sigma},
20511 @infoline @samp{x +/- s},
20512 this is the weighted mean of the @expr{x} values with weights
20513 @texline @math{1 /\sigma^2}.
20514 @infoline @expr{1 / s^2}.
20515 @tex
20516 \turnoffactive
20517 $$ \mu = { \displaystyle \sum { x_i \over \sigma_i^2 } \over
20518 \displaystyle \sum { 1 \over \sigma_i^2 } } $$
20519 @end tex
20520 If the inputs are not error forms, this is simply the sum of the
20521 values divided by the count of the values.
20522
20523 Note that a plain number can be considered an error form with
20524 error
20525 @texline @math{\sigma = 0}.
20526 @infoline @expr{s = 0}.
20527 If the input to @kbd{u M} is a mixture of
20528 plain numbers and error forms, the result is the mean of the
20529 plain numbers, ignoring all values with non-zero errors. (By the
20530 above definitions it's clear that a plain number effectively
20531 has an infinite weight, next to which an error form with a finite
20532 weight is completely negligible.)
20533
20534 This function also works for distributions (error forms or
20535 intervals). The mean of an error form `@var{a} @tfn{+/-} @var{b}' is simply
20536 @expr{a}. The mean of an interval is the mean of the minimum
20537 and maximum values of the interval.
20538
20539 @kindex I u M
20540 @pindex calc-vector-mean-error
20541 @tindex vmeane
20542 The @kbd{I u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean-error}) [@code{vmeane}]
20543 command computes the mean of the data points expressed as an
20544 error form. This includes the estimated error associated with
20545 the mean. If the inputs are error forms, the error is the square
20546 root of the reciprocal of the sum of the reciprocals of the squares
20547 of the input errors. (I.e., the variance is the reciprocal of the
20548 sum of the reciprocals of the variances.)
20549 @tex
20550 \turnoffactive
20551 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {1 \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}} $$
20552 @end tex
20553 If the inputs are plain
20554 numbers, the error is equal to the standard deviation of the values
20555 divided by the square root of the number of values. (This works
20556 out to be equivalent to calculating the standard deviation and
20557 then assuming each value's error is equal to this standard
20558 deviation.)
20559 @tex
20560 \turnoffactive
20561 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {\sigma^2 \over N} $$
20562 @end tex
20563
20564 @kindex H u M
20565 @pindex calc-vector-median
20566 @tindex vmedian
20567 @cindex Median of data values
20568 The @kbd{H u M} (@code{calc-vector-median}) [@code{vmedian}]
20569 command computes the median of the data values. The values are
20570 first sorted into numerical order; the median is the middle
20571 value after sorting. (If the number of data values is even,
20572 the median is taken to be the average of the two middle values.)
20573 The median function is different from the other functions in
20574 this section in that the arguments must all be real numbers;
20575 variables are not accepted even when nested inside vectors.
20576 (Otherwise it is not possible to sort the data values.) If
20577 any of the input values are error forms, their error parts are
20578 ignored.
20579
20580 The median function also accepts distributions. For both normal
20581 (error form) and uniform (interval) distributions, the median is
20582 the same as the mean.
20583
20584 @kindex H I u M
20585 @pindex calc-vector-harmonic-mean
20586 @tindex vhmean
20587 @cindex Harmonic mean
20588 The @kbd{H I u M} (@code{calc-vector-harmonic-mean}) [@code{vhmean}]
20589 command computes the harmonic mean of the data values. This is
20590 defined as the reciprocal of the arithmetic mean of the reciprocals
20591 of the values.
20592 @tex
20593 \turnoffactive
20594 $$ { N \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over x_i} } $$
20595 @end tex
20596
20597 @kindex u G
20598 @pindex calc-vector-geometric-mean
20599 @tindex vgmean
20600 @cindex Geometric mean
20601 The @kbd{u G} (@code{calc-vector-geometric-mean}) [@code{vgmean}]
20602 command computes the geometric mean of the data values. This
20603 is the @var{n}th root of the product of the values. This is also
20604 equal to the @code{exp} of the arithmetic mean of the logarithms
20605 of the data values.
20606 @tex
20607 \turnoffactive
20608 $$ \exp \left ( \sum { \ln x_i } \right ) =
20609 \left ( \prod { x_i } \right)^{1 / N} $$
20610 @end tex
20611
20612 @kindex H u G
20613 @tindex agmean
20614 The @kbd{H u G} [@code{agmean}] command computes the ``arithmetic-geometric
20615 mean'' of two numbers taken from the stack. This is computed by
20616 replacing the two numbers with their arithmetic mean and geometric
20617 mean, then repeating until the two values converge.
20618 @tex
20619 \turnoffactive
20620 $$ a_{i+1} = { a_i + b_i \over 2 } , \qquad b_{i+1} = \sqrt{a_i b_i} $$
20621 @end tex
20622
20623 @cindex Root-mean-square
20624 Another commonly used mean, the RMS (root-mean-square), can be computed
20625 for a vector of numbers simply by using the @kbd{A} command.
20626
20627 @kindex u S
20628 @pindex calc-vector-sdev
20629 @tindex vsdev
20630 @cindex Standard deviation
20631 @cindex Sample statistics
20632 The @kbd{u S} (@code{calc-vector-sdev}) [@code{vsdev}] command
20633 computes the standard
20634 @texline deviation@tie{}@math{\sigma}
20635 @infoline deviation
20636 of the data values. If the values are error forms, the errors are used
20637 as weights just as for @kbd{u M}. This is the @emph{sample} standard
20638 deviation, whose value is the square root of the sum of the squares of
20639 the differences between the values and the mean of the @expr{N} values,
20640 divided by @expr{N-1}.
20641 @tex
20642 \turnoffactive
20643 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N - 1} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20644 @end tex
20645
20646 This function also applies to distributions. The standard deviation
20647 of a single error form is simply the error part. The standard deviation
20648 of a continuous interval happens to equal the difference between the
20649 limits, divided by
20650 @texline @math{\sqrt{12}}.
20651 @infoline @expr{sqrt(12)}.
20652 The standard deviation of an integer interval is the same as the
20653 standard deviation of a vector of those integers.
20654
20655 @kindex I u S
20656 @pindex calc-vector-pop-sdev
20657 @tindex vpsdev
20658 @cindex Population statistics
20659 The @kbd{I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-sdev}) [@code{vpsdev}]
20660 command computes the @emph{population} standard deviation.
20661 It is defined by the same formula as above but dividing
20662 by @expr{N} instead of by @expr{N-1}. The population standard
20663 deviation is used when the input represents the entire set of
20664 data values in the distribution; the sample standard deviation
20665 is used when the input represents a sample of the set of all
20666 data values, so that the mean computed from the input is itself
20667 only an estimate of the true mean.
20668 @tex
20669 \turnoffactive
20670 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20671 @end tex
20672
20673 For error forms and continuous intervals, @code{vpsdev} works
20674 exactly like @code{vsdev}. For integer intervals, it computes the
20675 population standard deviation of the equivalent vector of integers.
20676
20677 @kindex H u S
20678 @kindex H I u S
20679 @pindex calc-vector-variance
20680 @pindex calc-vector-pop-variance
20681 @tindex vvar
20682 @tindex vpvar
20683 @cindex Variance of data values
20684 The @kbd{H u S} (@code{calc-vector-variance}) [@code{vvar}] and
20685 @kbd{H I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-variance}) [@code{vpvar}]
20686 commands compute the variance of the data values. The variance
20687 is the
20688 @texline square@tie{}@math{\sigma^2}
20689 @infoline square
20690 of the standard deviation, i.e., the sum of the
20691 squares of the deviations of the data values from the mean.
20692 (This definition also applies when the argument is a distribution.)
20693
20694 @ignore
20695 @starindex
20696 @end ignore
20697 @tindex vflat
20698 The @code{vflat} algebraic function returns a vector of its
20699 arguments, interpreted in the same way as the other functions
20700 in this section. For example, @samp{vflat(1, [2, [3, 4]], 5)}
20701 returns @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
20702
20703 @node Paired-Sample Statistics, , Single-Variable Statistics, Statistical Operations
20704 @subsection Paired-Sample Statistics
20705
20706 @noindent
20707 The functions in this section take two arguments, which must be
20708 vectors of equal size. The vectors are each flattened in the same
20709 way as by the single-variable statistical functions. Given a numeric
20710 prefix argument of 1, these functions instead take one object from
20711 the stack, which must be an
20712 @texline @math{N\times2}
20713 @infoline Nx2
20714 matrix of data values. Once again, variable names can be used in place
20715 of actual vectors and matrices.
20716
20717 @kindex u C
20718 @pindex calc-vector-covariance
20719 @tindex vcov
20720 @cindex Covariance
20721 The @kbd{u C} (@code{calc-vector-covariance}) [@code{vcov}] command
20722 computes the sample covariance of two vectors. The covariance
20723 of vectors @var{x} and @var{y} is the sum of the products of the
20724 differences between the elements of @var{x} and the mean of @var{x}
20725 times the differences between the corresponding elements of @var{y}
20726 and the mean of @var{y}, all divided by @expr{N-1}. Note that
20727 the variance of a vector is just the covariance of the vector
20728 with itself. Once again, if the inputs are error forms the
20729 errors are used as weight factors. If both @var{x} and @var{y}
20730 are composed of error forms, the error for a given data point
20731 is taken as the square root of the sum of the squares of the two
20732 input errors.
20733 @tex
20734 \turnoffactive
20735 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 = {1 \over N-1} \sum (x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) $$
20736 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 =
20737 {\displaystyle {1 \over N-1}
20738 \sum {(x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) \over \sigma_i^2}
20739 \over \displaystyle {1 \over N} \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}}
20740 $$
20741 @end tex
20742
20743 @kindex I u C
20744 @pindex calc-vector-pop-covariance
20745 @tindex vpcov
20746 The @kbd{I u C} (@code{calc-vector-pop-covariance}) [@code{vpcov}]
20747 command computes the population covariance, which is the same as the
20748 sample covariance computed by @kbd{u C} except dividing by @expr{N}
20749 instead of @expr{N-1}.
20750
20751 @kindex H u C
20752 @pindex calc-vector-correlation
20753 @tindex vcorr
20754 @cindex Correlation coefficient
20755 @cindex Linear correlation
20756 The @kbd{H u C} (@code{calc-vector-correlation}) [@code{vcorr}]
20757 command computes the linear correlation coefficient of two vectors.
20758 This is defined by the covariance of the vectors divided by the
20759 product of their standard deviations. (There is no difference
20760 between sample or population statistics here.)
20761 @tex
20762 \turnoffactive
20763 $$ r_{x\!y} = { \sigma_{x\!y}^2 \over \sigma_x^2 \sigma_y^2 } $$
20764 @end tex
20765
20766 @node Reducing and Mapping, Vector and Matrix Formats, Statistical Operations, Matrix Functions
20767 @section Reducing and Mapping Vectors
20768
20769 @noindent
20770 The commands in this section allow for more general operations on the
20771 elements of vectors.
20772
20773 @kindex v A
20774 @kindex V A
20775 @pindex calc-apply
20776 @tindex apply
20777 The simplest of these operations is @kbd{V A} (@code{calc-apply})
20778 [@code{apply}], which applies a given operator to the elements of a vector.
20779 For example, applying the hypothetical function @code{f} to the vector
20780 @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3]}} would produce the function call @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20781 Applying the @code{+} function to the vector @samp{[a, b]} gives
20782 @samp{a + b}. Applying @code{+} to the vector @samp{[a, b, c]} is an
20783 error, since the @code{+} function expects exactly two arguments.
20784
20785 While @kbd{V A} is useful in some cases, you will usually find that either
20786 @kbd{V R} or @kbd{V M}, described below, is closer to what you want.
20787
20788 @menu
20789 * Specifying Operators::
20790 * Mapping::
20791 * Reducing::
20792 * Nesting and Fixed Points::
20793 * Generalized Products::
20794 @end menu
20795
20796 @node Specifying Operators, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20797 @subsection Specifying Operators
20798
20799 @noindent
20800 Commands in this section (like @kbd{V A}) prompt you to press the key
20801 corresponding to the desired operator. Press @kbd{?} for a partial
20802 list of the available operators. Generally, an operator is any key or
20803 sequence of keys that would normally take one or more arguments from
20804 the stack and replace them with a result. For example, @kbd{V A H C}
20805 uses the hyperbolic cosine operator, @code{cosh}. (Since @code{cosh}
20806 expects one argument, @kbd{V A H C} requires a vector with a single
20807 element as its argument.)
20808
20809 You can press @kbd{x} at the operator prompt to select any algebraic
20810 function by name to use as the operator. This includes functions you
20811 have defined yourself using the @kbd{Z F} command. (@xref{Algebraic
20812 Definitions}.) If you give a name for which no function has been
20813 defined, the result is left in symbolic form, as in @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20814 Calc will prompt for the number of arguments the function takes if it
20815 can't figure it out on its own (say, because you named a function that
20816 is currently undefined). It is also possible to type a digit key before
20817 the function name to specify the number of arguments, e.g.,
20818 @kbd{V M 3 x f @key{RET}} calls @code{f} with three arguments even if it
20819 looks like it ought to have only two. This technique may be necessary
20820 if the function allows a variable number of arguments. For example,
20821 the @kbd{v e} [@code{vexp}] function accepts two or three arguments;
20822 if you want to map with the three-argument version, you will have to
20823 type @kbd{V M 3 v e}.
20824
20825 It is also possible to apply any formula to a vector by treating that
20826 formula as a function. When prompted for the operator to use, press
20827 @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) and type your formula as an algebraic entry.
20828 You will then be prompted for the argument list, which defaults to a
20829 list of all variables that appear in the formula, sorted into alphabetic
20830 order. For example, suppose you enter the formula @w{@samp{x + 2y^x}}.
20831 The default argument list would be @samp{(x y)}, which means that if
20832 this function is applied to the arguments @samp{[3, 10]} the result will
20833 be @samp{3 + 2*10^3}. (If you plan to use a certain formula in this
20834 way often, you might consider defining it as a function with @kbd{Z F}.)
20835
20836 Another way to specify the arguments to the formula you enter is with
20837 @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on. For example, @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$}
20838 has the same effect as the previous example. The argument list is
20839 automatically taken to be @samp{($$ $)}. (The order of the arguments
20840 may seem backwards, but it is analogous to the way normal algebraic
20841 entry interacts with the stack.)
20842
20843 If you press @kbd{$} at the operator prompt, the effect is similar to
20844 the apostrophe except that the relevant formula is taken from top-of-stack
20845 instead. The actual vector arguments of the @kbd{V A $} or related command
20846 then start at the second-to-top stack position. You will still be
20847 prompted for an argument list.
20848
20849 @cindex Nameless functions
20850 @cindex Generic functions
20851 A function can be written without a name using the notation @samp{<#1 - #2>},
20852 which means ``a function of two arguments that computes the first
20853 argument minus the second argument.'' The symbols @samp{#1} and @samp{#2}
20854 are placeholders for the arguments. You can use any names for these
20855 placeholders if you wish, by including an argument list followed by a
20856 colon: @samp{<x, y : x - y>}. When you type @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$ @key{RET}},
20857 Calc builds the nameless function @samp{<#1 + 2 #2^#1>} as the function
20858 to map across the vectors. When you type @kbd{V A ' x + 2y^x @key{RET} @key{RET}},
20859 Calc builds the nameless function @w{@samp{<x, y : x + 2 y^x>}}. In both
20860 cases, Calc also writes the nameless function to the Trail so that you
20861 can get it back later if you wish.
20862
20863 If there is only one argument, you can write @samp{#} in place of @samp{#1}.
20864 (Note that @samp{< >} notation is also used for date forms. Calc tells
20865 that @samp{<@var{stuff}>} is a nameless function by the presence of
20866 @samp{#} signs inside @var{stuff}, or by the fact that @var{stuff}
20867 begins with a list of variables followed by a colon.)
20868
20869 You can type a nameless function directly to @kbd{V A '}, or put one on
20870 the stack and use it with @w{@kbd{V A $}}. Calc will not prompt for an
20871 argument list in this case, since the nameless function specifies the
20872 argument list as well as the function itself. In @kbd{V A '}, you can
20873 omit the @samp{< >} marks if you use @samp{#} notation for the arguments,
20874 so that @kbd{V A ' #1+#2 @key{RET}} is the same as @kbd{V A ' <#1+#2> @key{RET}},
20875 which in turn is the same as @kbd{V A ' $$+$ @key{RET}}.
20876
20877 @cindex Lambda expressions
20878 @ignore
20879 @starindex
20880 @end ignore
20881 @tindex lambda
20882 The internal format for @samp{<x, y : x + y>} is @samp{lambda(x, y, x + y)}.
20883 (The word @code{lambda} derives from Lisp notation and the theory of
20884 functions.) The internal format for @samp{<#1 + #2>} is @samp{lambda(ArgA,
20885 ArgB, ArgA + ArgB)}. Note that there is no actual Calc function called
20886 @code{lambda}; the whole point is that the @code{lambda} expression is
20887 used in its symbolic form, not evaluated for an answer until it is applied
20888 to specific arguments by a command like @kbd{V A} or @kbd{V M}.
20889
20890 (Actually, @code{lambda} does have one special property: Its arguments
20891 are never evaluated; for example, putting @samp{<(2/3) #>} on the stack
20892 will not simplify the @samp{2/3} until the nameless function is actually
20893 called.)
20894
20895 @tindex add
20896 @tindex sub
20897 @ignore
20898 @mindex @idots
20899 @end ignore
20900 @tindex mul
20901 @ignore
20902 @mindex @null
20903 @end ignore
20904 @tindex div
20905 @ignore
20906 @mindex @null
20907 @end ignore
20908 @tindex pow
20909 @ignore
20910 @mindex @null
20911 @end ignore
20912 @tindex neg
20913 @ignore
20914 @mindex @null
20915 @end ignore
20916 @tindex mod
20917 @ignore
20918 @mindex @null
20919 @end ignore
20920 @tindex vconcat
20921 As usual, commands like @kbd{V A} have algebraic function name equivalents.
20922 For example, @kbd{V A k g} with an argument of @samp{v} is equivalent to
20923 @samp{apply(gcd, v)}. The first argument specifies the operator name,
20924 and is either a variable whose name is the same as the function name,
20925 or a nameless function like @samp{<#^3+1>}. Operators that are normally
20926 written as algebraic symbols have the names @code{add}, @code{sub},
20927 @code{mul}, @code{div}, @code{pow}, @code{neg}, @code{mod}, and
20928 @code{vconcat}.
20929
20930 @ignore
20931 @starindex
20932 @end ignore
20933 @tindex call
20934 The @code{call} function builds a function call out of several arguments:
20935 @samp{call(gcd, x, y)} is the same as @samp{apply(gcd, [x, y])}, which
20936 in turn is the same as @samp{gcd(x, y)}. The first argument of @code{call},
20937 like the other functions described here, may be either a variable naming a
20938 function, or a nameless function (@samp{call(<#1+2#2>, x, y)} is the same
20939 as @samp{x + 2y}).
20940
20941 (Experts will notice that it's not quite proper to use a variable to name
20942 a function, since the name @code{gcd} corresponds to the Lisp variable
20943 @code{var-gcd} but to the Lisp function @code{calcFunc-gcd}. Calc
20944 automatically makes this translation, so you don't have to worry
20945 about it.)
20946
20947 @node Mapping, Reducing, Specifying Operators, Reducing and Mapping
20948 @subsection Mapping
20949
20950 @noindent
20951 @kindex v M
20952 @kindex V M
20953 @pindex calc-map
20954 @tindex map
20955 The @kbd{V M} (@code{calc-map}) [@code{map}] command applies a given
20956 operator elementwise to one or more vectors. For example, mapping
20957 @code{A} [@code{abs}] produces a vector of the absolute values of the
20958 elements in the input vector. Mapping @code{+} pops two vectors from
20959 the stack, which must be of equal length, and produces a vector of the
20960 pairwise sums of the elements. If either argument is a non-vector, it
20961 is duplicated for each element of the other vector. For example,
20962 @kbd{[1,2,3] 2 V M ^} squares the elements of the specified vector.
20963 With the 2 listed first, it would have computed a vector of powers of
20964 two. Mapping a user-defined function pops as many arguments from the
20965 stack as the function requires. If you give an undefined name, you will
20966 be prompted for the number of arguments to use.
20967
20968 If any argument to @kbd{V M} is a matrix, the operator is normally mapped
20969 across all elements of the matrix. For example, given the matrix
20970 @expr{[[1, -2, 3], [-4, 5, -6]]}, @kbd{V M A} takes six absolute values to
20971 produce another
20972 @texline @math{3\times2}
20973 @infoline 3x2
20974 matrix, @expr{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}.
20975
20976 @tindex mapr
20977 The command @kbd{V M _} [@code{mapr}] (i.e., type an underscore at the
20978 operator prompt) maps by rows instead. For example, @kbd{V M _ A} views
20979 the above matrix as a vector of two 3-element row vectors. It produces
20980 a new vector which contains the absolute values of those row vectors,
20981 namely @expr{[3.74, 8.77]}. (Recall, the absolute value of a vector is
20982 defined as the square root of the sum of the squares of the elements.)
20983 Some operators accept vectors and return new vectors; for example,
20984 @kbd{v v} reverses a vector, so @kbd{V M _ v v} would reverse each row
20985 of the matrix to get a new matrix, @expr{[[3, -2, 1], [-6, 5, -4]]}.
20986
20987 Sometimes a vector of vectors (representing, say, strings, sets, or lists)
20988 happens to look like a matrix. If so, remember to use @kbd{V M _} if you
20989 want to map a function across the whole strings or sets rather than across
20990 their individual elements.
20991
20992 @tindex mapc
20993 The command @kbd{V M :} [@code{mapc}] maps by columns. Basically, it
20994 transposes the input matrix, maps by rows, and then, if the result is a
20995 matrix, transposes again. For example, @kbd{V M : A} takes the absolute
20996 values of the three columns of the matrix, treating each as a 2-vector,
20997 and @kbd{V M : v v} reverses the columns to get the matrix
20998 @expr{[[-4, 5, -6], [1, -2, 3]]}.
20999
21000 (The symbols @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} were chosen because they had row-like
21001 and column-like appearances, and were not already taken by useful
21002 operators. Also, they appear shifted on most keyboards so they are easy
21003 to type after @kbd{V M}.)
21004
21005 The @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} modifiers have no effect on arguments that are
21006 not matrices (so if none of the arguments are matrices, they have no
21007 effect at all). If some of the arguments are matrices and others are
21008 plain numbers, the plain numbers are held constant for all rows of the
21009 matrix (so that @kbd{2 V M _ ^} squares every row of a matrix; squaring
21010 a vector takes a dot product of the vector with itself).
21011
21012 If some of the arguments are vectors with the same lengths as the
21013 rows (for @kbd{V M _}) or columns (for @kbd{V M :}) of the matrix
21014 arguments, those vectors are also held constant for every row or
21015 column.
21016
21017 Sometimes it is useful to specify another mapping command as the operator
21018 to use with @kbd{V M}. For example, @kbd{V M _ V A +} applies @kbd{V A +}
21019 to each row of the input matrix, which in turn adds the two values on that
21020 row. If you give another vector-operator command as the operator for
21021 @kbd{V M}, it automatically uses map-by-rows mode if you don't specify
21022 otherwise; thus @kbd{V M V A +} is equivalent to @kbd{V M _ V A +}. (If
21023 you really want to map-by-elements another mapping command, you can use
21024 a triple-nested mapping command: @kbd{V M V M V A +} means to map
21025 @kbd{V M V A +} over the rows of the matrix; in turn, @kbd{V A +} is
21026 mapped over the elements of each row.)
21027
21028 @tindex mapa
21029 @tindex mapd
21030 Previous versions of Calc had ``map across'' and ``map down'' modes
21031 that are now considered obsolete; the old ``map across'' is now simply
21032 @kbd{V M V A}, and ``map down'' is now @kbd{V M : V A}. The algebraic
21033 functions @code{mapa} and @code{mapd} are still supported, though.
21034 Note also that, while the old mapping modes were persistent (once you
21035 set the mode, it would apply to later mapping commands until you reset
21036 it), the new @kbd{:} and @kbd{_} modifiers apply only to the current
21037 mapping command. The default @kbd{V M} always means map-by-elements.
21038
21039 @xref{Algebraic Manipulation}, for the @kbd{a M} command, which is like
21040 @kbd{V M} but for equations and inequalities instead of vectors.
21041 @xref{Storing Variables}, for the @kbd{s m} command which modifies a
21042 variable's stored value using a @kbd{V M}-like operator.
21043
21044 @node Reducing, Nesting and Fixed Points, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
21045 @subsection Reducing
21046
21047 @noindent
21048 @kindex v R
21049 @kindex V R
21050 @pindex calc-reduce
21051 @tindex reduce
21052 The @kbd{V R} (@code{calc-reduce}) [@code{reduce}] command applies a given
21053 binary operator across all the elements of a vector. A binary operator is
21054 a function such as @code{+} or @code{max} which takes two arguments. For
21055 example, reducing @code{+} over a vector computes the sum of the elements
21056 of the vector. Reducing @code{-} computes the first element minus each of
21057 the remaining elements. Reducing @code{max} computes the maximum element
21058 and so on. In general, reducing @code{f} over the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]}
21059 produces @samp{f(f(f(a, b), c), d)}.
21060
21061 @kindex I v R
21062 @kindex I V R
21063 @tindex rreduce
21064 The @kbd{I V R} [@code{rreduce}] command is similar to @kbd{V R} except
21065 that works from right to left through the vector. For example, plain
21066 @kbd{V R -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces @samp{a - b - c - d}
21067 but @kbd{I V R -} on the same vector produces @samp{a - (b - (c - d))},
21068 or @samp{a - b + c - d}. This ``alternating sum'' occurs frequently
21069 in power series expansions.
21070
21071 @kindex v U
21072 @kindex V U
21073 @tindex accum
21074 The @kbd{V U} (@code{calc-accumulate}) [@code{accum}] command does an
21075 accumulation operation. Here Calc does the corresponding reduction
21076 operation, but instead of producing only the final result, it produces
21077 a vector of all the intermediate results. Accumulating @code{+} over
21078 the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the vector
21079 @samp{[a, a + b, a + b + c, a + b + c + d]}.
21080
21081 @kindex I v U
21082 @kindex I V U
21083 @tindex raccum
21084 The @kbd{I V U} [@code{raccum}] command does a right-to-left accumulation.
21085 For example, @kbd{I V U -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the
21086 vector @samp{[a - b + c - d, b - c + d, c - d, d]}.
21087
21088 @tindex reducea
21089 @tindex rreducea
21090 @tindex reduced
21091 @tindex rreduced
21092 As for @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R} normally reduces a matrix elementwise. For
21093 example, given the matrix @expr{[[a, b, c], [d, e, f]]}, @kbd{V R +} will
21094 compute @expr{a + b + c + d + e + f}. You can type @kbd{V R _} or
21095 @kbd{V R :} to modify this behavior. The @kbd{V R _} [@code{reducea}]
21096 command reduces ``across'' the matrix; it reduces each row of the matrix
21097 as a vector, then collects the results. Thus @kbd{V R _ +} of this
21098 matrix would produce @expr{[a + b + c, d + e + f]}. Similarly, @kbd{V R :}
21099 [@code{reduced}] reduces down; @kbd{V R : +} would produce @expr{[a + d,
21100 b + e, c + f]}.
21101
21102 @tindex reducer
21103 @tindex rreducer
21104 There is a third ``by rows'' mode for reduction that is occasionally
21105 useful; @kbd{V R =} [@code{reducer}] simply reduces the operator over
21106 the rows of the matrix themselves. Thus @kbd{V R = +} on the above
21107 matrix would get the same result as @kbd{V R : +}, since adding two
21108 row vectors is equivalent to adding their elements. But @kbd{V R = *}
21109 would multiply the two rows (to get a single number, their dot product),
21110 while @kbd{V R : *} would produce a vector of the products of the columns.
21111
21112 These three matrix reduction modes work with @kbd{V R} and @kbd{I V R},
21113 but they are not currently supported with @kbd{V U} or @kbd{I V U}.
21114
21115 @tindex reducec
21116 @tindex rreducec
21117 The obsolete reduce-by-columns function, @code{reducec}, is still
21118 supported but there is no way to get it through the @kbd{V R} command.
21119
21120 The commands @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are equivalent to typing
21121 @kbd{C-x * r} to grab a rectangle of data into Calc, and then typing
21122 @kbd{V R : +} or @kbd{V R _ +}, respectively, to sum the columns or
21123 rows of the matrix. @xref{Grabbing From Buffers}.
21124
21125 @node Nesting and Fixed Points, Generalized Products, Reducing, Reducing and Mapping
21126 @subsection Nesting and Fixed Points
21127
21128 @noindent
21129 @kindex H v R
21130 @kindex H V R
21131 @tindex nest
21132 The @kbd{H V R} [@code{nest}] command applies a function to a given
21133 argument repeatedly. It takes two values, @samp{a} and @samp{n}, from
21134 the stack, where @samp{n} must be an integer. It then applies the
21135 function nested @samp{n} times; if the function is @samp{f} and @samp{n}
21136 is 3, the result is @samp{f(f(f(a)))}. The number @samp{n} may be
21137 negative if Calc knows an inverse for the function @samp{f}; for
21138 example, @samp{nest(sin, a, -2)} returns @samp{arcsin(arcsin(a))}.
21139
21140 @kindex H v U
21141 @kindex H V U
21142 @tindex anest
21143 The @kbd{H V U} [@code{anest}] command is an accumulating version of
21144 @code{nest}: It returns a vector of @samp{n+1} values, e.g.,
21145 @samp{[a, f(a), f(f(a)), f(f(f(a)))]}. If @samp{n} is negative and
21146 @samp{F} is the inverse of @samp{f}, then the result is of the
21147 form @samp{[a, F(a), F(F(a)), F(F(F(a)))]}.
21148
21149 @kindex H I v R
21150 @kindex H I V R
21151 @tindex fixp
21152 @cindex Fixed points
21153 The @kbd{H I V R} [@code{fixp}] command is like @kbd{H V R}, except
21154 that it takes only an @samp{a} value from the stack; the function is
21155 applied until it reaches a ``fixed point,'' i.e., until the result
21156 no longer changes.
21157
21158 @kindex H I v U
21159 @kindex H I V U
21160 @tindex afixp
21161 The @kbd{H I V U} [@code{afixp}] command is an accumulating @code{fixp}.
21162 The first element of the return vector will be the initial value @samp{a};
21163 the last element will be the final result that would have been returned
21164 by @code{fixp}.
21165
21166 For example, 0.739085 is a fixed point of the cosine function (in radians):
21167 @samp{cos(0.739085) = 0.739085}. You can find this value by putting, say,
21168 1.0 on the stack and typing @kbd{H I V U C}. (We use the accumulating
21169 version so we can see the intermediate results: @samp{[1, 0.540302, 0.857553,
21170 0.65329, ...]}. With a precision of six, this command will take 36 steps
21171 to converge to 0.739085.)
21172
21173 Newton's method for finding roots is a classic example of iteration
21174 to a fixed point. To find the square root of five starting with an
21175 initial guess, Newton's method would look for a fixed point of the
21176 function @samp{(x + 5/x) / 2}. Putting a guess of 1 on the stack
21177 and typing @kbd{H I V R ' ($ + 5/$)/2 @key{RET}} quickly yields the result
21178 2.23607. This is equivalent to using the @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root})
21179 command to find a root of the equation @samp{x^2 = 5}.
21180
21181 These examples used numbers for @samp{a} values. Calc keeps applying
21182 the function until two successive results are equal to within the
21183 current precision. For complex numbers, both the real parts and the
21184 imaginary parts must be equal to within the current precision. If
21185 @samp{a} is a formula (say, a variable name), then the function is
21186 applied until two successive results are exactly the same formula.
21187 It is up to you to ensure that the function will eventually converge;
21188 if it doesn't, you may have to press @kbd{C-g} to stop the Calculator.
21189
21190 The algebraic @code{fixp} function takes two optional arguments, @samp{n}
21191 and @samp{tol}. The first is the maximum number of steps to be allowed,
21192 and must be either an integer or the symbol @samp{inf} (infinity, the
21193 default). The second is a convergence tolerance. If a tolerance is
21194 specified, all results during the calculation must be numbers, not
21195 formulas, and the iteration stops when the magnitude of the difference
21196 between two successive results is less than or equal to the tolerance.
21197 (This implies that a tolerance of zero iterates until the results are
21198 exactly equal.)
21199
21200 Putting it all together, @samp{fixp(<(# + A/#)/2>, B, 20, 1e-10)}
21201 computes the square root of @samp{A} given the initial guess @samp{B},
21202 stopping when the result is correct within the specified tolerance, or
21203 when 20 steps have been taken, whichever is sooner.
21204
21205 @node Generalized Products, , Nesting and Fixed Points, Reducing and Mapping
21206 @subsection Generalized Products
21207
21208 @kindex v O
21209 @kindex V O
21210 @pindex calc-outer-product
21211 @tindex outer
21212 The @kbd{V O} (@code{calc-outer-product}) [@code{outer}] command applies
21213 a given binary operator to all possible pairs of elements from two
21214 vectors, to produce a matrix. For example, @kbd{V O *} with @samp{[a, b]}
21215 and @samp{[x, y, z]} on the stack produces a multiplication table:
21216 @samp{[[a x, a y, a z], [b x, b y, b z]]}. Element @var{r},@var{c} of
21217 the result matrix is obtained by applying the operator to element @var{r}
21218 of the lefthand vector and element @var{c} of the righthand vector.
21219
21220 @kindex v I
21221 @kindex V I
21222 @pindex calc-inner-product
21223 @tindex inner
21224 The @kbd{V I} (@code{calc-inner-product}) [@code{inner}] command computes
21225 the generalized inner product of two vectors or matrices, given a
21226 ``multiplicative'' operator and an ``additive'' operator. These can each
21227 actually be any binary operators; if they are @samp{*} and @samp{+},
21228 respectively, the result is a standard matrix multiplication. Element
21229 @var{r},@var{c} of the result matrix is obtained by mapping the
21230 multiplicative operator across row @var{r} of the lefthand matrix and
21231 column @var{c} of the righthand matrix, and then reducing with the additive
21232 operator. Just as for the standard @kbd{*} command, this can also do a
21233 vector-matrix or matrix-vector inner product, or a vector-vector
21234 generalized dot product.
21235
21236 Since @kbd{V I} requires two operators, it prompts twice. In each case,
21237 you can use any of the usual methods for entering the operator. If you
21238 use @kbd{$} twice to take both operator formulas from the stack, the
21239 first (multiplicative) operator is taken from the top of the stack
21240 and the second (additive) operator is taken from second-to-top.
21241
21242 @node Vector and Matrix Formats, , Reducing and Mapping, Matrix Functions
21243 @section Vector and Matrix Display Formats
21244
21245 @noindent
21246 Commands for controlling vector and matrix display use the @kbd{v} prefix
21247 instead of the usual @kbd{d} prefix. But they are display modes; in
21248 particular, they are influenced by the @kbd{I} and @kbd{H} prefix keys
21249 in the same way (@pxref{Display Modes}). Matrix display is also
21250 influenced by the @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) mode;
21251 @pxref{Normal Language Modes}.
21252
21253 @kindex v <
21254 @kindex V <
21255 @pindex calc-matrix-left-justify
21256 @kindex v =
21257 @kindex V =
21258 @pindex calc-matrix-center-justify
21259 @kindex v >
21260 @kindex V >
21261 @pindex calc-matrix-right-justify
21262 The commands @kbd{v <} (@code{calc-matrix-left-justify}), @kbd{v >}
21263 (@code{calc-matrix-right-justify}), and @w{@kbd{v =}}
21264 (@code{calc-matrix-center-justify}) control whether matrix elements
21265 are justified to the left, right, or center of their columns.
21266
21267 @kindex v [
21268 @kindex V [
21269 @pindex calc-vector-brackets
21270 @kindex v @{
21271 @kindex V @{
21272 @pindex calc-vector-braces
21273 @kindex v (
21274 @kindex V (
21275 @pindex calc-vector-parens
21276 The @kbd{v [} (@code{calc-vector-brackets}) command turns the square
21277 brackets that surround vectors and matrices displayed in the stack on
21278 and off. The @kbd{v @{} (@code{calc-vector-braces}) and @kbd{v (}
21279 (@code{calc-vector-parens}) commands use curly braces or parentheses,
21280 respectively, instead of square brackets. For example, @kbd{v @{} might
21281 be used in preparation for yanking a matrix into a buffer running
21282 Mathematica. (In fact, the Mathematica language mode uses this mode;
21283 @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}.) Note that, regardless of the
21284 display mode, either brackets or braces may be used to enter vectors,
21285 and parentheses may never be used for this purpose.
21286
21287 @kindex V ]
21288 @kindex v ]
21289 @kindex V )
21290 @kindex v )
21291 @kindex V @}
21292 @kindex v @}
21293 @pindex calc-matrix-brackets
21294 The @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) command controls the
21295 ``big'' style display of matrices, for matrices which have more than
21296 one row. It prompts for a string of code letters; currently
21297 implemented letters are @code{R}, which enables brackets on each row
21298 of the matrix; @code{O}, which enables outer brackets in opposite
21299 corners of the matrix; and @code{C}, which enables commas or
21300 semicolons at the ends of all rows but the last. The default format
21301 is @samp{RO}. (Before Calc 2.00, the format was fixed at @samp{ROC}.)
21302 Here are some example matrices:
21303
21304 @example
21305 @group
21306 [ [ 123, 0, 0 ] [ [ 123, 0, 0 ],
21307 [ 0, 123, 0 ] [ 0, 123, 0 ],
21308 [ 0, 0, 123 ] ] [ 0, 0, 123 ] ]
21309
21310 RO ROC
21311
21312 @end group
21313 @end example
21314 @noindent
21315 @example
21316 @group
21317 [ 123, 0, 0 [ 123, 0, 0 ;
21318 0, 123, 0 0, 123, 0 ;
21319 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123 ]
21320
21321 O OC
21322
21323 @end group
21324 @end example
21325 @noindent
21326 @example
21327 @group
21328 [ 123, 0, 0 ] 123, 0, 0
21329 [ 0, 123, 0 ] 0, 123, 0
21330 [ 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123
21331
21332 R @r{blank}
21333 @end group
21334 @end example
21335
21336 @noindent
21337 Note that of the formats shown here, @samp{RO}, @samp{ROC}, and
21338 @samp{OC} are all recognized as matrices during reading, while
21339 the others are useful for display only.
21340
21341 @kindex v ,
21342 @kindex V ,
21343 @pindex calc-vector-commas
21344 The @kbd{v ,} (@code{calc-vector-commas}) command turns commas on and
21345 off in vector and matrix display.
21346
21347 In vectors of length one, and in all vectors when commas have been
21348 turned off, Calc adds extra parentheses around formulas that might
21349 otherwise be ambiguous. For example, @samp{[a b]} could be a vector
21350 of the one formula @samp{a b}, or it could be a vector of two
21351 variables with commas turned off. Calc will display the former
21352 case as @samp{[(a b)]}. You can disable these extra parentheses
21353 (to make the output less cluttered at the expense of allowing some
21354 ambiguity) by adding the letter @code{P} to the control string you
21355 give to @kbd{v ]} (as described above).
21356
21357 @kindex v .
21358 @kindex V .
21359 @pindex calc-full-vectors
21360 The @kbd{v .} (@code{calc-full-vectors}) command turns abbreviated
21361 display of long vectors on and off. In this mode, vectors of six
21362 or more elements, or matrices of six or more rows or columns, will
21363 be displayed in an abbreviated form that displays only the first
21364 three elements and the last element: @samp{[a, b, c, ..., z]}.
21365 When very large vectors are involved this will substantially
21366 improve Calc's display speed.
21367
21368 @kindex t .
21369 @pindex calc-full-trail-vectors
21370 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command controls a
21371 similar mode for recording vectors in the Trail. If you turn on
21372 this mode, vectors of six or more elements and matrices of six or
21373 more rows or columns will be abbreviated when they are put in the
21374 Trail. The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command will be
21375 unable to recover those vectors. If you are working with very
21376 large vectors, this mode will improve the speed of all operations
21377 that involve the trail.
21378
21379 @kindex v /
21380 @kindex V /
21381 @pindex calc-break-vectors
21382 The @kbd{v /} (@code{calc-break-vectors}) command turns multi-line
21383 vector display on and off. Normally, matrices are displayed with one
21384 row per line but all other types of vectors are displayed in a single
21385 line. This mode causes all vectors, whether matrices or not, to be
21386 displayed with a single element per line. Sub-vectors within the
21387 vectors will still use the normal linear form.
21388
21389 @node Algebra, Units, Matrix Functions, Top
21390 @chapter Algebra
21391
21392 @noindent
21393 This section covers the Calc features that help you work with
21394 algebraic formulas. First, the general sub-formula selection
21395 mechanism is described; this works in conjunction with any Calc
21396 commands. Then, commands for specific algebraic operations are
21397 described. Finally, the flexible @dfn{rewrite rule} mechanism
21398 is discussed.
21399
21400 The algebraic commands use the @kbd{a} key prefix; selection
21401 commands use the @kbd{j} (for ``just a letter that wasn't used
21402 for anything else'') prefix.
21403
21404 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, to see how to manipulate formulas
21405 using regular Emacs editing commands.
21406
21407 When doing algebraic work, you may find several of the Calculator's
21408 modes to be helpful, including Algebraic Simplification mode (@kbd{m A})
21409 or No-Simplification mode (@kbd{m O}),
21410 Algebraic entry mode (@kbd{m a}), Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}), and
21411 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}). @xref{Mode Settings}, for discussions
21412 of these modes. You may also wish to select Big display mode (@kbd{d B}).
21413 @xref{Normal Language Modes}.
21414
21415 @menu
21416 * Selecting Subformulas::
21417 * Algebraic Manipulation::
21418 * Simplifying Formulas::
21419 * Polynomials::
21420 * Calculus::
21421 * Solving Equations::
21422 * Numerical Solutions::
21423 * Curve Fitting::
21424 * Summations::
21425 * Logical Operations::
21426 * Rewrite Rules::
21427 @end menu
21428
21429 @node Selecting Subformulas, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra, Algebra
21430 @section Selecting Sub-Formulas
21431
21432 @noindent
21433 @cindex Selections
21434 @cindex Sub-formulas
21435 @cindex Parts of formulas
21436 When working with an algebraic formula it is often necessary to
21437 manipulate a portion of the formula rather than the formula as a
21438 whole. Calc allows you to ``select'' a portion of any formula on
21439 the stack. Commands which would normally operate on that stack
21440 entry will now operate only on the sub-formula, leaving the
21441 surrounding part of the stack entry alone.
21442
21443 One common non-algebraic use for selection involves vectors. To work
21444 on one element of a vector in-place, simply select that element as a
21445 ``sub-formula'' of the vector.
21446
21447 @menu
21448 * Making Selections::
21449 * Changing Selections::
21450 * Displaying Selections::
21451 * Operating on Selections::
21452 * Rearranging with Selections::
21453 @end menu
21454
21455 @node Making Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas, Selecting Subformulas
21456 @subsection Making Selections
21457
21458 @noindent
21459 @kindex j s
21460 @pindex calc-select-here
21461 To select a sub-formula, move the Emacs cursor to any character in that
21462 sub-formula, and press @w{@kbd{j s}} (@code{calc-select-here}). Calc will
21463 highlight the smallest portion of the formula that contains that
21464 character. By default the sub-formula is highlighted by blanking out
21465 all of the rest of the formula with dots. Selection works in any
21466 display mode but is perhaps easiest in Big mode (@kbd{d B}).
21467 Suppose you enter the following formula:
21468
21469 @smallexample
21470 @group
21471 3 ___
21472 (a + b) + V c
21473 1: ---------------
21474 2 x + 1
21475 @end group
21476 @end smallexample
21477
21478 @noindent
21479 (by typing @kbd{' ((a+b)^3 + sqrt(c)) / (2x+1)}). If you move the
21480 cursor to the letter @samp{b} and press @w{@kbd{j s}}, the display changes
21481 to
21482
21483 @smallexample
21484 @group
21485 . ...
21486 .. . b. . . .
21487 1* ...............
21488 . . . .
21489 @end group
21490 @end smallexample
21491
21492 @noindent
21493 Every character not part of the sub-formula @samp{b} has been changed
21494 to a dot. The @samp{*} next to the line number is to remind you that
21495 the formula has a portion of it selected. (In this case, it's very
21496 obvious, but it might not always be. If Embedded mode is enabled,
21497 the word @samp{Sel} also appears in the mode line because the stack
21498 may not be visible. @pxref{Embedded Mode}.)
21499
21500 If you had instead placed the cursor on the parenthesis immediately to
21501 the right of the @samp{b}, the selection would have been:
21502
21503 @smallexample
21504 @group
21505 . ...
21506 (a + b) . . .
21507 1* ...............
21508 . . . .
21509 @end group
21510 @end smallexample
21511
21512 @noindent
21513 The portion selected is always large enough to be considered a complete
21514 formula all by itself, so selecting the parenthesis selects the whole
21515 formula that it encloses. Putting the cursor on the @samp{+} sign
21516 would have had the same effect.
21517
21518 (Strictly speaking, the Emacs cursor is really the manifestation of
21519 the Emacs ``point,'' which is a position @emph{between} two characters
21520 in the buffer. So purists would say that Calc selects the smallest
21521 sub-formula which contains the character to the right of ``point.'')
21522
21523 If you supply a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, the selection is
21524 expanded to the @var{n}th enclosing sub-formula. Thus, positioning
21525 the cursor on the @samp{b} and typing @kbd{C-u 1 j s} will select
21526 @samp{a + b}; typing @kbd{C-u 2 j s} will select @samp{(a + b)^3},
21527 and so on.
21528
21529 If the cursor is not on any part of the formula, or if you give a
21530 numeric prefix that is too large, the entire formula is selected.
21531
21532 If the cursor is on the @samp{.} line that marks the top of the stack
21533 (i.e., its normal ``rest position''), this command selects the entire
21534 formula at stack level 1. Most selection commands similarly operate
21535 on the formula at the top of the stack if you haven't positioned the
21536 cursor on any stack entry.
21537
21538 @kindex j a
21539 @pindex calc-select-additional
21540 The @kbd{j a} (@code{calc-select-additional}) command enlarges the
21541 current selection to encompass the cursor. To select the smallest
21542 sub-formula defined by two different points, move to the first and
21543 press @kbd{j s}, then move to the other and press @kbd{j a}. This
21544 is roughly analogous to using @kbd{C-@@} (@code{set-mark-command}) to
21545 select the two ends of a region of text during normal Emacs editing.
21546
21547 @kindex j o
21548 @pindex calc-select-once
21549 The @kbd{j o} (@code{calc-select-once}) command selects a formula in
21550 exactly the same way as @kbd{j s}, except that the selection will
21551 last only as long as the next command that uses it. For example,
21552 @kbd{j o 1 +} is a handy way to add one to the sub-formula indicated
21553 by the cursor.
21554
21555 (A somewhat more precise definition: The @kbd{j o} command sets a flag
21556 such that the next command involving selected stack entries will clear
21557 the selections on those stack entries afterwards. All other selection
21558 commands except @kbd{j a} and @kbd{j O} clear this flag.)
21559
21560 @kindex j S
21561 @kindex j O
21562 @pindex calc-select-here-maybe
21563 @pindex calc-select-once-maybe
21564 The @kbd{j S} (@code{calc-select-here-maybe}) and @kbd{j O}
21565 (@code{calc-select-once-maybe}) commands are equivalent to @kbd{j s}
21566 and @kbd{j o}, respectively, except that if the formula already
21567 has a selection they have no effect. This is analogous to the
21568 behavior of some commands such as @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection};
21569 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}) and is mainly intended to be
21570 used in keyboard macros that implement your own selection-oriented
21571 commands.
21572
21573 Selection of sub-formulas normally treats associative terms like
21574 @samp{a + b - c + d} and @samp{x * y * z} as single levels of the formula.
21575 If you place the cursor anywhere inside @samp{a + b - c + d} except
21576 on one of the variable names and use @kbd{j s}, you will select the
21577 entire four-term sum.
21578
21579 @kindex j b
21580 @pindex calc-break-selections
21581 The @kbd{j b} (@code{calc-break-selections}) command controls a mode
21582 in which the ``deep structure'' of these associative formulas shows
21583 through. Calc actually stores the above formulas as
21584 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d} and @samp{x * (y * z)}. (Note that for certain
21585 obscure reasons, by default Calc treats multiplication as
21586 right-associative.) Once you have enabled @kbd{j b} mode, selecting
21587 with the cursor on the @samp{-} sign would only select the @samp{a + b -
21588 c} portion, which makes sense when the deep structure of the sum is
21589 considered. There is no way to select the @samp{b - c + d} portion;
21590 although this might initially look like just as legitimate a sub-formula
21591 as @samp{a + b - c}, the deep structure shows that it isn't. The @kbd{d
21592 U} command can be used to view the deep structure of any formula
21593 (@pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
21594
21595 When @kbd{j b} mode has not been enabled, the deep structure is
21596 generally hidden by the selection commands---what you see is what
21597 you get.
21598
21599 @kindex j u
21600 @pindex calc-unselect
21601 The @kbd{j u} (@code{calc-unselect}) command unselects the formula
21602 that the cursor is on. If there was no selection in the formula,
21603 this command has no effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it
21604 unselects the @var{n}th stack element rather than using the cursor
21605 position.
21606
21607 @kindex j c
21608 @pindex calc-clear-selections
21609 The @kbd{j c} (@code{calc-clear-selections}) command unselects all
21610 stack elements.
21611
21612 @node Changing Selections, Displaying Selections, Making Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21613 @subsection Changing Selections
21614
21615 @noindent
21616 @kindex j m
21617 @pindex calc-select-more
21618 Once you have selected a sub-formula, you can expand it using the
21619 @w{@kbd{j m}} (@code{calc-select-more}) command. If @samp{a + b} is
21620 selected, pressing @w{@kbd{j m}} repeatedly works as follows:
21621
21622 @smallexample
21623 @group
21624 3 ... 3 ___ 3 ___
21625 (a + b) . . . (a + b) + V c (a + b) + V c
21626 1* ............... 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21627 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21628 @end group
21629 @end smallexample
21630
21631 @noindent
21632 In the last example, the entire formula is selected. This is roughly
21633 the same as having no selection at all, but because there are subtle
21634 differences the @samp{*} character is still there on the line number.
21635
21636 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, @kbd{j m} expands @var{n}
21637 times (or until the entire formula is selected). Note that @kbd{j s}
21638 with argument @var{n} is equivalent to plain @kbd{j s} followed by
21639 @kbd{j m} with argument @var{n}. If @w{@kbd{j m}} is used when there
21640 is no current selection, it is equivalent to @w{@kbd{j s}}.
21641
21642 Even though @kbd{j m} does not explicitly use the location of the
21643 cursor within the formula, it nevertheless uses the cursor to determine
21644 which stack element to operate on. As usual, @kbd{j m} when the cursor
21645 is not on any stack element operates on the top stack element.
21646
21647 @kindex j l
21648 @pindex calc-select-less
21649 The @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) command reduces the current
21650 selection around the cursor position. That is, it selects the
21651 immediate sub-formula of the current selection which contains the
21652 cursor, the opposite of @kbd{j m}. If the cursor is not inside the
21653 current selection, the command de-selects the formula.
21654
21655 @kindex j 1-9
21656 @pindex calc-select-part
21657 The @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} (@code{calc-select-part}) commands
21658 select the @var{n}th sub-formula of the current selection. They are
21659 like @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) except they use counting
21660 rather than the cursor position to decide which sub-formula to select.
21661 For example, if the current selection is @kbd{a + b + c} or
21662 @kbd{f(a, b, c)} or @kbd{[a, b, c]}, then @kbd{j 1} selects @samp{a},
21663 @kbd{j 2} selects @samp{b}, and @kbd{j 3} selects @samp{c}; in each of
21664 these cases, @kbd{j 4} through @kbd{j 9} would be errors.
21665
21666 If there is no current selection, @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} select
21667 the @var{n}th top-level sub-formula. (In other words, they act as if
21668 the entire stack entry were selected first.) To select the @var{n}th
21669 sub-formula where @var{n} is greater than nine, you must instead invoke
21670 @w{@kbd{j 1}} with @var{n} as a numeric prefix argument.
21671
21672 @kindex j n
21673 @kindex j p
21674 @pindex calc-select-next
21675 @pindex calc-select-previous
21676 The @kbd{j n} (@code{calc-select-next}) and @kbd{j p}
21677 (@code{calc-select-previous}) commands change the current selection
21678 to the next or previous sub-formula at the same level. For example,
21679 if @samp{b} is selected in @w{@samp{2 + a*b*c + x}}, then @kbd{j n}
21680 selects @samp{c}. Further @kbd{j n} commands would be in error because,
21681 even though there is something to the right of @samp{c} (namely, @samp{x}),
21682 it is not at the same level; in this case, it is not a term of the
21683 same product as @samp{b} and @samp{c}. However, @kbd{j m} (to select
21684 the whole product @samp{a*b*c} as a term of the sum) followed by
21685 @w{@kbd{j n}} would successfully select the @samp{x}.
21686
21687 Similarly, @kbd{j p} moves the selection from the @samp{b} in this
21688 sample formula to the @samp{a}. Both commands accept numeric prefix
21689 arguments to move several steps at a time.
21690
21691 It is interesting to compare Calc's selection commands with the
21692 Emacs Info system's commands for navigating through hierarchically
21693 organized documentation. Calc's @kbd{j n} command is completely
21694 analogous to Info's @kbd{n} command. Likewise, @kbd{j p} maps to
21695 @kbd{p}, @kbd{j 2} maps to @kbd{2}, and Info's @kbd{u} is like @kbd{j m}.
21696 (Note that @kbd{j u} stands for @code{calc-unselect}, not ``up''.)
21697 The Info @kbd{m} command is somewhat similar to Calc's @kbd{j s} and
21698 @kbd{j l}; in each case, you can jump directly to a sub-component
21699 of the hierarchy simply by pointing to it with the cursor.
21700
21701 @node Displaying Selections, Operating on Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21702 @subsection Displaying Selections
21703
21704 @noindent
21705 @kindex j d
21706 @pindex calc-show-selections
21707 The @kbd{j d} (@code{calc-show-selections}) command controls how
21708 selected sub-formulas are displayed. One of the alternatives is
21709 illustrated in the above examples; if we press @kbd{j d} we switch
21710 to the other style in which the selected portion itself is obscured
21711 by @samp{#} signs:
21712
21713 @smallexample
21714 @group
21715 3 ... # ___
21716 (a + b) . . . ## # ## + V c
21717 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21718 . . . . 2 x + 1
21719 @end group
21720 @end smallexample
21721
21722 @node Operating on Selections, Rearranging with Selections, Displaying Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21723 @subsection Operating on Selections
21724
21725 @noindent
21726 Once a selection is made, all Calc commands that manipulate items
21727 on the stack will operate on the selected portions of the items
21728 instead. (Note that several stack elements may have selections
21729 at once, though there can be only one selection at a time in any
21730 given stack element.)
21731
21732 @kindex j e
21733 @pindex calc-enable-selections
21734 The @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command disables the
21735 effect that selections have on Calc commands. The current selections
21736 still exist, but Calc commands operate on whole stack elements anyway.
21737 This mode can be identified by the fact that the @samp{*} markers on
21738 the line numbers are gone, even though selections are visible. To
21739 reactivate the selections, press @kbd{j e} again.
21740
21741 To extract a sub-formula as a new formula, simply select the
21742 sub-formula and press @key{RET}. This normally duplicates the top
21743 stack element; here it duplicates only the selected portion of that
21744 element.
21745
21746 To replace a sub-formula with something different, you can enter the
21747 new value onto the stack and press @key{TAB}. This normally exchanges
21748 the top two stack elements; here it swaps the value you entered into
21749 the selected portion of the formula, returning the old selected
21750 portion to the top of the stack.
21751
21752 @smallexample
21753 @group
21754 3 ... ... ___
21755 (a + b) . . . 17 x y . . . 17 x y + V c
21756 2* ............... 2* ............. 2: -------------
21757 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21758
21759 3 3
21760 1: 17 x y 1: (a + b) 1: (a + b)
21761 @end group
21762 @end smallexample
21763
21764 In this example we select a sub-formula of our original example,
21765 enter a new formula, @key{TAB} it into place, then deselect to see
21766 the complete, edited formula.
21767
21768 If you want to swap whole formulas around even though they contain
21769 selections, just use @kbd{j e} before and after.
21770
21771 @kindex j '
21772 @pindex calc-enter-selection
21773 The @kbd{j '} (@code{calc-enter-selection}) command is another way
21774 to replace a selected sub-formula. This command does an algebraic
21775 entry just like the regular @kbd{'} key. When you press @key{RET},
21776 the formula you type replaces the original selection. You can use
21777 the @samp{$} symbol in the formula to refer to the original
21778 selection. If there is no selection in the formula under the cursor,
21779 the cursor is used to make a temporary selection for the purposes of
21780 the command. Thus, to change a term of a formula, all you have to
21781 do is move the Emacs cursor to that term and press @kbd{j '}.
21782
21783 @kindex j `
21784 @pindex calc-edit-selection
21785 The @kbd{j `} (@code{calc-edit-selection}) command is a similar
21786 analogue of the @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command. It edits the
21787 selected sub-formula in a separate buffer. If there is no
21788 selection, it edits the sub-formula indicated by the cursor.
21789
21790 To delete a sub-formula, press @key{DEL}. This generally replaces
21791 the sub-formula with the constant zero, but in a few suitable contexts
21792 it uses the constant one instead. The @key{DEL} key automatically
21793 deselects and re-simplifies the entire formula afterwards. Thus:
21794
21795 @smallexample
21796 @group
21797 ###
21798 17 x y + # # 17 x y 17 # y 17 y
21799 1* ------------- 1: ------- 1* ------- 1: -------
21800 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1
21801 @end group
21802 @end smallexample
21803
21804 In this example, we first delete the @samp{sqrt(c)} term; Calc
21805 accomplishes this by replacing @samp{sqrt(c)} with zero and
21806 resimplifying. We then delete the @kbd{x} in the numerator;
21807 since this is part of a product, Calc replaces it with @samp{1}
21808 and resimplifies.
21809
21810 If you select an element of a vector and press @key{DEL}, that
21811 element is deleted from the vector. If you delete one side of
21812 an equation or inequality, only the opposite side remains.
21813
21814 @kindex j @key{DEL}
21815 @pindex calc-del-selection
21816 The @kbd{j @key{DEL}} (@code{calc-del-selection}) command is like
21817 @key{DEL} but with the auto-selecting behavior of @kbd{j '} and
21818 @kbd{j `}. It deletes the selected portion of the formula
21819 indicated by the cursor, or, in the absence of a selection, it
21820 deletes the sub-formula indicated by the cursor position.
21821
21822 @kindex j @key{RET}
21823 @pindex calc-grab-selection
21824 (There is also an auto-selecting @kbd{j @key{RET}} (@code{calc-copy-selection})
21825 command.)
21826
21827 Normal arithmetic operations also apply to sub-formulas. Here we
21828 select the denominator, press @kbd{5 -} to subtract five from the
21829 denominator, press @kbd{n} to negate the denominator, then
21830 press @kbd{Q} to take the square root.
21831
21832 @smallexample
21833 @group
21834 .. . .. . .. . .. .
21835 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ..........
21836 2 x + 1 2 x - 4 4 - 2 x _________
21837 V 4 - 2 x
21838 @end group
21839 @end smallexample
21840
21841 Certain types of operations on selections are not allowed. For
21842 example, for an arithmetic function like @kbd{-} no more than one of
21843 the arguments may be a selected sub-formula. (As the above example
21844 shows, the result of the subtraction is spliced back into the argument
21845 which had the selection; if there were more than one selection involved,
21846 this would not be well-defined.) If you try to subtract two selections,
21847 the command will abort with an error message.
21848
21849 Operations on sub-formulas sometimes leave the formula as a whole
21850 in an ``un-natural'' state. Consider negating the @samp{2 x} term
21851 of our sample formula by selecting it and pressing @kbd{n}
21852 (@code{calc-change-sign}).
21853
21854 @smallexample
21855 @group
21856 .. . .. .
21857 1* .......... 1* ...........
21858 ......... ..........
21859 . . . 2 x . . . -2 x
21860 @end group
21861 @end smallexample
21862
21863 Unselecting the sub-formula reveals that the minus sign, which would
21864 normally have cancelled out with the subtraction automatically, has
21865 not been able to do so because the subtraction was not part of the
21866 selected portion. Pressing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) or doing
21867 any other mathematical operation on the whole formula will cause it
21868 to be simplified.
21869
21870 @smallexample
21871 @group
21872 17 y 17 y
21873 1: ----------- 1: ----------
21874 __________ _________
21875 V 4 - -2 x V 4 + 2 x
21876 @end group
21877 @end smallexample
21878
21879 @node Rearranging with Selections, , Operating on Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21880 @subsection Rearranging Formulas using Selections
21881
21882 @noindent
21883 @kindex j R
21884 @pindex calc-commute-right
21885 The @kbd{j R} (@code{calc-commute-right}) command moves the selected
21886 sub-formula to the right in its surrounding formula. Generally the
21887 selection is one term of a sum or product; the sum or product is
21888 rearranged according to the commutative laws of algebra.
21889
21890 As with @kbd{j '} and @kbd{j @key{DEL}}, the term under the cursor is used
21891 if there is no selection in the current formula. All commands described
21892 in this section share this property. In this example, we place the
21893 cursor on the @samp{a} and type @kbd{j R}, then repeat.
21894
21895 @smallexample
21896 1: a + b - c 1: b + a - c 1: b - c + a
21897 @end smallexample
21898
21899 @noindent
21900 Note that in the final step above, the @samp{a} is switched with
21901 the @samp{c} but the signs are adjusted accordingly. When moving
21902 terms of sums and products, @kbd{j R} will never change the
21903 mathematical meaning of the formula.
21904
21905 The selected term may also be an element of a vector or an argument
21906 of a function. The term is exchanged with the one to its right.
21907 In this case, the ``meaning'' of the vector or function may of
21908 course be drastically changed.
21909
21910 @smallexample
21911 1: [a, b, c] 1: [b, a, c] 1: [b, c, a]
21912
21913 1: f(a, b, c) 1: f(b, a, c) 1: f(b, c, a)
21914 @end smallexample
21915
21916 @kindex j L
21917 @pindex calc-commute-left
21918 The @kbd{j L} (@code{calc-commute-left}) command is like @kbd{j R}
21919 except that it swaps the selected term with the one to its left.
21920
21921 With numeric prefix arguments, these commands move the selected
21922 term several steps at a time. It is an error to try to move a
21923 term left or right past the end of its enclosing formula.
21924 With numeric prefix arguments of zero, these commands move the
21925 selected term as far as possible in the given direction.
21926
21927 @kindex j D
21928 @pindex calc-sel-distribute
21929 The @kbd{j D} (@code{calc-sel-distribute}) command mixes the selected
21930 sum or product into the surrounding formula using the distributive
21931 law. For example, in @samp{a * (b - c)} with the @samp{b - c}
21932 selected, the result is @samp{a b - a c}. This also distributes
21933 products or quotients into surrounding powers, and can also do
21934 transformations like @samp{exp(a + b)} to @samp{exp(a) exp(b)},
21935 where @samp{a + b} is the selected term, and @samp{ln(a ^ b)}
21936 to @samp{ln(a) b}, where @samp{a ^ b} is the selected term.
21937
21938 For multiple-term sums or products, @kbd{j D} takes off one term
21939 at a time: @samp{a * (b + c - d)} goes to @samp{a * (c - d) + a b}
21940 with the @samp{c - d} selected so that you can type @kbd{j D}
21941 repeatedly to expand completely. The @kbd{j D} command allows a
21942 numeric prefix argument which specifies the maximum number of
21943 times to expand at once; the default is one time only.
21944
21945 @vindex DistribRules
21946 The @kbd{j D} command is implemented using rewrite rules.
21947 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}. The rules are stored in
21948 the Calc variable @code{DistribRules}. A convenient way to view
21949 these rules is to use @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) which
21950 displays and edits the stored value of a variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c}
21951 to return from editing mode; be careful not to make any actual changes
21952 or else you will affect the behavior of future @kbd{j D} commands!
21953
21954 To extend @kbd{j D} to handle new cases, just edit @code{DistribRules}
21955 as described above. You can then use the @kbd{s p} command to save
21956 this variable's value permanently for future Calc sessions.
21957 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
21958
21959 @kindex j M
21960 @pindex calc-sel-merge
21961 @vindex MergeRules
21962 The @kbd{j M} (@code{calc-sel-merge}) command is the complement
21963 of @kbd{j D}; given @samp{a b - a c} with either @samp{a b} or
21964 @samp{a c} selected, the result is @samp{a * (b - c)}. Once
21965 again, @kbd{j M} can also merge calls to functions like @code{exp}
21966 and @code{ln}; examine the variable @code{MergeRules} to see all
21967 the relevant rules.
21968
21969 @kindex j C
21970 @pindex calc-sel-commute
21971 @vindex CommuteRules
21972 The @kbd{j C} (@code{calc-sel-commute}) command swaps the arguments
21973 of the selected sum, product, or equation. It always behaves as
21974 if @kbd{j b} mode were in effect, i.e., the sum @samp{a + b + c} is
21975 treated as the nested sums @samp{(a + b) + c} by this command.
21976 If you put the cursor on the first @samp{+}, the result is
21977 @samp{(b + a) + c}; if you put the cursor on the second @samp{+}, the
21978 result is @samp{c + (a + b)} (which the default simplifications
21979 will rearrange to @samp{(c + a) + b}). The relevant rules are stored
21980 in the variable @code{CommuteRules}.
21981
21982 You may need to turn default simplifications off (with the @kbd{m O}
21983 command) in order to get the full benefit of @kbd{j C}. For example,
21984 commuting @samp{a - b} produces @samp{-b + a}, but the default
21985 simplifications will ``simplify'' this right back to @samp{a - b} if
21986 you don't turn them off. The same is true of some of the other
21987 manipulations described in this section.
21988
21989 @kindex j N
21990 @pindex calc-sel-negate
21991 @vindex NegateRules
21992 The @kbd{j N} (@code{calc-sel-negate}) command replaces the selected
21993 term with the negative of that term, then adjusts the surrounding
21994 formula in order to preserve the meaning. For example, given
21995 @samp{exp(a - b)} where @samp{a - b} is selected, the result is
21996 @samp{1 / exp(b - a)}. By contrast, selecting a term and using the
21997 regular @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the
21998 term without adjusting the surroundings, thus changing the meaning
21999 of the formula as a whole. The rules variable is @code{NegateRules}.
22000
22001 @kindex j &
22002 @pindex calc-sel-invert
22003 @vindex InvertRules
22004 The @kbd{j &} (@code{calc-sel-invert}) command is similar to @kbd{j N}
22005 except it takes the reciprocal of the selected term. For example,
22006 given @samp{a - ln(b)} with @samp{b} selected, the result is
22007 @samp{a + ln(1/b)}. The rules variable is @code{InvertRules}.
22008
22009 @kindex j E
22010 @pindex calc-sel-jump-equals
22011 @vindex JumpRules
22012 The @kbd{j E} (@code{calc-sel-jump-equals}) command moves the
22013 selected term from one side of an equation to the other. Given
22014 @samp{a + b = c + d} with @samp{c} selected, the result is
22015 @samp{a + b - c = d}. This command also works if the selected
22016 term is part of a @samp{*}, @samp{/}, or @samp{^} formula. The
22017 relevant rules variable is @code{JumpRules}.
22018
22019 @kindex j I
22020 @kindex H j I
22021 @pindex calc-sel-isolate
22022 The @kbd{j I} (@code{calc-sel-isolate}) command isolates the
22023 selected term on its side of an equation. It uses the @kbd{a S}
22024 (@code{calc-solve-for}) command to solve the equation, and the
22025 Hyperbolic flag affects it in the same way. @xref{Solving Equations}.
22026 When it applies, @kbd{j I} is often easier to use than @kbd{j E}.
22027 It understands more rules of algebra, and works for inequalities
22028 as well as equations.
22029
22030 @kindex j *
22031 @kindex j /
22032 @pindex calc-sel-mult-both-sides
22033 @pindex calc-sel-div-both-sides
22034 The @kbd{j *} (@code{calc-sel-mult-both-sides}) command prompts for a
22035 formula using algebraic entry, then multiplies both sides of the
22036 selected quotient or equation by that formula. It simplifies each
22037 side with @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) before re-forming the
22038 quotient or equation. You can suppress this simplification by
22039 providing a prefix argument: @kbd{C-u j *}. There is also a @kbd{j /}
22040 (@code{calc-sel-div-both-sides}) which is similar to @kbd{j *} but
22041 dividing instead of multiplying by the factor you enter.
22042
22043 If the selection is a quotient with numerator 1, then Calc's default
22044 simplifications would normally cancel the new factors. To prevent
22045 this, when the @kbd{j *} command is used on a selection whose numerator is
22046 1 or -1, the denominator is expanded at the top level using the
22047 distributive law (as if using the @kbd{C-u 1 a x} command). Suppose the
22048 formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (a + 1)} and you wish to multiplying the
22049 top and bottom by @samp{a - 1}. Calc's default simplifications would
22050 normally change the result @samp{(a - 1) /(a + 1) (a - 1)} back
22051 to the original form by cancellation; when @kbd{j *} is used, Calc
22052 expands the denominator to @samp{a (a - 1) + a - 1} to prevent this.
22053
22054 If you wish the @kbd{j *} command to completely expand the denominator
22055 of a quotient you can call it with a zero prefix: @kbd{C-u 0 j *}. For
22056 example, if the formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (sqrt(a) + 1)}, you may
22057 wish to eliminate the square root in the denominator by multiplying
22058 the top and bottom by @samp{sqrt(a) - 1}. If you did this simply by using
22059 a simple @kbd{j *} command, you would get
22060 @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/ (sqrt(a) (sqrt(a) - 1) + sqrt(a) - 1)}. Instead,
22061 you would probably want to use @kbd{C-u 0 j *}, which would expand the
22062 bottom and give you the desired result @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/(a-1)}. More
22063 generally, if @kbd{j *} is called with an argument of a positive
22064 integer @var{n}, then the denominator of the expression will be
22065 expanded @var{n} times (as if with the @kbd{C-u @var{n} a x} command).
22066
22067 If the selection is an inequality, @kbd{j *} and @kbd{j /} will
22068 accept any factor, but will warn unless they can prove the factor
22069 is either positive or negative. (In the latter case the direction
22070 of the inequality will be switched appropriately.) @xref{Declarations},
22071 for ways to inform Calc that a given variable is positive or
22072 negative. If Calc can't tell for sure what the sign of the factor
22073 will be, it will assume it is positive and display a warning
22074 message.
22075
22076 For selections that are not quotients, equations, or inequalities,
22077 these commands pull out a multiplicative factor: They divide (or
22078 multiply) by the entered formula, simplify, then multiply (or divide)
22079 back by the formula.
22080
22081 @kindex j +
22082 @kindex j -
22083 @pindex calc-sel-add-both-sides
22084 @pindex calc-sel-sub-both-sides
22085 The @kbd{j +} (@code{calc-sel-add-both-sides}) and @kbd{j -}
22086 (@code{calc-sel-sub-both-sides}) commands analogously add to or
22087 subtract from both sides of an equation or inequality. For other
22088 types of selections, they extract an additive factor. A numeric
22089 prefix argument suppresses simplification of the intermediate
22090 results.
22091
22092 @kindex j U
22093 @pindex calc-sel-unpack
22094 The @kbd{j U} (@code{calc-sel-unpack}) command replaces the
22095 selected function call with its argument. For example, given
22096 @samp{a + sin(x^2)} with @samp{sin(x^2)} selected, the result
22097 is @samp{a + x^2}. (The @samp{x^2} will remain selected; if you
22098 wanted to change the @code{sin} to @code{cos}, just press @kbd{C}
22099 now to take the cosine of the selected part.)
22100
22101 @kindex j v
22102 @pindex calc-sel-evaluate
22103 The @kbd{j v} (@code{calc-sel-evaluate}) command performs the
22104 normal default simplifications on the selected sub-formula.
22105 These are the simplifications that are normally done automatically
22106 on all results, but which may have been partially inhibited by
22107 previous selection-related operations, or turned off altogether
22108 by the @kbd{m O} command. This command is just an auto-selecting
22109 version of the @w{@kbd{a v}} command (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}).
22110
22111 With a numeric prefix argument of 2, @kbd{C-u 2 j v} applies
22112 the @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) command to the selected
22113 sub-formula. With a prefix argument of 3 or more, e.g., @kbd{C-u j v}
22114 applies the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) command.
22115 @xref{Simplifying Formulas}. With a negative prefix argument
22116 it simplifies at the top level only, just as with @kbd{a v}.
22117 Here the ``top'' level refers to the top level of the selected
22118 sub-formula.
22119
22120 @kindex j "
22121 @pindex calc-sel-expand-formula
22122 The @kbd{j "} (@code{calc-sel-expand-formula}) command is to @kbd{a "}
22123 (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}) what @kbd{j v} is to @kbd{a v}.
22124
22125 You can use the @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command
22126 to define other algebraic operations on sub-formulas. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22127
22128 @node Algebraic Manipulation, Simplifying Formulas, Selecting Subformulas, Algebra
22129 @section Algebraic Manipulation
22130
22131 @noindent
22132 The commands in this section perform general-purpose algebraic
22133 manipulations. They work on the whole formula at the top of the
22134 stack (unless, of course, you have made a selection in that
22135 formula).
22136
22137 Many algebra commands prompt for a variable name or formula. If you
22138 answer the prompt with a blank line, the variable or formula is taken
22139 from top-of-stack, and the normal argument for the command is taken
22140 from the second-to-top stack level.
22141
22142 @kindex a v
22143 @pindex calc-alg-evaluate
22144 The @kbd{a v} (@code{calc-alg-evaluate}) command performs the normal
22145 default simplifications on a formula; for example, @samp{a - -b} is
22146 changed to @samp{a + b}. These simplifications are normally done
22147 automatically on all Calc results, so this command is useful only if
22148 you have turned default simplifications off with an @kbd{m O}
22149 command. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
22150
22151 It is often more convenient to type @kbd{=}, which is like @kbd{a v}
22152 but which also substitutes stored values for variables in the formula.
22153 Use @kbd{a v} if you want the variables to ignore their stored values.
22154
22155 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 2 to @kbd{a v}, it simplifies
22156 as if in Algebraic Simplification mode. This is equivalent to typing
22157 @kbd{a s}; @pxref{Simplifying Formulas}. If you give a numeric prefix
22158 of 3 or more, it uses Extended Simplification mode (@kbd{a e}).
22159
22160 If you give a negative prefix argument @mathit{-1}, @mathit{-2}, or @mathit{-3},
22161 it simplifies in the corresponding mode but only works on the top-level
22162 function call of the formula. For example, @samp{(2 + 3) * (2 + 3)} will
22163 simplify to @samp{(2 + 3)^2}, without simplifying the sub-formulas
22164 @samp{2 + 3}. As another example, typing @kbd{V R +} to sum the vector
22165 @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]} produces the formula @samp{reduce(add, [1, 2, 3, 4])}
22166 in No-Simplify mode. Using @kbd{a v} will evaluate this all the way to
22167 10; using @kbd{C-u - a v} will evaluate it only to @samp{1 + 2 + 3 + 4}.
22168 (@xref{Reducing and Mapping}.)
22169
22170 @tindex evalv
22171 @tindex evalvn
22172 The @kbd{=} command corresponds to the @code{evalv} function, and
22173 the related @kbd{N} command, which is like @kbd{=} but temporarily
22174 disables Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}) during the evaluation, corresponds
22175 to the @code{evalvn} function. (These commands interpret their prefix
22176 arguments differently than @kbd{a v}; @kbd{=} treats the prefix as
22177 the number of stack elements to evaluate at once, and @kbd{N} treats
22178 it as a temporary different working precision.)
22179
22180 The @code{evalvn} function can take an alternate working precision
22181 as an optional second argument. This argument can be either an
22182 integer, to set the precision absolutely, or a vector containing
22183 a single integer, to adjust the precision relative to the current
22184 precision. Note that @code{evalvn} with a larger than current
22185 precision will do the calculation at this higher precision, but the
22186 result will as usual be rounded back down to the current precision
22187 afterward. For example, @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415)} at a precision
22188 of 12 will return @samp{9.265359e-5}; @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, 30)}
22189 will return @samp{9.26535897932e-5} (computing a 25-digit result which
22190 is then rounded down to 12); and @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, [-2])}
22191 will return @samp{9.2654e-5}.
22192
22193 @kindex a "
22194 @pindex calc-expand-formula
22195 The @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command expands functions
22196 into their defining formulas wherever possible. For example,
22197 @samp{deg(x^2)} is changed to @samp{180 x^2 / pi}. Most functions,
22198 like @code{sin} and @code{gcd}, are not defined by simple formulas
22199 and so are unaffected by this command. One important class of
22200 functions which @emph{can} be expanded is the user-defined functions
22201 created by the @kbd{Z F} command. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
22202 Other functions which @kbd{a "} can expand include the probability
22203 distribution functions, most of the financial functions, and the
22204 hyperbolic and inverse hyperbolic functions. A numeric prefix argument
22205 affects @kbd{a "} in the same way as it does @kbd{a v}: A positive
22206 argument expands all functions in the formula and then simplifies in
22207 various ways; a negative argument expands and simplifies only the
22208 top-level function call.
22209
22210 @kindex a M
22211 @pindex calc-map-equation
22212 @tindex mapeq
22213 The @kbd{a M} (@code{calc-map-equation}) [@code{mapeq}] command applies
22214 a given function or operator to one or more equations. It is analogous
22215 to @kbd{V M}, which operates on vectors instead of equations.
22216 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}. For example, @kbd{a M S} changes
22217 @samp{x = y+1} to @samp{sin(x) = sin(y+1)}, and @kbd{a M +} with
22218 @samp{x = y+1} and @expr{6} on the stack produces @samp{x+6 = y+7}.
22219 With two equations on the stack, @kbd{a M +} would add the lefthand
22220 sides together and the righthand sides together to get the two
22221 respective sides of a new equation.
22222
22223 Mapping also works on inequalities. Mapping two similar inequalities
22224 produces another inequality of the same type. Mapping an inequality
22225 with an equation produces an inequality of the same type. Mapping a
22226 @samp{<=} with a @samp{<} or @samp{!=} (not-equal) produces a @samp{<}.
22227 If inequalities with opposite direction (e.g., @samp{<} and @samp{>})
22228 are mapped, the direction of the second inequality is reversed to
22229 match the first: Using @kbd{a M +} on @samp{a < b} and @samp{a > 2}
22230 reverses the latter to get @samp{2 < a}, which then allows the
22231 combination @samp{a + 2 < b + a}, which the @kbd{a s} command can
22232 then simplify to get @samp{2 < b}.
22233
22234 Using @kbd{a M *}, @kbd{a M /}, @kbd{a M n}, or @kbd{a M &} to negate
22235 or invert an inequality will reverse the direction of the inequality.
22236 Other adjustments to inequalities are @emph{not} done automatically;
22237 @kbd{a M S} will change @w{@samp{x < y}} to @samp{sin(x) < sin(y)} even
22238 though this is not true for all values of the variables.
22239
22240 @kindex H a M
22241 @tindex mapeqp
22242 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a M} [@code{mapeqp}] does a plain
22243 mapping operation without reversing the direction of any inequalities.
22244 Thus, @kbd{H a M &} would change @kbd{x > 2} to @kbd{1/x > 0.5}.
22245 (This change is mathematically incorrect, but perhaps you were
22246 fixing an inequality which was already incorrect.)
22247
22248 @kindex I a M
22249 @tindex mapeqr
22250 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a M} [@code{mapeqr}] always reverses
22251 the direction of the inequality. You might use @kbd{I a M C} to
22252 change @samp{x < y} to @samp{cos(x) > cos(y)} if you know you are
22253 working with small positive angles.
22254
22255 @kindex a b
22256 @pindex calc-substitute
22257 @tindex subst
22258 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) [@code{subst}] command substitutes
22259 all occurrences
22260 of some variable or sub-expression of an expression with a new
22261 sub-expression. For example, substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(y)}
22262 in @samp{2 sin(x)^2 + x sin(x) + sin(2 x)} produces
22263 @samp{2 cos(y)^2 + x cos(y) + @w{sin(2 x)}}.
22264 Note that this is a purely structural substitution; the lone @samp{x} and
22265 the @samp{sin(2 x)} stayed the same because they did not look like
22266 @samp{sin(x)}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a more general method for
22267 doing substitutions.
22268
22269 The @kbd{a b} command normally prompts for two formulas, the old
22270 one and the new one. If you enter a blank line for the first
22271 prompt, all three arguments are taken from the stack (new, then old,
22272 then target expression). If you type an old formula but then enter a
22273 blank line for the new one, the new formula is taken from top-of-stack
22274 and the target from second-to-top. If you answer both prompts, the
22275 target is taken from top-of-stack as usual.
22276
22277 Note that @kbd{a b} has no understanding of commutativity or
22278 associativity. The pattern @samp{x+y} will not match the formula
22279 @samp{y+x}. Also, @samp{y+z} will not match inside the formula @samp{x+y+z}
22280 because the @samp{+} operator is left-associative, so the ``deep
22281 structure'' of that formula is @samp{(x+y) + z}. Use @kbd{d U}
22282 (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) mode to see the true structure of
22283 a formula. The rewrite rule mechanism, discussed later, does not have
22284 these limitations.
22285
22286 As an algebraic function, @code{subst} takes three arguments:
22287 Target expression, old, new. Note that @code{subst} is always
22288 evaluated immediately, even if its arguments are variables, so if
22289 you wish to put a call to @code{subst} onto the stack you must
22290 turn the default simplifications off first (with @kbd{m O}).
22291
22292 @node Simplifying Formulas, Polynomials, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra
22293 @section Simplifying Formulas
22294
22295 @noindent
22296 @kindex a s
22297 @pindex calc-simplify
22298 @tindex simplify
22299 The @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) [@code{simplify}] command applies
22300 various algebraic rules to simplify a formula. This includes rules which
22301 are not part of the default simplifications because they may be too slow
22302 to apply all the time, or may not be desirable all of the time. For
22303 example, non-adjacent terms of sums are combined, as in @samp{a + b + 2 a}
22304 to @samp{b + 3 a}, and some formulas like @samp{sin(arcsin(x))} are
22305 simplified to @samp{x}.
22306
22307 The sections below describe all the various kinds of algebraic
22308 simplifications Calc provides in full detail. None of Calc's
22309 simplification commands are designed to pull rabbits out of hats;
22310 they simply apply certain specific rules to put formulas into
22311 less redundant or more pleasing forms. Serious algebra in Calc
22312 must be done manually, usually with a combination of selections
22313 and rewrite rules. @xref{Rearranging with Selections}.
22314 @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22315
22316 @xref{Simplification Modes}, for commands to control what level of
22317 simplification occurs automatically. Normally only the ``default
22318 simplifications'' occur.
22319
22320 @menu
22321 * Default Simplifications::
22322 * Algebraic Simplifications::
22323 * Unsafe Simplifications::
22324 * Simplification of Units::
22325 @end menu
22326
22327 @node Default Simplifications, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas, Simplifying Formulas
22328 @subsection Default Simplifications
22329
22330 @noindent
22331 @cindex Default simplifications
22332 This section describes the ``default simplifications,'' those which are
22333 normally applied to all results. For example, if you enter the variable
22334 @expr{x} on the stack twice and push @kbd{+}, Calc's default
22335 simplifications automatically change @expr{x + x} to @expr{2 x}.
22336
22337 The @kbd{m O} command turns off the default simplifications, so that
22338 @expr{x + x} will remain in this form unless you give an explicit
22339 ``simplify'' command like @kbd{=} or @kbd{a v}. @xref{Algebraic
22340 Manipulation}. The @kbd{m D} command turns the default simplifications
22341 back on.
22342
22343 The most basic default simplification is the evaluation of functions.
22344 For example, @expr{2 + 3} is evaluated to @expr{5}, and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)}
22345 is evaluated to @expr{3}. Evaluation does not occur if the arguments
22346 to a function are somehow of the wrong type @expr{@tfn{tan}([2,3,4])}),
22347 range (@expr{@tfn{tan}(90)}), or number (@expr{@tfn{tan}(3,5)}),
22348 or if the function name is not recognized (@expr{@tfn{f}(5)}), or if
22349 Symbolic mode (@pxref{Symbolic Mode}) prevents evaluation
22350 (@expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2)}).
22351
22352 Calc simplifies (evaluates) the arguments to a function before it
22353 simplifies the function itself. Thus @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(5+4)} is
22354 simplified to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)} before the @code{sqrt} function
22355 itself is applied. There are very few exceptions to this rule:
22356 @code{quote}, @code{lambda}, and @code{condition} (the @code{::}
22357 operator) do not evaluate their arguments, @code{if} (the @code{? :}
22358 operator) does not evaluate all of its arguments, and @code{evalto}
22359 does not evaluate its lefthand argument.
22360
22361 Most commands apply the default simplifications to all arguments they
22362 take from the stack, perform a particular operation, then simplify
22363 the result before pushing it back on the stack. In the common special
22364 case of regular arithmetic commands like @kbd{+} and @kbd{Q} [@code{sqrt}],
22365 the arguments are simply popped from the stack and collected into a
22366 suitable function call, which is then simplified (the arguments being
22367 simplified first as part of the process, as described above).
22368
22369 The default simplifications are too numerous to describe completely
22370 here, but this section will describe the ones that apply to the
22371 major arithmetic operators. This list will be rather technical in
22372 nature, and will probably be interesting to you only if you are
22373 a serious user of Calc's algebra facilities.
22374
22375 @tex
22376 \bigskip
22377 @end tex
22378
22379 As well as the simplifications described here, if you have stored
22380 any rewrite rules in the variable @code{EvalRules} then these rules
22381 will also be applied before any built-in default simplifications.
22382 @xref{Automatic Rewrites}, for details.
22383
22384 @tex
22385 \bigskip
22386 @end tex
22387
22388 And now, on with the default simplifications:
22389
22390 Arithmetic operators like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} always take two
22391 arguments in Calc's internal form. Sums and products of three or
22392 more terms are arranged by the associative law of algebra into
22393 a left-associative form for sums, @expr{((a + b) + c) + d}, and
22394 (by default) a right-associative form for products,
22395 @expr{a * (b * (c * d))}. Formulas like @expr{(a + b) + (c + d)} are
22396 rearranged to left-associative form, though this rarely matters since
22397 Calc's algebra commands are designed to hide the inner structure of sums
22398 and products as much as possible. Sums and products in their proper
22399 associative form will be written without parentheses in the examples
22400 below.
22401
22402 Sums and products are @emph{not} rearranged according to the
22403 commutative law (@expr{a + b} to @expr{b + a}) except in a few
22404 special cases described below. Some algebra programs always
22405 rearrange terms into a canonical order, which enables them to
22406 see that @expr{a b + b a} can be simplified to @expr{2 a b}.
22407 Calc assumes you have put the terms into the order you want
22408 and generally leaves that order alone, with the consequence
22409 that formulas like the above will only be simplified if you
22410 explicitly give the @kbd{a s} command. @xref{Algebraic
22411 Simplifications}.
22412
22413 Differences @expr{a - b} are treated like sums @expr{a + (-b)}
22414 for purposes of simplification; one of the default simplifications
22415 is to rewrite @expr{a + (-b)} or @expr{(-b) + a}, where @expr{-b}
22416 represents a ``negative-looking'' term, into @expr{a - b} form.
22417 ``Negative-looking'' means negative numbers, negated formulas like
22418 @expr{-x}, and products or quotients in which either term is
22419 negative-looking.
22420
22421 Other simplifications involving negation are @expr{-(-x)} to @expr{x};
22422 @expr{-(a b)} or @expr{-(a/b)} where either @expr{a} or @expr{b} is
22423 negative-looking, simplified by negating that term, or else where
22424 @expr{a} or @expr{b} is any number, by negating that number;
22425 @expr{-(a + b)} to @expr{-a - b}, and @expr{-(b - a)} to @expr{a - b}.
22426 (This, and rewriting @expr{(-b) + a} to @expr{a - b}, are the only
22427 cases where the order of terms in a sum is changed by the default
22428 simplifications.)
22429
22430 The distributive law is used to simplify sums in some cases:
22431 @expr{a x + b x} to @expr{(a + b) x}, where @expr{a} represents
22432 a number or an implicit 1 or @mathit{-1} (as in @expr{x} or @expr{-x})
22433 and similarly for @expr{b}. Use the @kbd{a c}, @w{@kbd{a f}}, or
22434 @kbd{j M} commands to merge sums with non-numeric coefficients
22435 using the distributive law.
22436
22437 The distributive law is only used for sums of two terms, or
22438 for adjacent terms in a larger sum. Thus @expr{a + b + b + c}
22439 is simplified to @expr{a + 2 b + c}, but @expr{a + b + c + b}
22440 is not simplified. The reason is that comparing all terms of a
22441 sum with one another would require time proportional to the
22442 square of the number of terms; Calc relegates potentially slow
22443 operations like this to commands that have to be invoked
22444 explicitly, like @kbd{a s}.
22445
22446 Finally, @expr{a + 0} and @expr{0 + a} are simplified to @expr{a}.
22447 A consequence of the above rules is that @expr{0 - a} is simplified
22448 to @expr{-a}.
22449
22450 @tex
22451 \bigskip
22452 @end tex
22453
22454 The products @expr{1 a} and @expr{a 1} are simplified to @expr{a};
22455 @expr{(-1) a} and @expr{a (-1)} are simplified to @expr{-a};
22456 @expr{0 a} and @expr{a 0} are simplified to @expr{0}, except that
22457 in Matrix mode where @expr{a} is not provably scalar the result
22458 is the generic zero matrix @samp{idn(0)}, and that if @expr{a} is
22459 infinite the result is @samp{nan}.
22460
22461 Also, @expr{(-a) b} and @expr{a (-b)} are simplified to @expr{-(a b)},
22462 where this occurs for negated formulas but not for regular negative
22463 numbers.
22464
22465 Products are commuted only to move numbers to the front:
22466 @expr{a b 2} is commuted to @expr{2 a b}.
22467
22468 The product @expr{a (b + c)} is distributed over the sum only if
22469 @expr{a} and at least one of @expr{b} and @expr{c} are numbers:
22470 @expr{2 (x + 3)} goes to @expr{2 x + 6}. The formula
22471 @expr{(-a) (b - c)}, where @expr{-a} is a negative number, is
22472 rewritten to @expr{a (c - b)}.
22473
22474 The distributive law of products and powers is used for adjacent
22475 terms of the product: @expr{x^a x^b} goes to
22476 @texline @math{x^{a+b}}
22477 @infoline @expr{x^(a+b)}
22478 where @expr{a} is a number, or an implicit 1 (as in @expr{x}),
22479 or the implicit one-half of @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)}, and similarly for
22480 @expr{b}. The result is written using @samp{sqrt} or @samp{1/sqrt}
22481 if the sum of the powers is @expr{1/2} or @expr{-1/2}, respectively.
22482 If the sum of the powers is zero, the product is simplified to
22483 @expr{1} or to @samp{idn(1)} if Matrix mode is enabled.
22484
22485 The product of a negative power times anything but another negative
22486 power is changed to use division:
22487 @texline @math{x^{-2} y}
22488 @infoline @expr{x^(-2) y}
22489 goes to @expr{y / x^2} unless Matrix mode is
22490 in effect and neither @expr{x} nor @expr{y} are scalar (in which
22491 case it is considered unsafe to rearrange the order of the terms).
22492
22493 Finally, @expr{a (b/c)} is rewritten to @expr{(a b)/c}, and also
22494 @expr{(a/b) c} is changed to @expr{(a c)/b} unless in Matrix mode.
22495
22496 @tex
22497 \bigskip
22498 @end tex
22499
22500 Simplifications for quotients are analogous to those for products.
22501 The quotient @expr{0 / x} is simplified to @expr{0}, with the same
22502 exceptions that were noted for @expr{0 x}. Likewise, @expr{x / 1}
22503 and @expr{x / (-1)} are simplified to @expr{x} and @expr{-x},
22504 respectively.
22505
22506 The quotient @expr{x / 0} is left unsimplified or changed to an
22507 infinite quantity, as directed by the current infinite mode.
22508 @xref{Infinite Mode}.
22509
22510 The expression
22511 @texline @math{a / b^{-c}}
22512 @infoline @expr{a / b^(-c)}
22513 is changed to @expr{a b^c}, where @expr{-c} is any negative-looking
22514 power. Also, @expr{1 / b^c} is changed to
22515 @texline @math{b^{-c}}
22516 @infoline @expr{b^(-c)}
22517 for any power @expr{c}.
22518
22519 Also, @expr{(-a) / b} and @expr{a / (-b)} go to @expr{-(a/b)};
22520 @expr{(a/b) / c} goes to @expr{a / (b c)}; and @expr{a / (b/c)}
22521 goes to @expr{(a c) / b} unless Matrix mode prevents this
22522 rearrangement. Similarly, @expr{a / (b:c)} is simplified to
22523 @expr{(c:b) a} for any fraction @expr{b:c}.
22524
22525 The distributive law is applied to @expr{(a + b) / c} only if
22526 @expr{c} and at least one of @expr{a} and @expr{b} are numbers.
22527 Quotients of powers and square roots are distributed just as
22528 described for multiplication.
22529
22530 Quotients of products cancel only in the leading terms of the
22531 numerator and denominator. In other words, @expr{a x b / a y b}
22532 is cancelled to @expr{x b / y b} but not to @expr{x / y}. Once
22533 again this is because full cancellation can be slow; use @kbd{a s}
22534 to cancel all terms of the quotient.
22535
22536 Quotients of negative-looking values are simplified according
22537 to @expr{(-a) / (-b)} to @expr{a / b}, @expr{(-a) / (b - c)}
22538 to @expr{a / (c - b)}, and @expr{(a - b) / (-c)} to @expr{(b - a) / c}.
22539
22540 @tex
22541 \bigskip
22542 @end tex
22543
22544 The formula @expr{x^0} is simplified to @expr{1}, or to @samp{idn(1)}
22545 in Matrix mode. The formula @expr{0^x} is simplified to @expr{0}
22546 unless @expr{x} is a negative number, complex number or zero.
22547 If @expr{x} is negative, complex or @expr{0.0}, @expr{0^x} is an
22548 infinity or an unsimplified formula according to the current infinite
22549 mode. The expression @expr{0^0} is simplified to @expr{1}.
22550
22551 Powers of products or quotients @expr{(a b)^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c}
22552 are distributed to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{a^c / b^c} only if @expr{c}
22553 is an integer, or if either @expr{a} or @expr{b} are nonnegative
22554 real numbers. Powers of powers @expr{(a^b)^c} are simplified to
22555 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
22556 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22557 only when @expr{c} is an integer and @expr{b c} also
22558 evaluates to an integer. Without these restrictions these simplifications
22559 would not be safe because of problems with principal values.
22560 (In other words,
22561 @texline @math{((-3)^{1/2})^2}
22562 @infoline @expr{((-3)^1:2)^2}
22563 is safe to simplify, but
22564 @texline @math{((-3)^2)^{1/2}}
22565 @infoline @expr{((-3)^2)^1:2}
22566 is not.) @xref{Declarations}, for ways to inform Calc that your
22567 variables satisfy these requirements.
22568
22569 As a special case of this rule, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^n} is simplified to
22570 @texline @math{x^{n/2}}
22571 @infoline @expr{x^(n/2)}
22572 only for even integers @expr{n}.
22573
22574 If @expr{a} is known to be real, @expr{b} is an even integer, and
22575 @expr{c} is a half- or quarter-integer, then @expr{(a^b)^c} is
22576 simplified to @expr{@tfn{abs}(a^(b c))}.
22577
22578 Also, @expr{(-a)^b} is simplified to @expr{a^b} if @expr{b} is an
22579 even integer, or to @expr{-(a^b)} if @expr{b} is an odd integer,
22580 for any negative-looking expression @expr{-a}.
22581
22582 Square roots @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)} generally act like one-half powers
22583 @texline @math{x^{1:2}}
22584 @infoline @expr{x^1:2}
22585 for the purposes of the above-listed simplifications.
22586
22587 Also, note that
22588 @texline @math{1 / x^{1:2}}
22589 @infoline @expr{1 / x^1:2}
22590 is changed to
22591 @texline @math{x^{-1:2}},
22592 @infoline @expr{x^(-1:2)},
22593 but @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(x)} is left alone.
22594
22595 @tex
22596 \bigskip
22597 @end tex
22598
22599 Generic identity matrices (@pxref{Matrix Mode}) are simplified by the
22600 following rules: @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + b} to @expr{a + b} if @expr{b}
22601 is provably scalar, or expanded out if @expr{b} is a matrix;
22602 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + @tfn{idn}(b)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a + b)};
22603 @expr{-@tfn{idn}(a)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(-a)}; @expr{a @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22604 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)} if @expr{a} is provably scalar, or to @expr{a b}
22605 if @expr{a} is provably non-scalar; @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22606 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)}; analogous simplifications for quotients involving
22607 @code{idn}; and @expr{@tfn{idn}(a)^n} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a^n)} where
22608 @expr{n} is an integer.
22609
22610 @tex
22611 \bigskip
22612 @end tex
22613
22614 The @code{floor} function and other integer truncation functions
22615 vanish if the argument is provably integer-valued, so that
22616 @expr{@tfn{floor}(@tfn{round}(x))} simplifies to @expr{@tfn{round}(x)}.
22617 Also, combinations of @code{float}, @code{floor} and its friends,
22618 and @code{ffloor} and its friends, are simplified in appropriate
22619 ways. @xref{Integer Truncation}.
22620
22621 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(-x)} changes to @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}.
22622 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(@tfn{abs}(x))} changes to
22623 @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}; in fact, @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)} changes to @expr{x} or
22624 @expr{-x} if @expr{x} is provably nonnegative or nonpositive
22625 (@pxref{Declarations}).
22626
22627 While most functions do not recognize the variable @code{i} as an
22628 imaginary number, the @code{arg} function does handle the two cases
22629 @expr{@tfn{arg}(@tfn{i})} and @expr{@tfn{arg}(-@tfn{i})} just for convenience.
22630
22631 The expression @expr{@tfn{conj}(@tfn{conj}(x))} simplifies to @expr{x}.
22632 Various other expressions involving @code{conj}, @code{re}, and
22633 @code{im} are simplified, especially if some of the arguments are
22634 provably real or involve the constant @code{i}. For example,
22635 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a + b i)} is changed to
22636 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a) - @tfn{conj}(b) i}, or to @expr{a - b i} if @expr{a}
22637 and @expr{b} are known to be real.
22638
22639 Functions like @code{sin} and @code{arctan} generally don't have
22640 any default simplifications beyond simply evaluating the functions
22641 for suitable numeric arguments and infinity. The @kbd{a s} command
22642 described in the next section does provide some simplifications for
22643 these functions, though.
22644
22645 One important simplification that does occur is that
22646 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e})} is simplified to 1, and @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)} is
22647 simplified to @expr{x} for any @expr{x}. This occurs even if you have
22648 stored a different value in the Calc variable @samp{e}; but this would
22649 be a bad idea in any case if you were also using natural logarithms!
22650
22651 Among the logical functions, @tfn{!(@var{a} <= @var{b})} changes to
22652 @tfn{@var{a} > @var{b}} and so on. Equations and inequalities where both sides
22653 are either negative-looking or zero are simplified by negating both sides
22654 and reversing the inequality. While it might seem reasonable to simplify
22655 @expr{!!x} to @expr{x}, this would not be valid in general because
22656 @expr{!!2} is 1, not 2.
22657
22658 Most other Calc functions have few if any default simplifications
22659 defined, aside of course from evaluation when the arguments are
22660 suitable numbers.
22661
22662 @node Algebraic Simplifications, Unsafe Simplifications, Default Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22663 @subsection Algebraic Simplifications
22664
22665 @noindent
22666 @cindex Algebraic simplifications
22667 The @kbd{a s} command makes simplifications that may be too slow to
22668 do all the time, or that may not be desirable all of the time.
22669 If you find these simplifications are worthwhile, you can type
22670 @kbd{m A} to have Calc apply them automatically.
22671
22672 This section describes all simplifications that are performed by
22673 the @kbd{a s} command. Note that these occur in addition to the
22674 default simplifications; even if the default simplifications have
22675 been turned off by an @kbd{m O} command, @kbd{a s} will turn them
22676 back on temporarily while it simplifies the formula.
22677
22678 There is a variable, @code{AlgSimpRules}, in which you can put rewrites
22679 to be applied by @kbd{a s}. Its use is analogous to @code{EvalRules},
22680 but without the special restrictions. Basically, the simplifier does
22681 @samp{@w{a r} AlgSimpRules} with an infinite repeat count on the whole
22682 expression being simplified, then it traverses the expression applying
22683 the built-in rules described below. If the result is different from
22684 the original expression, the process repeats with the default
22685 simplifications (including @code{EvalRules}), then @code{AlgSimpRules},
22686 then the built-in simplifications, and so on.
22687
22688 @tex
22689 \bigskip
22690 @end tex
22691
22692 Sums are simplified in two ways. Constant terms are commuted to the
22693 end of the sum, so that @expr{a + 2 + b} changes to @expr{a + b + 2}.
22694 The only exception is that a constant will not be commuted away
22695 from the first position of a difference, i.e., @expr{2 - x} is not
22696 commuted to @expr{-x + 2}.
22697
22698 Also, terms of sums are combined by the distributive law, as in
22699 @expr{x + y + 2 x} to @expr{y + 3 x}. This always occurs for
22700 adjacent terms, but @kbd{a s} compares all pairs of terms including
22701 non-adjacent ones.
22702
22703 @tex
22704 \bigskip
22705 @end tex
22706
22707 Products are sorted into a canonical order using the commutative
22708 law. For example, @expr{b c a} is commuted to @expr{a b c}.
22709 This allows easier comparison of products; for example, the default
22710 simplifications will not change @expr{x y + y x} to @expr{2 x y},
22711 but @kbd{a s} will; it first rewrites the sum to @expr{x y + x y},
22712 and then the default simplifications are able to recognize a sum
22713 of identical terms.
22714
22715 The canonical ordering used to sort terms of products has the
22716 property that real-valued numbers, interval forms and infinities
22717 come first, and are sorted into increasing order. The @kbd{V S}
22718 command uses the same ordering when sorting a vector.
22719
22720 Sorting of terms of products is inhibited when Matrix mode is
22721 turned on; in this case, Calc will never exchange the order of
22722 two terms unless it knows at least one of the terms is a scalar.
22723
22724 Products of powers are distributed by comparing all pairs of
22725 terms, using the same method that the default simplifications
22726 use for adjacent terms of products.
22727
22728 Even though sums are not sorted, the commutative law is still
22729 taken into account when terms of a product are being compared.
22730 Thus @expr{(x + y) (y + x)} will be simplified to @expr{(x + y)^2}.
22731 A subtle point is that @expr{(x - y) (y - x)} will @emph{not}
22732 be simplified to @expr{-(x - y)^2}; Calc does not notice that
22733 one term can be written as a constant times the other, even if
22734 that constant is @mathit{-1}.
22735
22736 A fraction times any expression, @expr{(a:b) x}, is changed to
22737 a quotient involving integers: @expr{a x / b}. This is not
22738 done for floating-point numbers like @expr{0.5}, however. This
22739 is one reason why you may find it convenient to turn Fraction mode
22740 on while doing algebra; @pxref{Fraction Mode}.
22741
22742 @tex
22743 \bigskip
22744 @end tex
22745
22746 Quotients are simplified by comparing all terms in the numerator
22747 with all terms in the denominator for possible cancellation using
22748 the distributive law. For example, @expr{a x^2 b / c x^3 d} will
22749 cancel @expr{x^2} from the top and bottom to get @expr{a b / c x d}.
22750 (The terms in the denominator will then be rearranged to @expr{c d x}
22751 as described above.) If there is any common integer or fractional
22752 factor in the numerator and denominator, it is cancelled out;
22753 for example, @expr{(4 x + 6) / 8 x} simplifies to @expr{(2 x + 3) / 4 x}.
22754
22755 Non-constant common factors are not found even by @kbd{a s}. To
22756 cancel the factor @expr{a} in @expr{(a x + a) / a^2} you could first
22757 use @kbd{j M} on the product @expr{a x} to Merge the numerator to
22758 @expr{a (1+x)}, which can then be simplified successfully.
22759
22760 @tex
22761 \bigskip
22762 @end tex
22763
22764 Integer powers of the variable @code{i} are simplified according
22765 to the identity @expr{i^2 = -1}. If you store a new value other
22766 than the complex number @expr{(0,1)} in @code{i}, this simplification
22767 will no longer occur. This is done by @kbd{a s} instead of by default
22768 in case someone (unwisely) uses the name @code{i} for a variable
22769 unrelated to complex numbers; it would be unfortunate if Calc
22770 quietly and automatically changed this formula for reasons the
22771 user might not have been thinking of.
22772
22773 Square roots of integer or rational arguments are simplified in
22774 several ways. (Note that these will be left unevaluated only in
22775 Symbolic mode.) First, square integer or rational factors are
22776 pulled out so that @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(8)} is rewritten as
22777 @texline @math{2\,@tfn{sqrt}(2)}.
22778 @infoline @expr{2 sqrt(2)}.
22779 Conceptually speaking this implies factoring the argument into primes
22780 and moving pairs of primes out of the square root, but for reasons of
22781 efficiency Calc only looks for primes up to 29.
22782
22783 Square roots in the denominator of a quotient are moved to the
22784 numerator: @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(3) / 3}.
22785 The same effect occurs for the square root of a fraction:
22786 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2:3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(6) / 3}.
22787
22788 @tex
22789 \bigskip
22790 @end tex
22791
22792 The @code{%} (modulo) operator is simplified in several ways
22793 when the modulus @expr{M} is a positive real number. First, if
22794 the argument is of the form @expr{x + n} for some real number
22795 @expr{n}, then @expr{n} is itself reduced modulo @expr{M}. For
22796 example, @samp{(x - 23) % 10} is simplified to @samp{(x + 7) % 10}.
22797
22798 If the argument is multiplied by a constant, and this constant
22799 has a common integer divisor with the modulus, then this factor is
22800 cancelled out. For example, @samp{12 x % 15} is changed to
22801 @samp{3 (4 x % 5)} by factoring out 3. Also, @samp{(12 x + 1) % 15}
22802 is changed to @samp{3 ((4 x + 1:3) % 5)}. While these forms may
22803 not seem ``simpler,'' they allow Calc to discover useful information
22804 about modulo forms in the presence of declarations.
22805
22806 If the modulus is 1, then Calc can use @code{int} declarations to
22807 evaluate the expression. For example, the idiom @samp{x % 2} is
22808 often used to check whether a number is odd or even. As described
22809 above, @w{@samp{2 n % 2}} and @samp{(2 n + 1) % 2} are simplified to
22810 @samp{2 (n % 1)} and @samp{2 ((n + 1:2) % 1)}, respectively; Calc
22811 can simplify these to 0 and 1 (respectively) if @code{n} has been
22812 declared to be an integer.
22813
22814 @tex
22815 \bigskip
22816 @end tex
22817
22818 Trigonometric functions are simplified in several ways. Whenever a
22819 products of two trigonometric functions can be replaced by a single
22820 function, the replacement is made; for example,
22821 @expr{@tfn{tan}(x) @tfn{cos}(x)} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{sin}(x)}.
22822 Reciprocals of trigonometric functions are replaced by their reciprocal
22823 function; for example, @expr{1/@tfn{sec}(x)} is simplified to
22824 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. The corresponding simplifications for the
22825 hyperbolic functions are also handled.
22826
22827 Trigonometric functions of their inverse functions are
22828 simplified. The expression @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arcsin}(x))} is
22829 simplified to @expr{x}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22830 Trigonometric functions of inverses of different trigonometric
22831 functions can also be simplified, as in @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arccos}(x))}
22832 to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - x^2)}.
22833
22834 If the argument to @code{sin} is negative-looking, it is simplified to
22835 @expr{-@tfn{sin}(x)}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22836 Finally, certain special values of the argument are recognized;
22837 @pxref{Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions}.
22838
22839 Hyperbolic functions of their inverses and of negative-looking
22840 arguments are also handled, as are exponentials of inverse
22841 hyperbolic functions.
22842
22843 No simplifications for inverse trigonometric and hyperbolic
22844 functions are known, except for negative arguments of @code{arcsin},
22845 @code{arctan}, @code{arcsinh}, and @code{arctanh}. Note that
22846 @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} can @emph{not} safely change to
22847 @expr{x}, since this only correct within an integer multiple of
22848 @texline @math{2 \pi}
22849 @infoline @expr{2 pi}
22850 radians or 360 degrees. However, @expr{@tfn{arcsinh}(@tfn{sinh}(x))} is
22851 simplified to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22852
22853 Several simplifications that apply to logarithms and exponentials
22854 are that @expr{@tfn{exp}(@tfn{ln}(x))},
22855 @texline @tfn{e}@math{^{\ln(x)}},
22856 @infoline @expr{e^@tfn{ln}(x)},
22857 and
22858 @texline @math{10^{{\rm log10}(x)}}
22859 @infoline @expr{10^@tfn{log10}(x)}
22860 all reduce to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))}, etc., can
22861 reduce to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is provably real. The form
22862 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)^y} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{exp}(x y)}. If @expr{x}
22863 is a suitable multiple of
22864 @texline @math{\pi i}
22865 @infoline @expr{pi i}
22866 (as described above for the trigonometric functions), then
22867 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)} or @expr{e^x} will be expanded. Finally,
22868 @expr{@tfn{ln}(x)} is simplified to a form involving @code{pi} and
22869 @code{i} where @expr{x} is provably negative, positive imaginary, or
22870 negative imaginary.
22871
22872 The error functions @code{erf} and @code{erfc} are simplified when
22873 their arguments are negative-looking or are calls to the @code{conj}
22874 function.
22875
22876 @tex
22877 \bigskip
22878 @end tex
22879
22880 Equations and inequalities are simplified by cancelling factors
22881 of products, quotients, or sums on both sides. Inequalities
22882 change sign if a negative multiplicative factor is cancelled.
22883 Non-constant multiplicative factors as in @expr{a b = a c} are
22884 cancelled from equations only if they are provably nonzero (generally
22885 because they were declared so; @pxref{Declarations}). Factors
22886 are cancelled from inequalities only if they are nonzero and their
22887 sign is known.
22888
22889 Simplification also replaces an equation or inequality with
22890 1 or 0 (``true'' or ``false'') if it can through the use of
22891 declarations. If @expr{x} is declared to be an integer greater
22892 than 5, then @expr{x < 3}, @expr{x = 3}, and @expr{x = 7.5} are
22893 all simplified to 0, but @expr{x > 3} is simplified to 1.
22894 By a similar analysis, @expr{abs(x) >= 0} is simplified to 1,
22895 as is @expr{x^2 >= 0} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22896
22897 @node Unsafe Simplifications, Simplification of Units, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22898 @subsection ``Unsafe'' Simplifications
22899
22900 @noindent
22901 @cindex Unsafe simplifications
22902 @cindex Extended simplification
22903 @kindex a e
22904 @pindex calc-simplify-extended
22905 @ignore
22906 @mindex esimpl@idots
22907 @end ignore
22908 @tindex esimplify
22909 The @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) [@code{esimplify}] command
22910 is like @kbd{a s}
22911 except that it applies some additional simplifications which are not
22912 ``safe'' in all cases. Use this only if you know the values in your
22913 formula lie in the restricted ranges for which these simplifications
22914 are valid. The symbolic integrator uses @kbd{a e};
22915 one effect of this is that the integrator's results must be used with
22916 caution. Where an integral table will often attach conditions like
22917 ``for positive @expr{a} only,'' Calc (like most other symbolic
22918 integration programs) will simply produce an unqualified result.
22919
22920 Because @kbd{a e}'s simplifications are unsafe, it is sometimes better
22921 to type @kbd{C-u -3 a v}, which does extended simplification only
22922 on the top level of the formula without affecting the sub-formulas.
22923 In fact, @kbd{C-u -3 j v} allows you to target extended simplification
22924 to any specific part of a formula.
22925
22926 The variable @code{ExtSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
22927 the @kbd{a e} command. These are applied in addition to
22928 @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. (The @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
22929 step described above is simply followed by an @kbd{a r ExtSimpRules} step.)
22930
22931 Following is a complete list of ``unsafe'' simplifications performed
22932 by @kbd{a e}.
22933
22934 @tex
22935 \bigskip
22936 @end tex
22937
22938 Inverse trigonometric or hyperbolic functions, called with their
22939 corresponding non-inverse functions as arguments, are simplified
22940 by @kbd{a e}. For example, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} changes
22941 to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{cos}(x))} and
22942 @expr{@tfn{arccos}(@tfn{sin}(x))} both change to @expr{@tfn{pi}/2 - x}.
22943 These simplifications are unsafe because they are valid only for
22944 values of @expr{x} in a certain range; outside that range, values
22945 are folded down to the 360-degree range that the inverse trigonometric
22946 functions always produce.
22947
22948 Powers of powers @expr{(x^a)^b} are simplified to
22949 @texline @math{x^{a b}}
22950 @infoline @expr{x^(a b)}
22951 for all @expr{a} and @expr{b}. These results will be valid only
22952 in a restricted range of @expr{x}; for example, in
22953 @texline @math{(x^2)^{1:2}}
22954 @infoline @expr{(x^2)^1:2}
22955 the powers cancel to get @expr{x}, which is valid for positive values
22956 of @expr{x} but not for negative or complex values.
22957
22958 Similarly, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x^a)} and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^a} are both
22959 simplified (possibly unsafely) to
22960 @texline @math{x^{a/2}}.
22961 @infoline @expr{x^(a/2)}.
22962
22963 Forms like @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - sin(x)^2)} are simplified to, e.g.,
22964 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. Calc has identities of this sort for @code{sin},
22965 @code{cos}, @code{tan}, @code{sinh}, and @code{cosh}.
22966
22967 Arguments of square roots are partially factored to look for
22968 squared terms that can be extracted. For example,
22969 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(a^2 b^3 + a^3 b^2)} simplifies to
22970 @expr{a b @tfn{sqrt}(a+b)}.
22971
22972 The simplifications of @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))},
22973 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)}, and @expr{@tfn{log10}(10^x)} to @expr{x} are also
22974 unsafe because of problems with principal values (although these
22975 simplifications are safe if @expr{x} is known to be real).
22976
22977 Common factors are cancelled from products on both sides of an
22978 equation, even if those factors may be zero: @expr{a x / b x}
22979 to @expr{a / b}. Such factors are never cancelled from
22980 inequalities: Even @kbd{a e} is not bold enough to reduce
22981 @expr{a x < b x} to @expr{a < b} (or @expr{a > b}, depending
22982 on whether you believe @expr{x} is positive or negative).
22983 The @kbd{a M /} command can be used to divide a factor out of
22984 both sides of an inequality.
22985
22986 @node Simplification of Units, , Unsafe Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22987 @subsection Simplification of Units
22988
22989 @noindent
22990 The simplifications described in this section are applied by the
22991 @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command. These are in addition
22992 to the regular @kbd{a s} (but not @kbd{a e}) simplifications described
22993 earlier. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
22994
22995 The variable @code{UnitSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
22996 the @kbd{u s} command. These are applied in addition to @code{EvalRules}
22997 and @code{AlgSimpRules}.
22998
22999 Scalar mode is automatically put into effect when simplifying units.
23000 @xref{Matrix Mode}.
23001
23002 Sums @expr{a + b} involving units are simplified by extracting the
23003 units of @expr{a} as if by the @kbd{u x} command (call the result
23004 @expr{u_a}), then simplifying the expression @expr{b / u_a}
23005 using @kbd{u b} and @kbd{u s}. If the result has units then the sum
23006 is inconsistent and is left alone. Otherwise, it is rewritten
23007 in terms of the units @expr{u_a}.
23008
23009 If units auto-ranging mode is enabled, products or quotients in
23010 which the first argument is a number which is out of range for the
23011 leading unit are modified accordingly.
23012
23013 When cancelling and combining units in products and quotients,
23014 Calc accounts for unit names that differ only in the prefix letter.
23015 For example, @samp{2 km m} is simplified to @samp{2000 m^2}.
23016 However, compatible but different units like @code{ft} and @code{in}
23017 are not combined in this way.
23018
23019 Quotients @expr{a / b} are simplified in three additional ways. First,
23020 if @expr{b} is a number or a product beginning with a number, Calc
23021 computes the reciprocal of this number and moves it to the numerator.
23022
23023 Second, for each pair of unit names from the numerator and denominator
23024 of a quotient, if the units are compatible (e.g., they are both
23025 units of area) then they are replaced by the ratio between those
23026 units. For example, in @samp{3 s in N / kg cm} the units
23027 @samp{in / cm} will be replaced by @expr{2.54}.
23028
23029 Third, if the units in the quotient exactly cancel out, so that
23030 a @kbd{u b} command on the quotient would produce a dimensionless
23031 number for an answer, then the quotient simplifies to that number.
23032
23033 For powers and square roots, the ``unsafe'' simplifications
23034 @expr{(a b)^c} to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c} to @expr{a^c / b^c},
23035 and @expr{(a^b)^c} to
23036 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
23037 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
23038 are done if the powers are real numbers. (These are safe in the context
23039 of units because all numbers involved can reasonably be assumed to be
23040 real.)
23041
23042 Also, if a unit name is raised to a fractional power, and the
23043 base units in that unit name all occur to powers which are a
23044 multiple of the denominator of the power, then the unit name
23045 is expanded out into its base units, which can then be simplified
23046 according to the previous paragraph. For example, @samp{acre^1.5}
23047 is simplified by noting that @expr{1.5 = 3:2}, that @samp{acre}
23048 is defined in terms of @samp{m^2}, and that the 2 in the power of
23049 @code{m} is a multiple of 2 in @expr{3:2}. Thus, @code{acre^1.5} is
23050 replaced by approximately
23051 @texline @math{(4046 m^2)^{1.5}}
23052 @infoline @expr{(4046 m^2)^1.5},
23053 which is then changed to
23054 @texline @math{4046^{1.5} \, (m^2)^{1.5}},
23055 @infoline @expr{4046^1.5 (m^2)^1.5},
23056 then to @expr{257440 m^3}.
23057
23058 The functions @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{clean}, @code{abs},
23059 as well as @code{floor} and the other integer truncation functions,
23060 applied to unit names or products or quotients involving units, are
23061 simplified. For example, @samp{round(1.6 in)} is changed to
23062 @samp{round(1.6) round(in)}; the lefthand term evaluates to 2,
23063 and the righthand term simplifies to @code{in}.
23064
23065 The functions @code{sin}, @code{cos}, and @code{tan} with arguments
23066 that have angular units like @code{rad} or @code{arcmin} are
23067 simplified by converting to base units (radians), then evaluating
23068 with the angular mode temporarily set to radians.
23069
23070 @node Polynomials, Calculus, Simplifying Formulas, Algebra
23071 @section Polynomials
23072
23073 A @dfn{polynomial} is a sum of terms which are coefficients times
23074 various powers of a ``base'' variable. For example, @expr{2 x^2 + 3 x - 4}
23075 is a polynomial in @expr{x}. Some formulas can be considered
23076 polynomials in several different variables: @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2}
23077 is a polynomial in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}. Polynomial coefficients
23078 are often numbers, but they may in general be any formulas not
23079 involving the base variable.
23080
23081 @kindex a f
23082 @pindex calc-factor
23083 @tindex factor
23084 The @kbd{a f} (@code{calc-factor}) [@code{factor}] command factors a
23085 polynomial into a product of terms. For example, the polynomial
23086 @expr{x^3 + 2 x^2 + x} is factored into @samp{x*(x+1)^2}. As another
23087 example, @expr{a c + b d + b c + a d} is factored into the product
23088 @expr{(a + b) (c + d)}.
23089
23090 Calc currently has three algorithms for factoring. Formulas which are
23091 linear in several variables, such as the second example above, are
23092 merged according to the distributive law. Formulas which are
23093 polynomials in a single variable, with constant integer or fractional
23094 coefficients, are factored into irreducible linear and/or quadratic
23095 terms. The first example above factors into three linear terms
23096 (@expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, and @expr{x+1} again). Finally, formulas
23097 which do not fit the above criteria are handled by the algebraic
23098 rewrite mechanism.
23099
23100 Calc's polynomial factorization algorithm works by using the general
23101 root-finding command (@w{@kbd{a P}}) to solve for the roots of the
23102 polynomial. It then looks for roots which are rational numbers
23103 or complex-conjugate pairs, and converts these into linear and
23104 quadratic terms, respectively. Because it uses floating-point
23105 arithmetic, it may be unable to find terms that involve large
23106 integers (whose number of digits approaches the current precision).
23107 Also, irreducible factors of degree higher than quadratic are not
23108 found, and polynomials in more than one variable are not treated.
23109 (A more robust factorization algorithm may be included in a future
23110 version of Calc.)
23111
23112 @vindex FactorRules
23113 @ignore
23114 @starindex
23115 @end ignore
23116 @tindex thecoefs
23117 @ignore
23118 @starindex
23119 @end ignore
23120 @ignore
23121 @mindex @idots
23122 @end ignore
23123 @tindex thefactors
23124 The rewrite-based factorization method uses rules stored in the variable
23125 @code{FactorRules}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of the
23126 operation of rewrite rules. The default @code{FactorRules} are able
23127 to factor quadratic forms symbolically into two linear terms,
23128 @expr{(a x + b) (c x + d)}. You can edit these rules to include other
23129 cases if you wish. To use the rules, Calc builds the formula
23130 @samp{thecoefs(x, [a, b, c, ...])} where @code{x} is the polynomial
23131 base variable and @code{a}, @code{b}, etc., are polynomial coefficients
23132 (which may be numbers or formulas). The constant term is written first,
23133 i.e., in the @code{a} position. When the rules complete, they should have
23134 changed the formula into the form @samp{thefactors(x, [f1, f2, f3, ...])}
23135 where each @code{fi} should be a factored term, e.g., @samp{x - ai}.
23136 Calc then multiplies these terms together to get the complete
23137 factored form of the polynomial. If the rules do not change the
23138 @code{thecoefs} call to a @code{thefactors} call, @kbd{a f} leaves the
23139 polynomial alone on the assumption that it is unfactorable. (Note that
23140 the function names @code{thecoefs} and @code{thefactors} are used only
23141 as placeholders; there are no actual Calc functions by those names.)
23142
23143 @kindex H a f
23144 @tindex factors
23145 The @kbd{H a f} [@code{factors}] command also factors a polynomial,
23146 but it returns a list of factors instead of an expression which is the
23147 product of the factors. Each factor is represented by a sub-vector
23148 of the factor, and the power with which it appears. For example,
23149 @expr{x^5 + x^4 - 33 x^3 + 63 x^2} factors to @expr{(x + 7) x^2 (x - 3)^2}
23150 in @kbd{a f}, or to @expr{[ [x, 2], [x+7, 1], [x-3, 2] ]} in @kbd{H a f}.
23151 If there is an overall numeric factor, it always comes first in the list.
23152 The functions @code{factor} and @code{factors} allow a second argument
23153 when written in algebraic form; @samp{factor(x,v)} factors @expr{x} with
23154 respect to the specific variable @expr{v}. The default is to factor with
23155 respect to all the variables that appear in @expr{x}.
23156
23157 @kindex a c
23158 @pindex calc-collect
23159 @tindex collect
23160 The @kbd{a c} (@code{calc-collect}) [@code{collect}] command rearranges a
23161 formula as a
23162 polynomial in a given variable, ordered in decreasing powers of that
23163 variable. For example, given @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2} on
23164 the stack, @kbd{a c x} would produce @expr{(2 + 4 y^2) x + (1 + 3 y)},
23165 and @kbd{a c y} would produce @expr{(4 x) y^2 + 3 y + (1 + 2 x)}.
23166 The polynomial will be expanded out using the distributive law as
23167 necessary: Collecting @expr{x} in @expr{(x - 1)^3} produces
23168 @expr{x^3 - 3 x^2 + 3 x - 1}. Terms not involving @expr{x} will
23169 not be expanded.
23170
23171 The ``variable'' you specify at the prompt can actually be any
23172 expression: @kbd{a c ln(x+1)} will collect together all terms multiplied
23173 by @samp{ln(x+1)} or integer powers thereof. If @samp{x} also appears
23174 in the formula in a context other than @samp{ln(x+1)}, @kbd{a c} will
23175 treat those occurrences as unrelated to @samp{ln(x+1)}, i.e., as constants.
23176
23177 @kindex a x
23178 @pindex calc-expand
23179 @tindex expand
23180 The @kbd{a x} (@code{calc-expand}) [@code{expand}] command expands an
23181 expression by applying the distributive law everywhere. It applies to
23182 products, quotients, and powers involving sums. By default, it fully
23183 distributes all parts of the expression. With a numeric prefix argument,
23184 the distributive law is applied only the specified number of times, then
23185 the partially expanded expression is left on the stack.
23186
23187 The @kbd{a x} and @kbd{j D} commands are somewhat redundant. Use
23188 @kbd{a x} if you want to expand all products of sums in your formula.
23189 Use @kbd{j D} if you want to expand a particular specified term of
23190 the formula. There is an exactly analogous correspondence between
23191 @kbd{a f} and @kbd{j M}. (The @kbd{j D} and @kbd{j M} commands
23192 also know many other kinds of expansions, such as
23193 @samp{exp(a + b) = exp(a) exp(b)}, which @kbd{a x} and @kbd{a f}
23194 do not do.)
23195
23196 Calc's automatic simplifications will sometimes reverse a partial
23197 expansion. For example, the first step in expanding @expr{(x+1)^3} is
23198 to write @expr{(x+1) (x+1)^2}. If @kbd{a x} stops there and tries
23199 to put this formula onto the stack, though, Calc will automatically
23200 simplify it back to @expr{(x+1)^3} form. The solution is to turn
23201 simplification off first (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), or to run
23202 @kbd{a x} without a numeric prefix argument so that it expands all
23203 the way in one step.
23204
23205 @kindex a a
23206 @pindex calc-apart
23207 @tindex apart
23208 The @kbd{a a} (@code{calc-apart}) [@code{apart}] command expands a
23209 rational function by partial fractions. A rational function is the
23210 quotient of two polynomials; @code{apart} pulls this apart into a
23211 sum of rational functions with simple denominators. In algebraic
23212 notation, the @code{apart} function allows a second argument that
23213 specifies which variable to use as the ``base''; by default, Calc
23214 chooses the base variable automatically.
23215
23216 @kindex a n
23217 @pindex calc-normalize-rat
23218 @tindex nrat
23219 The @kbd{a n} (@code{calc-normalize-rat}) [@code{nrat}] command
23220 attempts to arrange a formula into a quotient of two polynomials.
23221 For example, given @expr{1 + (a + b/c) / d}, the result would be
23222 @expr{(b + a c + c d) / c d}. The quotient is reduced, so that
23223 @kbd{a n} will simplify @expr{(x^2 + 2x + 1) / (x^2 - 1)} by dividing
23224 out the common factor @expr{x + 1}, yielding @expr{(x + 1) / (x - 1)}.
23225
23226 @kindex a \
23227 @pindex calc-poly-div
23228 @tindex pdiv
23229 The @kbd{a \} (@code{calc-poly-div}) [@code{pdiv}] command divides
23230 two polynomials @expr{u} and @expr{v}, yielding a new polynomial
23231 @expr{q}. If several variables occur in the inputs, the inputs are
23232 considered multivariate polynomials. (Calc divides by the variable
23233 with the largest power in @expr{u} first, or, in the case of equal
23234 powers, chooses the variables in alphabetical order.) For example,
23235 dividing @expr{x^2 + 3 x + 2} by @expr{x + 2} yields @expr{x + 1}.
23236 The remainder from the division, if any, is reported at the bottom
23237 of the screen and is also placed in the Trail along with the quotient.
23238
23239 Using @code{pdiv} in algebraic notation, you can specify the particular
23240 variable to be used as the base: @code{pdiv(@var{a},@var{b},@var{x})}.
23241 If @code{pdiv} is given only two arguments (as is always the case with
23242 the @kbd{a \} command), then it does a multivariate division as outlined
23243 above.
23244
23245 @kindex a %
23246 @pindex calc-poly-rem
23247 @tindex prem
23248 The @kbd{a %} (@code{calc-poly-rem}) [@code{prem}] command divides
23249 two polynomials and keeps the remainder @expr{r}. The quotient
23250 @expr{q} is discarded. For any formulas @expr{a} and @expr{b}, the
23251 results of @kbd{a \} and @kbd{a %} satisfy @expr{a = q b + r}.
23252 (This is analogous to plain @kbd{\} and @kbd{%}, which compute the
23253 integer quotient and remainder from dividing two numbers.)
23254
23255 @kindex a /
23256 @kindex H a /
23257 @pindex calc-poly-div-rem
23258 @tindex pdivrem
23259 @tindex pdivide
23260 The @kbd{a /} (@code{calc-poly-div-rem}) [@code{pdivrem}] command
23261 divides two polynomials and reports both the quotient and the
23262 remainder as a vector @expr{[q, r]}. The @kbd{H a /} [@code{pdivide}]
23263 command divides two polynomials and constructs the formula
23264 @expr{q + r/b} on the stack. (Naturally if the remainder is zero,
23265 this will immediately simplify to @expr{q}.)
23266
23267 @kindex a g
23268 @pindex calc-poly-gcd
23269 @tindex pgcd
23270 The @kbd{a g} (@code{calc-poly-gcd}) [@code{pgcd}] command computes
23271 the greatest common divisor of two polynomials. (The GCD actually
23272 is unique only to within a constant multiplier; Calc attempts to
23273 choose a GCD which will be unsurprising.) For example, the @kbd{a n}
23274 command uses @kbd{a g} to take the GCD of the numerator and denominator
23275 of a quotient, then divides each by the result using @kbd{a \}. (The
23276 definition of GCD ensures that this division can take place without
23277 leaving a remainder.)
23278
23279 While the polynomials used in operations like @kbd{a /} and @kbd{a g}
23280 often have integer coefficients, this is not required. Calc can also
23281 deal with polynomials over the rationals or floating-point reals.
23282 Polynomials with modulo-form coefficients are also useful in many
23283 applications; if you enter @samp{(x^2 + 3 x - 1) mod 5}, Calc
23284 automatically transforms this into a polynomial over the field of
23285 integers mod 5: @samp{(1 mod 5) x^2 + (3 mod 5) x + (4 mod 5)}.
23286
23287 Congratulations and thanks go to Ove Ewerlid
23288 (@code{ewerlid@@mizar.DoCS.UU.SE}), who contributed many of the
23289 polynomial routines used in the above commands.
23290
23291 @xref{Decomposing Polynomials}, for several useful functions for
23292 extracting the individual coefficients of a polynomial.
23293
23294 @node Calculus, Solving Equations, Polynomials, Algebra
23295 @section Calculus
23296
23297 @noindent
23298 The following calculus commands do not automatically simplify their
23299 inputs or outputs using @code{calc-simplify}. You may find it helps
23300 to do this by hand by typing @kbd{a s} or @kbd{a e}. It may also help
23301 to use @kbd{a x} and/or @kbd{a c} to arrange a result in the most
23302 readable way.
23303
23304 @menu
23305 * Differentiation::
23306 * Integration::
23307 * Customizing the Integrator::
23308 * Numerical Integration::
23309 * Taylor Series::
23310 @end menu
23311
23312 @node Differentiation, Integration, Calculus, Calculus
23313 @subsection Differentiation
23314
23315 @noindent
23316 @kindex a d
23317 @kindex H a d
23318 @pindex calc-derivative
23319 @tindex deriv
23320 @tindex tderiv
23321 The @kbd{a d} (@code{calc-derivative}) [@code{deriv}] command computes
23322 the derivative of the expression on the top of the stack with respect to
23323 some variable, which it will prompt you to enter. Normally, variables
23324 in the formula other than the specified differentiation variable are
23325 considered constant, i.e., @samp{deriv(y,x)} is reduced to zero. With
23326 the Hyperbolic flag, the @code{tderiv} (total derivative) operation is used
23327 instead, in which derivatives of variables are not reduced to zero
23328 unless those variables are known to be ``constant,'' i.e., independent
23329 of any other variables. (The built-in special variables like @code{pi}
23330 are considered constant, as are variables that have been declared
23331 @code{const}; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23332
23333 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, this command computes the
23334 @var{n}th derivative.
23335
23336 When working with trigonometric functions, it is best to switch to
23337 Radians mode first (with @w{@kbd{m r}}). The derivative of @samp{sin(x)}
23338 in degrees is @samp{(pi/180) cos(x)}, probably not the expected
23339 answer!
23340
23341 If you use the @code{deriv} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23342 you can write @samp{deriv(f,x,x0)} which represents the derivative
23343 of @expr{f} with respect to @expr{x}, evaluated at the point
23344 @texline @math{x=x_0}.
23345 @infoline @expr{x=x0}.
23346
23347 If the formula being differentiated contains functions which Calc does
23348 not know, the derivatives of those functions are produced by adding
23349 primes (apostrophe characters). For example, @samp{deriv(f(2x), x)}
23350 produces @samp{2 f'(2 x)}, where the function @code{f'} represents the
23351 derivative of @code{f}.
23352
23353 For functions you have defined with the @kbd{Z F} command, Calc expands
23354 the functions according to their defining formulas unless you have
23355 also defined @code{f'} suitably. For example, suppose we define
23356 @samp{sinc(x) = sin(x)/x} using @kbd{Z F}. If we then differentiate
23357 the formula @samp{sinc(2 x)}, the formula will be expanded to
23358 @samp{sin(2 x) / (2 x)} and differentiated. However, if we also
23359 define @samp{sinc'(x) = dsinc(x)}, say, then Calc will write the
23360 result as @samp{2 dsinc(2 x)}. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
23361
23362 For multi-argument functions @samp{f(x,y,z)}, the derivative with respect
23363 to the first argument is written @samp{f'(x,y,z)}; derivatives with
23364 respect to the other arguments are @samp{f'2(x,y,z)} and @samp{f'3(x,y,z)}.
23365 Various higher-order derivatives can be formed in the obvious way, e.g.,
23366 @samp{f'@var{}'(x)} (the second derivative of @code{f}) or
23367 @samp{f'@var{}'2'3(x,y,z)} (@code{f} differentiated with respect to each
23368 argument once).
23369
23370 @node Integration, Customizing the Integrator, Differentiation, Calculus
23371 @subsection Integration
23372
23373 @noindent
23374 @kindex a i
23375 @pindex calc-integral
23376 @tindex integ
23377 The @kbd{a i} (@code{calc-integral}) [@code{integ}] command computes the
23378 indefinite integral of the expression on the top of the stack with
23379 respect to a prompted-for variable. The integrator is not guaranteed to
23380 work for all integrable functions, but it is able to integrate several
23381 large classes of formulas. In particular, any polynomial or rational
23382 function (a polynomial divided by a polynomial) is acceptable.
23383 (Rational functions don't have to be in explicit quotient form, however;
23384 @texline @math{x/(1+x^{-2})}
23385 @infoline @expr{x/(1+x^-2)}
23386 is not strictly a quotient of polynomials, but it is equivalent to
23387 @expr{x^3/(x^2+1)}, which is.) Also, square roots of terms involving
23388 @expr{x} and @expr{x^2} may appear in rational functions being
23389 integrated. Finally, rational functions involving trigonometric or
23390 hyperbolic functions can be integrated.
23391
23392 With an argument (@kbd{C-u a i}), this command will compute the definite
23393 integral of the expression on top of the stack. In this case, the
23394 command will again prompt for an integration variable, then prompt for a
23395 lower limit and an upper limit.
23396
23397 @ifnottex
23398 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23399 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23400 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23401 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23402 integral from @code{a} to @code{b}.
23403 @end ifnottex
23404 @tex
23405 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23406 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23407 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23408 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23409 integral $\int_a^b f(x) \, dx$.
23410 @end tex
23411
23412 Please note that the current implementation of Calc's integrator sometimes
23413 produces results that are significantly more complex than they need to
23414 be. For example, the integral Calc finds for
23415 @texline @math{1/(x+\sqrt{x^2+1})}
23416 @infoline @expr{1/(x+sqrt(x^2+1))}
23417 is several times more complicated than the answer Mathematica
23418 returns for the same input, although the two forms are numerically
23419 equivalent. Also, any indefinite integral should be considered to have
23420 an arbitrary constant of integration added to it, although Calc does not
23421 write an explicit constant of integration in its result. For example,
23422 Calc's solution for
23423 @texline @math{1/(1+\tan x)}
23424 @infoline @expr{1/(1+tan(x))}
23425 differs from the solution given in the @emph{CRC Math Tables} by a
23426 constant factor of
23427 @texline @math{\pi i / 2}
23428 @infoline @expr{pi i / 2},
23429 due to a different choice of constant of integration.
23430
23431 The Calculator remembers all the integrals it has done. If conditions
23432 change in a way that would invalidate the old integrals, say, a switch
23433 from Degrees to Radians mode, then they will be thrown out. If you
23434 suspect this is not happening when it should, use the
23435 @code{calc-flush-caches} command; @pxref{Caches}.
23436
23437 @vindex IntegLimit
23438 Calc normally will pursue integration by substitution or integration by
23439 parts up to 3 nested times before abandoning an approach as fruitless.
23440 If the integrator is taking too long, you can lower this limit by storing
23441 a number (like 2) in the variable @code{IntegLimit}. (The @kbd{s I}
23442 command is a convenient way to edit @code{IntegLimit}.) If this variable
23443 has no stored value or does not contain a nonnegative integer, a limit
23444 of 3 is used. The lower this limit is, the greater the chance that Calc
23445 will be unable to integrate a function it could otherwise handle. Raising
23446 this limit allows the Calculator to solve more integrals, though the time
23447 it takes may grow exponentially. You can monitor the integrator's actions
23448 by creating an Emacs buffer called @code{*Trace*}. If such a buffer
23449 exists, the @kbd{a i} command will write a log of its actions there.
23450
23451 If you want to manipulate integrals in a purely symbolic way, you can
23452 set the integration nesting limit to 0 to prevent all but fast
23453 table-lookup solutions of integrals. You might then wish to define
23454 rewrite rules for integration by parts, various kinds of substitutions,
23455 and so on. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
23456
23457 @node Customizing the Integrator, Numerical Integration, Integration, Calculus
23458 @subsection Customizing the Integrator
23459
23460 @noindent
23461 @vindex IntegRules
23462 Calc has two built-in rewrite rules called @code{IntegRules} and
23463 @code{IntegAfterRules} which you can edit to define new integration
23464 methods. @xref{Rewrite Rules}. At each step of the integration process,
23465 Calc wraps the current integrand in a call to the fictitious function
23466 @samp{integtry(@var{expr},@var{var})}, where @var{expr} is the
23467 integrand and @var{var} is the integration variable. If your rules
23468 rewrite this to be a plain formula (not a call to @code{integtry}), then
23469 Calc will use this formula as the integral of @var{expr}. For example,
23470 the rule @samp{integtry(mysin(x),x) := -mycos(x)} would define a rule to
23471 integrate a function @code{mysin} that acts like the sine function.
23472 Then, putting @samp{4 mysin(2y+1)} on the stack and typing @kbd{a i y}
23473 will produce the integral @samp{-2 mycos(2y+1)}. Note that Calc has
23474 automatically made various transformations on the integral to allow it
23475 to use your rule; integral tables generally give rules for
23476 @samp{mysin(a x + b)}, but you don't need to use this much generality
23477 in your @code{IntegRules}.
23478
23479 @cindex Exponential integral Ei(x)
23480 @ignore
23481 @starindex
23482 @end ignore
23483 @tindex Ei
23484 As a more serious example, the expression @samp{exp(x)/x} cannot be
23485 integrated in terms of the standard functions, so the ``exponential
23486 integral'' function
23487 @texline @math{{\rm Ei}(x)}
23488 @infoline @expr{Ei(x)}
23489 was invented to describe it.
23490 We can get Calc to do this integral in terms of a made-up @code{Ei}
23491 function by adding the rule @samp{[integtry(exp(x)/x, x) := Ei(x)]}
23492 to @code{IntegRules}. Now entering @samp{exp(2x)/x} on the stack
23493 and typing @kbd{a i x} yields @samp{Ei(2 x)}. This new rule will
23494 work with Calc's various built-in integration methods (such as
23495 integration by substitution) to solve a variety of other problems
23496 involving @code{Ei}: For example, now Calc will also be able to
23497 integrate @samp{exp(exp(x))} and @samp{ln(ln(x))} (to get @samp{Ei(exp(x))}
23498 and @samp{x ln(ln(x)) - Ei(ln(x))}, respectively).
23499
23500 Your rule may do further integration by calling @code{integ}. For
23501 example, @samp{integtry(twice(u),x) := twice(integ(u))} allows Calc
23502 to integrate @samp{twice(sin(x))} to get @samp{twice(-cos(x))}.
23503 Note that @code{integ} was called with only one argument. This notation
23504 is allowed only within @code{IntegRules}; it means ``integrate this
23505 with respect to the same integration variable.'' If Calc is unable
23506 to integrate @code{u}, the integration that invoked @code{IntegRules}
23507 also fails. Thus integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} fails, returning the
23508 unevaluated integral @samp{integ(twice(f(x)), x)}. It is still valid
23509 to call @code{integ} with two or more arguments, however; in this case,
23510 if @code{u} is not integrable, @code{twice} itself will still be
23511 integrated: If the above rule is changed to @samp{... := twice(integ(u,x))},
23512 then integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} will yield @samp{twice(integ(f(x),x))}.
23513
23514 If a rule instead produces the formula @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr},
23515 @var{svar})}, either replacing the top-level @code{integtry} call or
23516 nested anywhere inside the expression, then Calc will apply the
23517 substitution @samp{@var{u} = @var{sexpr}(@var{svar})} to try to
23518 integrate the original @var{expr}. For example, the rule
23519 @samp{sqrt(a) := integsubst(sqrt(x),x)} says that if Calc ever finds
23520 a square root in the integrand, it should attempt the substitution
23521 @samp{u = sqrt(x)}. (This particular rule is unnecessary because
23522 Calc always tries ``obvious'' substitutions where @var{sexpr} actually
23523 appears in the integrand.) The variable @var{svar} may be the same
23524 as the @var{var} that appeared in the call to @code{integtry}, but
23525 it need not be.
23526
23527 When integrating according to an @code{integsubst}, Calc uses the
23528 equation solver to find the inverse of @var{sexpr} (if the integrand
23529 refers to @var{var} anywhere except in subexpressions that exactly
23530 match @var{sexpr}). It uses the differentiator to find the derivative
23531 of @var{sexpr} and/or its inverse (it has two methods that use one
23532 derivative or the other). You can also specify these items by adding
23533 extra arguments to the @code{integsubst} your rules construct; the
23534 general form is @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr}, @var{svar}, @var{sinv},
23535 @var{sprime})}, where @var{sinv} is the inverse of @var{sexpr} (still
23536 written as a function of @var{svar}), and @var{sprime} is the
23537 derivative of @var{sexpr} with respect to @var{svar}. If you don't
23538 specify these things, and Calc is not able to work them out on its
23539 own with the information it knows, then your substitution rule will
23540 work only in very specific, simple cases.
23541
23542 Calc applies @code{IntegRules} as if by @kbd{C-u 1 a r IntegRules};
23543 in other words, Calc stops rewriting as soon as any rule in your rule
23544 set succeeds. (If it weren't for this, the @samp{integsubst(sqrt(x),x)}
23545 example above would keep on adding layers of @code{integsubst} calls
23546 forever!)
23547
23548 @vindex IntegSimpRules
23549 Another set of rules, stored in @code{IntegSimpRules}, are applied
23550 every time the integrator uses @kbd{a s} to simplify an intermediate
23551 result. For example, putting the rule @samp{twice(x) := 2 x} into
23552 @code{IntegSimpRules} would tell Calc to convert the @code{twice}
23553 function into a form it knows whenever integration is attempted.
23554
23555 One more way to influence the integrator is to define a function with
23556 the @kbd{Z F} command (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}). Calc's
23557 integrator automatically expands such functions according to their
23558 defining formulas, even if you originally asked for the function to
23559 be left unevaluated for symbolic arguments. (Certain other Calc
23560 systems, such as the differentiator and the equation solver, also
23561 do this.)
23562
23563 @vindex IntegAfterRules
23564 Sometimes Calc is able to find a solution to your integral, but it
23565 expresses the result in a way that is unnecessarily complicated. If
23566 this happens, you can either use @code{integsubst} as described
23567 above to try to hint at a more direct path to the desired result, or
23568 you can use @code{IntegAfterRules}. This is an extra rule set that
23569 runs after the main integrator returns its result; basically, Calc does
23570 an @kbd{a r IntegAfterRules} on the result before showing it to you.
23571 (It also does an @kbd{a s}, without @code{IntegSimpRules}, after that
23572 to further simplify the result.) For example, Calc's integrator
23573 sometimes produces expressions of the form @samp{ln(1+x) - ln(1-x)};
23574 the default @code{IntegAfterRules} rewrite this into the more readable
23575 form @samp{2 arctanh(x)}. Note that, unlike @code{IntegRules},
23576 @code{IntegSimpRules} and @code{IntegAfterRules} are applied any number
23577 of times until no further changes are possible. Rewriting by
23578 @code{IntegAfterRules} occurs only after the main integrator has
23579 finished, not at every step as for @code{IntegRules} and
23580 @code{IntegSimpRules}.
23581
23582 @node Numerical Integration, Taylor Series, Customizing the Integrator, Calculus
23583 @subsection Numerical Integration
23584
23585 @noindent
23586 @kindex a I
23587 @pindex calc-num-integral
23588 @tindex ninteg
23589 If you want a purely numerical answer to an integration problem, you can
23590 use the @kbd{a I} (@code{calc-num-integral}) [@code{ninteg}] command. This
23591 command prompts for an integration variable, a lower limit, and an
23592 upper limit. Except for the integration variable, all other variables
23593 that appear in the integrand formula must have stored values. (A stored
23594 value, if any, for the integration variable itself is ignored.)
23595
23596 Numerical integration works by evaluating your formula at many points in
23597 the specified interval. Calc uses an ``open Romberg'' method; this means
23598 that it does not evaluate the formula actually at the endpoints (so that
23599 it is safe to integrate @samp{sin(x)/x} from zero, for example). Also,
23600 the Romberg method works especially well when the function being
23601 integrated is fairly smooth. If the function is not smooth, Calc will
23602 have to evaluate it at quite a few points before it can accurately
23603 determine the value of the integral.
23604
23605 Integration is much faster when the current precision is small. It is
23606 best to set the precision to the smallest acceptable number of digits
23607 before you use @kbd{a I}. If Calc appears to be taking too long, press
23608 @kbd{C-g} to halt it and try a lower precision. If Calc still appears
23609 to need hundreds of evaluations, check to make sure your function is
23610 well-behaved in the specified interval.
23611
23612 It is possible for the lower integration limit to be @samp{-inf} (minus
23613 infinity). Likewise, the upper limit may be plus infinity. Calc
23614 internally transforms the integral into an equivalent one with finite
23615 limits. However, integration to or across singularities is not supported:
23616 The integral of @samp{1/sqrt(x)} from 0 to 1 exists (it can be found
23617 by Calc's symbolic integrator, for example), but @kbd{a I} will fail
23618 because the integrand goes to infinity at one of the endpoints.
23619
23620 @node Taylor Series, , Numerical Integration, Calculus
23621 @subsection Taylor Series
23622
23623 @noindent
23624 @kindex a t
23625 @pindex calc-taylor
23626 @tindex taylor
23627 The @kbd{a t} (@code{calc-taylor}) [@code{taylor}] command computes a
23628 power series expansion or Taylor series of a function. You specify the
23629 variable and the desired number of terms. You may give an expression of
23630 the form @samp{@var{var} = @var{a}} or @samp{@var{var} - @var{a}} instead
23631 of just a variable to produce a Taylor expansion about the point @var{a}.
23632 You may specify the number of terms with a numeric prefix argument;
23633 otherwise the command will prompt you for the number of terms. Note that
23634 many series expansions have coefficients of zero for some terms, so you
23635 may appear to get fewer terms than you asked for.
23636
23637 If the @kbd{a i} command is unable to find a symbolic integral for a
23638 function, you can get an approximation by integrating the function's
23639 Taylor series.
23640
23641 @node Solving Equations, Numerical Solutions, Calculus, Algebra
23642 @section Solving Equations
23643
23644 @noindent
23645 @kindex a S
23646 @pindex calc-solve-for
23647 @tindex solve
23648 @cindex Equations, solving
23649 @cindex Solving equations
23650 The @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) [@code{solve}] command rearranges
23651 an equation to solve for a specific variable. An equation is an
23652 expression of the form @expr{L = R}. For example, the command @kbd{a S x}
23653 will rearrange @expr{y = 3x + 6} to the form, @expr{x = y/3 - 2}. If the
23654 input is not an equation, it is treated like an equation of the
23655 form @expr{X = 0}.
23656
23657 This command also works for inequalities, as in @expr{y < 3x + 6}.
23658 Some inequalities cannot be solved where the analogous equation could
23659 be; for example, solving
23660 @texline @math{a < b \, c}
23661 @infoline @expr{a < b c}
23662 for @expr{b} is impossible
23663 without knowing the sign of @expr{c}. In this case, @kbd{a S} will
23664 produce the result
23665 @texline @math{b \mathbin{\hbox{\code{!=}}} a/c}
23666 @infoline @expr{b != a/c}
23667 (using the not-equal-to operator) to signify that the direction of the
23668 inequality is now unknown. The inequality
23669 @texline @math{a \le b \, c}
23670 @infoline @expr{a <= b c}
23671 is not even partially solved. @xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell
23672 Calc that the signs of the variables in a formula are in fact known.
23673
23674 Two useful commands for working with the result of @kbd{a S} are
23675 @kbd{a .} (@pxref{Logical Operations}), which converts @expr{x = y/3 - 2}
23676 to @expr{y/3 - 2}, and @kbd{s l} (@pxref{Let Command}) which evaluates
23677 another formula with @expr{x} set equal to @expr{y/3 - 2}.
23678
23679 @menu
23680 * Multiple Solutions::
23681 * Solving Systems of Equations::
23682 * Decomposing Polynomials::
23683 @end menu
23684
23685 @node Multiple Solutions, Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations, Solving Equations
23686 @subsection Multiple Solutions
23687
23688 @noindent
23689 @kindex H a S
23690 @tindex fsolve
23691 Some equations have more than one solution. The Hyperbolic flag
23692 (@code{H a S}) [@code{fsolve}] tells the solver to report the fully
23693 general family of solutions. It will invent variables @code{n1},
23694 @code{n2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary integers, and
23695 @code{s1}, @code{s2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary
23696 signs (either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}). If you don't use the Hyperbolic
23697 flag, Calc will use zero in place of all arbitrary integers, and plus
23698 one in place of all arbitrary signs. Note that variables like @code{n1}
23699 and @code{s1} are not given any special interpretation in Calc except by
23700 the equation solver itself. As usual, you can use the @w{@kbd{s l}}
23701 (@code{calc-let}) command to obtain solutions for various actual values
23702 of these variables.
23703
23704 For example, @kbd{' x^2 = y @key{RET} H a S x @key{RET}} solves to
23705 get @samp{x = s1 sqrt(y)}, indicating that the two solutions to the
23706 equation are @samp{sqrt(y)} and @samp{-sqrt(y)}. Another way to
23707 think about it is that the square-root operation is really a
23708 two-valued function; since every Calc function must return a
23709 single result, @code{sqrt} chooses to return the positive result.
23710 Then @kbd{H a S} doctors this result using @code{s1} to indicate
23711 the full set of possible values of the mathematical square-root.
23712
23713 There is a similar phenomenon going the other direction: Suppose
23714 we solve @samp{sqrt(y) = x} for @code{y}. Calc squares both sides
23715 to get @samp{y = x^2}. This is correct, except that it introduces
23716 some dubious solutions. Consider solving @samp{sqrt(y) = -3}:
23717 Calc will report @expr{y = 9} as a valid solution, which is true
23718 in the mathematical sense of square-root, but false (there is no
23719 solution) for the actual Calc positive-valued @code{sqrt}. This
23720 happens for both @kbd{a S} and @kbd{H a S}.
23721
23722 @cindex @code{GenCount} variable
23723 @vindex GenCount
23724 @ignore
23725 @starindex
23726 @end ignore
23727 @tindex an
23728 @ignore
23729 @starindex
23730 @end ignore
23731 @tindex as
23732 If you store a positive integer in the Calc variable @code{GenCount},
23733 then Calc will generate formulas of the form @samp{as(@var{n})} for
23734 arbitrary signs, and @samp{an(@var{n})} for arbitrary integers,
23735 where @var{n} represents successive values taken by incrementing
23736 @code{GenCount} by one. While the normal arbitrary sign and
23737 integer symbols start over at @code{s1} and @code{n1} with each
23738 new Calc command, the @code{GenCount} approach will give each
23739 arbitrary value a name that is unique throughout the entire Calc
23740 session. Also, the arbitrary values are function calls instead
23741 of variables, which is advantageous in some cases. For example,
23742 you can make a rewrite rule that recognizes all arbitrary signs
23743 using a pattern like @samp{as(n)}. The @kbd{s l} command only works
23744 on variables, but you can use the @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
23745 command to substitute actual values for function calls like @samp{as(3)}.
23746
23747 The @kbd{s G} (@code{calc-edit-GenCount}) command is a convenient
23748 way to create or edit this variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish.
23749
23750 If you have not stored a value in @code{GenCount}, or if the value
23751 in that variable is not a positive integer, the regular
23752 @code{s1}/@code{n1} notation is used.
23753
23754 @kindex I a S
23755 @kindex H I a S
23756 @tindex finv
23757 @tindex ffinv
23758 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a S} [@code{finv}] treats the expression
23759 on top of the stack as a function of the specified variable and solves
23760 to find the inverse function, written in terms of the same variable.
23761 For example, @kbd{I a S x} inverts @expr{2x + 6} to @expr{x/2 - 3}.
23762 You can use both Inverse and Hyperbolic [@code{ffinv}] to obtain a
23763 fully general inverse, as described above.
23764
23765 @kindex a P
23766 @pindex calc-poly-roots
23767 @tindex roots
23768 Some equations, specifically polynomials, have a known, finite number
23769 of solutions. The @kbd{a P} (@code{calc-poly-roots}) [@code{roots}]
23770 command uses @kbd{H a S} to solve an equation in general form, then, for
23771 all arbitrary-sign variables like @code{s1}, and all arbitrary-integer
23772 variables like @code{n1} for which @code{n1} only usefully varies over
23773 a finite range, it expands these variables out to all their possible
23774 values. The results are collected into a vector, which is returned.
23775 For example, @samp{roots(x^4 = 1, x)} returns the four solutions
23776 @samp{[1, -1, (0, 1), (0, -1)]}. Generally an @var{n}th degree
23777 polynomial will always have @var{n} roots on the complex plane.
23778 (If you have given a @code{real} declaration for the solution
23779 variable, then only the real-valued solutions, if any, will be
23780 reported; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23781
23782 Note that because @kbd{a P} uses @kbd{H a S}, it is able to deliver
23783 symbolic solutions if the polynomial has symbolic coefficients. Also
23784 note that Calc's solver is not able to get exact symbolic solutions
23785 to all polynomials. Polynomials containing powers up to @expr{x^4}
23786 can always be solved exactly; polynomials of higher degree sometimes
23787 can be: @expr{x^6 + x^3 + 1} is converted to @expr{(x^3)^2 + (x^3) + 1},
23788 which can be solved for @expr{x^3} using the quadratic equation, and then
23789 for @expr{x} by taking cube roots. But in many cases, like
23790 @expr{x^6 + x + 1}, Calc does not know how to rewrite the polynomial
23791 into a form it can solve. The @kbd{a P} command can still deliver a
23792 list of numerical roots, however, provided that Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s})
23793 is not turned on. (If you work with Symbolic mode on, recall that the
23794 @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) key is a handy way to reevaluate the
23795 formula on the stack with Symbolic mode temporarily off.) Naturally,
23796 @kbd{a P} can only provide numerical roots if the polynomial coefficients
23797 are all numbers (real or complex).
23798
23799 @node Solving Systems of Equations, Decomposing Polynomials, Multiple Solutions, Solving Equations
23800 @subsection Solving Systems of Equations
23801
23802 @noindent
23803 @cindex Systems of equations, symbolic
23804 You can also use the commands described above to solve systems of
23805 simultaneous equations. Just create a vector of equations, then
23806 specify a vector of variables for which to solve. (You can omit
23807 the surrounding brackets when entering the vector of variables
23808 at the prompt.)
23809
23810 For example, putting @samp{[x + y = a, x - y = b]} on the stack
23811 and typing @kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}} produces the vector of solutions
23812 @samp{[x = a - (a-b)/2, y = (a-b)/2]}. The result vector will
23813 have the same length as the variables vector, and the variables
23814 will be listed in the same order there. Note that the solutions
23815 are not always simplified as far as possible; the solution for
23816 @expr{x} here could be improved by an application of the @kbd{a n}
23817 command.
23818
23819 Calc's algorithm works by trying to eliminate one variable at a
23820 time by solving one of the equations for that variable and then
23821 substituting into the other equations. Calc will try all the
23822 possibilities, but you can speed things up by noting that Calc
23823 first tries to eliminate the first variable with the first
23824 equation, then the second variable with the second equation,
23825 and so on. It also helps to put the simpler (e.g., more linear)
23826 equations toward the front of the list. Calc's algorithm will
23827 solve any system of linear equations, and also many kinds of
23828 nonlinear systems.
23829
23830 @ignore
23831 @starindex
23832 @end ignore
23833 @tindex elim
23834 Normally there will be as many variables as equations. If you
23835 give fewer variables than equations (an ``over-determined'' system
23836 of equations), Calc will find a partial solution. For example,
23837 typing @kbd{a S y @key{RET}} with the above system of equations
23838 would produce @samp{[y = a - x]}. There are now several ways to
23839 express this solution in terms of the original variables; Calc uses
23840 the first one that it finds. You can control the choice by adding
23841 variable specifiers of the form @samp{elim(@var{v})} to the
23842 variables list. This says that @var{v} should be eliminated from
23843 the equations; the variable will not appear at all in the solution.
23844 For example, typing @kbd{a S y,elim(x)} would yield
23845 @samp{[y = a - (b+a)/2]}.
23846
23847 If the variables list contains only @code{elim} specifiers,
23848 Calc simply eliminates those variables from the equations
23849 and then returns the resulting set of equations. For example,
23850 @kbd{a S elim(x)} produces @samp{[a - 2 y = b]}. Every variable
23851 eliminated will reduce the number of equations in the system
23852 by one.
23853
23854 Again, @kbd{a S} gives you one solution to the system of
23855 equations. If there are several solutions, you can use @kbd{H a S}
23856 to get a general family of solutions, or, if there is a finite
23857 number of solutions, you can use @kbd{a P} to get a list. (In
23858 the latter case, the result will take the form of a matrix where
23859 the rows are different solutions and the columns correspond to the
23860 variables you requested.)
23861
23862 Another way to deal with certain kinds of overdetermined systems of
23863 equations is the @kbd{a F} command, which does least-squares fitting
23864 to satisfy the equations. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
23865
23866 @node Decomposing Polynomials, , Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations
23867 @subsection Decomposing Polynomials
23868
23869 @noindent
23870 @ignore
23871 @starindex
23872 @end ignore
23873 @tindex poly
23874 The @code{poly} function takes a polynomial and a variable as
23875 arguments, and returns a vector of polynomial coefficients (constant
23876 coefficient first). For example, @samp{poly(x^3 + 2 x, x)} returns
23877 @expr{[0, 2, 0, 1]}. If the input is not a polynomial in @expr{x},
23878 the call to @code{poly} is left in symbolic form. If the input does
23879 not involve the variable @expr{x}, the input is returned in a list
23880 of length one, representing a polynomial with only a constant
23881 coefficient. The call @samp{poly(x, x)} returns the vector @expr{[0, 1]}.
23882 The last element of the returned vector is guaranteed to be nonzero;
23883 note that @samp{poly(0, x)} returns the empty vector @expr{[]}.
23884 Note also that @expr{x} may actually be any formula; for example,
23885 @samp{poly(sin(x)^2 - sin(x) + 3, sin(x))} returns @expr{[3, -1, 1]}.
23886
23887 @cindex Coefficients of polynomial
23888 @cindex Degree of polynomial
23889 To get the @expr{x^k} coefficient of polynomial @expr{p}, use
23890 @samp{poly(p, x)_(k+1)}. To get the degree of polynomial @expr{p},
23891 use @samp{vlen(poly(p, x)) - 1}. For example, @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)}
23892 returns @samp{[1, 4, 6, 4, 1]}, so @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)_(2+1)}
23893 gives the @expr{x^2} coefficient of this polynomial, 6.
23894
23895 @ignore
23896 @starindex
23897 @end ignore
23898 @tindex gpoly
23899 One important feature of the solver is its ability to recognize
23900 formulas which are ``essentially'' polynomials. This ability is
23901 made available to the user through the @code{gpoly} function, which
23902 is used just like @code{poly}: @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var})}.
23903 If @var{expr} is a polynomial in some term which includes @var{var}, then
23904 this function will return a vector @samp{[@var{x}, @var{c}, @var{a}]}
23905 where @var{x} is the term that depends on @var{var}, @var{c} is a
23906 vector of polynomial coefficients (like the one returned by @code{poly}),
23907 and @var{a} is a multiplier which is usually 1. Basically,
23908 @samp{@var{expr} = @var{a}*(@var{c}_1 + @var{c}_2 @var{x} +
23909 @var{c}_3 @var{x}^2 + ...)}. The last element of @var{c} is
23910 guaranteed to be non-zero, and @var{c} will not equal @samp{[1]}
23911 (i.e., the trivial decomposition @var{expr} = @var{x} is not
23912 considered a polynomial). One side effect is that @samp{gpoly(x, x)}
23913 and @samp{gpoly(6, x)}, both of which might be expected to recognize
23914 their arguments as polynomials, will not because the decomposition
23915 is considered trivial.
23916
23917 For example, @samp{gpoly((x-2)^2, x)} returns @samp{[x, [4, -4, 1], 1]},
23918 since the expanded form of this polynomial is @expr{4 - 4 x + x^2}.
23919
23920 The term @var{x} may itself be a polynomial in @var{var}. This is
23921 done to reduce the size of the @var{c} vector. For example,
23922 @samp{gpoly(x^4 + x^2 - 1, x)} returns @samp{[x^2, [-1, 1, 1], 1]},
23923 since a quadratic polynomial in @expr{x^2} is easier to solve than
23924 a quartic polynomial in @expr{x}.
23925
23926 A few more examples of the kinds of polynomials @code{gpoly} can
23927 discover:
23928
23929 @smallexample
23930 sin(x) - 1 [sin(x), [-1, 1], 1]
23931 x + 1/x - 1 [x, [1, -1, 1], 1/x]
23932 x + 1/x [x^2, [1, 1], 1/x]
23933 x^3 + 2 x [x^2, [2, 1], x]
23934 x + x^2:3 + sqrt(x) [x^1:6, [1, 1, 0, 1], x^1:2]
23935 x^(2a) + 2 x^a + 5 [x^a, [5, 2, 1], 1]
23936 (exp(-x) + exp(x)) / 2 [e^(2 x), [0.5, 0.5], e^-x]
23937 @end smallexample
23938
23939 The @code{poly} and @code{gpoly} functions accept a third integer argument
23940 which specifies the largest degree of polynomial that is acceptable.
23941 If this is @expr{n}, then only @var{c} vectors of length @expr{n+1}
23942 or less will be returned. Otherwise, the @code{poly} or @code{gpoly}
23943 call will remain in symbolic form. For example, the equation solver
23944 can handle quartics and smaller polynomials, so it calls
23945 @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var}, 4)} to discover whether @var{expr}
23946 can be treated by its linear, quadratic, cubic, or quartic formulas.
23947
23948 @ignore
23949 @starindex
23950 @end ignore
23951 @tindex pdeg
23952 The @code{pdeg} function computes the degree of a polynomial;
23953 @samp{pdeg(p,x)} is the highest power of @code{x} that appears in
23954 @code{p}. This is the same as @samp{vlen(poly(p,x))-1}, but is
23955 much more efficient. If @code{p} is constant with respect to @code{x},
23956 then @samp{pdeg(p,x) = 0}. If @code{p} is not a polynomial in @code{x}
23957 (e.g., @samp{pdeg(2 cos(x), x)}, the function remains unevaluated.
23958 It is possible to omit the second argument @code{x}, in which case
23959 @samp{pdeg(p)} returns the highest total degree of any term of the
23960 polynomial, counting all variables that appear in @code{p}. Note
23961 that @code{pdeg(c) = pdeg(c,x) = 0} for any nonzero constant @code{c};
23962 the degree of the constant zero is considered to be @code{-inf}
23963 (minus infinity).
23964
23965 @ignore
23966 @starindex
23967 @end ignore
23968 @tindex plead
23969 The @code{plead} function finds the leading term of a polynomial.
23970 Thus @samp{plead(p,x)} is equivalent to @samp{poly(p,x)_vlen(poly(p,x))},
23971 though again more efficient. In particular, @samp{plead((2x+1)^10, x)}
23972 returns 1024 without expanding out the list of coefficients. The
23973 value of @code{plead(p,x)} will be zero only if @expr{p = 0}.
23974
23975 @ignore
23976 @starindex
23977 @end ignore
23978 @tindex pcont
23979 The @code{pcont} function finds the @dfn{content} of a polynomial. This
23980 is the greatest common divisor of all the coefficients of the polynomial.
23981 With two arguments, @code{pcont(p,x)} effectively uses @samp{poly(p,x)}
23982 to get a list of coefficients, then uses @code{pgcd} (the polynomial
23983 GCD function) to combine these into an answer. For example,
23984 @samp{pcont(4 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y, x)} is @samp{2 y}. The content is
23985 basically the ``biggest'' polynomial that can be divided into @code{p}
23986 exactly. The sign of the content is the same as the sign of the leading
23987 coefficient.
23988
23989 With only one argument, @samp{pcont(p)} computes the numerical
23990 content of the polynomial, i.e., the @code{gcd} of the numerical
23991 coefficients of all the terms in the formula. Note that @code{gcd}
23992 is defined on rational numbers as well as integers; it computes
23993 the @code{gcd} of the numerators and the @code{lcm} of the
23994 denominators. Thus @samp{pcont(4:3 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y)} returns 2:3.
23995 Dividing the polynomial by this number will clear all the
23996 denominators, as well as dividing by any common content in the
23997 numerators. The numerical content of a polynomial is negative only
23998 if all the coefficients in the polynomial are negative.
23999
24000 @ignore
24001 @starindex
24002 @end ignore
24003 @tindex pprim
24004 The @code{pprim} function finds the @dfn{primitive part} of a
24005 polynomial, which is simply the polynomial divided (using @code{pdiv}
24006 if necessary) by its content. If the input polynomial has rational
24007 coefficients, the result will have integer coefficients in simplest
24008 terms.
24009
24010 @node Numerical Solutions, Curve Fitting, Solving Equations, Algebra
24011 @section Numerical Solutions
24012
24013 @noindent
24014 Not all equations can be solved symbolically. The commands in this
24015 section use numerical algorithms that can find a solution to a specific
24016 instance of an equation to any desired accuracy. Note that the
24017 numerical commands are slower than their algebraic cousins; it is a
24018 good idea to try @kbd{a S} before resorting to these commands.
24019
24020 (@xref{Curve Fitting}, for some other, more specialized, operations
24021 on numerical data.)
24022
24023 @menu
24024 * Root Finding::
24025 * Minimization::
24026 * Numerical Systems of Equations::
24027 @end menu
24028
24029 @node Root Finding, Minimization, Numerical Solutions, Numerical Solutions
24030 @subsection Root Finding
24031
24032 @noindent
24033 @kindex a R
24034 @pindex calc-find-root
24035 @tindex root
24036 @cindex Newton's method
24037 @cindex Roots of equations
24038 @cindex Numerical root-finding
24039 The @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}) [@code{root}] command finds a
24040 numerical solution (or @dfn{root}) of an equation. (This command treats
24041 inequalities the same as equations. If the input is any other kind
24042 of formula, it is interpreted as an equation of the form @expr{X = 0}.)
24043
24044 The @kbd{a R} command requires an initial guess on the top of the
24045 stack, and a formula in the second-to-top position. It prompts for a
24046 solution variable, which must appear in the formula. All other variables
24047 that appear in the formula must have assigned values, i.e., when
24048 a value is assigned to the solution variable and the formula is
24049 evaluated with @kbd{=}, it should evaluate to a number. Any assigned
24050 value for the solution variable itself is ignored and unaffected by
24051 this command.
24052
24053 When the command completes, the initial guess is replaced on the stack
24054 by a vector of two numbers: The value of the solution variable that
24055 solves the equation, and the difference between the lefthand and
24056 righthand sides of the equation at that value. Ordinarily, the second
24057 number will be zero or very nearly zero. (Note that Calc uses a
24058 slightly higher precision while finding the root, and thus the second
24059 number may be slightly different from the value you would compute from
24060 the equation yourself.)
24061
24062 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) command is a handy way to extract
24063 the first element of the result vector, discarding the error term.
24064
24065 The initial guess can be a real number, in which case Calc searches
24066 for a real solution near that number, or a complex number, in which
24067 case Calc searches the whole complex plane near that number for a
24068 solution, or it can be an interval form which restricts the search
24069 to real numbers inside that interval.
24070
24071 Calc tries to use @kbd{a d} to take the derivative of the equation.
24072 If this succeeds, it uses Newton's method. If the equation is not
24073 differentiable Calc uses a bisection method. (If Newton's method
24074 appears to be going astray, Calc switches over to bisection if it
24075 can, or otherwise gives up. In this case it may help to try again
24076 with a slightly different initial guess.) If the initial guess is a
24077 complex number, the function must be differentiable.
24078
24079 If the formula (or the difference between the sides of an equation)
24080 is negative at one end of the interval you specify and positive at
24081 the other end, the root finder is guaranteed to find a root.
24082 Otherwise, Calc subdivides the interval into small parts looking for
24083 positive and negative values to bracket the root. When your guess is
24084 an interval, Calc will not look outside that interval for a root.
24085
24086 @kindex H a R
24087 @tindex wroot
24088 The @kbd{H a R} [@code{wroot}] command is similar to @kbd{a R}, except
24089 that if the initial guess is an interval for which the function has
24090 the same sign at both ends, then rather than subdividing the interval
24091 Calc attempts to widen it to enclose a root. Use this mode if
24092 you are not sure if the function has a root in your interval.
24093
24094 If the function is not differentiable, and you give a simple number
24095 instead of an interval as your initial guess, Calc uses this widening
24096 process even if you did not type the Hyperbolic flag. (If the function
24097 @emph{is} differentiable, Calc uses Newton's method which does not
24098 require a bounding interval in order to work.)
24099
24100 If Calc leaves the @code{root} or @code{wroot} function in symbolic
24101 form on the stack, it will normally display an explanation for why
24102 no root was found. If you miss this explanation, press @kbd{w}
24103 (@code{calc-why}) to get it back.
24104
24105 @node Minimization, Numerical Systems of Equations, Root Finding, Numerical Solutions
24106 @subsection Minimization
24107
24108 @noindent
24109 @kindex a N
24110 @kindex H a N
24111 @kindex a X
24112 @kindex H a X
24113 @pindex calc-find-minimum
24114 @pindex calc-find-maximum
24115 @tindex minimize
24116 @tindex maximize
24117 @cindex Minimization, numerical
24118 The @kbd{a N} (@code{calc-find-minimum}) [@code{minimize}] command
24119 finds a minimum value for a formula. It is very similar in operation
24120 to @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}): You give the formula and an initial
24121 guess on the stack, and are prompted for the name of a variable. The guess
24122 may be either a number near the desired minimum, or an interval enclosing
24123 the desired minimum. The function returns a vector containing the
24124 value of the variable which minimizes the formula's value, along
24125 with the minimum value itself.
24126
24127 Note that this command looks for a @emph{local} minimum. Many functions
24128 have more than one minimum; some, like
24129 @texline @math{x \sin x},
24130 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)},
24131 have infinitely many. In fact, there is no easy way to define the
24132 ``global'' minimum of
24133 @texline @math{x \sin x}
24134 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)}
24135 but Calc can still locate any particular local minimum
24136 for you. Calc basically goes downhill from the initial guess until it
24137 finds a point at which the function's value is greater both to the left
24138 and to the right. Calc does not use derivatives when minimizing a function.
24139
24140 If your initial guess is an interval and it looks like the minimum
24141 occurs at one or the other endpoint of the interval, Calc will return
24142 that endpoint only if that endpoint is closed; thus, minimizing @expr{17 x}
24143 over @expr{[2..3]} will return @expr{[2, 38]}, but minimizing over
24144 @expr{(2..3]} would report no minimum found. In general, you should
24145 use closed intervals to find literally the minimum value in that
24146 range of @expr{x}, or open intervals to find the local minimum, if
24147 any, that happens to lie in that range.
24148
24149 Most functions are smooth and flat near their minimum values. Because
24150 of this flatness, if the current precision is, say, 12 digits, the
24151 variable can only be determined meaningfully to about six digits. Thus
24152 you should set the precision to twice as many digits as you need in your
24153 answer.
24154
24155 @ignore
24156 @mindex wmin@idots
24157 @end ignore
24158 @tindex wminimize
24159 @ignore
24160 @mindex wmax@idots
24161 @end ignore
24162 @tindex wmaximize
24163 The @kbd{H a N} [@code{wminimize}] command, analogously to @kbd{H a R},
24164 expands the guess interval to enclose a minimum rather than requiring
24165 that the minimum lie inside the interval you supply.
24166
24167 The @kbd{a X} (@code{calc-find-maximum}) [@code{maximize}] and
24168 @kbd{H a X} [@code{wmaximize}] commands effectively minimize the
24169 negative of the formula you supply.
24170
24171 The formula must evaluate to a real number at all points inside the
24172 interval (or near the initial guess if the guess is a number). If
24173 the initial guess is a complex number the variable will be minimized
24174 over the complex numbers; if it is real or an interval it will
24175 be minimized over the reals.
24176
24177 @node Numerical Systems of Equations, , Minimization, Numerical Solutions
24178 @subsection Systems of Equations
24179
24180 @noindent
24181 @cindex Systems of equations, numerical
24182 The @kbd{a R} command can also solve systems of equations. In this
24183 case, the equation should instead be a vector of equations, the
24184 guess should instead be a vector of numbers (intervals are not
24185 supported), and the variable should be a vector of variables. You
24186 can omit the brackets while entering the list of variables. Each
24187 equation must be differentiable by each variable for this mode to
24188 work. The result will be a vector of two vectors: The variable
24189 values that solved the system of equations, and the differences
24190 between the sides of the equations with those variable values.
24191 There must be the same number of equations as variables. Since
24192 only plain numbers are allowed as guesses, the Hyperbolic flag has
24193 no effect when solving a system of equations.
24194
24195 It is also possible to minimize over many variables with @kbd{a N}
24196 (or maximize with @kbd{a X}). Once again the variable name should
24197 be replaced by a vector of variables, and the initial guess should
24198 be an equal-sized vector of initial guesses. But, unlike the case of
24199 multidimensional @kbd{a R}, the formula being minimized should
24200 still be a single formula, @emph{not} a vector. Beware that
24201 multidimensional minimization is currently @emph{very} slow.
24202
24203 @node Curve Fitting, Summations, Numerical Solutions, Algebra
24204 @section Curve Fitting
24205
24206 @noindent
24207 The @kbd{a F} command fits a set of data to a @dfn{model formula},
24208 such as @expr{y = m x + b} where @expr{m} and @expr{b} are parameters
24209 to be determined. For a typical set of measured data there will be
24210 no single @expr{m} and @expr{b} that exactly fit the data; in this
24211 case, Calc chooses values of the parameters that provide the closest
24212 possible fit. The model formula can be entered in various ways after
24213 the key sequence @kbd{a F} is pressed.
24214
24215 If the letter @kbd{P} is pressed after @kbd{a F} but before the model
24216 description is entered, the data as well as the model formula will be
24217 plotted after the formula is determined. This will be indicated by a
24218 ``P'' in the minibuffer after the help message.
24219
24220 @menu
24221 * Linear Fits::
24222 * Polynomial and Multilinear Fits::
24223 * Error Estimates for Fits::
24224 * Standard Nonlinear Models::
24225 * Curve Fitting Details::
24226 * Interpolation::
24227 @end menu
24228
24229 @node Linear Fits, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting, Curve Fitting
24230 @subsection Linear Fits
24231
24232 @noindent
24233 @kindex a F
24234 @pindex calc-curve-fit
24235 @tindex fit
24236 @cindex Linear regression
24237 @cindex Least-squares fits
24238 The @kbd{a F} (@code{calc-curve-fit}) [@code{fit}] command attempts
24239 to fit a set of data (@expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers) to a
24240 straight line, polynomial, or other function of @expr{x}. For the
24241 moment we will consider only the case of fitting to a line, and we
24242 will ignore the issue of whether or not the model was in fact a good
24243 fit for the data.
24244
24245 In a standard linear least-squares fit, we have a set of @expr{(x,y)}
24246 data points that we wish to fit to the model @expr{y = m x + b}
24247 by adjusting the parameters @expr{m} and @expr{b} to make the @expr{y}
24248 values calculated from the formula be as close as possible to the actual
24249 @expr{y} values in the data set. (In a polynomial fit, the model is
24250 instead, say, @expr{y = a x^3 + b x^2 + c x + d}. In a multilinear fit,
24251 we have data points of the form @expr{(x_1,x_2,x_3,y)} and our model is
24252 @expr{y = a x_1 + b x_2 + c x_3 + d}. These will be discussed later.)
24253
24254 In the model formula, variables like @expr{x} and @expr{x_2} are called
24255 the @dfn{independent variables}, and @expr{y} is the @dfn{dependent
24256 variable}. Variables like @expr{m}, @expr{a}, and @expr{b} are called
24257 the @dfn{parameters} of the model.
24258
24259 The @kbd{a F} command takes the data set to be fitted from the stack.
24260 By default, it expects the data in the form of a matrix. For example,
24261 for a linear or polynomial fit, this would be a
24262 @texline @math{2\times N}
24263 @infoline 2xN
24264 matrix where the first row is a list of @expr{x} values and the second
24265 row has the corresponding @expr{y} values. For the multilinear fit
24266 shown above, the matrix would have four rows (@expr{x_1}, @expr{x_2},
24267 @expr{x_3}, and @expr{y}, respectively).
24268
24269 If you happen to have an
24270 @texline @math{N\times2}
24271 @infoline Nx2
24272 matrix instead of a
24273 @texline @math{2\times N}
24274 @infoline 2xN
24275 matrix, just press @kbd{v t} first to transpose the matrix.
24276
24277 After you type @kbd{a F}, Calc prompts you to select a model. For a
24278 linear fit, press the digit @kbd{1}.
24279
24280 Calc then prompts for you to name the variables. By default it chooses
24281 high letters like @expr{x} and @expr{y} for independent variables and
24282 low letters like @expr{a} and @expr{b} for parameters. (The dependent
24283 variable doesn't need a name.) The two kinds of variables are separated
24284 by a semicolon. Since you generally care more about the names of the
24285 independent variables than of the parameters, Calc also allows you to
24286 name only those and let the parameters use default names.
24287
24288 For example, suppose the data matrix
24289
24290 @ifnottex
24291 @example
24292 @group
24293 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24294 [ 5, 7, 9, 11, 13 ] ]
24295 @end group
24296 @end example
24297 @end ifnottex
24298 @tex
24299 \turnoffactive
24300 \turnoffactive
24301 \beforedisplay
24302 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 \cr
24303 5 & 7 & 9 & 11 & 13 }
24304 $$
24305 \afterdisplay
24306 @end tex
24307
24308 @noindent
24309 is on the stack and we wish to do a simple linear fit. Type
24310 @kbd{a F}, then @kbd{1} for the model, then @key{RET} to use
24311 the default names. The result will be the formula @expr{3. + 2. x}
24312 on the stack. Calc has created the model expression @kbd{a + b x},
24313 then found the optimal values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} to fit the
24314 data. (In this case, it was able to find an exact fit.) Calc then
24315 substituted those values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} in the model
24316 formula.
24317
24318 The @kbd{a F} command puts two entries in the trail. One is, as
24319 always, a copy of the result that went to the stack; the other is
24320 a vector of the actual parameter values, written as equations:
24321 @expr{[a = 3, b = 2]}, in case you'd rather read them in a list
24322 than pick them out of the formula. (You can type @kbd{t y}
24323 to move this vector to the stack; see @ref{Trail Commands}.
24324
24325 Specifying a different independent variable name will affect the
24326 resulting formula: @kbd{a F 1 k @key{RET}} produces @kbd{3 + 2 k}.
24327 Changing the parameter names (say, @kbd{a F 1 k;b,m @key{RET}}) will affect
24328 the equations that go into the trail.
24329
24330 @tex
24331 \bigskip
24332 @end tex
24333
24334 To see what happens when the fit is not exact, we could change
24335 the number 13 in the data matrix to 14 and try the fit again.
24336 The result is:
24337
24338 @example
24339 2.6 + 2.2 x
24340 @end example
24341
24342 Evaluating this formula, say with @kbd{v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}}, shows
24343 a reasonably close match to the y-values in the data.
24344
24345 @example
24346 [4.8, 7., 9.2, 11.4, 13.6]
24347 @end example
24348
24349 Since there is no line which passes through all the @var{n} data points,
24350 Calc has chosen a line that best approximates the data points using
24351 the method of least squares. The idea is to define the @dfn{chi-square}
24352 error measure
24353
24354 @ifnottex
24355 @example
24356 chi^2 = sum((y_i - (a + b x_i))^2, i, 1, N)
24357 @end example
24358 @end ifnottex
24359 @tex
24360 \turnoffactive
24361 \beforedisplay
24362 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N (y_i - (a + b x_i))^2 $$
24363 \afterdisplay
24364 @end tex
24365
24366 @noindent
24367 which is clearly zero if @expr{a + b x} exactly fits all data points,
24368 and increases as various @expr{a + b x_i} values fail to match the
24369 corresponding @expr{y_i} values. There are several reasons why the
24370 summand is squared, one of them being to ensure that
24371 @texline @math{\chi^2 \ge 0}.
24372 @infoline @expr{chi^2 >= 0}.
24373 Least-squares fitting simply chooses the values of @expr{a} and @expr{b}
24374 for which the error
24375 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24376 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24377 is as small as possible.
24378
24379 Other kinds of models do the same thing but with a different model
24380 formula in place of @expr{a + b x_i}.
24381
24382 @tex
24383 \bigskip
24384 @end tex
24385
24386 A numeric prefix argument causes the @kbd{a F} command to take the
24387 data in some other form than one big matrix. A positive argument @var{n}
24388 will take @var{N} items from the stack, corresponding to the @var{n} rows
24389 of a data matrix. In the linear case, @var{n} must be 2 since there
24390 is always one independent variable and one dependent variable.
24391
24392 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} is a compromise; Calc takes two
24393 items from the stack, an @var{n}-row matrix of @expr{x} values, and a
24394 vector of @expr{y} values. If there is only one independent variable,
24395 the @expr{x} values can be either a one-row matrix or a plain vector,
24396 in which case the @kbd{C-u} prefix is the same as a @w{@kbd{C-u 2}} prefix.
24397
24398 @node Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Error Estimates for Fits, Linear Fits, Curve Fitting
24399 @subsection Polynomial and Multilinear Fits
24400
24401 @noindent
24402 To fit the data to higher-order polynomials, just type one of the
24403 digits @kbd{2} through @kbd{9} when prompted for a model. For example,
24404 we could fit the original data matrix from the previous section
24405 (with 13, not 14) to a parabola instead of a line by typing
24406 @kbd{a F 2 @key{RET}}.
24407
24408 @example
24409 2.00000000001 x - 1.5e-12 x^2 + 2.99999999999
24410 @end example
24411
24412 Note that since the constant and linear terms are enough to fit the
24413 data exactly, it's no surprise that Calc chose a tiny contribution
24414 for @expr{x^2}. (The fact that it's not exactly zero is due only
24415 to roundoff error. Since our data are exact integers, we could get
24416 an exact answer by typing @kbd{m f} first to get Fraction mode.
24417 Then the @expr{x^2} term would vanish altogether. Usually, though,
24418 the data being fitted will be approximate floats so Fraction mode
24419 won't help.)
24420
24421 Doing the @kbd{a F 2} fit on the data set with 14 instead of 13
24422 gives a much larger @expr{x^2} contribution, as Calc bends the
24423 line slightly to improve the fit.
24424
24425 @example
24426 0.142857142855 x^2 + 1.34285714287 x + 3.59999999998
24427 @end example
24428
24429 An important result from the theory of polynomial fitting is that it
24430 is always possible to fit @var{n} data points exactly using a polynomial
24431 of degree @mathit{@var{n}-1}, sometimes called an @dfn{interpolating polynomial}.
24432 Using the modified (14) data matrix, a model number of 4 gives
24433 a polynomial that exactly matches all five data points:
24434
24435 @example
24436 0.04167 x^4 - 0.4167 x^3 + 1.458 x^2 - 0.08333 x + 4.
24437 @end example
24438
24439 The actual coefficients we get with a precision of 12, like
24440 @expr{0.0416666663588}, clearly suffer from loss of precision.
24441 It is a good idea to increase the working precision to several
24442 digits beyond what you need when you do a fitting operation.
24443 Or, if your data are exact, use Fraction mode to get exact
24444 results.
24445
24446 You can type @kbd{i} instead of a digit at the model prompt to fit
24447 the data exactly to a polynomial. This just counts the number of
24448 columns of the data matrix to choose the degree of the polynomial
24449 automatically.
24450
24451 Fitting data ``exactly'' to high-degree polynomials is not always
24452 a good idea, though. High-degree polynomials have a tendency to
24453 wiggle uncontrollably in between the fitting data points. Also,
24454 if the exact-fit polynomial is going to be used to interpolate or
24455 extrapolate the data, it is numerically better to use the @kbd{a p}
24456 command described below. @xref{Interpolation}.
24457
24458 @tex
24459 \bigskip
24460 @end tex
24461
24462 Another generalization of the linear model is to assume the
24463 @expr{y} values are a sum of linear contributions from several
24464 @expr{x} values. This is a @dfn{multilinear} fit, and it is also
24465 selected by the @kbd{1} digit key. (Calc decides whether the fit
24466 is linear or multilinear by counting the rows in the data matrix.)
24467
24468 Given the data matrix,
24469
24470 @example
24471 @group
24472 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24473 [ 7, 2, 3, 5, 2 ]
24474 [ 14.5, 15, 18.5, 22.5, 24 ] ]
24475 @end group
24476 @end example
24477
24478 @noindent
24479 the command @kbd{a F 1 @key{RET}} will call the first row @expr{x} and the
24480 second row @expr{y}, and will fit the values in the third row to the
24481 model @expr{a + b x + c y}.
24482
24483 @example
24484 8. + 3. x + 0.5 y
24485 @end example
24486
24487 Calc can do multilinear fits with any number of independent variables
24488 (i.e., with any number of data rows).
24489
24490 @tex
24491 \bigskip
24492 @end tex
24493
24494 Yet another variation is @dfn{homogeneous} linear models, in which
24495 the constant term is known to be zero. In the linear case, this
24496 means the model formula is simply @expr{a x}; in the multilinear
24497 case, the model might be @expr{a x + b y + c z}; and in the polynomial
24498 case, the model could be @expr{a x + b x^2 + c x^3}. You can get
24499 a homogeneous linear or multilinear model by pressing the letter
24500 @kbd{h} followed by a regular model key, like @kbd{1} or @kbd{2}.
24501 This will be indicated by an ``h'' in the minibuffer after the help
24502 message.
24503
24504 It is certainly possible to have other constrained linear models,
24505 like @expr{2.3 + a x} or @expr{a - 4 x}. While there is no single
24506 key to select models like these, a later section shows how to enter
24507 any desired model by hand. In the first case, for example, you
24508 would enter @kbd{a F ' 2.3 + a x}.
24509
24510 Another class of models that will work but must be entered by hand
24511 are multinomial fits, e.g., @expr{a + b x + c y + d x^2 + e y^2 + f x y}.
24512
24513 @node Error Estimates for Fits, Standard Nonlinear Models, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting
24514 @subsection Error Estimates for Fits
24515
24516 @noindent
24517 @kindex H a F
24518 @tindex efit
24519 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a F} [@code{efit}] performs the same
24520 fitting operation as @kbd{a F}, but reports the coefficients as error
24521 forms instead of plain numbers. Fitting our two data matrices (first
24522 with 13, then with 14) to a line with @kbd{H a F} gives the results,
24523
24524 @example
24525 3. + 2. x
24526 2.6 +/- 0.382970843103 + 2.2 +/- 0.115470053838 x
24527 @end example
24528
24529 In the first case the estimated errors are zero because the linear
24530 fit is perfect. In the second case, the errors are nonzero but
24531 moderately small, because the data are still very close to linear.
24532
24533 It is also possible for the @emph{input} to a fitting operation to
24534 contain error forms. The data values must either all include errors
24535 or all be plain numbers. Error forms can go anywhere but generally
24536 go on the numbers in the last row of the data matrix. If the last
24537 row contains error forms
24538 @texline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@math{\sigma_i}',
24539 @infoline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@var{sigma_i}',
24540 then the
24541 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24542 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24543 statistic is now,
24544
24545 @ifnottex
24546 @example
24547 chi^2 = sum(((y_i - (a + b x_i)) / sigma_i)^2, i, 1, N)
24548 @end example
24549 @end ifnottex
24550 @tex
24551 \turnoffactive
24552 \beforedisplay
24553 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N \left(y_i - (a + b x_i) \over \sigma_i\right)^2 $$
24554 \afterdisplay
24555 @end tex
24556
24557 @noindent
24558 so that data points with larger error estimates contribute less to
24559 the fitting operation.
24560
24561 If there are error forms on other rows of the data matrix, all the
24562 errors for a given data point are combined; the square root of the
24563 sum of the squares of the errors forms the
24564 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24565 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24566 used for the data point.
24567
24568 Both @kbd{a F} and @kbd{H a F} can accept error forms in the input
24569 matrix, although if you are concerned about error analysis you will
24570 probably use @kbd{H a F} so that the output also contains error
24571 estimates.
24572
24573 If the input contains error forms but all the
24574 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24575 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24576 values are the same, it is easy to see that the resulting fitted model
24577 will be the same as if the input did not have error forms at all
24578 @texline (@math{\chi^2}
24579 @infoline (@expr{chi^2}
24580 is simply scaled uniformly by
24581 @texline @math{1 / \sigma^2},
24582 @infoline @expr{1 / sigma^2},
24583 which doesn't affect where it has a minimum). But there @emph{will} be
24584 a difference in the estimated errors of the coefficients reported by
24585 @kbd{H a F}.
24586
24587 Consult any text on statistical modeling of data for a discussion
24588 of where these error estimates come from and how they should be
24589 interpreted.
24590
24591 @tex
24592 \bigskip
24593 @end tex
24594
24595 @kindex I a F
24596 @tindex xfit
24597 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] produces even more
24598 information. The result is a vector of six items:
24599
24600 @enumerate
24601 @item
24602 The model formula with error forms for its coefficients or
24603 parameters. This is the result that @kbd{H a F} would have
24604 produced.
24605
24606 @item
24607 A vector of ``raw'' parameter values for the model. These are the
24608 polynomial coefficients or other parameters as plain numbers, in the
24609 same order as the parameters appeared in the final prompt of the
24610 @kbd{I a F} command. For polynomials of degree @expr{d}, this vector
24611 will have length @expr{M = d+1} with the constant term first.
24612
24613 @item
24614 The covariance matrix @expr{C} computed from the fit. This is
24615 an @var{m}x@var{m} symmetric matrix; the diagonal elements
24616 @texline @math{C_{jj}}
24617 @infoline @expr{C_j_j}
24618 are the variances
24619 @texline @math{\sigma_j^2}
24620 @infoline @expr{sigma_j^2}
24621 of the parameters. The other elements are covariances
24622 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2}
24623 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2}
24624 that describe the correlation between pairs of parameters. (A related
24625 set of numbers, the @dfn{linear correlation coefficients}
24626 @texline @math{r_{ij}},
24627 @infoline @expr{r_i_j},
24628 are defined as
24629 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2 / \sigma_i \, \sigma_j}.)
24630 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2 / sigma_i sigma_j}.)
24631
24632 @item
24633 A vector of @expr{M} ``parameter filter'' functions whose
24634 meanings are described below. If no filters are necessary this
24635 will instead be an empty vector; this is always the case for the
24636 polynomial and multilinear fits described so far.
24637
24638 @item
24639 The value of
24640 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24641 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24642 for the fit, calculated by the formulas shown above. This gives a
24643 measure of the quality of the fit; statisticians consider
24644 @texline @math{\chi^2 \approx N - M}
24645 @infoline @expr{chi^2 = N - M}
24646 to indicate a moderately good fit (where again @expr{N} is the number of
24647 data points and @expr{M} is the number of parameters).
24648
24649 @item
24650 A measure of goodness of fit expressed as a probability @expr{Q}.
24651 This is computed from the @code{utpc} probability distribution
24652 function using
24653 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24654 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24655 with @expr{N - M} degrees of freedom. A
24656 value of 0.5 implies a good fit; some texts recommend that often
24657 @expr{Q = 0.1} or even 0.001 can signify an acceptable fit. In
24658 particular,
24659 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24660 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24661 statistics assume the errors in your inputs
24662 follow a normal (Gaussian) distribution; if they don't, you may
24663 have to accept smaller values of @expr{Q}.
24664
24665 The @expr{Q} value is computed only if the input included error
24666 estimates. Otherwise, Calc will report the symbol @code{nan}
24667 for @expr{Q}. The reason is that in this case the
24668 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24669 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24670 value has effectively been used to estimate the original errors
24671 in the input, and thus there is no redundant information left
24672 over to use for a confidence test.
24673 @end enumerate
24674
24675 @node Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting Details, Error Estimates for Fits, Curve Fitting
24676 @subsection Standard Nonlinear Models
24677
24678 @noindent
24679 The @kbd{a F} command also accepts other kinds of models besides
24680 lines and polynomials. Some common models have quick single-key
24681 abbreviations; others must be entered by hand as algebraic formulas.
24682
24683 Here is a complete list of the standard models recognized by @kbd{a F}:
24684
24685 @table @kbd
24686 @item 1
24687 Linear or multilinear. @mathit{a + b x + c y + d z}.
24688 @item 2-9
24689 Polynomials. @mathit{a + b x + c x^2 + d x^3}.
24690 @item e
24691 Exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(c y)}.
24692 @item E
24693 Base-10 exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(c y)}.
24694 @item x
24695 Exponential (alternate notation). @tfn{exp}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24696 @item X
24697 Base-10 exponential (alternate). @tfn{10^}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24698 @item l
24699 Logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(y)}.
24700 @item L
24701 Base-10 logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(y)}.
24702 @item ^
24703 General exponential. @mathit{a b^x c^y}.
24704 @item p
24705 Power law. @mathit{a x^b y^c}.
24706 @item q
24707 Quadratic. @mathit{a + b (x-c)^2 + d (x-e)^2}.
24708 @item g
24709 Gaussian.
24710 @texline @math{{a \over b \sqrt{2 \pi}} \exp\left( -{1 \over 2} \left( x - c \over b \right)^2 \right)}.
24711 @infoline @mathit{(a / b sqrt(2 pi)) exp(-0.5*((x-c)/b)^2)}.
24712 @item s
24713 Logistic @emph{s} curve.
24714 @texline @math{a/(1+e^{b(x-c)})}.
24715 @infoline @mathit{a/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))}.
24716 @item b
24717 Logistic bell curve.
24718 @texline @math{ae^{b(x-c)}/(1+e^{b(x-c)})^2}.
24719 @infoline @mathit{a exp(b (x - c))/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))^2}.
24720 @item o
24721 Hubbert linearization.
24722 @texline @math{{y \over x} = a(1-x/b)}.
24723 @infoline @mathit{(y/x) = a (1 - x/b)}.
24724 @end table
24725
24726 All of these models are used in the usual way; just press the appropriate
24727 letter at the model prompt, and choose variable names if you wish. The
24728 result will be a formula as shown in the above table, with the best-fit
24729 values of the parameters substituted. (You may find it easier to read
24730 the parameter values from the vector that is placed in the trail.)
24731
24732 All models except Gaussian, logistics, Hubbert and polynomials can
24733 generalize as shown to any number of independent variables. Also, all
24734 the built-in models except for the logistic and Hubbert curves have an
24735 additive or multiplicative parameter shown as @expr{a} in the above table
24736 which can be replaced by zero or one, as appropriate, by typing @kbd{h}
24737 before the model key.
24738
24739 Note that many of these models are essentially equivalent, but express
24740 the parameters slightly differently. For example, @expr{a b^x} and
24741 the other two exponential models are all algebraic rearrangements of
24742 each other. Also, the ``quadratic'' model is just a degree-2 polynomial
24743 with the parameters expressed differently. Use whichever form best
24744 matches the problem.
24745
24746 The HP-28/48 calculators support four different models for curve
24747 fitting, called @code{LIN}, @code{LOG}, @code{EXP}, and @code{PWR}.
24748 These correspond to Calc models @samp{a + b x}, @samp{a + b ln(x)},
24749 @samp{a exp(b x)}, and @samp{a x^b}, respectively. In each case,
24750 @expr{a} is what the HP-48 identifies as the ``intercept,'' and
24751 @expr{b} is what it calls the ``slope.''
24752
24753 @tex
24754 \bigskip
24755 @end tex
24756
24757 If the model you want doesn't appear on this list, press @kbd{'}
24758 (the apostrophe key) at the model prompt to enter any algebraic
24759 formula, such as @kbd{m x - b}, as the model. (Not all models
24760 will work, though---see the next section for details.)
24761
24762 The model can also be an equation like @expr{y = m x + b}.
24763 In this case, Calc thinks of all the rows of the data matrix on
24764 equal terms; this model effectively has two parameters
24765 (@expr{m} and @expr{b}) and two independent variables (@expr{x}
24766 and @expr{y}), with no ``dependent'' variables. Model equations
24767 do not need to take this @expr{y =} form. For example, the
24768 implicit line equation @expr{a x + b y = 1} works fine as a
24769 model.
24770
24771 When you enter a model, Calc makes an alphabetical list of all
24772 the variables that appear in the model. These are used for the
24773 default parameters, independent variables, and dependent variable
24774 (in that order). If you enter a plain formula (not an equation),
24775 Calc assumes the dependent variable does not appear in the formula
24776 and thus does not need a name.
24777
24778 For example, if the model formula has the variables @expr{a,mu,sigma,t,x},
24779 and the data matrix has three rows (meaning two independent variables),
24780 Calc will use @expr{a,mu,sigma} as the default parameters, and the
24781 data rows will be named @expr{t} and @expr{x}, respectively. If you
24782 enter an equation instead of a plain formula, Calc will use @expr{a,mu}
24783 as the parameters, and @expr{sigma,t,x} as the three independent
24784 variables.
24785
24786 You can, of course, override these choices by entering something
24787 different at the prompt. If you leave some variables out of the list,
24788 those variables must have stored values and those stored values will
24789 be used as constants in the model. (Stored values for the parameters
24790 and independent variables are ignored by the @kbd{a F} command.)
24791 If you list only independent variables, all the remaining variables
24792 in the model formula will become parameters.
24793
24794 If there are @kbd{$} signs in the model you type, they will stand
24795 for parameters and all other variables (in alphabetical order)
24796 will be independent. Use @kbd{$} for one parameter, @kbd{$$} for
24797 another, and so on. Thus @kbd{$ x + $$} is another way to describe
24798 a linear model.
24799
24800 If you type a @kbd{$} instead of @kbd{'} at the model prompt itself,
24801 Calc will take the model formula from the stack. (The data must then
24802 appear at the second stack level.) The same conventions are used to
24803 choose which variables in the formula are independent by default and
24804 which are parameters.
24805
24806 Models taken from the stack can also be expressed as vectors of
24807 two or three elements, @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}]} or
24808 @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}]}. Each of @var{vars}
24809 and @var{params} may be either a variable or a vector of variables.
24810 (If @var{params} is omitted, all variables in @var{model} except
24811 those listed as @var{vars} are parameters.)
24812
24813 When you enter a model manually with @kbd{'}, Calc puts a 3-vector
24814 describing the model in the trail so you can get it back if you wish.
24815
24816 @tex
24817 \bigskip
24818 @end tex
24819
24820 @vindex Model1
24821 @vindex Model2
24822 Finally, you can store a model in one of the Calc variables
24823 @code{Model1} or @code{Model2}, then use this model by typing
24824 @kbd{a F u} or @kbd{a F U} (respectively). The value stored in
24825 the variable can be any of the formats that @kbd{a F $} would
24826 accept for a model on the stack.
24827
24828 @tex
24829 \bigskip
24830 @end tex
24831
24832 Calc uses the principal values of inverse functions like @code{ln}
24833 and @code{arcsin} when doing fits. For example, when you enter
24834 the model @samp{y = sin(a t + b)} Calc actually uses the easier
24835 form @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b}. The @code{arcsin} function always
24836 returns results in the range from @mathit{-90} to 90 degrees (or the
24837 equivalent range in radians). Suppose you had data that you
24838 believed to represent roughly three oscillations of a sine wave,
24839 so that the argument of the sine might go from zero to
24840 @texline @math{3\times360}
24841 @infoline @mathit{3*360}
24842 degrees.
24843 The above model would appear to be a good way to determine the
24844 true frequency and phase of the sine wave, but in practice it
24845 would fail utterly. The righthand side of the actual model
24846 @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b} will grow smoothly with @expr{t}, but
24847 the lefthand side will bounce back and forth between @mathit{-90} and 90.
24848 No values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} can make the two sides match,
24849 even approximately.
24850
24851 There is no good solution to this problem at present. You could
24852 restrict your data to small enough ranges so that the above problem
24853 doesn't occur (i.e., not straddling any peaks in the sine wave).
24854 Or, in this case, you could use a totally different method such as
24855 Fourier analysis, which is beyond the scope of the @kbd{a F} command.
24856 (Unfortunately, Calc does not currently have any facilities for
24857 taking Fourier and related transforms.)
24858
24859 @node Curve Fitting Details, Interpolation, Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting
24860 @subsection Curve Fitting Details
24861
24862 @noindent
24863 Calc's internal least-squares fitter can only handle multilinear
24864 models. More precisely, it can handle any model of the form
24865 @expr{a f(x,y,z) + b g(x,y,z) + c h(x,y,z)}, where @expr{a,b,c}
24866 are the parameters and @expr{x,y,z} are the independent variables
24867 (of course there can be any number of each, not just three).
24868
24869 In a simple multilinear or polynomial fit, it is easy to see how
24870 to convert the model into this form. For example, if the model
24871 is @expr{a + b x + c x^2}, then @expr{f(x) = 1}, @expr{g(x) = x},
24872 and @expr{h(x) = x^2} are suitable functions.
24873
24874 For most other models, Calc uses a variety of algebraic manipulations
24875 to try to put the problem into the form
24876
24877 @smallexample
24878 Y(x,y,z) = A(a,b,c) F(x,y,z) + B(a,b,c) G(x,y,z) + C(a,b,c) H(x,y,z)
24879 @end smallexample
24880
24881 @noindent
24882 where @expr{Y,A,B,C,F,G,H} are arbitrary functions. It computes
24883 @expr{Y}, @expr{F}, @expr{G}, and @expr{H} for all the data points,
24884 does a standard linear fit to find the values of @expr{A}, @expr{B},
24885 and @expr{C}, then uses the equation solver to solve for @expr{a,b,c}
24886 in terms of @expr{A,B,C}.
24887
24888 A remarkable number of models can be cast into this general form.
24889 We'll look at two examples here to see how it works. The power-law
24890 model @expr{y = a x^b} with two independent variables and two parameters
24891 can be rewritten as follows:
24892
24893 @example
24894 y = a x^b
24895 y = a exp(b ln(x))
24896 y = exp(ln(a) + b ln(x))
24897 ln(y) = ln(a) + b ln(x)
24898 @end example
24899
24900 @noindent
24901 which matches the desired form with
24902 @texline @math{Y = \ln(y)},
24903 @infoline @expr{Y = ln(y)},
24904 @texline @math{A = \ln(a)},
24905 @infoline @expr{A = ln(a)},
24906 @expr{F = 1}, @expr{B = b}, and
24907 @texline @math{G = \ln(x)}.
24908 @infoline @expr{G = ln(x)}.
24909 Calc thus computes the logarithms of your @expr{y} and @expr{x} values,
24910 does a linear fit for @expr{A} and @expr{B}, then solves to get
24911 @texline @math{a = \exp(A)}
24912 @infoline @expr{a = exp(A)}
24913 and @expr{b = B}.
24914
24915 Another interesting example is the ``quadratic'' model, which can
24916 be handled by expanding according to the distributive law.
24917
24918 @example
24919 y = a + b*(x - c)^2
24920 y = a + b c^2 - 2 b c x + b x^2
24921 @end example
24922
24923 @noindent
24924 which matches with @expr{Y = y}, @expr{A = a + b c^2}, @expr{F = 1},
24925 @expr{B = -2 b c}, @expr{G = x} (the @mathit{-2} factor could just as easily
24926 have been put into @expr{G} instead of @expr{B}), @expr{C = b}, and
24927 @expr{H = x^2}.
24928
24929 The Gaussian model looks quite complicated, but a closer examination
24930 shows that it's actually similar to the quadratic model but with an
24931 exponential that can be brought to the top and moved into @expr{Y}.
24932
24933 The logistic models cannot be put into general linear form. For these
24934 models, and the Hubbert linearization, Calc computes a rough
24935 approximation for the parameters, then uses the Levenberg-Marquardt
24936 iterative method to refine the approximations.
24937
24938 Another model that cannot be put into general linear
24939 form is a Gaussian with a constant background added on, i.e.,
24940 @expr{d} + the regular Gaussian formula. If you have a model like
24941 this, your best bet is to replace enough of your parameters with
24942 constants to make the model linearizable, then adjust the constants
24943 manually by doing a series of fits. You can compare the fits by
24944 graphing them, by examining the goodness-of-fit measures returned by
24945 @kbd{I a F}, or by some other method suitable to your application.
24946 Note that some models can be linearized in several ways. The
24947 Gaussian-plus-@var{d} model can be linearized by setting @expr{d}
24948 (the background) to a constant, or by setting @expr{b} (the standard
24949 deviation) and @expr{c} (the mean) to constants.
24950
24951 To fit a model with constants substituted for some parameters, just
24952 store suitable values in those parameter variables, then omit them
24953 from the list of parameters when you answer the variables prompt.
24954
24955 @tex
24956 \bigskip
24957 @end tex
24958
24959 A last desperate step would be to use the general-purpose
24960 @code{minimize} function rather than @code{fit}. After all, both
24961 functions solve the problem of minimizing an expression (the
24962 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24963 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24964 sum) by adjusting certain parameters in the expression. The @kbd{a F}
24965 command is able to use a vastly more efficient algorithm due to its
24966 special knowledge about linear chi-square sums, but the @kbd{a N}
24967 command can do the same thing by brute force.
24968
24969 A compromise would be to pick out a few parameters without which the
24970 fit is linearizable, and use @code{minimize} on a call to @code{fit}
24971 which efficiently takes care of the rest of the parameters. The thing
24972 to be minimized would be the value of
24973 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24974 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24975 returned as the fifth result of the @code{xfit} function:
24976
24977 @smallexample
24978 minimize(xfit(gaus(a,b,c,d,x), x, [a,b,c], data)_5, d, guess)
24979 @end smallexample
24980
24981 @noindent
24982 where @code{gaus} represents the Gaussian model with background,
24983 @code{data} represents the data matrix, and @code{guess} represents
24984 the initial guess for @expr{d} that @code{minimize} requires.
24985 This operation will only be, shall we say, extraordinarily slow
24986 rather than astronomically slow (as would be the case if @code{minimize}
24987 were used by itself to solve the problem).
24988
24989 @tex
24990 \bigskip
24991 @end tex
24992
24993 The @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] command is somewhat trickier when
24994 nonlinear models are used. The second item in the result is the
24995 vector of ``raw'' parameters @expr{A}, @expr{B}, @expr{C}. The
24996 covariance matrix is written in terms of those raw parameters.
24997 The fifth item is a vector of @dfn{filter} expressions. This
24998 is the empty vector @samp{[]} if the raw parameters were the same
24999 as the requested parameters, i.e., if @expr{A = a}, @expr{B = b},
25000 and so on (which is always true if the model is already linear
25001 in the parameters as written, e.g., for polynomial fits). If the
25002 parameters had to be rearranged, the fifth item is instead a vector
25003 of one formula per parameter in the original model. The raw
25004 parameters are expressed in these ``filter'' formulas as
25005 @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)} for @expr{B},
25006 and so on.
25007
25008 When Calc needs to modify the model to return the result, it replaces
25009 @samp{fitdummy(1)} in all the filters with the first item in the raw
25010 parameters list, and so on for the other raw parameters, then
25011 evaluates the resulting filter formulas to get the actual parameter
25012 values to be substituted into the original model. In the case of
25013 @kbd{H a F} and @kbd{I a F} where the parameters must be error forms,
25014 Calc uses the square roots of the diagonal entries of the covariance
25015 matrix as error values for the raw parameters, then lets Calc's
25016 standard error-form arithmetic take it from there.
25017
25018 If you use @kbd{I a F} with a nonlinear model, be sure to remember
25019 that the covariance matrix is in terms of the raw parameters,
25020 @emph{not} the actual requested parameters. It's up to you to
25021 figure out how to interpret the covariances in the presence of
25022 nontrivial filter functions.
25023
25024 Things are also complicated when the input contains error forms.
25025 Suppose there are three independent and dependent variables, @expr{x},
25026 @expr{y}, and @expr{z}, one or more of which are error forms in the
25027 data. Calc combines all the error values by taking the square root
25028 of the sum of the squares of the errors. It then changes @expr{x}
25029 and @expr{y} to be plain numbers, and makes @expr{z} into an error
25030 form with this combined error. The @expr{Y(x,y,z)} part of the
25031 linearized model is evaluated, and the result should be an error
25032 form. The error part of that result is used for
25033 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
25034 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
25035 for the data point. If for some reason @expr{Y(x,y,z)} does not return
25036 an error form, the combined error from @expr{z} is used directly for
25037 @texline @math{\sigma_i}.
25038 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}.
25039 Finally, @expr{z} is also stripped of its error
25040 for use in computing @expr{F(x,y,z)}, @expr{G(x,y,z)} and so on;
25041 the righthand side of the linearized model is computed in regular
25042 arithmetic with no error forms.
25043
25044 (While these rules may seem complicated, they are designed to do
25045 the most reasonable thing in the typical case that @expr{Y(x,y,z)}
25046 depends only on the dependent variable @expr{z}, and in fact is
25047 often simply equal to @expr{z}. For common cases like polynomials
25048 and multilinear models, the combined error is simply used as the
25049 @texline @math{\sigma}
25050 @infoline @expr{sigma}
25051 for the data point with no further ado.)
25052
25053 @tex
25054 \bigskip
25055 @end tex
25056
25057 @vindex FitRules
25058 It may be the case that the model you wish to use is linearizable,
25059 but Calc's built-in rules are unable to figure it out. Calc uses
25060 its algebraic rewrite mechanism to linearize a model. The rewrite
25061 rules are kept in the variable @code{FitRules}. You can edit this
25062 variable using the @kbd{s e FitRules} command; in fact, there is
25063 a special @kbd{s F} command just for editing @code{FitRules}.
25064 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
25065
25066 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of rewrite rules.
25067
25068 @ignore
25069 @starindex
25070 @end ignore
25071 @tindex fitvar
25072 @ignore
25073 @starindex
25074 @end ignore
25075 @ignore
25076 @mindex @idots
25077 @end ignore
25078 @tindex fitparam
25079 @ignore
25080 @starindex
25081 @end ignore
25082 @ignore
25083 @mindex @null
25084 @end ignore
25085 @tindex fitmodel
25086 @ignore
25087 @starindex
25088 @end ignore
25089 @ignore
25090 @mindex @null
25091 @end ignore
25092 @tindex fitsystem
25093 @ignore
25094 @starindex
25095 @end ignore
25096 @ignore
25097 @mindex @null
25098 @end ignore
25099 @tindex fitdummy
25100 Calc uses @code{FitRules} as follows. First, it converts the model
25101 to an equation if necessary and encloses the model equation in a
25102 call to the function @code{fitmodel} (which is not actually a defined
25103 function in Calc; it is only used as a placeholder by the rewrite rules).
25104 Parameter variables are renamed to function calls @samp{fitparam(1)},
25105 @samp{fitparam(2)}, and so on, and independent variables are renamed
25106 to @samp{fitvar(1)}, @samp{fitvar(2)}, etc. The dependent variable
25107 is the highest-numbered @code{fitvar}. For example, the power law
25108 model @expr{a x^b} is converted to @expr{y = a x^b}, then to
25109
25110 @smallexample
25111 @group
25112 fitmodel(fitvar(2) = fitparam(1) fitvar(1)^fitparam(2))
25113 @end group
25114 @end smallexample
25115
25116 Calc then applies the rewrites as if by @samp{C-u 0 a r FitRules}.
25117 (The zero prefix means that rewriting should continue until no further
25118 changes are possible.)
25119
25120 When rewriting is complete, the @code{fitmodel} call should have
25121 been replaced by a @code{fitsystem} call that looks like this:
25122
25123 @example
25124 fitsystem(@var{Y}, @var{FGH}, @var{abc})
25125 @end example
25126
25127 @noindent
25128 where @var{Y} is a formula that describes the function @expr{Y(x,y,z)},
25129 @var{FGH} is the vector of formulas @expr{[F(x,y,z), G(x,y,z), H(x,y,z)]},
25130 and @var{abc} is the vector of parameter filters which refer to the
25131 raw parameters as @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)}
25132 for @expr{B}, etc. While the number of raw parameters (the length of
25133 the @var{FGH} vector) is usually the same as the number of original
25134 parameters (the length of the @var{abc} vector), this is not required.
25135
25136 The power law model eventually boils down to
25137
25138 @smallexample
25139 @group
25140 fitsystem(ln(fitvar(2)),
25141 [1, ln(fitvar(1))],
25142 [exp(fitdummy(1)), fitdummy(2)])
25143 @end group
25144 @end smallexample
25145
25146 The actual implementation of @code{FitRules} is complicated; it
25147 proceeds in four phases. First, common rearrangements are done
25148 to try to bring linear terms together and to isolate functions like
25149 @code{exp} and @code{ln} either all the way ``out'' (so that they
25150 can be put into @var{Y}) or all the way ``in'' (so that they can
25151 be put into @var{abc} or @var{FGH}). In particular, all
25152 non-constant powers are converted to logs-and-exponentials form,
25153 and the distributive law is used to expand products of sums.
25154 Quotients are rewritten to use the @samp{fitinv} function, where
25155 @samp{fitinv(x)} represents @expr{1/x} while the @code{FitRules}
25156 are operating. (The use of @code{fitinv} makes recognition of
25157 linear-looking forms easier.) If you modify @code{FitRules}, you
25158 will probably only need to modify the rules for this phase.
25159
25160 Phase two, whose rules can actually also apply during phases one
25161 and three, first rewrites @code{fitmodel} to a two-argument
25162 form @samp{fitmodel(@var{Y}, @var{model})}, where @var{Y} is
25163 initially zero and @var{model} has been changed from @expr{a=b}
25164 to @expr{a-b} form. It then tries to peel off invertible functions
25165 from the outside of @var{model} and put them into @var{Y} instead,
25166 calling the equation solver to invert the functions. Finally, when
25167 this is no longer possible, the @code{fitmodel} is changed to a
25168 four-argument @code{fitsystem}, where the fourth argument is
25169 @var{model} and the @var{FGH} and @var{abc} vectors are initially
25170 empty. (The last vector is really @var{ABC}, corresponding to
25171 raw parameters, for now.)
25172
25173 Phase three converts a sum of items in the @var{model} to a sum
25174 of @samp{fitpart(@var{a}, @var{b}, @var{c})} terms which represent
25175 terms @samp{@var{a}*@var{b}*@var{c}} of the sum, where @var{a}
25176 is all factors that do not involve any variables, @var{b} is all
25177 factors that involve only parameters, and @var{c} is the factors
25178 that involve only independent variables. (If this decomposition
25179 is not possible, the rule set will not complete and Calc will
25180 complain that the model is too complex.) Then @code{fitpart}s
25181 with equal @var{b} or @var{c} components are merged back together
25182 using the distributive law in order to minimize the number of
25183 raw parameters needed.
25184
25185 Phase four moves the @code{fitpart} terms into the @var{FGH} and
25186 @var{ABC} vectors. Also, some of the algebraic expansions that
25187 were done in phase 1 are undone now to make the formulas more
25188 computationally efficient. Finally, it calls the solver one more
25189 time to convert the @var{ABC} vector to an @var{abc} vector, and
25190 removes the fourth @var{model} argument (which by now will be zero)
25191 to obtain the three-argument @code{fitsystem} that the linear
25192 least-squares solver wants to see.
25193
25194 @ignore
25195 @starindex
25196 @end ignore
25197 @ignore
25198 @mindex hasfit@idots
25199 @end ignore
25200 @tindex hasfitparams
25201 @ignore
25202 @starindex
25203 @end ignore
25204 @ignore
25205 @mindex @null
25206 @end ignore
25207 @tindex hasfitvars
25208 Two functions which are useful in connection with @code{FitRules}
25209 are @samp{hasfitparams(x)} and @samp{hasfitvars(x)}, which check
25210 whether @expr{x} refers to any parameters or independent variables,
25211 respectively. Specifically, these functions return ``true'' if the
25212 argument contains any @code{fitparam} (or @code{fitvar}) function
25213 calls, and ``false'' otherwise. (Recall that ``true'' means a
25214 nonzero number, and ``false'' means zero. The actual nonzero number
25215 returned is the largest @var{n} from all the @samp{fitparam(@var{n})}s
25216 or @samp{fitvar(@var{n})}s, respectively, that appear in the formula.)
25217
25218 @tex
25219 \bigskip
25220 @end tex
25221
25222 The @code{fit} function in algebraic notation normally takes four
25223 arguments, @samp{fit(@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}, @var{data})},
25224 where @var{model} is the model formula as it would be typed after
25225 @kbd{a F '}, @var{vars} is the independent variable or a vector of
25226 independent variables, @var{params} likewise gives the parameter(s),
25227 and @var{data} is the data matrix. Note that the length of @var{vars}
25228 must be equal to the number of rows in @var{data} if @var{model} is
25229 an equation, or one less than the number of rows if @var{model} is
25230 a plain formula. (Actually, a name for the dependent variable is
25231 allowed but will be ignored in the plain-formula case.)
25232
25233 If @var{params} is omitted, the parameters are all variables in
25234 @var{model} except those that appear in @var{vars}. If @var{vars}
25235 is also omitted, Calc sorts all the variables that appear in
25236 @var{model} alphabetically and uses the higher ones for @var{vars}
25237 and the lower ones for @var{params}.
25238
25239 Alternatively, @samp{fit(@var{modelvec}, @var{data})} is allowed
25240 where @var{modelvec} is a 2- or 3-vector describing the model
25241 and variables, as discussed previously.
25242
25243 If Calc is unable to do the fit, the @code{fit} function is left
25244 in symbolic form, ordinarily with an explanatory message. The
25245 message will be ``Model expression is too complex'' if the
25246 linearizer was unable to put the model into the required form.
25247
25248 The @code{efit} (corresponding to @kbd{H a F}) and @code{xfit}
25249 (for @kbd{I a F}) functions are completely analogous.
25250
25251 @node Interpolation, , Curve Fitting Details, Curve Fitting
25252 @subsection Polynomial Interpolation
25253
25254 @kindex a p
25255 @pindex calc-poly-interp
25256 @tindex polint
25257 The @kbd{a p} (@code{calc-poly-interp}) [@code{polint}] command does
25258 a polynomial interpolation at a particular @expr{x} value. It takes
25259 two arguments from the stack: A data matrix of the sort used by
25260 @kbd{a F}, and a single number which represents the desired @expr{x}
25261 value. Calc effectively does an exact polynomial fit as if by @kbd{a F i},
25262 then substitutes the @expr{x} value into the result in order to get an
25263 approximate @expr{y} value based on the fit. (Calc does not actually
25264 use @kbd{a F i}, however; it uses a direct method which is both more
25265 efficient and more numerically stable.)
25266
25267 The result of @kbd{a p} is actually a vector of two values: The @expr{y}
25268 value approximation, and an error measure @expr{dy} that reflects Calc's
25269 estimation of the probable error of the approximation at that value of
25270 @expr{x}. If the input @expr{x} is equal to any of the @expr{x} values
25271 in the data matrix, the output @expr{y} will be the corresponding @expr{y}
25272 value from the matrix, and the output @expr{dy} will be exactly zero.
25273
25274 A prefix argument of 2 causes @kbd{a p} to take separate x- and
25275 y-vectors from the stack instead of one data matrix.
25276
25277 If @expr{x} is a vector of numbers, @kbd{a p} will return a matrix of
25278 interpolated results for each of those @expr{x} values. (The matrix will
25279 have two columns, the @expr{y} values and the @expr{dy} values.)
25280 If @expr{x} is a formula instead of a number, the @code{polint} function
25281 remains in symbolic form; use the @kbd{a "} command to expand it out to
25282 a formula that describes the fit in symbolic terms.
25283
25284 In all cases, the @kbd{a p} command leaves the data vectors or matrix
25285 on the stack. Only the @expr{x} value is replaced by the result.
25286
25287 @kindex H a p
25288 @tindex ratint
25289 The @kbd{H a p} [@code{ratint}] command does a rational function
25290 interpolation. It is used exactly like @kbd{a p}, except that it
25291 uses as its model the quotient of two polynomials. If there are
25292 @expr{N} data points, the numerator and denominator polynomials will
25293 each have degree @expr{N/2} (if @expr{N} is odd, the denominator will
25294 have degree one higher than the numerator).
25295
25296 Rational approximations have the advantage that they can accurately
25297 describe functions that have poles (points at which the function's value
25298 goes to infinity, so that the denominator polynomial of the approximation
25299 goes to zero). If @expr{x} corresponds to a pole of the fitted rational
25300 function, then the result will be a division by zero. If Infinite mode
25301 is enabled, the result will be @samp{[uinf, uinf]}.
25302
25303 There is no way to get the actual coefficients of the rational function
25304 used by @kbd{H a p}. (The algorithm never generates these coefficients
25305 explicitly, and quotients of polynomials are beyond @w{@kbd{a F}}'s
25306 capabilities to fit.)
25307
25308 @node Summations, Logical Operations, Curve Fitting, Algebra
25309 @section Summations
25310
25311 @noindent
25312 @cindex Summation of a series
25313 @kindex a +
25314 @pindex calc-summation
25315 @tindex sum
25316 The @kbd{a +} (@code{calc-summation}) [@code{sum}] command computes
25317 the sum of a formula over a certain range of index values. The formula
25318 is taken from the top of the stack; the command prompts for the
25319 name of the summation index variable, the lower limit of the
25320 sum (any formula), and the upper limit of the sum. If you
25321 enter a blank line at any of these prompts, that prompt and
25322 any later ones are answered by reading additional elements from
25323 the stack. Thus, @kbd{' k^2 @key{RET} ' k @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 5 @key{RET} a + @key{RET}}
25324 produces the result 55.
25325 @tex
25326 \turnoffactive
25327 $$ \sum_{k=1}^5 k^2 = 55 $$
25328 @end tex
25329
25330 The choice of index variable is arbitrary, but it's best not to
25331 use a variable with a stored value. In particular, while
25332 @code{i} is often a favorite index variable, it should be avoided
25333 in Calc because @code{i} has the imaginary constant @expr{(0, 1)}
25334 as a value. If you pressed @kbd{=} on a sum over @code{i}, it would
25335 be changed to a nonsensical sum over the ``variable'' @expr{(0, 1)}!
25336 If you really want to use @code{i} as an index variable, use
25337 @w{@kbd{s u i @key{RET}}} first to ``unstore'' this variable.
25338 (@xref{Storing Variables}.)
25339
25340 A numeric prefix argument steps the index by that amount rather
25341 than by one. Thus @kbd{' a_k @key{RET} C-u -2 a + k @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 0 @key{RET}}
25342 yields @samp{a_10 + a_8 + a_6 + a_4 + a_2 + a_0}. A prefix
25343 argument of plain @kbd{C-u} causes @kbd{a +} to prompt for the
25344 step value, in which case you can enter any formula or enter
25345 a blank line to take the step value from the stack. With the
25346 @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{a +} can take up to five arguments from
25347 the stack: The formula, the variable, the lower limit, the
25348 upper limit, and (at the top of the stack), the step value.
25349
25350 Calc knows how to do certain sums in closed form. For example,
25351 @samp{sum(6 k^2, k, 1, n) = @w{2 n^3} + 3 n^2 + n}. In particular,
25352 this is possible if the formula being summed is polynomial or
25353 exponential in the index variable. Sums of logarithms are
25354 transformed into logarithms of products. Sums of trigonometric
25355 and hyperbolic functions are transformed to sums of exponentials
25356 and then done in closed form. Also, of course, sums in which the
25357 lower and upper limits are both numbers can always be evaluated
25358 just by grinding them out, although Calc will use closed forms
25359 whenever it can for the sake of efficiency.
25360
25361 The notation for sums in algebraic formulas is
25362 @samp{sum(@var{expr}, @var{var}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{step})}.
25363 If @var{step} is omitted, it defaults to one. If @var{high} is
25364 omitted, @var{low} is actually the upper limit and the lower limit
25365 is one. If @var{low} is also omitted, the limits are @samp{-inf}
25366 and @samp{inf}, respectively.
25367
25368 Infinite sums can sometimes be evaluated: @samp{sum(.5^k, k, 1, inf)}
25369 returns @expr{1}. This is done by evaluating the sum in closed
25370 form (to @samp{1. - 0.5^n} in this case), then evaluating this
25371 formula with @code{n} set to @code{inf}. Calc's usual rules
25372 for ``infinite'' arithmetic can find the answer from there. If
25373 infinite arithmetic yields a @samp{nan}, or if the sum cannot be
25374 solved in closed form, Calc leaves the @code{sum} function in
25375 symbolic form. @xref{Infinities}.
25376
25377 As a special feature, if the limits are infinite (or omitted, as
25378 described above) but the formula includes vectors subscripted by
25379 expressions that involve the iteration variable, Calc narrows
25380 the limits to include only the range of integers which result in
25381 valid subscripts for the vector. For example, the sum
25382 @samp{sum(k [a,b,c,d,e,f,g]_(2k),k)} evaluates to @samp{b + 2 d + 3 f}.
25383
25384 The limits of a sum do not need to be integers. For example,
25385 @samp{sum(a_k, k, 0, 2 n, n)} produces @samp{a_0 + a_n + a_(2 n)}.
25386 Calc computes the number of iterations using the formula
25387 @samp{1 + (@var{high} - @var{low}) / @var{step}}, which must,
25388 after simplification as if by @kbd{a s}, evaluate to an integer.
25389
25390 If the number of iterations according to the above formula does
25391 not come out to an integer, the sum is invalid and will be left
25392 in symbolic form. However, closed forms are still supplied, and
25393 you are on your honor not to misuse the resulting formulas by
25394 substituting mismatched bounds into them. For example,
25395 @samp{sum(k, k, 1, 10, 2)} is invalid, but Calc will go ahead and
25396 evaluate the closed form solution for the limits 1 and 10 to get
25397 the rather dubious answer, 29.25.
25398
25399 If the lower limit is greater than the upper limit (assuming a
25400 positive step size), the result is generally zero. However,
25401 Calc only guarantees a zero result when the upper limit is
25402 exactly one step less than the lower limit, i.e., if the number
25403 of iterations is @mathit{-1}. Thus @samp{sum(f(k), k, n, n-1)} is zero
25404 but the sum from @samp{n} to @samp{n-2} may report a nonzero value
25405 if Calc used a closed form solution.
25406
25407 Calc's logical predicates like @expr{a < b} return 1 for ``true''
25408 and 0 for ``false.'' @xref{Logical Operations}. This can be
25409 used to advantage for building conditional sums. For example,
25410 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k, 1, 20)} is the sum of the squares of all
25411 prime numbers from 1 to 20; the @code{prime} predicate returns 1 if
25412 its argument is prime and 0 otherwise. You can read this expression
25413 as ``the sum of @expr{k^2}, where @expr{k} is prime.'' Indeed,
25414 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k)} would represent the sum of @emph{all} primes
25415 squared, since the limits default to plus and minus infinity, but
25416 there are no such sums that Calc's built-in rules can do in
25417 closed form.
25418
25419 As another example, @samp{sum((k != k_0) * f(k), k, 1, n)} is the
25420 sum of @expr{f(k)} for all @expr{k} from 1 to @expr{n}, excluding
25421 one value @expr{k_0}. Slightly more tricky is the summand
25422 @samp{(k != k_0) / (k - k_0)}, which is an attempt to describe
25423 the sum of all @expr{1/(k-k_0)} except at @expr{k = k_0}, where
25424 this would be a division by zero. But at @expr{k = k_0}, this
25425 formula works out to the indeterminate form @expr{0 / 0}, which
25426 Calc will not assume is zero. Better would be to use
25427 @samp{(k != k_0) ? 1/(k-k_0) : 0}; the @samp{? :} operator does
25428 an ``if-then-else'' test: This expression says, ``if
25429 @texline @math{k \ne k_0},
25430 @infoline @expr{k != k_0},
25431 then @expr{1/(k-k_0)}, else zero.'' Now the formula @expr{1/(k-k_0)}
25432 will not even be evaluated by Calc when @expr{k = k_0}.
25433
25434 @cindex Alternating sums
25435 @kindex a -
25436 @pindex calc-alt-summation
25437 @tindex asum
25438 The @kbd{a -} (@code{calc-alt-summation}) [@code{asum}] command
25439 computes an alternating sum. Successive terms of the sequence
25440 are given alternating signs, with the first term (corresponding
25441 to the lower index value) being positive. Alternating sums
25442 are converted to normal sums with an extra term of the form
25443 @samp{(-1)^(k-@var{low})}. This formula is adjusted appropriately
25444 if the step value is other than one. For example, the Taylor
25445 series for the sine function is @samp{asum(x^k / k!, k, 1, inf, 2)}.
25446 (Calc cannot evaluate this infinite series, but it can approximate
25447 it if you replace @code{inf} with any particular odd number.)
25448 Calc converts this series to a regular sum with a step of one,
25449 namely @samp{sum((-1)^k x^(2k+1) / (2k+1)!, k, 0, inf)}.
25450
25451 @cindex Product of a sequence
25452 @kindex a *
25453 @pindex calc-product
25454 @tindex prod
25455 The @kbd{a *} (@code{calc-product}) [@code{prod}] command is
25456 the analogous way to take a product of many terms. Calc also knows
25457 some closed forms for products, such as @samp{prod(k, k, 1, n) = n!}.
25458 Conditional products can be written @samp{prod(k^prime(k), k, 1, n)}
25459 or @samp{prod(prime(k) ? k : 1, k, 1, n)}.
25460
25461 @kindex a T
25462 @pindex calc-tabulate
25463 @tindex table
25464 The @kbd{a T} (@code{calc-tabulate}) [@code{table}] command
25465 evaluates a formula at a series of iterated index values, just
25466 like @code{sum} and @code{prod}, but its result is simply a
25467 vector of the results. For example, @samp{table(a_i, i, 1, 7, 2)}
25468 produces @samp{[a_1, a_3, a_5, a_7]}.
25469
25470 @node Logical Operations, Rewrite Rules, Summations, Algebra
25471 @section Logical Operations
25472
25473 @noindent
25474 The following commands and algebraic functions return true/false values,
25475 where 1 represents ``true'' and 0 represents ``false.'' In cases where
25476 a truth value is required (such as for the condition part of a rewrite
25477 rule, or as the condition for a @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} control structure), any
25478 nonzero value is accepted to mean ``true.'' (Specifically, anything
25479 for which @code{dnonzero} returns 1 is ``true,'' and anything for
25480 which @code{dnonzero} returns 0 or cannot decide is assumed ``false.''
25481 Note that this means that @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} will execute the ``then''
25482 portion if its condition is provably true, but it will execute the
25483 ``else'' portion for any condition like @expr{a = b} that is not
25484 provably true, even if it might be true. Algebraic functions that
25485 have conditions as arguments, like @code{? :} and @code{&&}, remain
25486 unevaluated if the condition is neither provably true nor provably
25487 false. @xref{Declarations}.)
25488
25489 @kindex a =
25490 @pindex calc-equal-to
25491 @tindex eq
25492 @tindex =
25493 @tindex ==
25494 The @kbd{a =} (@code{calc-equal-to}) command, or @samp{eq(a,b)} function
25495 (which can also be written @samp{a = b} or @samp{a == b} in an algebraic
25496 formula) is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are equal, either because they
25497 are identical expressions, or because they are numbers which are
25498 numerically equal. (Thus the integer 1 is considered equal to the float
25499 1.0.) If the equality of @expr{a} and @expr{b} cannot be determined,
25500 the comparison is left in symbolic form. Note that as a command, this
25501 operation pops two values from the stack and pushes back either a 1 or
25502 a 0, or a formula @samp{a = b} if the values' equality cannot be determined.
25503
25504 Many Calc commands use @samp{=} formulas to represent @dfn{equations}.
25505 For example, the @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) command rearranges
25506 an equation to solve for a given variable. The @kbd{a M}
25507 (@code{calc-map-equation}) command can be used to apply any
25508 function to both sides of an equation; for example, @kbd{2 a M *}
25509 multiplies both sides of the equation by two. Note that just
25510 @kbd{2 *} would not do the same thing; it would produce the formula
25511 @samp{2 (a = b)} which represents 2 if the equality is true or
25512 zero if not.
25513
25514 The @code{eq} function with more than two arguments (e.g., @kbd{C-u 3 a =}
25515 or @samp{a = b = c}) tests if all of its arguments are equal. In
25516 algebraic notation, the @samp{=} operator is unusual in that it is
25517 neither left- nor right-associative: @samp{a = b = c} is not the
25518 same as @samp{(a = b) = c} or @samp{a = (b = c)} (which each compare
25519 one variable with the 1 or 0 that results from comparing two other
25520 variables).
25521
25522 @kindex a #
25523 @pindex calc-not-equal-to
25524 @tindex neq
25525 @tindex !=
25526 The @kbd{a #} (@code{calc-not-equal-to}) command, or @samp{neq(a,b)} or
25527 @samp{a != b} function, is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are not equal.
25528 This also works with more than two arguments; @samp{a != b != c != d}
25529 tests that all four of @expr{a}, @expr{b}, @expr{c}, and @expr{d} are
25530 distinct numbers.
25531
25532 @kindex a <
25533 @tindex lt
25534 @ignore
25535 @mindex @idots
25536 @end ignore
25537 @kindex a >
25538 @ignore
25539 @mindex @null
25540 @end ignore
25541 @kindex a [
25542 @ignore
25543 @mindex @null
25544 @end ignore
25545 @kindex a ]
25546 @pindex calc-less-than
25547 @pindex calc-greater-than
25548 @pindex calc-less-equal
25549 @pindex calc-greater-equal
25550 @ignore
25551 @mindex @null
25552 @end ignore
25553 @tindex gt
25554 @ignore
25555 @mindex @null
25556 @end ignore
25557 @tindex leq
25558 @ignore
25559 @mindex @null
25560 @end ignore
25561 @tindex geq
25562 @ignore
25563 @mindex @null
25564 @end ignore
25565 @tindex <
25566 @ignore
25567 @mindex @null
25568 @end ignore
25569 @tindex >
25570 @ignore
25571 @mindex @null
25572 @end ignore
25573 @tindex <=
25574 @ignore
25575 @mindex @null
25576 @end ignore
25577 @tindex >=
25578 The @kbd{a <} (@code{calc-less-than}) [@samp{lt(a,b)} or @samp{a < b}]
25579 operation is true if @expr{a} is less than @expr{b}. Similar functions
25580 are @kbd{a >} (@code{calc-greater-than}) [@samp{gt(a,b)} or @samp{a > b}],
25581 @kbd{a [} (@code{calc-less-equal}) [@samp{leq(a,b)} or @samp{a <= b}], and
25582 @kbd{a ]} (@code{calc-greater-equal}) [@samp{geq(a,b)} or @samp{a >= b}].
25583
25584 While the inequality functions like @code{lt} do not accept more
25585 than two arguments, the syntax @w{@samp{a <= b < c}} is translated to an
25586 equivalent expression involving intervals: @samp{b in [a .. c)}.
25587 (See the description of @code{in} below.) All four combinations
25588 of @samp{<} and @samp{<=} are allowed, or any of the four combinations
25589 of @samp{>} and @samp{>=}. Four-argument constructions like
25590 @samp{a < b < c < d}, and mixtures like @w{@samp{a < b = c}} that
25591 involve both equalities and inequalities, are not allowed.
25592
25593 @kindex a .
25594 @pindex calc-remove-equal
25595 @tindex rmeq
25596 The @kbd{a .} (@code{calc-remove-equal}) [@code{rmeq}] command extracts
25597 the righthand side of the equation or inequality on the top of the
25598 stack. It also works elementwise on vectors. For example, if
25599 @samp{[x = 2.34, y = z / 2]} is on the stack, then @kbd{a .} produces
25600 @samp{[2.34, z / 2]}. As a special case, if the righthand side is a
25601 variable and the lefthand side is a number (as in @samp{2.34 = x}), then
25602 Calc keeps the lefthand side instead. Finally, this command works with
25603 assignments @samp{x := 2.34} as well as equations, always taking the
25604 righthand side, and for @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operators, always
25605 taking the lefthand side.
25606
25607 @kindex a &
25608 @pindex calc-logical-and
25609 @tindex land
25610 @tindex &&
25611 The @kbd{a &} (@code{calc-logical-and}) [@samp{land(a,b)} or @samp{a && b}]
25612 function is true if both of its arguments are true, i.e., are
25613 non-zero numbers. In this case, the result will be either @expr{a} or
25614 @expr{b}, chosen arbitrarily. If either argument is zero, the result is
25615 zero. Otherwise, the formula is left in symbolic form.
25616
25617 @kindex a |
25618 @pindex calc-logical-or
25619 @tindex lor
25620 @tindex ||
25621 The @kbd{a |} (@code{calc-logical-or}) [@samp{lor(a,b)} or @samp{a || b}]
25622 function is true if either or both of its arguments are true (nonzero).
25623 The result is whichever argument was nonzero, choosing arbitrarily if both
25624 are nonzero. If both @expr{a} and @expr{b} are zero, the result is
25625 zero.
25626
25627 @kindex a !
25628 @pindex calc-logical-not
25629 @tindex lnot
25630 @tindex !
25631 The @kbd{a !} (@code{calc-logical-not}) [@samp{lnot(a)} or @samp{!@: a}]
25632 function is true if @expr{a} is false (zero), or false if @expr{a} is
25633 true (nonzero). It is left in symbolic form if @expr{a} is not a
25634 number.
25635
25636 @kindex a :
25637 @pindex calc-logical-if
25638 @tindex if
25639 @ignore
25640 @mindex ? :
25641 @end ignore
25642 @tindex ?
25643 @ignore
25644 @mindex @null
25645 @end ignore
25646 @tindex :
25647 @cindex Arguments, not evaluated
25648 The @kbd{a :} (@code{calc-logical-if}) [@samp{if(a,b,c)} or @samp{a ? b :@: c}]
25649 function is equal to either @expr{b} or @expr{c} if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25650 number or zero, respectively. If @expr{a} is not a number, the test is
25651 left in symbolic form and neither @expr{b} nor @expr{c} is evaluated in
25652 any way. In algebraic formulas, this is one of the few Calc functions
25653 whose arguments are not automatically evaluated when the function itself
25654 is evaluated. The others are @code{lambda}, @code{quote}, and
25655 @code{condition}.
25656
25657 One minor surprise to watch out for is that the formula @samp{a?3:4}
25658 will not work because the @samp{3:4} is parsed as a fraction instead of
25659 as three separate symbols. Type something like @samp{a ? 3 : 4} or
25660 @samp{a?(3):4} instead.
25661
25662 As a special case, if @expr{a} evaluates to a vector, then both @expr{b}
25663 and @expr{c} are evaluated; the result is a vector of the same length
25664 as @expr{a} whose elements are chosen from corresponding elements of
25665 @expr{b} and @expr{c} according to whether each element of @expr{a}
25666 is zero or nonzero. Each of @expr{b} and @expr{c} must be either a
25667 vector of the same length as @expr{a}, or a non-vector which is matched
25668 with all elements of @expr{a}.
25669
25670 @kindex a @{
25671 @pindex calc-in-set
25672 @tindex in
25673 The @kbd{a @{} (@code{calc-in-set}) [@samp{in(a,b)}] function is true if
25674 the number @expr{a} is in the set of numbers represented by @expr{b}.
25675 If @expr{b} is an interval form, @expr{a} must be one of the values
25676 encompassed by the interval. If @expr{b} is a vector, @expr{a} must be
25677 equal to one of the elements of the vector. (If any vector elements are
25678 intervals, @expr{a} must be in any of the intervals.) If @expr{b} is a
25679 plain number, @expr{a} must be numerically equal to @expr{b}.
25680 @xref{Set Operations}, for a group of commands that manipulate sets
25681 of this sort.
25682
25683 @ignore
25684 @starindex
25685 @end ignore
25686 @tindex typeof
25687 The @samp{typeof(a)} function produces an integer or variable which
25688 characterizes @expr{a}. If @expr{a} is a number, vector, or variable,
25689 the result will be one of the following numbers:
25690
25691 @example
25692 1 Integer
25693 2 Fraction
25694 3 Floating-point number
25695 4 HMS form
25696 5 Rectangular complex number
25697 6 Polar complex number
25698 7 Error form
25699 8 Interval form
25700 9 Modulo form
25701 10 Date-only form
25702 11 Date/time form
25703 12 Infinity (inf, uinf, or nan)
25704 100 Variable
25705 101 Vector (but not a matrix)
25706 102 Matrix
25707 @end example
25708
25709 Otherwise, @expr{a} is a formula, and the result is a variable which
25710 represents the name of the top-level function call.
25711
25712 @ignore
25713 @starindex
25714 @end ignore
25715 @tindex integer
25716 @ignore
25717 @starindex
25718 @end ignore
25719 @tindex real
25720 @ignore
25721 @starindex
25722 @end ignore
25723 @tindex constant
25724 The @samp{integer(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is an integer.
25725 The @samp{real(a)} function
25726 is true if @expr{a} is a real number, either integer, fraction, or
25727 float. The @samp{constant(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is
25728 any of the objects for which @code{typeof} would produce an integer
25729 code result except for variables, and provided that the components of
25730 an object like a vector or error form are themselves constant.
25731 Note that infinities do not satisfy any of these tests, nor do
25732 special constants like @code{pi} and @code{e}.
25733
25734 @xref{Declarations}, for a set of similar functions that recognize
25735 formulas as well as actual numbers. For example, @samp{dint(floor(x))}
25736 is true because @samp{floor(x)} is provably integer-valued, but
25737 @samp{integer(floor(x))} does not because @samp{floor(x)} is not
25738 literally an integer constant.
25739
25740 @ignore
25741 @starindex
25742 @end ignore
25743 @tindex refers
25744 The @samp{refers(a,b)} function is true if the variable (or sub-expression)
25745 @expr{b} appears in @expr{a}, or false otherwise. Unlike the other
25746 tests described here, this function returns a definite ``no'' answer
25747 even if its arguments are still in symbolic form. The only case where
25748 @code{refers} will be left unevaluated is if @expr{a} is a plain
25749 variable (different from @expr{b}).
25750
25751 @ignore
25752 @starindex
25753 @end ignore
25754 @tindex negative
25755 The @samp{negative(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} ``looks'' negative,
25756 because it is a negative number, because it is of the form @expr{-x},
25757 or because it is a product or quotient with a term that looks negative.
25758 This is most useful in rewrite rules. Beware that @samp{negative(a)}
25759 evaluates to 1 or 0 for @emph{any} argument @expr{a}, so it can only
25760 be stored in a formula if the default simplifications are turned off
25761 first with @kbd{m O} (or if it appears in an unevaluated context such
25762 as a rewrite rule condition).
25763
25764 @ignore
25765 @starindex
25766 @end ignore
25767 @tindex variable
25768 The @samp{variable(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a variable,
25769 or false if not. If @expr{a} is a function call, this test is left
25770 in symbolic form. Built-in variables like @code{pi} and @code{inf}
25771 are considered variables like any others by this test.
25772
25773 @ignore
25774 @starindex
25775 @end ignore
25776 @tindex nonvar
25777 The @samp{nonvar(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a non-variable.
25778 If its argument is a variable it is left unsimplified; it never
25779 actually returns zero. However, since Calc's condition-testing
25780 commands consider ``false'' anything not provably true, this is
25781 often good enough.
25782
25783 @ignore
25784 @starindex
25785 @end ignore
25786 @tindex lin
25787 @ignore
25788 @starindex
25789 @end ignore
25790 @tindex linnt
25791 @ignore
25792 @starindex
25793 @end ignore
25794 @tindex islin
25795 @ignore
25796 @starindex
25797 @end ignore
25798 @tindex islinnt
25799 @cindex Linearity testing
25800 The functions @code{lin}, @code{linnt}, @code{islin}, and @code{islinnt}
25801 check if an expression is ``linear,'' i.e., can be written in the form
25802 @expr{a + b x} for some constants @expr{a} and @expr{b}, and some
25803 variable or subformula @expr{x}. The function @samp{islin(f,x)} checks
25804 if formula @expr{f} is linear in @expr{x}, returning 1 if so. For
25805 example, @samp{islin(x,x)}, @samp{islin(-x,x)}, @samp{islin(3,x)}, and
25806 @samp{islin(x y / 3 - 2, x)} all return 1. The @samp{lin(f,x)} function
25807 is similar, except that instead of returning 1 it returns the vector
25808 @expr{[a, b, x]}. For the above examples, this vector would be
25809 @expr{[0, 1, x]}, @expr{[0, -1, x]}, @expr{[3, 0, x]}, and
25810 @expr{[-2, y/3, x]}, respectively. Both @code{lin} and @code{islin}
25811 generally remain unevaluated for expressions which are not linear,
25812 e.g., @samp{lin(2 x^2, x)} and @samp{lin(sin(x), x)}. The second
25813 argument can also be a formula; @samp{islin(2 + 3 sin(x), sin(x))}
25814 returns true.
25815
25816 The @code{linnt} and @code{islinnt} functions perform a similar check,
25817 but require a ``non-trivial'' linear form, which means that the
25818 @expr{b} coefficient must be non-zero. For example, @samp{lin(2,x)}
25819 returns @expr{[2, 0, x]} and @samp{lin(y,x)} returns @expr{[y, 0, x]},
25820 but @samp{linnt(2,x)} and @samp{linnt(y,x)} are left unevaluated
25821 (in other words, these formulas are considered to be only ``trivially''
25822 linear in @expr{x}).
25823
25824 All four linearity-testing functions allow you to omit the second
25825 argument, in which case the input may be linear in any non-constant
25826 formula. Here, the @expr{a=0}, @expr{b=1} case is also considered
25827 trivial, and only constant values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} are
25828 recognized. Thus, @samp{lin(2 x y)} returns @expr{[0, 2, x y]},
25829 @samp{lin(2 - x y)} returns @expr{[2, -1, x y]}, and @samp{lin(x y)}
25830 returns @expr{[0, 1, x y]}. The @code{linnt} function would allow the
25831 first two cases but not the third. Also, neither @code{lin} nor
25832 @code{linnt} accept plain constants as linear in the one-argument
25833 case: @samp{islin(2,x)} is true, but @samp{islin(2)} is false.
25834
25835 @ignore
25836 @starindex
25837 @end ignore
25838 @tindex istrue
25839 The @samp{istrue(a)} function returns 1 if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25840 number or provably nonzero formula, or 0 if @expr{a} is anything else.
25841 Calls to @code{istrue} can only be manipulated if @kbd{m O} mode is
25842 used to make sure they are not evaluated prematurely. (Note that
25843 declarations are used when deciding whether a formula is true;
25844 @code{istrue} returns 1 when @code{dnonzero} would return 1, and
25845 it returns 0 when @code{dnonzero} would return 0 or leave itself
25846 in symbolic form.)
25847
25848 @node Rewrite Rules, , Logical Operations, Algebra
25849 @section Rewrite Rules
25850
25851 @noindent
25852 @cindex Rewrite rules
25853 @cindex Transformations
25854 @cindex Pattern matching
25855 @kindex a r
25856 @pindex calc-rewrite
25857 @tindex rewrite
25858 The @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) [@code{rewrite}] command makes
25859 substitutions in a formula according to a specified pattern or patterns
25860 known as @dfn{rewrite rules}. Whereas @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
25861 matches literally, so that substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(x)}
25862 matches only the @code{sin} function applied to the variable @code{x},
25863 rewrite rules match general kinds of formulas; rewriting using the rule
25864 @samp{sin(x) := cos(x)} matches @code{sin} of any argument and replaces
25865 it with @code{cos} of that same argument. The only significance of the
25866 name @code{x} is that the same name is used on both sides of the rule.
25867
25868 Rewrite rules rearrange formulas already in Calc's memory.
25869 @xref{Syntax Tables}, to read about @dfn{syntax rules}, which are
25870 similar to algebraic rewrite rules but operate when new algebraic
25871 entries are being parsed, converting strings of characters into
25872 Calc formulas.
25873
25874 @menu
25875 * Entering Rewrite Rules::
25876 * Basic Rewrite Rules::
25877 * Conditional Rewrite Rules::
25878 * Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules::
25879 * Other Features of Rewrite Rules::
25880 * Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules::
25881 * Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules::
25882 * Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules::
25883 * Selections with Rewrite Rules::
25884 * Matching Commands::
25885 * Automatic Rewrites::
25886 * Debugging Rewrites::
25887 * Examples of Rewrite Rules::
25888 @end menu
25889
25890 @node Entering Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25891 @subsection Entering Rewrite Rules
25892
25893 @noindent
25894 Rewrite rules normally use the ``assignment'' operator
25895 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}.
25896 This operator is equivalent to the function call @samp{assign(old, new)}.
25897 The @code{assign} function is undefined by itself in Calc, so an
25898 assignment formula such as a rewrite rule will be left alone by ordinary
25899 Calc commands. But certain commands, like the rewrite system, interpret
25900 assignments in special ways.
25901
25902 For example, the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1-cos(x)^2} says to replace
25903 every occurrence of the sine of something, squared, with one minus the
25904 square of the cosine of that same thing. All by itself as a formula
25905 on the stack it does nothing, but when given to the @kbd{a r} command
25906 it turns that command into a sine-squared-to-cosine-squared converter.
25907
25908 To specify a set of rules to be applied all at once, make a vector of
25909 rules.
25910
25911 When @kbd{a r} prompts you to enter the rewrite rules, you can answer
25912 in several ways:
25913
25914 @enumerate
25915 @item
25916 With a rule: @kbd{f(x) := g(x) @key{RET}}.
25917 @item
25918 With a vector of rules: @kbd{[f1(x) := g1(x), f2(x) := g2(x)] @key{RET}}.
25919 (You can omit the enclosing square brackets if you wish.)
25920 @item
25921 With the name of a variable that contains the rule or rules vector:
25922 @kbd{myrules @key{RET}}.
25923 @item
25924 With any formula except a rule, a vector, or a variable name; this
25925 will be interpreted as the @var{old} half of a rewrite rule,
25926 and you will be prompted a second time for the @var{new} half:
25927 @kbd{f(x) @key{RET} g(x) @key{RET}}.
25928 @item
25929 With a blank line, in which case the rule, rules vector, or variable
25930 will be taken from the top of the stack (and the formula to be
25931 rewritten will come from the second-to-top position).
25932 @end enumerate
25933
25934 If you enter the rules directly (as opposed to using rules stored
25935 in a variable), those rules will be put into the Trail so that you
25936 can retrieve them later. @xref{Trail Commands}.
25937
25938 It is most convenient to store rules you use often in a variable and
25939 invoke them by giving the variable name. The @kbd{s e}
25940 (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command is an easy way to create or edit a
25941 rule set stored in a variable. You may also wish to use @kbd{s p}
25942 (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) to save your rules permanently;
25943 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
25944
25945 Rewrite rules are compiled into a special internal form for faster
25946 matching. If you enter a rule set directly it must be recompiled
25947 every time. If you store the rules in a variable and refer to them
25948 through that variable, they will be compiled once and saved away
25949 along with the variable for later reference. This is another good
25950 reason to store your rules in a variable.
25951
25952 Calc also accepts an obsolete notation for rules, as vectors
25953 @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}]}. But because it is easily confused with a
25954 vector of two rules, the use of this notation is no longer recommended.
25955
25956 @node Basic Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Entering Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25957 @subsection Basic Rewrite Rules
25958
25959 @noindent
25960 To match a particular formula @expr{x} with a particular rewrite rule
25961 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}, Calc compares the structure of @expr{x} with
25962 the structure of @var{old}. Variables that appear in @var{old} are
25963 treated as @dfn{meta-variables}; the corresponding positions in @expr{x}
25964 may contain any sub-formulas. For example, the pattern @samp{f(x,y)}
25965 would match the expression @samp{f(12, a+1)} with the meta-variable
25966 @samp{x} corresponding to 12 and with @samp{y} corresponding to
25967 @samp{a+1}. However, this pattern would not match @samp{f(12)} or
25968 @samp{g(12, a+1)}, since there is no assignment of the meta-variables
25969 that will make the pattern match these expressions. Notice that if
25970 the pattern is a single meta-variable, it will match any expression.
25971
25972 If a given meta-variable appears more than once in @var{old}, the
25973 corresponding sub-formulas of @expr{x} must be identical. Thus
25974 the pattern @samp{f(x,x)} would match @samp{f(12, 12)} and
25975 @samp{f(a+1, a+1)} but not @samp{f(12, a+1)} or @samp{f(a+b, b+a)}.
25976 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for a way to match the latter.)
25977
25978 Things other than variables must match exactly between the pattern
25979 and the target formula. To match a particular variable exactly, use
25980 the pseudo-function @samp{quote(v)} in the pattern. For example, the
25981 pattern @samp{x+quote(y)} matches @samp{x+y}, @samp{2+y}, or
25982 @samp{sin(a)+y}.
25983
25984 The special variable names @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi},
25985 @samp{gamma}, @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} always match
25986 literally. Thus the pattern @samp{sin(d + e + f)} acts exactly like
25987 @samp{sin(d + quote(e) + f)}.
25988
25989 If the @var{old} pattern is found to match a given formula, that
25990 formula is replaced by @var{new}, where any occurrences in @var{new}
25991 of meta-variables from the pattern are replaced with the sub-formulas
25992 that they matched. Thus, applying the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x)}
25993 to @samp{f(12, a+1)} would produce @samp{g(a+13, 12)}.
25994
25995 The normal @kbd{a r} command applies rewrite rules over and over
25996 throughout the target formula until no further changes are possible
25997 (up to a limit of 100 times). Use @kbd{C-u 1 a r} to make only one
25998 change at a time.
25999
26000 @node Conditional Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26001 @subsection Conditional Rewrite Rules
26002
26003 @noindent
26004 A rewrite rule can also be @dfn{conditional}, written in the form
26005 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}}. (There is also the obsolete
26006 form @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}, @var{cond}]}.) If a @var{cond} part
26007 is present in the
26008 rule, this is an additional condition that must be satisfied before
26009 the rule is accepted. Once @var{old} has been successfully matched
26010 to the target expression, @var{cond} is evaluated (with all the
26011 meta-variables substituted for the values they matched) and simplified
26012 with @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}). If the result is a nonzero
26013 number or any other object known to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}),
26014 the rule is accepted. If the result is zero or if it is a symbolic
26015 formula that is not known to be nonzero, the rule is rejected.
26016 @xref{Logical Operations}, for a number of functions that return
26017 1 or 0 according to the results of various tests.
26018
26019 For example, the formula @samp{n > 0} simplifies to 1 or 0 if @expr{n}
26020 is replaced by a positive or nonpositive number, respectively (or if
26021 @expr{n} has been declared to be positive or nonpositive). Thus,
26022 the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x) :: x+y > 0} would apply to
26023 @samp{f(0, 4)} but not to @samp{f(-3, 2)} or @samp{f(12, a+1)}
26024 (assuming no outstanding declarations for @expr{a}). In the case of
26025 @samp{f(-3, 2)}, the condition can be shown not to be satisfied; in
26026 the case of @samp{f(12, a+1)}, the condition merely cannot be shown
26027 to be satisfied, but that is enough to reject the rule.
26028
26029 While Calc will use declarations to reason about variables in the
26030 formula being rewritten, declarations do not apply to meta-variables.
26031 For example, the rule @samp{f(a) := g(a+1)} will match for any values
26032 of @samp{a}, such as complex numbers, vectors, or formulas, even if
26033 @samp{a} has been declared to be real or scalar. If you want the
26034 meta-variable @samp{a} to match only literal real numbers, use
26035 @samp{f(a) := g(a+1) :: real(a)}. If you want @samp{a} to match only
26036 reals and formulas which are provably real, use @samp{dreal(a)} as
26037 the condition.
26038
26039 The @samp{::} operator is a shorthand for the @code{condition}
26040 function; @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}} is equivalent to
26041 the formula @samp{condition(assign(@var{old}, @var{new}), @var{cond})}.
26042
26043 If you have several conditions, you can use @samp{... :: c1 :: c2 :: c3}
26044 or @samp{... :: c1 && c2 && c3}. The two are entirely equivalent.
26045
26046 It is also possible to embed conditions inside the pattern:
26047 @samp{f(x :: x>0, y) := g(y+x, x)}. This is purely a notational
26048 convenience, though; where a condition appears in a rule has no
26049 effect on when it is tested. The rewrite-rule compiler automatically
26050 decides when it is best to test each condition while a rule is being
26051 matched.
26052
26053 Certain conditions are handled as special cases by the rewrite rule
26054 system and are tested very efficiently: Where @expr{x} is any
26055 meta-variable, these conditions are @samp{integer(x)}, @samp{real(x)},
26056 @samp{constant(x)}, @samp{negative(x)}, @samp{x >= y} where @expr{y}
26057 is either a constant or another meta-variable and @samp{>=} may be
26058 replaced by any of the six relational operators, and @samp{x % a = b}
26059 where @expr{a} and @expr{b} are constants. Other conditions, like
26060 @samp{x >= y+1} or @samp{dreal(x)}, will be less efficient to check
26061 since Calc must bring the whole evaluator and simplifier into play.
26062
26063 An interesting property of @samp{::} is that neither of its arguments
26064 will be touched by Calc's default simplifications. This is important
26065 because conditions often are expressions that cannot safely be
26066 evaluated early. For example, the @code{typeof} function never
26067 remains in symbolic form; entering @samp{typeof(a)} will put the
26068 number 100 (the type code for variables like @samp{a}) on the stack.
26069 But putting the condition @samp{... :: typeof(a) = 6} on the stack
26070 is safe since @samp{::} prevents the @code{typeof} from being
26071 evaluated until the condition is actually used by the rewrite system.
26072
26073 Since @samp{::} protects its lefthand side, too, you can use a dummy
26074 condition to protect a rule that must itself not evaluate early.
26075 For example, it's not safe to put @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x])} on
26076 the stack because it will immediately evaluate to @samp{a(f,x) := f(x)},
26077 where the meta-variable-ness of @code{f} on the righthand side has been
26078 lost. But @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x]) :: 1} is safe, and of course
26079 the condition @samp{1} is always true (nonzero) so it has no effect on
26080 the functioning of the rule. (The rewrite compiler will ensure that
26081 it doesn't even impact the speed of matching the rule.)
26082
26083 @node Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26084 @subsection Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules
26085
26086 @noindent
26087 The rewrite mechanism understands the algebraic properties of functions
26088 like @samp{+} and @samp{*}. In particular, pattern matching takes
26089 the associativity and commutativity of the following functions into
26090 account:
26091
26092 @smallexample
26093 + - * = != && || and or xor vint vunion vxor gcd lcm max min beta
26094 @end smallexample
26095
26096 For example, the rewrite rule:
26097
26098 @example
26099 a x + b x := (a + b) x
26100 @end example
26101
26102 @noindent
26103 will match formulas of the form,
26104
26105 @example
26106 a x + b x, x a + x b, a x + x b, x a + b x
26107 @end example
26108
26109 Rewrites also understand the relationship between the @samp{+} and @samp{-}
26110 operators. The above rewrite rule will also match the formulas,
26111
26112 @example
26113 a x - b x, x a - x b, a x - x b, x a - b x
26114 @end example
26115
26116 @noindent
26117 by matching @samp{b} in the pattern to @samp{-b} from the formula.
26118
26119 Applied to a sum of many terms like @samp{r + a x + s + b x + t}, this
26120 pattern will check all pairs of terms for possible matches. The rewrite
26121 will take whichever suitable pair it discovers first.
26122
26123 In general, a pattern using an associative operator like @samp{a + b}
26124 will try @var{2 n} different ways to match a sum of @var{n} terms
26125 like @samp{x + y + z - w}. First, @samp{a} is matched against each
26126 of @samp{x}, @samp{y}, @samp{z}, and @samp{-w} in turn, with @samp{b}
26127 being matched to the remainders @samp{y + z - w}, @samp{x + z - w}, etc.
26128 If none of these succeed, then @samp{b} is matched against each of the
26129 four terms with @samp{a} matching the remainder. Half-and-half matches,
26130 like @samp{(x + y) + (z - w)}, are not tried.
26131
26132 Note that @samp{*} is not commutative when applied to matrices, but
26133 rewrite rules pretend that it is. If you type @kbd{m v} to enable
26134 Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), rewrite rules will match @samp{*}
26135 literally, ignoring its usual commutativity property. (In the
26136 current implementation, the associativity also vanishes---it is as
26137 if the pattern had been enclosed in a @code{plain} marker; see below.)
26138 If you are applying rewrites to formulas with matrices, it's best to
26139 enable Matrix mode first to prevent algebraically incorrect rewrites
26140 from occurring.
26141
26142 The pattern @samp{-x} will actually match any expression. For example,
26143 the rule
26144
26145 @example
26146 f(-x) := -f(x)
26147 @end example
26148
26149 @noindent
26150 will rewrite @samp{f(a)} to @samp{-f(-a)}. To avoid this, either use
26151 a @code{plain} marker as described below, or add a @samp{negative(x)}
26152 condition. The @code{negative} function is true if its argument
26153 ``looks'' negative, for example, because it is a negative number or
26154 because it is a formula like @samp{-x}. The new rule using this
26155 condition is:
26156
26157 @example
26158 f(x) := -f(-x) :: negative(x) @r{or, equivalently,}
26159 f(-x) := -f(x) :: negative(-x)
26160 @end example
26161
26162 In the same way, the pattern @samp{x - y} will match the sum @samp{a + b}
26163 by matching @samp{y} to @samp{-b}.
26164
26165 The pattern @samp{a b} will also match the formula @samp{x/y} if
26166 @samp{y} is a number. Thus the rule @samp{a x + @w{b x} := (a+b) x}
26167 will also convert @samp{a x + x / 2} to @samp{(a + 0.5) x} (or
26168 @samp{(a + 1:2) x}, depending on the current fraction mode).
26169
26170 Calc will @emph{not} take other liberties with @samp{*}, @samp{/}, and
26171 @samp{^}. For example, the pattern @samp{f(a b)} will not match
26172 @samp{f(x^2)}, and @samp{f(a + b)} will not match @samp{f(2 x)}, even
26173 though conceivably these patterns could match with @samp{a = b = x}.
26174 Nor will @samp{f(a b)} match @samp{f(x / y)} if @samp{y} is not a
26175 constant, even though it could be considered to match with @samp{a = x}
26176 and @samp{b = 1/y}. The reasons are partly for efficiency, and partly
26177 because while few mathematical operations are substantively different
26178 for addition and subtraction, often it is preferable to treat the cases
26179 of multiplication, division, and integer powers separately.
26180
26181 Even more subtle is the rule set
26182
26183 @example
26184 [ f(a) + f(b) := f(a + b), -f(a) := f(-a) ]
26185 @end example
26186
26187 @noindent
26188 attempting to match @samp{f(x) - f(y)}. You might think that Calc
26189 will view this subtraction as @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))} and then apply
26190 the above two rules in turn, but actually this will not work because
26191 Calc only does this when considering rules for @samp{+} (like the
26192 first rule in this set). So it will see first that @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))}
26193 does not match @samp{f(a) + f(b)} for any assignments of the
26194 meta-variables, and then it will see that @samp{f(x) - f(y)} does
26195 not match @samp{-f(a)} for any assignment of @samp{a}. Because Calc
26196 tries only one rule at a time, it will not be able to rewrite
26197 @samp{f(x) - f(y)} with this rule set. An explicit @samp{f(a) - f(b)}
26198 rule will have to be added.
26199
26200 Another thing patterns will @emph{not} do is break up complex numbers.
26201 The pattern @samp{myconj(a + @w{b i)} := a - b i} will work for formulas
26202 involving the special constant @samp{i} (such as @samp{3 - 4 i}), but
26203 it will not match actual complex numbers like @samp{(3, -4)}. A version
26204 of the above rule for complex numbers would be
26205
26206 @example
26207 myconj(a) := re(a) - im(a) (0,1) :: im(a) != 0
26208 @end example
26209
26210 @noindent
26211 (Because the @code{re} and @code{im} functions understand the properties
26212 of the special constant @samp{i}, this rule will also work for
26213 @samp{3 - 4 i}. In fact, this particular rule would probably be better
26214 without the @samp{im(a) != 0} condition, since if @samp{im(a) = 0} the
26215 righthand side of the rule will still give the correct answer for the
26216 conjugate of a real number.)
26217
26218 It is also possible to specify optional arguments in patterns. The rule
26219
26220 @example
26221 opt(a) x + opt(b) (x^opt(c) + opt(d)) := f(a, b, c, d)
26222 @end example
26223
26224 @noindent
26225 will match the formula
26226
26227 @example
26228 5 (x^2 - 4) + 3 x
26229 @end example
26230
26231 @noindent
26232 in a fairly straightforward manner, but it will also match reduced
26233 formulas like
26234
26235 @example
26236 x + x^2, 2(x + 1) - x, x + x
26237 @end example
26238
26239 @noindent
26240 producing, respectively,
26241
26242 @example
26243 f(1, 1, 2, 0), f(-1, 2, 1, 1), f(1, 1, 1, 0)
26244 @end example
26245
26246 (The latter two formulas can be entered only if default simplifications
26247 have been turned off with @kbd{m O}.)
26248
26249 The default value for a term of a sum is zero. The default value
26250 for a part of a product, for a power, or for the denominator of a
26251 quotient, is one. Also, @samp{-x} matches the pattern @samp{opt(a) b}
26252 with @samp{a = -1}.
26253
26254 In particular, the distributive-law rule can be refined to
26255
26256 @example
26257 opt(a) x + opt(b) x := (a + b) x
26258 @end example
26259
26260 @noindent
26261 so that it will convert, e.g., @samp{a x - x}, to @samp{(a - 1) x}.
26262
26263 The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x} matches almost any formulas which
26264 are linear in @samp{x}. You can also use the @code{lin} and @code{islin}
26265 functions with rewrite conditions to test for this; @pxref{Logical
26266 Operations}. These functions are not as convenient to use in rewrite
26267 rules, but they recognize more kinds of formulas as linear:
26268 @samp{x/z} is considered linear with @expr{b = 1/z} by @code{lin},
26269 but it will not match the above pattern because that pattern calls
26270 for a multiplication, not a division.
26271
26272 As another example, the obvious rule to replace @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2}
26273 by 1,
26274
26275 @example
26276 sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 := 1
26277 @end example
26278
26279 @noindent
26280 misses many cases because the sine and cosine may both be multiplied by
26281 an equal factor. Here's a more successful rule:
26282
26283 @example
26284 opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a
26285 @end example
26286
26287 Note that this rule will @emph{not} match @samp{sin(x)^2 + 6 cos(x)^2}
26288 because one @expr{a} would have ``matched'' 1 while the other matched 6.
26289
26290 Calc automatically converts a rule like
26291
26292 @example
26293 f(x-1, x) := g(x)
26294 @end example
26295
26296 @noindent
26297 into the form
26298
26299 @example
26300 f(temp, x) := g(x) :: temp = x-1
26301 @end example
26302
26303 @noindent
26304 (where @code{temp} stands for a new, invented meta-variable that
26305 doesn't actually have a name). This modified rule will successfully
26306 match @samp{f(6, 7)}, binding @samp{temp} and @samp{x} to 6 and 7,
26307 respectively, then verifying that they differ by one even though
26308 @samp{6} does not superficially look like @samp{x-1}.
26309
26310 However, Calc does not solve equations to interpret a rule. The
26311 following rule,
26312
26313 @example
26314 f(x-1, x+1) := g(x)
26315 @end example
26316
26317 @noindent
26318 will not work. That is, it will match @samp{f(a - 1 + b, a + 1 + b)}
26319 but not @samp{f(6, 8)}. Calc always interprets at least one occurrence
26320 of a variable by literal matching. If the variable appears ``isolated''
26321 then Calc is smart enough to use it for literal matching. But in this
26322 last example, Calc is forced to rewrite the rule to @samp{f(x-1, temp)
26323 := g(x) :: temp = x+1} where the @samp{x-1} term must correspond to an
26324 actual ``something-minus-one'' in the target formula.
26325
26326 A successful way to write this would be @samp{f(x, x+2) := g(x+1)}.
26327 You could make this resemble the original form more closely by using
26328 @code{let} notation, which is described in the next section:
26329
26330 @example
26331 f(xm1, x+1) := g(x) :: let(x := xm1+1)
26332 @end example
26333
26334 Calc does this rewriting or ``conditionalizing'' for any sub-pattern
26335 which involves only the functions in the following list, operating
26336 only on constants and meta-variables which have already been matched
26337 elsewhere in the pattern. When matching a function call, Calc is
26338 careful to match arguments which are plain variables before arguments
26339 which are calls to any of the functions below, so that a pattern like
26340 @samp{f(x-1, x)} can be conditionalized even though the isolated
26341 @samp{x} comes after the @samp{x-1}.
26342
26343 @smallexample
26344 + - * / \ % ^ abs sign round rounde roundu trunc floor ceil
26345 max min re im conj arg
26346 @end smallexample
26347
26348 You can suppress all of the special treatments described in this
26349 section by surrounding a function call with a @code{plain} marker.
26350 This marker causes the function call which is its argument to be
26351 matched literally, without regard to commutativity, associativity,
26352 negation, or conditionalization. When you use @code{plain}, the
26353 ``deep structure'' of the formula being matched can show through.
26354 For example,
26355
26356 @example
26357 plain(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26358 @end example
26359
26360 @noindent
26361 will match only literal subtractions. However, the @code{plain}
26362 marker does not affect its arguments' arguments. In this case,
26363 commutativity and associativity is still considered while matching
26364 the @w{@samp{a b}} sub-pattern, so the whole pattern will match
26365 @samp{x - y x} as well as @samp{x - x y}. We could go still
26366 further and use
26367
26368 @example
26369 plain(a - plain(a b)) := f(a, b)
26370 @end example
26371
26372 @noindent
26373 which would do a completely strict match for the pattern.
26374
26375 By contrast, the @code{quote} marker means that not only the
26376 function name but also the arguments must be literally the same.
26377 The above pattern will match @samp{x - x y} but
26378
26379 @example
26380 quote(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26381 @end example
26382
26383 @noindent
26384 will match only the single formula @samp{a - a b}. Also,
26385
26386 @example
26387 quote(a - quote(a b)) := f(a, b)
26388 @end example
26389
26390 @noindent
26391 will match only @samp{a - quote(a b)}---probably not the desired
26392 effect!
26393
26394 A certain amount of algebra is also done when substituting the
26395 meta-variables on the righthand side of a rule. For example,
26396 in the rule
26397
26398 @example
26399 a + f(b) := f(a + b)
26400 @end example
26401
26402 @noindent
26403 matching @samp{f(x) - y} would produce @samp{f((-y) + x)} if
26404 taken literally, but the rewrite mechanism will simplify the
26405 righthand side to @samp{f(x - y)} automatically. (Of course,
26406 the default simplifications would do this anyway, so this
26407 special simplification is only noticeable if you have turned the
26408 default simplifications off.) This rewriting is done only when
26409 a meta-variable expands to a ``negative-looking'' expression.
26410 If this simplification is not desirable, you can use a @code{plain}
26411 marker on the righthand side:
26412
26413 @example
26414 a + f(b) := f(plain(a + b))
26415 @end example
26416
26417 @noindent
26418 In this example, we are still allowing the pattern-matcher to
26419 use all the algebra it can muster, but the righthand side will
26420 always simplify to a literal addition like @samp{f((-y) + x)}.
26421
26422 @node Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26423 @subsection Other Features of Rewrite Rules
26424
26425 @noindent
26426 Certain ``function names'' serve as markers in rewrite rules.
26427 Here is a complete list of these markers. First are listed the
26428 markers that work inside a pattern; then come the markers that
26429 work in the righthand side of a rule.
26430
26431 @ignore
26432 @starindex
26433 @end ignore
26434 @tindex import
26435 One kind of marker, @samp{import(x)}, takes the place of a whole
26436 rule. Here @expr{x} is the name of a variable containing another
26437 rule set; those rules are ``spliced into'' the rule set that
26438 imports them. For example, if @samp{[f(a+b) := f(a) + f(b),
26439 f(a b) := a f(b) :: real(a)]} is stored in variable @samp{linearF},
26440 then the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 0, import(linearF)]} will apply
26441 all three rules. It is possible to modify the imported rules
26442 slightly: @samp{import(x, v1, x1, v2, x2, @dots{})} imports
26443 the rule set @expr{x} with all occurrences of
26444 @texline @math{v_1},
26445 @infoline @expr{v1},
26446 as either a variable name or a function name, replaced with
26447 @texline @math{x_1}
26448 @infoline @expr{x1}
26449 and so on. (If
26450 @texline @math{v_1}
26451 @infoline @expr{v1}
26452 is used as a function name, then
26453 @texline @math{x_1}
26454 @infoline @expr{x1}
26455 must be either a function name itself or a @w{@samp{< >}} nameless
26456 function; @pxref{Specifying Operators}.) For example, @samp{[g(0) := 0,
26457 import(linearF, f, g)]} applies the linearity rules to the function
26458 @samp{g} instead of @samp{f}. Imports can be nested, but the
26459 import-with-renaming feature may fail to rename sub-imports properly.
26460
26461 The special functions allowed in patterns are:
26462
26463 @table @samp
26464 @item quote(x)
26465 @ignore
26466 @starindex
26467 @end ignore
26468 @tindex quote
26469 This pattern matches exactly @expr{x}; variable names in @expr{x} are
26470 not interpreted as meta-variables. The only flexibility is that
26471 numbers are compared for numeric equality, so that the pattern
26472 @samp{f(quote(12))} will match both @samp{f(12)} and @samp{f(12.0)}.
26473 (Numbers are always treated this way by the rewrite mechanism:
26474 The rule @samp{f(x,x) := g(x)} will match @samp{f(12, 12.0)}.
26475 The rewrite may produce either @samp{g(12)} or @samp{g(12.0)}
26476 as a result in this case.)
26477
26478 @item plain(x)
26479 @ignore
26480 @starindex
26481 @end ignore
26482 @tindex plain
26483 Here @expr{x} must be a function call @samp{f(x1,x2,@dots{})}. This
26484 pattern matches a call to function @expr{f} with the specified
26485 argument patterns. No special knowledge of the properties of the
26486 function @expr{f} is used in this case; @samp{+} is not commutative or
26487 associative. Unlike @code{quote}, the arguments @samp{x1,x2,@dots{}}
26488 are treated as patterns. If you wish them to be treated ``plainly''
26489 as well, you must enclose them with more @code{plain} markers:
26490 @samp{plain(plain(@w{-a}) + plain(b c))}.
26491
26492 @item opt(x,def)
26493 @ignore
26494 @starindex
26495 @end ignore
26496 @tindex opt
26497 Here @expr{x} must be a variable name. This must appear as an
26498 argument to a function or an element of a vector; it specifies that
26499 the argument or element is optional.
26500 As an argument to @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*}, @samp{&&}, or @samp{||},
26501 or as the second argument to @samp{/} or @samp{^}, the value @var{def}
26502 may be omitted. The pattern @samp{x + opt(y)} matches a sum by
26503 binding one summand to @expr{x} and the other to @expr{y}, and it
26504 matches anything else by binding the whole expression to @expr{x} and
26505 zero to @expr{y}. The other operators above work similarly.
26506
26507 For general miscellaneous functions, the default value @code{def}
26508 must be specified. Optional arguments are dropped starting with
26509 the rightmost one during matching. For example, the pattern
26510 @samp{f(opt(a,0), b, opt(c,b))} will match @samp{f(b)}, @samp{f(a,b)},
26511 or @samp{f(a,b,c)}. Default values of zero and @expr{b} are
26512 supplied in this example for the omitted arguments. Note that
26513 the literal variable @expr{b} will be the default in the latter
26514 case, @emph{not} the value that matched the meta-variable @expr{b}.
26515 In other words, the default @var{def} is effectively quoted.
26516
26517 @item condition(x,c)
26518 @ignore
26519 @starindex
26520 @end ignore
26521 @tindex condition
26522 @tindex ::
26523 This matches the pattern @expr{x}, with the attached condition
26524 @expr{c}. It is the same as @samp{x :: c}.
26525
26526 @item pand(x,y)
26527 @ignore
26528 @starindex
26529 @end ignore
26530 @tindex pand
26531 @tindex &&&
26532 This matches anything that matches both pattern @expr{x} and
26533 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @samp{x &&& y}.
26534 @pxref{Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules}.
26535
26536 @item por(x,y)
26537 @ignore
26538 @starindex
26539 @end ignore
26540 @tindex por
26541 @tindex |||
26542 This matches anything that matches either pattern @expr{x} or
26543 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @w{@samp{x ||| y}}.
26544
26545 @item pnot(x)
26546 @ignore
26547 @starindex
26548 @end ignore
26549 @tindex pnot
26550 @tindex !!!
26551 This matches anything that does not match pattern @expr{x}.
26552 It is the same as @samp{!!! x}.
26553
26554 @item cons(h,t)
26555 @ignore
26556 @mindex cons
26557 @end ignore
26558 @tindex cons (rewrites)
26559 This matches any vector of one or more elements. The first
26560 element is matched to @expr{h}; a vector of the remaining
26561 elements is matched to @expr{t}. Note that vectors of fixed
26562 length can also be matched as actual vectors: The rule
26563 @samp{cons(a,cons(b,[])) := cons(a+b,[])} is equivalent
26564 to the rule @samp{[a,b] := [a+b]}.
26565
26566 @item rcons(t,h)
26567 @ignore
26568 @mindex rcons
26569 @end ignore
26570 @tindex rcons (rewrites)
26571 This is like @code{cons}, except that the @emph{last} element
26572 is matched to @expr{h}, with the remaining elements matched
26573 to @expr{t}.
26574
26575 @item apply(f,args)
26576 @ignore
26577 @mindex apply
26578 @end ignore
26579 @tindex apply (rewrites)
26580 This matches any function call. The name of the function, in
26581 the form of a variable, is matched to @expr{f}. The arguments
26582 of the function, as a vector of zero or more objects, are
26583 matched to @samp{args}. Constants, variables, and vectors
26584 do @emph{not} match an @code{apply} pattern. For example,
26585 @samp{apply(f,x)} matches any function call, @samp{apply(quote(f),x)}
26586 matches any call to the function @samp{f}, @samp{apply(f,[a,b])}
26587 matches any function call with exactly two arguments, and
26588 @samp{apply(quote(f), cons(a,cons(b,x)))} matches any call
26589 to the function @samp{f} with two or more arguments. Another
26590 way to implement the latter, if the rest of the rule does not
26591 need to refer to the first two arguments of @samp{f} by name,
26592 would be @samp{apply(quote(f), x :: vlen(x) >= 2)}.
26593 Here's a more interesting sample use of @code{apply}:
26594
26595 @example
26596 apply(f,[x+n]) := n + apply(f,[x])
26597 :: in(f, [floor,ceil,round,trunc]) :: integer(n)
26598 @end example
26599
26600 Note, however, that this will be slower to match than a rule
26601 set with four separate rules. The reason is that Calc sorts
26602 the rules of a rule set according to top-level function name;
26603 if the top-level function is @code{apply}, Calc must try the
26604 rule for every single formula and sub-formula. If the top-level
26605 function in the pattern is, say, @code{floor}, then Calc invokes
26606 the rule only for sub-formulas which are calls to @code{floor}.
26607
26608 Formulas normally written with operators like @code{+} are still
26609 considered function calls: @code{apply(f,x)} matches @samp{a+b}
26610 with @samp{f = add}, @samp{x = [a,b]}.
26611
26612 You must use @code{apply} for meta-variables with function names
26613 on both sides of a rewrite rule: @samp{apply(f, [x]) := f(x+1)}
26614 is @emph{not} correct, because it rewrites @samp{spam(6)} into
26615 @samp{f(7)}. The righthand side should be @samp{apply(f, [x+1])}.
26616 Also note that you will have to use No-Simplify mode (@kbd{m O})
26617 when entering this rule so that the @code{apply} isn't
26618 evaluated immediately to get the new rule @samp{f(x) := f(x+1)}.
26619 Or, use @kbd{s e} to enter the rule without going through the stack,
26620 or enter the rule as @samp{apply(f, [x]) := apply(f, [x+1]) @w{:: 1}}.
26621 @xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}.
26622
26623 @item select(x)
26624 @ignore
26625 @starindex
26626 @end ignore
26627 @tindex select
26628 This is used for applying rules to formulas with selections;
26629 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26630 @end table
26631
26632 Special functions for the righthand sides of rules are:
26633
26634 @table @samp
26635 @item quote(x)
26636 The notation @samp{quote(x)} is changed to @samp{x} when the
26637 righthand side is used. As far as the rewrite rule is concerned,
26638 @code{quote} is invisible. However, @code{quote} has the special
26639 property in Calc that its argument is not evaluated. Thus,
26640 while it will not work to put the rule @samp{t(a) := typeof(a)}
26641 on the stack because @samp{typeof(a)} is evaluated immediately
26642 to produce @samp{t(a) := 100}, you can use @code{quote} to
26643 protect the righthand side: @samp{t(a) := quote(typeof(a))}.
26644 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for another trick for
26645 protecting rules from evaluation.)
26646
26647 @item plain(x)
26648 Special properties of and simplifications for the function call
26649 @expr{x} are not used. One interesting case where @code{plain}
26650 is useful is the rule, @samp{q(x) := quote(x)}, trying to expand a
26651 shorthand notation for the @code{quote} function. This rule will
26652 not work as shown; instead of replacing @samp{q(foo)} with
26653 @samp{quote(foo)}, it will replace it with @samp{foo}! The correct
26654 rule would be @samp{q(x) := plain(quote(x))}.
26655
26656 @item cons(h,t)
26657 Where @expr{t} is a vector, this is converted into an expanded
26658 vector during rewrite processing. Note that @code{cons} is a regular
26659 Calc function which normally does this anyway; the only way @code{cons}
26660 is treated specially by rewrites is that @code{cons} on the righthand
26661 side of a rule will be evaluated even if default simplifications
26662 have been turned off.
26663
26664 @item rcons(t,h)
26665 Analogous to @code{cons} except putting @expr{h} at the @emph{end} of
26666 the vector @expr{t}.
26667
26668 @item apply(f,args)
26669 Where @expr{f} is a variable and @var{args} is a vector, this
26670 is converted to a function call. Once again, note that @code{apply}
26671 is also a regular Calc function.
26672
26673 @item eval(x)
26674 @ignore
26675 @starindex
26676 @end ignore
26677 @tindex eval
26678 The formula @expr{x} is handled in the usual way, then the
26679 default simplifications are applied to it even if they have
26680 been turned off normally. This allows you to treat any function
26681 similarly to the way @code{cons} and @code{apply} are always
26682 treated. However, there is a slight difference: @samp{cons(2+3, [])}
26683 with default simplifications off will be converted to @samp{[2+3]},
26684 whereas @samp{eval(cons(2+3, []))} will be converted to @samp{[5]}.
26685
26686 @item evalsimp(x)
26687 @ignore
26688 @starindex
26689 @end ignore
26690 @tindex evalsimp
26691 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the usual
26692 way, then algebraically simplified as if by the @kbd{a s} command.
26693
26694 @item evalextsimp(x)
26695 @ignore
26696 @starindex
26697 @end ignore
26698 @tindex evalextsimp
26699 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the normal
26700 way, then ``extendedly'' simplified as if by the @kbd{a e} command.
26701
26702 @item select(x)
26703 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26704 @end table
26705
26706 There are also some special functions you can use in conditions.
26707
26708 @table @samp
26709 @item let(v := x)
26710 @ignore
26711 @starindex
26712 @end ignore
26713 @tindex let
26714 The expression @expr{x} is evaluated with meta-variables substituted.
26715 The @kbd{a s} command's simplifications are @emph{not} applied by
26716 default, but @expr{x} can include calls to @code{evalsimp} or
26717 @code{evalextsimp} as described above to invoke higher levels
26718 of simplification. The
26719 result of @expr{x} is then bound to the meta-variable @expr{v}. As
26720 usual, if this meta-variable has already been matched to something
26721 else the two values must be equal; if the meta-variable is new then
26722 it is bound to the result of the expression. This variable can then
26723 appear in later conditions, and on the righthand side of the rule.
26724 In fact, @expr{v} may be any pattern in which case the result of
26725 evaluating @expr{x} is matched to that pattern, binding any
26726 meta-variables that appear in that pattern. Note that @code{let}
26727 can only appear by itself as a condition, or as one term of an
26728 @samp{&&} which is a whole condition: It cannot be inside
26729 an @samp{||} term or otherwise buried.
26730
26731 The alternate, equivalent form @samp{let(v, x)} is also recognized.
26732 Note that the use of @samp{:=} by @code{let}, while still being
26733 assignment-like in character, is unrelated to the use of @samp{:=}
26734 in the main part of a rewrite rule.
26735
26736 As an example, @samp{f(a) := g(ia) :: let(ia := 1/a) :: constant(ia)}
26737 replaces @samp{f(a)} with @samp{g} of the inverse of @samp{a}, if
26738 that inverse exists and is constant. For example, if @samp{a} is a
26739 singular matrix the operation @samp{1/a} is left unsimplified and
26740 @samp{constant(ia)} fails, but if @samp{a} is an invertible matrix
26741 then the rule succeeds. Without @code{let} there would be no way
26742 to express this rule that didn't have to invert the matrix twice.
26743 Note that, because the meta-variable @samp{ia} is otherwise unbound
26744 in this rule, the @code{let} condition itself always ``succeeds''
26745 because no matter what @samp{1/a} evaluates to, it can successfully
26746 be bound to @code{ia}.
26747
26748 Here's another example, for integrating cosines of linear
26749 terms: @samp{myint(cos(y),x) := sin(y)/b :: let([a,b,x] := lin(y,x))}.
26750 The @code{lin} function returns a 3-vector if its argument is linear,
26751 or leaves itself unevaluated if not. But an unevaluated @code{lin}
26752 call will not match the 3-vector on the lefthand side of the @code{let},
26753 so this @code{let} both verifies that @code{y} is linear, and binds
26754 the coefficients @code{a} and @code{b} for use elsewhere in the rule.
26755 (It would have been possible to use @samp{sin(a x + b)/b} for the
26756 righthand side instead, but using @samp{sin(y)/b} avoids gratuitous
26757 rearrangement of the argument of the sine.)
26758
26759 @ignore
26760 @starindex
26761 @end ignore
26762 @tindex ierf
26763 Similarly, here is a rule that implements an inverse-@code{erf}
26764 function. It uses @code{root} to search for a solution. If
26765 @code{root} succeeds, it will return a vector of two numbers
26766 where the first number is the desired solution. If no solution
26767 is found, @code{root} remains in symbolic form. So we use
26768 @code{let} to check that the result was indeed a vector.
26769
26770 @example
26771 ierf(x) := y :: let([y,z] := root(erf(a) = x, a, .5))
26772 @end example
26773
26774 @item matches(v,p)
26775 The meta-variable @var{v}, which must already have been matched
26776 to something elsewhere in the rule, is compared against pattern
26777 @var{p}. Since @code{matches} is a standard Calc function, it
26778 can appear anywhere in a condition. But if it appears alone or
26779 as a term of a top-level @samp{&&}, then you get the special
26780 extra feature that meta-variables which are bound to things
26781 inside @var{p} can be used elsewhere in the surrounding rewrite
26782 rule.
26783
26784 The only real difference between @samp{let(p := v)} and
26785 @samp{matches(v, p)} is that the former evaluates @samp{v} using
26786 the default simplifications, while the latter does not.
26787
26788 @item remember
26789 @vindex remember
26790 This is actually a variable, not a function. If @code{remember}
26791 appears as a condition in a rule, then when that rule succeeds
26792 the original expression and rewritten expression are added to the
26793 front of the rule set that contained the rule. If the rule set
26794 was not stored in a variable, @code{remember} is ignored. The
26795 lefthand side is enclosed in @code{quote} in the added rule if it
26796 contains any variables.
26797
26798 For example, the rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: remember} applied
26799 to @samp{f(7)} will add the rule @samp{f(7) := 7 f(6)} to the front
26800 of the rule set. The rule set @code{EvalRules} works slightly
26801 differently: There, the evaluation of @samp{f(6)} will complete before
26802 the result is added to the rule set, in this case as @samp{f(7) := 5040}.
26803 Thus @code{remember} is most useful inside @code{EvalRules}.
26804
26805 It is up to you to ensure that the optimization performed by
26806 @code{remember} is safe. For example, the rule @samp{foo(n) := n
26807 :: evalv(eatfoo) > 0 :: remember} is a bad idea (@code{evalv} is
26808 the function equivalent of the @kbd{=} command); if the variable
26809 @code{eatfoo} ever contains 1, rules like @samp{foo(7) := 7} will
26810 be added to the rule set and will continue to operate even if
26811 @code{eatfoo} is later changed to 0.
26812
26813 @item remember(c)
26814 @ignore
26815 @starindex
26816 @end ignore
26817 @tindex remember
26818 Remember the match as described above, but only if condition @expr{c}
26819 is true. For example, @samp{remember(n % 4 = 0)} in the above factorial
26820 rule remembers only every fourth result. Note that @samp{remember(1)}
26821 is equivalent to @samp{remember}, and @samp{remember(0)} has no effect.
26822 @end table
26823
26824 @node Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26825 @subsection Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules
26826
26827 @noindent
26828 There are three operators, @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!},
26829 that combine rewrite patterns to make larger patterns. The
26830 combinations are ``and,'' ``or,'' and ``not,'' respectively, and
26831 these operators are the pattern equivalents of @samp{&&}, @samp{||}
26832 and @samp{!} (which operate on zero-or-nonzero logical values).
26833
26834 Note that @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!} are left in symbolic
26835 form by all regular Calc features; they have special meaning only in
26836 the context of rewrite rule patterns.
26837
26838 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} &&& @var{p2}} matches anything that
26839 matches both @var{p1} and @var{p2}. One especially useful case is
26840 when one of @var{p1} or @var{p2} is a meta-variable. For example,
26841 here is a rule that operates on error forms:
26842
26843 @example
26844 f(x &&& a +/- b, x) := g(x)
26845 @end example
26846
26847 This does the same thing, but is arguably simpler than, the rule
26848
26849 @example
26850 f(a +/- b, a +/- b) := g(a +/- b)
26851 @end example
26852
26853 @ignore
26854 @starindex
26855 @end ignore
26856 @tindex ends
26857 Here's another interesting example:
26858
26859 @example
26860 ends(cons(a, x) &&& rcons(y, b)) := [a, b]
26861 @end example
26862
26863 @noindent
26864 which effectively clips out the middle of a vector leaving just
26865 the first and last elements. This rule will change a one-element
26866 vector @samp{[a]} to @samp{[a, a]}. The similar rule
26867
26868 @example
26869 ends(cons(a, rcons(y, b))) := [a, b]
26870 @end example
26871
26872 @noindent
26873 would do the same thing except that it would fail to match a
26874 one-element vector.
26875
26876 @tex
26877 \bigskip
26878 @end tex
26879
26880 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} ||| @var{p2}} matches anything that
26881 matches either @var{p1} or @var{p2}. Calc first tries matching
26882 against @var{p1}; if that fails, it goes on to try @var{p2}.
26883
26884 @ignore
26885 @starindex
26886 @end ignore
26887 @tindex curve
26888 A simple example of @samp{|||} is
26889
26890 @example
26891 curve(inf ||| -inf) := 0
26892 @end example
26893
26894 @noindent
26895 which converts both @samp{curve(inf)} and @samp{curve(-inf)} to zero.
26896
26897 Here is a larger example:
26898
26899 @example
26900 log(a, b) ||| (ln(a) :: let(b := e)) := mylog(a, b)
26901 @end example
26902
26903 This matches both generalized and natural logarithms in a single rule.
26904 Note that the @samp{::} term must be enclosed in parentheses because
26905 that operator has lower precedence than @samp{|||} or @samp{:=}.
26906
26907 (In practice this rule would probably include a third alternative,
26908 omitted here for brevity, to take care of @code{log10}.)
26909
26910 While Calc generally treats interior conditions exactly the same as
26911 conditions on the outside of a rule, it does guarantee that if all the
26912 variables in the condition are special names like @code{e}, or already
26913 bound in the pattern to which the condition is attached (say, if
26914 @samp{a} had appeared in this condition), then Calc will process this
26915 condition right after matching the pattern to the left of the @samp{::}.
26916 Thus, we know that @samp{b} will be bound to @samp{e} only if the
26917 @code{ln} branch of the @samp{|||} was taken.
26918
26919 Note that this rule was careful to bind the same set of meta-variables
26920 on both sides of the @samp{|||}. Calc does not check this, but if
26921 you bind a certain meta-variable only in one branch and then use that
26922 meta-variable elsewhere in the rule, results are unpredictable:
26923
26924 @example
26925 f(a,b) ||| g(b) := h(a,b)
26926 @end example
26927
26928 Here if the pattern matches @samp{g(17)}, Calc makes no promises about
26929 the value that will be substituted for @samp{a} on the righthand side.
26930
26931 @tex
26932 \bigskip
26933 @end tex
26934
26935 The pattern @samp{!!! @var{pat}} matches anything that does not
26936 match @var{pat}. Any meta-variables that are bound while matching
26937 @var{pat} remain unbound outside of @var{pat}.
26938
26939 For example,
26940
26941 @example
26942 f(x &&& !!! a +/- b, !!![]) := g(x)
26943 @end example
26944
26945 @noindent
26946 converts @code{f} whose first argument is anything @emph{except} an
26947 error form, and whose second argument is not the empty vector, into
26948 a similar call to @code{g} (but without the second argument).
26949
26950 If we know that the second argument will be a vector (empty or not),
26951 then an equivalent rule would be:
26952
26953 @example
26954 f(x, y) := g(x) :: typeof(x) != 7 :: vlen(y) > 0
26955 @end example
26956
26957 @noindent
26958 where of course 7 is the @code{typeof} code for error forms.
26959 Another final condition, that works for any kind of @samp{y},
26960 would be @samp{!istrue(y == [])}. (The @code{istrue} function
26961 returns an explicit 0 if its argument was left in symbolic form;
26962 plain @samp{!(y == [])} or @samp{y != []} would not work to replace
26963 @samp{!!![]} since these would be left unsimplified, and thus cause
26964 the rule to fail, if @samp{y} was something like a variable name.)
26965
26966 It is possible for a @samp{!!!} to refer to meta-variables bound
26967 elsewhere in the pattern. For example,
26968
26969 @example
26970 f(a, !!!a) := g(a)
26971 @end example
26972
26973 @noindent
26974 matches any call to @code{f} with different arguments, changing
26975 this to @code{g} with only the first argument.
26976
26977 If a function call is to be matched and one of the argument patterns
26978 contains a @samp{!!!} somewhere inside it, that argument will be
26979 matched last. Thus
26980
26981 @example
26982 f(!!!a, a) := g(a)
26983 @end example
26984
26985 @noindent
26986 will be careful to bind @samp{a} to the second argument of @code{f}
26987 before testing the first argument. If Calc had tried to match the
26988 first argument of @code{f} first, the results would have been
26989 disastrous: since @code{a} was unbound so far, the pattern @samp{a}
26990 would have matched anything at all, and the pattern @samp{!!!a}
26991 therefore would @emph{not} have matched anything at all!
26992
26993 @node Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26994 @subsection Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules
26995
26996 @noindent
26997 When @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) is used, it takes an expression from
26998 the top of the stack and attempts to match any of the specified rules
26999 to any part of the expression, starting with the whole expression
27000 and then, if that fails, trying deeper and deeper sub-expressions.
27001 For each part of the expression, the rules are tried in the order
27002 they appear in the rules vector. The first rule to match the first
27003 sub-expression wins; it replaces the matched sub-expression according
27004 to the @var{new} part of the rule.
27005
27006 Often, the rule set will match and change the formula several times.
27007 The top-level formula is first matched and substituted repeatedly until
27008 it no longer matches the pattern; then, sub-formulas are tried, and
27009 so on. Once every part of the formula has gotten its chance, the
27010 rewrite mechanism starts over again with the top-level formula
27011 (in case a substitution of one of its arguments has caused it again
27012 to match). This continues until no further matches can be made
27013 anywhere in the formula.
27014
27015 It is possible for a rule set to get into an infinite loop. The
27016 most obvious case, replacing a formula with itself, is not a problem
27017 because a rule is not considered to ``succeed'' unless the righthand
27018 side actually comes out to something different than the original
27019 formula or sub-formula that was matched. But if you accidentally
27020 had both @samp{ln(a b) := ln(a) + ln(b)} and the reverse
27021 @samp{ln(a) + ln(b) := ln(a b)} in your rule set, Calc would
27022 run forever switching a formula back and forth between the two
27023 forms.
27024
27025 To avoid disaster, Calc normally stops after 100 changes have been
27026 made to the formula. This will be enough for most multiple rewrites,
27027 but it will keep an endless loop of rewrites from locking up the
27028 computer forever. (On most systems, you can also type @kbd{C-g} to
27029 halt any Emacs command prematurely.)
27030
27031 To change this limit, give a positive numeric prefix argument.
27032 In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} applies only one rewrite at a time,
27033 useful when you are first testing your rule (or just if repeated
27034 rewriting is not what is called for by your application).
27035
27036 @ignore
27037 @starindex
27038 @end ignore
27039 @ignore
27040 @mindex iter@idots
27041 @end ignore
27042 @tindex iterations
27043 You can also put a ``function call'' @samp{iterations(@var{n})}
27044 in place of a rule anywhere in your rules vector (but usually at
27045 the top). Then, @var{n} will be used instead of 100 as the default
27046 number of iterations for this rule set. You can use
27047 @samp{iterations(inf)} if you want no iteration limit by default.
27048 A prefix argument will override the @code{iterations} limit in the
27049 rule set.
27050
27051 @example
27052 [ iterations(1),
27053 f(x) := f(x+1) ]
27054 @end example
27055
27056 More precisely, the limit controls the number of ``iterations,''
27057 where each iteration is a successful matching of a rule pattern whose
27058 righthand side, after substituting meta-variables and applying the
27059 default simplifications, is different from the original sub-formula
27060 that was matched.
27061
27062 A prefix argument of zero sets the limit to infinity. Use with caution!
27063
27064 Given a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{a r} will match and
27065 substitute the top-level expression up to that many times, but
27066 will not attempt to match the rules to any sub-expressions.
27067
27068 In a formula, @code{rewrite(@var{expr}, @var{rules}, @var{n})}
27069 does a rewriting operation. Here @var{expr} is the expression
27070 being rewritten, @var{rules} is the rule, vector of rules, or
27071 variable containing the rules, and @var{n} is the optional
27072 iteration limit, which may be a positive integer, a negative
27073 integer, or @samp{inf} or @samp{-inf}. If @var{n} is omitted
27074 the @code{iterations} value from the rule set is used; if both
27075 are omitted, 100 is used.
27076
27077 @node Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27078 @subsection Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules
27079
27080 @noindent
27081 It is possible to separate a rewrite rule set into several @dfn{phases}.
27082 During each phase, certain rules will be enabled while certain others
27083 will be disabled. A @dfn{phase schedule} controls the order in which
27084 phases occur during the rewriting process.
27085
27086 @ignore
27087 @starindex
27088 @end ignore
27089 @tindex phase
27090 @vindex all
27091 If a call to the marker function @code{phase} appears in the rules
27092 vector in place of a rule, all rules following that point will be
27093 members of the phase(s) identified in the arguments to @code{phase}.
27094 Phases are given integer numbers. The markers @samp{phase()} and
27095 @samp{phase(all)} both mean the following rules belong to all phases;
27096 this is the default at the start of the rule set.
27097
27098 If you do not explicitly schedule the phases, Calc sorts all phase
27099 numbers that appear in the rule set and executes the phases in
27100 ascending order. For example, the rule set
27101
27102 @example
27103 @group
27104 [ f0(x) := g0(x),
27105 phase(1),
27106 f1(x) := g1(x),
27107 phase(2),
27108 f2(x) := g2(x),
27109 phase(3),
27110 f3(x) := g3(x),
27111 phase(1,2),
27112 f4(x) := g4(x) ]
27113 @end group
27114 @end example
27115
27116 @noindent
27117 has three phases, 1 through 3. Phase 1 consists of the @code{f0},
27118 @code{f1}, and @code{f4} rules (in that order). Phase 2 consists of
27119 @code{f0}, @code{f2}, and @code{f4}. Phase 3 consists of @code{f0}
27120 and @code{f3}.
27121
27122 When Calc rewrites a formula using this rule set, it first rewrites
27123 the formula using only the phase 1 rules until no further changes are
27124 possible. Then it switches to the phase 2 rule set and continues
27125 until no further changes occur, then finally rewrites with phase 3.
27126 When no more phase 3 rules apply, rewriting finishes. (This is
27127 assuming @kbd{a r} with a large enough prefix argument to allow the
27128 rewriting to run to completion; the sequence just described stops
27129 early if the number of iterations specified in the prefix argument,
27130 100 by default, is reached.)
27131
27132 During each phase, Calc descends through the nested levels of the
27133 formula as described previously. (@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite
27134 Rules}.) Rewriting starts at the top of the formula, then works its
27135 way down to the parts, then goes back to the top and works down again.
27136 The phase 2 rules do not begin until no phase 1 rules apply anywhere
27137 in the formula.
27138
27139 @ignore
27140 @starindex
27141 @end ignore
27142 @tindex schedule
27143 A @code{schedule} marker appearing in the rule set (anywhere, but
27144 conventionally at the top) changes the default schedule of phases.
27145 In the simplest case, @code{schedule} has a sequence of phase numbers
27146 for arguments; each phase number is invoked in turn until the
27147 arguments to @code{schedule} are exhausted. Thus adding
27148 @samp{schedule(3,2,1)} at the top of the above rule set would
27149 reverse the order of the phases; @samp{schedule(1,2,3)} would have
27150 no effect since this is the default schedule; and @samp{schedule(1,2,1,3)}
27151 would give phase 1 a second chance after phase 2 has completed, before
27152 moving on to phase 3.
27153
27154 Any argument to @code{schedule} can instead be a vector of phase
27155 numbers (or even of sub-vectors). Then the sub-sequence of phases
27156 described by the vector are tried repeatedly until no change occurs
27157 in any phase in the sequence. For example, @samp{schedule([1, 2], 3)}
27158 tries phase 1, then phase 2, then, if either phase made any changes
27159 to the formula, repeats these two phases until they can make no
27160 further progress. Finally, it goes on to phase 3 for finishing
27161 touches.
27162
27163 Also, items in @code{schedule} can be variable names as well as
27164 numbers. A variable name is interpreted as the name of a function
27165 to call on the whole formula. For example, @samp{schedule(1, simplify)}
27166 says to apply the phase-1 rules (presumably, all of them), then to
27167 call @code{simplify} which is the function name equivalent of @kbd{a s}.
27168 Likewise, @samp{schedule([1, simplify])} says to alternate between
27169 phase 1 and @kbd{a s} until no further changes occur.
27170
27171 Phases can be used purely to improve efficiency; if it is known that
27172 a certain group of rules will apply only at the beginning of rewriting,
27173 and a certain other group will apply only at the end, then rewriting
27174 will be faster if these groups are identified as separate phases.
27175 Once the phase 1 rules are done, Calc can put them aside and no longer
27176 spend any time on them while it works on phase 2.
27177
27178 There are also some problems that can only be solved with several
27179 rewrite phases. For a real-world example of a multi-phase rule set,
27180 examine the set @code{FitRules}, which is used by the curve-fitting
27181 command to convert a model expression to linear form.
27182 @xref{Curve Fitting Details}. This set is divided into four phases.
27183 The first phase rewrites certain kinds of expressions to be more
27184 easily linearizable, but less computationally efficient. After the
27185 linear components have been picked out, the final phase includes the
27186 opposite rewrites to put each component back into an efficient form.
27187 If both sets of rules were included in one big phase, Calc could get
27188 into an infinite loop going back and forth between the two forms.
27189
27190 Elsewhere in @code{FitRules}, the components are first isolated,
27191 then recombined where possible to reduce the complexity of the linear
27192 fit, then finally packaged one component at a time into vectors.
27193 If the packaging rules were allowed to begin before the recombining
27194 rules were finished, some components might be put away into vectors
27195 before they had a chance to recombine. By putting these rules in
27196 two separate phases, this problem is neatly avoided.
27197
27198 @node Selections with Rewrite Rules, Matching Commands, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27199 @subsection Selections with Rewrite Rules
27200
27201 @noindent
27202 If a sub-formula of the current formula is selected (as by @kbd{j s};
27203 @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}), the @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite})
27204 command applies only to that sub-formula. Together with a negative
27205 prefix argument, you can use this fact to apply a rewrite to one
27206 specific part of a formula without affecting any other parts.
27207
27208 @kindex j r
27209 @pindex calc-rewrite-selection
27210 The @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command allows more
27211 sophisticated operations on selections. This command prompts for
27212 the rules in the same way as @kbd{a r}, but it then applies those
27213 rules to the whole formula in question even though a sub-formula
27214 of it has been selected. However, the selected sub-formula will
27215 first have been surrounded by a @samp{select( )} function call.
27216 (Calc's evaluator does not understand the function name @code{select};
27217 this is only a tag used by the @kbd{j r} command.)
27218
27219 For example, suppose the formula on the stack is @samp{2 (a + b)^2}
27220 and the sub-formula @samp{a + b} is selected. This formula will
27221 be rewritten to @samp{2 select(a + b)^2} and then the rewrite
27222 rules will be applied in the usual way. The rewrite rules can
27223 include references to @code{select} to tell where in the pattern
27224 the selected sub-formula should appear.
27225
27226 If there is still exactly one @samp{select( )} function call in
27227 the formula after rewriting is done, it indicates which part of
27228 the formula should be selected afterwards. Otherwise, the
27229 formula will be unselected.
27230
27231 You can make @kbd{j r} act much like @kbd{a r} by enclosing both parts
27232 of the rewrite rule with @samp{select()}. However, @kbd{j r}
27233 allows you to use the current selection in more flexible ways.
27234 Suppose you wished to make a rule which removed the exponent from
27235 the selected term; the rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} would
27236 work. In the above example, it would rewrite @samp{2 select(a + b)^2}
27237 to @samp{2 select(a + b)}. This would then be returned to the
27238 stack as @samp{2 (a + b)} with the @samp{a + b} selected.
27239
27240 The @kbd{j r} command uses one iteration by default, unlike
27241 @kbd{a r} which defaults to 100 iterations. A numeric prefix
27242 argument affects @kbd{j r} in the same way as @kbd{a r}.
27243 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.
27244
27245 As with other selection commands, @kbd{j r} operates on the stack
27246 entry that contains the cursor. (If the cursor is on the top-of-stack
27247 @samp{.} marker, it works as if the cursor were on the formula
27248 at stack level 1.)
27249
27250 If you don't specify a set of rules, the rules are taken from the
27251 top of the stack, just as with @kbd{a r}. In this case, the
27252 cursor must indicate stack entry 2 or above as the formula to be
27253 rewritten (otherwise the same formula would be used as both the
27254 target and the rewrite rules).
27255
27256 If the indicated formula has no selection, the cursor position within
27257 the formula temporarily selects a sub-formula for the purposes of this
27258 command. If the cursor is not on any sub-formula (e.g., it is in
27259 the line-number area to the left of the formula), the @samp{select( )}
27260 markers are ignored by the rewrite mechanism and the rules are allowed
27261 to apply anywhere in the formula.
27262
27263 As a special feature, the normal @kbd{a r} command also ignores
27264 @samp{select( )} calls in rewrite rules. For example, if you used the
27265 above rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} with @kbd{a r}, it would apply
27266 the rule as if it were @samp{a^x := a}. Thus, you can write general
27267 purpose rules with @samp{select( )} hints inside them so that they
27268 will ``do the right thing'' in both @kbd{a r} and @kbd{j r},
27269 both with and without selections.
27270
27271 @node Matching Commands, Automatic Rewrites, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27272 @subsection Matching Commands
27273
27274 @noindent
27275 @kindex a m
27276 @pindex calc-match
27277 @tindex match
27278 The @kbd{a m} (@code{calc-match}) [@code{match}] function takes a
27279 vector of formulas and a rewrite-rule-style pattern, and produces
27280 a vector of all formulas which match the pattern. The command
27281 prompts you to enter the pattern; as for @kbd{a r}, you can enter
27282 a single pattern (i.e., a formula with meta-variables), or a
27283 vector of patterns, or a variable which contains patterns, or
27284 you can give a blank response in which case the patterns are taken
27285 from the top of the stack. The pattern set will be compiled once
27286 and saved if it is stored in a variable. If there are several
27287 patterns in the set, vector elements are kept if they match any
27288 of the patterns.
27289
27290 For example, @samp{match(a+b, [x, x+y, x-y, 7, x+y+z])}
27291 will return @samp{[x+y, x-y, x+y+z]}.
27292
27293 The @code{import} mechanism is not available for pattern sets.
27294
27295 The @kbd{a m} command can also be used to extract all vector elements
27296 which satisfy any condition: The pattern @samp{x :: x>0} will select
27297 all the positive vector elements.
27298
27299 @kindex I a m
27300 @tindex matchnot
27301 With the Inverse flag [@code{matchnot}], this command extracts all
27302 vector elements which do @emph{not} match the given pattern.
27303
27304 @ignore
27305 @starindex
27306 @end ignore
27307 @tindex matches
27308 There is also a function @samp{matches(@var{x}, @var{p})} which
27309 evaluates to 1 if expression @var{x} matches pattern @var{p}, or
27310 to 0 otherwise. This is sometimes useful for including into the
27311 conditional clauses of other rewrite rules.
27312
27313 @ignore
27314 @starindex
27315 @end ignore
27316 @tindex vmatches
27317 The function @code{vmatches} is just like @code{matches}, except
27318 that if the match succeeds it returns a vector of assignments to
27319 the meta-variables instead of the number 1. For example,
27320 @samp{vmatches(f(1,2), f(a,b))} returns @samp{[a := 1, b := 2]}.
27321 If the match fails, the function returns the number 0.
27322
27323 @node Automatic Rewrites, Debugging Rewrites, Matching Commands, Rewrite Rules
27324 @subsection Automatic Rewrites
27325
27326 @noindent
27327 @cindex @code{EvalRules} variable
27328 @vindex EvalRules
27329 It is possible to get Calc to apply a set of rewrite rules on all
27330 results, effectively adding to the built-in set of default
27331 simplifications. To do this, simply store your rule set in the
27332 variable @code{EvalRules}. There is a convenient @kbd{s E} command
27333 for editing @code{EvalRules}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27334
27335 For example, suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out
27336 to @samp{sin(b) cos(a) + cos(b) sin(a)} wherever it appears, and
27337 similarly for @samp{cos(a + b)}. The corresponding rewrite rule
27338 set would be,
27339
27340 @smallexample
27341 @group
27342 [ sin(a + b) := cos(a) sin(b) + sin(a) cos(b),
27343 cos(a + b) := cos(a) cos(b) - sin(a) sin(b) ]
27344 @end group
27345 @end smallexample
27346
27347 To apply these manually, you could put them in a variable called
27348 @code{trigexp} and then use @kbd{a r trigexp} every time you wanted
27349 to expand trig functions. But if instead you store them in the
27350 variable @code{EvalRules}, they will automatically be applied to all
27351 sines and cosines of sums. Then, with @samp{2 x} and @samp{45} on
27352 the stack, typing @kbd{+ S} will (assuming Degrees mode) result in
27353 @samp{0.7071 sin(2 x) + 0.7071 cos(2 x)} automatically.
27354
27355 As each level of a formula is evaluated, the rules from
27356 @code{EvalRules} are applied before the default simplifications.
27357 Rewriting continues until no further @code{EvalRules} apply.
27358 Note that this is different from the usual order of application of
27359 rewrite rules: @code{EvalRules} works from the bottom up, simplifying
27360 the arguments to a function before the function itself, while @kbd{a r}
27361 applies rules from the top down.
27362
27363 Because the @code{EvalRules} are tried first, you can use them to
27364 override the normal behavior of any built-in Calc function.
27365
27366 It is important not to write a rule that will get into an infinite
27367 loop. For example, the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 1, f(n) := n f(n-1)]}
27368 appears to be a good definition of a factorial function, but it is
27369 unsafe. Imagine what happens if @samp{f(2.5)} is simplified. Calc
27370 will continue to subtract 1 from this argument forever without reaching
27371 zero. A safer second rule would be @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0}.
27372 Another dangerous rule is @samp{g(x, y) := g(y, x)}. Rewriting
27373 @samp{g(2, 4)}, this would bounce back and forth between that and
27374 @samp{g(4, 2)} forever. If an infinite loop in @code{EvalRules}
27375 occurs, Emacs will eventually stop with a ``Computation got stuck
27376 or ran too long'' message.
27377
27378 Another subtle difference between @code{EvalRules} and regular rewrites
27379 concerns rules that rewrite a formula into an identical formula. For
27380 example, @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} ``fails to match'' when @expr{n} is
27381 already an integer. But in @code{EvalRules} this case is detected only
27382 if the righthand side literally becomes the original formula before any
27383 further simplification. This means that @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} will
27384 get into an infinite loop if it occurs in @code{EvalRules}. Calc will
27385 replace @samp{f(6)} with @samp{f(floor(6))}, which is different from
27386 @samp{f(6)}, so it will consider the rule to have matched and will
27387 continue simplifying that formula; first the argument is simplified
27388 to get @samp{f(6)}, then the rule matches again to get @samp{f(floor(6))}
27389 again, ad infinitum. A much safer rule would check its argument first,
27390 say, with @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n)) :: !dint(n)}.
27391
27392 (What really happens is that the rewrite mechanism substitutes the
27393 meta-variables in the righthand side of a rule, compares to see if the
27394 result is the same as the original formula and fails if so, then uses
27395 the default simplifications to simplify the result and compares again
27396 (and again fails if the formula has simplified back to its original
27397 form). The only special wrinkle for the @code{EvalRules} is that the
27398 same rules will come back into play when the default simplifications
27399 are used. What Calc wants to do is build @samp{f(floor(6))}, see that
27400 this is different from the original formula, simplify to @samp{f(6)},
27401 see that this is the same as the original formula, and thus halt the
27402 rewriting. But while simplifying, @samp{f(6)} will again trigger
27403 the same @code{EvalRules} rule and Calc will get into a loop inside
27404 the rewrite mechanism itself.)
27405
27406 The @code{phase}, @code{schedule}, and @code{iterations} markers do
27407 not work in @code{EvalRules}. If the rule set is divided into phases,
27408 only the phase 1 rules are applied, and the schedule is ignored.
27409 The rules are always repeated as many times as possible.
27410
27411 The @code{EvalRules} are applied to all function calls in a formula,
27412 but not to numbers (and other number-like objects like error forms),
27413 nor to vectors or individual variable names. (Though they will apply
27414 to @emph{components} of vectors and error forms when appropriate.) You
27415 might try to make a variable @code{phihat} which automatically expands
27416 to its definition without the need to press @kbd{=} by writing the
27417 rule @samp{quote(phihat) := (1-sqrt(5))/2}, but unfortunately this rule
27418 will not work as part of @code{EvalRules}.
27419
27420 Finally, another limitation is that Calc sometimes calls its built-in
27421 functions directly rather than going through the default simplifications.
27422 When it does this, @code{EvalRules} will not be able to override those
27423 functions. For example, when you take the absolute value of the complex
27424 number @expr{(2, 3)}, Calc computes @samp{sqrt(2*2 + 3*3)} by calling
27425 the multiplication, addition, and square root functions directly rather
27426 than applying the default simplifications to this formula. So an
27427 @code{EvalRules} rule that (perversely) rewrites @samp{sqrt(13) := 6}
27428 would not apply. (However, if you put Calc into Symbolic mode so that
27429 @samp{sqrt(13)} will be left in symbolic form by the built-in square
27430 root function, your rule will be able to apply. But if the complex
27431 number were @expr{(3,4)}, so that @samp{sqrt(25)} must be calculated,
27432 then Symbolic mode will not help because @samp{sqrt(25)} can be
27433 evaluated exactly to 5.)
27434
27435 One subtle restriction that normally only manifests itself with
27436 @code{EvalRules} is that while a given rewrite rule is in the process
27437 of being checked, that same rule cannot be recursively applied. Calc
27438 effectively removes the rule from its rule set while checking the rule,
27439 then puts it back once the match succeeds or fails. (The technical
27440 reason for this is that compiled pattern programs are not reentrant.)
27441 For example, consider the rule @samp{foo(x) := x :: foo(x/2) > 0}
27442 attempting to match @samp{foo(8)}. This rule will be inactive while
27443 the condition @samp{foo(4) > 0} is checked, even though it might be
27444 an integral part of evaluating that condition. Note that this is not
27445 a problem for the more usual recursive type of rule, such as
27446 @samp{foo(x) := foo(x/2)}, because there the rule has succeeded and
27447 been reactivated by the time the righthand side is evaluated.
27448
27449 If @code{EvalRules} has no stored value (its default state), or if
27450 anything but a vector is stored in it, then it is ignored.
27451
27452 Even though Calc's rewrite mechanism is designed to compare rewrite
27453 rules to formulas as quickly as possible, storing rules in
27454 @code{EvalRules} may make Calc run substantially slower. This is
27455 particularly true of rules where the top-level call is a commonly used
27456 function, or is not fixed. The rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0} will
27457 only activate the rewrite mechanism for calls to the function @code{f},
27458 but @samp{lg(n) + lg(m) := lg(n m)} will check every @samp{+} operator.
27459
27460 @smallexample
27461 apply(f, [a*b]) := apply(f, [a]) + apply(f, [b]) :: in(f, [ln, log10])
27462 @end smallexample
27463
27464 @noindent
27465 may seem more ``efficient'' than two separate rules for @code{ln} and
27466 @code{log10}, but actually it is vastly less efficient because rules
27467 with @code{apply} as the top-level pattern must be tested against
27468 @emph{every} function call that is simplified.
27469
27470 @cindex @code{AlgSimpRules} variable
27471 @vindex AlgSimpRules
27472 Suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out not all the time,
27473 but only when @kbd{a s} is used to simplify the formula. The variable
27474 @code{AlgSimpRules} holds rules for this purpose. The @kbd{a s} command
27475 will apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules} to the formula, as
27476 well as all of its built-in simplifications.
27477
27478 Most of the special limitations for @code{EvalRules} don't apply to
27479 @code{AlgSimpRules}. Calc simply does an @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
27480 command with an infinite repeat count as the first step of @kbd{a s}.
27481 It then applies its own built-in simplifications throughout the
27482 formula, and then repeats these two steps (along with applying the
27483 default simplifications) until no further changes are possible.
27484
27485 @cindex @code{ExtSimpRules} variable
27486 @cindex @code{UnitSimpRules} variable
27487 @vindex ExtSimpRules
27488 @vindex UnitSimpRules
27489 There are also @code{ExtSimpRules} and @code{UnitSimpRules} variables
27490 that are used by @kbd{a e} and @kbd{u s}, respectively; these commands
27491 also apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. The variable
27492 @code{IntegSimpRules} contains simplification rules that are used
27493 only during integration by @kbd{a i}.
27494
27495 @node Debugging Rewrites, Examples of Rewrite Rules, Automatic Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27496 @subsection Debugging Rewrites
27497
27498 @noindent
27499 If a buffer named @samp{*Trace*} exists, the rewrite mechanism will
27500 record some useful information there as it operates. The original
27501 formula is written there, as is the result of each successful rewrite,
27502 and the final result of the rewriting. All phase changes are also
27503 noted.
27504
27505 Calc always appends to @samp{*Trace*}. You must empty this buffer
27506 yourself periodically if it is in danger of growing unwieldy.
27507
27508 Note that the rewriting mechanism is substantially slower when the
27509 @samp{*Trace*} buffer exists, even if the buffer is not visible on
27510 the screen. Once you are done, you will probably want to kill this
27511 buffer (with @kbd{C-x k *Trace* @key{RET}}). If you leave it in
27512 existence and forget about it, all your future rewrite commands will
27513 be needlessly slow.
27514
27515 @node Examples of Rewrite Rules, , Debugging Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27516 @subsection Examples of Rewrite Rules
27517
27518 @noindent
27519 Returning to the example of substituting the pattern
27520 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2} with 1, we saw that the rule
27521 @samp{opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a} does a good job of
27522 finding suitable cases. Another solution would be to use the rule
27523 @samp{cos(x)^2 := 1 - sin(x)^2}, followed by algebraic simplification
27524 if necessary. This rule will be the most effective way to do the job,
27525 but at the expense of making some changes that you might not desire.
27526
27527 Another algebraic rewrite rule is @samp{exp(x+y) := exp(x) exp(y)}.
27528 To make this work with the @w{@kbd{j r}} command so that it can be
27529 easily targeted to a particular exponential in a large formula,
27530 you might wish to write the rule as @samp{select(exp(x+y)) :=
27531 select(exp(x) exp(y))}. The @samp{select} markers will be
27532 ignored by the regular @kbd{a r} command
27533 (@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}).
27534
27535 A surprisingly useful rewrite rule is @samp{a/(b-c) := a*(b+c)/(b^2-c^2)}.
27536 This will simplify the formula whenever @expr{b} and/or @expr{c} can
27537 be made simpler by squaring. For example, applying this rule to
27538 @samp{2 / (sqrt(2) + 3)} yields @samp{6:7 - 2:7 sqrt(2)} (assuming
27539 Symbolic mode has been enabled to keep the square root from being
27540 evaluated to a floating-point approximation). This rule is also
27541 useful when working with symbolic complex numbers, e.g.,
27542 @samp{(a + b i) / (c + d i)}.
27543
27544 As another example, we could define our own ``triangular numbers'' function
27545 with the rules @samp{[tri(0) := 0, tri(n) := n + tri(n-1) :: n>0]}. Enter
27546 this vector and store it in a variable: @kbd{@w{s t} trirules}. Now, given
27547 a suitable formula like @samp{tri(5)} on the stack, type @samp{a r trirules}
27548 to apply these rules repeatedly. After six applications, @kbd{a r} will
27549 stop with 15 on the stack. Once these rules are debugged, it would probably
27550 be most useful to add them to @code{EvalRules} so that Calc will evaluate
27551 the new @code{tri} function automatically. We could then use @kbd{Z K} on
27552 the keyboard macro @kbd{' tri($) @key{RET}} to make a command that applies
27553 @code{tri} to the value on the top of the stack. @xref{Programming}.
27554
27555 @cindex Quaternions
27556 The following rule set, contributed by
27557 @texline Fran\c cois
27558 @infoline Francois
27559 Pinard, implements @dfn{quaternions}, a generalization of the concept of
27560 complex numbers. Quaternions have four components, and are here
27561 represented by function calls @samp{quat(@var{w}, [@var{x}, @var{y},
27562 @var{z}])} with ``real part'' @var{w} and the three ``imaginary'' parts
27563 collected into a vector. Various arithmetical operations on quaternions
27564 are supported. To use these rules, either add them to @code{EvalRules},
27565 or create a command based on @kbd{a r} for simplifying quaternion
27566 formulas. A convenient way to enter quaternions would be a command
27567 defined by a keyboard macro containing: @kbd{' quat($$$$, [$$$, $$, $])
27568 @key{RET}}.
27569
27570 @smallexample
27571 [ quat(w, x, y, z) := quat(w, [x, y, z]),
27572 quat(w, [0, 0, 0]) := w,
27573 abs(quat(w, v)) := hypot(w, v),
27574 -quat(w, v) := quat(-w, -v),
27575 r + quat(w, v) := quat(r + w, v) :: real(r),
27576 r - quat(w, v) := quat(r - w, -v) :: real(r),
27577 quat(w1, v1) + quat(w2, v2) := quat(w1 + w2, v1 + v2),
27578 r * quat(w, v) := quat(r * w, r * v) :: real(r),
27579 plain(quat(w1, v1) * quat(w2, v2))
27580 := quat(w1 * w2 - v1 * v2, w1 * v2 + w2 * v1 + cross(v1, v2)),
27581 quat(w1, v1) / r := quat(w1 / r, v1 / r) :: real(r),
27582 z / quat(w, v) := z * quatinv(quat(w, v)),
27583 quatinv(quat(w, v)) := quat(w, -v) / (w^2 + v^2),
27584 quatsqr(quat(w, v)) := quat(w^2 - v^2, 2 * w * v),
27585 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^(k / 2))
27586 :: integer(k) :: k > 0 :: k % 2 = 0,
27587 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^((k - 1) / 2)) * quat(w, v)
27588 :: integer(k) :: k > 2,
27589 quat(w, v)^-k := quatinv(quat(w, v)^k) :: integer(k) :: k > 0 ]
27590 @end smallexample
27591
27592 Quaternions, like matrices, have non-commutative multiplication.
27593 In other words, @expr{q1 * q2 = q2 * q1} is not necessarily true if
27594 @expr{q1} and @expr{q2} are @code{quat} forms. The @samp{quat*quat}
27595 rule above uses @code{plain} to prevent Calc from rearranging the
27596 product. It may also be wise to add the line @samp{[quat(), matrix]}
27597 to the @code{Decls} matrix, to ensure that Calc's other algebraic
27598 operations will not rearrange a quaternion product. @xref{Declarations}.
27599
27600 These rules also accept a four-argument @code{quat} form, converting
27601 it to the preferred form in the first rule. If you would rather see
27602 results in the four-argument form, just append the two items
27603 @samp{phase(2), quat(w, [x, y, z]) := quat(w, x, y, z)} to the end
27604 of the rule set. (But remember that multi-phase rule sets don't work
27605 in @code{EvalRules}.)
27606
27607 @node Units, Store and Recall, Algebra, Top
27608 @chapter Operating on Units
27609
27610 @noindent
27611 One special interpretation of algebraic formulas is as numbers with units.
27612 For example, the formula @samp{5 m / s^2} can be read ``five meters
27613 per second squared.'' The commands in this chapter help you
27614 manipulate units expressions in this form. Units-related commands
27615 begin with the @kbd{u} prefix key.
27616
27617 @menu
27618 * Basic Operations on Units::
27619 * The Units Table::
27620 * Predefined Units::
27621 * User-Defined Units::
27622 @end menu
27623
27624 @node Basic Operations on Units, The Units Table, Units, Units
27625 @section Basic Operations on Units
27626
27627 @noindent
27628 A @dfn{units expression} is a formula which is basically a number
27629 multiplied and/or divided by one or more @dfn{unit names}, which may
27630 optionally be raised to integer powers. Actually, the value part need not
27631 be a number; any product or quotient involving unit names is a units
27632 expression. Many of the units commands will also accept any formula,
27633 where the command applies to all units expressions which appear in the
27634 formula.
27635
27636 A unit name is a variable whose name appears in the @dfn{unit table},
27637 or a variable whose name is a prefix character like @samp{k} (for ``kilo'')
27638 or @samp{u} (for ``micro'') followed by a name in the unit table.
27639 A substantial table of built-in units is provided with Calc;
27640 @pxref{Predefined Units}. You can also define your own unit names;
27641 @pxref{User-Defined Units}.
27642
27643 Note that if the value part of a units expression is exactly @samp{1},
27644 it will be removed by the Calculator's automatic algebra routines: The
27645 formula @samp{1 mm} is ``simplified'' to @samp{mm}. This is only a
27646 display anomaly, however; @samp{mm} will work just fine as a
27647 representation of one millimeter.
27648
27649 You may find that Algebraic mode (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}) makes working
27650 with units expressions easier. Otherwise, you will have to remember
27651 to hit the apostrophe key every time you wish to enter units.
27652
27653 @kindex u s
27654 @pindex calc-simplify-units
27655 @ignore
27656 @mindex usimpl@idots
27657 @end ignore
27658 @tindex usimplify
27659 The @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) [@code{usimplify}] command
27660 simplifies a units
27661 expression. It uses @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) to simplify the
27662 expression first as a regular algebraic formula; it then looks for
27663 features that can be further simplified by converting one object's units
27664 to be compatible with another's. For example, @samp{5 m + 23 mm} will
27665 simplify to @samp{5.023 m}. When different but compatible units are
27666 added, the righthand term's units are converted to match those of the
27667 lefthand term. @xref{Simplification Modes}, for a way to have this done
27668 automatically at all times.
27669
27670 Units simplification also handles quotients of two units with the same
27671 dimensionality, as in @w{@samp{2 in s/L cm}} to @samp{5.08 s/L}; fractional
27672 powers of unit expressions, as in @samp{sqrt(9 mm^2)} to @samp{3 mm} and
27673 @samp{sqrt(9 acre)} to a quantity in meters; and @code{floor},
27674 @code{ceil}, @code{round}, @code{rounde}, @code{roundu}, @code{trunc},
27675 @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{abs}, and @code{clean}
27676 applied to units expressions, in which case
27677 the operation in question is applied only to the numeric part of the
27678 expression. Finally, trigonometric functions of quantities with units
27679 of angle are evaluated, regardless of the current angular mode.
27680
27681 @kindex u c
27682 @pindex calc-convert-units
27683 The @kbd{u c} (@code{calc-convert-units}) command converts a units
27684 expression to new, compatible units. For example, given the units
27685 expression @samp{55 mph}, typing @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces
27686 @samp{24.5872 m/s}. If you have previously converted a units expression
27687 with the same type of units (in this case, distance over time), you will
27688 be offered the previous choice of new units as a default. Continuing
27689 the above example, entering the units expression @samp{100 km/hr} and
27690 typing @kbd{u c @key{RET}} (without specifying new units) produces
27691 @samp{27.7777777778 m/s}.
27692
27693 While many of Calc's conversion factors are exact, some are necessarily
27694 approximate. If Calc is in fraction mode (@pxref{Fraction Mode}), then
27695 unit conversions will try to give exact, rational conversions, but it
27696 isn't always possible. Given @samp{55 mph} in fraction mode, typing
27697 @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces @samp{15367:625 m/s}, for example,
27698 while typing @kbd{u c au/yr @key{RET}} produces
27699 @samp{5.18665819999e-3 au/yr}.
27700
27701 If the units you request are inconsistent with the original units, the
27702 number will be converted into your units times whatever ``remainder''
27703 units are left over. For example, converting @samp{55 mph} into acres
27704 produces @samp{6.08e-3 acre / m s}. (Recall that multiplication binds
27705 more strongly than division in Calc formulas, so the units here are
27706 acres per meter-second.) Remainder units are expressed in terms of
27707 ``fundamental'' units like @samp{m} and @samp{s}, regardless of the
27708 input units.
27709
27710 One special exception is that if you specify a single unit name, and
27711 a compatible unit appears somewhere in the units expression, then
27712 that compatible unit will be converted to the new unit and the
27713 remaining units in the expression will be left alone. For example,
27714 given the input @samp{980 cm/s^2}, the command @kbd{u c ms} will
27715 change the @samp{s} to @samp{ms} to get @samp{9.8e-4 cm/ms^2}.
27716 The ``remainder unit'' @samp{cm} is left alone rather than being
27717 changed to the base unit @samp{m}.
27718
27719 You can use explicit unit conversion instead of the @kbd{u s} command
27720 to gain more control over the units of the result of an expression.
27721 For example, given @samp{5 m + 23 mm}, you can type @kbd{u c m} or
27722 @kbd{u c mm} to express the result in either meters or millimeters.
27723 (For that matter, you could type @kbd{u c fath} to express the result
27724 in fathoms, if you preferred!)
27725
27726 In place of a specific set of units, you can also enter one of the
27727 units system names @code{si}, @code{mks} (equivalent), or @code{cgs}.
27728 For example, @kbd{u c si @key{RET}} converts the expression into
27729 International System of Units (SI) base units. Also, @kbd{u c base}
27730 converts to Calc's base units, which are the same as @code{si} units
27731 except that @code{base} uses @samp{g} as the fundamental unit of mass
27732 whereas @code{si} uses @samp{kg}.
27733
27734 @cindex Composite units
27735 The @kbd{u c} command also accepts @dfn{composite units}, which
27736 are expressed as the sum of several compatible unit names. For
27737 example, converting @samp{30.5 in} to units @samp{mi+ft+in} (miles,
27738 feet, and inches) produces @samp{2 ft + 6.5 in}. Calc first
27739 sorts the unit names into order of decreasing relative size.
27740 It then accounts for as much of the input quantity as it can
27741 using an integer number times the largest unit, then moves on
27742 to the next smaller unit, and so on. Only the smallest unit
27743 may have a non-integer amount attached in the result. A few
27744 standard unit names exist for common combinations, such as
27745 @code{mfi} for @samp{mi+ft+in}, and @code{tpo} for @samp{ton+lb+oz}.
27746 Composite units are expanded as if by @kbd{a x}, so that
27747 @samp{(ft+in)/hr} is first converted to @samp{ft/hr+in/hr}.
27748
27749 If the value on the stack does not contain any units, @kbd{u c} will
27750 prompt first for the old units which this value should be considered
27751 to have, then for the new units. Assuming the old and new units you
27752 give are consistent with each other, the result also will not contain
27753 any units. For example, @kbd{@w{u c} cm @key{RET} in @key{RET}}
27754 converts the number 2 on the stack to 5.08.
27755
27756 @kindex u b
27757 @pindex calc-base-units
27758 The @kbd{u b} (@code{calc-base-units}) command is shorthand for
27759 @kbd{u c base}; it converts the units expression on the top of the
27760 stack into @code{base} units. If @kbd{u s} does not simplify a
27761 units expression as far as you would like, try @kbd{u b}.
27762
27763 The @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u b} commands treat temperature units (like
27764 @samp{degC} and @samp{K}) as relative temperatures. For example,
27765 @kbd{u c} converts @samp{10 degC} to @samp{18 degF}: A change of 10
27766 degrees Celsius corresponds to a change of 18 degrees Fahrenheit.
27767
27768 @kindex u t
27769 @pindex calc-convert-temperature
27770 @cindex Temperature conversion
27771 The @kbd{u t} (@code{calc-convert-temperature}) command converts
27772 absolute temperatures. The value on the stack must be a simple units
27773 expression with units of temperature only. This command would convert
27774 @samp{10 degC} to @samp{50 degF}, the equivalent temperature on the
27775 Fahrenheit scale.
27776
27777 @kindex u r
27778 @pindex calc-remove-units
27779 @kindex u x
27780 @pindex calc-extract-units
27781 The @kbd{u r} (@code{calc-remove-units}) command removes units from the
27782 formula at the top of the stack. The @kbd{u x}
27783 (@code{calc-extract-units}) command extracts only the units portion of a
27784 formula. These commands essentially replace every term of the formula
27785 that does or doesn't (respectively) look like a unit name by the
27786 constant 1, then resimplify the formula.
27787
27788 @kindex u a
27789 @pindex calc-autorange-units
27790 The @kbd{u a} (@code{calc-autorange-units}) command turns on and off a
27791 mode in which unit prefixes like @code{k} (``kilo'') are automatically
27792 applied to keep the numeric part of a units expression in a reasonable
27793 range. This mode affects @kbd{u s} and all units conversion commands
27794 except @kbd{u b}. For example, with autoranging on, @samp{12345 Hz}
27795 will be simplified to @samp{12.345 kHz}. Autoranging is useful for
27796 some kinds of units (like @code{Hz} and @code{m}), but is probably
27797 undesirable for non-metric units like @code{ft} and @code{tbsp}.
27798 (Composite units are more appropriate for those; see above.)
27799
27800 Autoranging always applies the prefix to the leftmost unit name.
27801 Calc chooses the largest prefix that causes the number to be greater
27802 than or equal to 1.0. Thus an increasing sequence of adjusted times
27803 would be @samp{1 ms, 10 ms, 100 ms, 1 s, 10 s, 100 s, 1 ks}.
27804 Generally the rule of thumb is that the number will be adjusted
27805 to be in the interval @samp{[1 .. 1000)}, although there are several
27806 exceptions to this rule. First, if the unit has a power then this
27807 is not possible; @samp{0.1 s^2} simplifies to @samp{100000 ms^2}.
27808 Second, the ``centi-'' prefix is allowed to form @code{cm} (centimeters),
27809 but will not apply to other units. The ``deci-,'' ``deka-,'' and
27810 ``hecto-'' prefixes are never used. Thus the allowable interval is
27811 @samp{[1 .. 10)} for millimeters and @samp{[1 .. 100)} for centimeters.
27812 Finally, a prefix will not be added to a unit if the resulting name
27813 is also the actual name of another unit; @samp{1e-15 t} would normally
27814 be considered a ``femto-ton,'' but it is written as @samp{1000 at}
27815 (1000 atto-tons) instead because @code{ft} would be confused with feet.
27816
27817 @node The Units Table, Predefined Units, Basic Operations on Units, Units
27818 @section The Units Table
27819
27820 @noindent
27821 @kindex u v
27822 @pindex calc-enter-units-table
27823 The @kbd{u v} (@code{calc-enter-units-table}) command displays the units table
27824 in another buffer called @code{*Units Table*}. Each entry in this table
27825 gives the unit name as it would appear in an expression, the definition
27826 of the unit in terms of simpler units, and a full name or description of
27827 the unit. Fundamental units are defined as themselves; these are the
27828 units produced by the @kbd{u b} command. The fundamental units are
27829 meters, seconds, grams, kelvins, amperes, candelas, moles, radians,
27830 and steradians.
27831
27832 The Units Table buffer also displays the Unit Prefix Table. Note that
27833 two prefixes, ``kilo'' and ``hecto,'' accept either upper- or lower-case
27834 prefix letters. @samp{Meg} is also accepted as a synonym for the @samp{M}
27835 prefix. Whenever a unit name can be interpreted as either a built-in name
27836 or a prefix followed by another built-in name, the former interpretation
27837 wins. For example, @samp{2 pt} means two pints, not two pico-tons.
27838
27839 The Units Table buffer, once created, is not rebuilt unless you define
27840 new units. To force the buffer to be rebuilt, give any numeric prefix
27841 argument to @kbd{u v}.
27842
27843 @kindex u V
27844 @pindex calc-view-units-table
27845 The @kbd{u V} (@code{calc-view-units-table}) command is like @kbd{u v} except
27846 that the cursor is not moved into the Units Table buffer. You can
27847 type @kbd{u V} again to remove the Units Table from the display. To
27848 return from the Units Table buffer after a @kbd{u v}, type @kbd{C-x * c}
27849 again or use the regular Emacs @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window})
27850 command. You can also kill the buffer with @kbd{C-x k} if you wish;
27851 the actual units table is safely stored inside the Calculator.
27852
27853 @kindex u g
27854 @pindex calc-get-unit-definition
27855 The @kbd{u g} (@code{calc-get-unit-definition}) command retrieves a unit's
27856 defining expression and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. For example,
27857 @kbd{u g in} will produce the expression @samp{2.54 cm}. This is the
27858 same definition for the unit that would appear in the Units Table buffer.
27859 Note that this command works only for actual unit names; @kbd{u g km}
27860 will report that no such unit exists, for example, because @code{km} is
27861 really the unit @code{m} with a @code{k} (``kilo'') prefix. To see a
27862 definition of a unit in terms of base units, it is easier to push the
27863 unit name on the stack and then reduce it to base units with @kbd{u b}.
27864
27865 @kindex u e
27866 @pindex calc-explain-units
27867 The @kbd{u e} (@code{calc-explain-units}) command displays an English
27868 description of the units of the expression on the stack. For example,
27869 for the expression @samp{62 km^2 g / s^2 mol K}, the description is
27870 ``Square-Kilometer Gram per (Second-squared Mole Degree-Kelvin).'' This
27871 command uses the English descriptions that appear in the righthand
27872 column of the Units Table.
27873
27874 @node Predefined Units, User-Defined Units, The Units Table, Units
27875 @section Predefined Units
27876
27877 @noindent
27878 The definitions of many units have changed over the years. For example,
27879 the meter was originally defined in 1791 as one ten-millionth of the
27880 distance from the equator to the north pole. In order to be more
27881 precise, the definition was adjusted several times, and now a meter is
27882 defined as the distance that light will travel in a vacuum in
27883 1/299792458 of a second; consequently, the speed of light in a
27884 vacuum is exactly 299792458 m/s. Many other units have been
27885 redefined in terms of fundamental physical processes; a second, for
27886 example, is currently defined as 9192631770 periods of a certain
27887 radiation related to the cesium-133 atom. The only SI unit that is not
27888 based on a fundamental physical process (although there are efforts to
27889 change this) is the kilogram, which was originally defined as the mass
27890 of one liter of water, but is now defined as the mass of the
27891 International Prototype Kilogram (IPK), a cylinder of platinum-iridium
27892 kept at the Bureau International des Poids et Mesures in S@`evres,
27893 France. (There are several copies of the IPK throughout the world.)
27894 The British imperial units, once defined in terms of physical objects,
27895 were redefined in 1963 in terms of SI units. The US customary units,
27896 which were the same as British units until the British imperial system
27897 was created in 1824, were also defined in terms of the SI units in 1893.
27898 Because of these redefinitions, conversions between metric, British
27899 Imperial, and US customary units can often be done precisely.
27900
27901 Since the exact definitions of many kinds of units have evolved over the
27902 years, and since certain countries sometimes have local differences in
27903 their definitions, it is a good idea to examine Calc's definition of a
27904 unit before depending on its exact value. For example, there are three
27905 different units for gallons, corresponding to the US (@code{gal}),
27906 Canadian (@code{galC}), and British (@code{galUK}) definitions. Also,
27907 note that @code{oz} is a standard ounce of mass, @code{ozt} is a Troy
27908 ounce, and @code{ozfl} is a fluid ounce.
27909
27910 The temperature units corresponding to degrees Kelvin and Centigrade
27911 (Celsius) are the same in this table, since most units commands treat
27912 temperatures as being relative. The @code{calc-convert-temperature}
27913 command has special rules for handling the different absolute magnitudes
27914 of the various temperature scales.
27915
27916 The unit of volume ``liters'' can be referred to by either the lower-case
27917 @code{l} or the upper-case @code{L}.
27918
27919 The unit @code{A} stands for Amperes; the name @code{Ang} is used
27920 @tex
27921 for \AA ngstroms.
27922 @end tex
27923 @ifnottex
27924 for Angstroms.
27925 @end ifnottex
27926
27927 The unit @code{pt} stands for pints; the name @code{point} stands for
27928 a typographical point, defined by @samp{72 point = 1 in}. This is
27929 slightly different than the point defined by the American Typefounder's
27930 Association in 1886, but the point used by Calc has become standard
27931 largely due to its use by the PostScript page description language.
27932 There is also @code{texpt}, which stands for a printer's point as
27933 defined by the @TeX{} typesetting system: @samp{72.27 texpt = 1 in}.
27934 Other units used by @TeX{} are available; they are @code{texpc} (a pica),
27935 @code{texbp} (a ``big point'', equal to a standard point which is larger
27936 than the point used by @TeX{}), @code{texdd} (a Didot point),
27937 @code{texcc} (a Cicero) and @code{texsp} (a scaled @TeX{} point,
27938 all dimensions representable in @TeX{} are multiples of this value).
27939
27940 The unit @code{e} stands for the elementary (electron) unit of charge;
27941 because algebra command could mistake this for the special constant
27942 @expr{e}, Calc provides the alternate unit name @code{ech} which is
27943 preferable to @code{e}.
27944
27945 The name @code{g} stands for one gram of mass; there is also @code{gf},
27946 one gram of force. (Likewise for @kbd{lb}, pounds, and @kbd{lbf}.)
27947 Meanwhile, one ``@expr{g}'' of acceleration is denoted @code{ga}.
27948
27949 The unit @code{ton} is a U.S. ton of @samp{2000 lb}, and @code{t} is
27950 a metric ton of @samp{1000 kg}.
27951
27952 The names @code{s} (or @code{sec}) and @code{min} refer to units of
27953 time; @code{arcsec} and @code{arcmin} are units of angle.
27954
27955 Some ``units'' are really physical constants; for example, @code{c}
27956 represents the speed of light, and @code{h} represents Planck's
27957 constant. You can use these just like other units: converting
27958 @samp{.5 c} to @samp{m/s} expresses one-half the speed of light in
27959 meters per second. You can also use this merely as a handy reference;
27960 the @kbd{u g} command gets the definition of one of these constants
27961 in its normal terms, and @kbd{u b} expresses the definition in base
27962 units.
27963
27964 Two units, @code{pi} and @code{alpha} (the fine structure constant,
27965 approximately @mathit{1/137}) are dimensionless. The units simplification
27966 commands simply treat these names as equivalent to their corresponding
27967 values. However you can, for example, use @kbd{u c} to convert a pure
27968 number into multiples of the fine structure constant, or @kbd{u b} to
27969 convert this back into a pure number. (When @kbd{u c} prompts for the
27970 ``old units,'' just enter a blank line to signify that the value
27971 really is unitless.)
27972
27973 @c Describe angular units, luminosity vs. steradians problem.
27974
27975 @node User-Defined Units, , Predefined Units, Units
27976 @section User-Defined Units
27977
27978 @noindent
27979 Calc provides ways to get quick access to your selected ``favorite''
27980 units, as well as ways to define your own new units.
27981
27982 @kindex u 0-9
27983 @pindex calc-quick-units
27984 @vindex Units
27985 @cindex @code{Units} variable
27986 @cindex Quick units
27987 To select your favorite units, store a vector of unit names or
27988 expressions in the Calc variable @code{Units}. The @kbd{u 1}
27989 through @kbd{u 9} commands (@code{calc-quick-units}) provide access
27990 to these units. If the value on the top of the stack is a plain
27991 number (with no units attached), then @kbd{u 1} gives it the
27992 specified units. (Basically, it multiplies the number by the
27993 first item in the @code{Units} vector.) If the number on the
27994 stack @emph{does} have units, then @kbd{u 1} converts that number
27995 to the new units. For example, suppose the vector @samp{[in, ft]}
27996 is stored in @code{Units}. Then @kbd{30 u 1} will create the
27997 expression @samp{30 in}, and @kbd{u 2} will convert that expression
27998 to @samp{2.5 ft}.
27999
28000 The @kbd{u 0} command accesses the tenth element of @code{Units}.
28001 Only ten quick units may be defined at a time. If the @code{Units}
28002 variable has no stored value (the default), or if its value is not
28003 a vector, then the quick-units commands will not function. The
28004 @kbd{s U} command is a convenient way to edit the @code{Units}
28005 variable; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
28006
28007 @kindex u d
28008 @pindex calc-define-unit
28009 @cindex User-defined units
28010 The @kbd{u d} (@code{calc-define-unit}) command records the units
28011 expression on the top of the stack as the definition for a new,
28012 user-defined unit. For example, putting @samp{16.5 ft} on the stack and
28013 typing @kbd{u d rod} defines the new unit @samp{rod} to be equivalent to
28014 16.5 feet. The unit conversion and simplification commands will now
28015 treat @code{rod} just like any other unit of length. You will also be
28016 prompted for an optional English description of the unit, which will
28017 appear in the Units Table. If you wish the definition of this unit to
28018 be displayed in a special way in the Units Table buffer (such as with an
28019 asterisk to indicate an approximate value), then you can call this
28020 command with an argument, @kbd{C-u u d}; you will then also be prompted
28021 for a string that will be used to display the definition.
28022
28023 @kindex u u
28024 @pindex calc-undefine-unit
28025 The @kbd{u u} (@code{calc-undefine-unit}) command removes a user-defined
28026 unit. It is not possible to remove one of the predefined units,
28027 however.
28028
28029 If you define a unit with an existing unit name, your new definition
28030 will replace the original definition of that unit. If the unit was a
28031 predefined unit, the old definition will not be replaced, only
28032 ``shadowed.'' The built-in definition will reappear if you later use
28033 @kbd{u u} to remove the shadowing definition.
28034
28035 To create a new fundamental unit, use either 1 or the unit name itself
28036 as the defining expression. Otherwise the expression can involve any
28037 other units that you like (except for composite units like @samp{mfi}).
28038 You can create a new composite unit with a sum of other units as the
28039 defining expression. The next unit operation like @kbd{u c} or @kbd{u v}
28040 will rebuild the internal unit table incorporating your modifications.
28041 Note that erroneous definitions (such as two units defined in terms of
28042 each other) will not be detected until the unit table is next rebuilt;
28043 @kbd{u v} is a convenient way to force this to happen.
28044
28045 Temperature units are treated specially inside the Calculator; it is not
28046 possible to create user-defined temperature units.
28047
28048 @kindex u p
28049 @pindex calc-permanent-units
28050 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined units
28051 The @kbd{u p} (@code{calc-permanent-units}) command stores the user-defined
28052 units in your Calc init file (the file given by the variable
28053 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}), so that the
28054 units will still be available in subsequent Emacs sessions. If there
28055 was already a set of user-defined units in your Calc init file, it
28056 is replaced by the new set. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to
28057 tell Calc to use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28058
28059 @node Store and Recall, Graphics, Units, Top
28060 @chapter Storing and Recalling
28061
28062 @noindent
28063 Calculator variables are really just Lisp variables that contain numbers
28064 or formulas in a form that Calc can understand. The commands in this
28065 section allow you to manipulate variables conveniently. Commands related
28066 to variables use the @kbd{s} prefix key.
28067
28068 @menu
28069 * Storing Variables::
28070 * Recalling Variables::
28071 * Operations on Variables::
28072 * Let Command::
28073 * Evaluates-To Operator::
28074 @end menu
28075
28076 @node Storing Variables, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall, Store and Recall
28077 @section Storing Variables
28078
28079 @noindent
28080 @kindex s s
28081 @pindex calc-store
28082 @cindex Storing variables
28083 @cindex Quick variables
28084 @vindex q0
28085 @vindex q9
28086 The @kbd{s s} (@code{calc-store}) command stores the value at the top of
28087 the stack into a specified variable. It prompts you to enter the
28088 name of the variable. If you press a single digit, the value is stored
28089 immediately in one of the ``quick'' variables @code{q0} through
28090 @code{q9}. Or you can enter any variable name.
28091
28092 @kindex s t
28093 @pindex calc-store-into
28094 The @kbd{s s} command leaves the stored value on the stack. There is
28095 also an @kbd{s t} (@code{calc-store-into}) command, which removes a
28096 value from the stack and stores it in a variable.
28097
28098 If the top of stack value is an equation @samp{a = 7} or assignment
28099 @samp{a := 7} with a variable on the lefthand side, then Calc will
28100 assign that variable with that value by default, i.e., if you type
28101 @kbd{s s @key{RET}} or @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. In this example, the
28102 value 7 would be stored in the variable @samp{a}. (If you do type
28103 a variable name at the prompt, the top-of-stack value is stored in
28104 its entirety, even if it is an equation: @samp{s s b @key{RET}}
28105 with @samp{a := 7} on the stack stores @samp{a := 7} in @code{b}.)
28106
28107 In fact, the top of stack value can be a vector of equations or
28108 assignments with different variables on their lefthand sides; the
28109 default will be to store all the variables with their corresponding
28110 righthand sides simultaneously.
28111
28112 It is also possible to type an equation or assignment directly at
28113 the prompt for the @kbd{s s} or @kbd{s t} command: @kbd{s s foo = 7}.
28114 In this case the expression to the right of the @kbd{=} or @kbd{:=}
28115 symbol is evaluated as if by the @kbd{=} command, and that value is
28116 stored in the variable. No value is taken from the stack; @kbd{s s}
28117 and @kbd{s t} are equivalent when used in this way.
28118
28119 @kindex s 0-9
28120 @kindex t 0-9
28121 The prefix keys @kbd{s} and @kbd{t} may be followed immediately by a
28122 digit; @kbd{s 9} is equivalent to @kbd{s s 9}, and @kbd{t 9} is
28123 equivalent to @kbd{s t 9}. (The @kbd{t} prefix is otherwise used
28124 for trail and time/date commands.)
28125
28126 @kindex s +
28127 @kindex s -
28128 @ignore
28129 @mindex @idots
28130 @end ignore
28131 @kindex s *
28132 @ignore
28133 @mindex @null
28134 @end ignore
28135 @kindex s /
28136 @ignore
28137 @mindex @null
28138 @end ignore
28139 @kindex s ^
28140 @ignore
28141 @mindex @null
28142 @end ignore
28143 @kindex s |
28144 @ignore
28145 @mindex @null
28146 @end ignore
28147 @kindex s n
28148 @ignore
28149 @mindex @null
28150 @end ignore
28151 @kindex s &
28152 @ignore
28153 @mindex @null
28154 @end ignore
28155 @kindex s [
28156 @ignore
28157 @mindex @null
28158 @end ignore
28159 @kindex s ]
28160 @pindex calc-store-plus
28161 @pindex calc-store-minus
28162 @pindex calc-store-times
28163 @pindex calc-store-div
28164 @pindex calc-store-power
28165 @pindex calc-store-concat
28166 @pindex calc-store-neg
28167 @pindex calc-store-inv
28168 @pindex calc-store-decr
28169 @pindex calc-store-incr
28170 There are also several ``arithmetic store'' commands. For example,
28171 @kbd{s +} removes a value from the stack and adds it to the specified
28172 variable. The other arithmetic stores are @kbd{s -}, @kbd{s *}, @kbd{s /},
28173 @kbd{s ^}, and @w{@kbd{s |}} (vector concatenation), plus @kbd{s n} and
28174 @kbd{s &} which negate or invert the value in a variable, and @w{@kbd{s [}}
28175 and @kbd{s ]} which decrease or increase a variable by one.
28176
28177 All the arithmetic stores accept the Inverse prefix to reverse the
28178 order of the operands. If @expr{v} represents the contents of the
28179 variable, and @expr{a} is the value drawn from the stack, then regular
28180 @w{@kbd{s -}} assigns
28181 @texline @math{v \coloneq v - a},
28182 @infoline @expr{v := v - a},
28183 but @kbd{I s -} assigns
28184 @texline @math{v \coloneq a - v}.
28185 @infoline @expr{v := a - v}.
28186 While @kbd{I s *} might seem pointless, it is
28187 useful if matrix multiplication is involved. Actually, all the
28188 arithmetic stores use formulas designed to behave usefully both
28189 forwards and backwards:
28190
28191 @example
28192 @group
28193 s + v := v + a v := a + v
28194 s - v := v - a v := a - v
28195 s * v := v * a v := a * v
28196 s / v := v / a v := a / v
28197 s ^ v := v ^ a v := a ^ v
28198 s | v := v | a v := a | v
28199 s n v := v / (-1) v := (-1) / v
28200 s & v := v ^ (-1) v := (-1) ^ v
28201 s [ v := v - 1 v := 1 - v
28202 s ] v := v - (-1) v := (-1) - v
28203 @end group
28204 @end example
28205
28206 In the last four cases, a numeric prefix argument will be used in
28207 place of the number one. (For example, @kbd{M-2 s ]} increases
28208 a variable by 2, and @kbd{M-2 I s ]} replaces a variable by
28209 minus-two minus the variable.
28210
28211 The first six arithmetic stores can also be typed @kbd{s t +}, @kbd{s t -},
28212 etc. The commands @kbd{s s +}, @kbd{s s -}, and so on are analogous
28213 arithmetic stores that don't remove the value @expr{a} from the stack.
28214
28215 All arithmetic stores report the new value of the variable in the
28216 Trail for your information. They signal an error if the variable
28217 previously had no stored value. If default simplifications have been
28218 turned off, the arithmetic stores temporarily turn them on for numeric
28219 arguments only (i.e., they temporarily do an @kbd{m N} command).
28220 @xref{Simplification Modes}. Large vectors put in the trail by
28221 these commands always use abbreviated (@kbd{t .}) mode.
28222
28223 @kindex s m
28224 @pindex calc-store-map
28225 The @kbd{s m} command is a general way to adjust a variable's value
28226 using any Calc function. It is a ``mapping'' command analogous to
28227 @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R}, etc. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, to see
28228 how to specify a function for a mapping command. Basically,
28229 all you do is type the Calc command key that would invoke that
28230 function normally. For example, @kbd{s m n} applies the @kbd{n}
28231 key to negate the contents of the variable, so @kbd{s m n} is
28232 equivalent to @kbd{s n}. Also, @kbd{s m Q} takes the square root
28233 of the value stored in a variable, @kbd{s m v v} uses @kbd{v v} to
28234 reverse the vector stored in the variable, and @kbd{s m H I S}
28235 takes the hyperbolic arcsine of the variable contents.
28236
28237 If the mapping function takes two or more arguments, the additional
28238 arguments are taken from the stack; the old value of the variable
28239 is provided as the first argument. Thus @kbd{s m -} with @expr{a}
28240 on the stack computes @expr{v - a}, just like @kbd{s -}. With the
28241 Inverse prefix, the variable's original value becomes the @emph{last}
28242 argument instead of the first. Thus @kbd{I s m -} is also
28243 equivalent to @kbd{I s -}.
28244
28245 @kindex s x
28246 @pindex calc-store-exchange
28247 The @kbd{s x} (@code{calc-store-exchange}) command exchanges the value
28248 of a variable with the value on the top of the stack. Naturally, the
28249 variable must already have a stored value for this to work.
28250
28251 You can type an equation or assignment at the @kbd{s x} prompt. The
28252 command @kbd{s x a=6} takes no values from the stack; instead, it
28253 pushes the old value of @samp{a} on the stack and stores @samp{a = 6}.
28254
28255 @kindex s u
28256 @pindex calc-unstore
28257 @cindex Void variables
28258 @cindex Un-storing variables
28259 Until you store something in them, most variables are ``void,'' that is,
28260 they contain no value at all. If they appear in an algebraic formula
28261 they will be left alone even if you press @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
28262 The @kbd{s u} (@code{calc-unstore}) command returns a variable to the
28263 void state.
28264
28265 @kindex s c
28266 @pindex calc-copy-variable
28267 The @kbd{s c} (@code{calc-copy-variable}) command copies the stored
28268 value of one variable to another. One way it differs from a simple
28269 @kbd{s r} followed by an @kbd{s t} (aside from saving keystrokes) is
28270 that the value never goes on the stack and thus is never rounded,
28271 evaluated, or simplified in any way; it is not even rounded down to the
28272 current precision.
28273
28274 The only variables with predefined values are the ``special constants''
28275 @code{pi}, @code{e}, @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}. You are free
28276 to unstore these variables or to store new values into them if you like,
28277 although some of the algebraic-manipulation functions may assume these
28278 variables represent their standard values. Calc displays a warning if
28279 you change the value of one of these variables, or of one of the other
28280 special variables @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} (which are
28281 normally void).
28282
28283 Note that @code{pi} doesn't actually have 3.14159265359 stored in it,
28284 but rather a special magic value that evaluates to @cpi{} at the current
28285 precision. Likewise @code{e}, @code{i}, and @code{phi} evaluate
28286 according to the current precision or polar mode. If you recall a value
28287 from @code{pi} and store it back, this magic property will be lost. The
28288 magic property is preserved, however, when a variable is copied with
28289 @kbd{s c}.
28290
28291 @kindex s k
28292 @pindex calc-copy-special-constant
28293 If one of the ``special constants'' is redefined (or undefined) so that
28294 it no longer has its magic property, the property can be restored with
28295 @kbd{s k} (@code{calc-copy-special-constant}). This command will prompt
28296 for a special constant and a variable to store it in, and so a special
28297 constant can be stored in any variable. Here, the special constant that
28298 you enter doesn't depend on the value of the corresponding variable;
28299 @code{pi} will represent 3.14159@dots{} regardless of what is currently
28300 stored in the Calc variable @code{pi}. If one of the other special
28301 variables, @code{inf}, @code{uinf} or @code{nan}, is given a value, its
28302 original behavior can be restored by voiding it with @kbd{s u}.
28303
28304 @node Recalling Variables, Operations on Variables, Storing Variables, Store and Recall
28305 @section Recalling Variables
28306
28307 @noindent
28308 @kindex s r
28309 @pindex calc-recall
28310 @cindex Recalling variables
28311 The most straightforward way to extract the stored value from a variable
28312 is to use the @kbd{s r} (@code{calc-recall}) command. This command prompts
28313 for a variable name (similarly to @code{calc-store}), looks up the value
28314 of the specified variable, and pushes that value onto the stack. It is
28315 an error to try to recall a void variable.
28316
28317 It is also possible to recall the value from a variable by evaluating a
28318 formula containing that variable. For example, @kbd{' a @key{RET} =} is
28319 the same as @kbd{s r a @key{RET}} except that if the variable is void, the
28320 former will simply leave the formula @samp{a} on the stack whereas the
28321 latter will produce an error message.
28322
28323 @kindex r 0-9
28324 The @kbd{r} prefix may be followed by a digit, so that @kbd{r 9} is
28325 equivalent to @kbd{s r 9}.
28326
28327 @node Operations on Variables, Let Command, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall
28328 @section Other Operations on Variables
28329
28330 @noindent
28331 @kindex s e
28332 @pindex calc-edit-variable
28333 The @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command edits the stored
28334 value of a variable without ever putting that value on the stack
28335 or simplifying or evaluating the value. It prompts for the name of
28336 the variable to edit. If the variable has no stored value, the
28337 editing buffer will start out empty. If the editing buffer is
28338 empty when you press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish, the variable will
28339 be made void. @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, for a general
28340 description of editing.
28341
28342 The @kbd{s e} command is especially useful for creating and editing
28343 rewrite rules which are stored in variables. Sometimes these rules
28344 contain formulas which must not be evaluated until the rules are
28345 actually used. (For example, they may refer to @samp{deriv(x,y)},
28346 where @code{x} will someday become some expression involving @code{y};
28347 if you let Calc evaluate the rule while you are defining it, Calc will
28348 replace @samp{deriv(x,y)} with 0 because the formula @code{x} does
28349 not itself refer to @code{y}.) By contrast, recalling the variable,
28350 editing with @kbd{`}, and storing will evaluate the variable's value
28351 as a side effect of putting the value on the stack.
28352
28353 @kindex s A
28354 @kindex s D
28355 @ignore
28356 @mindex @idots
28357 @end ignore
28358 @kindex s E
28359 @ignore
28360 @mindex @null
28361 @end ignore
28362 @kindex s F
28363 @ignore
28364 @mindex @null
28365 @end ignore
28366 @kindex s G
28367 @ignore
28368 @mindex @null
28369 @end ignore
28370 @kindex s H
28371 @ignore
28372 @mindex @null
28373 @end ignore
28374 @kindex s I
28375 @ignore
28376 @mindex @null
28377 @end ignore
28378 @kindex s L
28379 @ignore
28380 @mindex @null
28381 @end ignore
28382 @kindex s P
28383 @ignore
28384 @mindex @null
28385 @end ignore
28386 @kindex s R
28387 @ignore
28388 @mindex @null
28389 @end ignore
28390 @kindex s T
28391 @ignore
28392 @mindex @null
28393 @end ignore
28394 @kindex s U
28395 @ignore
28396 @mindex @null
28397 @end ignore
28398 @kindex s X
28399 @pindex calc-store-AlgSimpRules
28400 @pindex calc-store-Decls
28401 @pindex calc-store-EvalRules
28402 @pindex calc-store-FitRules
28403 @pindex calc-store-GenCount
28404 @pindex calc-store-Holidays
28405 @pindex calc-store-IntegLimit
28406 @pindex calc-store-LineStyles
28407 @pindex calc-store-PointStyles
28408 @pindex calc-store-PlotRejects
28409 @pindex calc-store-TimeZone
28410 @pindex calc-store-Units
28411 @pindex calc-store-ExtSimpRules
28412 There are several special-purpose variable-editing commands that
28413 use the @kbd{s} prefix followed by a shifted letter:
28414
28415 @table @kbd
28416 @item s A
28417 Edit @code{AlgSimpRules}. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
28418 @item s D
28419 Edit @code{Decls}. @xref{Declarations}.
28420 @item s E
28421 Edit @code{EvalRules}. @xref{Default Simplifications}.
28422 @item s F
28423 Edit @code{FitRules}. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
28424 @item s G
28425 Edit @code{GenCount}. @xref{Solving Equations}.
28426 @item s H
28427 Edit @code{Holidays}. @xref{Business Days}.
28428 @item s I
28429 Edit @code{IntegLimit}. @xref{Calculus}.
28430 @item s L
28431 Edit @code{LineStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28432 @item s P
28433 Edit @code{PointStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28434 @item s R
28435 Edit @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Graphics}.
28436 @item s T
28437 Edit @code{TimeZone}. @xref{Time Zones}.
28438 @item s U
28439 Edit @code{Units}. @xref{User-Defined Units}.
28440 @item s X
28441 Edit @code{ExtSimpRules}. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
28442 @end table
28443
28444 These commands are just versions of @kbd{s e} that use fixed variable
28445 names rather than prompting for the variable name.
28446
28447 @kindex s p
28448 @pindex calc-permanent-variable
28449 @cindex Storing variables
28450 @cindex Permanent variables
28451 @cindex Calc init file, variables
28452 The @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command saves a
28453 variable's value permanently in your Calc init file (the file given by
28454 the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}), so
28455 that its value will still be available in future Emacs sessions. You
28456 can re-execute @w{@kbd{s p}} later on to update the saved value, but the
28457 only way to remove a saved variable is to edit your calc init file
28458 by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
28459 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28460
28461 If you do not specify the name of a variable to save (i.e.,
28462 @kbd{s p @key{RET}}), all Calc variables with defined values
28463 are saved except for the special constants @code{pi}, @code{e},
28464 @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}; the variables @code{TimeZone}
28465 and @code{PlotRejects};
28466 @code{FitRules}, @code{DistribRules}, and other built-in rewrite
28467 rules; and @code{PlotData@var{n}} variables generated
28468 by the graphics commands. (You can still save these variables by
28469 explicitly naming them in an @kbd{s p} command.)
28470
28471 @kindex s i
28472 @pindex calc-insert-variables
28473 The @kbd{s i} (@code{calc-insert-variables}) command writes
28474 the values of all Calc variables into a specified buffer.
28475 The variables are written with the prefix @code{var-} in the form of
28476 Lisp @code{setq} commands
28477 which store the values in string form. You can place these commands
28478 in your Calc init file (or @file{.emacs}) if you wish, though in this case it
28479 would be easier to use @kbd{s p @key{RET}}. (Note that @kbd{s i}
28480 omits the same set of variables as @w{@kbd{s p @key{RET}}}; the difference
28481 is that @kbd{s i} will store the variables in any buffer, and it also
28482 stores in a more human-readable format.)
28483
28484 @node Let Command, Evaluates-To Operator, Operations on Variables, Store and Recall
28485 @section The Let Command
28486
28487 @noindent
28488 @kindex s l
28489 @pindex calc-let
28490 @cindex Variables, temporary assignment
28491 @cindex Temporary assignment to variables
28492 If you have an expression like @samp{a+b^2} on the stack and you wish to
28493 compute its value where @expr{b=3}, you can simply store 3 in @expr{b} and
28494 then press @kbd{=} to reevaluate the formula. This has the side-effect
28495 of leaving the stored value of 3 in @expr{b} for future operations.
28496
28497 The @kbd{s l} (@code{calc-let}) command evaluates a formula under a
28498 @emph{temporary} assignment of a variable. It stores the value on the
28499 top of the stack into the specified variable, then evaluates the
28500 second-to-top stack entry, then restores the original value (or lack of one)
28501 in the variable. Thus after @kbd{'@w{ }a+b^2 @key{RET} 3 s l b @key{RET}},
28502 the stack will contain the formula @samp{a + 9}. The subsequent command
28503 @kbd{@w{5 s l a} @key{RET}} will replace this formula with the number 14.
28504 The variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} are not permanently affected in any way
28505 by these commands.
28506
28507 The value on the top of the stack may be an equation or assignment, or
28508 a vector of equations or assignments, in which case the default will be
28509 analogous to the case of @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
28510
28511 Also, you can answer the variable-name prompt with an equation or
28512 assignment: @kbd{s l b=3 @key{RET}} is the same as storing 3 on the stack
28513 and typing @kbd{s l b @key{RET}}.
28514
28515 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) command is another way to substitute
28516 a variable with a value in a formula. It does an actual substitution
28517 rather than temporarily assigning the variable and evaluating. For
28518 example, letting @expr{n=2} in @samp{f(n pi)} with @kbd{a b} will
28519 produce @samp{f(2 pi)}, whereas @kbd{s l} would give @samp{f(6.28)}
28520 since the evaluation step will also evaluate @code{pi}.
28521
28522 @node Evaluates-To Operator, , Let Command, Store and Recall
28523 @section The Evaluates-To Operator
28524
28525 @noindent
28526 @tindex evalto
28527 @tindex =>
28528 @cindex Evaluates-to operator
28529 @cindex @samp{=>} operator
28530 The special algebraic symbol @samp{=>} is known as the @dfn{evaluates-to
28531 operator}. (It will show up as an @code{evalto} function call in
28532 other language modes like Pascal and La@TeX{}.) This is a binary
28533 operator, that is, it has a lefthand and a righthand argument,
28534 although it can be entered with the righthand argument omitted.
28535
28536 A formula like @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}} is evaluated by Calc as
28537 follows: First, @var{a} is not simplified or modified in any
28538 way. The previous value of argument @var{b} is thrown away; the
28539 formula @var{a} is then copied and evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
28540 command according to all current modes and stored variable values,
28541 and the result is installed as the new value of @var{b}.
28542
28543 For example, suppose you enter the algebraic formula @samp{2 + 3 => 17}.
28544 The number 17 is ignored, and the lefthand argument is left in its
28545 unevaluated form; the result is the formula @samp{2 + 3 => 5}.
28546
28547 @kindex s =
28548 @pindex calc-evalto
28549 You can enter an @samp{=>} formula either directly using algebraic
28550 entry (in which case the righthand side may be omitted since it is
28551 going to be replaced right away anyhow), or by using the @kbd{s =}
28552 (@code{calc-evalto}) command, which takes @var{a} from the stack
28553 and replaces it with @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}}.
28554
28555 Calc keeps track of all @samp{=>} operators on the stack, and
28556 recomputes them whenever anything changes that might affect their
28557 values, i.e., a mode setting or variable value. This occurs only
28558 if the @samp{=>} operator is at the top level of the formula, or
28559 if it is part of a top-level vector. In other words, pushing
28560 @samp{2 + (a => 17)} will change the 17 to the actual value of
28561 @samp{a} when you enter the formula, but the result will not be
28562 dynamically updated when @samp{a} is changed later because the
28563 @samp{=>} operator is buried inside a sum. However, a vector
28564 of @samp{=>} operators will be recomputed, since it is convenient
28565 to push a vector like @samp{[a =>, b =>, c =>]} on the stack to
28566 make a concise display of all the variables in your problem.
28567 (Another way to do this would be to use @samp{[a, b, c] =>},
28568 which provides a slightly different format of display. You
28569 can use whichever you find easiest to read.)
28570
28571 @kindex m C
28572 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
28573 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command allows you to
28574 turn this automatic recomputation on or off. If you turn
28575 recomputation off, you must explicitly recompute an @samp{=>}
28576 operator on the stack in one of the usual ways, such as by
28577 pressing @kbd{=}. Turning recomputation off temporarily can save
28578 a lot of time if you will be changing several modes or variables
28579 before you look at the @samp{=>} entries again.
28580
28581 Most commands are not especially useful with @samp{=>} operators
28582 as arguments. For example, given @samp{x + 2 => 17}, it won't
28583 work to type @kbd{1 +} to get @samp{x + 3 => 18}. If you want
28584 to operate on the lefthand side of the @samp{=>} operator on
28585 the top of the stack, type @kbd{j 1} (that's the digit ``one'')
28586 to select the lefthand side, execute your commands, then type
28587 @kbd{j u} to unselect.
28588
28589 All current modes apply when an @samp{=>} operator is computed,
28590 including the current simplification mode. Recall that the
28591 formula @samp{x + y + x} is not handled by Calc's default
28592 simplifications, but the @kbd{a s} command will reduce it to
28593 the simpler form @samp{y + 2 x}. You can also type @kbd{m A}
28594 to enable an Algebraic Simplification mode in which the
28595 equivalent of @kbd{a s} is used on all of Calc's results.
28596 If you enter @samp{x + y + x =>} normally, the result will
28597 be @samp{x + y + x => x + y + x}. If you change to
28598 Algebraic Simplification mode, the result will be
28599 @samp{x + y + x => y + 2 x}. However, just pressing @kbd{a s}
28600 once will have no effect on @samp{x + y + x => x + y + x},
28601 because the righthand side depends only on the lefthand side
28602 and the current mode settings, and the lefthand side is not
28603 affected by commands like @kbd{a s}.
28604
28605 The ``let'' command (@kbd{s l}) has an interesting interaction
28606 with the @samp{=>} operator. The @kbd{s l} command evaluates the
28607 second-to-top stack entry with the top stack entry supplying
28608 a temporary value for a given variable. As you might expect,
28609 if that stack entry is an @samp{=>} operator its righthand
28610 side will temporarily show this value for the variable. In
28611 fact, all @samp{=>}s on the stack will be updated if they refer
28612 to that variable. But this change is temporary in the sense
28613 that the next command that causes Calc to look at those stack
28614 entries will make them revert to the old variable value.
28615
28616 @smallexample
28617 @group
28618 2: a => a 2: a => 17 2: a => a
28619 1: a + 1 => a + 1 1: a + 1 => 18 1: a + 1 => a + 1
28620 . . .
28621
28622 17 s l a @key{RET} p 8 @key{RET}
28623 @end group
28624 @end smallexample
28625
28626 Here the @kbd{p 8} command changes the current precision,
28627 thus causing the @samp{=>} forms to be recomputed after the
28628 influence of the ``let'' is gone. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command
28629 (@code{calc-refresh}) is a handy way to force the @samp{=>}
28630 operators on the stack to be recomputed without any other
28631 side effects.
28632
28633 @kindex s :
28634 @pindex calc-assign
28635 @tindex assign
28636 @tindex :=
28637 Embedded mode also uses @samp{=>} operators. In Embedded mode,
28638 the lefthand side of an @samp{=>} operator can refer to variables
28639 assigned elsewhere in the file by @samp{:=} operators. The
28640 assignment operator @samp{a := 17} does not actually do anything
28641 by itself. But Embedded mode recognizes it and marks it as a sort
28642 of file-local definition of the variable. You can enter @samp{:=}
28643 operators in Algebraic mode, or by using the @kbd{s :}
28644 (@code{calc-assign}) [@code{assign}] command which takes a variable
28645 and value from the stack and replaces them with an assignment.
28646
28647 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for the way @samp{=>} appears in
28648 @TeX{} language output. The @dfn{eqn} mode gives similar
28649 treatment to @samp{=>}.
28650
28651 @node Graphics, Kill and Yank, Store and Recall, Top
28652 @chapter Graphics
28653
28654 @noindent
28655 The commands for graphing data begin with the @kbd{g} prefix key. Calc
28656 uses GNUPLOT 2.0 or later to do graphics. These commands will only work
28657 if GNUPLOT is available on your system. (While GNUPLOT sounds like
28658 a relative of GNU Emacs, it is actually completely unrelated.
28659 However, it is free software. It can be obtained from
28660 @samp{http://www.gnuplot.info}.)
28661
28662 @vindex calc-gnuplot-name
28663 If you have GNUPLOT installed on your system but Calc is unable to
28664 find it, you may need to set the @code{calc-gnuplot-name} variable in
28665 your Calc init file or @file{.emacs}. You may also need to set some
28666 Lisp variables to show Calc how to run GNUPLOT on your system; these
28667 are described under @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} below. If you are using
28668 the X window system or MS-Windows, Calc will configure GNUPLOT for you
28669 automatically. If you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later and you are using a
28670 Unix or GNU system without X, Calc will configure GNUPLOT to display
28671 graphs using simple character graphics that will work on any
28672 Posix-compatible terminal.
28673
28674 @menu
28675 * Basic Graphics::
28676 * Three Dimensional Graphics::
28677 * Managing Curves::
28678 * Graphics Options::
28679 * Devices::
28680 @end menu
28681
28682 @node Basic Graphics, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics, Graphics
28683 @section Basic Graphics
28684
28685 @noindent
28686 @kindex g f
28687 @pindex calc-graph-fast
28688 The easiest graphics command is @kbd{g f} (@code{calc-graph-fast}).
28689 This command takes two vectors of equal length from the stack.
28690 The vector at the top of the stack represents the ``y'' values of
28691 the various data points. The vector in the second-to-top position
28692 represents the corresponding ``x'' values. This command runs
28693 GNUPLOT (if it has not already been started by previous graphing
28694 commands) and displays the set of data points. The points will
28695 be connected by lines, and there will also be some kind of symbol
28696 to indicate the points themselves.
28697
28698 The ``x'' entry may instead be an interval form, in which case suitable
28699 ``x'' values are interpolated between the minimum and maximum values of
28700 the interval (whether the interval is open or closed is ignored).
28701
28702 The ``x'' entry may also be a number, in which case Calc uses the
28703 sequence of ``x'' values @expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, @expr{x+2}, etc.
28704 (Generally the number 0 or 1 would be used for @expr{x} in this case.)
28705
28706 The ``y'' entry may be any formula instead of a vector. Calc effectively
28707 uses @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) to evaluate variables in the formula;
28708 the result of this must be a formula in a single (unassigned) variable.
28709 The formula is plotted with this variable taking on the various ``x''
28710 values. Graphs of formulas by default use lines without symbols at the
28711 computed data points. Note that if neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is a vector,
28712 Calc guesses at a reasonable number of data points to use. See the
28713 @kbd{g N} command below. (The ``x'' values must be either a vector
28714 or an interval if ``y'' is a formula.)
28715
28716 @ignore
28717 @starindex
28718 @end ignore
28719 @tindex xy
28720 If ``y'' is (or evaluates to) a formula of the form
28721 @samp{xy(@var{x}, @var{y})} then the result is a
28722 parametric plot. The two arguments of the fictitious @code{xy} function
28723 are used as the ``x'' and ``y'' coordinates of the curve, respectively.
28724 In this case the ``x'' vector or interval you specified is not directly
28725 visible in the graph. For example, if ``x'' is the interval @samp{[0..360]}
28726 and ``y'' is the formula @samp{xy(sin(t), cos(t))}, the resulting graph
28727 will be a circle.
28728
28729 Also, ``x'' and ``y'' may each be variable names, in which case Calc
28730 looks for suitable vectors, intervals, or formulas stored in those
28731 variables.
28732
28733 The ``x'' and ``y'' values for the data points (as pulled from the vectors,
28734 calculated from the formulas, or interpolated from the intervals) should
28735 be real numbers (integers, fractions, or floats). One exception to this
28736 is that the ``y'' entry can consist of a vector of numbers combined with
28737 error forms, in which case the points will be plotted with the
28738 appropriate error bars. Other than this, if either the ``x''
28739 value or the ``y'' value of a given data point is not a real number, that
28740 data point will be omitted from the graph. The points on either side
28741 of the invalid point will @emph{not} be connected by a line.
28742
28743 See the documentation for @kbd{g a} below for a description of the way
28744 numeric prefix arguments affect @kbd{g f}.
28745
28746 @cindex @code{PlotRejects} variable
28747 @vindex PlotRejects
28748 If you store an empty vector in the variable @code{PlotRejects}
28749 (i.e., @kbd{[ ] s t PlotRejects}), Calc will append information to
28750 this vector for every data point which was rejected because its
28751 ``x'' or ``y'' values were not real numbers. The result will be
28752 a matrix where each row holds the curve number, data point number,
28753 ``x'' value, and ``y'' value for a rejected data point.
28754 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a handy way to keep tabs on the
28755 current value of @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Operations on Variables},
28756 for the @kbd{s R} command which is another easy way to examine
28757 @code{PlotRejects}.
28758
28759 @kindex g c
28760 @pindex calc-graph-clear
28761 To clear the graphics display, type @kbd{g c} (@code{calc-graph-clear}).
28762 If the GNUPLOT output device is an X window, the window will go away.
28763 Effects on other kinds of output devices will vary. You don't need
28764 to use @kbd{g c} if you don't want to---if you give another @kbd{g f}
28765 or @kbd{g p} command later on, it will reuse the existing graphics
28766 window if there is one.
28767
28768 @node Three Dimensional Graphics, Managing Curves, Basic Graphics, Graphics
28769 @section Three-Dimensional Graphics
28770
28771 @kindex g F
28772 @pindex calc-graph-fast-3d
28773 The @kbd{g F} (@code{calc-graph-fast-3d}) command makes a three-dimensional
28774 graph. It works only if you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later; with GNUPLOT 2.0,
28775 you will see a GNUPLOT error message if you try this command.
28776
28777 The @kbd{g F} command takes three values from the stack, called ``x'',
28778 ``y'', and ``z'', respectively. As was the case for 2D graphs, there
28779 are several options for these values.
28780
28781 In the first case, ``x'' and ``y'' are each vectors (not necessarily of
28782 the same length); either or both may instead be interval forms. The
28783 ``z'' value must be a matrix with the same number of rows as elements
28784 in ``x'', and the same number of columns as elements in ``y''. The
28785 result is a surface plot where
28786 @texline @math{z_{ij}}
28787 @infoline @expr{z_ij}
28788 is the height of the point
28789 at coordinate @expr{(x_i, y_j)} on the surface. The 3D graph will
28790 be displayed from a certain default viewpoint; you can change this
28791 viewpoint by adding a @samp{set view} to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
28792 buffer as described later. See the GNUPLOT documentation for a
28793 description of the @samp{set view} command.
28794
28795 Each point in the matrix will be displayed as a dot in the graph,
28796 and these points will be connected by a grid of lines (@dfn{isolines}).
28797
28798 In the second case, ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' are all vectors of equal
28799 length. The resulting graph displays a 3D line instead of a surface,
28800 where the coordinates of points along the line are successive triplets
28801 of values from the input vectors.
28802
28803 In the third case, ``x'' and ``y'' are vectors or interval forms, and
28804 ``z'' is any formula involving two variables (not counting variables
28805 with assigned values). These variables are sorted into alphabetical
28806 order; the first takes on values from ``x'' and the second takes on
28807 values from ``y'' to form a matrix of results that are graphed as a
28808 3D surface.
28809
28810 @ignore
28811 @starindex
28812 @end ignore
28813 @tindex xyz
28814 If the ``z'' formula evaluates to a call to the fictitious function
28815 @samp{xyz(@var{x}, @var{y}, @var{z})}, then the result is a
28816 ``parametric surface.'' In this case, the axes of the graph are
28817 taken from the @var{x} and @var{y} values in these calls, and the
28818 ``x'' and ``y'' values from the input vectors or intervals are used only
28819 to specify the range of inputs to the formula. For example, plotting
28820 @samp{[0..360], [0..180], xyz(sin(x)*sin(y), cos(x)*sin(y), cos(y))}
28821 will draw a sphere. (Since the default resolution for 3D plots is
28822 5 steps in each of ``x'' and ``y'', this will draw a very crude
28823 sphere. You could use the @kbd{g N} command, described below, to
28824 increase this resolution, or specify the ``x'' and ``y'' values as
28825 vectors with more than 5 elements.
28826
28827 It is also possible to have a function in a regular @kbd{g f} plot
28828 evaluate to an @code{xyz} call. Since @kbd{g f} plots a line, not
28829 a surface, the result will be a 3D parametric line. For example,
28830 @samp{[[0..720], xyz(sin(x), cos(x), x)]} will plot two turns of a
28831 helix (a three-dimensional spiral).
28832
28833 As for @kbd{g f}, each of ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' may instead be
28834 variables containing the relevant data.
28835
28836 @node Managing Curves, Graphics Options, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics
28837 @section Managing Curves
28838
28839 @noindent
28840 The @kbd{g f} command is really shorthand for the following commands:
28841 @kbd{C-u g d g a g p}. Likewise, @w{@kbd{g F}} is shorthand for
28842 @kbd{C-u g d g A g p}. You can gain more control over your graph
28843 by using these commands directly.
28844
28845 @kindex g a
28846 @pindex calc-graph-add
28847 The @kbd{g a} (@code{calc-graph-add}) command adds the ``curve''
28848 represented by the two values on the top of the stack to the current
28849 graph. You can have any number of curves in the same graph. When
28850 you give the @kbd{g p} command, all the curves will be drawn superimposed
28851 on the same axes.
28852
28853 The @kbd{g a} command (and many others that affect the current graph)
28854 will cause a special buffer, @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}, to be displayed
28855 in another window. This buffer is a template of the commands that will
28856 be sent to GNUPLOT when it is time to draw the graph. The first
28857 @kbd{g a} command adds a @code{plot} command to this buffer. Succeeding
28858 @kbd{g a} commands add extra curves onto that @code{plot} command.
28859 Other graph-related commands put other GNUPLOT commands into this
28860 buffer. In normal usage you never need to work with this buffer
28861 directly, but you can if you wish. The only constraint is that there
28862 must be only one @code{plot} command, and it must be the last command
28863 in the buffer. If you want to save and later restore a complete graph
28864 configuration, you can use regular Emacs commands to save and restore
28865 the contents of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
28866
28867 @vindex PlotData1
28868 @vindex PlotData2
28869 If the values on the stack are not variable names, @kbd{g a} will invent
28870 variable names for them (of the form @samp{PlotData@var{n}}) and store
28871 the values in those variables. The ``x'' and ``y'' variables are what
28872 go into the @code{plot} command in the template. If you add a curve
28873 that uses a certain variable and then later change that variable, you
28874 can replot the graph without having to delete and re-add the curve.
28875 That's because the variable name, not the vector, interval or formula
28876 itself, is what was added by @kbd{g a}.
28877
28878 A numeric prefix argument on @kbd{g a} or @kbd{g f} changes the way
28879 stack entries are interpreted as curves. With a positive prefix
28880 argument @expr{n}, the top @expr{n} stack entries are ``y'' values
28881 for @expr{n} different curves which share a common ``x'' value in
28882 the @expr{n+1}st stack entry. (Thus @kbd{g a} with no prefix
28883 argument is equivalent to @kbd{C-u 1 g a}.)
28884
28885 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} means to take two stack entries,
28886 ``x'' and ``y'' as usual, but to interpret ``y'' as a vector of
28887 ``y'' values for several curves that share a common ``x''.
28888
28889 A negative prefix argument tells Calc to read @expr{n} vectors from
28890 the stack; each vector @expr{[x, y]} describes an independent curve.
28891 This is the only form of @kbd{g a} that creates several curves at once
28892 that don't have common ``x'' values. (Of course, the range of ``x''
28893 values covered by all the curves ought to be roughly the same if
28894 they are to look nice on the same graph.)
28895
28896 For example, to plot
28897 @texline @math{\sin n x}
28898 @infoline @expr{sin(n x)}
28899 for integers @expr{n}
28900 from 1 to 5, you could use @kbd{v x} to create a vector of integers
28901 (@expr{n}), then @kbd{V M '} or @kbd{V M $} to map @samp{sin(n x)}
28902 across this vector. The resulting vector of formulas is suitable
28903 for use as the ``y'' argument to a @kbd{C-u g a} or @kbd{C-u g f}
28904 command.
28905
28906 @kindex g A
28907 @pindex calc-graph-add-3d
28908 The @kbd{g A} (@code{calc-graph-add-3d}) command adds a 3D curve
28909 to the graph. It is not valid to intermix 2D and 3D curves in a
28910 single graph. This command takes three arguments, ``x'', ``y'',
28911 and ``z'', from the stack. With a positive prefix @expr{n}, it
28912 takes @expr{n+2} arguments (common ``x'' and ``y'', plus @expr{n}
28913 separate ``z''s). With a zero prefix, it takes three stack entries
28914 but the ``z'' entry is a vector of curve values. With a negative
28915 prefix @expr{-n}, it takes @expr{n} vectors of the form @expr{[x, y, z]}.
28916 The @kbd{g A} command works by adding a @code{splot} (surface-plot)
28917 command to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
28918
28919 (Although @kbd{g a} adds a 2D @code{plot} command to the
28920 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer, Calc changes this to @code{splot}
28921 before sending it to GNUPLOT if it notices that the data points are
28922 evaluating to @code{xyz} calls. It will not work to mix 2D and 3D
28923 @kbd{g a} curves in a single graph, although Calc does not currently
28924 check for this.)
28925
28926 @kindex g d
28927 @pindex calc-graph-delete
28928 The @kbd{g d} (@code{calc-graph-delete}) command deletes the most
28929 recently added curve from the graph. It has no effect if there are
28930 no curves in the graph. With a numeric prefix argument of any kind,
28931 it deletes all of the curves from the graph.
28932
28933 @kindex g H
28934 @pindex calc-graph-hide
28935 The @kbd{g H} (@code{calc-graph-hide}) command ``hides'' or ``unhides''
28936 the most recently added curve. A hidden curve will not appear in
28937 the actual plot, but information about it such as its name and line and
28938 point styles will be retained.
28939
28940 @kindex g j
28941 @pindex calc-graph-juggle
28942 The @kbd{g j} (@code{calc-graph-juggle}) command moves the curve
28943 at the end of the list (the ``most recently added curve'') to the
28944 front of the list. The next-most-recent curve is thus exposed for
28945 @w{@kbd{g d}} or similar commands to use. With @kbd{g j} you can work
28946 with any curve in the graph even though curve-related commands only
28947 affect the last curve in the list.
28948
28949 @kindex g p
28950 @pindex calc-graph-plot
28951 The @kbd{g p} (@code{calc-graph-plot}) command uses GNUPLOT to draw
28952 the graph described in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Any
28953 GNUPLOT parameters which are not defined by commands in this buffer
28954 are reset to their default values. The variables named in the @code{plot}
28955 command are written to a temporary data file and the variable names
28956 are then replaced by the file name in the template. The resulting
28957 plotting commands are fed to the GNUPLOT program. See the documentation
28958 for the GNUPLOT program for more specific information. All temporary
28959 files are removed when Emacs or GNUPLOT exits.
28960
28961 If you give a formula for ``y'', Calc will remember all the values that
28962 it calculates for the formula so that later plots can reuse these values.
28963 Calc throws out these saved values when you change any circumstances
28964 that may affect the data, such as switching from Degrees to Radians
28965 mode, or changing the value of a parameter in the formula. You can
28966 force Calc to recompute the data from scratch by giving a negative
28967 numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}.
28968
28969 Calc uses a fairly rough step size when graphing formulas over intervals.
28970 This is to ensure quick response. You can ``refine'' a plot by giving
28971 a positive numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}. Calc goes through
28972 the data points it has computed and saved from previous plots of the
28973 function, and computes and inserts a new data point midway between
28974 each of the existing points. You can refine a plot any number of times,
28975 but beware that the amount of calculation involved doubles each time.
28976
28977 Calc does not remember computed values for 3D graphs. This means the
28978 numerix prefix argument, if any, to @kbd{g p} is effectively ignored if
28979 the current graph is three-dimensional.
28980
28981 @kindex g P
28982 @pindex calc-graph-print
28983 The @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}) command is like @kbd{g p},
28984 except that it sends the output to a printer instead of to the
28985 screen. More precisely, @kbd{g p} looks for @samp{set terminal}
28986 or @samp{set output} commands in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer;
28987 lacking these it uses the default settings. However, @kbd{g P}
28988 ignores @samp{set terminal} and @samp{set output} commands and
28989 uses a different set of default values. All of these values are
28990 controlled by the @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} commands discussed below.
28991 Provided everything is set up properly, @kbd{g p} will plot to
28992 the screen unless you have specified otherwise and @kbd{g P} will
28993 always plot to the printer.
28994
28995 @node Graphics Options, Devices, Managing Curves, Graphics
28996 @section Graphics Options
28997
28998 @noindent
28999 @kindex g g
29000 @pindex calc-graph-grid
29001 The @kbd{g g} (@code{calc-graph-grid}) command turns the ``grid''
29002 on and off. It is off by default; tick marks appear only at the
29003 edges of the graph. With the grid turned on, dotted lines appear
29004 across the graph at each tick mark. Note that this command only
29005 changes the setting in @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}; to see the effects
29006 of the change you must give another @kbd{g p} command.
29007
29008 @kindex g b
29009 @pindex calc-graph-border
29010 The @kbd{g b} (@code{calc-graph-border}) command turns the border
29011 (the box that surrounds the graph) on and off. It is on by default.
29012 This command will only work with GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29013
29014 @kindex g k
29015 @pindex calc-graph-key
29016 The @kbd{g k} (@code{calc-graph-key}) command turns the ``key''
29017 on and off. The key is a chart in the corner of the graph that
29018 shows the correspondence between curves and line styles. It is
29019 off by default, and is only really useful if you have several
29020 curves on the same graph.
29021
29022 @kindex g N
29023 @pindex calc-graph-num-points
29024 The @kbd{g N} (@code{calc-graph-num-points}) command allows you
29025 to select the number of data points in the graph. This only affects
29026 curves where neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is specified as a vector.
29027 Enter a blank line to revert to the default value (initially 15).
29028 With no prefix argument, this command affects only the current graph.
29029 With a positive prefix argument this command changes or, if you enter
29030 a blank line, displays the default number of points used for all
29031 graphs created by @kbd{g a} that don't specify the resolution explicitly.
29032 With a negative prefix argument, this command changes or displays
29033 the default value (initially 5) used for 3D graphs created by @kbd{g A}.
29034 Note that a 3D setting of 5 means that a total of @expr{5^2 = 25} points
29035 will be computed for the surface.
29036
29037 Data values in the graph of a function are normally computed to a
29038 precision of five digits, regardless of the current precision at the
29039 time. This is usually more than adequate, but there are cases where
29040 it will not be. For example, plotting @expr{1 + x} with @expr{x} in the
29041 interval @samp{[0 ..@: 1e-6]} will round all the data points down
29042 to 1.0! Putting the command @samp{set precision @var{n}} in the
29043 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer will cause the data to be computed
29044 at precision @var{n} instead of 5. Since this is such a rare case,
29045 there is no keystroke-based command to set the precision.
29046
29047 @kindex g h
29048 @pindex calc-graph-header
29049 The @kbd{g h} (@code{calc-graph-header}) command sets the title
29050 for the graph. This will show up centered above the graph.
29051 The default title is blank (no title).
29052
29053 @kindex g n
29054 @pindex calc-graph-name
29055 The @kbd{g n} (@code{calc-graph-name}) command sets the title of an
29056 individual curve. Like the other curve-manipulating commands, it
29057 affects the most recently added curve, i.e., the last curve on the
29058 list in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. To set the title of
29059 the other curves you must first juggle them to the end of the list
29060 with @kbd{g j}, or edit the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer by hand.
29061 Curve titles appear in the key; if the key is turned off they are
29062 not used.
29063
29064 @kindex g t
29065 @kindex g T
29066 @pindex calc-graph-title-x
29067 @pindex calc-graph-title-y
29068 The @kbd{g t} (@code{calc-graph-title-x}) and @kbd{g T}
29069 (@code{calc-graph-title-y}) commands set the titles on the ``x''
29070 and ``y'' axes, respectively. These titles appear next to the
29071 tick marks on the left and bottom edges of the graph, respectively.
29072 Calc does not have commands to control the tick marks themselves,
29073 but you can edit them into the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer if
29074 you wish. See the GNUPLOT documentation for details.
29075
29076 @kindex g r
29077 @kindex g R
29078 @pindex calc-graph-range-x
29079 @pindex calc-graph-range-y
29080 The @kbd{g r} (@code{calc-graph-range-x}) and @kbd{g R}
29081 (@code{calc-graph-range-y}) commands set the range of values on the
29082 ``x'' and ``y'' axes, respectively. You are prompted to enter a
29083 suitable range. This should be either a pair of numbers of the
29084 form, @samp{@var{min}:@var{max}}, or a blank line to revert to the
29085 default behavior of setting the range based on the range of values
29086 in the data, or @samp{$} to take the range from the top of the stack.
29087 Ranges on the stack can be represented as either interval forms or
29088 vectors: @samp{[@var{min} ..@: @var{max}]} or @samp{[@var{min}, @var{max}]}.
29089
29090 @kindex g l
29091 @kindex g L
29092 @pindex calc-graph-log-x
29093 @pindex calc-graph-log-y
29094 The @kbd{g l} (@code{calc-graph-log-x}) and @kbd{g L} (@code{calc-graph-log-y})
29095 commands allow you to set either or both of the axes of the graph to
29096 be logarithmic instead of linear.
29097
29098 @kindex g C-l
29099 @kindex g C-r
29100 @kindex g C-t
29101 @pindex calc-graph-log-z
29102 @pindex calc-graph-range-z
29103 @pindex calc-graph-title-z
29104 For 3D plots, @kbd{g C-t}, @kbd{g C-r}, and @kbd{g C-l} (those are
29105 letters with the Control key held down) are the corresponding commands
29106 for the ``z'' axis.
29107
29108 @kindex g z
29109 @kindex g Z
29110 @pindex calc-graph-zero-x
29111 @pindex calc-graph-zero-y
29112 The @kbd{g z} (@code{calc-graph-zero-x}) and @kbd{g Z}
29113 (@code{calc-graph-zero-y}) commands control whether a dotted line is
29114 drawn to indicate the ``x'' and/or ``y'' zero axes. (These are the same
29115 dotted lines that would be drawn there anyway if you used @kbd{g g} to
29116 turn the ``grid'' feature on.) Zero-axis lines are on by default, and
29117 may be turned off only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions. They are
29118 not available for 3D plots.
29119
29120 @kindex g s
29121 @pindex calc-graph-line-style
29122 The @kbd{g s} (@code{calc-graph-line-style}) command turns the connecting
29123 lines on or off for the most recently added curve, and optionally selects
29124 the style of lines to be used for that curve. Plain @kbd{g s} simply
29125 toggles the lines on and off. With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g s}
29126 turns lines on and sets a particular line style. Line style numbers
29127 start at one and their meanings vary depending on the output device.
29128 GNUPLOT guarantees that there will be at least six different line styles
29129 available for any device.
29130
29131 @kindex g S
29132 @pindex calc-graph-point-style
29133 The @kbd{g S} (@code{calc-graph-point-style}) command similarly turns
29134 the symbols at the data points on or off, or sets the point style.
29135 If you turn both lines and points off, the data points will show as
29136 tiny dots. If the ``y'' values being plotted contain error forms and
29137 the connecting lines are turned off, then this command will also turn
29138 the error bars on or off.
29139
29140 @cindex @code{LineStyles} variable
29141 @cindex @code{PointStyles} variable
29142 @vindex LineStyles
29143 @vindex PointStyles
29144 Another way to specify curve styles is with the @code{LineStyles} and
29145 @code{PointStyles} variables. These variables initially have no stored
29146 values, but if you store a vector of integers in one of these variables,
29147 the @kbd{g a} and @kbd{g f} commands will use those style numbers
29148 instead of the defaults for new curves that are added to the graph.
29149 An entry should be a positive integer for a specific style, or 0 to let
29150 the style be chosen automatically, or @mathit{-1} to turn off lines or points
29151 altogether. If there are more curves than elements in the vector, the
29152 last few curves will continue to have the default styles. Of course,
29153 you can later use @kbd{g s} and @kbd{g S} to change any of these styles.
29154
29155 For example, @kbd{'[2 -1 3] @key{RET} s t LineStyles} causes the first curve
29156 to have lines in style number 2, the second curve to have no connecting
29157 lines, and the third curve to have lines in style 3. Point styles will
29158 still be assigned automatically, but you could store another vector in
29159 @code{PointStyles} to define them, too.
29160
29161 @node Devices, , Graphics Options, Graphics
29162 @section Graphical Devices
29163
29164 @noindent
29165 @kindex g D
29166 @pindex calc-graph-device
29167 The @kbd{g D} (@code{calc-graph-device}) command sets the device name
29168 (or ``terminal name'' in GNUPLOT lingo) to be used by @kbd{g p} commands
29169 on this graph. It does not affect the permanent default device name.
29170 If you enter a blank name, the device name reverts to the default.
29171 Enter @samp{?} to see a list of supported devices.
29172
29173 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} instead sets
29174 the default device name, used by all plots in the future which do
29175 not override it with a plain @kbd{g D} command. If you enter a
29176 blank line this command shows you the current default. The special
29177 name @code{default} signifies that Calc should choose @code{x11} if
29178 the X window system is in use (as indicated by the presence of a
29179 @code{DISPLAY} environment variable), @code{windows} on MS-Windows, or
29180 otherwise @code{dumb} under GNUPLOT 3.0 and later, or
29181 @code{postscript} under GNUPLOT 2.0. This is the initial default
29182 value.
29183
29184 The @code{dumb} device is an interface to ``dumb terminals,'' i.e.,
29185 terminals with no special graphics facilities. It writes a crude
29186 picture of the graph composed of characters like @code{-} and @code{|}
29187 to a buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}, which Calc then displays.
29188 The graph is made the same size as the Emacs screen, which on most
29189 dumb terminals will be
29190 @texline @math{80\times24}
29191 @infoline 80x24
29192 characters. The graph is displayed in
29193 an Emacs ``recursive edit''; type @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-c C-c} to exit
29194 the recursive edit and return to Calc. Note that the @code{dumb}
29195 device is present only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29196
29197 The word @code{dumb} may be followed by two numbers separated by
29198 spaces. These are the desired width and height of the graph in
29199 characters. Also, the device name @code{big} is like @code{dumb}
29200 but creates a graph four times the width and height of the Emacs
29201 screen. You will then have to scroll around to view the entire
29202 graph. In the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer, @key{SPC}, @key{DEL},
29203 @kbd{<}, and @kbd{>} are defined to scroll by one screenful in each
29204 of the four directions.
29205
29206 With a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} sets or displays
29207 the device name used by @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}). This
29208 is initially @code{postscript}. If you don't have a PostScript
29209 printer, you may decide once again to use @code{dumb} to create a
29210 plot on any text-only printer.
29211
29212 @kindex g O
29213 @pindex calc-graph-output
29214 The @kbd{g O} (@code{calc-graph-output}) command sets the name of the
29215 output file used by GNUPLOT. For some devices, notably @code{x11} and
29216 @code{windows}, there is no output file and this information is not
29217 used. Many other ``devices'' are really file formats like
29218 @code{postscript}; in these cases the output in the desired format
29219 goes into the file you name with @kbd{g O}. Type @kbd{g O stdout
29220 @key{RET}} to set GNUPLOT to write to its standard output stream,
29221 i.e., to @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}. This is the default setting.
29222
29223 Another special output name is @code{tty}, which means that GNUPLOT
29224 is going to write graphics commands directly to its standard output,
29225 which you wish Emacs to pass through to your terminal. Tektronix
29226 graphics terminals, among other devices, operate this way. Calc does
29227 this by telling GNUPLOT to write to a temporary file, then running a
29228 sub-shell executing the command @samp{cat tempfile >/dev/tty}. On
29229 typical Unix systems, this will copy the temporary file directly to
29230 the terminal, bypassing Emacs entirely. You will have to type @kbd{C-l}
29231 to Emacs afterwards to refresh the screen.
29232
29233 Once again, @kbd{g O} with a positive or negative prefix argument
29234 sets the default or printer output file names, respectively. In each
29235 case you can specify @code{auto}, which causes Calc to invent a temporary
29236 file name for each @kbd{g p} (or @kbd{g P}) command. This temporary file
29237 will be deleted once it has been displayed or printed. If the output file
29238 name is not @code{auto}, the file is not automatically deleted.
29239
29240 The default and printer devices and output files can be saved
29241 permanently by the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command. The
29242 default number of data points (see @kbd{g N}) and the X geometry
29243 (see @kbd{g X}) are also saved. Other graph information is @emph{not}
29244 saved; you can save a graph's configuration simply by saving the contents
29245 of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29246
29247 @vindex calc-gnuplot-plot-command
29248 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-device
29249 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-output
29250 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-command
29251 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-device
29252 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-output
29253 You may wish to configure the default and
29254 printer devices and output files for the whole system. The relevant
29255 Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-default-device} and @code{-output},
29256 and @code{calc-gnuplot-print-device} and @code{-output}. The output
29257 file names must be either strings as described above, or Lisp
29258 expressions which are evaluated on the fly to get the output file names.
29259
29260 Other important Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
29261 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command}, which give the system commands to
29262 display or print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
29263 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
29264 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
29265 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
29266 to display or print the output. These variables are customizable
29267 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
29268
29269 @kindex g x
29270 @pindex calc-graph-display
29271 The @kbd{g x} (@code{calc-graph-display}) command lets you specify
29272 on which X window system display your graphs should be drawn. Enter
29273 a blank line to see the current display name. This command has no
29274 effect unless the current device is @code{x11}.
29275
29276 @kindex g X
29277 @pindex calc-graph-geometry
29278 The @kbd{g X} (@code{calc-graph-geometry}) command is a similar
29279 command for specifying the position and size of the X window.
29280 The normal value is @code{default}, which generally means your
29281 window manager will let you place the window interactively.
29282 Entering @samp{800x500+0+0} would create an 800-by-500 pixel
29283 window in the upper-left corner of the screen. This command has no
29284 effect if the current device is @code{windows}.
29285
29286 The buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} holds a transcript of the
29287 session with GNUPLOT. This shows the commands Calc has ``typed'' to
29288 GNUPLOT and the responses it has received. Calc tries to notice when an
29289 error message has appeared here and display the buffer for you when
29290 this happens. You can check this buffer yourself if you suspect
29291 something has gone wrong@footnote{
29292 On MS-Windows, due to the peculiarities of how the Windows version of
29293 GNUPLOT (called @command{wgnuplot}) works, the GNUPLOT responses are
29294 not communicated back to Calc. Instead, you need to look them up in
29295 the GNUPLOT command window that is displayed as in normal interactive
29296 usage of GNUPLOT.
29297 }.
29298
29299 @kindex g C
29300 @pindex calc-graph-command
29301 The @kbd{g C} (@code{calc-graph-command}) command prompts you to
29302 enter any line of text, then simply sends that line to the current
29303 GNUPLOT process. The @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer looks deceptively
29304 like a Shell buffer but you can't type commands in it yourself.
29305 Instead, you must use @kbd{g C} for this purpose.
29306
29307 @kindex g v
29308 @kindex g V
29309 @pindex calc-graph-view-commands
29310 @pindex calc-graph-view-trail
29311 The @kbd{g v} (@code{calc-graph-view-commands}) and @kbd{g V}
29312 (@code{calc-graph-view-trail}) commands display the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29313 and @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffers, respectively, in another window.
29314 This happens automatically when Calc thinks there is something you
29315 will want to see in either of these buffers. If you type @kbd{g v}
29316 or @kbd{g V} when the relevant buffer is already displayed, the
29317 buffer is hidden again. (Note that on MS-Windows, the @samp{*Gnuplot
29318 Trail*} buffer will usually show nothing of interest, because
29319 GNUPLOT's responses are not communicated back to Calc.)
29320
29321 One reason to use @kbd{g v} is to add your own commands to the
29322 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Press @kbd{g v}, then use
29323 @kbd{C-x o} to switch into that window. For example, GNUPLOT has
29324 @samp{set label} and @samp{set arrow} commands that allow you to
29325 annotate your plots. Since Calc doesn't understand these commands,
29326 you have to add them to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer
29327 yourself, then use @w{@kbd{g p}} to replot using these new commands. Note
29328 that your commands must appear @emph{before} the @code{plot} command.
29329 To get help on any GNUPLOT feature, type, e.g., @kbd{g C help set label}.
29330 You may have to type @kbd{g C @key{RET}} a few times to clear the
29331 ``press return for more'' or ``subtopic of @dots{}'' requests.
29332 Note that Calc always sends commands (like @samp{set nolabel}) to
29333 reset all plotting parameters to the defaults before each plot, so
29334 to delete a label all you need to do is delete the @samp{set label}
29335 line you added (or comment it out with @samp{#}) and then replot
29336 with @kbd{g p}.
29337
29338 @kindex g q
29339 @pindex calc-graph-quit
29340 You can use @kbd{g q} (@code{calc-graph-quit}) to kill the GNUPLOT
29341 process that is running. The next graphing command you give will
29342 start a fresh GNUPLOT process. The word @samp{Graph} appears in
29343 the Calc window's mode line whenever a GNUPLOT process is currently
29344 running. The GNUPLOT process is automatically killed when you
29345 exit Emacs if you haven't killed it manually by then.
29346
29347 @kindex g K
29348 @pindex calc-graph-kill
29349 The @kbd{g K} (@code{calc-graph-kill}) command is like @kbd{g q}
29350 except that it also views the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer so that
29351 you can see the process being killed. This is better if you are
29352 killing GNUPLOT because you think it has gotten stuck.
29353
29354 @node Kill and Yank, Keypad Mode, Graphics, Top
29355 @chapter Kill and Yank Functions
29356
29357 @noindent
29358 The commands in this chapter move information between the Calculator and
29359 other Emacs editing buffers.
29360
29361 In many cases Embedded mode is an easier and more natural way to
29362 work with Calc from a regular editing buffer. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
29363
29364 @menu
29365 * Killing From Stack::
29366 * Yanking Into Stack::
29367 * Saving Into Registers::
29368 * Inserting From Registers::
29369 * Grabbing From Buffers::
29370 * Yanking Into Buffers::
29371 * X Cut and Paste::
29372 @end menu
29373
29374 @node Killing From Stack, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank, Kill and Yank
29375 @section Killing from the Stack
29376
29377 @noindent
29378 @kindex C-k
29379 @pindex calc-kill
29380 @kindex M-k
29381 @pindex calc-copy-as-kill
29382 @kindex C-w
29383 @pindex calc-kill-region
29384 @kindex M-w
29385 @pindex calc-copy-region-as-kill
29386 @kindex M-C-w
29387 @cindex Kill ring
29388 @dfn{Kill} commands are Emacs commands that insert text into the ``kill
29389 ring,'' from which it can later be ``yanked'' by a @kbd{C-y} command.
29390 Three common kill commands in normal Emacs are @kbd{C-k}, which kills
29391 one line, @kbd{C-w}, which kills the region between mark and point, and
29392 @kbd{M-w}, which puts the region into the kill ring without actually
29393 deleting it. All of these commands work in the Calculator, too,
29394 although in the Calculator they operate on whole stack entries, so they
29395 ``round up'' the specified region to encompass full lines. (To copy
29396 only parts of lines, the @kbd{M-C-w} command in the Calculator will copy
29397 the region to the kill ring without any ``rounding up'', just like the
29398 @kbd{M-w} command in normal Emacs.) Also, @kbd{M-k} has been provided
29399 to complete the set; it puts the current line into the kill ring without
29400 deleting anything.
29401
29402 The kill commands are unusual in that they pay attention to the location
29403 of the cursor in the Calculator buffer. If the cursor is on or below
29404 the bottom line, the kill commands operate on the top of the stack.
29405 Otherwise, they operate on whatever stack element the cursor is on. The
29406 text is copied into the kill ring exactly as it appears on the screen,
29407 including line numbers if they are enabled.
29408
29409 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{C-k} or @kbd{M-k} affects the number
29410 of lines killed. A positive argument kills the current line and @expr{n-1}
29411 lines below it. A negative argument kills the @expr{-n} lines above the
29412 current line. Again this mirrors the behavior of the standard Emacs
29413 @kbd{C-k} command. Although a whole line is always deleted, @kbd{C-k}
29414 with no argument copies only the number itself into the kill ring, whereas
29415 @kbd{C-k} with a prefix argument of 1 copies the number with its trailing
29416 newline.
29417
29418 @node Yanking Into Stack, Saving Into Registers, Killing From Stack, Kill and Yank
29419 @section Yanking into the Stack
29420
29421 @noindent
29422 @kindex C-y
29423 @pindex calc-yank
29424 The @kbd{C-y} command yanks the most recently killed text back into the
29425 Calculator. It pushes this value onto the top of the stack regardless of
29426 the cursor position. In general it re-parses the killed text as a number
29427 or formula (or a list of these separated by commas or newlines). However if
29428 the thing being yanked is something that was just killed from the Calculator
29429 itself, its full internal structure is yanked. For example, if you have
29430 set the floating-point display mode to show only four significant digits,
29431 then killing and re-yanking 3.14159 (which displays as 3.142) will yank the
29432 full 3.14159, even though yanking it into any other buffer would yank the
29433 number in its displayed form, 3.142. (Since the default display modes
29434 show all objects to their full precision, this feature normally makes no
29435 difference.)
29436
29437 @node Saving Into Registers, Inserting From Registers, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank
29438 @section Saving into Registers
29439
29440 @noindent
29441 @kindex r s
29442 @pindex calc-copy-to-register
29443 @pindex calc-prepend-to-register
29444 @pindex calc-append-to-register
29445 @cindex Registers
29446 An alternative to killing and yanking stack entries is using
29447 registers in Calc. Saving stack entries in registers is like
29448 saving text in normal Emacs registers; although, like Calc's kill
29449 commands, register commands always operate on whole stack
29450 entries.
29451
29452 Registers in Calc are places to store stack entries for later use;
29453 each register is indexed by a single character. To store the current
29454 region (rounded up, of course, to include full stack entries) into a
29455 register, use the command @kbd{r s} (@code{calc-copy-to-register}).
29456 You will then be prompted for a register to use, the next character
29457 you type will be the index for the register. To store the region in
29458 register @var{r}, the full command will be @kbd{r s @var{r}}. With an
29459 argument, @kbd{C-u r s @var{r}}, the region being copied to the
29460 register will be deleted from the Calc buffer.
29461
29462 It is possible to add additional stack entries to a register. The
29463 command @kbd{M-x calc-append-to-register} will prompt for a register,
29464 then add the stack entries in the region to the end of the register
29465 contents. The command @kbd{M-x calc-prepend-to-register} will
29466 similarly prompt for a register and add the stack entries in the
29467 region to the beginning of the register contents. Both commands take
29468 @kbd{C-u} arguments, which will cause the region to be deleted after being
29469 added to the register.
29470
29471 @node Inserting From Registers, Grabbing From Buffers, Saving Into Registers, Kill and Yank
29472 @section Inserting from Registers
29473 @noindent
29474 @kindex r i
29475 @pindex calc-insert-register
29476 The command @kbd{r i} (@code{calc-insert-register}) will prompt for a
29477 register, then insert the contents of that register into the
29478 Calculator. If the contents of the register were placed there from
29479 within Calc, then the full internal structure of the contents will be
29480 inserted into the Calculator, otherwise whatever text is in the
29481 register is reparsed and then inserted into the Calculator.
29482
29483 @node Grabbing From Buffers, Yanking Into Buffers, Inserting From Registers, Kill and Yank
29484 @section Grabbing from Other Buffers
29485
29486 @noindent
29487 @kindex C-x * g
29488 @pindex calc-grab-region
29489 The @kbd{C-x * g} (@code{calc-grab-region}) command takes the text between
29490 point and mark in the current buffer and attempts to parse it as a
29491 vector of values. Basically, it wraps the text in vector brackets
29492 @samp{[ ]} unless the text already is enclosed in vector brackets,
29493 then reads the text as if it were an algebraic entry. The contents
29494 of the vector may be numbers, formulas, or any other Calc objects.
29495 If the @kbd{C-x * g} command works successfully, it does an automatic
29496 @kbd{C-x * c} to enter the Calculator buffer.
29497
29498 A numeric prefix argument grabs the specified number of lines around
29499 point, ignoring the mark. A positive prefix grabs from point to the
29500 @expr{n}th following newline (so that @kbd{M-1 C-x * g} grabs from point
29501 to the end of the current line); a negative prefix grabs from point
29502 back to the @expr{n+1}st preceding newline. In these cases the text
29503 that is grabbed is exactly the same as the text that @kbd{C-k} would
29504 delete given that prefix argument.
29505
29506 A prefix of zero grabs the current line; point may be anywhere on the
29507 line.
29508
29509 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix interprets the region between point and mark
29510 as a single number or formula rather than a vector. For example,
29511 @kbd{C-x * g} on the text @samp{2 a b} produces the vector of three
29512 values @samp{[2, a, b]}, but @kbd{C-u C-x * g} on the same region
29513 reads a formula which is a product of three things: @samp{2 a b}.
29514 (The text @samp{a + b}, on the other hand, will be grabbed as a
29515 vector of one element by plain @kbd{C-x * g} because the interpretation
29516 @samp{[a, +, b]} would be a syntax error.)
29517
29518 If a different language has been specified (@pxref{Language Modes}),
29519 the grabbed text will be interpreted according to that language.
29520
29521 @kindex C-x * r
29522 @pindex calc-grab-rectangle
29523 The @kbd{C-x * r} (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) command takes the text between
29524 point and mark and attempts to parse it as a matrix. If point and mark
29525 are both in the leftmost column, the lines in between are parsed in their
29526 entirety. Otherwise, point and mark define the corners of a rectangle
29527 whose contents are parsed.
29528
29529 Each line of the grabbed area becomes a row of the matrix. The result
29530 will actually be a vector of vectors, which Calc will treat as a matrix
29531 only if every row contains the same number of values.
29532
29533 If a line contains a portion surrounded by square brackets (or curly
29534 braces), that portion is interpreted as a vector which becomes a row
29535 of the matrix. Any text surrounding the bracketed portion on the line
29536 is ignored.
29537
29538 Otherwise, the entire line is interpreted as a row vector as if it
29539 were surrounded by square brackets. Leading line numbers (in the
29540 format used in the Calc stack buffer) are ignored. If you wish to
29541 force this interpretation (even if the line contains bracketed
29542 portions), give a negative numeric prefix argument to the
29543 @kbd{C-x * r} command.
29544
29545 If you give a numeric prefix argument of zero or plain @kbd{C-u}, each
29546 line is instead interpreted as a single formula which is converted into
29547 a one-element vector. Thus the result of @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will be a
29548 one-column matrix. For example, suppose one line of the data is the
29549 expression @samp{2 a}. A plain @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} will interpret this as
29550 @samp{[2 a]}, which in turn is read as a two-element vector that forms
29551 one row of the matrix. But a @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will interpret this row
29552 as @samp{[2*a]}.
29553
29554 If you give a positive numeric prefix argument @var{n}, then each line
29555 will be split up into columns of width @var{n}; each column is parsed
29556 separately as a matrix element. If a line contained
29557 @w{@samp{2 +/- 3 4 +/- 5}}, then grabbing with a prefix argument of 8
29558 would correctly split the line into two error forms.
29559
29560 @xref{Matrix Functions}, to see how to pull the matrix apart into its
29561 constituent rows and columns. (If it is a
29562 @texline @math{1\times1}
29563 @infoline 1x1
29564 matrix, just hit @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) twice.)
29565
29566 @kindex C-x * :
29567 @kindex C-x * _
29568 @pindex calc-grab-sum-across
29569 @pindex calc-grab-sum-down
29570 @cindex Summing rows and columns of data
29571 The @kbd{C-x * :} (@code{calc-grab-sum-down}) command is a handy way to
29572 grab a rectangle of data and sum its columns. It is equivalent to
29573 typing @kbd{C-x * r}, followed by @kbd{V R : +} (the vector reduction
29574 command that sums the columns of a matrix; @pxref{Reducing}). The
29575 result of the command will be a vector of numbers, one for each column
29576 in the input data. The @kbd{C-x * _} (@code{calc-grab-sum-across}) command
29577 similarly grabs a rectangle and sums its rows by executing @w{@kbd{V R _ +}}.
29578
29579 As well as being more convenient, @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are also
29580 much faster because they don't actually place the grabbed vector on
29581 the stack. In a @kbd{C-x * r V R : +} sequence, formatting the vector
29582 for display on the stack takes a large fraction of the total time
29583 (unless you have planned ahead and used @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} modes).
29584
29585 For example, suppose we have a column of numbers in a file which we
29586 wish to sum. Go to one corner of the column and press @kbd{C-@@} to
29587 set the mark; go to the other corner and type @kbd{C-x * :}. Since there
29588 is only one column, the result will be a vector of one number, the sum.
29589 (You can type @kbd{v u} to unpack this vector into a plain number if
29590 you want to do further arithmetic with it.)
29591
29592 To compute the product of the column of numbers, we would have to do
29593 it ``by hand'' since there's no special grab-and-multiply command.
29594 Use @kbd{C-x * r} to grab the column of numbers into the calculator in
29595 the form of a column matrix. The statistics command @kbd{u *} is a
29596 handy way to find the product of a vector or matrix of numbers.
29597 @xref{Statistical Operations}. Another approach would be to use
29598 an explicit column reduction command, @kbd{V R : *}.
29599
29600 @node Yanking Into Buffers, X Cut and Paste, Grabbing From Buffers, Kill and Yank
29601 @section Yanking into Other Buffers
29602
29603 @noindent
29604 @kindex y
29605 @pindex calc-copy-to-buffer
29606 The plain @kbd{y} (@code{calc-copy-to-buffer}) command inserts the number
29607 at the top of the stack into the most recently used normal editing buffer.
29608 (More specifically, this is the most recently used buffer which is displayed
29609 in a window and whose name does not begin with @samp{*}. If there is no
29610 such buffer, this is the most recently used buffer except for Calculator
29611 and Calc Trail buffers.) The number is inserted exactly as it appears and
29612 without a newline. (If line-numbering is enabled, the line number is
29613 normally not included.) The number is @emph{not} removed from the stack.
29614
29615 With a prefix argument, @kbd{y} inserts several numbers, one per line.
29616 A positive argument inserts the specified number of values from the top
29617 of the stack. A negative argument inserts the @expr{n}th value from the
29618 top of the stack. An argument of zero inserts the entire stack. Note
29619 that @kbd{y} with an argument of 1 is slightly different from @kbd{y}
29620 with no argument; the former always copies full lines, whereas the
29621 latter strips off the trailing newline.
29622
29623 With a lone @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, @kbd{y} @emph{replaces} the
29624 region in the other buffer with the yanked text, then quits the
29625 Calculator, leaving you in that buffer. A typical use would be to use
29626 @kbd{C-x * g} to read a region of data into the Calculator, operate on the
29627 data to produce a new matrix, then type @kbd{C-u y} to replace the
29628 original data with the new data. One might wish to alter the matrix
29629 display style (@pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}) or change the current
29630 display language (@pxref{Language Modes}) before doing this. Also, note
29631 that this command replaces a linear region of text (as grabbed by
29632 @kbd{C-x * g}), not a rectangle (as grabbed by @kbd{C-x * r}).
29633
29634 If the editing buffer is in overwrite (as opposed to insert) mode,
29635 and the @kbd{C-u} prefix was not used, then the yanked number will
29636 overwrite the characters following point rather than being inserted
29637 before those characters. The usual conventions of overwrite mode
29638 are observed; for example, characters will be inserted at the end of
29639 a line rather than overflowing onto the next line. Yanking a multi-line
29640 object such as a matrix in overwrite mode overwrites the next @var{n}
29641 lines in the buffer, lengthening or shortening each line as necessary.
29642 Finally, if the thing being yanked is a simple integer or floating-point
29643 number (like @samp{-1.2345e-3}) and the characters following point also
29644 make up such a number, then Calc will replace that number with the new
29645 number, lengthening or shortening as necessary. The concept of
29646 ``overwrite mode'' has thus been generalized from overwriting characters
29647 to overwriting one complete number with another.
29648
29649 @kindex C-x * y
29650 The @kbd{C-x * y} key sequence is equivalent to @kbd{y} except that
29651 it can be typed anywhere, not just in Calc. This provides an easy
29652 way to guarantee that Calc knows which editing buffer you want to use!
29653
29654 @node X Cut and Paste, , Yanking Into Buffers, Kill and Yank
29655 @section X Cut and Paste
29656
29657 @noindent
29658 If you are using Emacs with the X window system, there is an easier
29659 way to move small amounts of data into and out of the calculator:
29660 Use the mouse-oriented cut and paste facilities of X.
29661
29662 The default bindings for a three-button mouse cause the left button
29663 to move the Emacs cursor to the given place, the right button to
29664 select the text between the cursor and the clicked location, and
29665 the middle button to yank the selection into the buffer at the
29666 clicked location. So, if you have a Calc window and an editing
29667 window on your Emacs screen, you can use left-click/right-click
29668 to select a number, vector, or formula from one window, then
29669 middle-click to paste that value into the other window. When you
29670 paste text into the Calc window, Calc interprets it as an algebraic
29671 entry. It doesn't matter where you click in the Calc window; the
29672 new value is always pushed onto the top of the stack.
29673
29674 The @code{xterm} program that is typically used for general-purpose
29675 shell windows in X interprets the mouse buttons in the same way.
29676 So you can use the mouse to move data between Calc and any other
29677 Unix program. One nice feature of @code{xterm} is that a double
29678 left-click selects one word, and a triple left-click selects a
29679 whole line. So you can usually transfer a single number into Calc
29680 just by double-clicking on it in the shell, then middle-clicking
29681 in the Calc window.
29682
29683 @node Keypad Mode, Embedded Mode, Kill and Yank, Top
29684 @chapter Keypad Mode
29685
29686 @noindent
29687 @kindex C-x * k
29688 @pindex calc-keypad
29689 The @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) command starts the Calculator
29690 and displays a picture of a calculator-style keypad. If you are using
29691 the X window system, you can click on any of the ``keys'' in the
29692 keypad using the left mouse button to operate the calculator.
29693 The original window remains the selected window; in Keypad mode
29694 you can type in your file while simultaneously performing
29695 calculations with the mouse.
29696
29697 @pindex full-calc-keypad
29698 If you have used @kbd{C-x * b} first, @kbd{C-x * k} instead invokes
29699 the @code{full-calc-keypad} command, which takes over the whole
29700 Emacs screen and displays the keypad, the Calc stack, and the Calc
29701 trail all at once. This mode would normally be used when running
29702 Calc standalone (@pxref{Standalone Operation}).
29703
29704 If you aren't using the X window system, you must switch into
29705 the @samp{*Calc Keypad*} window, place the cursor on the desired
29706 ``key,'' and type @key{SPC} or @key{RET}. If you think this
29707 is easier than using Calc normally, go right ahead.
29708
29709 Calc commands are more or less the same in Keypad mode. Certain
29710 keypad keys differ slightly from the corresponding normal Calc
29711 keystrokes; all such deviations are described below.
29712
29713 Keypad mode includes many more commands than will fit on the keypad
29714 at once. Click the right mouse button [@code{calc-keypad-menu}]
29715 to switch to the next menu. The bottom five rows of the keypad
29716 stay the same; the top three rows change to a new set of commands.
29717 To return to earlier menus, click the middle mouse button
29718 [@code{calc-keypad-menu-back}] or simply advance through the menus
29719 until you wrap around. Typing @key{TAB} inside the keypad window
29720 is equivalent to clicking the right mouse button there.
29721
29722 You can always click the @key{EXEC} button and type any normal
29723 Calc key sequence. This is equivalent to switching into the
29724 Calc buffer, typing the keys, then switching back to your
29725 original buffer.
29726
29727 @menu
29728 * Keypad Main Menu::
29729 * Keypad Functions Menu::
29730 * Keypad Binary Menu::
29731 * Keypad Vectors Menu::
29732 * Keypad Modes Menu::
29733 @end menu
29734
29735 @node Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode, Keypad Mode
29736 @section Main Menu
29737
29738 @smallexample
29739 @group
29740 |----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
29741 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
29742 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29743 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
29744 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29745 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
29746 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29747 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
29748 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
29749 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
29750 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29751 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
29752 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29753 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
29754 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29755 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
29756 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
29757 @end group
29758 @end smallexample
29759
29760 @noindent
29761 This is the menu that appears the first time you start Keypad mode.
29762 It will show up in a vertical window on the right side of your screen.
29763 Above this menu is the traditional Calc stack display. On a 24-line
29764 screen you will be able to see the top three stack entries.
29765
29766 The ten digit keys, decimal point, and @key{EEX} key are used for
29767 entering numbers in the obvious way. @key{EEX} begins entry of an
29768 exponent in scientific notation. Just as with regular Calc, the
29769 number is pushed onto the stack as soon as you press @key{ENTER}
29770 or any other function key.
29771
29772 The @key{+/-} key corresponds to normal Calc's @kbd{n} key. During
29773 numeric entry it changes the sign of the number or of the exponent.
29774 At other times it changes the sign of the number on the top of the
29775 stack.
29776
29777 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys modify other keys. As well as
29778 having the effects described elsewhere in this manual, Keypad mode
29779 defines several other ``inverse'' operations. These are described
29780 below and in the following sections.
29781
29782 The @key{ENTER} key finishes the current numeric entry, or otherwise
29783 duplicates the top entry on the stack.
29784
29785 The @key{UNDO} key undoes the most recent Calc operation.
29786 @kbd{INV UNDO} is the ``redo'' command, and @kbd{HYP UNDO} is
29787 ``last arguments'' (@kbd{M-@key{RET}}).
29788
29789 The @key{<-} key acts as a ``backspace'' during numeric entry.
29790 At other times it removes the top stack entry. @kbd{INV <-}
29791 clears the entire stack. @kbd{HYP <-} takes an integer from
29792 the stack, then removes that many additional stack elements.
29793
29794 The @key{EXEC} key prompts you to enter any keystroke sequence
29795 that would normally work in Calc mode. This can include a
29796 numeric prefix if you wish. It is also possible simply to
29797 switch into the Calc window and type commands in it; there is
29798 nothing ``magic'' about this window when Keypad mode is active.
29799
29800 The other keys in this display perform their obvious calculator
29801 functions. @key{CLN2} rounds the top-of-stack by temporarily
29802 reducing the precision by 2 digits. @key{FLT} converts an
29803 integer or fraction on the top of the stack to floating-point.
29804
29805 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys combined with several of these keys
29806 give you access to some common functions even if the appropriate menu
29807 is not displayed. Obviously you don't need to learn these keys
29808 unless you find yourself wasting time switching among the menus.
29809
29810 @table @kbd
29811 @item INV +/-
29812 is the same as @key{1/x}.
29813 @item INV +
29814 is the same as @key{SQRT}.
29815 @item INV -
29816 is the same as @key{CONJ}.
29817 @item INV *
29818 is the same as @key{y^x}.
29819 @item INV /
29820 is the same as @key{INV y^x} (the @expr{x}th root of @expr{y}).
29821 @item HYP/INV 1
29822 are the same as @key{SIN} / @kbd{INV SIN}.
29823 @item HYP/INV 2
29824 are the same as @key{COS} / @kbd{INV COS}.
29825 @item HYP/INV 3
29826 are the same as @key{TAN} / @kbd{INV TAN}.
29827 @item INV/HYP 4
29828 are the same as @key{LN} / @kbd{HYP LN}.
29829 @item INV/HYP 5
29830 are the same as @key{EXP} / @kbd{HYP EXP}.
29831 @item INV 6
29832 is the same as @key{ABS}.
29833 @item INV 7
29834 is the same as @key{RND} (@code{calc-round}).
29835 @item INV 8
29836 is the same as @key{CLN2}.
29837 @item INV 9
29838 is the same as @key{FLT} (@code{calc-float}).
29839 @item INV 0
29840 is the same as @key{IMAG}.
29841 @item INV .
29842 is the same as @key{PREC}.
29843 @item INV ENTER
29844 is the same as @key{SWAP}.
29845 @item HYP ENTER
29846 is the same as @key{RLL3}.
29847 @item INV HYP ENTER
29848 is the same as @key{OVER}.
29849 @item HYP +/-
29850 packs the top two stack entries as an error form.
29851 @item HYP EEX
29852 packs the top two stack entries as a modulo form.
29853 @item INV EEX
29854 creates an interval form; this removes an integer which is one
29855 of 0 @samp{[]}, 1 @samp{[)}, 2 @samp{(]} or 3 @samp{()}, followed
29856 by the two limits of the interval.
29857 @end table
29858
29859 The @kbd{OFF} key turns Calc off; typing @kbd{C-x * k} or @kbd{C-x * *}
29860 again has the same effect. This is analogous to typing @kbd{q} or
29861 hitting @kbd{C-x * c} again in the normal calculator. If Calc is
29862 running standalone (the @code{full-calc-keypad} command appeared in the
29863 command line that started Emacs), then @kbd{OFF} is replaced with
29864 @kbd{EXIT}; clicking on this actually exits Emacs itself.
29865
29866 @node Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Mode
29867 @section Functions Menu
29868
29869 @smallexample
29870 @group
29871 |----+----+----+----+----+----2
29872 |IGAM|BETA|IBET|ERF |BESJ|BESY|
29873 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29874 |IMAG|CONJ| RE |ATN2|RAND|RAGN|
29875 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29876 |GCD |FACT|DFCT|BNOM|PERM|NXTP|
29877 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29878 @end group
29879 @end smallexample
29880
29881 @noindent
29882 This menu provides various operations from the @kbd{f} and @kbd{k}
29883 prefix keys.
29884
29885 @key{IMAG} multiplies the number on the stack by the imaginary
29886 number @expr{i = (0, 1)}.
29887
29888 @key{RE} extracts the real part a complex number. @kbd{INV RE}
29889 extracts the imaginary part.
29890
29891 @key{RAND} takes a number from the top of the stack and computes
29892 a random number greater than or equal to zero but less than that
29893 number. (@xref{Random Numbers}.) @key{RAGN} is the ``random
29894 again'' command; it computes another random number using the
29895 same limit as last time.
29896
29897 @key{INV GCD} computes the LCM (least common multiple) function.
29898
29899 @key{INV FACT} is the gamma function.
29900 @texline @math{\Gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
29901 @infoline @expr{gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
29902
29903 @key{PERM} is the number-of-permutations function, which is on the
29904 @kbd{H k c} key in normal Calc.
29905
29906 @key{NXTP} finds the next prime after a number. @kbd{INV NXTP}
29907 finds the previous prime.
29908
29909 @node Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode
29910 @section Binary Menu
29911
29912 @smallexample
29913 @group
29914 |----+----+----+----+----+----3
29915 |AND | OR |XOR |NOT |LSH |RSH |
29916 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29917 |DEC |HEX |OCT |BIN |WSIZ|ARSH|
29918 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29919 | A | B | C | D | E | F |
29920 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29921 @end group
29922 @end smallexample
29923
29924 @noindent
29925 The keys in this menu perform operations on binary integers.
29926 Note that both logical and arithmetic right-shifts are provided.
29927 @key{INV LSH} rotates one bit to the left.
29928
29929 The ``difference'' function (normally on @kbd{b d}) is on @key{INV AND}.
29930 The ``clip'' function (normally on @w{@kbd{b c}}) is on @key{INV NOT}.
29931
29932 The @key{DEC}, @key{HEX}, @key{OCT}, and @key{BIN} keys select the
29933 current radix for display and entry of numbers: Decimal, hexadecimal,
29934 octal, or binary. The six letter keys @key{A} through @key{F} are used
29935 for entering hexadecimal numbers.
29936
29937 The @key{WSIZ} key displays the current word size for binary operations
29938 and allows you to enter a new word size. You can respond to the prompt
29939 using either the keyboard or the digits and @key{ENTER} from the keypad.
29940 The initial word size is 32 bits.
29941
29942 @node Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Modes Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Mode
29943 @section Vectors Menu
29944
29945 @smallexample
29946 @group
29947 |----+----+----+----+----+----4
29948 |SUM |PROD|MAX |MAP*|MAP^|MAP$|
29949 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29950 |MINV|MDET|MTRN|IDNT|CRSS|"x" |
29951 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29952 |PACK|UNPK|INDX|BLD |LEN |... |
29953 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29954 @end group
29955 @end smallexample
29956
29957 @noindent
29958 The keys in this menu operate on vectors and matrices.
29959
29960 @key{PACK} removes an integer @var{n} from the top of the stack;
29961 the next @var{n} stack elements are removed and packed into a vector,
29962 which is replaced onto the stack. Thus the sequence
29963 @kbd{1 ENTER 3 ENTER 5 ENTER 3 PACK} enters the vector
29964 @samp{[1, 3, 5]} onto the stack. To enter a matrix, build each row
29965 on the stack as a vector, then use a final @key{PACK} to collect the
29966 rows into a matrix.
29967
29968 @key{UNPK} unpacks the vector on the stack, pushing each of its
29969 components separately.
29970
29971 @key{INDX} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds a vector of
29972 integers from 1 to @var{n}. @kbd{INV INDX} takes three numbers
29973 from the stack: The vector size @var{n}, the starting number,
29974 and the increment. @kbd{BLD} takes an integer @var{n} and any
29975 value @var{x} and builds a vector of @var{n} copies of @var{x}.
29976
29977 @key{IDNT} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds an @var{n}-by-@var{n}
29978 identity matrix.
29979
29980 @key{LEN} replaces a vector by its length, an integer.
29981
29982 @key{...} turns on or off ``abbreviated'' display mode for large vectors.
29983
29984 @key{MINV}, @key{MDET}, @key{MTRN}, and @key{CROSS} are the matrix
29985 inverse, determinant, and transpose, and vector cross product.
29986
29987 @key{SUM} replaces a vector by the sum of its elements. It is
29988 equivalent to @kbd{u +} in normal Calc (@pxref{Statistical Operations}).
29989 @key{PROD} computes the product of the elements of a vector, and
29990 @key{MAX} computes the maximum of all the elements of a vector.
29991
29992 @key{INV SUM} computes the alternating sum of the first element
29993 minus the second, plus the third, minus the fourth, and so on.
29994 @key{INV MAX} computes the minimum of the vector elements.
29995
29996 @key{HYP SUM} computes the mean of the vector elements.
29997 @key{HYP PROD} computes the sample standard deviation.
29998 @key{HYP MAX} computes the median.
29999
30000 @key{MAP*} multiplies two vectors elementwise. It is equivalent
30001 to the @kbd{V M *} command. @key{MAP^} computes powers elementwise.
30002 The arguments must be vectors of equal length, or one must be a vector
30003 and the other must be a plain number. For example, @kbd{2 MAP^} squares
30004 all the elements of a vector.
30005
30006 @key{MAP$} maps the formula on the top of the stack across the
30007 vector in the second-to-top position. If the formula contains
30008 several variables, Calc takes that many vectors starting at the
30009 second-to-top position and matches them to the variables in
30010 alphabetical order. The result is a vector of the same size as
30011 the input vectors, whose elements are the formula evaluated with
30012 the variables set to the various sets of numbers in those vectors.
30013 For example, you could simulate @key{MAP^} using @key{MAP$} with
30014 the formula @samp{x^y}.
30015
30016 The @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable name @expr{x} onto the
30017 stack. To build the formula @expr{x^2 + 6}, you would use the
30018 key sequence @kbd{"x" 2 y^x 6 +}. This formula would then be
30019 suitable for use with the @key{MAP$} key described above.
30020 With @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, or @key{INV} and @key{HYP}, the
30021 @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable names @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and
30022 @expr{t}, respectively.
30023
30024 @node Keypad Modes Menu, , Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Mode
30025 @section Modes Menu
30026
30027 @smallexample
30028 @group
30029 |----+----+----+----+----+----5
30030 |FLT |FIX |SCI |ENG |GRP | |
30031 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30032 |RAD |DEG |FRAC|POLR|SYMB|PREC|
30033 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30034 |SWAP|RLL3|RLL4|OVER|STO |RCL |
30035 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30036 @end group
30037 @end smallexample
30038
30039 @noindent
30040 The keys in this menu manipulate modes, variables, and the stack.
30041
30042 The @key{FLT}, @key{FIX}, @key{SCI}, and @key{ENG} keys select
30043 floating-point, fixed-point, scientific, or engineering notation.
30044 @key{FIX} displays two digits after the decimal by default; the
30045 others display full precision. With the @key{INV} prefix, these
30046 keys pop a number-of-digits argument from the stack.
30047
30048 The @key{GRP} key turns grouping of digits with commas on or off.
30049 @kbd{INV GRP} enables grouping to the right of the decimal point as
30050 well as to the left.
30051
30052 The @key{RAD} and @key{DEG} keys switch between radians and degrees
30053 for trigonometric functions.
30054
30055 The @key{FRAC} key turns Fraction mode on or off. This affects
30056 whether commands like @kbd{/} with integer arguments produce
30057 fractional or floating-point results.
30058
30059 The @key{POLR} key turns Polar mode on or off, determining whether
30060 polar or rectangular complex numbers are used by default.
30061
30062 The @key{SYMB} key turns Symbolic mode on or off, in which
30063 operations that would produce inexact floating-point results
30064 are left unevaluated as algebraic formulas.
30065
30066 The @key{PREC} key selects the current precision. Answer with
30067 the keyboard or with the keypad digit and @key{ENTER} keys.
30068
30069 The @key{SWAP} key exchanges the top two stack elements.
30070 The @key{RLL3} key rotates the top three stack elements upwards.
30071 The @key{RLL4} key rotates the top four stack elements upwards.
30072 The @key{OVER} key duplicates the second-to-top stack element.
30073
30074 The @key{STO} and @key{RCL} keys are analogous to @kbd{s t} and
30075 @kbd{s r} in regular Calc. @xref{Store and Recall}. Click the
30076 @key{STO} or @key{RCL} key, then one of the ten digits. (Named
30077 variables are not available in Keypad mode.) You can also use,
30078 for example, @kbd{STO + 3} to add to register 3.
30079
30080 @node Embedded Mode, Programming, Keypad Mode, Top
30081 @chapter Embedded Mode
30082
30083 @noindent
30084 Embedded mode in Calc provides an alternative to copying numbers
30085 and formulas back and forth between editing buffers and the Calc
30086 stack. In Embedded mode, your editing buffer becomes temporarily
30087 linked to the stack and this copying is taken care of automatically.
30088
30089 @menu
30090 * Basic Embedded Mode::
30091 * More About Embedded Mode::
30092 * Assignments in Embedded Mode::
30093 * Mode Settings in Embedded Mode::
30094 * Customizing Embedded Mode::
30095 @end menu
30096
30097 @node Basic Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30098 @section Basic Embedded Mode
30099
30100 @noindent
30101 @kindex C-x * e
30102 @pindex calc-embedded
30103 To enter Embedded mode, position the Emacs point (cursor) on a
30104 formula in any buffer and press @kbd{C-x * e} (@code{calc-embedded}).
30105 Note that @kbd{C-x * e} is not to be used in the Calc stack buffer
30106 like most Calc commands, but rather in regular editing buffers that
30107 are visiting your own files.
30108
30109 Calc will try to guess an appropriate language based on the major mode
30110 of the editing buffer. (@xref{Language Modes}.) If the current buffer is
30111 in @code{latex-mode}, for example, Calc will set its language to La@TeX{}.
30112 Similarly, Calc will use @TeX{} language for @code{tex-mode},
30113 @code{plain-tex-mode} and @code{context-mode}, C language for
30114 @code{c-mode} and @code{c++-mode}, FORTRAN language for
30115 @code{fortran-mode} and @code{f90-mode}, Pascal for @code{pascal-mode},
30116 and eqn for @code{nroff-mode} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
30117 These can be overridden with Calc's mode
30118 changing commands (@pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}). If no
30119 suitable language is available, Calc will continue with its current language.
30120
30121 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
30122 nearest opening and closing @dfn{formula delimiters}. The simplest
30123 delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that Embedded mode
30124 understands are:
30125
30126 @enumerate
30127 @item
30128 The @TeX{} and La@TeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
30129 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
30130 @item
30131 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
30132 @item
30133 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
30134 @item
30135 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
30136 @item
30137 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
30138 @end enumerate
30139
30140 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to make Calc recognize
30141 your own favorite delimiters. Delimiters like @samp{$ $} can appear
30142 on their own separate lines or in-line with the formula.
30143
30144 If you give a positive or negative numeric prefix argument, Calc
30145 instead uses the current point as one end of the formula, and includes
30146 that many lines forward or backward (respectively, including the current
30147 line). Explicit delimiters are not necessary in this case.
30148
30149 With a prefix argument of zero, Calc uses the current region (delimited
30150 by point and mark) instead of formula delimiters. With a prefix
30151 argument of @kbd{C-u} only, Calc uses the current line as the formula.
30152
30153 @kindex C-x * w
30154 @pindex calc-embedded-word
30155 The @kbd{C-x * w} (@code{calc-embedded-word}) command will start Embedded
30156 mode on the current ``word''; in this case Calc will scan for the first
30157 non-numeric character (i.e., the first character that is not a digit,
30158 sign, decimal point, or upper- or lower-case @samp{e}) forward and
30159 backward to delimit the formula.
30160
30161 When you enable Embedded mode for a formula, Calc reads the text
30162 between the delimiters and tries to interpret it as a Calc formula.
30163 Calc can generally identify @TeX{} formulas and
30164 Big-style formulas even if the language mode is wrong. If Calc
30165 can't make sense of the formula, it beeps and refuses to enter
30166 Embedded mode. But if the current language is wrong, Calc can
30167 sometimes parse the formula successfully (but incorrectly);
30168 for example, the C expression @samp{atan(a[1])} can be parsed
30169 in Normal language mode, but the @code{atan} won't correspond to
30170 the built-in @code{arctan} function, and the @samp{a[1]} will be
30171 interpreted as @samp{a} times the vector @samp{[1]}!
30172
30173 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} or @kbd{C-x * w} to activate an embedded
30174 formula which is blank, say with the cursor on the space between
30175 the two delimiters @samp{$ $}, Calc will immediately prompt for
30176 an algebraic entry.
30177
30178 Only one formula in one buffer can be enabled at a time. If you
30179 move to another area of the current buffer and give Calc commands,
30180 Calc turns Embedded mode off for the old formula and then tries
30181 to restart Embedded mode at the new position. Other buffers are
30182 not affected by Embedded mode.
30183
30184 When Embedded mode begins, Calc pushes the current formula onto
30185 the stack. No Calc stack window is created; however, Calc copies
30186 the top-of-stack position into the original buffer at all times.
30187 You can create a Calc window by hand with @kbd{C-x * o} if you
30188 find you need to see the entire stack.
30189
30190 For example, typing @kbd{C-x * e} while somewhere in the formula
30191 @samp{n>2} in the following line enables Embedded mode on that
30192 inequality:
30193
30194 @example
30195 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n>2$.
30196 @end example
30197
30198 @noindent
30199 The formula @expr{n>2} will be pushed onto the Calc stack, and
30200 the top of stack will be copied back into the editing buffer.
30201 This means that spaces will appear around the @samp{>} symbol
30202 to match Calc's usual display style:
30203
30204 @example
30205 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n > 2$.
30206 @end example
30207
30208 @noindent
30209 No spaces have appeared around the @samp{+} sign because it's
30210 in a different formula, one which we have not yet touched with
30211 Embedded mode.
30212
30213 Now that Embedded mode is enabled, keys you type in this buffer
30214 are interpreted as Calc commands. At this point we might use
30215 the ``commute'' command @kbd{j C} to reverse the inequality.
30216 This is a selection-based command for which we first need to
30217 move the cursor onto the operator (@samp{>} in this case) that
30218 needs to be commuted.
30219
30220 @example
30221 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $2 < n$.
30222 @end example
30223
30224 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is a useful way to open a Calc window
30225 without actually selecting that window. Giving this command
30226 verifies that @samp{2 < n} is also on the Calc stack. Typing
30227 @kbd{17 @key{RET}} would produce:
30228
30229 @example
30230 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $17$.
30231 @end example
30232
30233 @noindent
30234 with @samp{2 < n} and @samp{17} on the stack; typing @key{TAB}
30235 at this point will exchange the two stack values and restore
30236 @samp{2 < n} to the embedded formula. Even though you can't
30237 normally see the stack in Embedded mode, it is still there and
30238 it still operates in the same way. But, as with old-fashioned
30239 RPN calculators, you can only see the value at the top of the
30240 stack at any given time (unless you use @kbd{C-x * o}).
30241
30242 Typing @kbd{C-x * e} again turns Embedded mode off. The Calc
30243 window reveals that the formula @w{@samp{2 < n}} is automatically
30244 removed from the stack, but the @samp{17} is not. Entering
30245 Embedded mode always pushes one thing onto the stack, and
30246 leaving Embedded mode always removes one thing. Anything else
30247 that happens on the stack is entirely your business as far as
30248 Embedded mode is concerned.
30249
30250 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} in the wrong place by accident, it is
30251 possible that Calc will be able to parse the nearby text as a
30252 formula and will mangle that text in an attempt to redisplay it
30253 ``properly'' in the current language mode. If this happens,
30254 press @kbd{C-x * e} again to exit Embedded mode, then give the
30255 regular Emacs ``undo'' command (@kbd{C-_} or @kbd{C-x u}) to put
30256 the text back the way it was before Calc edited it. Note that Calc's
30257 own Undo command (typed before you turn Embedded mode back off)
30258 will not do you any good, because as far as Calc is concerned
30259 you haven't done anything with this formula yet.
30260
30261 @node More About Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Basic Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30262 @section More About Embedded Mode
30263
30264 @noindent
30265 When Embedded mode ``activates'' a formula, i.e., when it examines
30266 the formula for the first time since the buffer was created or
30267 loaded, Calc tries to sense the language in which the formula was
30268 written. If the formula contains any La@TeX{}-like @samp{\} sequences,
30269 it is parsed (i.e., read) in La@TeX{} mode. If the formula appears to
30270 be written in multi-line Big mode, it is parsed in Big mode. Otherwise,
30271 it is parsed according to the current language mode.
30272
30273 Note that Calc does not change the current language mode according
30274 the formula it reads in. Even though it can read a La@TeX{} formula when
30275 not in La@TeX{} mode, it will immediately rewrite this formula using
30276 whatever language mode is in effect.
30277
30278 @tex
30279 \bigskip
30280 @end tex
30281
30282 @kindex d p
30283 @pindex calc-show-plain
30284 Calc's parser is unable to read certain kinds of formulas. For
30285 example, with @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) you can
30286 specify matrix display styles which the parser is unable to
30287 recognize as matrices. The @kbd{d p} (@code{calc-show-plain})
30288 command turns on a mode in which a ``plain'' version of a
30289 formula is placed in front of the fully-formatted version.
30290 When Calc reads a formula that has such a plain version in
30291 front, it reads the plain version and ignores the formatted
30292 version.
30293
30294 Plain formulas are preceded and followed by @samp{%%%} signs
30295 by default. This notation has the advantage that the @samp{%}
30296 character begins a comment in @TeX{} and La@TeX{}, so if your formula is
30297 embedded in a @TeX{} or La@TeX{} document its plain version will be
30298 invisible in the final printed copy. Certain major modes have different
30299 delimiters to ensure that the ``plain'' version will be
30300 in a comment for those modes, also.
30301 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode} to see how to change the ``plain''
30302 formula delimiters.
30303
30304 There are several notations which Calc's parser for ``big''
30305 formatted formulas can't yet recognize. In particular, it can't
30306 read the large symbols for @code{sum}, @code{prod}, and @code{integ},
30307 and it can't handle @samp{=>} with the righthand argument omitted.
30308 Also, Calc won't recognize special formats you have defined with
30309 the @kbd{Z C} command (@pxref{User-Defined Compositions}). In
30310 these cases it is important to use ``plain'' mode to make sure
30311 Calc will be able to read your formula later.
30312
30313 Another example where ``plain'' mode is important is if you have
30314 specified a float mode with few digits of precision. Normally
30315 any digits that are computed but not displayed will simply be
30316 lost when you save and re-load your embedded buffer, but ``plain''
30317 mode allows you to make sure that the complete number is present
30318 in the file as well as the rounded-down number.
30319
30320 @tex
30321 \bigskip
30322 @end tex
30323
30324 Embedded buffers remember active formulas for as long as they
30325 exist in Emacs memory. Suppose you have an embedded formula
30326 which is @cpi{} to the normal 12 decimal places, and then
30327 type @w{@kbd{C-u 5 d n}} to display only five decimal places.
30328 If you then type @kbd{d n}, all 12 places reappear because the
30329 full number is still there on the Calc stack. More surprisingly,
30330 even if you exit Embedded mode and later re-enter it for that
30331 formula, typing @kbd{d n} will restore all 12 places because
30332 each buffer remembers all its active formulas. However, if you
30333 save the buffer in a file and reload it in a new Emacs session,
30334 all non-displayed digits will have been lost unless you used
30335 ``plain'' mode.
30336
30337 @tex
30338 \bigskip
30339 @end tex
30340
30341 In some applications of Embedded mode, you will want to have a
30342 sequence of copies of a formula that show its evolution as you
30343 work on it. For example, you might want to have a sequence
30344 like this in your file (elaborating here on the example from
30345 the ``Getting Started'' chapter):
30346
30347 @smallexample
30348 The derivative of
30349
30350 ln(ln(x))
30351
30352 is
30353
30354 @r{(the derivative of }ln(ln(x))@r{)}
30355
30356 whose value at x = 2 is
30357
30358 @r{(the value)}
30359
30360 and at x = 3 is
30361
30362 @r{(the value)}
30363 @end smallexample
30364
30365 @kindex C-x * d
30366 @pindex calc-embedded-duplicate
30367 The @kbd{C-x * d} (@code{calc-embedded-duplicate}) command is a
30368 handy way to make sequences like this. If you type @kbd{C-x * d},
30369 the formula under the cursor (which may or may not have Embedded
30370 mode enabled for it at the time) is copied immediately below and
30371 Embedded mode is then enabled for that copy.
30372
30373 For this example, you would start with just
30374
30375 @smallexample
30376 The derivative of
30377
30378 ln(ln(x))
30379 @end smallexample
30380
30381 @noindent
30382 and press @kbd{C-x * d} with the cursor on this formula. The result
30383 is
30384
30385 @smallexample
30386 The derivative of
30387
30388 ln(ln(x))
30389
30390
30391 ln(ln(x))
30392 @end smallexample
30393
30394 @noindent
30395 with the second copy of the formula enabled in Embedded mode.
30396 You can now press @kbd{a d x @key{RET}} to take the derivative, and
30397 @kbd{C-x * d C-x * d} to make two more copies of the derivative.
30398 To complete the computations, type @kbd{3 s l x @key{RET}} to evaluate
30399 the last formula, then move up to the second-to-last formula
30400 and type @kbd{2 s l x @key{RET}}.
30401
30402 Finally, you would want to press @kbd{C-x * e} to exit Embedded
30403 mode, then go up and insert the necessary text in between the
30404 various formulas and numbers.
30405
30406 @tex
30407 \bigskip
30408 @end tex
30409
30410 @kindex C-x * f
30411 @kindex C-x * '
30412 @pindex calc-embedded-new-formula
30413 The @kbd{C-x * f} (@code{calc-embedded-new-formula}) command
30414 creates a new embedded formula at the current point. It inserts
30415 some default delimiters, which are usually just blank lines,
30416 and then does an algebraic entry to get the formula (which is
30417 then enabled for Embedded mode). This is just shorthand for
30418 typing the delimiters yourself, positioning the cursor between
30419 the new delimiters, and pressing @kbd{C-x * e}. The key sequence
30420 @kbd{C-x * '} is equivalent to @kbd{C-x * f}.
30421
30422 @kindex C-x * n
30423 @kindex C-x * p
30424 @pindex calc-embedded-next
30425 @pindex calc-embedded-previous
30426 The @kbd{C-x * n} (@code{calc-embedded-next}) and @kbd{C-x * p}
30427 (@code{calc-embedded-previous}) commands move the cursor to the
30428 next or previous active embedded formula in the buffer. They
30429 can take positive or negative prefix arguments to move by several
30430 formulas. Note that these commands do not actually examine the
30431 text of the buffer looking for formulas; they only see formulas
30432 which have previously been activated in Embedded mode. In fact,
30433 @kbd{C-x * n} and @kbd{C-x * p} are a useful way to tell which
30434 embedded formulas are currently active. Also, note that these
30435 commands do not enable Embedded mode on the next or previous
30436 formula, they just move the cursor.
30437
30438 @kindex C-x * `
30439 @pindex calc-embedded-edit
30440 The @kbd{C-x * `} (@code{calc-embedded-edit}) command edits the
30441 embedded formula at the current point as if by @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}).
30442 Embedded mode does not have to be enabled for this to work. Press
30443 @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish the edit, or @kbd{C-x k} to cancel.
30444
30445 @node Assignments in Embedded Mode, Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30446 @section Assignments in Embedded Mode
30447
30448 @noindent
30449 The @samp{:=} (assignment) and @samp{=>} (``evaluates-to'') operators
30450 are especially useful in Embedded mode. They allow you to make
30451 a definition in one formula, then refer to that definition in
30452 other formulas embedded in the same buffer.
30453
30454 An embedded formula which is an assignment to a variable, as in
30455
30456 @example
30457 foo := 5
30458 @end example
30459
30460 @noindent
30461 records @expr{5} as the stored value of @code{foo} for the
30462 purposes of Embedded mode operations in the current buffer. It
30463 does @emph{not} actually store @expr{5} as the ``global'' value
30464 of @code{foo}, however. Regular Calc operations, and Embedded
30465 formulas in other buffers, will not see this assignment.
30466
30467 One way to use this assigned value is simply to create an
30468 Embedded formula elsewhere that refers to @code{foo}, and to press
30469 @kbd{=} in that formula. However, this permanently replaces the
30470 @code{foo} in the formula with its current value. More interesting
30471 is to use @samp{=>} elsewhere:
30472
30473 @example
30474 foo + 7 => 12
30475 @end example
30476
30477 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a general discussion of @samp{=>}.
30478
30479 If you move back and change the assignment to @code{foo}, any
30480 @samp{=>} formulas which refer to it are automatically updated.
30481
30482 @example
30483 foo := 17
30484
30485 foo + 7 => 24
30486 @end example
30487
30488 The obvious question then is, @emph{how} can one easily change the
30489 assignment to @code{foo}? If you simply select the formula in
30490 Embedded mode and type 17, the assignment itself will be replaced
30491 by the 17. The effect on the other formula will be that the
30492 variable @code{foo} becomes unassigned:
30493
30494 @example
30495 17
30496
30497 foo + 7 => foo + 7
30498 @end example
30499
30500 The right thing to do is first to use a selection command (@kbd{j 2}
30501 will do the trick) to select the righthand side of the assignment.
30502 Then, @kbd{17 @key{TAB} @key{DEL}} will swap the 17 into place (@pxref{Selecting
30503 Subformulas}, to see how this works).
30504
30505 @kindex C-x * j
30506 @pindex calc-embedded-select
30507 The @kbd{C-x * j} (@code{calc-embedded-select}) command provides an
30508 easy way to operate on assignments. It is just like @kbd{C-x * e},
30509 except that if the enabled formula is an assignment, it uses
30510 @kbd{j 2} to select the righthand side. If the enabled formula
30511 is an evaluates-to, it uses @kbd{j 1} to select the lefthand side.
30512 A formula can also be a combination of both:
30513
30514 @example
30515 bar := foo + 3 => 20
30516 @end example
30517
30518 @noindent
30519 in which case @kbd{C-x * j} will select the middle part (@samp{foo + 3}).
30520
30521 The formula is automatically deselected when you leave Embedded
30522 mode.
30523
30524 @kindex C-x * u
30525 @pindex calc-embedded-update-formula
30526 Another way to change the assignment to @code{foo} would simply be
30527 to edit the number using regular Emacs editing rather than Embedded
30528 mode. Then, we have to find a way to get Embedded mode to notice
30529 the change. The @kbd{C-x * u} (@code{calc-embedded-update-formula})
30530 command is a convenient way to do this.
30531
30532 @example
30533 foo := 6
30534
30535 foo + 7 => 13
30536 @end example
30537
30538 Pressing @kbd{C-x * u} is much like pressing @kbd{C-x * e = C-x * e}, that
30539 is, temporarily enabling Embedded mode for the formula under the
30540 cursor and then evaluating it with @kbd{=}. But @kbd{C-x * u} does
30541 not actually use @kbd{C-x * e}, and in fact another formula somewhere
30542 else can be enabled in Embedded mode while you use @kbd{C-x * u} and
30543 that formula will not be disturbed.
30544
30545 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * u} updates all active
30546 @samp{=>} formulas in the buffer. Formulas which have not yet
30547 been activated in Embedded mode, and formulas which do not have
30548 @samp{=>} as their top-level operator, are not affected by this.
30549 (This is useful only if you have used @kbd{m C}; see below.)
30550
30551 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{C-u C-x * u} updates only in the
30552 region between mark and point rather than in the whole buffer.
30553
30554 @kbd{C-x * u} is also a handy way to activate a formula, such as an
30555 @samp{=>} formula that has freshly been typed in or loaded from a
30556 file.
30557
30558 @kindex C-x * a
30559 @pindex calc-embedded-activate
30560 The @kbd{C-x * a} (@code{calc-embedded-activate}) command scans
30561 through the current buffer and activates all embedded formulas
30562 that contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols. This does not mean
30563 that Embedded mode is actually turned on, but only that the
30564 formulas' positions are registered with Embedded mode so that
30565 the @samp{=>} values can be properly updated as assignments are
30566 changed.
30567
30568 It is a good idea to type @kbd{C-x * a} right after loading a file
30569 that uses embedded @samp{=>} operators. Emacs includes a nifty
30570 ``buffer-local variables'' feature that you can use to do this
30571 automatically. The idea is to place near the end of your file
30572 a few lines that look like this:
30573
30574 @example
30575 --- Local Variables: ---
30576 --- eval:(calc-embedded-activate) ---
30577 --- End: ---
30578 @end example
30579
30580 @noindent
30581 where the leading and trailing @samp{---} can be replaced by
30582 any suitable strings (which must be the same on all three lines)
30583 or omitted altogether; in a @TeX{} or La@TeX{} file, @samp{%} would be a good
30584 leading string and no trailing string would be necessary. In a
30585 C program, @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} would be good leading and
30586 trailing strings.
30587
30588 When Emacs loads a file into memory, it checks for a Local Variables
30589 section like this one at the end of the file. If it finds this
30590 section, it does the specified things (in this case, running
30591 @kbd{C-x * a} automatically) before editing of the file begins.
30592 The Local Variables section must be within 3000 characters of the
30593 end of the file for Emacs to find it, and it must be in the last
30594 page of the file if the file has any page separators.
30595 @xref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the
30596 Emacs manual}.
30597
30598 Note that @kbd{C-x * a} does not update the formulas it finds.
30599 To do this, type, say, @kbd{M-1 C-x * u} after @w{@kbd{C-x * a}}.
30600 Generally this should not be a problem, though, because the
30601 formulas will have been up-to-date already when the file was
30602 saved.
30603
30604 Normally, @kbd{C-x * a} activates all the formulas it finds, but
30605 any previous active formulas remain active as well. With a
30606 positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * a} first deactivates
30607 all current active formulas, then actives the ones it finds in
30608 its scan of the buffer. With a negative prefix argument,
30609 @kbd{C-x * a} simply deactivates all formulas.
30610
30611 Embedded mode has two symbols, @samp{Active} and @samp{~Active},
30612 which it puts next to the major mode name in a buffer's mode line.
30613 It puts @samp{Active} if it has reason to believe that all
30614 formulas in the buffer are active, because you have typed @kbd{C-x * a}
30615 and Calc has not since had to deactivate any formulas (which can
30616 happen if Calc goes to update an @samp{=>} formula somewhere because
30617 a variable changed, and finds that the formula is no longer there
30618 due to some kind of editing outside of Embedded mode). Calc puts
30619 @samp{~Active} in the mode line if some, but probably not all,
30620 formulas in the buffer are active. This happens if you activate
30621 a few formulas one at a time but never use @kbd{C-x * a}, or if you
30622 used @kbd{C-x * a} but then Calc had to deactivate a formula
30623 because it lost track of it. If neither of these symbols appears
30624 in the mode line, no embedded formulas are active in the buffer
30625 (e.g., before Embedded mode has been used, or after a @kbd{M-- C-x * a}).
30626
30627 Embedded formulas can refer to assignments both before and after them
30628 in the buffer. If there are several assignments to a variable, the
30629 nearest preceding assignment is used if there is one, otherwise the
30630 following assignment is used.
30631
30632 @example
30633 x => 1
30634
30635 x := 1
30636
30637 x => 1
30638
30639 x := 2
30640
30641 x => 2
30642 @end example
30643
30644 As well as simple variables, you can also assign to subscript
30645 expressions of the form @samp{@var{var}_@var{number}} (as in
30646 @code{x_0}), or @samp{@var{var}_@var{var}} (as in @code{x_max}).
30647 Assignments to other kinds of objects can be represented by Calc,
30648 but the automatic linkage between assignments and references works
30649 only for plain variables and these two kinds of subscript expressions.
30650
30651 If there are no assignments to a given variable, the global
30652 stored value for the variable is used (@pxref{Storing Variables}),
30653 or, if no value is stored, the variable is left in symbolic form.
30654 Note that global stored values will be lost when the file is saved
30655 and loaded in a later Emacs session, unless you have used the
30656 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save them;
30657 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
30658
30659 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns automatic
30660 recomputation of @samp{=>} forms on and off. If you turn automatic
30661 recomputation off, you will have to use @kbd{C-x * u} to update these
30662 formulas manually after an assignment has been changed. If you
30663 plan to change several assignments at once, it may be more efficient
30664 to type @kbd{m C}, change all the assignments, then use @kbd{M-1 C-x * u}
30665 to update the entire buffer afterwards. The @kbd{m C} command also
30666 controls @samp{=>} formulas on the stack; @pxref{Evaluates-To
30667 Operator}. When you turn automatic recomputation back on, the
30668 stack will be updated but the Embedded buffer will not; you must
30669 use @kbd{C-x * u} to update the buffer by hand.
30670
30671 @node Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Customizing Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30672 @section Mode Settings in Embedded Mode
30673
30674 @kindex m e
30675 @pindex calc-embedded-preserve-modes
30676 @noindent
30677 The mode settings can be changed while Calc is in embedded mode, but
30678 by default they will revert to their original values when embedded mode
30679 is ended. However, the modes saved when the mode-recording mode is
30680 @code{Save} (see below) and the modes in effect when the @kbd{m e}
30681 (@code{calc-embedded-preserve-modes}) command is given
30682 will be preserved when embedded mode is ended.
30683
30684 Embedded mode has a rather complicated mechanism for handling mode
30685 settings in Embedded formulas. It is possible to put annotations
30686 in the file that specify mode settings either global to the entire
30687 file or local to a particular formula or formulas. In the latter
30688 case, different modes can be specified for use when a formula
30689 is the enabled Embedded mode formula.
30690
30691 When you give any mode-setting command, like @kbd{m f} (for Fraction
30692 mode) or @kbd{d s} (for scientific notation), Embedded mode adds
30693 a line like the following one to the file just before the opening
30694 delimiter of the formula.
30695
30696 @example
30697 % [calc-mode: fractions: t]
30698 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30699 @end example
30700
30701 When Calc interprets an embedded formula, it scans the text before
30702 the formula for mode-setting annotations like these and sets the
30703 Calc buffer to match these modes. Modes not explicitly described
30704 in the file are not changed. Calc scans all the way to the top of
30705 the file, or up to a line of the form
30706
30707 @example
30708 % [calc-defaults]
30709 @end example
30710
30711 @noindent
30712 which you can insert at strategic places in the file if this backward
30713 scan is getting too slow, or just to provide a barrier between one
30714 ``zone'' of mode settings and another.
30715
30716 If the file contains several annotations for the same mode, the
30717 closest one before the formula is used. Annotations after the
30718 formula are never used (except for global annotations, described
30719 below).
30720
30721 The scan does not look for the leading @samp{% }, only for the
30722 square brackets and the text they enclose. In fact, the leading
30723 characters are different for different major modes. You can edit the
30724 mode annotations to a style that works better in context if you wish.
30725 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to change the style
30726 that Calc uses when it generates the annotations. You can write
30727 mode annotations into the file yourself if you know the syntax;
30728 the easiest way to find the syntax for a given mode is to let
30729 Calc write the annotation for it once and see what it does.
30730
30731 If you give a mode-changing command for a mode that already has
30732 a suitable annotation just above the current formula, Calc will
30733 modify that annotation rather than generating a new, conflicting
30734 one.
30735
30736 Mode annotations have three parts, separated by colons. (Spaces
30737 after the colons are optional.) The first identifies the kind
30738 of mode setting, the second is a name for the mode itself, and
30739 the third is the value in the form of a Lisp symbol, number,
30740 or list. Annotations with unrecognizable text in the first or
30741 second parts are ignored. The third part is not checked to make
30742 sure the value is of a valid type or range; if you write an
30743 annotation by hand, be sure to give a proper value or results
30744 will be unpredictable. Mode-setting annotations are case-sensitive.
30745
30746 While Embedded mode is enabled, the word @code{Local} appears in
30747 the mode line. This is to show that mode setting commands generate
30748 annotations that are ``local'' to the current formula or set of
30749 formulas. The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command
30750 causes Calc to generate different kinds of annotations. Pressing
30751 @kbd{m R} repeatedly cycles through the possible modes.
30752
30753 @code{LocEdit} and @code{LocPerm} modes generate annotations
30754 that look like this, respectively:
30755
30756 @example
30757 % [calc-edit-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30758 % [calc-perm-mode: float-format: (sci 5)]
30759 @end example
30760
30761 The first kind of annotation will be used only while a formula
30762 is enabled in Embedded mode. The second kind will be used only
30763 when the formula is @emph{not} enabled. (Whether the formula
30764 is ``active'' or not, i.e., whether Calc has seen this formula
30765 yet, is not relevant here.)
30766
30767 @code{Global} mode generates an annotation like this at the end
30768 of the file:
30769
30770 @example
30771 % [calc-global-mode: fractions t]
30772 @end example
30773
30774 Global mode annotations affect all formulas throughout the file,
30775 and may appear anywhere in the file. This allows you to tuck your
30776 mode annotations somewhere out of the way, say, on a new page of
30777 the file, as long as those mode settings are suitable for all
30778 formulas in the file.
30779
30780 Enabling a formula with @kbd{C-x * e} causes a fresh scan for local
30781 mode annotations; you will have to use this after adding annotations
30782 above a formula by hand to get the formula to notice them. Updating
30783 a formula with @kbd{C-x * u} will also re-scan the local modes, but
30784 global modes are only re-scanned by @kbd{C-x * a}.
30785
30786 Another way that modes can get out of date is if you add a local
30787 mode annotation to a formula that has another formula after it.
30788 In this example, we have used the @kbd{d s} command while the
30789 first of the two embedded formulas is active. But the second
30790 formula has not changed its style to match, even though by the
30791 rules of reading annotations the @samp{(sci 0)} applies to it, too.
30792
30793 @example
30794 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30795 1.23e2
30796
30797 456.
30798 @end example
30799
30800 We would have to go down to the other formula and press @kbd{C-x * u}
30801 on it in order to get it to notice the new annotation.
30802
30803 Two more mode-recording modes selectable by @kbd{m R} are available
30804 which are also available outside of Embedded mode.
30805 (@pxref{General Mode Commands}.) They are @code{Save}, in which mode
30806 settings are recorded permanently in your Calc init file (the file given
30807 by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el})
30808 rather than by annotating the current document, and no-recording
30809 mode (where there is no symbol like @code{Save} or @code{Local} in
30810 the mode line), in which mode-changing commands do not leave any
30811 annotations at all.
30812
30813 When Embedded mode is not enabled, mode-recording modes except
30814 for @code{Save} have no effect.
30815
30816 @node Customizing Embedded Mode, , Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30817 @section Customizing Embedded Mode
30818
30819 @noindent
30820 You can modify Embedded mode's behavior by setting various Lisp
30821 variables described here. These variables are customizable
30822 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), or you can use @kbd{M-x set-variable}
30823 or @kbd{M-x edit-options} to adjust a variable on the fly.
30824 (Another possibility would be to use a file-local variable annotation at
30825 the end of the file;
30826 @pxref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the Emacs manual}.)
30827 Many of the variables given mentioned here can be set to depend on the
30828 major mode of the editing buffer (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
30829
30830 @vindex calc-embedded-open-formula
30831 The @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} variable holds a regular
30832 expression for the opening delimiter of a formula. @xref{Regexp Search,
30833 , Regular Expression Search, emacs, the Emacs manual}, to see
30834 how regular expressions work. Basically, a regular expression is a
30835 pattern that Calc can search for. A regular expression that considers
30836 blank lines, @samp{$}, and @samp{$$} to be opening delimiters is
30837 @code{"\\`\\|^\n\\|\\$\\$?"}. Just in case the meaning of this
30838 regular expression is not completely plain, let's go through it
30839 in detail.
30840
30841 The surrounding @samp{" "} marks quote the text between them as a
30842 Lisp string. If you left them off, @code{set-variable} or
30843 @code{edit-options} would try to read the regular expression as a
30844 Lisp program.
30845
30846 The most obvious property of this regular expression is that it
30847 contains indecently many backslashes. There are actually two levels
30848 of backslash usage going on here. First, when Lisp reads a quoted
30849 string, all pairs of characters beginning with a backslash are
30850 interpreted as special characters. Here, @code{\n} changes to a
30851 new-line character, and @code{\\} changes to a single backslash.
30852 So the actual regular expression seen by Calc is
30853 @samp{\`\|^ @r{(newline)} \|\$\$?}.
30854
30855 Regular expressions also consider pairs beginning with backslash
30856 to have special meanings. Sometimes the backslash is used to quote
30857 a character that otherwise would have a special meaning in a regular
30858 expression, like @samp{$}, which normally means ``end-of-line,''
30859 or @samp{?}, which means that the preceding item is optional. So
30860 @samp{\$\$?} matches either one or two dollar signs.
30861
30862 The other codes in this regular expression are @samp{^}, which matches
30863 ``beginning-of-line,'' @samp{\|}, which means ``or,'' and @samp{\`},
30864 which matches ``beginning-of-buffer.'' So the whole pattern means
30865 that a formula begins at the beginning of the buffer, or on a newline
30866 that occurs at the beginning of a line (i.e., a blank line), or at
30867 one or two dollar signs.
30868
30869 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} looks just
30870 like this example, with several more alternatives added on to
30871 recognize various other common kinds of delimiters.
30872
30873 By the way, the reason to use @samp{^\n} rather than @samp{^$}
30874 or @samp{\n\n}, which also would appear to match blank lines,
30875 is that the former expression actually ``consumes'' only one
30876 newline character as @emph{part of} the delimiter, whereas the
30877 latter expressions consume zero or two newlines, respectively.
30878 The former choice gives the most natural behavior when Calc
30879 must operate on a whole formula including its delimiters.
30880
30881 See the Emacs manual for complete details on regular expressions.
30882 But just for your convenience, here is a list of all characters
30883 which must be quoted with backslash (like @samp{\$}) to avoid
30884 some special interpretation: @samp{. * + ? [ ] ^ $ \}. (Note
30885 the backslash in this list; for example, to match @samp{\[} you
30886 must use @code{"\\\\\\["}. An exercise for the reader is to
30887 account for each of these six backslashes!)
30888
30889 @vindex calc-embedded-close-formula
30890 The @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} variable holds a regular
30891 expression for the closing delimiter of a formula. A closing
30892 regular expression to match the above example would be
30893 @code{"\\'\\|\n$\\|\\$\\$?"}. This is almost the same as the
30894 other one, except it now uses @samp{\'} (``end-of-buffer'') and
30895 @samp{\n$} (newline occurring at end of line, yet another way
30896 of describing a blank line that is more appropriate for this
30897 case).
30898
30899 @vindex calc-embedded-word-regexp
30900 The @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} variable holds a regular expression
30901 used to define an expression to look for (a ``word'') when you type
30902 @kbd{C-x * w} to enable Embedded mode.
30903
30904 @vindex calc-embedded-open-plain
30905 The @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} variable is a string which
30906 begins a ``plain'' formula written in front of the formatted
30907 formula when @kbd{d p} mode is turned on. Note that this is an
30908 actual string, not a regular expression, because Calc must be able
30909 to write this string into a buffer as well as to recognize it.
30910 The default string is @code{"%%% "} (note the trailing space), but may
30911 be different for certain major modes.
30912
30913 @vindex calc-embedded-close-plain
30914 The @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} variable is a string which
30915 ends a ``plain'' formula. The default is @code{" %%%\n"}, but may be
30916 different for different major modes. Without
30917 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
30918 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
30919
30920 @vindex calc-embedded-open-new-formula
30921 The @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} variable is a string
30922 which is inserted at the front of a new formula when you type
30923 @kbd{C-x * f}. Its default value is @code{"\n\n"}. If this
30924 string begins with a newline character and the @kbd{C-x * f} is
30925 typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip this
30926 first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in
30927 the file.
30928
30929 @vindex calc-embedded-close-new-formula
30930 The @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} variable is the corresponding
30931 string which is inserted at the end of a new formula. Its default
30932 value is also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by
30933 @w{@kbd{C-x * f}} if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if
30934 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed on a blank line, both a leading opening
30935 newline and a trailing closing newline are omitted.)
30936
30937 @vindex calc-embedded-announce-formula
30938 The @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} variable is a regular
30939 expression which is sure to be followed by an embedded formula.
30940 The @kbd{C-x * a} command searches for this pattern as well as for
30941 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=} operators. Note that @kbd{C-x * a} will
30942 not activate just anything surrounded by formula delimiters; after
30943 all, blank lines are considered formula delimiters by default!
30944 But if your language includes a delimiter which can only occur
30945 actually in front of a formula, you can take advantage of it here.
30946 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, but may be
30947 different for different major modes.
30948 This pattern will check for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of
30949 lines beginning with @samp{%} and a space. This last is important to
30950 make Calc consider mode annotations part of the pattern, so that the
30951 formula's opening delimiter really is sure to follow the pattern.
30952
30953 @vindex calc-embedded-open-mode
30954 The @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} variable is a string (not a
30955 regular expression) which should precede a mode annotation.
30956 Calc never scans for this string; Calc always looks for the
30957 annotation itself. But this is the string that is inserted before
30958 the opening bracket when Calc adds an annotation on its own.
30959 The default is @code{"% "}, but may be different for different major
30960 modes.
30961
30962 @vindex calc-embedded-close-mode
30963 The @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} variable is a string which
30964 follows a mode annotation written by Calc. Its default value
30965 is simply a newline, @code{"\n"}, but may be different for different
30966 major modes. If you change this, it is a good idea still to end with a
30967 newline so that mode annotations will appear on lines by themselves.
30968
30969 @node Programming, Copying, Embedded Mode, Top
30970 @chapter Programming
30971
30972 @noindent
30973 There are several ways to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator, depending
30974 on the nature of the problem you need to solve.
30975
30976 @enumerate
30977 @item
30978 @dfn{Keyboard macros} allow you to record a sequence of keystrokes
30979 and play them back at a later time. This is just the standard Emacs
30980 keyboard macro mechanism, dressed up with a few more features such
30981 as loops and conditionals.
30982
30983 @item
30984 @dfn{Algebraic definitions} allow you to use any formula to define a
30985 new function. This function can then be used in algebraic formulas or
30986 as an interactive command.
30987
30988 @item
30989 @dfn{Rewrite rules} are discussed in the section on algebra commands.
30990 @xref{Rewrite Rules}. If you put your rewrite rules in the variable
30991 @code{EvalRules}, they will be applied automatically to all Calc
30992 results in just the same way as an internal ``rule'' is applied to
30993 evaluate @samp{sqrt(9)} to 3 and so on. @xref{Automatic Rewrites}.
30994
30995 @item
30996 @dfn{Lisp} is the programming language that Calc (and most of Emacs)
30997 is written in. If the above techniques aren't powerful enough, you
30998 can write Lisp functions to do anything that built-in Calc commands
30999 can do. Lisp code is also somewhat faster than keyboard macros or
31000 rewrite rules.
31001 @end enumerate
31002
31003 @kindex z
31004 Programming features are available through the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z}
31005 prefix keys. New commands that you define are two-key sequences
31006 beginning with @kbd{z}. Commands for managing these definitions
31007 use the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix. (The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing})
31008 command is described elsewhere; @pxref{Troubleshooting Commands}.
31009 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command is also
31010 described elsewhere; @pxref{User-Defined Compositions}.)
31011
31012 @menu
31013 * Creating User Keys::
31014 * Keyboard Macros::
31015 * Invocation Macros::
31016 * Algebraic Definitions::
31017 * Lisp Definitions::
31018 @end menu
31019
31020 @node Creating User Keys, Keyboard Macros, Programming, Programming
31021 @section Creating User Keys
31022
31023 @noindent
31024 @kindex Z D
31025 @pindex calc-user-define
31026 Any Calculator command may be bound to a key using the @kbd{Z D}
31027 (@code{calc-user-define}) command. Actually, it is bound to a two-key
31028 sequence beginning with the lower-case @kbd{z} prefix.
31029
31030 The @kbd{Z D} command first prompts for the key to define. For example,
31031 press @kbd{Z D a} to define the new key sequence @kbd{z a}. You are then
31032 prompted for the name of the Calculator command that this key should
31033 run. For example, the @code{calc-sincos} command is not normally
31034 available on a key. Typing @kbd{Z D s sincos @key{RET}} programs the
31035 @kbd{z s} key sequence to run @code{calc-sincos}. This definition will remain
31036 in effect for the rest of this Emacs session, or until you redefine
31037 @kbd{z s} to be something else.
31038
31039 You can actually bind any Emacs command to a @kbd{z} key sequence by
31040 backspacing over the @samp{calc-} when you are prompted for the command name.
31041
31042 As with any other prefix key, you can type @kbd{z ?} to see a list of
31043 all the two-key sequences you have defined that start with @kbd{z}.
31044 Initially, no @kbd{z} sequences (except @kbd{z ?} itself) are defined.
31045
31046 User keys are typically letters, but may in fact be any key.
31047 (@key{META}-keys are not permitted, nor are a terminal's special
31048 function keys which generate multi-character sequences when pressed.)
31049 You can define different commands on the shifted and unshifted versions
31050 of a letter if you wish.
31051
31052 @kindex Z U
31053 @pindex calc-user-undefine
31054 The @kbd{Z U} (@code{calc-user-undefine}) command unbinds a user key.
31055 For example, the key sequence @kbd{Z U s} will undefine the @code{sincos}
31056 key we defined above.
31057
31058 @kindex Z P
31059 @pindex calc-user-define-permanent
31060 @cindex Storing user definitions
31061 @cindex Permanent user definitions
31062 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined commands
31063 The @kbd{Z P} (@code{calc-user-define-permanent}) command makes a key
31064 binding permanent so that it will remain in effect even in future Emacs
31065 sessions. (It does this by adding a suitable bit of Lisp code into
31066 your Calc init file; that is, the file given by the variable
31067 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}.) For example,
31068 @kbd{Z P s} would register our @code{sincos} command permanently. If
31069 you later wish to unregister this command you must edit your Calc init
31070 file by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
31071 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
31072
31073 The @kbd{Z P} command also saves the user definition, if any, for the
31074 command bound to the key. After @kbd{Z F} and @kbd{Z C}, a given user
31075 key could invoke a command, which in turn calls an algebraic function,
31076 which might have one or more special display formats. A single @kbd{Z P}
31077 command will save all of these definitions.
31078 To save an algebraic function, type @kbd{'} (the apostrophe)
31079 when prompted for a key, and type the function name. To save a command
31080 without its key binding, type @kbd{M-x} and enter a function name. (The
31081 @samp{calc-} prefix will automatically be inserted for you.)
31082 (If the command you give implies a function, the function will be saved,
31083 and if the function has any display formats, those will be saved, but
31084 not the other way around: Saving a function will not save any commands
31085 or key bindings associated with the function.)
31086
31087 @kindex Z E
31088 @pindex calc-user-define-edit
31089 @cindex Editing user definitions
31090 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command edits the definition
31091 of a user key. This works for keys that have been defined by either
31092 keyboard macros or formulas; further details are contained in the relevant
31093 following sections.
31094
31095 @node Keyboard Macros, Invocation Macros, Creating User Keys, Programming
31096 @section Programming with Keyboard Macros
31097
31098 @noindent
31099 @kindex X
31100 @cindex Programming with keyboard macros
31101 @cindex Keyboard macros
31102 The easiest way to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator is to use standard
31103 keyboard macros. Press @w{@kbd{C-x (}} to begin recording a macro. From
31104 this point on, keystrokes you type will be saved away as well as
31105 performing their usual functions. Press @kbd{C-x )} to end recording.
31106 Press shift-@kbd{X} (or the standard Emacs key sequence @kbd{C-x e}) to
31107 execute your keyboard macro by replaying the recorded keystrokes.
31108 @xref{Keyboard Macros, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for further
31109 information.
31110
31111 When you use @kbd{X} to invoke a keyboard macro, the entire macro is
31112 treated as a single command by the undo and trail features. The stack
31113 display buffer is not updated during macro execution, but is instead
31114 fixed up once the macro completes. Thus, commands defined with keyboard
31115 macros are convenient and efficient. The @kbd{C-x e} command, on the
31116 other hand, invokes the keyboard macro with no special treatment: Each
31117 command in the macro will record its own undo information and trail entry,
31118 and update the stack buffer accordingly. If your macro uses features
31119 outside of Calc's control to operate on the contents of the Calc stack
31120 buffer, or if it includes Undo, Redo, or last-arguments commands, you
31121 must use @kbd{C-x e} to make sure the buffer and undo list are up-to-date
31122 at all times. You could also consider using @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args})
31123 instead of @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
31124
31125 Calc extends the standard Emacs keyboard macros in several ways.
31126 Keyboard macros can be used to create user-defined commands. Keyboard
31127 macros can include conditional and iteration structures, somewhat
31128 analogous to those provided by a traditional programmable calculator.
31129
31130 @menu
31131 * Naming Keyboard Macros::
31132 * Conditionals in Macros::
31133 * Loops in Macros::
31134 * Local Values in Macros::
31135 * Queries in Macros::
31136 @end menu
31137
31138 @node Naming Keyboard Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31139 @subsection Naming Keyboard Macros
31140
31141 @noindent
31142 @kindex Z K
31143 @pindex calc-user-define-kbd-macro
31144 Once you have defined a keyboard macro, you can bind it to a @kbd{z}
31145 key sequence with the @kbd{Z K} (@code{calc-user-define-kbd-macro}) command.
31146 This command prompts first for a key, then for a command name. For
31147 example, if you type @kbd{C-x ( n @key{TAB} n @key{TAB} C-x )} you will
31148 define a keyboard macro which negates the top two numbers on the stack
31149 (@key{TAB} swaps the top two stack elements). Now you can type
31150 @kbd{Z K n @key{RET}} to define this keyboard macro onto the @kbd{z n} key
31151 sequence. The default command name (if you answer the second prompt with
31152 just the @key{RET} key as in this example) will be something like
31153 @samp{calc-User-n}. The keyboard macro will now be available as both
31154 @kbd{z n} and @kbd{M-x calc-User-n}. You can backspace and enter a more
31155 descriptive command name if you wish.
31156
31157 Macros defined by @kbd{Z K} act like single commands; they are executed
31158 in the same way as by the @kbd{X} key. If you wish to define the macro
31159 as a standard no-frills Emacs macro (to be executed as if by @kbd{C-x e}),
31160 give a negative prefix argument to @kbd{Z K}.
31161
31162 Once you have bound your keyboard macro to a key, you can use
31163 @kbd{Z P} to register it permanently with Emacs. @xref{Creating User Keys}.
31164
31165 @cindex Keyboard macros, editing
31166 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31167 been defined by a keyboard macro tries to use the @code{edmacro} package
31168 edit the macro. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and update
31169 the definition stored on the key, or, to cancel the edit, kill the
31170 buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
31171 The special characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC},
31172 @code{DEL}, and @code{NUL} must be entered as these three character
31173 sequences, written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes @code{C-} and
31174 @code{M-}. Spaces and line breaks are ignored. Other characters are
31175 copied verbatim into the keyboard macro. Basically, the notation is the
31176 same as is used in all of this manual's examples, except that the manual
31177 takes some liberties with spaces: When we say @kbd{' [1 2 3] @key{RET}},
31178 we take it for granted that it is clear we really mean
31179 @kbd{' [1 @key{SPC} 2 @key{SPC} 3] @key{RET}}.
31180
31181 @kindex C-x * m
31182 @pindex read-kbd-macro
31183 The @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) command reads an Emacs ``region''
31184 of spelled-out keystrokes and defines it as the current keyboard macro.
31185 It is a convenient way to define a keyboard macro that has been stored
31186 in a file, or to define a macro without executing it at the same time.
31187
31188 @node Conditionals in Macros, Loops in Macros, Naming Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31189 @subsection Conditionals in Keyboard Macros
31190
31191 @noindent
31192 @kindex Z [
31193 @kindex Z ]
31194 @pindex calc-kbd-if
31195 @pindex calc-kbd-else
31196 @pindex calc-kbd-else-if
31197 @pindex calc-kbd-end-if
31198 @cindex Conditional structures
31199 The @kbd{Z [} (@code{calc-kbd-if}) and @kbd{Z ]} (@code{calc-kbd-end-if})
31200 commands allow you to put simple tests in a keyboard macro. When Calc
31201 sees the @kbd{Z [}, it pops an object from the stack and, if the object is
31202 a non-zero value, continues executing keystrokes. But if the object is
31203 zero, or if it is not provably nonzero, Calc skips ahead to the matching
31204 @kbd{Z ]} keystroke. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a set of commands for
31205 performing tests which conveniently produce 1 for true and 0 for false.
31206
31207 For example, @kbd{@key{RET} 0 a < Z [ n Z ]} implements an absolute-value
31208 function in the form of a keyboard macro. This macro duplicates the
31209 number on the top of the stack, pushes zero and compares using @kbd{a <}
31210 (@code{calc-less-than}), then, if the number was less than zero,
31211 executes @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}). Otherwise, the change-sign
31212 command is skipped.
31213
31214 To program this macro, type @kbd{C-x (}, type the above sequence of
31215 keystrokes, then type @kbd{C-x )}. Note that the keystrokes will be
31216 executed while you are making the definition as well as when you later
31217 re-execute the macro by typing @kbd{X}. Thus you should make sure a
31218 suitable number is on the stack before defining the macro so that you
31219 don't get a stack-underflow error during the definition process.
31220
31221 Conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. However, there should be exactly
31222 one @kbd{Z ]} for each @kbd{Z [} in a keyboard macro.
31223
31224 @kindex Z :
31225 The @kbd{Z :} (@code{calc-kbd-else}) command allows you to choose between
31226 two keystroke sequences. The general format is @kbd{@var{cond} Z [
31227 @var{then-part} Z : @var{else-part} Z ]}. If @var{cond} is true
31228 (i.e., if the top of stack contains a non-zero number after @var{cond}
31229 has been executed), the @var{then-part} will be executed and the
31230 @var{else-part} will be skipped. Otherwise, the @var{then-part} will
31231 be skipped and the @var{else-part} will be executed.
31232
31233 @kindex Z |
31234 The @kbd{Z |} (@code{calc-kbd-else-if}) command allows you to choose
31235 between any number of alternatives. For example,
31236 @kbd{@var{cond1} Z [ @var{part1} Z : @var{cond2} Z | @var{part2} Z :
31237 @var{part3} Z ]} will execute @var{part1} if @var{cond1} is true,
31238 otherwise it will execute @var{part2} if @var{cond2} is true, otherwise
31239 it will execute @var{part3}.
31240
31241 More precisely, @kbd{Z [} pops a number and conditionally skips to the
31242 next matching @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]} key. @w{@kbd{Z ]}} has no effect when
31243 actually executed. @kbd{Z :} skips to the next matching @kbd{Z ]}.
31244 @kbd{Z |} pops a number and conditionally skips to the next matching
31245 @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]}; thus, @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z |} are functionally
31246 equivalent except that @kbd{Z [} participates in nesting but @kbd{Z |}
31247 does not.
31248
31249 Calc's conditional and looping constructs work by scanning the
31250 keyboard macro for occurrences of character sequences like @samp{Z:}
31251 and @samp{Z]}. One side-effect of this is that if you use these
31252 constructs you must be careful that these character pairs do not
31253 occur by accident in other parts of the macros. Since Calc rarely
31254 uses shift-@kbd{Z} for any purpose except as a prefix character, this
31255 is not likely to be a problem. Another side-effect is that it will
31256 not work to define your own custom key bindings for these commands.
31257 Only the standard shift-@kbd{Z} bindings will work correctly.
31258
31259 @kindex Z C-g
31260 If Calc gets stuck while skipping characters during the definition of a
31261 macro, type @kbd{Z C-g} to cancel the definition. (Typing plain @kbd{C-g}
31262 actually adds a @kbd{C-g} keystroke to the macro.)
31263
31264 @node Loops in Macros, Local Values in Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31265 @subsection Loops in Keyboard Macros
31266
31267 @noindent
31268 @kindex Z <
31269 @kindex Z >
31270 @pindex calc-kbd-repeat
31271 @pindex calc-kbd-end-repeat
31272 @cindex Looping structures
31273 @cindex Iterative structures
31274 The @kbd{Z <} (@code{calc-kbd-repeat}) and @kbd{Z >}
31275 (@code{calc-kbd-end-repeat}) commands pop a number from the stack,
31276 which must be an integer, then repeat the keystrokes between the brackets
31277 the specified number of times. If the integer is zero or negative, the
31278 body is skipped altogether. For example, @kbd{1 @key{TAB} Z < 2 * Z >}
31279 computes two to a nonnegative integer power. First, we push 1 on the
31280 stack and then swap the integer argument back to the top. The @kbd{Z <}
31281 pops that argument leaving the 1 back on top of the stack. Then, we
31282 repeat a multiply-by-two step however many times.
31283
31284 Once again, the keyboard macro is executed as it is being entered.
31285 In this case it is especially important to set up reasonable initial
31286 conditions before making the definition: Suppose the integer 1000 just
31287 happened to be sitting on the stack before we typed the above definition!
31288 Another approach is to enter a harmless dummy definition for the macro,
31289 then go back and edit in the real one with a @kbd{Z E} command. Yet
31290 another approach is to type the macro as written-out keystroke names
31291 in a buffer, then use @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the
31292 macro.
31293
31294 @kindex Z /
31295 @pindex calc-break
31296 The @kbd{Z /} (@code{calc-kbd-break}) command allows you to break out
31297 of a keyboard macro loop prematurely. It pops an object from the stack;
31298 if that object is true (a non-zero number), control jumps out of the
31299 innermost enclosing @kbd{Z <} @dots{} @kbd{Z >} loop and continues
31300 after the @kbd{Z >}. If the object is false, the @kbd{Z /} has no
31301 effect. Thus @kbd{@var{cond} Z /} is similar to @samp{if (@var{cond}) break;}
31302 in the C language.
31303
31304 @kindex Z (
31305 @kindex Z )
31306 @pindex calc-kbd-for
31307 @pindex calc-kbd-end-for
31308 The @kbd{Z (} (@code{calc-kbd-for}) and @kbd{Z )} (@code{calc-kbd-end-for})
31309 commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and @kbd{Z >}, except that they make the
31310 value of the counter available inside the loop. The general layout is
31311 @kbd{@var{init} @var{final} Z ( @var{body} @var{step} Z )}. The @kbd{Z (}
31312 command pops initial and final values from the stack. It then creates
31313 a temporary internal counter and initializes it with the value @var{init}.
31314 The @kbd{Z (} command then repeatedly pushes the counter value onto the
31315 stack and executes @var{body} and @var{step}, adding @var{step} to the
31316 counter each time until the loop finishes.
31317
31318 @cindex Summations (by keyboard macros)
31319 By default, the loop finishes when the counter becomes greater than (or
31320 less than) @var{final}, assuming @var{initial} is less than (greater
31321 than) @var{final}. If @var{initial} is equal to @var{final}, the body
31322 executes exactly once. The body of the loop always executes at least
31323 once. For example, @kbd{0 1 10 Z ( 2 ^ + 1 Z )} computes the sum of the
31324 squares of the integers from 1 to 10, in steps of 1.
31325
31326 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{Z (}, the loop is
31327 forced to use upward-counting conventions. In this case, if @var{initial}
31328 is greater than @var{final} the body will not be executed at all.
31329 Note that @var{step} may still be negative in this loop; the prefix
31330 argument merely constrains the loop-finished test. Likewise, a prefix
31331 argument of @mathit{-1} forces downward-counting conventions.
31332
31333 @kindex Z @{
31334 @kindex Z @}
31335 @pindex calc-kbd-loop
31336 @pindex calc-kbd-end-loop
31337 The @kbd{Z @{} (@code{calc-kbd-loop}) and @kbd{Z @}}
31338 (@code{calc-kbd-end-loop}) commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and
31339 @kbd{Z >}, except that they do not pop a count from the stack---they
31340 effectively create an infinite loop. Every @kbd{Z @{} @dots{} @kbd{Z @}}
31341 loop ought to include at least one @kbd{Z /} to make sure the loop
31342 doesn't run forever. (If any error message occurs which causes Emacs
31343 to beep, the keyboard macro will also be halted; this is a standard
31344 feature of Emacs. You can also generally press @kbd{C-g} to halt a
31345 running keyboard macro, although not all versions of Unix support
31346 this feature.)
31347
31348 The conditional and looping constructs are not actually tied to
31349 keyboard macros, but they are most often used in that context.
31350 For example, the keystrokes @kbd{10 Z < 23 @key{RET} Z >} push
31351 ten copies of 23 onto the stack. This can be typed ``live'' just
31352 as easily as in a macro definition.
31353
31354 @xref{Conditionals in Macros}, for some additional notes about
31355 conditional and looping commands.
31356
31357 @node Local Values in Macros, Queries in Macros, Loops in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31358 @subsection Local Values in Macros
31359
31360 @noindent
31361 @cindex Local variables
31362 @cindex Restoring saved modes
31363 Keyboard macros sometimes want to operate under known conditions
31364 without affecting surrounding conditions. For example, a keyboard
31365 macro may wish to turn on Fraction mode, or set a particular
31366 precision, independent of the user's normal setting for those
31367 modes.
31368
31369 @kindex Z `
31370 @kindex Z '
31371 @pindex calc-kbd-push
31372 @pindex calc-kbd-pop
31373 Macros also sometimes need to use local variables. Assignments to
31374 local variables inside the macro should not affect any variables
31375 outside the macro. The @kbd{Z `} (@code{calc-kbd-push}) and @kbd{Z '}
31376 (@code{calc-kbd-pop}) commands give you both of these capabilities.
31377
31378 When you type @kbd{Z `} (with a backquote or accent grave character),
31379 the values of various mode settings are saved away. The ten ``quick''
31380 variables @code{q0} through @code{q9} are also saved. When
31381 you type @w{@kbd{Z '}} (with an apostrophe), these values are restored.
31382 Pairs of @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} commands may be nested.
31383
31384 If a keyboard macro halts due to an error in between a @kbd{Z `} and
31385 a @kbd{Z '}, the saved values will be restored correctly even though
31386 the macro never reaches the @kbd{Z '} command. Thus you can use
31387 @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} without having to worry about what happens
31388 in exceptional conditions.
31389
31390 If you type @kbd{Z `} ``live'' (not in a keyboard macro), Calc puts
31391 you into a ``recursive edit.'' You can tell you are in a recursive
31392 edit because there will be extra square brackets in the mode line,
31393 as in @samp{[(Calculator)]}. These brackets will go away when you
31394 type the matching @kbd{Z '} command. The modes and quick variables
31395 will be saved and restored in just the same way as if actual keyboard
31396 macros were involved.
31397
31398 The modes saved by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} are the current precision
31399 and binary word size, the angular mode (Deg, Rad, or HMS), the
31400 simplification mode, Algebraic mode, Symbolic mode, Infinite mode,
31401 Matrix or Scalar mode, Fraction mode, and the current complex mode
31402 (Polar or Rectangular). The ten ``quick'' variables' values (or lack
31403 thereof) are also saved.
31404
31405 Most mode-setting commands act as toggles, but with a numeric prefix
31406 they force the mode either on (positive prefix) or off (negative
31407 or zero prefix). Since you don't know what the environment might
31408 be when you invoke your macro, it's best to use prefix arguments
31409 for all mode-setting commands inside the macro.
31410
31411 In fact, @kbd{C-u Z `} is like @kbd{Z `} except that it sets the modes
31412 listed above to their default values. As usual, the matching @kbd{Z '}
31413 will restore the modes to their settings from before the @kbd{C-u Z `}.
31414 Also, @w{@kbd{Z `}} with a negative prefix argument resets the algebraic mode
31415 to its default (off) but leaves the other modes the same as they were
31416 outside the construct.
31417
31418 The contents of the stack and trail, values of non-quick variables, and
31419 other settings such as the language mode and the various display modes,
31420 are @emph{not} affected by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '}.
31421
31422 @node Queries in Macros, , Local Values in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31423 @subsection Queries in Keyboard Macros
31424
31425 @c @noindent
31426 @c @kindex Z =
31427 @c @pindex calc-kbd-report
31428 @c The @kbd{Z =} (@code{calc-kbd-report}) command displays an informative
31429 @c message including the value on the top of the stack. You are prompted
31430 @c to enter a string. That string, along with the top-of-stack value,
31431 @c is displayed unless @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) has been used
31432 @c to turn such messages off.
31433
31434 @noindent
31435 @kindex Z #
31436 @pindex calc-kbd-query
31437 The @kbd{Z #} (@code{calc-kbd-query}) command prompts for an algebraic
31438 entry which takes its input from the keyboard, even during macro
31439 execution. All the normal conventions of algebraic input, including the
31440 use of @kbd{$} characters, are supported. The prompt message itself is
31441 taken from the top of the stack, and so must be entered (as a string)
31442 before the @kbd{Z #} command. (Recall, as a string it can be entered by
31443 pressing the @kbd{"} key and will appear as a vector when it is put on
31444 the stack. The prompt message is only put on the stack to provide a
31445 prompt for the @kbd{Z #} command; it will not play any role in any
31446 subsequent calculations.) This command allows your keyboard macros to
31447 accept numbers or formulas as interactive input.
31448
31449 As an example,
31450 @kbd{2 @key{RET} "Power: " @key{RET} Z # 3 @key{RET} ^} will prompt for
31451 input with ``Power: '' in the minibuffer, then return 2 to the provided
31452 power. (The response to the prompt that's given, 3 in this example,
31453 will not be part of the macro.)
31454
31455 @xref{Keyboard Macro Query, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for a description of
31456 @kbd{C-x q} (@code{kbd-macro-query}), the standard Emacs way to accept
31457 keyboard input during a keyboard macro. In particular, you can use
31458 @kbd{C-x q} to enter a recursive edit, which allows the user to perform
31459 any Calculator operations interactively before pressing @kbd{C-M-c} to
31460 return control to the keyboard macro.
31461
31462 @node Invocation Macros, Algebraic Definitions, Keyboard Macros, Programming
31463 @section Invocation Macros
31464
31465 @kindex C-x * z
31466 @kindex Z I
31467 @pindex calc-user-invocation
31468 @pindex calc-user-define-invocation
31469 Calc provides one special keyboard macro, called up by @kbd{C-x * z}
31470 (@code{calc-user-invocation}), that is intended to allow you to define
31471 your own special way of starting Calc. To define this ``invocation
31472 macro,'' create the macro in the usual way with @kbd{C-x (} and
31473 @kbd{C-x )}, then type @kbd{Z I} (@code{calc-user-define-invocation}).
31474 There is only one invocation macro, so you don't need to type any
31475 additional letters after @kbd{Z I}. From now on, you can type
31476 @kbd{C-x * z} at any time to execute your invocation macro.
31477
31478 For example, suppose you find yourself often grabbing rectangles of
31479 numbers into Calc and multiplying their columns. You can do this
31480 by typing @kbd{C-x * r} to grab, and @kbd{V R : *} to multiply columns.
31481 To make this into an invocation macro, just type @kbd{C-x ( C-x * r
31482 V R : * C-x )}, then @kbd{Z I}. Then, to multiply a rectangle of data,
31483 just mark the data in its buffer in the usual way and type @kbd{C-x * z}.
31484
31485 Invocation macros are treated like regular Emacs keyboard macros;
31486 all the special features described above for @kbd{Z K}-style macros
31487 do not apply. @kbd{C-x * z} is just like @kbd{C-x e}, except that it
31488 uses the macro that was last stored by @kbd{Z I}. (In fact, the
31489 macro does not even have to have anything to do with Calc!)
31490
31491 The @kbd{m m} command saves the last invocation macro defined by
31492 @kbd{Z I} along with all the other Calc mode settings.
31493 @xref{General Mode Commands}.
31494
31495 @node Algebraic Definitions, Lisp Definitions, Invocation Macros, Programming
31496 @section Programming with Formulas
31497
31498 @noindent
31499 @kindex Z F
31500 @pindex calc-user-define-formula
31501 @cindex Programming with algebraic formulas
31502 Another way to create a new Calculator command uses algebraic formulas.
31503 The @kbd{Z F} (@code{calc-user-define-formula}) command stores the
31504 formula at the top of the stack as the definition for a key. This
31505 command prompts for five things: The key, the command name, the function
31506 name, the argument list, and the behavior of the command when given
31507 non-numeric arguments.
31508
31509 For example, suppose we type @kbd{' a+2b @key{RET}} to push the formula
31510 @samp{a + 2*b} onto the stack. We now type @kbd{Z F m} to define this
31511 formula on the @kbd{z m} key sequence. The next prompt is for a command
31512 name, beginning with @samp{calc-}, which should be the long (@kbd{M-x}) form
31513 for the new command. If you simply press @key{RET}, a default name like
31514 @code{calc-User-m} will be constructed. In our example, suppose we enter
31515 @kbd{spam @key{RET}} to define the new command as @code{calc-spam}.
31516
31517 If you want to give the formula a long-style name only, you can press
31518 @key{SPC} or @key{RET} when asked which single key to use. For example
31519 @kbd{Z F @key{RET} spam @key{RET}} defines the new command as
31520 @kbd{M-x calc-spam}, with no keyboard equivalent.
31521
31522 The third prompt is for an algebraic function name. The default is to
31523 use the same name as the command name but without the @samp{calc-}
31524 prefix. (If this is of the form @samp{User-m}, the hyphen is removed so
31525 it won't be taken for a minus sign in algebraic formulas.)
31526 This is the name you will use if you want to enter your
31527 new function in an algebraic formula. Suppose we enter @kbd{yow @key{RET}}.
31528 Then the new function can be invoked by pushing two numbers on the
31529 stack and typing @kbd{z m} or @kbd{x spam}, or by entering the algebraic
31530 formula @samp{yow(x,y)}.
31531
31532 The fourth prompt is for the function's argument list. This is used to
31533 associate values on the stack with the variables that appear in the formula.
31534 The default is a list of all variables which appear in the formula, sorted
31535 into alphabetical order. In our case, the default would be @samp{(a b)}.
31536 This means that, when the user types @kbd{z m}, the Calculator will remove
31537 two numbers from the stack, substitute these numbers for @samp{a} and
31538 @samp{b} (respectively) in the formula, then simplify the formula and
31539 push the result on the stack. In other words, @kbd{10 @key{RET} 100 z m}
31540 would replace the 10 and 100 on the stack with the number 210, which is
31541 @expr{a + 2 b} with @expr{a=10} and @expr{b=100}. Likewise, the formula
31542 @samp{yow(10, 100)} will be evaluated by substituting @expr{a=10} and
31543 @expr{b=100} in the definition.
31544
31545 You can rearrange the order of the names before pressing @key{RET} to
31546 control which stack positions go to which variables in the formula. If
31547 you remove a variable from the argument list, that variable will be left
31548 in symbolic form by the command. Thus using an argument list of @samp{(b)}
31549 for our function would cause @kbd{10 z m} to replace the 10 on the stack
31550 with the formula @samp{a + 20}. If we had used an argument list of
31551 @samp{(b a)}, the result with inputs 10 and 100 would have been 120.
31552
31553 You can also put a nameless function on the stack instead of just a
31554 formula, as in @samp{<a, b : a + 2 b>}. @xref{Specifying Operators}.
31555 In this example, the command will be defined by the formula @samp{a + 2 b}
31556 using the argument list @samp{(a b)}.
31557
31558 The final prompt is a y-or-n question concerning what to do if symbolic
31559 arguments are given to your function. If you answer @kbd{y}, then
31560 executing @kbd{z m} (using the original argument list @samp{(a b)}) with
31561 arguments @expr{10} and @expr{x} will leave the function in symbolic
31562 form, i.e., @samp{yow(10,x)}. On the other hand, if you answer @kbd{n},
31563 then the formula will always be expanded, even for non-constant
31564 arguments: @samp{10 + 2 x}. If you never plan to feed algebraic
31565 formulas to your new function, it doesn't matter how you answer this
31566 question.
31567
31568 If you answered @kbd{y} to this question you can still cause a function
31569 call to be expanded by typing @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}).
31570 Also, Calc will expand the function if necessary when you take a
31571 derivative or integral or solve an equation involving the function.
31572
31573 @kindex Z G
31574 @pindex calc-get-user-defn
31575 Once you have defined a formula on a key, you can retrieve this formula
31576 with the @kbd{Z G} (@code{calc-user-define-get-defn}) command. Press a
31577 key, and this command pushes the formula that was used to define that
31578 key onto the stack. Actually, it pushes a nameless function that
31579 specifies both the argument list and the defining formula. You will get
31580 an error message if the key is undefined, or if the key was not defined
31581 by a @kbd{Z F} command.
31582
31583 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31584 been defined by a formula uses a variant of the @code{calc-edit} command
31585 to edit the defining formula. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and
31586 store the new formula back in the definition, or kill the buffer with
31587 @kbd{C-x k} to
31588 cancel the edit. (The argument list and other properties of the
31589 definition are unchanged; to adjust the argument list, you can use
31590 @kbd{Z G} to grab the function onto the stack, edit with @kbd{`}, and
31591 then re-execute the @kbd{Z F} command.)
31592
31593 As usual, the @kbd{Z P} command records your definition permanently.
31594 In this case it will permanently record all three of the relevant
31595 definitions: the key, the command, and the function.
31596
31597 You may find it useful to turn off the default simplifications with
31598 @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) when entering a formula to be
31599 used as a function definition. For example, the formula @samp{deriv(a^2,v)}
31600 which might be used to define a new function @samp{dsqr(a,v)} will be
31601 ``simplified'' to 0 immediately upon entry since @code{deriv} considers
31602 @expr{a} to be constant with respect to @expr{v}. Turning off
31603 default simplifications cures this problem: The definition will be stored
31604 in symbolic form without ever activating the @code{deriv} function. Press
31605 @kbd{m D} to turn the default simplifications back on afterwards.
31606
31607 @node Lisp Definitions, , Algebraic Definitions, Programming
31608 @section Programming with Lisp
31609
31610 @noindent
31611 The Calculator can be programmed quite extensively in Lisp. All you
31612 do is write a normal Lisp function definition, but with @code{defmath}
31613 in place of @code{defun}. This has the same form as @code{defun}, but it
31614 automagically replaces calls to standard Lisp functions like @code{+} and
31615 @code{zerop} with calls to the corresponding functions in Calc's own library.
31616 Thus you can write natural-looking Lisp code which operates on all of the
31617 standard Calculator data types. You can then use @kbd{Z D} if you wish to
31618 bind your new command to a @kbd{z}-prefix key sequence. The @kbd{Z E} command
31619 will not edit a Lisp-based definition.
31620
31621 Emacs Lisp is described in the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. This section
31622 assumes a familiarity with Lisp programming concepts; if you do not know
31623 Lisp, you may find keyboard macros or rewrite rules to be an easier way
31624 to program the Calculator.
31625
31626 This section first discusses ways to write commands, functions, or
31627 small programs to be executed inside of Calc. Then it discusses how
31628 your own separate programs are able to call Calc from the outside.
31629 Finally, there is a list of internal Calc functions and data structures
31630 for the true Lisp enthusiast.
31631
31632 @menu
31633 * Defining Functions::
31634 * Defining Simple Commands::
31635 * Defining Stack Commands::
31636 * Argument Qualifiers::
31637 * Example Definitions::
31638
31639 * Calling Calc from Your Programs::
31640 * Internals::
31641 @end menu
31642
31643 @node Defining Functions, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions, Lisp Definitions
31644 @subsection Defining New Functions
31645
31646 @noindent
31647 @findex defmath
31648 The @code{defmath} function (actually a Lisp macro) is like @code{defun}
31649 except that code in the body of the definition can make use of the full
31650 range of Calculator data types. The prefix @samp{calcFunc-} is added
31651 to the specified name to get the actual Lisp function name. As a simple
31652 example,
31653
31654 @example
31655 (defmath myfact (n)
31656 (if (> n 0)
31657 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31658 1))
31659 @end example
31660
31661 @noindent
31662 This actually expands to the code,
31663
31664 @example
31665 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
31666 (if (math-posp n)
31667 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
31668 1))
31669 @end example
31670
31671 @noindent
31672 This function can be used in algebraic expressions, e.g., @samp{myfact(5)}.
31673
31674 The @samp{myfact} function as it is defined above has the bug that an
31675 expression @samp{myfact(a+b)} will be simplified to 1 because the
31676 formula @samp{a+b} is not considered to be @code{posp}. A robust
31677 factorial function would be written along the following lines:
31678
31679 @smallexample
31680 (defmath myfact (n)
31681 (if (> n 0)
31682 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31683 (if (= n 0)
31684 1
31685 nil))) ; this could be simplified as: (and (= n 0) 1)
31686 @end smallexample
31687
31688 If a function returns @code{nil}, it is left unsimplified by the Calculator
31689 (except that its arguments will be simplified). Thus, @samp{myfact(a+1+2)}
31690 will be simplified to @samp{myfact(a+3)} but no further. Beware that every
31691 time the Calculator reexamines this formula it will attempt to resimplify
31692 it, so your function ought to detect the returning-@code{nil} case as
31693 efficiently as possible.
31694
31695 The following standard Lisp functions are treated by @code{defmath}:
31696 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^} or
31697 @code{expt}, @code{=}, @code{<}, @code{>}, @code{<=}, @code{>=},
31698 @code{/=}, @code{1+}, @code{1-}, @code{logand}, @code{logior}, @code{logxor},
31699 @code{logandc2}, @code{lognot}. Also, @code{~=} is an abbreviation for
31700 @code{math-nearly-equal}, which is useful in implementing Taylor series.
31701
31702 For other functions @var{func}, if a function by the name
31703 @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if a function by the
31704 name @samp{math-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if @var{func} itself
31705 is defined as a function it is used, otherwise @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} is
31706 used on the assumption that this is a to-be-defined math function. Also, if
31707 the function name is quoted as in @samp{('integerp a)} the function name is
31708 always used exactly as written (but not quoted).
31709
31710 Variable names have @samp{var-} prepended to them unless they appear in
31711 the function's argument list or in an enclosing @code{let}, @code{let*},
31712 @code{for}, or @code{foreach} form,
31713 or their names already contain a @samp{-} character. Thus a reference to
31714 @samp{foo} is the same as a reference to @samp{var-foo}.
31715
31716 A few other Lisp extensions are available in @code{defmath} definitions:
31717
31718 @itemize @bullet
31719 @item
31720 The @code{elt} function accepts any number of index variables.
31721 Note that Calc vectors are stored as Lisp lists whose first
31722 element is the symbol @code{vec}; thus, @samp{(elt v 2)} yields
31723 the second element of vector @code{v}, and @samp{(elt m i j)}
31724 yields one element of a Calc matrix.
31725
31726 @item
31727 The @code{setq} function has been extended to act like the Common
31728 Lisp @code{setf} function. (The name @code{setf} is recognized as
31729 a synonym of @code{setq}.) Specifically, the first argument of
31730 @code{setq} can be an @code{nth}, @code{elt}, @code{car}, or @code{cdr} form,
31731 in which case the effect is to store into the specified
31732 element of a list. Thus, @samp{(setq (elt m i j) x)} stores @expr{x}
31733 into one element of a matrix.
31734
31735 @item
31736 A @code{for} looping construct is available. For example,
31737 @samp{(for ((i 0 10)) body)} executes @code{body} once for each
31738 binding of @expr{i} from zero to 10. This is like a @code{let}
31739 form in that @expr{i} is temporarily bound to the loop count
31740 without disturbing its value outside the @code{for} construct.
31741 Nested loops, as in @samp{(for ((i 0 10) (j 0 (1- i) 2)) body)},
31742 are also available. For each value of @expr{i} from zero to 10,
31743 @expr{j} counts from 0 to @expr{i-1} in steps of two. Note that
31744 @code{for} has the same general outline as @code{let*}, except
31745 that each element of the header is a list of three or four
31746 things, not just two.
31747
31748 @item
31749 The @code{foreach} construct loops over elements of a list.
31750 For example, @samp{(foreach ((x (cdr v))) body)} executes
31751 @code{body} with @expr{x} bound to each element of Calc vector
31752 @expr{v} in turn. The purpose of @code{cdr} here is to skip over
31753 the initial @code{vec} symbol in the vector.
31754
31755 @item
31756 The @code{break} function breaks out of the innermost enclosing
31757 @code{while}, @code{for}, or @code{foreach} loop. If given a
31758 value, as in @samp{(break x)}, this value is returned by the
31759 loop. (Lisp loops otherwise always return @code{nil}.)
31760
31761 @item
31762 The @code{return} function prematurely returns from the enclosing
31763 function. For example, @samp{(return (+ x y))} returns @expr{x+y}
31764 as the value of a function. You can use @code{return} anywhere
31765 inside the body of the function.
31766 @end itemize
31767
31768 Non-integer numbers (and extremely large integers) cannot be included
31769 directly into a @code{defmath} definition. This is because the Lisp
31770 reader will fail to parse them long before @code{defmath} ever gets control.
31771 Instead, use the notation, @samp{:"3.1415"}. In fact, any algebraic
31772 formula can go between the quotes. For example,
31773
31774 @smallexample
31775 (defmath sqexp (x) ; sqexp(x) == sqrt(exp(x)) == exp(x*0.5)
31776 (and (numberp x)
31777 (exp :"x * 0.5")))
31778 @end smallexample
31779
31780 expands to
31781
31782 @smallexample
31783 (defun calcFunc-sqexp (x)
31784 (and (math-numberp x)
31785 (calcFunc-exp (math-mul x '(float 5 -1)))))
31786 @end smallexample
31787
31788 Note the use of @code{numberp} as a guard to ensure that the argument is
31789 a number first, returning @code{nil} if not. The exponential function
31790 could itself have been included in the expression, if we had preferred:
31791 @samp{:"exp(x * 0.5)"}. As another example, the multiplication-and-recursion
31792 step of @code{myfact} could have been written
31793
31794 @example
31795 :"n * myfact(n-1)"
31796 @end example
31797
31798 A good place to put your @code{defmath} commands is your Calc init file
31799 (the file given by @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
31800 @file{~/.calc.el}), which will not be loaded until Calc starts.
31801 If a file named @file{.emacs} exists in your home directory, Emacs reads
31802 and executes the Lisp forms in this file as it starts up. While it may
31803 seem reasonable to put your favorite @code{defmath} commands there,
31804 this has the unfortunate side-effect that parts of the Calculator must be
31805 loaded in to process the @code{defmath} commands whether or not you will
31806 actually use the Calculator! If you want to put the @code{defmath}
31807 commands there (for example, if you redefine @code{calc-settings-file}
31808 to be @file{.emacs}), a better effect can be had by writing
31809
31810 @example
31811 (put 'calc-define 'thing '(progn
31812 (defmath ... )
31813 (defmath ... )
31814 ))
31815 @end example
31816
31817 @noindent
31818 @vindex calc-define
31819 The @code{put} function adds a @dfn{property} to a symbol. Each Lisp
31820 symbol has a list of properties associated with it. Here we add a
31821 property with a name of @code{thing} and a @samp{(progn ...)} form as
31822 its value. When Calc starts up, and at the start of every Calc command,
31823 the property list for the symbol @code{calc-define} is checked and the
31824 values of any properties found are evaluated as Lisp forms. The
31825 properties are removed as they are evaluated. The property names
31826 (like @code{thing}) are not used; you should choose something like the
31827 name of your project so as not to conflict with other properties.
31828
31829 The net effect is that you can put the above code in your @file{.emacs}
31830 file and it will not be executed until Calc is loaded. Or, you can put
31831 that same code in another file which you load by hand either before or
31832 after Calc itself is loaded.
31833
31834 The properties of @code{calc-define} are evaluated in the same order
31835 that they were added. They can assume that the Calc modules @file{calc.el},
31836 @file{calc-ext.el}, and @file{calc-macs.el} have been fully loaded, and
31837 that the @samp{*Calculator*} buffer will be the current buffer.
31838
31839 If your @code{calc-define} property only defines algebraic functions,
31840 you can be sure that it will have been evaluated before Calc tries to
31841 call your function, even if the file defining the property is loaded
31842 after Calc is loaded. But if the property defines commands or key
31843 sequences, it may not be evaluated soon enough. (Suppose it defines the
31844 new command @code{tweak-calc}; the user can load your file, then type
31845 @kbd{M-x tweak-calc} before Calc has had chance to do anything.) To
31846 protect against this situation, you can put
31847
31848 @example
31849 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
31850 @end example
31851
31852 @findex calc-check-defines
31853 @noindent
31854 at the end of your file. The @code{calc-check-defines} function is what
31855 looks for and evaluates properties on @code{calc-define}; @code{run-hooks}
31856 has the advantage that it is quietly ignored if @code{calc-check-defines}
31857 is not yet defined because Calc has not yet been loaded.
31858
31859 Examples of things that ought to be enclosed in a @code{calc-define}
31860 property are @code{defmath} calls, @code{define-key} calls that modify
31861 the Calc key map, and any calls that redefine things defined inside Calc.
31862 Ordinary @code{defun}s need not be enclosed with @code{calc-define}.
31863
31864 @node Defining Simple Commands, Defining Stack Commands, Defining Functions, Lisp Definitions
31865 @subsection Defining New Simple Commands
31866
31867 @noindent
31868 @findex interactive
31869 If a @code{defmath} form contains an @code{interactive} clause, it defines
31870 a Calculator command. Actually such a @code{defmath} results in @emph{two}
31871 function definitions: One, a @samp{calcFunc-} function as was just described,
31872 with the @code{interactive} clause removed. Two, a @samp{calc-} function
31873 with a suitable @code{interactive} clause and some sort of wrapper to make
31874 the command work in the Calc environment.
31875
31876 In the simple case, the @code{interactive} clause has the same form as
31877 for normal Emacs Lisp commands:
31878
31879 @smallexample
31880 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
31881 "Increase precision by DELTA." ; This is the "documentation string"
31882 (interactive "p") ; Register this as a M-x-able command
31883 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
31884 @end smallexample
31885
31886 This expands to the pair of definitions,
31887
31888 @smallexample
31889 (defun calc-increase-precision (delta)
31890 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31891 (interactive "p")
31892 (calc-wrapper
31893 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta))))
31894
31895 (defun calcFunc-increase-precision (delta)
31896 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31897 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta)))
31898 @end smallexample
31899
31900 @noindent
31901 where in this case the latter function would never really be used! Note
31902 that since the Calculator stores small integers as plain Lisp integers,
31903 the @code{math-add} function will work just as well as the native
31904 @code{+} even when the intent is to operate on native Lisp integers.
31905
31906 @findex calc-wrapper
31907 The @samp{calc-wrapper} call invokes a macro which surrounds the body of
31908 the function with code that looks roughly like this:
31909
31910 @smallexample
31911 (let ((calc-command-flags nil))
31912 (unwind-protect
31913 (save-excursion
31914 (calc-select-buffer)
31915 @emph{body of function}
31916 @emph{renumber stack}
31917 @emph{clear} Working @emph{message})
31918 @emph{realign cursor and window}
31919 @emph{clear Inverse, Hyperbolic, and Keep Args flags}
31920 @emph{update Emacs mode line}))
31921 @end smallexample
31922
31923 @findex calc-select-buffer
31924 The @code{calc-select-buffer} function selects the @samp{*Calculator*}
31925 buffer if necessary, say, because the command was invoked from inside
31926 the @samp{*Calc Trail*} window.
31927
31928 @findex calc-set-command-flag
31929 You can call, for example, @code{(calc-set-command-flag 'no-align)} to
31930 set the above-mentioned command flags. Calc routines recognize the
31931 following command flags:
31932
31933 @table @code
31934 @item renum-stack
31935 Stack line numbers @samp{1:}, @samp{2:}, and so on must be renumbered
31936 after this command completes. This is set by routines like
31937 @code{calc-push}.
31938
31939 @item clear-message
31940 Calc should call @samp{(message "")} if this command completes normally
31941 (to clear a ``Working@dots{}'' message out of the echo area).
31942
31943 @item no-align
31944 Do not move the cursor back to the @samp{.} top-of-stack marker.
31945
31946 @item position-point
31947 Use the variables @code{calc-position-point-line} and
31948 @code{calc-position-point-column} to position the cursor after
31949 this command finishes.
31950
31951 @item keep-flags
31952 Do not clear @code{calc-inverse-flag}, @code{calc-hyperbolic-flag},
31953 and @code{calc-keep-args-flag} at the end of this command.
31954
31955 @item do-edit
31956 Switch to buffer @samp{*Calc Edit*} after this command.
31957
31958 @item hold-trail
31959 Do not move trail pointer to end of trail when something is recorded
31960 there.
31961 @end table
31962
31963 @kindex Y
31964 @kindex Y ?
31965 @vindex calc-Y-help-msgs
31966 Calc reserves a special prefix key, shift-@kbd{Y}, for user-written
31967 extensions to Calc. There are no built-in commands that work with
31968 this prefix key; you must call @code{define-key} from Lisp (probably
31969 from inside a @code{calc-define} property) to add to it. Initially only
31970 @kbd{Y ?} is defined; it takes help messages from a list of strings
31971 (initially @code{nil}) in the variable @code{calc-Y-help-msgs}. All
31972 other undefined keys except for @kbd{Y} are reserved for use by
31973 future versions of Calc.
31974
31975 If you are writing a Calc enhancement which you expect to give to
31976 others, it is best to minimize the number of @kbd{Y}-key sequences
31977 you use. In fact, if you have more than one key sequence you should
31978 consider defining three-key sequences with a @kbd{Y}, then a key that
31979 stands for your package, then a third key for the particular command
31980 within your package.
31981
31982 Users may wish to install several Calc enhancements, and it is possible
31983 that several enhancements will choose to use the same key. In the
31984 example below, a variable @code{inc-prec-base-key} has been defined
31985 to contain the key that identifies the @code{inc-prec} package. Its
31986 value is initially @code{"P"}, but a user can change this variable
31987 if necessary without having to modify the file.
31988
31989 Here is a complete file, @file{inc-prec.el}, which makes a @kbd{Y P I}
31990 command that increases the precision, and a @kbd{Y P D} command that
31991 decreases the precision.
31992
31993 @smallexample
31994 ;;; Increase and decrease Calc precision. Dave Gillespie, 5/31/91.
31995 ;; (Include copyright or copyleft stuff here.)
31996
31997 (defvar inc-prec-base-key "P"
31998 "Base key for inc-prec.el commands.")
31999
32000 (put 'calc-define 'inc-prec '(progn
32001
32002 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sI" inc-prec-base-key)
32003 'increase-precision)
32004 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sD" inc-prec-base-key)
32005 'decrease-precision)
32006
32007 (setq calc-Y-help-msgs
32008 (cons (format "%s + Inc-prec, Dec-prec" inc-prec-base-key)
32009 calc-Y-help-msgs))
32010
32011 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
32012 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32013 (interactive "p")
32014 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
32015
32016 (defmath decrease-precision (delta)
32017 "Decrease precision by DELTA."
32018 (interactive "p")
32019 (setq calc-internal-prec (- calc-internal-prec delta)))
32020
32021 )) ; end of calc-define property
32022
32023 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
32024 @end smallexample
32025
32026 @node Defining Stack Commands, Argument Qualifiers, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions
32027 @subsection Defining New Stack-Based Commands
32028
32029 @noindent
32030 To define a new computational command which takes and/or leaves arguments
32031 on the stack, a special form of @code{interactive} clause is used.
32032
32033 @example
32034 (interactive @var{num} @var{tag})
32035 @end example
32036
32037 @noindent
32038 where @var{num} is an integer, and @var{tag} is a string. The effect is
32039 to pop @var{num} values off the stack, resimplify them by calling
32040 @code{calc-normalize}, and hand them to your function according to the
32041 function's argument list. Your function may include @code{&optional} and
32042 @code{&rest} parameters, so long as calling the function with @var{num}
32043 parameters is valid.
32044
32045 Your function must return either a number or a formula in a form
32046 acceptable to Calc, or a list of such numbers or formulas. These value(s)
32047 are pushed onto the stack when the function completes. They are also
32048 recorded in the Calc Trail buffer on a line beginning with @var{tag},
32049 a string of (normally) four characters or less. If you omit @var{tag}
32050 or use @code{nil} as a tag, the result is not recorded in the trail.
32051
32052 As an example, the definition
32053
32054 @smallexample
32055 (defmath myfact (n)
32056 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32057 (interactive 1 "fact")
32058 (if (> n 0)
32059 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32060 (and (= n 0) 1)))
32061 @end smallexample
32062
32063 @noindent
32064 is a version of the factorial function shown previously which can be used
32065 as a command as well as an algebraic function. It expands to
32066
32067 @smallexample
32068 (defun calc-myfact ()
32069 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32070 (interactive)
32071 (calc-slow-wrapper
32072 (calc-enter-result 1 "fact"
32073 (cons 'calcFunc-myfact (calc-top-list-n 1)))))
32074
32075 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
32076 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32077 (if (math-posp n)
32078 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
32079 (and (math-zerop n) 1)))
32080 @end smallexample
32081
32082 @findex calc-slow-wrapper
32083 The @code{calc-slow-wrapper} function is a version of @code{calc-wrapper}
32084 that automatically puts up a @samp{Working...} message before the
32085 computation begins. (This message can be turned off by the user
32086 with an @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) command.)
32087
32088 @findex calc-top-list-n
32089 The @code{calc-top-list-n} function returns a list of the specified number
32090 of values from the top of the stack. It resimplifies each value by
32091 calling @code{calc-normalize}. If its argument is zero it returns an
32092 empty list. It does not actually remove these values from the stack.
32093
32094 @findex calc-enter-result
32095 The @code{calc-enter-result} function takes an integer @var{num} and string
32096 @var{tag} as described above, plus a third argument which is either a
32097 Calculator data object or a list of such objects. These objects are
32098 resimplified and pushed onto the stack after popping the specified number
32099 of values from the stack. If @var{tag} is non-@code{nil}, the values
32100 being pushed are also recorded in the trail.
32101
32102 Note that if @code{calcFunc-myfact} returns @code{nil} this represents
32103 ``leave the function in symbolic form.'' To return an actual empty list,
32104 in the sense that @code{calc-enter-result} will push zero elements back
32105 onto the stack, you should return the special value @samp{'(nil)}, a list
32106 containing the single symbol @code{nil}.
32107
32108 The @code{interactive} declaration can actually contain a limited
32109 Emacs-style code string as well which comes just before @var{num} and
32110 @var{tag}. Currently the only Emacs code supported is @samp{"p"}, as in
32111
32112 @example
32113 (defmath foo (a b &optional c)
32114 (interactive "p" 2 "foo")
32115 @var{body})
32116 @end example
32117
32118 In this example, the command @code{calc-foo} will evaluate the expression
32119 @samp{foo(a,b)} if executed with no argument, or @samp{foo(a,b,n)} if
32120 executed with a numeric prefix argument of @expr{n}.
32121
32122 The other code string allowed is @samp{"m"} (unrelated to the usual @samp{"m"}
32123 code as used with @code{defun}). It uses the numeric prefix argument as the
32124 number of objects to remove from the stack and pass to the function.
32125 In this case, the integer @var{num} serves as a default number of
32126 arguments to be used when no prefix is supplied.
32127
32128 @node Argument Qualifiers, Example Definitions, Defining Stack Commands, Lisp Definitions
32129 @subsection Argument Qualifiers
32130
32131 @noindent
32132 Anywhere a parameter name can appear in the parameter list you can also use
32133 an @dfn{argument qualifier}. Thus the general form of a definition is:
32134
32135 @example
32136 (defmath @var{name} (@var{param} @var{param...}
32137 &optional @var{param} @var{param...}
32138 &rest @var{param})
32139 @var{body})
32140 @end example
32141
32142 @noindent
32143 where each @var{param} is either a symbol or a list of the form
32144
32145 @example
32146 (@var{qual} @var{param})
32147 @end example
32148
32149 The following qualifiers are recognized:
32150
32151 @table @samp
32152 @item complete
32153 @findex complete
32154 The argument must not be an incomplete vector, interval, or complex number.
32155 (This is rarely needed since the Calculator itself will never call your
32156 function with an incomplete argument. But there is nothing stopping your
32157 own Lisp code from calling your function with an incomplete argument.)
32158
32159 @item integer
32160 @findex integer
32161 The argument must be an integer. If it is an integer-valued float
32162 it will be accepted but converted to integer form. Non-integers and
32163 formulas are rejected.
32164
32165 @item natnum
32166 @findex natnum
32167 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must be non-negative.
32168
32169 @item fixnum
32170 @findex fixnum
32171 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must fit into a native Lisp integer,
32172 which on most systems means less than 2^23 in absolute value. The
32173 argument is converted into Lisp-integer form if necessary.
32174
32175 @item float
32176 @findex float
32177 The argument is converted to floating-point format if it is a number or
32178 vector. If it is a formula it is left alone. (The argument is never
32179 actually rejected by this qualifier.)
32180
32181 @item @var{pred}
32182 The argument must satisfy predicate @var{pred}, which is one of the
32183 standard Calculator predicates. @xref{Predicates}.
32184
32185 @item not-@var{pred}
32186 The argument must @emph{not} satisfy predicate @var{pred}.
32187 @end table
32188
32189 For example,
32190
32191 @example
32192 (defmath foo (a (constp (not-matrixp b)) &optional (float c)
32193 &rest (integer d))
32194 @var{body})
32195 @end example
32196
32197 @noindent
32198 expands to
32199
32200 @example
32201 (defun calcFunc-foo (a b &optional c &rest d)
32202 (and (math-matrixp b)
32203 (math-reject-arg b 'not-matrixp))
32204 (or (math-constp b)
32205 (math-reject-arg b 'constp))
32206 (and c (setq c (math-check-float c)))
32207 (setq d (mapcar 'math-check-integer d))
32208 @var{body})
32209 @end example
32210
32211 @noindent
32212 which performs the necessary checks and conversions before executing the
32213 body of the function.
32214
32215 @node Example Definitions, Calling Calc from Your Programs, Argument Qualifiers, Lisp Definitions
32216 @subsection Example Definitions
32217
32218 @noindent
32219 This section includes some Lisp programming examples on a larger scale.
32220 These programs make use of some of the Calculator's internal functions;
32221 @pxref{Internals}.
32222
32223 @menu
32224 * Bit Counting Example::
32225 * Sine Example::
32226 @end menu
32227
32228 @node Bit Counting Example, Sine Example, Example Definitions, Example Definitions
32229 @subsubsection Bit-Counting
32230
32231 @noindent
32232 @ignore
32233 @starindex
32234 @end ignore
32235 @tindex bcount
32236 Calc does not include a built-in function for counting the number of
32237 ``one'' bits in a binary integer. It's easy to invent one using @kbd{b u}
32238 to convert the integer to a set, and @kbd{V #} to count the elements of
32239 that set; let's write a function that counts the bits without having to
32240 create an intermediate set.
32241
32242 @smallexample
32243 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32244 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32245 (let ((count 0))
32246 (while (> n 0)
32247 (if (oddp n)
32248 (setq count (1+ count)))
32249 (setq n (lsh n -1)))
32250 count))
32251 @end smallexample
32252
32253 @noindent
32254 When this is expanded by @code{defmath}, it will become the following
32255 Emacs Lisp function:
32256
32257 @smallexample
32258 (defun calcFunc-bcount (n)
32259 (setq n (math-check-natnum n))
32260 (let ((count 0))
32261 (while (math-posp n)
32262 (if (math-oddp n)
32263 (setq count (math-add count 1)))
32264 (setq n (calcFunc-lsh n -1)))
32265 count))
32266 @end smallexample
32267
32268 If the input numbers are large, this function involves a fair amount
32269 of arithmetic. A binary right shift is essentially a division by two;
32270 recall that Calc stores integers in decimal form so bit shifts must
32271 involve actual division.
32272
32273 To gain a bit more efficiency, we could divide the integer into
32274 @var{n}-bit chunks, each of which can be handled quickly because
32275 they fit into Lisp integers. It turns out that Calc's arithmetic
32276 routines are especially fast when dividing by an integer less than
32277 1000, so we can set @var{n = 9} bits and use repeated division by 512:
32278
32279 @smallexample
32280 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32281 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32282 (let ((count 0))
32283 (while (not (fixnump n))
32284 (let ((qr (idivmod n 512)))
32285 (setq count (+ count (bcount-fixnum (cdr qr)))
32286 n (car qr))))
32287 (+ count (bcount-fixnum n))))
32288
32289 (defun bcount-fixnum (n)
32290 (let ((count 0))
32291 (while (> n 0)
32292 (setq count (+ count (logand n 1))
32293 n (lsh n -1)))
32294 count))
32295 @end smallexample
32296
32297 @noindent
32298 Note that the second function uses @code{defun}, not @code{defmath}.
32299 Because this function deals only with native Lisp integers (``fixnums''),
32300 it can use the actual Emacs @code{+} and related functions rather
32301 than the slower but more general Calc equivalents which @code{defmath}
32302 uses.
32303
32304 The @code{idivmod} function does an integer division, returning both
32305 the quotient and the remainder at once. Again, note that while it
32306 might seem that @samp{(logand n 511)} and @samp{(lsh n -9)} are
32307 more efficient ways to split off the bottom nine bits of @code{n},
32308 actually they are less efficient because each operation is really
32309 a division by 512 in disguise; @code{idivmod} allows us to do the
32310 same thing with a single division by 512.
32311
32312 @node Sine Example, , Bit Counting Example, Example Definitions
32313 @subsubsection The Sine Function
32314
32315 @noindent
32316 @ignore
32317 @starindex
32318 @end ignore
32319 @tindex mysin
32320 A somewhat limited sine function could be defined as follows, using the
32321 well-known Taylor series expansion for
32322 @texline @math{\sin x}:
32323 @infoline @samp{sin(x)}:
32324
32325 @smallexample
32326 (defmath mysin ((float (anglep x)))
32327 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32328 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32329 (let ((sum x) ; Initial term of Taylor expansion of sin.
32330 newsum
32331 (nfact 1) ; "nfact" equals "n" factorial at all times.
32332 (xnegsqr :"-(x^2)")) ; "xnegsqr" equals -x^2.
32333 (for ((n 3 100 2)) ; Upper limit of 100 is a good precaution.
32334 (working "mysin" sum) ; Display "Working" message, if enabled.
32335 (setq nfact (* nfact (1- n) n)
32336 x (* x xnegsqr)
32337 newsum (+ sum (/ x nfact)))
32338 (if (~= newsum sum) ; If newsum is "nearly equal to" sum,
32339 (break)) ; then we are done.
32340 (setq sum newsum))
32341 sum))
32342 @end smallexample
32343
32344 The actual @code{sin} function in Calc works by first reducing the problem
32345 to a sine or cosine of a nonnegative number less than @cpiover{4}. This
32346 ensures that the Taylor series will converge quickly. Also, the calculation
32347 is carried out with two extra digits of precision to guard against cumulative
32348 round-off in @samp{sum}. Finally, complex arguments are allowed and handled
32349 by a separate algorithm.
32350
32351 @smallexample
32352 (defmath mysin ((float (scalarp x)))
32353 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32354 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32355 (with-extra-prec 2 ; Evaluate with extra precision.
32356 (cond ((complexp x)
32357 (mysin-complex x))
32358 ((< x 0)
32359 (- (mysin-raw (- x))) ; Always call mysin-raw with x >= 0.
32360 (t (mysin-raw x))))))
32361
32362 (defmath mysin-raw (x)
32363 (cond ((>= x 7)
32364 (mysin-raw (% x (two-pi)))) ; Now x < 7.
32365 ((> x (pi-over-2))
32366 (- (mysin-raw (- x (pi))))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/2.
32367 ((> x (pi-over-4))
32368 (mycos-raw (- x (pi-over-2)))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/4.
32369 ((< x (- (pi-over-4)))
32370 (- (mycos-raw (+ x (pi-over-2))))) ; Now -pi/4 <= x <= pi/4,
32371 (t (mysin-series x)))) ; so the series will be efficient.
32372 @end smallexample
32373
32374 @noindent
32375 where @code{mysin-complex} is an appropriate function to handle complex
32376 numbers, @code{mysin-series} is the routine to compute the sine Taylor
32377 series as before, and @code{mycos-raw} is a function analogous to
32378 @code{mysin-raw} for cosines.
32379
32380 The strategy is to ensure that @expr{x} is nonnegative before calling
32381 @code{mysin-raw}. This function then recursively reduces its argument
32382 to a suitable range, namely, plus-or-minus @cpiover{4}. Note that each
32383 test, and particularly the first comparison against 7, is designed so
32384 that small roundoff errors cannot produce an infinite loop. (Suppose
32385 we compared with @samp{(two-pi)} instead; if due to roundoff problems
32386 the modulo operator ever returned @samp{(two-pi)} exactly, an infinite
32387 recursion could result!) We use modulo only for arguments that will
32388 clearly get reduced, knowing that the next rule will catch any reductions
32389 that this rule misses.
32390
32391 If a program is being written for general use, it is important to code
32392 it carefully as shown in this second example. For quick-and-dirty programs,
32393 when you know that your own use of the sine function will never encounter
32394 a large argument, a simpler program like the first one shown is fine.
32395
32396 @node Calling Calc from Your Programs, Internals, Example Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32397 @subsection Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs
32398
32399 @noindent
32400 A later section (@pxref{Internals}) gives a full description of
32401 Calc's internal Lisp functions. It's not hard to call Calc from
32402 inside your programs, but the number of these functions can be daunting.
32403 So Calc provides one special ``programmer-friendly'' function called
32404 @code{calc-eval} that can be made to do just about everything you
32405 need. It's not as fast as the low-level Calc functions, but it's
32406 much simpler to use!
32407
32408 It may seem that @code{calc-eval} itself has a daunting number of
32409 options, but they all stem from one simple operation.
32410
32411 In its simplest manifestation, @samp{(calc-eval "1+2")} parses the
32412 string @code{"1+2"} as if it were a Calc algebraic entry and returns
32413 the result formatted as a string: @code{"3"}.
32414
32415 Since @code{calc-eval} is on the list of recommended @code{autoload}
32416 functions, you don't need to make any special preparations to load
32417 Calc before calling @code{calc-eval} the first time. Calc will be
32418 loaded and initialized for you.
32419
32420 All the Calc modes that are currently in effect will be used when
32421 evaluating the expression and formatting the result.
32422
32423 @ifinfo
32424 @example
32425
32426 @end example
32427 @end ifinfo
32428 @subsubsection Additional Arguments to @code{calc-eval}
32429
32430 @noindent
32431 If the input string parses to a list of expressions, Calc returns
32432 the results separated by @code{", "}. You can specify a different
32433 separator by giving a second string argument to @code{calc-eval}:
32434 @samp{(calc-eval "1+2,3+4" ";")} returns @code{"3;7"}.
32435
32436 The ``separator'' can also be any of several Lisp symbols which
32437 request other behaviors from @code{calc-eval}. These are discussed
32438 one by one below.
32439
32440 You can give additional arguments to be substituted for
32441 @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, and so on in the main expression. For
32442 example, @samp{(calc-eval "$/$$" nil "7" "1+1")} evaluates the
32443 expression @code{"7/(1+1)"} to yield the result @code{"3.5"}
32444 (assuming Fraction mode is not in effect). Note the @code{nil}
32445 used as a placeholder for the item-separator argument.
32446
32447 @ifinfo
32448 @example
32449
32450 @end example
32451 @end ifinfo
32452 @subsubsection Error Handling
32453
32454 @noindent
32455 If @code{calc-eval} encounters an error, it returns a list containing
32456 the character position of the error, plus a suitable message as a
32457 string. Note that @samp{1 / 0} is @emph{not} an error by Calc's
32458 standards; it simply returns the string @code{"1 / 0"} which is the
32459 division left in symbolic form. But @samp{(calc-eval "1/")} will
32460 return the list @samp{(2 "Expected a number")}.
32461
32462 If you bind the variable @code{calc-eval-error} to @code{t}
32463 using a @code{let} form surrounding the call to @code{calc-eval},
32464 errors instead call the Emacs @code{error} function which aborts
32465 to the Emacs command loop with a beep and an error message.
32466
32467 If you bind this variable to the symbol @code{string}, error messages
32468 are returned as strings instead of lists. The character position is
32469 ignored.
32470
32471 As a courtesy to other Lisp code which may be using Calc, be sure
32472 to bind @code{calc-eval-error} using @code{let} rather than changing
32473 it permanently with @code{setq}.
32474
32475 @ifinfo
32476 @example
32477
32478 @end example
32479 @end ifinfo
32480 @subsubsection Numbers Only
32481
32482 @noindent
32483 Sometimes it is preferable to treat @samp{1 / 0} as an error
32484 rather than returning a symbolic result. If you pass the symbol
32485 @code{num} as the second argument to @code{calc-eval}, results
32486 that are not constants are treated as errors. The error message
32487 reported is the first @code{calc-why} message if there is one,
32488 or otherwise ``Number expected.''
32489
32490 A result is ``constant'' if it is a number, vector, or other
32491 object that does not include variables or function calls. If it
32492 is a vector, the components must themselves be constants.
32493
32494 @ifinfo
32495 @example
32496
32497 @end example
32498 @end ifinfo
32499 @subsubsection Default Modes
32500
32501 @noindent
32502 If the first argument to @code{calc-eval} is a list whose first
32503 element is a formula string, then @code{calc-eval} sets all the
32504 various Calc modes to their default values while the formula is
32505 evaluated and formatted. For example, the precision is set to 12
32506 digits, digit grouping is turned off, and the Normal language
32507 mode is used.
32508
32509 This same principle applies to the other options discussed below.
32510 If the first argument would normally be @var{x}, then it can also
32511 be the list @samp{(@var{x})} to use the default mode settings.
32512
32513 If there are other elements in the list, they are taken as
32514 variable-name/value pairs which override the default mode
32515 settings. Look at the documentation at the front of the
32516 @file{calc.el} file to find the names of the Lisp variables for
32517 the various modes. The mode settings are restored to their
32518 original values when @code{calc-eval} is done.
32519
32520 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '("$+$$" calc-internal-prec 8) 'num a b)}
32521 computes the sum of two numbers, requiring a numeric result, and
32522 using default mode settings except that the precision is 8 instead
32523 of the default of 12.
32524
32525 It's usually best to use this form of @code{calc-eval} unless your
32526 program actually considers the interaction with Calc's mode settings
32527 to be a feature. This will avoid all sorts of potential ``gotchas'';
32528 consider what happens with @samp{(calc-eval "sqrt(2)" 'num)}
32529 when the user has left Calc in Symbolic mode or No-Simplify mode.
32530
32531 As another example, @samp{(equal (calc-eval '("$<$$") nil a b) "1")}
32532 checks if the number in string @expr{a} is less than the one in
32533 string @expr{b}. Without using a list, the integer 1 might
32534 come out in a variety of formats which would be hard to test for
32535 conveniently: @code{"1"}, @code{"8#1"}, @code{"00001"}. (But
32536 see ``Predicates'' mode, below.)
32537
32538 @ifinfo
32539 @example
32540
32541 @end example
32542 @end ifinfo
32543 @subsubsection Raw Numbers
32544
32545 @noindent
32546 Normally all input and output for @code{calc-eval} is done with strings.
32547 You can do arithmetic with, say, @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" nil a b)}
32548 in place of @samp{(+ a b)}, but this is very inefficient since the
32549 numbers must be converted to and from string format as they are passed
32550 from one @code{calc-eval} to the next.
32551
32552 If the separator is the symbol @code{raw}, the result will be returned
32553 as a raw Calc data structure rather than a string. You can read about
32554 how these objects look in the following sections, but usually you can
32555 treat them as ``black box'' objects with no important internal
32556 structure.
32557
32558 There is also a @code{rawnum} symbol, which is a combination of
32559 @code{raw} (returning a raw Calc object) and @code{num} (signaling
32560 an error if that object is not a constant).
32561
32562 You can pass a raw Calc object to @code{calc-eval} in place of a
32563 string, either as the formula itself or as one of the @samp{$}
32564 arguments. Thus @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" 'raw a b)} is an
32565 addition function that operates on raw Calc objects. Of course
32566 in this case it would be easier to call the low-level @code{math-add}
32567 function in Calc, if you can remember its name.
32568
32569 In particular, note that a plain Lisp integer is acceptable to Calc
32570 as a raw object. (All Lisp integers are accepted on input, but
32571 integers of more than six decimal digits are converted to ``big-integer''
32572 form for output. @xref{Data Type Formats}.)
32573
32574 When it comes time to display the object, just use @samp{(calc-eval a)}
32575 to format it as a string.
32576
32577 It is an error if the input expression evaluates to a list of
32578 values. The separator symbol @code{list} is like @code{raw}
32579 except that it returns a list of one or more raw Calc objects.
32580
32581 Note that a Lisp string is not a valid Calc object, nor is a list
32582 containing a string. Thus you can still safely distinguish all the
32583 various kinds of error returns discussed above.
32584
32585 @ifinfo
32586 @example
32587
32588 @end example
32589 @end ifinfo
32590 @subsubsection Predicates
32591
32592 @noindent
32593 If the separator symbol is @code{pred}, the result of the formula is
32594 treated as a true/false value; @code{calc-eval} returns @code{t} or
32595 @code{nil}, respectively. A value is considered ``true'' if it is a
32596 non-zero number, or false if it is zero or if it is not a number.
32597
32598 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "$<$$" 'pred a b)} tests whether
32599 one value is less than another.
32600
32601 As usual, it is also possible for @code{calc-eval} to return one of
32602 the error indicators described above. Lisp will interpret such an
32603 indicator as ``true'' if you don't check for it explicitly. If you
32604 wish to have an error register as ``false'', use something like
32605 @samp{(eq (calc-eval ...) t)}.
32606
32607 @ifinfo
32608 @example
32609
32610 @end example
32611 @end ifinfo
32612 @subsubsection Variable Values
32613
32614 @noindent
32615 Variables in the formula passed to @code{calc-eval} are not normally
32616 replaced by their values. If you wish this, you can use the
32617 @code{evalv} function (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}). For example,
32618 if 4 is stored in Calc variable @code{a} (i.e., in Lisp variable
32619 @code{var-a}), then @samp{(calc-eval "a+pi")} will return the
32620 formula @code{"a + pi"}, but @samp{(calc-eval "evalv(a+pi)")}
32621 will return @code{"7.14159265359"}.
32622
32623 To store in a Calc variable, just use @code{setq} to store in the
32624 corresponding Lisp variable. (This is obtained by prepending
32625 @samp{var-} to the Calc variable name.) Calc routines will
32626 understand either string or raw form values stored in variables,
32627 although raw data objects are much more efficient. For example,
32628 to increment the Calc variable @code{a}:
32629
32630 @example
32631 (setq var-a (calc-eval "evalv(a+1)" 'raw))
32632 @end example
32633
32634 @ifinfo
32635 @example
32636
32637 @end example
32638 @end ifinfo
32639 @subsubsection Stack Access
32640
32641 @noindent
32642 If the separator symbol is @code{push}, the formula argument is
32643 evaluated (with possible @samp{$} expansions, as usual). The
32644 result is pushed onto the Calc stack. The return value is @code{nil}
32645 (unless there is an error from evaluating the formula, in which
32646 case the return value depends on @code{calc-eval-error} in the
32647 usual way).
32648
32649 If the separator symbol is @code{pop}, the first argument to
32650 @code{calc-eval} must be an integer instead of a string. That
32651 many values are popped from the stack and thrown away. A negative
32652 argument deletes the entry at that stack level. The return value
32653 is the number of elements remaining in the stack after popping;
32654 @samp{(calc-eval 0 'pop)} is a good way to measure the size of
32655 the stack.
32656
32657 If the separator symbol is @code{top}, the first argument to
32658 @code{calc-eval} must again be an integer. The value at that
32659 stack level is formatted as a string and returned. Thus
32660 @samp{(calc-eval 1 'top)} returns the top-of-stack value. If the
32661 integer is out of range, @code{nil} is returned.
32662
32663 The separator symbol @code{rawtop} is just like @code{top} except
32664 that the stack entry is returned as a raw Calc object instead of
32665 as a string.
32666
32667 In all of these cases the first argument can be made a list in
32668 order to force the default mode settings, as described above.
32669 Thus @samp{(calc-eval '(2 calc-number-radix 16) 'top)} returns the
32670 second-to-top stack entry, formatted as a string using the default
32671 instead of current display modes, except that the radix is
32672 hexadecimal instead of decimal.
32673
32674 It is, of course, polite to put the Calc stack back the way you
32675 found it when you are done, unless the user of your program is
32676 actually expecting it to affect the stack.
32677
32678 Note that you do not actually have to switch into the @samp{*Calculator*}
32679 buffer in order to use @code{calc-eval}; it temporarily switches into
32680 the stack buffer if necessary.
32681
32682 @ifinfo
32683 @example
32684
32685 @end example
32686 @end ifinfo
32687 @subsubsection Keyboard Macros
32688
32689 @noindent
32690 If the separator symbol is @code{macro}, the first argument must be a
32691 string of characters which Calc can execute as a sequence of keystrokes.
32692 This switches into the Calc buffer for the duration of the macro.
32693 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "vx5\rVR+" 'macro)} pushes the
32694 vector @samp{[1,2,3,4,5]} on the stack and then replaces it
32695 with the sum of those numbers. Note that @samp{\r} is the Lisp
32696 notation for the carriage-return, @key{RET}, character.
32697
32698 If your keyboard macro wishes to pop the stack, @samp{\C-d} is
32699 safer than @samp{\177} (the @key{DEL} character) because some
32700 installations may have switched the meanings of @key{DEL} and
32701 @kbd{C-h}. Calc always interprets @kbd{C-d} as a synonym for
32702 ``pop-stack'' regardless of key mapping.
32703
32704 If you provide a third argument to @code{calc-eval}, evaluation
32705 of the keyboard macro will leave a record in the Trail using
32706 that argument as a tag string. Normally the Trail is unaffected.
32707
32708 The return value in this case is always @code{nil}.
32709
32710 @ifinfo
32711 @example
32712
32713 @end example
32714 @end ifinfo
32715 @subsubsection Lisp Evaluation
32716
32717 @noindent
32718 Finally, if the separator symbol is @code{eval}, then the Lisp
32719 @code{eval} function is called on the first argument, which must
32720 be a Lisp expression rather than a Calc formula. Remember to
32721 quote the expression so that it is not evaluated until inside
32722 @code{calc-eval}.
32723
32724 The difference from plain @code{eval} is that @code{calc-eval}
32725 switches to the Calc buffer before evaluating the expression.
32726 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '(setq calc-internal-prec 17) 'eval)}
32727 will correctly affect the buffer-local Calc precision variable.
32728
32729 An alternative would be @samp{(calc-eval '(calc-precision 17) 'eval)}.
32730 This is evaluating a call to the function that is normally invoked
32731 by the @kbd{p} key, giving it 17 as its ``numeric prefix argument.''
32732 Note that this function will leave a message in the echo area as
32733 a side effect. Also, all Calc functions switch to the Calc buffer
32734 automatically if not invoked from there, so the above call is
32735 also equivalent to @samp{(calc-precision 17)} by itself.
32736 In all cases, Calc uses @code{save-excursion} to switch back to
32737 your original buffer when it is done.
32738
32739 As usual the first argument can be a list that begins with a Lisp
32740 expression to use default instead of current mode settings.
32741
32742 The result of @code{calc-eval} in this usage is just the result
32743 returned by the evaluated Lisp expression.
32744
32745 @ifinfo
32746 @example
32747
32748 @end example
32749 @end ifinfo
32750 @subsubsection Example
32751
32752 @noindent
32753 @findex convert-temp
32754 Here is a sample Emacs command that uses @code{calc-eval}. Suppose
32755 you have a document with lots of references to temperatures on the
32756 Fahrenheit scale, say ``98.6 F'', and you wish to convert these
32757 references to Centigrade. The following command does this conversion.
32758 Place the Emacs cursor right after the letter ``F'' and invoke the
32759 command to change ``98.6 F'' to ``37 C''. Or, if the temperature is
32760 already in Centigrade form, the command changes it back to Fahrenheit.
32761
32762 @example
32763 (defun convert-temp ()
32764 (interactive)
32765 (save-excursion
32766 (re-search-backward "[^-.0-9]\\([-.0-9]+\\) *\\([FC]\\)")
32767 (let* ((top1 (match-beginning 1))
32768 (bot1 (match-end 1))
32769 (number (buffer-substring top1 bot1))
32770 (top2 (match-beginning 2))
32771 (bot2 (match-end 2))
32772 (type (buffer-substring top2 bot2)))
32773 (if (equal type "F")
32774 (setq type "C"
32775 number (calc-eval "($ - 32)*5/9" nil number))
32776 (setq type "F"
32777 number (calc-eval "$*9/5 + 32" nil number)))
32778 (goto-char top2)
32779 (delete-region top2 bot2)
32780 (insert-before-markers type)
32781 (goto-char top1)
32782 (delete-region top1 bot1)
32783 (if (string-match "\\.$" number) ; change "37." to "37"
32784 (setq number (substring number 0 -1)))
32785 (insert number))))
32786 @end example
32787
32788 Note the use of @code{insert-before-markers} when changing between
32789 ``F'' and ``C'', so that the character winds up before the cursor
32790 instead of after it.
32791
32792 @node Internals, , Calling Calc from Your Programs, Lisp Definitions
32793 @subsection Calculator Internals
32794
32795 @noindent
32796 This section describes the Lisp functions defined by the Calculator that
32797 may be of use to user-written Calculator programs (as described in the
32798 rest of this chapter). These functions are shown by their names as they
32799 conventionally appear in @code{defmath}. Their full Lisp names are
32800 generally gotten by prepending @samp{calcFunc-} or @samp{math-} to their
32801 apparent names. (Names that begin with @samp{calc-} are already in
32802 their full Lisp form.) You can use the actual full names instead if you
32803 prefer them, or if you are calling these functions from regular Lisp.
32804
32805 The functions described here are scattered throughout the various
32806 Calc component files. Note that @file{calc.el} includes @code{autoload}s
32807 for only a few component files; when Calc wants to call an advanced
32808 function it calls @samp{(calc-extensions)} first; this function
32809 autoloads @file{calc-ext.el}, which in turn autoloads all the functions
32810 in the remaining component files.
32811
32812 Because @code{defmath} itself uses the extensions, user-written code
32813 generally always executes with the extensions already loaded, so
32814 normally you can use any Calc function and be confident that it will
32815 be autoloaded for you when necessary. If you are doing something
32816 special, check carefully to make sure each function you are using is
32817 from @file{calc.el} or its components, and call @samp{(calc-extensions)}
32818 before using any function based in @file{calc-ext.el} if you can't
32819 prove this file will already be loaded.
32820
32821 @menu
32822 * Data Type Formats::
32823 * Interactive Lisp Functions::
32824 * Stack Lisp Functions::
32825 * Predicates::
32826 * Computational Lisp Functions::
32827 * Vector Lisp Functions::
32828 * Symbolic Lisp Functions::
32829 * Formatting Lisp Functions::
32830 * Hooks::
32831 @end menu
32832
32833 @node Data Type Formats, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals, Internals
32834 @subsubsection Data Type Formats
32835
32836 @noindent
32837 Integers are stored in either of two ways, depending on their magnitude.
32838 Integers less than one million in absolute value are stored as standard
32839 Lisp integers. This is the only storage format for Calc data objects
32840 which is not a Lisp list.
32841
32842 Large integers are stored as lists of the form @samp{(bigpos @var{d0}
32843 @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for positive integers 1000000 or more, or
32844 @samp{(bigneg @var{d0} @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for negative integers
32845 @mathit{-1000000} or less. Each @var{d} is a base-1000 ``digit,'' a Lisp integer
32846 from 0 to 999. The least significant digit is @var{d0}; the last digit,
32847 @var{dn}, which is always nonzero, is the most significant digit. For
32848 example, the integer @mathit{-12345678} is stored as @samp{(bigneg 678 345 12)}.
32849
32850 The distinction between small and large integers is entirely hidden from
32851 the user. In @code{defmath} definitions, the Lisp predicate @code{integerp}
32852 returns true for either kind of integer, and in general both big and small
32853 integers are accepted anywhere the word ``integer'' is used in this manual.
32854 If the distinction must be made, native Lisp integers are called @dfn{fixnums}
32855 and large integers are called @dfn{bignums}.
32856
32857 Fractions are stored as a list of the form, @samp{(frac @var{n} @var{d})}
32858 where @var{n} is an integer (big or small) numerator, @var{d} is an
32859 integer denominator greater than one, and @var{n} and @var{d} are relatively
32860 prime. Note that fractions where @var{d} is one are automatically converted
32861 to plain integers by all math routines; fractions where @var{d} is negative
32862 are normalized by negating the numerator and denominator.
32863
32864 Floating-point numbers are stored in the form, @samp{(float @var{mant}
32865 @var{exp})}, where @var{mant} (the ``mantissa'') is an integer less than
32866 @samp{10^@var{p}} in absolute value (@var{p} represents the current
32867 precision), and @var{exp} (the ``exponent'') is a fixnum. The value of
32868 the float is @samp{@var{mant} * 10^@var{exp}}. For example, the number
32869 @mathit{-3.14} is stored as @samp{(float -314 -2) = -314*10^-2}. Other constraints
32870 are that the number 0.0 is always stored as @samp{(float 0 0)}, and,
32871 except for the 0.0 case, the rightmost base-10 digit of @var{mant} is
32872 always nonzero. (If the rightmost digit is zero, the number is
32873 rearranged by dividing @var{mant} by ten and incrementing @var{exp}.)
32874
32875 Rectangular complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(cplx @var{re}
32876 @var{im})}, where @var{re} and @var{im} are each real numbers, either
32877 integers, fractions, or floats. The value is @samp{@var{re} + @var{im}i}.
32878 The @var{im} part is nonzero; complex numbers with zero imaginary
32879 components are converted to real numbers automatically.
32880
32881 Polar complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(polar @var{r}
32882 @var{theta})}, where @var{r} is a positive real value and @var{theta}
32883 is a real value or HMS form representing an angle. This angle is
32884 usually normalized to lie in the interval @samp{(-180 ..@: 180)} degrees,
32885 or @samp{(-pi ..@: pi)} radians, according to the current angular mode.
32886 If the angle is 0 the value is converted to a real number automatically.
32887 (If the angle is 180 degrees, the value is usually also converted to a
32888 negative real number.)
32889
32890 Hours-minutes-seconds forms are stored as @samp{(hms @var{h} @var{m}
32891 @var{s})}, where @var{h} is an integer or an integer-valued float (i.e.,
32892 a float with @samp{@var{exp} >= 0}), @var{m} is an integer or integer-valued
32893 float in the range @w{@samp{[0 ..@: 60)}}, and @var{s} is any real number
32894 in the range @samp{[0 ..@: 60)}.
32895
32896 Date forms are stored as @samp{(date @var{n})}, where @var{n} is
32897 a real number that counts days since midnight on the morning of
32898 January 1, 1 AD. If @var{n} is an integer, this is a pure date
32899 form. If @var{n} is a fraction or float, this is a date/time form.
32900
32901 Modulo forms are stored as @samp{(mod @var{n} @var{m})}, where @var{m} is a
32902 positive real number or HMS form, and @var{n} is a real number or HMS
32903 form in the range @samp{[0 ..@: @var{m})}.
32904
32905 Error forms are stored as @samp{(sdev @var{x} @var{sigma})}, where @var{x}
32906 is the mean value and @var{sigma} is the standard deviation. Each
32907 component is either a number, an HMS form, or a symbolic object
32908 (a variable or function call). If @var{sigma} is zero, the value is
32909 converted to a plain real number. If @var{sigma} is negative or
32910 complex, it is automatically normalized to be a positive real.
32911
32912 Interval forms are stored as @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{lo} @var{hi})},
32913 where @var{mask} is one of the integers 0, 1, 2, or 3, and @var{lo} and
32914 @var{hi} are real numbers, HMS forms, or symbolic objects. The @var{mask}
32915 is a binary integer where 1 represents the fact that the interval is
32916 closed on the high end, and 2 represents the fact that it is closed on
32917 the low end. (Thus 3 represents a fully closed interval.) The interval
32918 @w{@samp{(intv 3 @var{x} @var{x})}} is converted to the plain number @var{x};
32919 intervals @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{x} @var{x})} for any other @var{mask}
32920 represent empty intervals. If @var{hi} is less than @var{lo}, the interval
32921 is converted to a standard empty interval by replacing @var{hi} with @var{lo}.
32922
32923 Vectors are stored as @samp{(vec @var{v1} @var{v2} @dots{})}, where @var{v1}
32924 is the first element of the vector, @var{v2} is the second, and so on.
32925 An empty vector is stored as @samp{(vec)}. A matrix is simply a vector
32926 where all @var{v}'s are themselves vectors of equal lengths. Note that
32927 Calc vectors are unrelated to the Emacs Lisp ``vector'' type, which is
32928 generally unused by Calc data structures.
32929
32930 Variables are stored as @samp{(var @var{name} @var{sym})}, where
32931 @var{name} is a Lisp symbol whose print name is used as the visible name
32932 of the variable, and @var{sym} is a Lisp symbol in which the variable's
32933 value is actually stored. Thus, @samp{(var pi var-pi)} represents the
32934 special constant @samp{pi}. Almost always, the form is @samp{(var
32935 @var{v} var-@var{v})}. If the variable name was entered with @code{#}
32936 signs (which are converted to hyphens internally), the form is
32937 @samp{(var @var{u} @var{v})}, where @var{u} is a symbol whose name
32938 contains @code{#} characters, and @var{v} is a symbol that contains
32939 @code{-} characters instead. The value of a variable is the Calc
32940 object stored in its @var{sym} symbol's value cell. If the symbol's
32941 value cell is void or if it contains @code{nil}, the variable has no
32942 value. Special constants have the form @samp{(special-const
32943 @var{value})} stored in their value cell, where @var{value} is a formula
32944 which is evaluated when the constant's value is requested. Variables
32945 which represent units are not stored in any special way; they are units
32946 only because their names appear in the units table. If the value
32947 cell contains a string, it is parsed to get the variable's value when
32948 the variable is used.
32949
32950 A Lisp list with any other symbol as the first element is a function call.
32951 The symbols @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^},
32952 and @code{|} represent special binary operators; these lists are always
32953 of the form @samp{(@var{op} @var{lhs} @var{rhs})} where @var{lhs} is the
32954 sub-formula on the lefthand side and @var{rhs} is the sub-formula on the
32955 right. The symbol @code{neg} represents unary negation; this list is always
32956 of the form @samp{(neg @var{arg})}. Any other symbol @var{func} represents a
32957 function that would be displayed in function-call notation; the symbol
32958 @var{func} is in general always of the form @samp{calcFunc-@var{name}}.
32959 The function cell of the symbol @var{func} should contain a Lisp function
32960 for evaluating a call to @var{func}. This function is passed the remaining
32961 elements of the list (themselves already evaluated) as arguments; such
32962 functions should return @code{nil} or call @code{reject-arg} to signify
32963 that they should be left in symbolic form, or they should return a Calc
32964 object which represents their value, or a list of such objects if they
32965 wish to return multiple values. (The latter case is allowed only for
32966 functions which are the outer-level call in an expression whose value is
32967 about to be pushed on the stack; this feature is considered obsolete
32968 and is not used by any built-in Calc functions.)
32969
32970 @node Interactive Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Data Type Formats, Internals
32971 @subsubsection Interactive Functions
32972
32973 @noindent
32974 The functions described here are used in implementing interactive Calc
32975 commands. Note that this list is not exhaustive! If there is an
32976 existing command that behaves similarly to the one you want to define,
32977 you may find helpful tricks by checking the source code for that command.
32978
32979 @defun calc-set-command-flag flag
32980 Set the command flag @var{flag}. This is generally a Lisp symbol, but
32981 may in fact be anything. The effect is to add @var{flag} to the list
32982 stored in the variable @code{calc-command-flags}, unless it is already
32983 there. @xref{Defining Simple Commands}.
32984 @end defun
32985
32986 @defun calc-clear-command-flag flag
32987 If @var{flag} appears among the list of currently-set command flags,
32988 remove it from that list.
32989 @end defun
32990
32991 @defun calc-record-undo rec
32992 Add the ``undo record'' @var{rec} to the list of steps to take if the
32993 current operation should need to be undone. Stack push and pop functions
32994 automatically call @code{calc-record-undo}, so the kinds of undo records
32995 you might need to create take the form @samp{(set @var{sym} @var{value})},
32996 which says that the Lisp variable @var{sym} was changed and had previously
32997 contained @var{value}; @samp{(store @var{var} @var{value})} which says that
32998 the Calc variable @var{var} (a string which is the name of the symbol that
32999 contains the variable's value) was stored and its previous value was
33000 @var{value} (either a Calc data object, or @code{nil} if the variable was
33001 previously void); or @samp{(eval @var{undo} @var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})},
33002 which means that to undo requires calling the function @samp{(@var{undo}
33003 @var{args} @dots{})} and, if the undo is later redone, calling
33004 @samp{(@var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})}.
33005 @end defun
33006
33007 @defun calc-record-why msg args
33008 Record the error or warning message @var{msg}, which is normally a string.
33009 This message will be replayed if the user types @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why});
33010 if the message string begins with a @samp{*}, it is considered important
33011 enough to display even if the user doesn't type @kbd{w}. If one or more
33012 @var{args} are present, the displayed message will be of the form,
33013 @samp{@var{msg}: @var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}}, where the arguments are
33014 formatted on the assumption that they are either strings or Calc objects of
33015 some sort. If @var{msg} is a symbol, it is the name of a Calc predicate
33016 (such as @code{integerp} or @code{numvecp}) which the arguments did not
33017 satisfy; it is expanded to a suitable string such as ``Expected an
33018 integer.'' The @code{reject-arg} function calls @code{calc-record-why}
33019 automatically; @pxref{Predicates}.
33020 @end defun
33021
33022 @defun calc-is-inverse
33023 This predicate returns true if the current command is inverse,
33024 i.e., if the Inverse (@kbd{I} key) flag was set.
33025 @end defun
33026
33027 @defun calc-is-hyperbolic
33028 This predicate is the analogous function for the @kbd{H} key.
33029 @end defun
33030
33031 @node Stack Lisp Functions, Predicates, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals
33032 @subsubsection Stack-Oriented Functions
33033
33034 @noindent
33035 The functions described here perform various operations on the Calc
33036 stack and trail. They are to be used in interactive Calc commands.
33037
33038 @defun calc-push-list vals n
33039 Push the Calc objects in list @var{vals} onto the stack at stack level
33040 @var{n}. If @var{n} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements
33041 are pushed at the top of the stack. If @var{n} is greater than 1, the
33042 elements will be inserted into the stack so that the last element will
33043 end up at level @var{n}, the next-to-last at level @var{n}+1, etc.
33044 The elements of @var{vals} are assumed to be valid Calc objects, and
33045 are not evaluated, rounded, or renormalized in any way. If @var{vals}
33046 is an empty list, nothing happens.
33047
33048 The stack elements are pushed without any sub-formula selections.
33049 You can give an optional third argument to this function, which must
33050 be a list the same size as @var{vals} of selections. Each selection
33051 must be @code{eq} to some sub-formula of the corresponding formula
33052 in @var{vals}, or @code{nil} if that formula should have no selection.
33053 @end defun
33054
33055 @defun calc-top-list n m
33056 Return a list of the @var{n} objects starting at level @var{m} of the
33057 stack. If @var{m} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements are
33058 taken from the top of the stack. If @var{n} is omitted, it also
33059 defaults to 1, so that the top stack element (in the form of a
33060 one-element list) is returned. If @var{m} is greater than 1, the
33061 @var{m}th stack element will be at the end of the list, the @var{m}+1st
33062 element will be next-to-last, etc. If @var{n} or @var{m} are out of
33063 range, the command is aborted with a suitable error message. If @var{n}
33064 is zero, the function returns an empty list. The stack elements are not
33065 evaluated, rounded, or renormalized.
33066
33067 If any stack elements contain selections, and selections have not
33068 been disabled by the @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command,
33069 this function returns the selected portions rather than the entire
33070 stack elements. It can be given a third ``selection-mode'' argument
33071 which selects other behaviors. If it is the symbol @code{t}, then
33072 a selection in any of the requested stack elements produces an
33073 ``invalid operation on selections'' error. If it is the symbol @code{full},
33074 the whole stack entry is always returned regardless of selections.
33075 If it is the symbol @code{sel}, the selected portion is always returned,
33076 or @code{nil} if there is no selection. (This mode ignores the @kbd{j e}
33077 command.) If the symbol is @code{entry}, the complete stack entry in
33078 list form is returned; the first element of this list will be the whole
33079 formula, and the third element will be the selection (or @code{nil}).
33080 @end defun
33081
33082 @defun calc-pop-stack n m
33083 Remove the specified elements from the stack. The parameters @var{n}
33084 and @var{m} are defined the same as for @code{calc-top-list}. The return
33085 value of @code{calc-pop-stack} is uninteresting.
33086
33087 If there are any selected sub-formulas among the popped elements, and
33088 @kbd{j e} has not been used to disable selections, this produces an
33089 error without changing the stack. If you supply an optional third
33090 argument of @code{t}, the stack elements are popped even if they
33091 contain selections.
33092 @end defun
33093
33094 @defun calc-record-list vals tag
33095 This function records one or more results in the trail. The @var{vals}
33096 are a list of strings or Calc objects. The @var{tag} is the four-character
33097 tag string to identify the values. If @var{tag} is omitted, a blank tag
33098 will be used.
33099 @end defun
33100
33101 @defun calc-normalize n
33102 This function takes a Calc object and ``normalizes'' it. At the very
33103 least this involves re-rounding floating-point values according to the
33104 current precision and other similar jobs. Also, unless the user has
33105 selected No-Simplify mode (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), this involves
33106 actually evaluating a formula object by executing the function calls
33107 it contains, and possibly also doing algebraic simplification, etc.
33108 @end defun
33109
33110 @defun calc-top-list-n n m
33111 This function is identical to @code{calc-top-list}, except that it calls
33112 @code{calc-normalize} on the values that it takes from the stack. They
33113 are also passed through @code{check-complete}, so that incomplete
33114 objects will be rejected with an error message. All computational
33115 commands should use this in preference to @code{calc-top-list}; the only
33116 standard Calc commands that operate on the stack without normalizing
33117 are stack management commands like @code{calc-enter} and @code{calc-roll-up}.
33118 This function accepts the same optional selection-mode argument as
33119 @code{calc-top-list}.
33120 @end defun
33121
33122 @defun calc-top-n m
33123 This function is a convenient form of @code{calc-top-list-n} in which only
33124 a single element of the stack is taken and returned, rather than a list
33125 of elements. This also accepts an optional selection-mode argument.
33126 @end defun
33127
33128 @defun calc-enter-result n tag vals
33129 This function is a convenient interface to most of the above functions.
33130 The @var{vals} argument should be either a single Calc object, or a list
33131 of Calc objects; the object or objects are normalized, and the top @var{n}
33132 stack entries are replaced by the normalized objects. If @var{tag} is
33133 non-@code{nil}, the normalized objects are also recorded in the trail.
33134 A typical stack-based computational command would take the form,
33135
33136 @smallexample
33137 (calc-enter-result @var{n} @var{tag} (cons 'calcFunc-@var{func}
33138 (calc-top-list-n @var{n})))
33139 @end smallexample
33140
33141 If any of the @var{n} stack elements replaced contain sub-formula
33142 selections, and selections have not been disabled by @kbd{j e},
33143 this function takes one of two courses of action. If @var{n} is
33144 equal to the number of elements in @var{vals}, then each element of
33145 @var{vals} is spliced into the corresponding selection; this is what
33146 happens when you use the @key{TAB} key, or when you use a unary
33147 arithmetic operation like @code{sqrt}. If @var{vals} has only one
33148 element but @var{n} is greater than one, there must be only one
33149 selection among the top @var{n} stack elements; the element from
33150 @var{vals} is spliced into that selection. This is what happens when
33151 you use a binary arithmetic operation like @kbd{+}. Any other
33152 combination of @var{n} and @var{vals} is an error when selections
33153 are present.
33154 @end defun
33155
33156 @defun calc-unary-op tag func arg
33157 This function implements a unary operator that allows a numeric prefix
33158 argument to apply the operator over many stack entries. If the prefix
33159 argument @var{arg} is @code{nil}, this uses @code{calc-enter-result}
33160 as outlined above. Otherwise, it maps the function over several stack
33161 elements; @pxref{Prefix Arguments}. For example,
33162
33163 @smallexample
33164 (defun calc-zeta (arg)
33165 (interactive "P")
33166 (calc-unary-op "zeta" 'calcFunc-zeta arg))
33167 @end smallexample
33168 @end defun
33169
33170 @defun calc-binary-op tag func arg ident unary
33171 This function implements a binary operator, analogously to
33172 @code{calc-unary-op}. The optional @var{ident} and @var{unary}
33173 arguments specify the behavior when the prefix argument is zero or
33174 one, respectively. If the prefix is zero, the value @var{ident}
33175 is pushed onto the stack, if specified, otherwise an error message
33176 is displayed. If the prefix is one, the unary function @var{unary}
33177 is applied to the top stack element, or, if @var{unary} is not
33178 specified, nothing happens. When the argument is two or more,
33179 the binary function @var{func} is reduced across the top @var{arg}
33180 stack elements; when the argument is negative, the function is
33181 mapped between the next-to-top @mathit{-@var{arg}} stack elements and the
33182 top element.
33183 @end defun
33184
33185 @defun calc-stack-size
33186 Return the number of elements on the stack as an integer. This count
33187 does not include elements that have been temporarily hidden by stack
33188 truncation; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
33189 @end defun
33190
33191 @defun calc-cursor-stack-index n
33192 Move the point to the @var{n}th stack entry. If @var{n} is zero, this
33193 will be the @samp{.} line. If @var{n} is from 1 to the current stack size,
33194 this will be the beginning of the first line of that stack entry's display.
33195 If line numbers are enabled, this will move to the first character of the
33196 line number, not the stack entry itself.
33197 @end defun
33198
33199 @defun calc-substack-height n
33200 Return the number of lines between the beginning of the @var{n}th stack
33201 entry and the bottom of the buffer. If @var{n} is zero, this
33202 will be one (assuming no stack truncation). If all stack entries are
33203 one line long (i.e., no matrices are displayed), the return value will
33204 be equal @var{n}+1 as long as @var{n} is in range. (Note that in Big
33205 mode, the return value includes the blank lines that separate stack
33206 entries.)
33207 @end defun
33208
33209 @defun calc-refresh
33210 Erase the @code{*Calculator*} buffer and reformat its contents from memory.
33211 This must be called after changing any parameter, such as the current
33212 display radix, which might change the appearance of existing stack
33213 entries. (During a keyboard macro invoked by the @kbd{X} key, refreshing
33214 is suppressed, but a flag is set so that the entire stack will be refreshed
33215 rather than just the top few elements when the macro finishes.)
33216 @end defun
33217
33218 @node Predicates, Computational Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Internals
33219 @subsubsection Predicates
33220
33221 @noindent
33222 The functions described here are predicates, that is, they return a
33223 true/false value where @code{nil} means false and anything else means
33224 true. These predicates are expanded by @code{defmath}, for example,
33225 from @code{zerop} to @code{math-zerop}. In many cases they correspond
33226 to native Lisp functions by the same name, but are extended to cover
33227 the full range of Calc data types.
33228
33229 @defun zerop x
33230 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically zero, in any of the Calc data
33231 types. (Note that for some types, such as error forms and intervals,
33232 it never makes sense to return true.) In @code{defmath}, the expression
33233 @samp{(= x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-zerop x)},
33234 and @samp{(/= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-zerop x))}.
33235 @end defun
33236
33237 @defun negp x
33238 Returns true if @var{x} is negative. This accepts negative real numbers
33239 of various types, negative HMS and date forms, and intervals in which
33240 all included values are negative. In @code{defmath}, the expression
33241 @samp{(< x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-negp x)},
33242 and @samp{(>= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-negp x))}.
33243 @end defun
33244
33245 @defun posp x
33246 Returns true if @var{x} is positive (and non-zero). For complex
33247 numbers, none of these three predicates will return true.
33248 @end defun
33249
33250 @defun looks-negp x
33251 Returns true if @var{x} is ``negative-looking.'' This returns true if
33252 @var{x} is a negative number, or a formula with a leading minus sign
33253 such as @samp{-a/b}. In other words, this is an object which can be
33254 made simpler by calling @code{(- @var{x})}.
33255 @end defun
33256
33257 @defun integerp x
33258 Returns true if @var{x} is an integer of any size.
33259 @end defun
33260
33261 @defun fixnump x
33262 Returns true if @var{x} is a native Lisp integer.
33263 @end defun
33264
33265 @defun natnump x
33266 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative integer of any size.
33267 @end defun
33268
33269 @defun fixnatnump x
33270 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative Lisp integer.
33271 @end defun
33272
33273 @defun num-integerp x
33274 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically an integer, i.e., either a
33275 true integer or a float with no significant digits to the right of
33276 the decimal point.
33277 @end defun
33278
33279 @defun messy-integerp x
33280 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically, but not literally, an integer.
33281 A value is @code{num-integerp} if it is @code{integerp} or
33282 @code{messy-integerp} (but it is never both at once).
33283 @end defun
33284
33285 @defun num-natnump x
33286 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically a nonnegative integer.
33287 @end defun
33288
33289 @defun evenp x
33290 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer.
33291 @end defun
33292
33293 @defun looks-evenp x
33294 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer, or a formula with a leading
33295 multiplicative coefficient which is an even integer.
33296 @end defun
33297
33298 @defun oddp x
33299 Returns true if @var{x} is an odd integer.
33300 @end defun
33301
33302 @defun ratp x
33303 Returns true if @var{x} is a rational number, i.e., an integer or a
33304 fraction.
33305 @end defun
33306
33307 @defun realp x
33308 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number, i.e., an integer, fraction,
33309 or floating-point number.
33310 @end defun
33311
33312 @defun anglep x
33313 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or HMS form.
33314 @end defun
33315
33316 @defun floatp x
33317 Returns true if @var{x} is a float, or a complex number, error form,
33318 interval, date form, or modulo form in which at least one component
33319 is a float.
33320 @end defun
33321
33322 @defun complexp x
33323 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular or polar complex number
33324 (but not a real number).
33325 @end defun
33326
33327 @defun rect-complexp x
33328 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular complex number.
33329 @end defun
33330
33331 @defun polar-complexp x
33332 Returns true if @var{x} is a polar complex number.
33333 @end defun
33334
33335 @defun numberp x
33336 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or a complex number.
33337 @end defun
33338
33339 @defun scalarp x
33340 Returns true if @var{x} is a real or complex number or an HMS form.
33341 @end defun
33342
33343 @defun vectorp x
33344 Returns true if @var{x} is a vector (this simply checks if its argument
33345 is a list whose first element is the symbol @code{vec}).
33346 @end defun
33347
33348 @defun numvecp x
33349 Returns true if @var{x} is a number or vector.
33350 @end defun
33351
33352 @defun matrixp x
33353 Returns true if @var{x} is a matrix, i.e., a vector of one or more vectors,
33354 all of the same size.
33355 @end defun
33356
33357 @defun square-matrixp x
33358 Returns true if @var{x} is a square matrix.
33359 @end defun
33360
33361 @defun objectp x
33362 Returns true if @var{x} is any numeric Calc object, including real and
33363 complex numbers, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33364 modulo forms. (Note that error forms and intervals may include formulas
33365 as their components; see @code{constp} below.)
33366 @end defun
33367
33368 @defun objvecp x
33369 Returns true if @var{x} is an object or a vector. This also accepts
33370 incomplete objects, but it rejects variables and formulas (except as
33371 mentioned above for @code{objectp}).
33372 @end defun
33373
33374 @defun primp x
33375 Returns true if @var{x} is a ``primitive'' or ``atomic'' Calc object,
33376 i.e., one whose components cannot be regarded as sub-formulas. This
33377 includes variables, and all @code{objectp} types except error forms
33378 and intervals.
33379 @end defun
33380
33381 @defun constp x
33382 Returns true if @var{x} is constant, i.e., a real or complex number,
33383 HMS form, date form, or error form, interval, or vector all of whose
33384 components are @code{constp}.
33385 @end defun
33386
33387 @defun lessp x y
33388 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically less than @var{y}. Returns false
33389 if @var{x} is greater than or equal to @var{y}, or if the order is
33390 undefined or cannot be determined. Generally speaking, this works
33391 by checking whether @samp{@var{x} - @var{y}} is @code{negp}. In
33392 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(< x y)} will automatically be
33393 converted to @samp{(lessp x y)}; expressions involving @code{>}, @code{<=},
33394 and @code{>=} are similarly converted in terms of @code{lessp}.
33395 @end defun
33396
33397 @defun beforep x y
33398 Returns true if @var{x} comes before @var{y} in a canonical ordering
33399 of Calc objects. If @var{x} and @var{y} are both real numbers, this
33400 will be the same as @code{lessp}. But whereas @code{lessp} considers
33401 other types of objects to be unordered, @code{beforep} puts any two
33402 objects into a definite, consistent order. The @code{beforep}
33403 function is used by the @kbd{V S} vector-sorting command, and also
33404 by @kbd{a s} to put the terms of a product into canonical order:
33405 This allows @samp{x y + y x} to be simplified easily to @samp{2 x y}.
33406 @end defun
33407
33408 @defun equal x y
33409 This is the standard Lisp @code{equal} predicate; it returns true if
33410 @var{x} and @var{y} are structurally identical. This is the usual way
33411 to compare numbers for equality, but note that @code{equal} will treat
33412 0 and 0.0 as different.
33413 @end defun
33414
33415 @defun math-equal x y
33416 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y} are numerically equal, either because
33417 they are @code{equal}, or because their difference is @code{zerop}. In
33418 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(= x y)} will automatically be
33419 converted to @samp{(math-equal x y)}.
33420 @end defun
33421
33422 @defun equal-int x n
33423 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{n} are numerically equal, where @var{n}
33424 is a fixnum which is not a multiple of 10. This will automatically be
33425 used by @code{defmath} in place of the more general @code{math-equal}
33426 whenever possible.
33427 @end defun
33428
33429 @defun nearly-equal x y
33430 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y}, as floating-point numbers, are
33431 equal except possibly in the last decimal place. For example,
33432 314.159 and 314.166 are considered nearly equal if the current
33433 precision is 6 (since they differ by 7 units), but not if the current
33434 precision is 7 (since they differ by 70 units). Most functions which
33435 use series expansions use @code{with-extra-prec} to evaluate the
33436 series with 2 extra digits of precision, then use @code{nearly-equal}
33437 to decide when the series has converged; this guards against cumulative
33438 error in the series evaluation without doing extra work which would be
33439 lost when the result is rounded back down to the current precision.
33440 In @code{defmath}, this can be written @samp{(~= @var{x} @var{y})}.
33441 The @var{x} and @var{y} can be numbers of any kind, including complex.
33442 @end defun
33443
33444 @defun nearly-zerop x y
33445 Returns true if @var{x} is nearly zero, compared to @var{y}. This
33446 checks whether @var{x} plus @var{y} would by be @code{nearly-equal}
33447 to @var{y} itself, to within the current precision, in other words,
33448 if adding @var{x} to @var{y} would have a negligible effect on @var{y}
33449 due to roundoff error. @var{X} may be a real or complex number, but
33450 @var{y} must be real.
33451 @end defun
33452
33453 @defun is-true x
33454 Return true if the formula @var{x} represents a true value in
33455 Calc, not Lisp, terms. It tests if @var{x} is a non-zero number
33456 or a provably non-zero formula.
33457 @end defun
33458
33459 @defun reject-arg val pred
33460 Abort the current function evaluation due to unacceptable argument values.
33461 This calls @samp{(calc-record-why @var{pred} @var{val})}, then signals a
33462 Lisp error which @code{normalize} will trap. The net effect is that the
33463 function call which led here will be left in symbolic form.
33464 @end defun
33465
33466 @defun inexact-value
33467 If Symbolic mode is enabled, this will signal an error that causes
33468 @code{normalize} to leave the formula in symbolic form, with the message
33469 ``Inexact result.'' (This function has no effect when not in Symbolic mode.)
33470 Note that if your function calls @samp{(sin 5)} in Symbolic mode, the
33471 @code{sin} function will call @code{inexact-value}, which will cause your
33472 function to be left unsimplified. You may instead wish to call
33473 @samp{(normalize (list 'calcFunc-sin 5))}, which in Symbolic mode will
33474 return the formula @samp{sin(5)} to your function.
33475 @end defun
33476
33477 @defun overflow
33478 This signals an error that will be reported as a floating-point overflow.
33479 @end defun
33480
33481 @defun underflow
33482 This signals a floating-point underflow.
33483 @end defun
33484
33485 @node Computational Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Predicates, Internals
33486 @subsubsection Computational Functions
33487
33488 @noindent
33489 The functions described here do the actual computational work of the
33490 Calculator. In addition to these, note that any function described in
33491 the main body of this manual may be called from Lisp; for example, if
33492 the documentation refers to the @code{calc-sqrt} [@code{sqrt}] command,
33493 this means @code{calc-sqrt} is an interactive stack-based square-root
33494 command and @code{sqrt} (which @code{defmath} expands to @code{calcFunc-sqrt})
33495 is the actual Lisp function for taking square roots.
33496
33497 The functions @code{math-add}, @code{math-sub}, @code{math-mul},
33498 @code{math-div}, @code{math-mod}, and @code{math-neg} are not included
33499 in this list, since @code{defmath} allows you to write native Lisp
33500 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, and unary @code{-},
33501 respectively, instead.
33502
33503 @defun normalize val
33504 (Full form: @code{math-normalize}.)
33505 Reduce the value @var{val} to standard form. For example, if @var{val}
33506 is a fixnum, it will be converted to a bignum if it is too large, and
33507 if @var{val} is a bignum it will be normalized by clipping off trailing
33508 (i.e., most-significant) zero digits and converting to a fixnum if it is
33509 small. All the various data types are similarly converted to their standard
33510 forms. Variables are left alone, but function calls are actually evaluated
33511 in formulas. For example, normalizing @samp{(+ 2 (calcFunc-abs -4))} will
33512 return 6.
33513
33514 If a function call fails, because the function is void or has the wrong
33515 number of parameters, or because it returns @code{nil} or calls
33516 @code{reject-arg} or @code{inexact-result}, @code{normalize} returns
33517 the formula still in symbolic form.
33518
33519 If the current simplification mode is ``none'' or ``numeric arguments
33520 only,'' @code{normalize} will act appropriately. However, the more
33521 powerful simplification modes (like Algebraic Simplification) are
33522 not handled by @code{normalize}. They are handled by @code{calc-normalize},
33523 which calls @code{normalize} and possibly some other routines, such
33524 as @code{simplify} or @code{simplify-units}. Programs generally will
33525 never call @code{calc-normalize} except when popping or pushing values
33526 on the stack.
33527 @end defun
33528
33529 @defun evaluate-expr expr
33530 Replace all variables in @var{expr} that have values with their values,
33531 then use @code{normalize} to simplify the result. This is what happens
33532 when you press the @kbd{=} key interactively.
33533 @end defun
33534
33535 @defmac with-extra-prec n body
33536 Evaluate the Lisp forms in @var{body} with precision increased by @var{n}
33537 digits. This is a macro which expands to
33538
33539 @smallexample
33540 (math-normalize
33541 (let ((calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec @var{n})))
33542 @var{body}))
33543 @end smallexample
33544
33545 The surrounding call to @code{math-normalize} causes a floating-point
33546 result to be rounded down to the original precision afterwards. This
33547 is important because some arithmetic operations assume a number's
33548 mantissa contains no more digits than the current precision allows.
33549 @end defmac
33550
33551 @defun make-frac n d
33552 Build a fraction @samp{@var{n}:@var{d}}. This is equivalent to calling
33553 @samp{(normalize (list 'frac @var{n} @var{d}))}, but more efficient.
33554 @end defun
33555
33556 @defun make-float mant exp
33557 Build a floating-point value out of @var{mant} and @var{exp}, both
33558 of which are arbitrary integers. This function will return a
33559 properly normalized float value, or signal an overflow or underflow
33560 if @var{exp} is out of range.
33561 @end defun
33562
33563 @defun make-sdev x sigma
33564 Build an error form out of @var{x} and the absolute value of @var{sigma}.
33565 If @var{sigma} is zero, the result is the number @var{x} directly.
33566 If @var{sigma} is negative or complex, its absolute value is used.
33567 If @var{x} or @var{sigma} is not a valid type of object for use in
33568 error forms, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33569 @end defun
33570
33571 @defun make-intv mask lo hi
33572 Build an interval form out of @var{mask} (which is assumed to be an
33573 integer from 0 to 3), and the limits @var{lo} and @var{hi}. If
33574 @var{lo} is greater than @var{hi}, an empty interval form is returned.
33575 This calls @code{reject-arg} if @var{lo} or @var{hi} is unsuitable.
33576 @end defun
33577
33578 @defun sort-intv mask lo hi
33579 Build an interval form, similar to @code{make-intv}, except that if
33580 @var{lo} is less than @var{hi} they are simply exchanged, and the
33581 bits of @var{mask} are swapped accordingly.
33582 @end defun
33583
33584 @defun make-mod n m
33585 Build a modulo form out of @var{n} and the modulus @var{m}. Since modulo
33586 forms do not allow formulas as their components, if @var{n} or @var{m}
33587 is not a real number or HMS form the result will be a formula which
33588 is a call to @code{makemod}, the algebraic version of this function.
33589 @end defun
33590
33591 @defun float x
33592 Convert @var{x} to floating-point form. Integers and fractions are
33593 converted to numerically equivalent floats; components of complex
33594 numbers, vectors, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33595 modulo forms are recursively floated. If the argument is a variable
33596 or formula, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33597 @end defun
33598
33599 @defun compare x y
33600 Compare the numbers @var{x} and @var{y}, and return @mathit{-1} if
33601 @samp{(lessp @var{x} @var{y})}, 1 if @samp{(lessp @var{y} @var{x})},
33602 0 if @samp{(math-equal @var{x} @var{y})}, or 2 if the order is
33603 undefined or cannot be determined.
33604 @end defun
33605
33606 @defun numdigs n
33607 Return the number of digits of integer @var{n}, effectively
33608 @samp{ceil(log10(@var{n}))}, but much more efficient. Zero is
33609 considered to have zero digits.
33610 @end defun
33611
33612 @defun scale-int x n
33613 Shift integer @var{x} left @var{n} decimal digits, or right @mathit{-@var{n}}
33614 digits with truncation toward zero.
33615 @end defun
33616
33617 @defun scale-rounding x n
33618 Like @code{scale-int}, except that a right shift rounds to the nearest
33619 integer rather than truncating.
33620 @end defun
33621
33622 @defun fixnum n
33623 Return the integer @var{n} as a fixnum, i.e., a native Lisp integer.
33624 If @var{n} is outside the permissible range for Lisp integers (usually
33625 24 binary bits) the result is undefined.
33626 @end defun
33627
33628 @defun sqr x
33629 Compute the square of @var{x}; short for @samp{(* @var{x} @var{x})}.
33630 @end defun
33631
33632 @defun quotient x y
33633 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return an integer quotient
33634 and discard the remainder. If @var{x} or @var{y} is negative, the
33635 direction of rounding is undefined.
33636 @end defun
33637
33638 @defun idiv x y
33639 Perform an integer division; if @var{x} and @var{y} are both nonnegative
33640 integers, this uses the @code{quotient} function, otherwise it computes
33641 @samp{floor(@var{x}/@var{y})}. Thus the result is well-defined but
33642 slower than for @code{quotient}.
33643 @end defun
33644
33645 @defun imod x y
33646 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return the integer remainder
33647 and discard the quotient. Like @code{quotient}, this works only for
33648 integer arguments and is not well-defined for negative arguments.
33649 For a more well-defined result, use @samp{(% @var{x} @var{y})}.
33650 @end defun
33651
33652 @defun idivmod x y
33653 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return a cons cell whose
33654 @code{car} is @samp{(quotient @var{x} @var{y})} and whose @code{cdr}
33655 is @samp{(imod @var{x} @var{y})}.
33656 @end defun
33657
33658 @defun pow x y
33659 Compute @var{x} to the power @var{y}. In @code{defmath} code, this can
33660 also be written @samp{(^ @var{x} @var{y})} or
33661 @w{@samp{(expt @var{x} @var{y})}}.
33662 @end defun
33663
33664 @defun abs-approx x
33665 Compute a fast approximation to the absolute value of @var{x}. For
33666 example, for a rectangular complex number the result is the sum of
33667 the absolute values of the components.
33668 @end defun
33669
33670 @findex e
33671 @findex gamma-const
33672 @findex ln-2
33673 @findex ln-10
33674 @findex phi
33675 @findex pi-over-2
33676 @findex pi-over-4
33677 @findex pi-over-180
33678 @findex sqrt-two-pi
33679 @findex sqrt-e
33680 @findex two-pi
33681 @defun pi
33682 The function @samp{(pi)} computes @samp{pi} to the current precision.
33683 Other related constant-generating functions are @code{two-pi},
33684 @code{pi-over-2}, @code{pi-over-4}, @code{pi-over-180}, @code{sqrt-two-pi},
33685 @code{e}, @code{sqrt-e}, @code{ln-2}, @code{ln-10}, @code{phi} and
33686 @code{gamma-const}. Each function returns a floating-point value in the
33687 current precision, and each uses caching so that all calls after the
33688 first are essentially free.
33689 @end defun
33690
33691 @defmac math-defcache @var{func} @var{initial} @var{form}
33692 This macro, usually used as a top-level call like @code{defun} or
33693 @code{defvar}, defines a new cached constant analogous to @code{pi}, etc.
33694 It defines a function @code{func} which returns the requested value;
33695 if @var{initial} is non-@code{nil} it must be a @samp{(float @dots{})}
33696 form which serves as an initial value for the cache. If @var{func}
33697 is called when the cache is empty or does not have enough digits to
33698 satisfy the current precision, the Lisp expression @var{form} is evaluated
33699 with the current precision increased by four, and the result minus its
33700 two least significant digits is stored in the cache. For example,
33701 calling @samp{(pi)} with a precision of 30 computes @samp{pi} to 34
33702 digits, rounds it down to 32 digits for future use, then rounds it
33703 again to 30 digits for use in the present request.
33704 @end defmac
33705
33706 @findex half-circle
33707 @findex quarter-circle
33708 @defun full-circle symb
33709 If the current angular mode is Degrees or HMS, this function returns the
33710 integer 360. In Radians mode, this function returns either the
33711 corresponding value in radians to the current precision, or the formula
33712 @samp{2*pi}, depending on the Symbolic mode. There are also similar
33713 function @code{half-circle} and @code{quarter-circle}.
33714 @end defun
33715
33716 @defun power-of-2 n
33717 Compute two to the integer power @var{n}, as a (potentially very large)
33718 integer. Powers of two are cached, so only the first call for a
33719 particular @var{n} is expensive.
33720 @end defun
33721
33722 @defun integer-log2 n
33723 Compute the base-2 logarithm of @var{n}, which must be an integer which
33724 is a power of two. If @var{n} is not a power of two, this function will
33725 return @code{nil}.
33726 @end defun
33727
33728 @defun div-mod a b m
33729 Divide @var{a} by @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. This returns @code{nil} if
33730 there is no solution, or if any of the arguments are not integers.
33731 @end defun
33732
33733 @defun pow-mod a b m
33734 Compute @var{a} to the power @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. If @var{a},
33735 @var{b}, and @var{m} are integers, this uses an especially efficient
33736 algorithm. Otherwise, it simply computes @samp{(% (^ a b) m)}.
33737 @end defun
33738
33739 @defun isqrt n
33740 Compute the integer square root of @var{n}. This is the square root
33741 of @var{n} rounded down toward zero, i.e., @samp{floor(sqrt(@var{n}))}.
33742 If @var{n} is itself an integer, the computation is especially efficient.
33743 @end defun
33744
33745 @defun to-hms a ang
33746 Convert the argument @var{a} into an HMS form. If @var{ang} is specified,
33747 it is the angular mode in which to interpret @var{a}, either @code{deg}
33748 or @code{rad}. Otherwise, the current angular mode is used. If @var{a}
33749 is already an HMS form it is returned as-is.
33750 @end defun
33751
33752 @defun from-hms a ang
33753 Convert the HMS form @var{a} into a real number. If @var{ang} is specified,
33754 it is the angular mode in which to express the result, otherwise the
33755 current angular mode is used. If @var{a} is already a real number, it
33756 is returned as-is.
33757 @end defun
33758
33759 @defun to-radians a
33760 Convert the number or HMS form @var{a} to radians from the current
33761 angular mode.
33762 @end defun
33763
33764 @defun from-radians a
33765 Convert the number @var{a} from radians to the current angular mode.
33766 If @var{a} is a formula, this returns the formula @samp{deg(@var{a})}.
33767 @end defun
33768
33769 @defun to-radians-2 a
33770 Like @code{to-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a degrees to
33771 radians conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*pi/180}.
33772 @end defun
33773
33774 @defun from-radians-2 a
33775 Like @code{from-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a radians to
33776 degrees conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*180/pi}.
33777 @end defun
33778
33779 @defun random-digit
33780 Produce a random base-1000 digit in the range 0 to 999.
33781 @end defun
33782
33783 @defun random-digits n
33784 Produce a random @var{n}-digit integer; this will be an integer
33785 in the interval @samp{[0, 10^@var{n})}.
33786 @end defun
33787
33788 @defun random-float
33789 Produce a random float in the interval @samp{[0, 1)}.
33790 @end defun
33791
33792 @defun prime-test n iters
33793 Determine whether the integer @var{n} is prime. Return a list which has
33794 one of these forms: @samp{(nil @var{f})} means the number is non-prime
33795 because it was found to be divisible by @var{f}; @samp{(nil)} means it
33796 was found to be non-prime by table look-up (so no factors are known);
33797 @samp{(nil unknown)} means it is definitely non-prime but no factors
33798 are known because @var{n} was large enough that Fermat's probabilistic
33799 test had to be used; @samp{(t)} means the number is definitely prime;
33800 and @samp{(maybe @var{i} @var{p})} means that Fermat's test, after @var{i}
33801 iterations, is @var{p} percent sure that the number is prime. The
33802 @var{iters} parameter is the number of Fermat iterations to use, in the
33803 case that this is necessary. If @code{prime-test} returns ``maybe,''
33804 you can call it again with the same @var{n} to get a greater certainty;
33805 @code{prime-test} remembers where it left off.
33806 @end defun
33807
33808 @defun to-simple-fraction f
33809 If @var{f} is a floating-point number which can be represented exactly
33810 as a small rational number. return that number, else return @var{f}.
33811 For example, 0.75 would be converted to 3:4. This function is very
33812 fast.
33813 @end defun
33814
33815 @defun to-fraction f tol
33816 Find a rational approximation to floating-point number @var{f} to within
33817 a specified tolerance @var{tol}; this corresponds to the algebraic
33818 function @code{frac}, and can be rather slow.
33819 @end defun
33820
33821 @defun quarter-integer n
33822 If @var{n} is an integer or integer-valued float, this function
33823 returns zero. If @var{n} is a half-integer (i.e., an integer plus
33824 @mathit{1:2} or 0.5), it returns 2. If @var{n} is a quarter-integer,
33825 it returns 1 or 3. If @var{n} is anything else, this function
33826 returns @code{nil}.
33827 @end defun
33828
33829 @node Vector Lisp Functions, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Computational Lisp Functions, Internals
33830 @subsubsection Vector Functions
33831
33832 @noindent
33833 The functions described here perform various operations on vectors and
33834 matrices.
33835
33836 @defun math-concat x y
33837 Do a vector concatenation; this operation is written @samp{@var{x} | @var{y}}
33838 in a symbolic formula. @xref{Building Vectors}.
33839 @end defun
33840
33841 @defun vec-length v
33842 Return the length of vector @var{v}. If @var{v} is not a vector, the
33843 result is zero. If @var{v} is a matrix, this returns the number of
33844 rows in the matrix.
33845 @end defun
33846
33847 @defun mat-dimens m
33848 Determine the dimensions of vector or matrix @var{m}. If @var{m} is not
33849 a vector, the result is an empty list. If @var{m} is a plain vector
33850 but not a matrix, the result is a one-element list containing the length
33851 of the vector. If @var{m} is a matrix with @var{r} rows and @var{c} columns,
33852 the result is the list @samp{(@var{r} @var{c})}. Higher-order tensors
33853 produce lists of more than two dimensions. Note that the object
33854 @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} is a vector of vectors not all the same size,
33855 and is treated by this and other Calc routines as a plain vector of two
33856 elements.
33857 @end defun
33858
33859 @defun dimension-error
33860 Abort the current function with a message of ``Dimension error.''
33861 The Calculator will leave the function being evaluated in symbolic
33862 form; this is really just a special case of @code{reject-arg}.
33863 @end defun
33864
33865 @defun build-vector args
33866 Return a Calc vector with @var{args} as elements.
33867 For example, @samp{(build-vector 1 2 3)} returns the Calc vector
33868 @samp{[1, 2, 3]}, stored internally as the list @samp{(vec 1 2 3)}.
33869 @end defun
33870
33871 @defun make-vec obj dims
33872 Return a Calc vector or matrix all of whose elements are equal to
33873 @var{obj}. For example, @samp{(make-vec 27 3 4)} returns a 3x4 matrix
33874 filled with 27's.
33875 @end defun
33876
33877 @defun row-matrix v
33878 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a row matrix, i.e.,
33879 a matrix whose single row is @var{v}. If @var{v} is already a matrix,
33880 leave it alone.
33881 @end defun
33882
33883 @defun col-matrix v
33884 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a column matrix, i.e., a
33885 matrix with each element of @var{v} as a separate row. If @var{v} is
33886 already a matrix, leave it alone.
33887 @end defun
33888
33889 @defun map-vec f v
33890 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the Calc vector @var{v}. For example,
33891 @samp{(map-vec 'math-floor v)} returns a vector of the floored components
33892 of vector @var{v}.
33893 @end defun
33894
33895 @defun map-vec-2 f a b
33896 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the two vectors @var{a} and @var{b}.
33897 If @var{a} and @var{b} are vectors of equal length, the result is a
33898 vector of the results of calling @samp{(@var{f} @var{ai} @var{bi})}
33899 for each pair of elements @var{ai} and @var{bi}. If either @var{a} or
33900 @var{b} is a scalar, it is matched with each value of the other vector.
33901 For example, @samp{(map-vec-2 'math-add v 1)} returns the vector @var{v}
33902 with each element increased by one. Note that using @samp{'+} would not
33903 work here, since @code{defmath} does not expand function names everywhere,
33904 just where they are in the function position of a Lisp expression.
33905 @end defun
33906
33907 @defun reduce-vec f v
33908 Reduce the function @var{f} over the vector @var{v}. For example, if
33909 @var{v} is @samp{[10, 20, 30, 40]}, this calls @samp{(f (f (f 10 20) 30) 40)}.
33910 If @var{v} is a matrix, this reduces over the rows of @var{v}.
33911 @end defun
33912
33913 @defun reduce-cols f m
33914 Reduce the function @var{f} over the columns of matrix @var{m}. For
33915 example, if @var{m} is @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4], [5, 6]]}, the result
33916 is a vector of the two elements @samp{(f (f 1 3) 5)} and @samp{(f (f 2 4) 6)}.
33917 @end defun
33918
33919 @defun mat-row m n
33920 Return the @var{n}th row of matrix @var{m}. This is equivalent to
33921 @samp{(elt m n)}. For a slower but safer version, use @code{mrow}.
33922 (@xref{Extracting Elements}.)
33923 @end defun
33924
33925 @defun mat-col m n
33926 Return the @var{n}th column of matrix @var{m}, in the form of a vector.
33927 The arguments are not checked for correctness.
33928 @end defun
33929
33930 @defun mat-less-row m n
33931 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th row deleted. The
33932 number @var{n} must be in range from 1 to the number of rows in @var{m}.
33933 @end defun
33934
33935 @defun mat-less-col m n
33936 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th column deleted.
33937 @end defun
33938
33939 @defun transpose m
33940 Return the transpose of matrix @var{m}.
33941 @end defun
33942
33943 @defun flatten-vector v
33944 Flatten nested vector @var{v} into a vector of scalars. For example,
33945 if @var{v} is @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} the result is @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
33946 @end defun
33947
33948 @defun copy-matrix m
33949 If @var{m} is a matrix, return a copy of @var{m}. This maps
33950 @code{copy-sequence} over the rows of @var{m}; in Lisp terms, each
33951 element of the result matrix will be @code{eq} to the corresponding
33952 element of @var{m}, but none of the @code{cons} cells that make up
33953 the structure of the matrix will be @code{eq}. If @var{m} is a plain
33954 vector, this is the same as @code{copy-sequence}.
33955 @end defun
33956
33957 @defun swap-rows m r1 r2
33958 Exchange rows @var{r1} and @var{r2} of matrix @var{m} in-place. In
33959 other words, unlike most of the other functions described here, this
33960 function changes @var{m} itself rather than building up a new result
33961 matrix. The return value is @var{m}, i.e., @samp{(eq (swap-rows m 1 2) m)}
33962 is true, with the side effect of exchanging the first two rows of
33963 @var{m}.
33964 @end defun
33965
33966 @node Symbolic Lisp Functions, Formatting Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Internals
33967 @subsubsection Symbolic Functions
33968
33969 @noindent
33970 The functions described here operate on symbolic formulas in the
33971 Calculator.
33972
33973 @defun calc-prepare-selection num
33974 Prepare a stack entry for selection operations. If @var{num} is
33975 omitted, the stack entry containing the cursor is used; otherwise,
33976 it is the number of the stack entry to use. This function stores
33977 useful information about the current stack entry into a set of
33978 variables. @code{calc-selection-cache-num} contains the number of
33979 the stack entry involved (equal to @var{num} if you specified it);
33980 @code{calc-selection-cache-entry} contains the stack entry as a
33981 list (such as @code{calc-top-list} would return with @code{entry}
33982 as the selection mode); and @code{calc-selection-cache-comp} contains
33983 a special ``tagged'' composition (@pxref{Formatting Lisp Functions})
33984 which allows Calc to relate cursor positions in the buffer with
33985 their corresponding sub-formulas.
33986
33987 A slight complication arises in the selection mechanism because
33988 formulas may contain small integers. For example, in the vector
33989 @samp{[1, 2, 1]} the first and last elements are @code{eq} to each
33990 other; selections are recorded as the actual Lisp object that
33991 appears somewhere in the tree of the whole formula, but storing
33992 @code{1} would falsely select both @code{1}'s in the vector. So
33993 @code{calc-prepare-selection} also checks the stack entry and
33994 replaces any plain integers with ``complex number'' lists of the form
33995 @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)}. This list will be displayed the same as a
33996 plain @var{n} and the change will be completely invisible to the
33997 user, but it will guarantee that no two sub-formulas of the stack
33998 entry will be @code{eq} to each other. Next time the stack entry
33999 is involved in a computation, @code{calc-normalize} will replace
34000 these lists with plain numbers again, again invisibly to the user.
34001 @end defun
34002
34003 @defun calc-encase-atoms x
34004 This modifies the formula @var{x} to ensure that each part of the
34005 formula is a unique atom, using the @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)} trick
34006 described above. This function may use @code{setcar} to modify
34007 the formula in-place.
34008 @end defun
34009
34010 @defun calc-find-selected-part
34011 Find the smallest sub-formula of the current formula that contains
34012 the cursor. This assumes @code{calc-prepare-selection} has been
34013 called already. If the cursor is not actually on any part of the
34014 formula, this returns @code{nil}.
34015 @end defun
34016
34017 @defun calc-change-current-selection selection
34018 Change the currently prepared stack element's selection to
34019 @var{selection}, which should be @code{eq} to some sub-formula
34020 of the stack element, or @code{nil} to unselect the formula.
34021 The stack element's appearance in the Calc buffer is adjusted
34022 to reflect the new selection.
34023 @end defun
34024
34025 @defun calc-find-nth-part expr n
34026 Return the @var{n}th sub-formula of @var{expr}. This function is used
34027 by the selection commands, and (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) treats
34028 sums and products as flat many-element formulas. Thus if @var{expr}
34029 is @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, calling @code{calc-find-nth-part} with
34030 @var{n} equal to four will return @samp{d}.
34031 @end defun
34032
34033 @defun calc-find-parent-formula expr part
34034 Return the sub-formula of @var{expr} which immediately contains
34035 @var{part}. If @var{expr} is @samp{a*b + (c+1)*d} and @var{part}
34036 is @code{eq} to the @samp{c+1} term of @var{expr}, then this function
34037 will return @samp{(c+1)*d}. If @var{part} turns out not to be a
34038 sub-formula of @var{expr}, the function returns @code{nil}. If
34039 @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, the function returns @code{t}.
34040 This function does not take associativity into account.
34041 @end defun
34042
34043 @defun calc-find-assoc-parent-formula expr part
34044 This is the same as @code{calc-find-parent-formula}, except that
34045 (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) it continues widening the selection
34046 to contain a complete level of the formula. Given @samp{a} from
34047 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, @code{calc-find-parent-formula} will
34048 return @samp{a + b} but @code{calc-find-assoc-parent-formula} will
34049 return the whole expression.
34050 @end defun
34051
34052 @defun calc-grow-assoc-formula expr part
34053 This expands sub-formula @var{part} of @var{expr} to encompass a
34054 complete level of the formula. If @var{part} and its immediate
34055 parent are not compatible associative operators, or if @kbd{j b}
34056 has been used, this simply returns @var{part}.
34057 @end defun
34058
34059 @defun calc-find-sub-formula expr part
34060 This finds the immediate sub-formula of @var{expr} which contains
34061 @var{part}. It returns an index @var{n} such that
34062 @samp{(calc-find-nth-part @var{expr} @var{n})} would return @var{part}.
34063 If @var{part} is not a sub-formula of @var{expr}, it returns @code{nil}.
34064 If @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, it returns @code{t}. This
34065 function does not take associativity into account.
34066 @end defun
34067
34068 @defun calc-replace-sub-formula expr old new
34069 This function returns a copy of formula @var{expr}, with the
34070 sub-formula that is @code{eq} to @var{old} replaced by @var{new}.
34071 @end defun
34072
34073 @defun simplify expr
34074 Simplify the expression @var{expr} by applying various algebraic rules.
34075 This is what the @w{@kbd{a s}} (@code{calc-simplify}) command uses. This
34076 always returns a copy of the expression; the structure @var{expr} points
34077 to remains unchanged in memory.
34078
34079 More precisely, here is what @code{simplify} does: The expression is
34080 first normalized and evaluated by calling @code{normalize}. If any
34081 @code{AlgSimpRules} have been defined, they are then applied. Then
34082 the expression is traversed in a depth-first, bottom-up fashion; at
34083 each level, any simplifications that can be made are made until no
34084 further changes are possible. Once the entire formula has been
34085 traversed in this way, it is compared with the original formula (from
34086 before the call to @code{normalize}) and, if it has changed,
34087 the entire procedure is repeated (starting with @code{normalize})
34088 until no further changes occur. Usually only two iterations are
34089 needed:@: one to simplify the formula, and another to verify that no
34090 further simplifications were possible.
34091 @end defun
34092
34093 @defun simplify-extended expr
34094 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, with additional rules enabled that
34095 help do a more thorough job, while not being entirely ``safe'' in all
34096 circumstances. (For example, this mode will simplify @samp{sqrt(x^2)}
34097 to @samp{x}, which is only valid when @var{x} is positive.) This is
34098 implemented by temporarily binding the variable @code{math-living-dangerously}
34099 to @code{t} (using a @code{let} form) and calling @code{simplify}.
34100 Dangerous simplification rules are written to check this variable
34101 before taking any action.
34102 @end defun
34103
34104 @defun simplify-units expr
34105 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, treating variable names as units
34106 whenever possible. This works by binding the variable
34107 @code{math-simplifying-units} to @code{t} while calling @code{simplify}.
34108 @end defun
34109
34110 @defmac math-defsimplify funcs body
34111 Register a new simplification rule; this is normally called as a top-level
34112 form, like @code{defun} or @code{defmath}. If @var{funcs} is a symbol
34113 (like @code{+} or @code{calcFunc-sqrt}), this simplification rule is
34114 applied to the formulas which are calls to the specified function. Or,
34115 @var{funcs} can be a list of such symbols; the rule applies to all
34116 functions on the list. The @var{body} is written like the body of a
34117 function with a single argument called @code{expr}. The body will be
34118 executed with @code{expr} bound to a formula which is a call to one of
34119 the functions @var{funcs}. If the function body returns @code{nil}, or
34120 if it returns a result @code{equal} to the original @code{expr}, it is
34121 ignored and Calc goes on to try the next simplification rule that applies.
34122 If the function body returns something different, that new formula is
34123 substituted for @var{expr} in the original formula.
34124
34125 At each point in the formula, rules are tried in the order of the
34126 original calls to @code{math-defsimplify}; the search stops after the
34127 first rule that makes a change. Thus later rules for that same
34128 function will not have a chance to trigger until the next iteration
34129 of the main @code{simplify} loop.
34130
34131 Note that, since @code{defmath} is not being used here, @var{body} must
34132 be written in true Lisp code without the conveniences that @code{defmath}
34133 provides. If you prefer, you can have @var{body} simply call another
34134 function (defined with @code{defmath}) which does the real work.
34135
34136 The arguments of a function call will already have been simplified
34137 before any rules for the call itself are invoked. Since a new argument
34138 list is consed up when this happens, this means that the rule's body is
34139 allowed to rearrange the function's arguments destructively if that is
34140 convenient. Here is a typical example of a simplification rule:
34141
34142 @smallexample
34143 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-arcsinh
34144 (or (and (math-looks-negp (nth 1 expr))
34145 (math-neg (list 'calcFunc-arcsinh
34146 (math-neg (nth 1 expr)))))
34147 (and (eq (car-safe (nth 1 expr)) 'calcFunc-sinh)
34148 (or math-living-dangerously
34149 (math-known-realp (nth 1 (nth 1 expr))))
34150 (nth 1 (nth 1 expr)))))
34151 @end smallexample
34152
34153 This is really a pair of rules written with one @code{math-defsimplify}
34154 for convenience; the first replaces @samp{arcsinh(-x)} with
34155 @samp{-arcsinh(x)}, and the second, which is safe only for real @samp{x},
34156 replaces @samp{arcsinh(sinh(x))} with @samp{x}.
34157 @end defmac
34158
34159 @defun common-constant-factor expr
34160 Check @var{expr} to see if it is a sum of terms all multiplied by the
34161 same rational value. If so, return this value. If not, return @code{nil}.
34162 For example, if called on @samp{6x + 9y + 12z}, it would return 3, since
34163 3 is a common factor of all the terms.
34164 @end defun
34165
34166 @defun cancel-common-factor expr factor
34167 Assuming @var{expr} is a sum with @var{factor} as a common factor,
34168 divide each term of the sum by @var{factor}. This is done by
34169 destructively modifying parts of @var{expr}, on the assumption that
34170 it is being used by a simplification rule (where such things are
34171 allowed; see above). For example, consider this built-in rule for
34172 square roots:
34173
34174 @smallexample
34175 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-sqrt
34176 (let ((fac (math-common-constant-factor (nth 1 expr))))
34177 (and fac (not (eq fac 1))
34178 (math-mul (math-normalize (list 'calcFunc-sqrt fac))
34179 (math-normalize
34180 (list 'calcFunc-sqrt
34181 (math-cancel-common-factor
34182 (nth 1 expr) fac)))))))
34183 @end smallexample
34184 @end defun
34185
34186 @defun frac-gcd a b
34187 Compute a ``rational GCD'' of @var{a} and @var{b}, which must both be
34188 rational numbers. This is the fraction composed of the GCD of the
34189 numerators of @var{a} and @var{b}, over the GCD of the denominators.
34190 It is used by @code{common-constant-factor}. Note that the standard
34191 @code{gcd} function uses the LCM to combine the denominators.
34192 @end defun
34193
34194 @defun map-tree func expr many
34195 Try applying Lisp function @var{func} to various sub-expressions of
34196 @var{expr}. Initially, call @var{func} with @var{expr} itself as an
34197 argument. If this returns an expression which is not @code{equal} to
34198 @var{expr}, apply @var{func} again until eventually it does return
34199 @var{expr} with no changes. Then, if @var{expr} is a function call,
34200 recursively apply @var{func} to each of the arguments. This keeps going
34201 until no changes occur anywhere in the expression; this final expression
34202 is returned by @code{map-tree}. Note that, unlike simplification rules,
34203 @var{func} functions may @emph{not} make destructive changes to
34204 @var{expr}. If a third argument @var{many} is provided, it is an
34205 integer which says how many times @var{func} may be applied; the
34206 default, as described above, is infinitely many times.
34207 @end defun
34208
34209 @defun compile-rewrites rules
34210 Compile the rewrite rule set specified by @var{rules}, which should
34211 be a formula that is either a vector or a variable name. If the latter,
34212 the compiled rules are saved so that later @code{compile-rules} calls
34213 for that same variable can return immediately. If there are problems
34214 with the rules, this function calls @code{error} with a suitable
34215 message.
34216 @end defun
34217
34218 @defun apply-rewrites expr crules heads
34219 Apply the compiled rewrite rule set @var{crules} to the expression
34220 @var{expr}. This will make only one rewrite and only checks at the
34221 top level of the expression. The result @code{nil} if no rules
34222 matched, or if the only rules that matched did not actually change
34223 the expression. The @var{heads} argument is optional; if is given,
34224 it should be a list of all function names that (may) appear in
34225 @var{expr}. The rewrite compiler tags each rule with the
34226 rarest-looking function name in the rule; if you specify @var{heads},
34227 @code{apply-rewrites} can use this information to narrow its search
34228 down to just a few rules in the rule set.
34229 @end defun
34230
34231 @defun rewrite-heads expr
34232 Compute a @var{heads} list for @var{expr} suitable for use with
34233 @code{apply-rewrites}, as discussed above.
34234 @end defun
34235
34236 @defun rewrite expr rules many
34237 This is an all-in-one rewrite function. It compiles the rule set
34238 specified by @var{rules}, then uses @code{map-tree} to apply the
34239 rules throughout @var{expr} up to @var{many} (default infinity)
34240 times.
34241 @end defun
34242
34243 @defun match-patterns pat vec not-flag
34244 Given a Calc vector @var{vec} and an uncompiled pattern set or
34245 pattern set variable @var{pat}, this function returns a new vector
34246 of all elements of @var{vec} which do (or don't, if @var{not-flag} is
34247 non-@code{nil}) match any of the patterns in @var{pat}.
34248 @end defun
34249
34250 @defun deriv expr var value symb
34251 Compute the derivative of @var{expr} with respect to variable @var{var}
34252 (which may actually be any sub-expression). If @var{value} is specified,
34253 the derivative is evaluated at the value of @var{var}; otherwise, the
34254 derivative is left in terms of @var{var}. If the expression contains
34255 functions for which no derivative formula is known, new derivative
34256 functions are invented by adding primes to the names; @pxref{Calculus}.
34257 However, if @var{symb} is non-@code{nil}, the presence of undifferentiable
34258 functions in @var{expr} instead cancels the whole differentiation, and
34259 @code{deriv} returns @code{nil} instead.
34260
34261 Derivatives of an @var{n}-argument function can be defined by
34262 adding a @code{math-derivative-@var{n}} property to the property list
34263 of the symbol for the function's derivative, which will be the
34264 function name followed by an apostrophe. The value of the property
34265 should be a Lisp function; it is called with the same arguments as the
34266 original function call that is being differentiated. It should return
34267 a formula for the derivative. For example, the derivative of @code{ln}
34268 is defined by
34269
34270 @smallexample
34271 (put 'calcFunc-ln\' 'math-derivative-1
34272 (function (lambda (u) (math-div 1 u))))
34273 @end smallexample
34274
34275 The two-argument @code{log} function has two derivatives,
34276 @smallexample
34277 (put 'calcFunc-log\' 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / dx
34278 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34279 (put 'calcFunc-log\'2 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / db
34280 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34281 @end smallexample
34282 @end defun
34283
34284 @defun tderiv expr var value symb
34285 Compute the total derivative of @var{expr}. This is the same as
34286 @code{deriv}, except that variables other than @var{var} are not
34287 assumed to be constant with respect to @var{var}.
34288 @end defun
34289
34290 @defun integ expr var low high
34291 Compute the integral of @var{expr} with respect to @var{var}.
34292 @xref{Calculus}, for further details.
34293 @end defun
34294
34295 @defmac math-defintegral funcs body
34296 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of one argument;
34297 this macro is very similar in format to @code{math-defsimplify}.
34298 The main difference is that here @var{body} is the body of a function
34299 with a single argument @code{u} which is bound to the argument to the
34300 function being integrated, not the function call itself. Also, the
34301 variable of integration is available as @code{math-integ-var}. If
34302 evaluation of the integral requires doing further integrals, the body
34303 should call @samp{(math-integral @var{x})} to find the integral of
34304 @var{x} with respect to @code{math-integ-var}; this function returns
34305 @code{nil} if the integral could not be done. Some examples:
34306
34307 @smallexample
34308 (math-defintegral calcFunc-conj
34309 (let ((int (math-integral u)))
34310 (and int
34311 (list 'calcFunc-conj int))))
34312
34313 (math-defintegral calcFunc-cos
34314 (and (equal u math-integ-var)
34315 (math-from-radians-2 (list 'calcFunc-sin u))))
34316 @end smallexample
34317
34318 In the @code{cos} example, we define only the integral of @samp{cos(x) dx},
34319 relying on the general integration-by-substitution facility to handle
34320 cosines of more complicated arguments. An integration rule should return
34321 @code{nil} if it can't do the integral; if several rules are defined for
34322 the same function, they are tried in order until one returns a non-@code{nil}
34323 result.
34324 @end defmac
34325
34326 @defmac math-defintegral-2 funcs body
34327 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of two arguments.
34328 This is exactly analogous to @code{math-defintegral}, except that @var{body}
34329 is written as the body of a function with two arguments, @var{u} and
34330 @var{v}.
34331 @end defmac
34332
34333 @defun solve-for lhs rhs var full
34334 Attempt to solve the equation @samp{@var{lhs} = @var{rhs}} by isolating
34335 the variable @var{var} on the lefthand side; return the resulting righthand
34336 side, or @code{nil} if the equation cannot be solved. The variable
34337 @var{var} must appear at least once in @var{lhs} or @var{rhs}. Note that
34338 the return value is a formula which does not contain @var{var}; this is
34339 different from the user-level @code{solve} and @code{finv} functions,
34340 which return a rearranged equation or a functional inverse, respectively.
34341 If @var{full} is non-@code{nil}, a full solution including dummy signs
34342 and dummy integers will be produced. User-defined inverses are provided
34343 as properties in a manner similar to derivatives:
34344
34345 @smallexample
34346 (put 'calcFunc-ln 'math-inverse
34347 (function (lambda (x) (list 'calcFunc-exp x))))
34348 @end smallexample
34349
34350 This function can call @samp{(math-solve-get-sign @var{x})} to create
34351 a new arbitrary sign variable, returning @var{x} times that sign, and
34352 @samp{(math-solve-get-int @var{x})} to create a new arbitrary integer
34353 variable multiplied by @var{x}. These functions simply return @var{x}
34354 if the caller requested a non-``full'' solution.
34355 @end defun
34356
34357 @defun solve-eqn expr var full
34358 This version of @code{solve-for} takes an expression which will
34359 typically be an equation or inequality. (If it is not, it will be
34360 interpreted as the equation @samp{@var{expr} = 0}.) It returns an
34361 equation or inequality, or @code{nil} if no solution could be found.
34362 @end defun
34363
34364 @defun solve-system exprs vars full
34365 This function solves a system of equations. Generally, @var{exprs}
34366 and @var{vars} will be vectors of equal length.
34367 @xref{Solving Systems of Equations}, for other options.
34368 @end defun
34369
34370 @defun expr-contains expr var
34371 Returns a non-@code{nil} value if @var{var} occurs as a subexpression
34372 of @var{expr}.
34373
34374 This function might seem at first to be identical to
34375 @code{calc-find-sub-formula}. The key difference is that
34376 @code{expr-contains} uses @code{equal} to test for matches, whereas
34377 @code{calc-find-sub-formula} uses @code{eq}. In the formula
34378 @samp{f(a, a)}, the two @samp{a}s will be @code{equal} but not
34379 @code{eq} to each other.
34380 @end defun
34381
34382 @defun expr-contains-count expr var
34383 Returns the number of occurrences of @var{var} as a subexpression
34384 of @var{expr}, or @code{nil} if there are no occurrences.
34385 @end defun
34386
34387 @defun expr-depends expr var
34388 Returns true if @var{expr} refers to any variable the occurs in @var{var}.
34389 In other words, it checks if @var{expr} and @var{var} have any variables
34390 in common.
34391 @end defun
34392
34393 @defun expr-contains-vars expr
34394 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables, or @code{nil} if @var{expr}
34395 contains only constants and functions with constant arguments.
34396 @end defun
34397
34398 @defun expr-subst expr old new
34399 Returns a copy of @var{expr}, with all occurrences of @var{old} replaced
34400 by @var{new}. This treats @code{lambda} forms specially with respect
34401 to the dummy argument variables, so that the effect is always to return
34402 @var{expr} evaluated at @var{old} = @var{new}.
34403 @end defun
34404
34405 @defun multi-subst expr old new
34406 This is like @code{expr-subst}, except that @var{old} and @var{new}
34407 are lists of expressions to be substituted simultaneously. If one
34408 list is shorter than the other, trailing elements of the longer list
34409 are ignored.
34410 @end defun
34411
34412 @defun expr-weight expr
34413 Returns the ``weight'' of @var{expr}, basically a count of the total
34414 number of objects and function calls that appear in @var{expr}. For
34415 ``primitive'' objects, this will be one.
34416 @end defun
34417
34418 @defun expr-height expr
34419 Returns the ``height'' of @var{expr}, which is the deepest level to
34420 which function calls are nested. (Note that @samp{@var{a} + @var{b}}
34421 counts as a function call.) For primitive objects, this returns zero.
34422 @end defun
34423
34424 @defun polynomial-p expr var
34425 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable (or sub-expression)
34426 @var{var}. If so, return the degree of the polynomial, that is, the
34427 highest power of @var{var} that appears in @var{expr}. For example,
34428 for @samp{(x^2 + 3)^3 + 4} this would return 6. This function returns
34429 @code{nil} unless @var{expr}, when expanded out by @kbd{a x}
34430 (@code{calc-expand}), would consist of a sum of terms in which @var{var}
34431 appears only raised to nonnegative integer powers. Note that if
34432 @var{var} does not occur in @var{expr}, then @var{expr} is considered
34433 a polynomial of degree 0.
34434 @end defun
34435
34436 @defun is-polynomial expr var degree loose
34437 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable or sub-expression
34438 @var{var}, and, if so, return a list representation of the polynomial
34439 where the elements of the list are coefficients of successive powers of
34440 @var{var}: @samp{@var{a} + @var{b} x + @var{c} x^3} would produce the
34441 list @samp{(@var{a} @var{b} 0 @var{c})}, and @samp{(x + 1)^2} would
34442 produce the list @samp{(1 2 1)}. The highest element of the list will
34443 be non-zero, with the special exception that if @var{expr} is the
34444 constant zero, the returned value will be @samp{(0)}. Return @code{nil}
34445 if @var{expr} is not a polynomial in @var{var}. If @var{degree} is
34446 specified, this will not consider polynomials of degree higher than that
34447 value. This is a good precaution because otherwise an input of
34448 @samp{(x+1)^1000} will cause a huge coefficient list to be built. If
34449 @var{loose} is non-@code{nil}, then a looser definition of a polynomial
34450 is used in which coefficients are no longer required not to depend on
34451 @var{var}, but are only required not to take the form of polynomials
34452 themselves. For example, @samp{sin(x) x^2 + cos(x)} is a loose
34453 polynomial with coefficients @samp{((calcFunc-cos x) 0 (calcFunc-sin
34454 x))}. The result will never be @code{nil} in loose mode, since any
34455 expression can be interpreted as a ``constant'' loose polynomial.
34456 @end defun
34457
34458 @defun polynomial-base expr pred
34459 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in any variable that occurs in it;
34460 if so, return that variable. (If @var{expr} is a multivariate polynomial,
34461 this chooses one variable arbitrarily.) If @var{pred} is specified, it should
34462 be a Lisp function which is called as @samp{(@var{pred} @var{subexpr})},
34463 and which should return true if @code{mpb-top-expr} (a global name for
34464 the original @var{expr}) is a suitable polynomial in @var{subexpr}.
34465 The default predicate uses @samp{(polynomial-p mpb-top-expr @var{subexpr})};
34466 you can use @var{pred} to specify additional conditions. Or, you could
34467 have @var{pred} build up a list of every suitable @var{subexpr} that
34468 is found.
34469 @end defun
34470
34471 @defun poly-simplify poly
34472 Simplify polynomial coefficient list @var{poly} by (destructively)
34473 clipping off trailing zeros.
34474 @end defun
34475
34476 @defun poly-mix a ac b bc
34477 Mix two polynomial lists @var{a} and @var{b} (in the form returned by
34478 @code{is-polynomial}) in a linear combination with coefficient expressions
34479 @var{ac} and @var{bc}. The result is a (not necessarily simplified)
34480 polynomial list representing @samp{@var{ac} @var{a} + @var{bc} @var{b}}.
34481 @end defun
34482
34483 @defun poly-mul a b
34484 Multiply two polynomial coefficient lists @var{a} and @var{b}. The
34485 result will be in simplified form if the inputs were simplified.
34486 @end defun
34487
34488 @defun build-polynomial-expr poly var
34489 Construct a Calc formula which represents the polynomial coefficient
34490 list @var{poly} applied to variable @var{var}. The @kbd{a c}
34491 (@code{calc-collect}) command uses @code{is-polynomial} to turn an
34492 expression into a coefficient list, then @code{build-polynomial-expr}
34493 to turn the list back into an expression in regular form.
34494 @end defun
34495
34496 @defun check-unit-name var
34497 Check if @var{var} is a variable which can be interpreted as a unit
34498 name. If so, return the units table entry for that unit. This
34499 will be a list whose first element is the unit name (not counting
34500 prefix characters) as a symbol and whose second element is the
34501 Calc expression which defines the unit. (Refer to the Calc sources
34502 for details on the remaining elements of this list.) If @var{var}
34503 is not a variable or is not a unit name, return @code{nil}.
34504 @end defun
34505
34506 @defun units-in-expr-p expr sub-exprs
34507 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables which can be
34508 interpreted as units. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{t}, the entire
34509 expression is searched. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{nil}, this
34510 checks whether @var{expr} is directly a units expression.
34511 @end defun
34512
34513 @defun single-units-in-expr-p expr
34514 Check whether @var{expr} contains exactly one units variable. If so,
34515 return the units table entry for the variable. If @var{expr} does
34516 not contain any units, return @code{nil}. If @var{expr} contains
34517 two or more units, return the symbol @code{wrong}.
34518 @end defun
34519
34520 @defun to-standard-units expr which
34521 Convert units expression @var{expr} to base units. If @var{which}
34522 is @code{nil}, use Calc's native base units. Otherwise, @var{which}
34523 can specify a units system, which is a list of two-element lists,
34524 where the first element is a Calc base symbol name and the second
34525 is an expression to substitute for it.
34526 @end defun
34527
34528 @defun remove-units expr
34529 Return a copy of @var{expr} with all units variables replaced by ones.
34530 This expression is generally normalized before use.
34531 @end defun
34532
34533 @defun extract-units expr
34534 Return a copy of @var{expr} with everything but units variables replaced
34535 by ones.
34536 @end defun
34537
34538 @node Formatting Lisp Functions, Hooks, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Internals
34539 @subsubsection I/O and Formatting Functions
34540
34541 @noindent
34542 The functions described here are responsible for parsing and formatting
34543 Calc numbers and formulas.
34544
34545 @defun calc-eval str sep arg1 arg2 @dots{}
34546 This is the simplest interface to the Calculator from another Lisp program.
34547 @xref{Calling Calc from Your Programs}.
34548 @end defun
34549
34550 @defun read-number str
34551 If string @var{str} contains a valid Calc number, either integer,
34552 fraction, float, or HMS form, this function parses and returns that
34553 number. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}.
34554 @end defun
34555
34556 @defun read-expr str
34557 Read an algebraic expression from string @var{str}. If @var{str} does
34558 not have the form of a valid expression, return a list of the form
34559 @samp{(error @var{pos} @var{msg})} where @var{pos} is an integer index
34560 into @var{str} of the general location of the error, and @var{msg} is
34561 a string describing the problem.
34562 @end defun
34563
34564 @defun read-exprs str
34565 Read a list of expressions separated by commas, and return it as a
34566 Lisp list. If an error occurs in any expressions, an error list as
34567 shown above is returned instead.
34568 @end defun
34569
34570 @defun calc-do-alg-entry initial prompt no-norm
34571 Read an algebraic formula or formulas using the minibuffer. All
34572 conventions of regular algebraic entry are observed. The return value
34573 is a list of Calc formulas; there will be more than one if the user
34574 entered a list of values separated by commas. The result is @code{nil}
34575 if the user presses Return with a blank line. If @var{initial} is
34576 given, it is a string which the minibuffer will initially contain.
34577 If @var{prompt} is given, it is the prompt string to use; the default
34578 is ``Algebraic:''. If @var{no-norm} is @code{t}, the formulas will
34579 be returned exactly as parsed; otherwise, they will be passed through
34580 @code{calc-normalize} first.
34581
34582 To support the use of @kbd{$} characters in the algebraic entry, use
34583 @code{let} to bind @code{calc-dollar-values} to a list of the values
34584 to be substituted for @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on, and bind
34585 @code{calc-dollar-used} to 0. Upon return, @code{calc-dollar-used}
34586 will have been changed to the highest number of consecutive @kbd{$}s
34587 that actually appeared in the input.
34588 @end defun
34589
34590 @defun format-number a
34591 Convert the real or complex number or HMS form @var{a} to string form.
34592 @end defun
34593
34594 @defun format-flat-expr a prec
34595 Convert the arbitrary Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form,
34596 in the style used by the trail buffer and the @code{calc-edit} command.
34597 This is a simple format designed
34598 mostly to guarantee the string is of a form that can be re-parsed by
34599 @code{read-expr}. Most formatting modes, such as digit grouping,
34600 complex number format, and point character, are ignored to ensure the
34601 result will be re-readable. The @var{prec} parameter is normally 0; if
34602 you pass a large integer like 1000 instead, the expression will be
34603 surrounded by parentheses unless it is a plain number or variable name.
34604 @end defun
34605
34606 @defun format-nice-expr a width
34607 This is like @code{format-flat-expr} (with @var{prec} equal to 0),
34608 except that newlines will be inserted to keep lines down to the
34609 specified @var{width}, and vectors that look like matrices or rewrite
34610 rules are written in a pseudo-matrix format. The @code{calc-edit}
34611 command uses this when only one stack entry is being edited.
34612 @end defun
34613
34614 @defun format-value a width
34615 Convert the Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form, using the
34616 format seen in the stack buffer. Beware the string returned may
34617 not be re-readable by @code{read-expr}, for example, because of digit
34618 grouping. Multi-line objects like matrices produce strings that
34619 contain newline characters to separate the lines. The @var{w}
34620 parameter, if given, is the target window size for which to format
34621 the expressions. If @var{w} is omitted, the width of the Calculator
34622 window is used.
34623 @end defun
34624
34625 @defun compose-expr a prec
34626 Format the Calc number or formula @var{a} according to the current
34627 language mode, returning a ``composition.'' To learn about the
34628 structure of compositions, see the comments in the Calc source code.
34629 You can specify the format of a given type of function call by putting
34630 a @code{math-compose-@var{lang}} property on the function's symbol,
34631 whose value is a Lisp function that takes @var{a} and @var{prec} as
34632 arguments and returns a composition. Here @var{lang} is a language
34633 mode name, one of @code{normal}, @code{big}, @code{c}, @code{pascal},
34634 @code{fortran}, @code{tex}, @code{eqn}, @code{math}, or @code{maple}.
34635 In Big mode, Calc actually tries @code{math-compose-big} first, then
34636 tries @code{math-compose-normal}. If this property does not exist,
34637 or if the function returns @code{nil}, the function is written in the
34638 normal function-call notation for that language.
34639 @end defun
34640
34641 @defun composition-to-string c w
34642 Convert a composition structure returned by @code{compose-expr} into
34643 a string. Multi-line compositions convert to strings containing
34644 newline characters. The target window size is given by @var{w}.
34645 The @code{format-value} function basically calls @code{compose-expr}
34646 followed by @code{composition-to-string}.
34647 @end defun
34648
34649 @defun comp-width c
34650 Compute the width in characters of composition @var{c}.
34651 @end defun
34652
34653 @defun comp-height c
34654 Compute the height in lines of composition @var{c}.
34655 @end defun
34656
34657 @defun comp-ascent c
34658 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is on or
34659 above the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be one.
34660 @end defun
34661
34662 @defun comp-descent c
34663 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is below
34664 the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be zero.
34665 @end defun
34666
34667 @defun comp-first-char c
34668 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the first
34669 (leftmost) character of the composition as an integer. Otherwise,
34670 return @code{nil}.
34671 @end defun
34672
34673 @defun comp-last-char c
34674 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the last
34675 (rightmost) character, otherwise return @code{nil}.
34676 @end defun
34677
34678 @comment @node Lisp Variables, Hooks, Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
34679 @comment @subsubsection Lisp Variables
34680 @comment
34681 @comment @noindent
34682 @comment (This section is currently unfinished.)
34683
34684 @node Hooks, , Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
34685 @subsubsection Hooks
34686
34687 @noindent
34688 Hooks are variables which contain Lisp functions (or lists of functions)
34689 which are called at various times. Calc defines a number of hooks
34690 that help you to customize it in various ways. Calc uses the Lisp
34691 function @code{run-hooks} to invoke the hooks shown below. Several
34692 other customization-related variables are also described here.
34693
34694 @defvar calc-load-hook
34695 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc.el}, after the file has
34696 been loaded, before any functions in it have been called, but after
34697 @code{calc-mode-map} and similar variables have been set up.
34698 @end defvar
34699
34700 @defvar calc-ext-load-hook
34701 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc-ext.el}.
34702 @end defvar
34703
34704 @defvar calc-start-hook
34705 This hook is called as the last step in a @kbd{M-x calc} command.
34706 At this point, the Calc buffer has been created and initialized if
34707 necessary, the Calc window and trail window have been created,
34708 and the ``Welcome to Calc'' message has been displayed.
34709 @end defvar
34710
34711 @defvar calc-mode-hook
34712 This hook is called when the Calc buffer is being created. Usually
34713 this will only happen once per Emacs session. The hook is called
34714 after Emacs has switched to the new buffer, the mode-settings file
34715 has been read if necessary, and all other buffer-local variables
34716 have been set up. After this hook returns, Calc will perform a
34717 @code{calc-refresh} operation, set up the mode line display, then
34718 evaluate any deferred @code{calc-define} properties that have not
34719 been evaluated yet.
34720 @end defvar
34721
34722 @defvar calc-trail-mode-hook
34723 This hook is called when the Calc Trail buffer is being created.
34724 It is called as the very last step of setting up the Trail buffer.
34725 Like @code{calc-mode-hook}, this will normally happen only once
34726 per Emacs session.
34727 @end defvar
34728
34729 @defvar calc-end-hook
34730 This hook is called by @code{calc-quit}, generally because the user
34731 presses @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} while in Calc. The Calc buffer will
34732 be the current buffer. The hook is called as the very first
34733 step, before the Calc window is destroyed.
34734 @end defvar
34735
34736 @defvar calc-window-hook
34737 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc window.
34738 Upon return, this new Calc window should be the current window.
34739 (The Calc buffer will already be the current buffer when the
34740 hook is called.) If the hook is not defined, Calc will
34741 generally use @code{split-window}, @code{set-window-buffer},
34742 and @code{select-window} to create the Calc window.
34743 @end defvar
34744
34745 @defvar calc-trail-window-hook
34746 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc Trail
34747 window. The variable @code{calc-trail-buffer} will contain the buffer
34748 which the window should use. Unlike @code{calc-window-hook}, this hook
34749 must @emph{not} switch into the new window.
34750 @end defvar
34751
34752 @defvar calc-embedded-mode-hook
34753 This hook is called the first time that Embedded mode is entered.
34754 @end defvar
34755
34756 @defvar calc-embedded-new-buffer-hook
34757 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is entered in a
34758 new buffer.
34759 @end defvar
34760
34761 @defvar calc-embedded-new-formula-hook
34762 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is enabled for a
34763 new formula.
34764 @end defvar
34765
34766 @defvar calc-edit-mode-hook
34767 This hook is called by @code{calc-edit} (and the other ``edit''
34768 commands) when the temporary editing buffer is being created.
34769 The buffer will have been selected and set up to be in
34770 @code{calc-edit-mode}, but will not yet have been filled with
34771 text. (In fact it may still have leftover text from a previous
34772 @code{calc-edit} command.)
34773 @end defvar
34774
34775 @defvar calc-mode-save-hook
34776 This hook is called by the @code{calc-save-modes} command,
34777 after Calc's own mode features have been inserted into the
34778 Calc init file and just before the ``End of mode settings''
34779 message is inserted.
34780 @end defvar
34781
34782 @defvar calc-reset-hook
34783 This hook is called after @kbd{C-x * 0} (@code{calc-reset}) has
34784 reset all modes. The Calc buffer will be the current buffer.
34785 @end defvar
34786
34787 @defvar calc-other-modes
34788 This variable contains a list of strings. The strings are
34789 concatenated at the end of the modes portion of the Calc
34790 mode line (after standard modes such as ``Deg'', ``Inv'' and
34791 ``Hyp''). Each string should be a short, single word followed
34792 by a space. The variable is @code{nil} by default.
34793 @end defvar
34794
34795 @defvar calc-mode-map
34796 This is the keymap that is used by Calc mode. The best time
34797 to adjust it is probably in a @code{calc-mode-hook}. If the
34798 Calc extensions package (@file{calc-ext.el}) has not yet been
34799 loaded, many of these keys will be bound to @code{calc-missing-key},
34800 which is a command that loads the extensions package and
34801 ``retypes'' the key. If your @code{calc-mode-hook} rebinds
34802 one of these keys, it will probably be overridden when the
34803 extensions are loaded.
34804 @end defvar
34805
34806 @defvar calc-digit-map
34807 This is the keymap that is used during numeric entry. Numeric
34808 entry uses the minibuffer, but this map binds every non-numeric
34809 key to @code{calcDigit-nondigit} which generally calls
34810 @code{exit-minibuffer} and ``retypes'' the key.
34811 @end defvar
34812
34813 @defvar calc-alg-ent-map
34814 This is the keymap that is used during algebraic entry. This is
34815 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-map}.
34816 @end defvar
34817
34818 @defvar calc-store-var-map
34819 This is the keymap that is used during entry of variable names for
34820 commands like @code{calc-store} and @code{calc-recall}. This is
34821 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-completion-map}.
34822 @end defvar
34823
34824 @defvar calc-edit-mode-map
34825 This is the (sparse) keymap used by @code{calc-edit} and other
34826 temporary editing commands. It binds @key{RET}, @key{LFD},
34827 and @kbd{C-c C-c} to @code{calc-edit-finish}.
34828 @end defvar
34829
34830 @defvar calc-mode-var-list
34831 This is a list of variables which are saved by @code{calc-save-modes}.
34832 Each entry is a list of two items, the variable (as a Lisp symbol)
34833 and its default value. When modes are being saved, each variable
34834 is compared with its default value (using @code{equal}) and any
34835 non-default variables are written out.
34836 @end defvar
34837
34838 @defvar calc-local-var-list
34839 This is a list of variables which should be buffer-local to the
34840 Calc buffer. Each entry is a variable name (as a Lisp symbol).
34841 These variables also have their default values manipulated by
34842 the @code{calc} and @code{calc-quit} commands; @pxref{Multiple Calculators}.
34843 Since @code{calc-mode-hook} is called after this list has been
34844 used the first time, your hook should add a variable to the
34845 list and also call @code{make-local-variable} itself.
34846 @end defvar
34847
34848 @node Copying, GNU Free Documentation License, Programming, Top
34849 @appendix GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
34850 @include gpl.texi
34851
34852 @node GNU Free Documentation License, Customizing Calc, Copying, Top
34853 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
34854 @include doclicense.texi
34855
34856 @node Customizing Calc, Reporting Bugs, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
34857 @appendix Customizing Calc
34858
34859 The usual prefix for Calc is the key sequence @kbd{C-x *}. If you wish
34860 to use a different prefix, you can put
34861
34862 @example
34863 (global-set-key "NEWPREFIX" 'calc-dispatch)
34864 @end example
34865
34866 @noindent
34867 in your .emacs file.
34868 (@xref{Key Bindings,,Customizing Key Bindings,emacs,
34869 The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information on binding keys.)
34870 A convenient way to start Calc is with @kbd{C-x * *}; to make it equally
34871 convenient for users who use a different prefix, the prefix can be
34872 followed by @kbd{=}, @kbd{&}, @kbd{#}, @kbd{\}, @kbd{/}, @kbd{+} or
34873 @kbd{-} as well as @kbd{*} to start Calc, and so in many cases the last
34874 character of the prefix can simply be typed twice.
34875
34876 Calc is controlled by many variables, most of which can be reset
34877 from within Calc. Some variables are less involved with actual
34878 calculation, and can be set outside of Calc using Emacs's
34879 customization facilities. These variables are listed below.
34880 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-variable RET @var{variable-name} RET}
34881 will bring up a buffer in which the variable's value can be redefined.
34882 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-group RET calc RET} will bring up a buffer which
34883 contains all of Calc's customizable variables. (These variables can
34884 also be reset by putting the appropriate lines in your .emacs file;
34885 @xref{Init File, ,Init File, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.)
34886
34887 Some of the customizable variables are regular expressions. A regular
34888 expression is basically a pattern that Calc can search for.
34889 See @ref{Regexp Search,, Regular Expression Search, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}
34890 to see how regular expressions work.
34891
34892 @defvar calc-settings-file
34893 The variable @code{calc-settings-file} holds the file name in
34894 which commands like @kbd{m m} and @kbd{Z P} store ``permanent''
34895 definitions.
34896 If @code{calc-settings-file} is not your user init file (typically
34897 @file{~/.emacs}) and if the variable @code{calc-loaded-settings-file} is
34898 @code{nil}, then Calc will automatically load your settings file (if it
34899 exists) the first time Calc is invoked.
34900
34901 The default value for this variable is @code{"~/.calc.el"}.
34902 @end defvar
34903
34904 @defvar calc-gnuplot-name
34905 See @ref{Graphics}.@*
34906 The variable @code{calc-gnuplot-name} should be the name of the
34907 GNUPLOT program (a string). If you have GNUPLOT installed on your
34908 system but Calc is unable to find it, you may need to set this
34909 variable. You may also need to set some Lisp variables to show Calc how
34910 to run GNUPLOT on your system, see @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices} .
34911 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-name} is @code{"gnuplot"}.
34912 @end defvar
34913
34914 @defvar calc-gnuplot-plot-command
34915 @defvarx calc-gnuplot-print-command
34916 See @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices}.@*
34917 The variables @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
34918 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} represent system commands to
34919 display and print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
34920 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
34921 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
34922 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
34923 to display or print the output.
34924
34925 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} is @code{nil},
34926 and the default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} is
34927 @code{"lp %s"}.
34928 @end defvar
34929
34930 @defvar calc-language-alist
34931 See @ref{Basic Embedded Mode}.@*
34932 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} controls the languages that
34933 Calc will associate with major modes. When Calc embedded mode is
34934 enabled, it will try to use the current major mode to
34935 determine what language should be used. (This can be overridden using
34936 Calc's mode changing commands, @xref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
34937 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} consists of a list of pairs of
34938 the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} . @var{LANGUAGE})}; for example,
34939 @code{(latex-mode . latex)} is one such pair. If Calc embedded is
34940 activated in a buffer whose major mode is @var{MAJOR-MODE}, it will set itself
34941 to use the language @var{LANGUAGE}.
34942
34943 The default value of @code{calc-language-alist} is
34944 @example
34945 ((latex-mode . latex)
34946 (tex-mode . tex)
34947 (plain-tex-mode . tex)
34948 (context-mode . tex)
34949 (nroff-mode . eqn)
34950 (pascal-mode . pascal)
34951 (c-mode . c)
34952 (c++-mode . c)
34953 (fortran-mode . fortran)
34954 (f90-mode . fortran))
34955 @end example
34956 @end defvar
34957
34958 @defvar calc-embedded-announce-formula
34959 @defvarx calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist
34960 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34961 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} helps determine
34962 what formulas @kbd{C-x * a} will activate in a buffer. It is a
34963 regular expression, and when activating embedded formulas with
34964 @kbd{C-x * a}, it will tell Calc that what follows is a formula to be
34965 activated. (Calc also uses other patterns to find formulas, such as
34966 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=}.)
34967
34968 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, which checks
34969 for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of lines beginning with
34970 @samp{%} and a space.
34971
34972 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist} is used to
34973 set @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} to different regular
34974 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34975 It consists of a list of pairs of the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} .
34976 @var{REGEXP})}, and its default value is
34977 @example
34978 ((c++-mode . "//Embed\n\\(// .*\n\\)*")
34979 (c-mode . "/\\*Embed\\*/\n\\(/\\* .*\\*/\n\\)*")
34980 (f90-mode . "!Embed\n\\(! .*\n\\)*")
34981 (fortran-mode . "C Embed\n\\(C .*\n\\)*")
34982 (html-helper-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34983 (html-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34984 (nroff-mode . "\\\\\"Embed\n\\(\\\\\" .*\n\\)*")
34985 (pascal-mode . "@{Embed@}\n\\(@{.*@}\n\\)*")
34986 (sgml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34987 (xml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34988 (texinfo-mode . "@@c Embed\n\\(@@c .*\n\\)*"))
34989 @end example
34990 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
34991 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
34992 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
34993 @end defvar
34994
34995 @defvar calc-embedded-open-formula
34996 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-formula
34997 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist
34998 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34999 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
35000 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} control the region that Calc will
35001 activate as a formula when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x * e}.
35002 They are regular expressions;
35003 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
35004 nearest text matching these regular expressions to be the ``formula
35005 delimiters''.
35006
35007 The simplest delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that
35008 Embedded mode understands by default are:
35009 @enumerate
35010 @item
35011 The @TeX{} and La@TeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
35012 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
35013 @item
35014 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
35015 @item
35016 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
35017 @item
35018 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
35019 @item
35020 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
35021 @end enumerate
35022
35023 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist} is used to
35024 set @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
35025 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} to different regular
35026 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35027 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35028 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-FORMULA-REGEXP}
35029 @var{CLOSE-FORMULA-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35030 @code{nil}.
35031 @end defvar
35032
35033 @defvar calc-embedded-word-regexp
35034 @defvarx calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist
35035 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35036 The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} determines the expression
35037 that Calc will activate when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x *
35038 w}. It is a regular expressions.
35039
35040 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} is
35041 @code{"[-+]?[0-9]+\\(\\.[0-9]+\\)?\\([eE][-+]?[0-9]+\\)?"}.
35042
35043 The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist} is used to
35044 set @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} to a different regular
35045 expression depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35046 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35047 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{WORD-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35048 @code{nil}.
35049 @end defvar
35050
35051 @defvar calc-embedded-open-plain
35052 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-plain
35053 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist
35054 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35055 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
35056 @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} are used to delimit ``plain''
35057 formulas. Note that these are actual strings, not regular
35058 expressions, because Calc must be able to write these string into a
35059 buffer as well as to recognize them.
35060
35061 The default string for @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} is
35062 @code{"%%% "}, note the trailing space. The default string for
35063 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} is @code{" %%%\n"}, without
35064 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
35065 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
35066
35067 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist} is used to
35068 set @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
35069 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} to different strings
35070 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35071 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35072 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-PLAIN-STRING}
35073 @var{CLOSE-PLAIN-STRING})}, and its default value is
35074 @example
35075 ((c++-mode "// %% " " %%\n")
35076 (c-mode "/* %% " " %% */\n")
35077 (f90-mode "! %% " " %%\n")
35078 (fortran-mode "C %% " " %%\n")
35079 (html-helper-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35080 (html-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35081 (nroff-mode "\\\" %% " " %%\n")
35082 (pascal-mode "@{%% " " %%@}\n")
35083 (sgml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35084 (xml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35085 (texinfo-mode "@@c %% " " %%\n"))
35086 @end example
35087 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
35088 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35089 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
35090 @end defvar
35091
35092 @defvar calc-embedded-open-new-formula
35093 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-new-formula
35094 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist
35095 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35096 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
35097 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} are strings which are
35098 inserted before and after a new formula when you type @kbd{C-x * f}.
35099
35100 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} is
35101 @code{"\n\n"}. If this string begins with a newline character and the
35102 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip
35103 this first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in the
35104 file. The default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} is
35105 also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by @w{@kbd{C-x * f}}
35106 if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if @kbd{C-x * f} is
35107 typed on a blank line, both a leading opening newline and a trailing
35108 closing newline are omitted.)
35109
35110 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist} is used to
35111 set @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
35112 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} to different strings
35113 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35114 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35115 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-NEW-FORMULA-STRING}
35116 @var{CLOSE-NEW-FORMULA-STRING})}, and its default value is
35117 @code{nil}.
35118 @end defvar
35119
35120 @defvar calc-embedded-open-mode
35121 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-mode
35122 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist
35123 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35124 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35125 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} are strings which Calc will place before
35126 and after any mode annotations that it inserts. Calc never scans for
35127 these strings; Calc always looks for the annotation itself, so it is not
35128 necessary to add them to user-written annotations.
35129
35130 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} is @code{"% "}
35131 and the default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} is
35132 @code{"\n"}.
35133 If you change the value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode}, it is a good
35134 idea still to end with a newline so that mode annotations will appear on
35135 lines by themselves.
35136
35137 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist} is used to
35138 set @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35139 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} to different strings
35140 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35141 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35142 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-MODE-STRING}
35143 @var{CLOSE-MODE-STRING})}, and its default value is
35144 @example
35145 ((c++-mode "// " "\n")
35146 (c-mode "/* " " */\n")
35147 (f90-mode "! " "\n")
35148 (fortran-mode "C " "\n")
35149 (html-helper-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35150 (html-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35151 (nroff-mode "\\\" " "\n")
35152 (pascal-mode "@{ " " @}\n")
35153 (sgml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35154 (xml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35155 (texinfo-mode "@@c " "\n"))
35156 @end example
35157 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}
35158 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35159 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}.
35160 @end defvar
35161
35162 @defvar calc-multiplication-has-precedence
35163 The variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} determines
35164 whether multiplication has precedence over division in algebraic
35165 formulas in normal language modes. If
35166 @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is non-@code{nil}, then
35167 multiplication has precedence (and, for certain obscure reasons, is
35168 right associative), and so for example @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted
35169 as @samp{a/(b*c)}. If @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is
35170 @code{nil}, then multiplication has the same precedence as division
35171 (and, like division, is left associative), and so for example
35172 @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted as @samp{(a/b)*c}. The default value
35173 of @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is @code{t}.
35174 @end defvar
35175
35176 @defvar calc-undo-length
35177 The variable @code{calc-undo-length} determines the number of undo
35178 steps that Calc will keep track of when @code{calc-quit} is called.
35179 If @code{calc-undo-length} is a non-negative integer, then this is the
35180 number of undo steps that will be preserved; if
35181 @code{calc-undo-length} has any other value, then all undo steps will
35182 be preserved. The default value of @code{calc-undo-length} is @expr{100}.
35183 @end defvar
35184
35185 @node Reporting Bugs, Summary, Customizing Calc, Top
35186 @appendix Reporting Bugs
35187
35188 @noindent
35189 If you find a bug in Calc, send e-mail to Jay Belanger,
35190
35191 @example
35192 jay.p.belanger@@gmail.com
35193 @end example
35194
35195 @noindent
35196 There is an automatic command @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug} which helps
35197 you to report bugs. This command prompts you for a brief subject
35198 line, then leaves you in a mail editing buffer. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to
35199 send your mail. Make sure your subject line indicates that you are
35200 reporting a Calc bug; this command sends mail to the maintainer's
35201 regular mailbox.
35202
35203 If you have suggestions for additional features for Calc, please send
35204 them. Some have dared to suggest that Calc is already top-heavy with
35205 features; this obviously cannot be the case, so if you have ideas, send
35206 them right in.
35207
35208 At the front of the source file, @file{calc.el}, is a list of ideas for
35209 future work. If any enthusiastic souls wish to take it upon themselves
35210 to work on these, please send a message (using @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug})
35211 so any efforts can be coordinated.
35212
35213 The latest version of Calc is available from Savannah, in the Emacs
35214 CVS tree. See @uref{http://savannah.gnu.org/projects/emacs}.
35215
35216 @c [summary]
35217 @node Summary, Key Index, Reporting Bugs, Top
35218 @appendix Calc Summary
35219
35220 @noindent
35221 This section includes a complete list of Calc keystroke commands.
35222 Each line lists the stack entries used by the command (top-of-stack
35223 last), the keystrokes themselves, the prompts asked by the command,
35224 and the result of the command (also with top-of-stack last).
35225 The result is expressed using the equivalent algebraic function.
35226 Commands which put no results on the stack show the full @kbd{M-x}
35227 command name in that position. Numbers preceding the result or
35228 command name refer to notes at the end.
35229
35230 Algebraic functions and @kbd{M-x} commands that don't have corresponding
35231 keystrokes are not listed in this summary.
35232 @xref{Command Index}. @xref{Function Index}.
35233
35234 @iftex
35235 @begingroup
35236 @tex
35237 \vskip-2\baselineskip \null
35238 \gdef\sumrow#1{\sumrowx#1\relax}%
35239 \gdef\sumrowx#1\:#2\:#3\:#4\:#5\:#6\relax{%
35240 \leavevmode%
35241 {\smallfonts
35242 \hbox to5em{\sl\hss#1}%
35243 \hbox to5em{\tt#2\hss}%
35244 \hbox to4em{\sl#3\hss}%
35245 \hbox to5em{\rm\hss#4}%
35246 \thinspace%
35247 {\tt#5}%
35248 {\sl#6}%
35249 }}%
35250 \gdef\sumlpar{{\rm(}}%
35251 \gdef\sumrpar{{\rm)}}%
35252 \gdef\sumcomma{{\rm,\thinspace}}%
35253 \gdef\sumexcl{{\rm!}}%
35254 \gdef\sumbreak{\vskip-2.5\baselineskip\goodbreak}%
35255 \gdef\minus#1{{\tt-}}%
35256 @end tex
35257 @let@:=@sumsep
35258 @let@r=@sumrow
35259 @catcode`@(=@active @let(=@sumlpar
35260 @catcode`@)=@active @let)=@sumrpar
35261 @catcode`@,=@active @let,=@sumcomma
35262 @catcode`@!=@active @let!=@sumexcl
35263 @end iftex
35264 @format
35265 @iftex
35266 @advance@baselineskip-2.5pt
35267 @let@c@sumbreak
35268 @end iftex
35269 @r{ @: C-x * a @: @: 33 @:calc-embedded-activate@:}
35270 @r{ @: C-x * b @: @: @:calc-big-or-small@:}
35271 @r{ @: C-x * c @: @: @:calc@:}
35272 @r{ @: C-x * d @: @: @:calc-embedded-duplicate@:}
35273 @r{ @: C-x * e @: @: 34 @:calc-embedded@:}
35274 @r{ @: C-x * f @:formula @: @:calc-embedded-new-formula@:}
35275 @r{ @: C-x * g @: @: 35 @:calc-grab-region@:}
35276 @r{ @: C-x * i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35277 @r{ @: C-x * j @: @: @:calc-embedded-select@:}
35278 @r{ @: C-x * k @: @: @:calc-keypad@:}
35279 @r{ @: C-x * l @: @: @:calc-load-everything@:}
35280 @r{ @: C-x * m @: @: @:read-kbd-macro@:}
35281 @r{ @: C-x * n @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-next@:}
35282 @r{ @: C-x * o @: @: @:calc-other-window@:}
35283 @r{ @: C-x * p @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-previous@:}
35284 @r{ @: C-x * q @:formula @: @:quick-calc@:}
35285 @r{ @: C-x * r @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-rectangle@:}
35286 @r{ @: C-x * s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35287 @r{ @: C-x * t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35288 @r{ @: C-x * u @: @: @:calc-embedded-update-formula@:}
35289 @r{ @: C-x * w @: @: @:calc-embedded-word@:}
35290 @r{ @: C-x * x @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35291 @r{ @: C-x * y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35292 @r{ @: C-x * z @: @: @:calc-user-invocation@:}
35293 @r{ @: C-x * : @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-down@:}
35294 @r{ @: C-x * _ @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-across@:}
35295 @r{ @: C-x * ` @:editing @: 30 @:calc-embedded-edit@:}
35296 @r{ @: C-x * 0 @:(zero) @: @:calc-reset@:}
35297
35298 @c
35299 @r{ @: 0-9 @:number @: @:@:number}
35300 @r{ @: . @:number @: @:@:0.number}
35301 @r{ @: _ @:number @: @:-@:number}
35302 @r{ @: e @:number @: @:@:1e number}
35303 @r{ @: # @:number @: @:@:current-radix@tfn{#}number}
35304 @r{ @: P @:(in number) @: @:+/-@:}
35305 @r{ @: M @:(in number) @: @:mod@:}
35306 @r{ @: @@ ' " @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35307 @r{ @: h m s @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35308
35309 @c
35310 @r{ @: ' @:formula @: 37,46 @:@:formula}
35311 @r{ @: $ @:formula @: 37,46 @:$@:formula}
35312 @r{ @: " @:string @: 37,46 @:@:string}
35313
35314 @c
35315 @r{ a b@: + @: @: 2 @:add@:(a,b) a+b}
35316 @r{ a b@: - @: @: 2 @:sub@:(a,b) a@minus{}b}
35317 @r{ a b@: * @: @: 2 @:mul@:(a,b) a b, a*b}
35318 @r{ a b@: / @: @: 2 @:div@:(a,b) a/b}
35319 @r{ a b@: ^ @: @: 2 @:pow@:(a,b) a^b}
35320 @r{ a b@: I ^ @: @: 2 @:nroot@:(a,b) a^(1/b)}
35321 @r{ a b@: % @: @: 2 @:mod@:(a,b) a%b}
35322 @r{ a b@: \ @: @: 2 @:idiv@:(a,b) a\b}
35323 @r{ a b@: : @: @: 2 @:fdiv@:(a,b)}
35324 @r{ a b@: | @: @: 2 @:vconcat@:(a,b) a|b}
35325 @r{ a b@: I | @: @: @:vconcat@:(b,a) b|a}
35326 @r{ a b@: H | @: @: 2 @:append@:(a,b)}
35327 @r{ a b@: I H | @: @: @:append@:(b,a)}
35328 @r{ a@: & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(a) 1/a}
35329 @r{ a@: ! @: @: 1 @:fact@:(a) a!}
35330 @r{ a@: = @: @: 1 @:evalv@:(a)}
35331 @r{ a@: M-% @: @: @:percent@:(a) a%}
35332
35333 @c
35334 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35335 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{SPC} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35336 @r{... a b@: @summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b a}
35337 @r{. a b c@: M-@summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b c a}
35338 @r{... a b@: @summarykey{LFD} @: @: 1 @:@:... a b a}
35339 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35340 @r{... a b@: M-@summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:... b}
35341 @r{ @: M-@summarykey{RET} @: @: 4 @:calc-last-args@:}
35342 @r{ a@: ` @:editing @: 1,30 @:calc-edit@:}
35343
35344 @c
35345 @r{ ... a@: C-d @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35346 @r{ @: C-k @: @: 27 @:calc-kill@:}
35347 @r{ @: C-w @: @: 27 @:calc-kill-region@:}
35348 @r{ @: C-y @: @: @:calc-yank@:}
35349 @r{ @: C-_ @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35350 @r{ @: M-k @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-as-kill@:}
35351 @r{ @: M-w @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-region-as-kill@:}
35352
35353 @c
35354 @r{ @: [ @: @: @:@:[...}
35355 @r{[.. a b@: ] @: @: @:@:[a,b]}
35356 @r{ @: ( @: @: @:@:(...}
35357 @r{(.. a b@: ) @: @: @:@:(a,b)}
35358 @r{ @: , @: @: @:@:vector or rect complex}
35359 @r{ @: ; @: @: @:@:matrix or polar complex}
35360 @r{ @: .. @: @: @:@:interval}
35361
35362 @c
35363 @r{ @: ~ @: @: @:calc-num-prefix@:}
35364 @r{ @: < @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-left@:}
35365 @r{ @: > @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-right@:}
35366 @r{ @: @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-down@:}
35367 @r{ @: @} @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-up@:}
35368 @r{ @: ? @: @: @:calc-help@:}
35369
35370 @c
35371 @r{ a@: n @: @: 1 @:neg@:(a) @minus{}a}
35372 @r{ @: o @: @: 4 @:calc-realign@:}
35373 @r{ @: p @:precision @: 31 @:calc-precision@:}
35374 @r{ @: q @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35375 @r{ @: w @: @: @:calc-why@:}
35376 @r{ @: x @:command @: @:M-x calc-@:command}
35377 @r{ a@: y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35378
35379 @c
35380 @r{ a@: A @: @: 1 @:abs@:(a)}
35381 @r{ a b@: B @: @: 2 @:log@:(a,b)}
35382 @r{ a b@: I B @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35383 @r{ a@: C @: @: 1 @:cos@:(a)}
35384 @r{ a@: I C @: @: 1 @:arccos@:(a)}
35385 @r{ a@: H C @: @: 1 @:cosh@:(a)}
35386 @r{ a@: I H C @: @: 1 @:arccosh@:(a)}
35387 @r{ @: D @: @: 4 @:calc-redo@:}
35388 @r{ a@: E @: @: 1 @:exp@:(a)}
35389 @r{ a@: H E @: @: 1 @:exp10@:(a) 10.^a}
35390 @r{ a@: F @: @: 1,11 @:floor@:(a,d)}
35391 @r{ a@: I F @: @: 1,11 @:ceil@:(a,d)}
35392 @r{ a@: H F @: @: 1,11 @:ffloor@:(a,d)}
35393 @r{ a@: I H F @: @: 1,11 @:fceil@:(a,d)}
35394 @r{ a@: G @: @: 1 @:arg@:(a)}
35395 @r{ @: H @:command @: 32 @:@:Hyperbolic}
35396 @r{ @: I @:command @: 32 @:@:Inverse}
35397 @r{ a@: J @: @: 1 @:conj@:(a)}
35398 @r{ @: K @:command @: 32 @:@:Keep-args}
35399 @r{ a@: L @: @: 1 @:ln@:(a)}
35400 @r{ a@: H L @: @: 1 @:log10@:(a)}
35401 @r{ @: M @: @: @:calc-more-recursion-depth@:}
35402 @r{ @: I M @: @: @:calc-less-recursion-depth@:}
35403 @r{ a@: N @: @: 5 @:evalvn@:(a)}
35404 @r{ @: P @: @: @:@:pi}
35405 @r{ @: I P @: @: @:@:gamma}
35406 @r{ @: H P @: @: @:@:e}
35407 @r{ @: I H P @: @: @:@:phi}
35408 @r{ a@: Q @: @: 1 @:sqrt@:(a)}
35409 @r{ a@: I Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35410 @r{ a@: R @: @: 1,11 @:round@:(a,d)}
35411 @r{ a@: I R @: @: 1,11 @:trunc@:(a,d)}
35412 @r{ a@: H R @: @: 1,11 @:fround@:(a,d)}
35413 @r{ a@: I H R @: @: 1,11 @:ftrunc@:(a,d)}
35414 @r{ a@: S @: @: 1 @:sin@:(a)}
35415 @r{ a@: I S @: @: 1 @:arcsin@:(a)}
35416 @r{ a@: H S @: @: 1 @:sinh@:(a)}
35417 @r{ a@: I H S @: @: 1 @:arcsinh@:(a)}
35418 @r{ a@: T @: @: 1 @:tan@:(a)}
35419 @r{ a@: I T @: @: 1 @:arctan@:(a)}
35420 @r{ a@: H T @: @: 1 @:tanh@:(a)}
35421 @r{ a@: I H T @: @: 1 @:arctanh@:(a)}
35422 @r{ @: U @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35423 @r{ @: X @: @: 4 @:calc-call-last-kbd-macro@:}
35424
35425 @c
35426 @r{ a b@: a = @: @: 2 @:eq@:(a,b) a=b}
35427 @r{ a b@: a # @: @: 2 @:neq@:(a,b) a!=b}
35428 @r{ a b@: a < @: @: 2 @:lt@:(a,b) a<b}
35429 @r{ a b@: a > @: @: 2 @:gt@:(a,b) a>b}
35430 @r{ a b@: a [ @: @: 2 @:leq@:(a,b) a<=b}
35431 @r{ a b@: a ] @: @: 2 @:geq@:(a,b) a>=b}
35432 @r{ a b@: a @{ @: @: 2 @:in@:(a,b)}
35433 @r{ a b@: a & @: @: 2,45 @:land@:(a,b) a&&b}
35434 @r{ a b@: a | @: @: 2,45 @:lor@:(a,b) a||b}
35435 @r{ a@: a ! @: @: 1,45 @:lnot@:(a) !a}
35436 @r{ a b c@: a : @: @: 45 @:if@:(a,b,c) a?b:c}
35437 @r{ a@: a . @: @: 1 @:rmeq@:(a)}
35438 @r{ a@: a " @: @: 7,8 @:calc-expand-formula@:}
35439
35440 @c
35441 @r{ a@: a + @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:sum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35442 @r{ a@: a - @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:asum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35443 @r{ a@: a * @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:prod@:(a,i,l,h)}
35444 @r{ a b@: a _ @: @: 2 @:subscr@:(a,b) a_b}
35445
35446 @c
35447 @r{ a b@: a \ @: @: 2 @:pdiv@:(a,b)}
35448 @r{ a b@: a % @: @: 2 @:prem@:(a,b)}
35449 @r{ a b@: a / @: @: 2 @:pdivrem@:(a,b) [q,r]}
35450 @r{ a b@: H a / @: @: 2 @:pdivide@:(a,b) q+r/b}
35451
35452 @c
35453 @r{ a@: a a @: @: 1 @:apart@:(a)}
35454 @r{ a@: a b @:old, new @: 38 @:subst@:(a,old,new)}
35455 @r{ a@: a c @:v @: 38 @:collect@:(a,v)}
35456 @r{ a@: a d @:v @: 4,38 @:deriv@:(a,v)}
35457 @r{ a@: H a d @:v @: 4,38 @:tderiv@:(a,v)}
35458 @r{ a@: a e @: @: @:esimplify@:(a)}
35459 @r{ a@: a f @: @: 1 @:factor@:(a)}
35460 @r{ a@: H a f @: @: 1 @:factors@:(a)}
35461 @r{ a b@: a g @: @: 2 @:pgcd@:(a,b)}
35462 @r{ a@: a i @:v @: 38 @:integ@:(a,v)}
35463 @r{ a@: a m @:pats @: 38 @:match@:(a,pats)}
35464 @r{ a@: I a m @:pats @: 38 @:matchnot@:(a,pats)}
35465 @r{ data x@: a p @: @: 28 @:polint@:(data,x)}
35466 @r{ data x@: H a p @: @: 28 @:ratint@:(data,x)}
35467 @r{ a@: a n @: @: 1 @:nrat@:(a)}
35468 @r{ a@: a r @:rules @:4,8,38 @:rewrite@:(a,rules,n)}
35469 @r{ a@: a s @: @: @:simplify@:(a)}
35470 @r{ a@: a t @:v, n @: 31,39 @:taylor@:(a,v,n)}
35471 @r{ a@: a v @: @: 7,8 @:calc-alg-evaluate@:}
35472 @r{ a@: a x @: @: 4,8 @:expand@:(a)}
35473
35474 @c
35475 @r{ data@: a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:fit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35476 @r{ data@: I a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:xfit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35477 @r{ data@: H a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:efit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35478 @r{ a@: a I @:v, l, h @: 38 @:ninteg@:(a,v,l,h)}
35479 @r{ a b@: a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeq@:(op,a,b)}
35480 @r{ a b@: I a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqr@:(op,a,b)}
35481 @r{ a b@: H a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqp@:(op,a,b)}
35482 @r{ a g@: a N @:v @: 38 @:minimize@:(a,v,g)}
35483 @r{ a g@: H a N @:v @: 38 @:wminimize@:(a,v,g)}
35484 @r{ a@: a P @:v @: 38 @:roots@:(a,v)}
35485 @r{ a g@: a R @:v @: 38 @:root@:(a,v,g)}
35486 @r{ a g@: H a R @:v @: 38 @:wroot@:(a,v,g)}
35487 @r{ a@: a S @:v @: 38 @:solve@:(a,v)}
35488 @r{ a@: I a S @:v @: 38 @:finv@:(a,v)}
35489 @r{ a@: H a S @:v @: 38 @:fsolve@:(a,v)}
35490 @r{ a@: I H a S @:v @: 38 @:ffinv@:(a,v)}
35491 @r{ a@: a T @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:table@:(a,i,l,h)}
35492 @r{ a g@: a X @:v @: 38 @:maximize@:(a,v,g)}
35493 @r{ a g@: H a X @:v @: 38 @:wmaximize@:(a,v,g)}
35494
35495 @c
35496 @r{ a b@: b a @: @: 9 @:and@:(a,b,w)}
35497 @r{ a@: b c @: @: 9 @:clip@:(a,w)}
35498 @r{ a b@: b d @: @: 9 @:diff@:(a,b,w)}
35499 @r{ a@: b l @: @: 10 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
35500 @r{ a n@: H b l @: @: 9 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
35501 @r{ a@: b n @: @: 9 @:not@:(a,w)}
35502 @r{ a b@: b o @: @: 9 @:or@:(a,b,w)}
35503 @r{ v@: b p @: @: 1 @:vpack@:(v)}
35504 @r{ a@: b r @: @: 10 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
35505 @r{ a n@: H b r @: @: 9 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
35506 @r{ a@: b t @: @: 10 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
35507 @r{ a n@: H b t @: @: 9 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
35508 @r{ a@: b u @: @: 1 @:vunpack@:(a)}
35509 @r{ @: b w @:w @: 9,50 @:calc-word-size@:}
35510 @r{ a b@: b x @: @: 9 @:xor@:(a,b,w)}
35511
35512 @c
35513 @r{c s l p@: b D @: @: @:ddb@:(c,s,l,p)}
35514 @r{ r n p@: b F @: @: @:fv@:(r,n,p)}
35515 @r{ r n p@: I b F @: @: @:fvb@:(r,n,p)}
35516 @r{ r n p@: H b F @: @: @:fvl@:(r,n,p)}
35517 @r{ v@: b I @: @: 19 @:irr@:(v)}
35518 @r{ v@: I b I @: @: 19 @:irrb@:(v)}
35519 @r{ a@: b L @: @: 10 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35520 @r{ a n@: H b L @: @: 9 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35521 @r{ r n a@: b M @: @: @:pmt@:(r,n,a)}
35522 @r{ r n a@: I b M @: @: @:pmtb@:(r,n,a)}
35523 @r{ r n a@: H b M @: @: @:pmtl@:(r,n,a)}
35524 @r{ r v@: b N @: @: 19 @:npv@:(r,v)}
35525 @r{ r v@: I b N @: @: 19 @:npvb@:(r,v)}
35526 @r{ r n p@: b P @: @: @:pv@:(r,n,p)}
35527 @r{ r n p@: I b P @: @: @:pvb@:(r,n,p)}
35528 @r{ r n p@: H b P @: @: @:pvl@:(r,n,p)}
35529 @r{ a@: b R @: @: 10 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35530 @r{ a n@: H b R @: @: 9 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35531 @r{ c s l@: b S @: @: @:sln@:(c,s,l)}
35532 @r{ n p a@: b T @: @: @:rate@:(n,p,a)}
35533 @r{ n p a@: I b T @: @: @:rateb@:(n,p,a)}
35534 @r{ n p a@: H b T @: @: @:ratel@:(n,p,a)}
35535 @r{c s l p@: b Y @: @: @:syd@:(c,s,l,p)}
35536
35537 @r{ r p a@: b # @: @: @:nper@:(r,p,a)}
35538 @r{ r p a@: I b # @: @: @:nperb@:(r,p,a)}
35539 @r{ r p a@: H b # @: @: @:nperl@:(r,p,a)}
35540 @r{ a b@: b % @: @: @:relch@:(a,b)}
35541
35542 @c
35543 @r{ a@: c c @: @: 5 @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35544 @r{ a@: c 0-9 @: @: @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35545 @r{ a@: H c c @: @: 5 @:clean@:(a,p)}
35546 @r{ a@: H c 0-9 @: @: @:clean@:(a,p)}
35547 @r{ a@: c d @: @: 1 @:deg@:(a)}
35548 @r{ a@: c f @: @: 1 @:pfloat@:(a)}
35549 @r{ a@: H c f @: @: 1 @:float@:(a)}
35550 @r{ a@: c h @: @: 1 @:hms@:(a)}
35551 @r{ a@: c p @: @: @:polar@:(a)}
35552 @r{ a@: I c p @: @: @:rect@:(a)}
35553 @r{ a@: c r @: @: 1 @:rad@:(a)}
35554
35555 @c
35556 @r{ a@: c F @: @: 5 @:pfrac@:(a,p)}
35557 @r{ a@: H c F @: @: 5 @:frac@:(a,p)}
35558
35559 @c
35560 @r{ a@: c % @: @: @:percent@:(a*100)}
35561
35562 @c
35563 @r{ @: d . @:char @: 50 @:calc-point-char@:}
35564 @r{ @: d , @:char @: 50 @:calc-group-char@:}
35565 @r{ @: d < @: @: 13,50 @:calc-left-justify@:}
35566 @r{ @: d = @: @: 13,50 @:calc-center-justify@:}
35567 @r{ @: d > @: @: 13,50 @:calc-right-justify@:}
35568 @r{ @: d @{ @:label @: 50 @:calc-left-label@:}
35569 @r{ @: d @} @:label @: 50 @:calc-right-label@:}
35570 @r{ @: d [ @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-up@:}
35571 @r{ @: d ] @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-down@:}
35572 @r{ @: d " @: @: 12,50 @:calc-display-strings@:}
35573 @r{ @: d @summarykey{SPC} @: @: @:calc-refresh@:}
35574 @r{ @: d @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:calc-refresh-top@:}
35575
35576 @c
35577 @r{ @: d 0 @: @: 50 @:calc-decimal-radix@:}
35578 @r{ @: d 2 @: @: 50 @:calc-binary-radix@:}
35579 @r{ @: d 6 @: @: 50 @:calc-hex-radix@:}
35580 @r{ @: d 8 @: @: 50 @:calc-octal-radix@:}
35581
35582 @c
35583 @r{ @: d b @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-line-breaking@:}
35584 @r{ @: d c @: @: 50 @:calc-complex-notation@:}
35585 @r{ @: d d @:format @: 50 @:calc-date-notation@:}
35586 @r{ @: d e @: @: 5,50 @:calc-eng-notation@:}
35587 @r{ @: d f @:num @: 31,50 @:calc-fix-notation@:}
35588 @r{ @: d g @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-group-digits@:}
35589 @r{ @: d h @:format @: 50 @:calc-hms-notation@:}
35590 @r{ @: d i @: @: 50 @:calc-i-notation@:}
35591 @r{ @: d j @: @: 50 @:calc-j-notation@:}
35592 @r{ @: d l @: @: 12,50 @:calc-line-numbering@:}
35593 @r{ @: d n @: @: 5,50 @:calc-normal-notation@:}
35594 @r{ @: d o @:format @: 50 @:calc-over-notation@:}
35595 @r{ @: d p @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-plain@:}
35596 @r{ @: d r @:radix @: 31,50 @:calc-radix@:}
35597 @r{ @: d s @: @: 5,50 @:calc-sci-notation@:}
35598 @r{ @: d t @: @: 27 @:calc-truncate-stack@:}
35599 @r{ @: d w @: @: 12,13 @:calc-auto-why@:}
35600 @r{ @: d z @: @: 12,50 @:calc-leading-zeros@:}
35601
35602 @c
35603 @r{ @: d B @: @: 50 @:calc-big-language@:}
35604 @r{ @: d C @: @: 50 @:calc-c-language@:}
35605 @r{ @: d E @: @: 50 @:calc-eqn-language@:}
35606 @r{ @: d F @: @: 50 @:calc-fortran-language@:}
35607 @r{ @: d M @: @: 50 @:calc-mathematica-language@:}
35608 @r{ @: d N @: @: 50 @:calc-normal-language@:}
35609 @r{ @: d O @: @: 50 @:calc-flat-language@:}
35610 @r{ @: d P @: @: 50 @:calc-pascal-language@:}
35611 @r{ @: d T @: @: 50 @:calc-tex-language@:}
35612 @r{ @: d L @: @: 50 @:calc-latex-language@:}
35613 @r{ @: d U @: @: 50 @:calc-unformatted-language@:}
35614 @r{ @: d W @: @: 50 @:calc-maple-language@:}
35615
35616 @c
35617 @r{ a@: f [ @: @: 4 @:decr@:(a,n)}
35618 @r{ a@: f ] @: @: 4 @:incr@:(a,n)}
35619
35620 @c
35621 @r{ a b@: f b @: @: 2 @:beta@:(a,b)}
35622 @r{ a@: f e @: @: 1 @:erf@:(a)}
35623 @r{ a@: I f e @: @: 1 @:erfc@:(a)}
35624 @r{ a@: f g @: @: 1 @:gamma@:(a)}
35625 @r{ a b@: f h @: @: 2 @:hypot@:(a,b)}
35626 @r{ a@: f i @: @: 1 @:im@:(a)}
35627 @r{ n a@: f j @: @: 2 @:besJ@:(n,a)}
35628 @r{ a b@: f n @: @: 2 @:min@:(a,b)}
35629 @r{ a@: f r @: @: 1 @:re@:(a)}
35630 @r{ a@: f s @: @: 1 @:sign@:(a)}
35631 @r{ a b@: f x @: @: 2 @:max@:(a,b)}
35632 @r{ n a@: f y @: @: 2 @:besY@:(n,a)}
35633
35634 @c
35635 @r{ a@: f A @: @: 1 @:abssqr@:(a)}
35636 @r{ x a b@: f B @: @: @:betaI@:(x,a,b)}
35637 @r{ x a b@: H f B @: @: @:betaB@:(x,a,b)}
35638 @r{ a@: f E @: @: 1 @:expm1@:(a)}
35639 @r{ a x@: f G @: @: 2 @:gammaP@:(a,x)}
35640 @r{ a x@: I f G @: @: 2 @:gammaQ@:(a,x)}
35641 @r{ a x@: H f G @: @: 2 @:gammag@:(a,x)}
35642 @r{ a x@: I H f G @: @: 2 @:gammaG@:(a,x)}
35643 @r{ a b@: f I @: @: 2 @:ilog@:(a,b)}
35644 @r{ a b@: I f I @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35645 @r{ a@: f L @: @: 1 @:lnp1@:(a)}
35646 @r{ a@: f M @: @: 1 @:mant@:(a)}
35647 @r{ a@: f Q @: @: 1 @:isqrt@:(a)}
35648 @r{ a@: I f Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35649 @r{ a n@: f S @: @: 2 @:scf@:(a,n)}
35650 @r{ y x@: f T @: @: @:arctan2@:(y,x)}
35651 @r{ a@: f X @: @: 1 @:xpon@:(a)}
35652
35653 @c
35654 @r{ x y@: g a @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add@:}
35655 @r{ @: g b @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-border@:}
35656 @r{ @: g c @: @: @:calc-graph-clear@:}
35657 @r{ @: g d @: @: 41 @:calc-graph-delete@:}
35658 @r{ x y@: g f @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast@:}
35659 @r{ @: g g @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-grid@:}
35660 @r{ @: g h @:title @: @:calc-graph-header@:}
35661 @r{ @: g j @: @: 4 @:calc-graph-juggle@:}
35662 @r{ @: g k @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-key@:}
35663 @r{ @: g l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-x@:}
35664 @r{ @: g n @:name @: @:calc-graph-name@:}
35665 @r{ @: g p @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-plot@:}
35666 @r{ @: g q @: @: @:calc-graph-quit@:}
35667 @r{ @: g r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-x@:}
35668 @r{ @: g s @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-line-style@:}
35669 @r{ @: g t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-x@:}
35670 @r{ @: g v @: @: @:calc-graph-view-commands@:}
35671 @r{ @: g x @:display @: @:calc-graph-display@:}
35672 @r{ @: g z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-x@:}
35673
35674 @c
35675 @r{ x y z@: g A @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add-3d@:}
35676 @r{ @: g C @:command @: @:calc-graph-command@:}
35677 @r{ @: g D @:device @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-device@:}
35678 @r{ x y z@: g F @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast-3d@:}
35679 @r{ @: g H @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-hide@:}
35680 @r{ @: g K @: @: @:calc-graph-kill@:}
35681 @r{ @: g L @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-y@:}
35682 @r{ @: g N @:number @: 43,51 @:calc-graph-num-points@:}
35683 @r{ @: g O @:filename @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-output@:}
35684 @r{ @: g P @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-print@:}
35685 @r{ @: g R @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-y@:}
35686 @r{ @: g S @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-point-style@:}
35687 @r{ @: g T @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-y@:}
35688 @r{ @: g V @: @: @:calc-graph-view-trail@:}
35689 @r{ @: g X @:format @: @:calc-graph-geometry@:}
35690 @r{ @: g Z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-y@:}
35691
35692 @c
35693 @r{ @: g C-l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-z@:}
35694 @r{ @: g C-r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-z@:}
35695 @r{ @: g C-t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-z@:}
35696
35697 @c
35698 @r{ @: h b @: @: @:calc-describe-bindings@:}
35699 @r{ @: h c @:key @: @:calc-describe-key-briefly@:}
35700 @r{ @: h f @:function @: @:calc-describe-function@:}
35701 @r{ @: h h @: @: @:calc-full-help@:}
35702 @r{ @: h i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35703 @r{ @: h k @:key @: @:calc-describe-key@:}
35704 @r{ @: h n @: @: @:calc-view-news@:}
35705 @r{ @: h s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35706 @r{ @: h t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35707 @r{ @: h v @:var @: @:calc-describe-variable@:}
35708
35709 @c
35710 @r{ @: j 1-9 @: @: @:calc-select-part@:}
35711 @r{ @: j @summarykey{RET} @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-selection@:}
35712 @r{ @: j @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 27 @:calc-del-selection@:}
35713 @r{ @: j ' @:formula @: 27 @:calc-enter-selection@:}
35714 @r{ @: j ` @:editing @: 27,30 @:calc-edit-selection@:}
35715 @r{ @: j " @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-expand-formula@:}
35716
35717 @c
35718 @r{ @: j + @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-add-both-sides@:}
35719 @r{ @: j - @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-sub-both-sides@:}
35720 @r{ @: j * @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-mul-both-sides@:}
35721 @r{ @: j / @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-div-both-sides@:}
35722 @r{ @: j & @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-invert@:}
35723
35724 @c
35725 @r{ @: j a @: @: 27 @:calc-select-additional@:}
35726 @r{ @: j b @: @: 12 @:calc-break-selections@:}
35727 @r{ @: j c @: @: @:calc-clear-selections@:}
35728 @r{ @: j d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-selections@:}
35729 @r{ @: j e @: @: 12 @:calc-enable-selections@:}
35730 @r{ @: j l @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-less@:}
35731 @r{ @: j m @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-more@:}
35732 @r{ @: j n @: @: 4 @:calc-select-next@:}
35733 @r{ @: j o @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once@:}
35734 @r{ @: j p @: @: 4 @:calc-select-previous@:}
35735 @r{ @: j r @:rules @:4,8,27 @:calc-rewrite-selection@:}
35736 @r{ @: j s @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here@:}
35737 @r{ @: j u @: @: 27 @:calc-unselect@:}
35738 @r{ @: j v @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-evaluate@:}
35739
35740 @c
35741 @r{ @: j C @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-commute@:}
35742 @r{ @: j D @: @: 4,27 @:calc-sel-distribute@:}
35743 @r{ @: j E @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-jump-equals@:}
35744 @r{ @: j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@:}
35745 @r{ @: H j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@: (full)}
35746 @r{ @: j L @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-left@:}
35747 @r{ @: j M @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-merge@:}
35748 @r{ @: j N @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-negate@:}
35749 @r{ @: j O @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once-maybe@:}
35750 @r{ @: j R @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-right@:}
35751 @r{ @: j S @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here-maybe@:}
35752 @r{ @: j U @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-unpack@:}
35753
35754 @c
35755 @r{ @: k a @: @: @:calc-random-again@:}
35756 @r{ n@: k b @: @: 1 @:bern@:(n)}
35757 @r{ n x@: H k b @: @: 2 @:bern@:(n,x)}
35758 @r{ n m@: k c @: @: 2 @:choose@:(n,m)}
35759 @r{ n m@: H k c @: @: 2 @:perm@:(n,m)}
35760 @r{ n@: k d @: @: 1 @:dfact@:(n) n!!}
35761 @r{ n@: k e @: @: 1 @:euler@:(n)}
35762 @r{ n x@: H k e @: @: 2 @:euler@:(n,x)}
35763 @r{ n@: k f @: @: 4 @:prfac@:(n)}
35764 @r{ n m@: k g @: @: 2 @:gcd@:(n,m)}
35765 @r{ m n@: k h @: @: 14 @:shuffle@:(n,m)}
35766 @r{ n m@: k l @: @: 2 @:lcm@:(n,m)}
35767 @r{ n@: k m @: @: 1 @:moebius@:(n)}
35768 @r{ n@: k n @: @: 4 @:nextprime@:(n)}
35769 @r{ n@: I k n @: @: 4 @:prevprime@:(n)}
35770 @r{ n@: k p @: @: 4,28 @:calc-prime-test@:}
35771 @r{ m@: k r @: @: 14 @:random@:(m)}
35772 @r{ n m@: k s @: @: 2 @:stir1@:(n,m)}
35773 @r{ n m@: H k s @: @: 2 @:stir2@:(n,m)}
35774 @r{ n@: k t @: @: 1 @:totient@:(n)}
35775
35776 @c
35777 @r{ n p x@: k B @: @: @:utpb@:(x,n,p)}
35778 @r{ n p x@: I k B @: @: @:ltpb@:(x,n,p)}
35779 @r{ v x@: k C @: @: @:utpc@:(x,v)}
35780 @r{ v x@: I k C @: @: @:ltpc@:(x,v)}
35781 @r{ n m@: k E @: @: @:egcd@:(n,m)}
35782 @r{v1 v2 x@: k F @: @: @:utpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
35783 @r{v1 v2 x@: I k F @: @: @:ltpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
35784 @r{ m s x@: k N @: @: @:utpn@:(x,m,s)}
35785 @r{ m s x@: I k N @: @: @:ltpn@:(x,m,s)}
35786 @r{ m x@: k P @: @: @:utpp@:(x,m)}
35787 @r{ m x@: I k P @: @: @:ltpp@:(x,m)}
35788 @r{ v x@: k T @: @: @:utpt@:(x,v)}
35789 @r{ v x@: I k T @: @: @:ltpt@:(x,v)}
35790
35791 @c
35792 @r{ @: m a @: @: 12,13 @:calc-algebraic-mode@:}
35793 @r{ @: m d @: @: @:calc-degrees-mode@:}
35794 @r{ @: m e @: @: @:calc-embedded-preserve-modes@:}
35795 @r{ @: m f @: @: 12 @:calc-frac-mode@:}
35796 @r{ @: m g @: @: 52 @:calc-get-modes@:}
35797 @r{ @: m h @: @: @:calc-hms-mode@:}
35798 @r{ @: m i @: @: 12,13 @:calc-infinite-mode@:}
35799 @r{ @: m m @: @: @:calc-save-modes@:}
35800 @r{ @: m p @: @: 12 @:calc-polar-mode@:}
35801 @r{ @: m r @: @: @:calc-radians-mode@:}
35802 @r{ @: m s @: @: 12 @:calc-symbolic-mode@:}
35803 @r{ @: m t @: @: 12 @:calc-total-algebraic-mode@:}
35804 @r{ @: m v @: @: 12,13 @:calc-matrix-mode@:}
35805 @r{ @: m w @: @: 13 @:calc-working@:}
35806 @r{ @: m x @: @: @:calc-always-load-extensions@:}
35807
35808 @c
35809 @r{ @: m A @: @: 12 @:calc-alg-simplify-mode@:}
35810 @r{ @: m B @: @: 12 @:calc-bin-simplify-mode@:}
35811 @r{ @: m C @: @: 12 @:calc-auto-recompute@:}
35812 @r{ @: m D @: @: @:calc-default-simplify-mode@:}
35813 @r{ @: m E @: @: 12 @:calc-ext-simplify-mode@:}
35814 @r{ @: m F @:filename @: 13 @:calc-settings-file-name@:}
35815 @r{ @: m N @: @: 12 @:calc-num-simplify-mode@:}
35816 @r{ @: m O @: @: 12 @:calc-no-simplify-mode@:}
35817 @r{ @: m R @: @: 12,13 @:calc-mode-record-mode@:}
35818 @r{ @: m S @: @: 12 @:calc-shift-prefix@:}
35819 @r{ @: m U @: @: 12 @:calc-units-simplify-mode@:}
35820
35821 @c
35822 @r{ @: r s @:register @: 27 @:calc-copy-to-register@:}
35823 @r{ @: r i @:register @: @:calc-insert-register@:}
35824
35825 @c
35826 @r{ @: s c @:var1, var2 @: 29 @:calc-copy-variable@:}
35827 @r{ @: s d @:var, decl @: @:calc-declare-variable@:}
35828 @r{ @: s e @:var, editing @: 29,30 @:calc-edit-variable@:}
35829 @r{ @: s i @:buffer @: @:calc-insert-variables@:}
35830 @r{ @: s k @:const, var @: 29 @:calc-copy-special-constant@:}
35831 @r{ a b@: s l @:var @: 29 @:@:a (letting var=b)}
35832 @r{ a ...@: s m @:op, var @: 22,29 @:calc-store-map@:}
35833 @r{ @: s n @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-neg@: (v/-1)}
35834 @r{ @: s p @:var @: 29 @:calc-permanent-variable@:}
35835 @r{ @: s r @:var @: 29 @:@:v (recalled value)}
35836 @r{ @: r 0-9 @: @: @:calc-recall-quick@:}
35837 @r{ a@: s s @:var @: 28,29 @:calc-store@:}
35838 @r{ a@: s 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-quick@:}
35839 @r{ a@: s t @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-into@:}
35840 @r{ a@: t 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-into-quick@:}
35841 @r{ @: s u @:var @: 29 @:calc-unstore@:}
35842 @r{ a@: s x @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-exchange@:}
35843
35844 @c
35845 @r{ @: s A @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-AlgSimpRules@:}
35846 @r{ @: s D @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Decls@:}
35847 @r{ @: s E @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-EvalRules@:}
35848 @r{ @: s F @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-FitRules@:}
35849 @r{ @: s G @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-GenCount@:}
35850 @r{ @: s H @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Holidays@:}
35851 @r{ @: s I @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-IntegLimit@:}
35852 @r{ @: s L @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-LineStyles@:}
35853 @r{ @: s P @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PointStyles@:}
35854 @r{ @: s R @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PlotRejects@:}
35855 @r{ @: s T @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-TimeZone@:}
35856 @r{ @: s U @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Units@:}
35857 @r{ @: s X @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-ExtSimpRules@:}
35858
35859 @c
35860 @r{ a@: s + @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-plus@: (v+a)}
35861 @r{ a@: s - @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-minus@: (v-a)}
35862 @r{ a@: s * @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-times@: (v*a)}
35863 @r{ a@: s / @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-div@: (v/a)}
35864 @r{ a@: s ^ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-power@: (v^a)}
35865 @r{ a@: s | @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-concat@: (v|a)}
35866 @r{ @: s & @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-inv@: (v^-1)}
35867 @r{ @: s [ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-decr@: (v-1)}
35868 @r{ @: s ] @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-incr@: (v-(-1))}
35869 @r{ a b@: s : @: @: 2 @:assign@:(a,b) a @tfn{:=} b}
35870 @r{ a@: s = @: @: 1 @:evalto@:(a,b) a @tfn{=>}}
35871
35872 @c
35873 @r{ @: t [ @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-first@:}
35874 @r{ @: t ] @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-last@:}
35875 @r{ @: t < @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-left@:}
35876 @r{ @: t > @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-right@:}
35877 @r{ @: t . @: @: 12 @:calc-full-trail-vectors@:}
35878
35879 @c
35880 @r{ @: t b @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-backward@:}
35881 @r{ @: t d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-trail-display@:}
35882 @r{ @: t f @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-forward@:}
35883 @r{ @: t h @: @: @:calc-trail-here@:}
35884 @r{ @: t i @: @: @:calc-trail-in@:}
35885 @r{ @: t k @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-kill@:}
35886 @r{ @: t m @:string @: @:calc-trail-marker@:}
35887 @r{ @: t n @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-next@:}
35888 @r{ @: t o @: @: @:calc-trail-out@:}
35889 @r{ @: t p @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-previous@:}
35890 @r{ @: t r @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-backward@:}
35891 @r{ @: t s @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-forward@:}
35892 @r{ @: t y @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-yank@:}
35893
35894 @c
35895 @r{ d@: t C @:oz, nz @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
35896 @r{d oz nz@: t C @:$ @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
35897 @r{ d@: t D @: @: 15 @:date@:(d)}
35898 @r{ d@: t I @: @: 4 @:incmonth@:(d,n)}
35899 @r{ d@: t J @: @: 16 @:julian@:(d,z)}
35900 @r{ d@: t M @: @: 17 @:newmonth@:(d,n)}
35901 @r{ @: t N @: @: 16 @:now@:(z)}
35902 @r{ d@: t P @:1 @: 31 @:year@:(d)}
35903 @r{ d@: t P @:2 @: 31 @:month@:(d)}
35904 @r{ d@: t P @:3 @: 31 @:day@:(d)}
35905 @r{ d@: t P @:4 @: 31 @:hour@:(d)}
35906 @r{ d@: t P @:5 @: 31 @:minute@:(d)}
35907 @r{ d@: t P @:6 @: 31 @:second@:(d)}
35908 @r{ d@: t P @:7 @: 31 @:weekday@:(d)}
35909 @r{ d@: t P @:8 @: 31 @:yearday@:(d)}
35910 @r{ d@: t P @:9 @: 31 @:time@:(d)}
35911 @r{ d@: t U @: @: 16 @:unixtime@:(d,z)}
35912 @r{ d@: t W @: @: 17 @:newweek@:(d,w)}
35913 @r{ d@: t Y @: @: 17 @:newyear@:(d,n)}
35914
35915 @c
35916 @r{ a b@: t + @: @: 2 @:badd@:(a,b)}
35917 @r{ a b@: t - @: @: 2 @:bsub@:(a,b)}
35918
35919 @c
35920 @r{ @: u a @: @: 12 @:calc-autorange-units@:}
35921 @r{ a@: u b @: @: @:calc-base-units@:}
35922 @r{ a@: u c @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-units@:}
35923 @r{ defn@: u d @:unit, descr @: @:calc-define-unit@:}
35924 @r{ @: u e @: @: @:calc-explain-units@:}
35925 @r{ @: u g @:unit @: @:calc-get-unit-definition@:}
35926 @r{ @: u p @: @: @:calc-permanent-units@:}
35927 @r{ a@: u r @: @: @:calc-remove-units@:}
35928 @r{ a@: u s @: @: @:usimplify@:(a)}
35929 @r{ a@: u t @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-temperature@:}
35930 @r{ @: u u @:unit @: @:calc-undefine-unit@:}
35931 @r{ @: u v @: @: @:calc-enter-units-table@:}
35932 @r{ a@: u x @: @: @:calc-extract-units@:}
35933 @r{ a@: u 0-9 @: @: @:calc-quick-units@:}
35934
35935 @c
35936 @r{ v1 v2@: u C @: @: 20 @:vcov@:(v1,v2)}
35937 @r{ v1 v2@: I u C @: @: 20 @:vpcov@:(v1,v2)}
35938 @r{ v1 v2@: H u C @: @: 20 @:vcorr@:(v1,v2)}
35939 @r{ v@: u G @: @: 19 @:vgmean@:(v)}
35940 @r{ a b@: H u G @: @: 2 @:agmean@:(a,b)}
35941 @r{ v@: u M @: @: 19 @:vmean@:(v)}
35942 @r{ v@: I u M @: @: 19 @:vmeane@:(v)}
35943 @r{ v@: H u M @: @: 19 @:vmedian@:(v)}
35944 @r{ v@: I H u M @: @: 19 @:vhmean@:(v)}
35945 @r{ v@: u N @: @: 19 @:vmin@:(v)}
35946 @r{ v@: u S @: @: 19 @:vsdev@:(v)}
35947 @r{ v@: I u S @: @: 19 @:vpsdev@:(v)}
35948 @r{ v@: H u S @: @: 19 @:vvar@:(v)}
35949 @r{ v@: I H u S @: @: 19 @:vpvar@:(v)}
35950 @r{ @: u V @: @: @:calc-view-units-table@:}
35951 @r{ v@: u X @: @: 19 @:vmax@:(v)}
35952
35953 @c
35954 @r{ v@: u + @: @: 19 @:vsum@:(v)}
35955 @r{ v@: u * @: @: 19 @:vprod@:(v)}
35956 @r{ v@: u # @: @: 19 @:vcount@:(v)}
35957
35958 @c
35959 @r{ @: V ( @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-parens@:}
35960 @r{ @: V @{ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-braces@:}
35961 @r{ @: V [ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-brackets@:}
35962 @r{ @: V ] @:ROCP @: 50 @:calc-matrix-brackets@:}
35963 @r{ @: V , @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-commas@:}
35964 @r{ @: V < @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-left-justify@:}
35965 @r{ @: V = @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-center-justify@:}
35966 @r{ @: V > @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-right-justify@:}
35967 @r{ @: V / @: @: 12,50 @:calc-break-vectors@:}
35968 @r{ @: V . @: @: 12,50 @:calc-full-vectors@:}
35969
35970 @c
35971 @r{ s t@: V ^ @: @: 2 @:vint@:(s,t)}
35972 @r{ s t@: V - @: @: 2 @:vdiff@:(s,t)}
35973 @r{ s@: V ~ @: @: 1 @:vcompl@:(s)}
35974 @r{ s@: V # @: @: 1 @:vcard@:(s)}
35975 @r{ s@: V : @: @: 1 @:vspan@:(s)}
35976 @r{ s@: V + @: @: 1 @:rdup@:(s)}
35977
35978 @c
35979 @r{ m@: V & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(m) 1/m}
35980
35981 @c
35982 @r{ v@: v a @:n @: @:arrange@:(v,n)}
35983 @r{ a@: v b @:n @: @:cvec@:(a,n)}
35984 @r{ v@: v c @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mcol@:(v,n)}
35985 @r{ v@: v c @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrcol@:(v,-n)}
35986 @r{ m@: v c @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
35987 @r{ v@: v d @: @: 25 @:diag@:(v,n)}
35988 @r{ v m@: v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m)}
35989 @r{ v m f@: H v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m,f)}
35990 @r{ v a@: v f @: @: 26 @:find@:(v,a,n)}
35991 @r{ v@: v h @: @: 1 @:head@:(v)}
35992 @r{ v@: I v h @: @: 1 @:tail@:(v)}
35993 @r{ v@: H v h @: @: 1 @:rhead@:(v)}
35994 @r{ v@: I H v h @: @: 1 @:rtail@:(v)}
35995 @r{ @: v i @:n @: 31 @:idn@:(1,n)}
35996 @r{ @: v i @:0 @: 31 @:idn@:(1)}
35997 @r{ h t@: v k @: @: 2 @:cons@:(h,t)}
35998 @r{ h t@: H v k @: @: 2 @:rcons@:(h,t)}
35999 @r{ v@: v l @: @: 1 @:vlen@:(v)}
36000 @r{ v@: H v l @: @: 1 @:mdims@:(v)}
36001 @r{ v m@: v m @: @: 2 @:vmask@:(v,m)}
36002 @r{ v@: v n @: @: 1 @:rnorm@:(v)}
36003 @r{ a b c@: v p @: @: 24 @:calc-pack@:}
36004 @r{ v@: v r @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mrow@:(v,n)}
36005 @r{ v@: v r @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrrow@:(v,-n)}
36006 @r{ m@: v r @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
36007 @r{ v i j@: v s @: @: @:subvec@:(v,i,j)}
36008 @r{ v i j@: I v s @: @: @:rsubvec@:(v,i,j)}
36009 @r{ m@: v t @: @: 1 @:trn@:(m)}
36010 @r{ v@: v u @: @: 24 @:calc-unpack@:}
36011 @r{ v@: v v @: @: 1 @:rev@:(v)}
36012 @r{ @: v x @:n @: 31 @:index@:(n)}
36013 @r{ n s i@: C-u v x @: @: @:index@:(n,s,i)}
36014
36015 @c
36016 @r{ v@: V A @:op @: 22 @:apply@:(op,v)}
36017 @r{ v1 v2@: V C @: @: 2 @:cross@:(v1,v2)}
36018 @r{ m@: V D @: @: 1 @:det@:(m)}
36019 @r{ s@: V E @: @: 1 @:venum@:(s)}
36020 @r{ s@: V F @: @: 1 @:vfloor@:(s)}
36021 @r{ v@: V G @: @: @:grade@:(v)}
36022 @r{ v@: I V G @: @: @:rgrade@:(v)}
36023 @r{ v@: V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,n)}
36024 @r{ v w@: H V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,w,n)}
36025 @r{ v1 v2@: V I @:mop aop @: 22 @:inner@:(mop,aop,v1,v2)}
36026 @r{ m@: V J @: @: 1 @:ctrn@:(m)}
36027 @r{ m1 m2@: V K @: @: @:kron@:(m1,m2)}
36028 @r{ m@: V L @: @: 1 @:lud@:(m)}
36029 @r{ v@: V M @:op @: 22,23 @:map@:(op,v)}
36030 @r{ v@: V N @: @: 1 @:cnorm@:(v)}
36031 @r{ v1 v2@: V O @:op @: 22 @:outer@:(op,v1,v2)}
36032 @r{ v@: V R @:op @: 22,23 @:reduce@:(op,v)}
36033 @r{ v@: I V R @:op @: 22,23 @:rreduce@:(op,v)}
36034 @r{ a n@: H V R @:op @: 22 @:nest@:(op,a,n)}
36035 @r{ a@: I H V R @:op @: 22 @:fixp@:(op,a)}
36036 @r{ v@: V S @: @: @:sort@:(v)}
36037 @r{ v@: I V S @: @: @:rsort@:(v)}
36038 @r{ m@: V T @: @: 1 @:tr@:(m)}
36039 @r{ v@: V U @:op @: 22 @:accum@:(op,v)}
36040 @r{ v@: I V U @:op @: 22 @:raccum@:(op,v)}
36041 @r{ a n@: H V U @:op @: 22 @:anest@:(op,a,n)}
36042 @r{ a@: I H V U @:op @: 22 @:afixp@:(op,a)}
36043 @r{ s t@: V V @: @: 2 @:vunion@:(s,t)}
36044 @r{ s t@: V X @: @: 2 @:vxor@:(s,t)}
36045
36046 @c
36047 @r{ @: Y @: @: @:@:user commands}
36048
36049 @c
36050 @r{ @: z @: @: @:@:user commands}
36051
36052 @c
36053 @r{ c@: Z [ @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-if@:}
36054 @r{ c@: Z | @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-else-if@:}
36055 @r{ @: Z : @: @: @:calc-kbd-else@:}
36056 @r{ @: Z ] @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-if@:}
36057
36058 @c
36059 @r{ @: Z @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-kbd-loop@:}
36060 @r{ c@: Z / @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-break@:}
36061 @r{ @: Z @} @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-loop@:}
36062 @r{ n@: Z < @: @: @:calc-kbd-repeat@:}
36063 @r{ @: Z > @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-repeat@:}
36064 @r{ n m@: Z ( @: @: @:calc-kbd-for@:}
36065 @r{ s@: Z ) @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-for@:}
36066
36067 @c
36068 @r{ @: Z C-g @: @: @:@:cancel if/loop command}
36069
36070 @c
36071 @r{ @: Z ` @: @: @:calc-kbd-push@:}
36072 @r{ @: Z ' @: @: @:calc-kbd-pop@:}
36073 @r{ @: Z # @: @: @:calc-kbd-query@:}
36074
36075 @c
36076 @r{ comp@: Z C @:func, args @: 50 @:calc-user-define-composition@:}
36077 @r{ @: Z D @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define@:}
36078 @r{ @: Z E @:key, editing @: 30 @:calc-user-define-edit@:}
36079 @r{ defn@: Z F @:k, c, f, a, n@: 28 @:calc-user-define-formula@:}
36080 @r{ @: Z G @:key @: @:calc-get-user-defn@:}
36081 @r{ @: Z I @: @: @:calc-user-define-invocation@:}
36082 @r{ @: Z K @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define-kbd-macro@:}
36083 @r{ @: Z P @:key @: @:calc-user-define-permanent@:}
36084 @r{ @: Z S @: @: 30 @:calc-edit-user-syntax@:}
36085 @r{ @: Z T @: @: 12 @:calc-timing@:}
36086 @r{ @: Z U @:key @: @:calc-user-undefine@:}
36087
36088 @end format
36089
36090 @noindent
36091 NOTES
36092
36093 @enumerate
36094 @c 1
36095 @item
36096 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
36097 Negative prefix arguments apply to the @expr{-n}th stack entry.
36098 A prefix of zero applies to the entire stack. (For @key{LFD} and
36099 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, the meaning of the sign is reversed.)
36100
36101 @c 2
36102 @item
36103 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
36104 Negative prefix arguments apply to the top stack entry
36105 and the next @expr{-n} stack entries.
36106
36107 @c 3
36108 @item
36109 Positive prefix arguments rotate top @expr{n} stack entries by one.
36110 Negative prefix arguments rotate the entire stack by @expr{-n}.
36111 A prefix of zero reverses the entire stack.
36112
36113 @c 4
36114 @item
36115 Prefix argument specifies a repeat count or distance.
36116
36117 @c 5
36118 @item
36119 Positive prefix arguments specify a precision @expr{p}.
36120 Negative prefix arguments reduce the current precision by @expr{-p}.
36121
36122 @c 6
36123 @item
36124 A prefix argument is interpreted as an additional step-size parameter.
36125 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix means to prompt for the step size.
36126
36127 @c 7
36128 @item
36129 A prefix argument specifies simplification level and depth.
36130 1=Default, 2=like @kbd{a s}, 3=like @kbd{a e}.
36131
36132 @c 8
36133 @item
36134 A negative prefix operates only on the top level of the input formula.
36135
36136 @c 9
36137 @item
36138 Positive prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, unsigned.
36139 Negative prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, signed.
36140
36141 @c 10
36142 @item
36143 Prefix arguments specify the shift amount @expr{n}. The @expr{w} argument
36144 cannot be specified in the keyboard version of this command.
36145
36146 @c 11
36147 @item
36148 From the keyboard, @expr{d} is omitted and defaults to zero.
36149
36150 @c 12
36151 @item
36152 Mode is toggled; a positive prefix always sets the mode, and a negative
36153 prefix always clears the mode.
36154
36155 @c 13
36156 @item
36157 Some prefix argument values provide special variations of the mode.
36158
36159 @c 14
36160 @item
36161 A prefix argument, if any, is used for @expr{m} instead of taking
36162 @expr{m} from the stack. @expr{M} may take any of these values:
36163 @iftex
36164 {@advance@tableindent10pt
36165 @end iftex
36166 @table @asis
36167 @item Integer
36168 Random integer in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36169 @item Float
36170 Random floating-point number in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36171 @item 0.0
36172 Gaussian with mean 1 and standard deviation 0.
36173 @item Error form
36174 Gaussian with specified mean and standard deviation.
36175 @item Interval
36176 Random integer or floating-point number in that interval.
36177 @item Vector
36178 Random element from the vector.
36179 @end table
36180 @iftex
36181 }
36182 @end iftex
36183
36184 @c 15
36185 @item
36186 A prefix argument from 1 to 6 specifies number of date components
36187 to remove from the stack. @xref{Date Conversions}.
36188
36189 @c 16
36190 @item
36191 A prefix argument specifies a time zone; @kbd{C-u} says to take the
36192 time zone number or name from the top of the stack. @xref{Time Zones}.
36193
36194 @c 17
36195 @item
36196 A prefix argument specifies a day number (0-6, 0-31, or 0-366).
36197
36198 @c 18
36199 @item
36200 If the input has no units, you will be prompted for both the old and
36201 the new units.
36202
36203 @c 19
36204 @item
36205 With a prefix argument, collect that many stack entries to form the
36206 input data set. Each entry may be a single value or a vector of values.
36207
36208 @c 20
36209 @item
36210 With a prefix argument of 1, take a single
36211 @texline @var{n}@math{\times2}
36212 @infoline @mathit{@var{N}x2}
36213 matrix from the stack instead of two separate data vectors.
36214
36215 @c 21
36216 @item
36217 The row or column number @expr{n} may be given as a numeric prefix
36218 argument instead. A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix says to take @expr{n}
36219 from the top of the stack. If @expr{n} is a vector or interval,
36220 a subvector/submatrix of the input is created.
36221
36222 @c 22
36223 @item
36224 The @expr{op} prompt can be answered with the key sequence for the
36225 desired function, or with @kbd{x} or @kbd{z} followed by a function name,
36226 or with @kbd{$} to take a formula from the top of the stack, or with
36227 @kbd{'} and a typed formula. In the last two cases, the formula may
36228 be a nameless function like @samp{<#1+#2>} or @samp{<x, y : x+y>}, or it
36229 may include @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, etc. (where @kbd{$} will correspond to the
36230 last argument of the created function), or otherwise you will be
36231 prompted for an argument list. The number of vectors popped from the
36232 stack by @kbd{V M} depends on the number of arguments of the function.
36233
36234 @c 23
36235 @item
36236 One of the mapping direction keys @kbd{_} (horizontal, i.e., map
36237 by rows or reduce across), @kbd{:} (vertical, i.e., map by columns or
36238 reduce down), or @kbd{=} (map or reduce by rows) may be used before
36239 entering @expr{op}; these modify the function name by adding the letter
36240 @code{r} for ``rows,'' @code{c} for ``columns,'' @code{a} for ``across,''
36241 or @code{d} for ``down.''
36242
36243 @c 24
36244 @item
36245 The prefix argument specifies a packing mode. A nonnegative mode
36246 is the number of items (for @kbd{v p}) or the number of levels
36247 (for @kbd{v u}). A negative mode is as described below. With no
36248 prefix argument, the mode is taken from the top of the stack and
36249 may be an integer or a vector of integers.
36250 @iftex
36251 {@advance@tableindent-20pt
36252 @end iftex
36253 @table @cite
36254 @item -1
36255 (@var{2}) Rectangular complex number.
36256 @item -2
36257 (@var{2}) Polar complex number.
36258 @item -3
36259 (@var{3}) HMS form.
36260 @item -4
36261 (@var{2}) Error form.
36262 @item -5
36263 (@var{2}) Modulo form.
36264 @item -6
36265 (@var{2}) Closed interval.
36266 @item -7
36267 (@var{2}) Closed .. open interval.
36268 @item -8
36269 (@var{2}) Open .. closed interval.
36270 @item -9
36271 (@var{2}) Open interval.
36272 @item -10
36273 (@var{2}) Fraction.
36274 @item -11
36275 (@var{2}) Float with integer mantissa.
36276 @item -12
36277 (@var{2}) Float with mantissa in @expr{[1 .. 10)}.
36278 @item -13
36279 (@var{1}) Date form (using date numbers).
36280 @item -14
36281 (@var{3}) Date form (using year, month, day).
36282 @item -15
36283 (@var{6}) Date form (using year, month, day, hour, minute, second).
36284 @end table
36285 @iftex
36286 }
36287 @end iftex
36288
36289 @c 25
36290 @item
36291 A prefix argument specifies the size @expr{n} of the matrix. With no
36292 prefix argument, @expr{n} is omitted and the size is inferred from
36293 the input vector.
36294
36295 @c 26
36296 @item
36297 The prefix argument specifies the starting position @expr{n} (default 1).
36298
36299 @c 27
36300 @item
36301 Cursor position within stack buffer affects this command.
36302
36303 @c 28
36304 @item
36305 Arguments are not actually removed from the stack by this command.
36306
36307 @c 29
36308 @item
36309 Variable name may be a single digit or a full name.
36310
36311 @c 30
36312 @item
36313 Editing occurs in a separate buffer. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} (or
36314 @key{LFD}, or in some cases @key{RET}) to finish the edit, or kill the
36315 buffer with @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @key{LFD} key prevents evaluation
36316 of the result of the edit.
36317
36318 @c 31
36319 @item
36320 The number prompted for can also be provided as a prefix argument.
36321
36322 @c 32
36323 @item
36324 Press this key a second time to cancel the prefix.
36325
36326 @c 33
36327 @item
36328 With a negative prefix, deactivate all formulas. With a positive
36329 prefix, deactivate and then reactivate from scratch.
36330
36331 @c 34
36332 @item
36333 Default is to scan for nearest formula delimiter symbols. With a
36334 prefix of zero, formula is delimited by mark and point. With a
36335 non-zero prefix, formula is delimited by scanning forward or
36336 backward by that many lines.
36337
36338 @c 35
36339 @item
36340 Parse the region between point and mark as a vector. A nonzero prefix
36341 parses @var{n} lines before or after point as a vector. A zero prefix
36342 parses the current line as a vector. A @kbd{C-u} prefix parses the
36343 region between point and mark as a single formula.
36344
36345 @c 36
36346 @item
36347 Parse the rectangle defined by point and mark as a matrix. A positive
36348 prefix @var{n} divides the rectangle into columns of width @var{n}.
36349 A zero or @kbd{C-u} prefix parses each line as one formula. A negative
36350 prefix suppresses special treatment of bracketed portions of a line.
36351
36352 @c 37
36353 @item
36354 A numeric prefix causes the current language mode to be ignored.
36355
36356 @c 38
36357 @item
36358 Responding to a prompt with a blank line answers that and all
36359 later prompts by popping additional stack entries.
36360
36361 @c 39
36362 @item
36363 Answer for @expr{v} may also be of the form @expr{v = v_0} or
36364 @expr{v - v_0}.
36365
36366 @c 40
36367 @item
36368 With a positive prefix argument, stack contains many @expr{y}'s and one
36369 common @expr{x}. With a zero prefix, stack contains a vector of
36370 @expr{y}s and a common @expr{x}. With a negative prefix, stack
36371 contains many @expr{[x,y]} vectors. (For 3D plots, substitute
36372 @expr{z} for @expr{y} and @expr{x,y} for @expr{x}.)
36373
36374 @c 41
36375 @item
36376 With any prefix argument, all curves in the graph are deleted.
36377
36378 @c 42
36379 @item
36380 With a positive prefix, refines an existing plot with more data points.
36381 With a negative prefix, forces recomputation of the plot data.
36382
36383 @c 43
36384 @item
36385 With any prefix argument, set the default value instead of the
36386 value for this graph.
36387
36388 @c 44
36389 @item
36390 With a negative prefix argument, set the value for the printer.
36391
36392 @c 45
36393 @item
36394 Condition is considered ``true'' if it is a nonzero real or complex
36395 number, or a formula whose value is known to be nonzero; it is ``false''
36396 otherwise.
36397
36398 @c 46
36399 @item
36400 Several formulas separated by commas are pushed as multiple stack
36401 entries. Trailing @kbd{)}, @kbd{]}, @kbd{@}}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{"}
36402 delimiters may be omitted. The notation @kbd{$$$} refers to the value
36403 in stack level three, and causes the formula to replace the top three
36404 stack levels. The notation @kbd{$3} refers to stack level three without
36405 causing that value to be removed from the stack. Use @key{LFD} in place
36406 of @key{RET} to prevent evaluation; use @kbd{M-=} in place of @key{RET}
36407 to evaluate variables.
36408
36409 @c 47
36410 @item
36411 The variable is replaced by the formula shown on the right. The
36412 Inverse flag reverses the order of the operands, e.g., @kbd{I s - x}
36413 assigns
36414 @texline @math{x \coloneq a-x}.
36415 @infoline @expr{x := a-x}.
36416
36417 @c 48
36418 @item
36419 Press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see how to choose a model. Answer the
36420 variables prompt with @expr{iv} or @expr{iv;pv} to specify
36421 independent and parameter variables. A positive prefix argument
36422 takes @mathit{@var{n}+1} vectors from the stack; a zero prefix takes a matrix
36423 and a vector from the stack.
36424
36425 @c 49
36426 @item
36427 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, replace the current region of the
36428 destination buffer with the yanked text instead of inserting.
36429
36430 @c 50
36431 @item
36432 All stack entries are reformatted; the @kbd{H} prefix inhibits this.
36433 The @kbd{I} prefix sets the mode temporarily, redraws the top stack
36434 entry, then restores the original setting of the mode.
36435
36436 @c 51
36437 @item
36438 A negative prefix sets the default 3D resolution instead of the
36439 default 2D resolution.
36440
36441 @c 52
36442 @item
36443 This grabs a vector of the form [@var{prec}, @var{wsize}, @var{ssize},
36444 @var{radix}, @var{flfmt}, @var{ang}, @var{frac}, @var{symb}, @var{polar},
36445 @var{matrix}, @var{simp}, @var{inf}]. A prefix argument from 1 to 12
36446 grabs the @var{n}th mode value only.
36447 @end enumerate
36448
36449 @iftex
36450 (Space is provided below for you to keep your own written notes.)
36451 @page
36452 @endgroup
36453 @end iftex
36454
36455
36456 @c [end-summary]
36457
36458 @node Key Index, Command Index, Summary, Top
36459 @unnumbered Index of Key Sequences
36460
36461 @printindex ky
36462
36463 @node Command Index, Function Index, Key Index, Top
36464 @unnumbered Index of Calculator Commands
36465
36466 Since all Calculator commands begin with the prefix @samp{calc-}, the
36467 @kbd{x} key has been provided as a variant of @kbd{M-x} which automatically
36468 types @samp{calc-} for you. Thus, @kbd{x last-args} is short for
36469 @kbd{M-x calc-last-args}.
36470
36471 @printindex pg
36472
36473 @node Function Index, Concept Index, Command Index, Top
36474 @unnumbered Index of Algebraic Functions
36475
36476 This is a list of built-in functions and operators usable in algebraic
36477 expressions. Their full Lisp names are derived by adding the prefix
36478 @samp{calcFunc-}, as in @code{calcFunc-sqrt}.
36479 @iftex
36480 All functions except those noted with ``*'' have corresponding
36481 Calc keystrokes and can also be found in the Calc Summary.
36482 @end iftex
36483
36484 @printindex tp
36485
36486 @node Concept Index, Variable Index, Function Index, Top
36487 @unnumbered Concept Index
36488
36489 @printindex cp
36490
36491 @node Variable Index, Lisp Function Index, Concept Index, Top
36492 @unnumbered Index of Variables
36493
36494 The variables in this list that do not contain dashes are accessible
36495 as Calc variables. Add a @samp{var-} prefix to get the name of the
36496 corresponding Lisp variable.
36497
36498 The remaining variables are Lisp variables suitable for @code{setq}ing
36499 in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs} file.
36500
36501 @printindex vr
36502
36503 @node Lisp Function Index, , Variable Index, Top
36504 @unnumbered Index of Lisp Math Functions
36505
36506 The following functions are meant to be used with @code{defmath}, not
36507 @code{defun} definitions. For names that do not start with @samp{calc-},
36508 the corresponding full Lisp name is derived by adding a prefix of
36509 @samp{math-}.
36510
36511 @printindex fn
36512
36513 @bye
36514
36515
36516 @ignore
36517 arch-tag: 77a71809-fa4d-40be-b2cc-da3e8fb137c0
36518 @end ignore